Form 20-F
Table of Contents

 

 

UNITED STATES

SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION

Washington, D.C. 20549

 

 

FORM 20-F

 

 

 

¨ REGISTRATION STATEMENT PURSUANT TO SECTION 12(b) OR 12(g) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

OR

 

x ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15 (d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

FOR THE FISCAL YEAR ENDED 30 JUNE 2014

OR

 

¨ TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15 (d) OF THE SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

 

¨ SHELL COMPANY REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

Date of event requiring this shell company report                     

For the transition period from                      to                     

 

Commission file number: 001-09526   Commission file number: 001-31714
BHP BILLITON LIMITED   BHP BILLITON PLC
(ABN 49 004 028 077)   (REG. NO. 3196209)
(Exact name of Registrant as specified in its charter)   (Exact name of Registrant as specified in its charter)
VICTORIA, AUSTRALIA   ENGLAND AND WALES
(Jurisdiction of incorporation or organisation)   (Jurisdiction of incorporation or organisation)
171 COLLINS STREET, MELBOURNE,
VICTORIA 3000 AUSTRALIA
 

NEATHOUSE PLACE, LONDON

UNITED KINGDOM

(Address of principal executive offices)   (Address of principal executive offices)

 

 

Securities registered or to be registered pursuant to section 12(b) of the Act.

 

Title of each class

 

Name of each exchange on
which registered

 

Title of each class

 

Name of each exchange on
which registered

American Depositary Shares*

  New York Stock Exchange   American Depositary Shares*   New York Stock Exchange

Ordinary Shares**

  New York Stock Exchange   Ordinary Shares, nominal
value US$0.50 each**
  New York Stock Exchange

 

* Evidenced by American Depositary Receipts. Each American Depositary Receipt represents two ordinary shares of BHP Billiton Limited or BHP Billiton Plc, as the case may be.
** Not for trading, but only in connection with the listing of the applicable American Depositary Shares.

Securities registered or to be registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act.

None

Securities for which there is a reporting obligation pursuant to Section 15(d) of the Act.

None

 

 

Indicate the number of outstanding shares of each of the issuer’s classes of capital or common stock as of the close of the period covered by the annual report.

 

     BHP Billiton Limited    BHP Billiton Plc

Fully Paid Ordinary Shares

   3,211,691,105    2,136,185,454

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act.    Yes  x    No  ¨

If this report is an annual or transition report, indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934.    Yes  ¨     No  x

Note – Checking the box above will not relieve any registrant required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 from their obligations under those Sections.

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days.    Yes  x     No  ¨

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate Web site, if any, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§ 232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files).    Yes  ¨     No  ¨

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, or a non-accelerated filer. See definition of “accelerated filer and large accelerated filer” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act. (Check one):

 

Large accelerated filer    x

 

Accelerated filer    ¨

 

Non-accelerated filer    ¨

Indicate by check mark which basis of accounting the registrant has used to prepare the financial statements included in this filing:

 

U.S. GAAP  ¨

   International Financial Reporting Standards as issued by the International Accounting
Standards Board  x
   Other  ¨

If “Other” has been checked in response to the previous question, indicate by check mark which financial statement item the registrant has elected to follow.    Item 17  ¨    Item 18  ¨

If this is an annual report, indicate by checkmark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act).    Yes  ¨    No  x

 

 

 


Table of Contents

Contents

 

1    Strategic Report      1   
1.1    Our Company      1   
1.2    BHP Billiton locations      5   
1.3    Chairman’s Review      7   
1.4    Chief Executive Officer’s Report      8   
1.5    Our strategy and business model      9   
1.6    Strategic priorities      16   
1.7    Our management of risk      24   
1.8    Our approach to corporate governance      34   
1.9    Our approach to remuneration      35   
1.10    Key performance indicators      37   
1.11    Summary of consolidated performance      41   
1.12    Our Businesses      46   
1.13    Our people      68   
1.14    Sustainability      72   
1.15    Additional information      86   
2    Our assets      106   
2.1    Businesses overview      106   
2.1.1    Petroleum and Potash Business      106   
2.1.2    Copper Business      122   
2.1.3    Iron Ore Business      130   
2.1.4    Coal Business      140   
2.1.5    Aluminium, Manganese and Nickel Business      151   
2.1.6    Marketing      165   
2.2    Production      167   
2.3    Reserves      172   
2.4    Major projects      192   
2.5    Business performance      194   
3    Corporate Governance Statement      217   
3.1    Governance at BHP Billiton      217   
3.2    Board of Directors and Group Management Committee      219   
3.3    Shareholder engagement      228   
3.4    Role and responsibilities of the Board      231   
3.5    Board membership      233   
3.6    Chairman      234   
3.7    Senior Independent Director      234   
3.8    Directors skills, experience and attributes      234   
3.9    Director induction, training and development      240   
3.10    Independence      242   
3.11    Board evaluation      245   
3.12   

Board meetings and attendance

     248   
3.13   

Director re-election

     248   
3.14   

Board committees

     249   
3.15   

Risk management governance structure

     266   
3.16   

Management

     267   
3.17   

Business conduct

     269   
3.18   

Diversity and inclusion at BHP Billiton

     270   
3.19   

Market disclosure

     270   
3.20   

Remuneration

     271   
3.21   

Directors’ share ownership

     271   
3.22   

Company secretaries

     271   
3.23   

Conformance with corporate governance standards

     271   

 

i


Table of Contents
3.24   

Additional UK disclosure

     272   
4   

Remuneration Report

     273   
4.1   

Annual statement by the Remuneration Committee Chairman

     274   
4.2   

Introduction to the Remuneration Report

     276   
4.3   

Remuneration policy report

     278   
4.4   

Annual report on remuneration

     296   
5   

Directors’ Report

     335   
5.1   

Review of operations, principal activities and state of affairs

     335   
5.2   

Share capital and buy-back programs

     336   
5.3   

Results, financial instruments and going concern

     337   
5.4   

Directors

     338   
5.5   

Remuneration and share interests

     338   
5.6   

Secretaries

     339   
5.7   

Indemnities and insurance

     339   
5.8   

Employee policies

     340   
5.9   

Corporate governance

     340   
5.10   

Dividends

     340   
5.11   

Auditors

     340   
5.12   

Non-audit services

     341   
5.13   

Political donations

     341   
5.14   

Exploration, research and development

     341   
5.15   

Class order

     341   
5.16   

Proceedings on behalf of BHP Billiton Limited

     341   
5.17   

Directors’ shareholdings

     341   
5.18   

GMC members’ shareholders (other than Directors)

     341   
5.19   

Performance in relation to environmental Regulation

     342   
5.20   

Share capital, restrictions on transfer of shares and other additional information

     343   
6   

Legal proceedings

     344   
7   

Financial statements

     346   
8   

Glossary

     347   
8.1    Mining, oil and gas-related terms      347   
8.2    Non-mining, oil and gas terms      351   
8.3    Terms used in reserves and resources      356   
8.4    Units of measure      357   
9   

Shareholder information

     358   
9.1    History and development      358   
9.2    Markets      358   
9.3    Organisational structure      358   
9.4    Material contracts      361   
9.5    Constitution      361   
9.6    Share ownership      367   
9.7    Dividends      371   
9.8    Share price information      372   
9.9    American Depositary Receipts fees and charges      374   
9.10    Taxation      375   
9.11    Government regulations      383   
9.12    Ancillary information for our shareholders      386   
10   

Exhibits

     391   

 

ii


Table of Contents

Form 20-F Cross Reference Table

 

Item Number

 

Description

  

Report section reference

1.

  Identity of directors, senior management and advisors    Not applicable

2.

  Offer statistics and expected timetable    Not applicable

3.

  Key Information   

    A

  Selected financial information    1.

    B

  Capitalisation and indebtedness    Not applicable

    C

  Reasons for the offer and use of proceeds    Not applicable

    D

  Risk factors    1.7

4.

  Information on the company   

    A

  History and development of the company    1.12, 2.1, 2.2, and 9.3

    B

  Business overview    1.5 to 1.15, 2.1 to 2.5

    C

  Organisational structure    9.2 and Note 26 to the Financial Statements

    D

  Property, plant and equipment    1.12, 2.1 to 2.4

4A.

  Unresolved staff comments    None

5.

  Operating and financial review and prospects   

    A

  Operating results    1.10,1.11,1.15

    B

  Liquidity and capital resources    1.15.4, 1.15.5

    C

  Research and development, patents and licences etc    2.3, and 5.14

    D

  Trend information    1.15.1

    E

  Off-balance sheet arrangements    1.15.6 and Notes 21 and 22 to the Financial Statements

    F

  Tabular disclosure of contractual obligations    1.15.6 and Notes 21 and 22 to the Financial Statements

6.

  Directors, senior management and employees   

    A

  Directors and senior management    3.2

    B

  Compensation    4

    C

  Board practices    3.2, 3, 4.2

    D

  Employees    1.14 and 5.8

    E

  Share ownership    4, 5.8, 5.17 and 5.18

7.

  Major shareholders and related party transactions   

    A

  Major shareholders    9.6

    B

  Related party transactions    1.15.6 and Note 32 to the Financial Statements

    C

  Interests of experts and counsel    Not applicable

8.

  Financial information   

    A

  Consolidated statements and other financial information    7, 9.7 and the pages beginning on page F-1 in this Annual Report

    B

  Significant changes    1.15.6

9.

  The offer and listing   

    A

  Offer and listing details    9.8

    B

  Plan of distribution    Not applicable

    C

  Markets    9.2

    D

  Selling shareholders    Not applicable

    E

  Dilution    Not applicable

    F

  Expenses of the issue    Not applicable

10.

  Additional Information   

    A

  Share capital    Not applicable

    B

  Memorandum and articles of association    9.5 and 9.11

    C

  Material contracts    9.4

 

iii


Table of Contents

Item Number

 

Description

  

Report section reference

    D

  Exchange controls    9.11.2

    E

  Taxation    9.10

    F

  Dividends and paying agents    Not applicable

    G

  Statement by experts    Not applicable

    H

  Documents on display    9.5.14

    I

  Subsidiary information    1.15.6 and Note 26 to the Financial Statements

11.

  Quantitative and qualitative disclosures about market risk    1.15.6 and Note 29 to the Financial Statements

12.

  Description of securities other than equity securities   

    A

  Debt Securities    Not applicable

    B

  Warrants and Rights    Not applicable

    C

  Other Securities    Not applicable

    D

  American Depositary Shares    9.9

13.

  Defaults, dividend arrearages and delinquencies    There have been no defaults, dividend arrearages or delinquencies

14.

  Material modifications to the rights of security holders and use of proceeds    There have been no material modifications to the rights of security holders and use of proceeds since our last Annual Report

15.

  Controls and procedures    3.14.1

16.

    

    A

  Audit committee financial expert    3.2.1 and 3.14.1

    B

  Code of ethics    3.17

    C

  Principal accountant fees and services    3.14.1 and Note 35 to the Financial Statements

    D

  Exemptions from the listing standards for audit committees    Not applicable

    E

  Purchases of equity securities by the issuer and affiliated purchasers    5.2

    F

  Change in Registrant’s Certifying Accountant   

3.14.1

    G

  Corporate Governance    3.23

    H (proposed)

  Mine Safety and Health Administration (MSHA) Disclosure    The information concerning mine safety violations or other regulatory matters required by section 1503(a) of the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act. This item is included in Exhibit 95.1

17.

  Financial statements    Not applicable as Item 18 complied with

18.

  Financial statements    The pages beginning on page F-1 in this Annual Report, Exhibit 15.1

19.

  Exhibits    10

 

iv


Table of Contents

1    Strategic Report

1.1    Our Company

1.1.1    Group overview

We are BHP Billiton, a leading global resources company. We are among the world’s top producers of major commodities, including iron ore, metallurgical and energy coal, conventional and unconventional oil and gas, copper, aluminium, manganese, uranium, nickel and silver.

Our strategy is to own and operate large, long-life, low-cost, expandable, upstream assets diversified by commodity, geography and market. Our portfolio of high-quality growth opportunities positions BHP Billiton to continue to meet the changing needs of our customers and the resource demands of emerging and developed economies at every stage of their growth.

We extract and process minerals, oil and gas from our production operations located primarily in Australia, the Americas and southern Africa. We sell our products globally with sales and marketing taking place principally through Singapore and Houston, United States. In FY2014, our workforce consisted of approximately 123,800 employees and contractors at 130 locations in 21 countries.

The safety and health of our people and of the broader communities in which we operate are central to the success of our organisation. Regardless of where our people are located, the area of the organisation in which they work or the type of work they undertake, we strive to create an environment that is free from occupational illness or injury.

The long-term nature of our operations allows us to build collaborative community relationships. Our size and scope mean we can make a meaningful contribution to communities in which we operate, while we support the continued development of global economic growth.

We have strong governance processes in place, high standards of ethical and responsible behaviour, and we are an active contributor to societal development. We care as much about how results are achieved as we do about the results themselves. Our BHP Billiton Code of Business Conduct and specific internal policies prohibit bribery and corruption in all our business dealings regardless of the country or culture within which our people work.

1.1.2    Our structure

BHP Billiton operates under a Dual Listed Company (DLC) structure, with two parent companies BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc operated as a single economic entity, run by a unified Board and management team. Our headquarters are located in Melbourne, Australia.

BHP Billiton Limited has a primary listing on the Australian Securities Exchange (ASX) in Australia. BHP Billiton Plc has a premium listing on the UK Listing Authority’s Official List and its ordinary shares are admitted to trading on the London Stock Exchange (LSE) in the United Kingdom and a secondary listing on the Johannesburg Stock Exchange (JSE) in South Africa. In addition, BHP Billiton Limited American Depositary Receipts (ADRs) and BHP Billiton Plc ADRs trade on the New York Stock Exchange (NYSE) in the United States.

Our Operating Model describes the way the Company is organised and sets out the relationship between the Businesses, Group Functions and Marketing. The Operating Model defines how we work, how we are organised and how we measure performance.

 

  Businesses: Our assets, operations and interests are separated into five business units. These Businesses are: Petroleum and Potash; Copper; Iron Ore; Coal; and Aluminium, Manganese and Nickel. The Operating Model has been designed to ensure that decision-making remains as close to the Businesses as possible.

 

1


Table of Contents
  Group Functions: Group Functions support the Businesses and operate under a defined set of accountabilities authorised by the Group Management Committee (GMC). Our Group Functions are primarily located in Melbourne, London and Singapore.

 

  Marketing: Marketing is responsible for selling our products and for the purchase of all major raw materials; managing the supply chain from assets to markets and raw materials from suppliers to assets; achieving market clearing prices for the Group’s products; managing price risk; and developing a single Company view of the markets.

The core principles of the Operating Model include mandatory performance requirements, common organisational design, common systems and processes, and common planning and reporting.

The Operating Model is designed to deliver a simple and scalable organisation to achieve a sustainable improvement in productivity by providing performance transparency, eliminating duplication of effort and enabling the more rapid identification and deployment of best practice.

1.1.3    Strategic context

The mineral and energy commodities we produce are crucial at all stages of economic development. Emerging economies require construction materials like steel as their populations expand and new cities and heavy industry develop. As economies grow and people become wealthier, a consumer economy emerges and steel intensity slows while demand increases for materials that are used in consumer goods, such as copper. Agricultural demand increases steadily with income.

Access to energy underpins economic development. The most rapid demand growth comes at the earliest stages when people first gain access to modern energy supplies. In the next 20 years, we expect 1.7 billion people to gain access to electricity for the first time. Reliable and affordable energy supports the development of industry and as incomes rise, more people can buy consumer goods, like cars and appliances, further increasing the demand for energy.

We are proud that the supply of our products supports global economic growth and development, with the associated reduction in poverty and improvement in living standards. Continued global development depends on access to affordable energy and other critical resources.

Demand for energy is widely expected to increase by more than 30 per cent in the next 20 years, with two thirds of new demand originating from Asia and half from China and India. Africa is expected to see the fastest growth, albeit from a lower base. The way these regions meet their energy needs will significantly influence commodity demand.

Every nation will choose a different mix of energy sources, which balances affordability and security of supply. The Intergovernmental Panel on Climate Change (IPCC), the International Energy Agency and others believe that over the next few decades fossil fuels will remain central to the energy mix as their affordability and the scale of existing infrastructure make them hard to practically replace, although their exact percentage varies across a range of scenarios.

Our strategy is tied to economic growth in both emerging and developed economies. Sustainable growth requires an effective response to climate change. BHP Billiton accepts the IPCC’s assessment of climate change science, which has found that warming of the climate is unequivocal, the human influence is clear and physical impacts are unavoidable. We believe that the world must pursue the twin objectives of limiting climate change to the lower end of the IPCC emission scenarios in line with current international agreements, while providing access to the affordable energy required to continue the economic growth essential for maintaining living standards and alleviating poverty.

 

2


Table of Contents

The global challenge of climate change remains a priority for us. Our approach to investment decision-making and portfolio management and the diversity of our overall portfolio positions us not only to manage and respond to changes, but also to capture opportunities to grow shareholder value over time. We are taking action by focusing on reducing our emissions, increasing our preparedness for physical climate impacts and working with others, including industry and governments, to support effective responses to climate change. We support development of a long-term policy framework that uses a portfolio of complementary measures, including a price on carbon that addresses competitiveness concerns, support for energy efficiency and low emissions technologies, and measures to build resilience. A price on carbon is an effective measure to drive greenhouse gas emission reductions and technological innovation. To effectively address the challenge of climate change, there must be a significant focus on developing and deploying low-emissions technologies. We will, through material investments in low-emissions technology, contribute to reducing emissions from fossil fuels.

1.1.4    FY2014 performance highlights

Not required for US reporting. Refer to sections 1.11 and 1.15.

1.1.5    About this Strategic Report

This Strategic Report meets the requirements of the Strategic Reporting required by the UK Companies Act and the Operating and Financial Review required by the Australian Corporations Act.

This Strategic Report provides insight into BHP Billiton’s strategy, operating and business model and objectives. It describes the principal risks the Company faces and how these risks might affect our future prospects. It also gives our perspective on our recent operational and financial performance.

We intend this disclosure to assist shareholders and other stakeholders to understand and interpret the Consolidated Financial Statements prepared in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS) included in this Annual Report. The basis of preparation of the Consolidated Financial Statements is set out in note 1 ‘Accounting policies’ to the Financial Statements. To obtain full details of the financial and operational performance of BHP Billiton this Strategic Report should be read in conjunction with the Consolidated Financial Statements and accompanying notes.

Section 1 of this Annual Report 2014 constitutes our Strategic Report 2014. References to sections beyond section 1 are references to sections in this Annual Report 2014. Shareholders may obtain a hard copy of the Annual Report free of charge by contacting our registrars, whose details are set out in our Corporate Directory at the end of this Annual Report.

All references to websites in this Annual Report are, unless expressly stated otherwise, intended to be inactive textual references for information only and any information contained in or accessible through any such website does not form a part of this Annual Report.

1.1.6    Forward looking statements

This Annual Report contains forward looking statements, including statements regarding trends in commodity prices and currency exchange rates; demand for commodities; production forecasts; plans, strategies and objectives of management; closure or divestment of certain operations or facilities (including associated costs); anticipated production or construction commencement dates; capital costs and scheduling; operating costs; anticipated productive lives of projects, mines and facilities; provisions and contingent liabilities; and tax and regulatory developments.

Forward looking statements can be identified by the use of terminology such as ‘intend’, ‘aim’, ‘project’, ‘anticipate’, ‘estimate’, ‘plan’, ‘believe’, ‘expect’, ‘may’, ‘should’, ‘will’, ‘continue’ or similar words. These statements discuss future expectations concerning the results of operations or financial condition, or provide other forward looking statements.

 

3


Table of Contents

These forward looking statements are not guarantees or predictions of future performance, and involve known and unknown risks, uncertainties and other factors, many of which are beyond our control, and which may cause actual results to differ materially from those expressed in the statements contained in this Annual Report. Readers are cautioned not to put undue reliance on forward looking statements.

For example, our future revenues from our operations, projects or mines described in this Annual Report will be based, in part, upon the market price of the minerals, metals or petroleum products produced, which may vary significantly from current levels. These variations, if materially adverse, may affect the timing or the feasibility of the development of a particular project, the expansion of certain facilities or mines, or the continuation of existing operations.

Other factors that may affect the actual construction or production commencement dates, costs or production output and anticipated lives of operations, mines or facilities include our ability to profitably produce and transport the minerals, petroleum and/or metals extracted to applicable markets; the impact of foreign currency exchange rates on the market prices of the minerals, petroleum or metals we produce; activities of government authorities in the countries where we are exploring or developing projects, facilities or mines, including increases in taxes, changes in environmental and other regulations and political uncertainty; labour unrest; and other factors identified in the risk factors in section 1.7.2 of this Annual Report.

Except as required by applicable regulations or by law, the Group does not undertake to publicly update or review any forward looking statements, whether as a result of new information or future events.

Past performance cannot be relied on as a guide to future performance.

1.1.7    Proposed demerger of assets

On 19 August 2014, we announced plans to create an independent global metals and mining company based on a selection of BHP Billiton’s high-quality aluminium, coal, manganese, nickel and silver assets. Separating these assets via a demerger has the potential to unlock shareholder value by significantly simplifying the BHP Billiton Group and creating a new company specifically designed to enhance the performance of its assets.

Once simplified, BHP Billiton will be almost exclusively focused on our large, long-life iron ore, copper, coal, petroleum and potash basins. With fewer assets and a greater upstream focus, we plan to reduce costs and improve the productivity of our largest Businesses more quickly. As a result, our portfolio is expected to generate growth in free cash flow and a superior return on investment.

A final Board decision on the proposed demerger will only be made once the necessary government, taxation, regulatory and other third party approvals are secured on satisfactory terms. Once the necessary approvals are in place, shareholders will have the opportunity to vote on the proposed demerger.

For additional information on the proposed demerger of assets, refer to section 1.6.4 of this Annual Report.

 

4


Table of Contents

1.2    BHP Billiton locations

 

LOGO

 

5


Table of Contents

 

LOGO

 

6


Table of Contents

1.3    Chairman’s Review

Dear Shareholder

I am pleased to report that your Company delivered strong performance this past financial year. BHP Billiton reported an Attributable profit of US$13.8 billion and Net operating cash flow of US$25.4 billion. These strong results were underpinned by increased production and productivity-led cost efficiencies.

Our balance sheet remains strong and we have maintained our solid ‘A’ credit rating. The full-year progressive base dividend was increased by 4.3 per cent to 121 US cents per share. At the same time, the Company has continued to invest in high-return growth options within the existing portfolio.

Markets for our commodities have been affected by the mixed global economic environment, with solid but moderately slower Chinese growth, underlying momentum in the United States and some positive signs in Japan, while the European Union has remained weak. Overall, demand for our commodities continues to be strong, underpinning the long-term outlook for our portfolio of products.

We continuously review our strategy against changes in the external environment, including climate change. We consider various scenarios and the risks and opportunities facing the natural resources sector and seek to optimise the investments we make on behalf of shareholders.

Our position on climate change is clear. Sustainable growth requires an effective response to climate change. We accept the Intergovernmental Panel on Climate Change’s assessment that warming of the climate is unequivocal, the human influence is clear and the physical impacts are unavoidable. We believe that the Board’s approach to strategy, investment decision-making and portfolio management, as well as the diversity of our overall portfolio, positions us to manage and respond to changes and capture opportunities to grow shareholder value over time. We believe that the resilience of our portfolio under a range of climate change scenarios is underpinned by its diversity and by the relatively short pay-back periods for most of our present and future investments in fossil fuels production. BHP Billiton is committed to reducing greenhouse gas emissions in its own operations, to actively participating in the development and deployment of low-emissions technologies and to being a leader in our sector on climate change action and advocacy.

Next year marks the 130th anniversary of the founding and stock exchange listing of The Broken Hill Proprietary Company Limited. Over these years the Company has reshaped its business to maintain its industry leadership. We moved from mining silver, lead and zinc at Broken Hill, to producing steel, and then to petroleum in Bass Strait, iron ore in the Pilbara, metallurgical coal in the Bowen Basin and copper in the Andes.

For the past 10 years we have also been simplifying our portfolio and looking at ways to make your Company simpler and more productive. In the last two years alone we have sold US$6.7 billion of assets at attractive prices. This year, we have proposed another step in our evolution with the demerger of selected aluminium, coal, manganese, nickel and silver assets. This proposed demerger will allow BHP Billiton to improve the productivity of our largest businesses more quickly and create a new global metals and mining company specifically designed to enhance the performance of the demerged assets. All BHP Billiton shareholders would retain their existing shares in BHP Billiton and receive shares in the new company pro rata with your BHP Billiton shareholding. Following the demerger, BHP Billiton would seek to steadily increase or at least maintain its dividend per share in US dollar terms – implying a higher payout ratio. Subject to final Board approval to proceed, shareholder approval and the receipt of satisfactory third party approvals, the demerger is expected to be completed in the first half of the 2015 calendar year.

Against the backdrop of external and organisational change, we continue to be guided by Our BHP Billiton Charter, which defines our values. Our first Charter value is Sustainability and we maintain a relentless focus on the health and safety of our people and the communities in which we operate. This year, we reported a record low total recordable injury frequency and no fatalities at our operated assets during the period. While this is an encouraging result, our efforts to protect the health and safety of our people will be unrelenting.

 

7


Table of Contents

We are committed to making a positive contribution to the communities where we live and conduct our business. This year, we contributed one per cent of pre-tax profit, investing US$242 million across a wide range of programs and activities to support our communities. These funds support local programs, such as the LEAD project which seeks to improve the lives of smallholder farmers in the rural Maputo Province of Mozambique; an innovative education program in Pakistan that has seen 800 children graduate from the program with another 2,000 currently studying in 13 model schools; the ANDA project which addresses the needs of people displaced by conflict and vulnerable communities in the Cordoba District of Colombia to complement poverty reduction efforts by the national government; and Bush Blitz, a unique species discovery program in Australia.

Our community programs are in addition to the US$9.9 billion in taxes and royalties we paid to governments and our broader economic contribution in terms of jobs, capital investment and support of local businesses.

I would like to take this opportunity to acknowledge David Crawford who will retire from the BHP Billiton Board in November 2014. David has served with distinction on the board of BHP and BHP Billiton for 20 years. In announcing our plans to create an independent global metals and mining company we said that David would become the new company’s inaugural chairman. His skills and experience make David the right person to guide the new company through its entry into the global resources sector.

In line with our planned approach to Board succession, we have appointed Malcolm Brinded to the Board as a Non-executive Director and member of the Sustainability Committee. Malcolm’s deep experience in energy, governance and sustainability will make a significant contribution to the Board.

In summary, a strong management team and over 123,000 talented employees and contractors in 21 countries have improved safety, increased production and delivered more value for shareholders and all our stakeholders. Your company does make a positive difference. BHP Billiton helps lift living standards for people around the world and we work hard to add value to the communities, regions and countries where we live and do business.

Jac Nasser AO

Chairman

1.4    Chief Executive Officer’s Report

I am pleased to report that BHP Billiton delivered a strong set of financial results in FY2014, with improvements in operating performance and safety supported by a continued focus on productivity. This performance was achieved against a background of improving economic conditions in the United States, Japan and the European Union, solid but slower Chinese economic growth and a decline in key commodity prices in a highly competitive global marketplace.

In a year of record production we had no fatalities at our operated assets and improved our total recordable injury frequency performance by nine per cent to 4.2 injuries per million hours worked. While we are encouraged to have recorded a year without fatalities, we must never rest on past performance. We will continue to relentlessly identify and manage material health and safety risks to protect our people and communities.

Annual production records were achieved at 12 of our operations and across four commodities. Western Australia Iron Ore and Queensland Coal both increased annual production volume by more than 20 per cent as we delivered more tonnes from existing infrastructure and growth projects ahead of schedule. These results were supported by our Onshore US petroleum asset delivering a 73 per cent increase in petroleum liquids production.

Our safety performance improves through our continued focus on accelerating sustainable improvements in productivity by finding more efficient and effective ways of performing day-to-day operations. We delivered more than US$6.6 billion of sustainable productivity-led gains over the last two years. There are more achievements in productivity still to come as our teams continue to innovate and learn from each other, replicating best practice and operating on a common data platform across the organisation.

 

8


Table of Contents

We continue to invest selectively in those projects that meet our demanding criteria. In FY2014, we reduced our share of exploration and capital expenditure by 32 per cent to US$15.2 billion and expect this to decline to US$14.8 billion in FY2015. This approach has increased internal competition for capital, improved our capital efficiency and provides for long-term, sustainable shareholder value.

In August 2014, we announced a proposal to create an independent global metals and mining company based on a selection of BHP Billiton’s high-quality aluminium, coal, manganese, nickel and silver assets. Separating these assets via a demerger has the potential to unlock shareholder value by significantly simplifying the BHP Billiton Group and creating two portfolios of complementary assets. Once simplified, BHP Billiton would be almost exclusively focused on our large, long-life iron ore, copper, coal, petroleum and potash basins. With fewer assets and a greater upstream focus, BHP Billiton would be able to reduce costs and improve the productivity of our largest businesses more quickly. The proposed demerger remains subject to the receipt of satisfactory third party approvals, final Board approval and shareholder vote.

In addition to our work to simplify BHP Billiton’s portfolio, we continue to support the communities where we operate. We support local economies through employment, infrastructure development, taxes and royalties, as well as purchasing local goods and services. We are part of these communities and we strive to be a positive and active participant in community life. In FY2014, our voluntary community investment amounted to US$242 million.

We are proud that the supply of our products supports global economic growth and development, with the associated reduction in poverty and improvement in living standards. Continued global development depends on access to affordable energy and other critical resources.

Sustainable growth requires an effective response to climate change. We accept the Intergovernmental Panel on Climate Change’s assessment that warming of the climate is unequivocal, the human influence is clear, and physical impacts are unavoidable. We are taking action by focusing on reducing our emissions, increasing our preparedness for physical climate impacts and working with others, including industry and governments, to support effective responses to climate change. We will, through material investments in low-emissions technology, contribute to reducing emissions from fossil fuels. We view climate change as a critical element in our approach to risk management across our business.

In everything we do, we are guided by Our BHP Billiton Charter values of Sustainability, Integrity, Respect, Performance, Simplicity and Accountability. These are the foundation of who we are, and how we perform our role as an active and engaged corporate citizen. I am honoured to be part of a company where we live our values every day.

Finally, I would like to thank all our suppliers, customers, host communities and shareholders for their continued support over the past year as we strive to be a valued partner of choice. I would especially like to thank our employees and contractors whose commitment and contribution is the cornerstone of the success of this Company.

Andrew Mackenzie

Chief Executive Officer

1.5    Our strategy and business model

1.5.1    Our consistent strategy

Our purpose

Our corporate purpose is to create long-term shareholder value through the discovery, acquisition, development and marketing of natural resources.

 

9


Table of Contents

Our strategy

Our strategy is to own and operate large, long-life, low-cost, expandable, upstream assets diversified by commodity, geography and market.

Our unique position in the resources industry is due to our proven and consistent strategy. In line with our strategy, we pursue growth opportunities consistent with our core skills of:

 

  evaluating, developing and extracting resources in our Businesses;

 

  distributing and selling our products, and managing financial risk associated with our revenue through Marketing;

 

  defining and governing world-class functional standards, which are implemented Group-wide through our Group Functions.

We operate in a dynamic external environment and this strategy has delivered strong company performance over time which, in turn, underpins the creation of long-term sustainable value for our shareholders, customers, employees and the communities in which we operate. We aim to deliver long-term sustainable value rather than focusing on short-term returns.

Our values

In pursuing our strategy through all stages of the economic and commodity cycles, we are guided by Our BHP Billiton Charter values of Sustainability, Integrity, Respect, Performance, Simplicity and Accountability.

Our overriding commitment is to ensuring the safety of our people, and respecting our environment and the communities in which we work. This commitment informs everything we do and influences every aspect of our work.

Operational capability is fundamental to our strategy. It is reflected in Our Charter, in particular our values of Performance – achieving superior business results by stretching our capabilities, and Simplicity – focusing our efforts on the things that matter most.

Our success factors

We are successful when:

 

  our people start each day with a sense of purpose and end the day with a sense of accomplishment;

 

  our communities, customers and suppliers value their relationships with us;

 

  our asset portfolio is world-class and sustainably developed;

 

  our operational discipline and financial strength enables our future growth; and

 

  our shareholders receive a superior return on their investment.

Our key performance indicators presented in section 1.10 of this Annual Report enable our Group Management Committee (GMC) to measure our performance.

1.5.2    Our business model

Exploration and evaluation

 

  Discovery through brownfield and greenfield exploration.

 

  Evaluating our portfolio.

 

  Divestment and acquisition.

 

10


Table of Contents

Over the past six years, brownfield exploration has increased our reserve base around our portfolio of existing assets in large resource basins, which now provide us with significant growth opportunities. This has allowed us to reduce brownfield exploration expenditure and rationalise our greenfield exploration program to focus on copper in Chile and Peru and conventional oil and gas, predominantly offshore in the Gulf of Mexico and Western Australia.

We evaluate the results of our brownfield and greenfield exploration to identify future growth projects consistent with our strategy to own and operate large, long-life, low-cost, expandable, upstream assets. We also continually evaluate our portfolio and consider divestment and acquisition opportunities.

Development

 

  Evaluating and developing projects.

The evaluation and development of large-scale resource projects generates significant value for BHP Billiton. We have a number of high-quality growth projects currently under development. We also have a large number of growth opportunities in our project pipeline in varying stages of evaluation.

In our development process, these projects progress through feasibility to execution only after external approvals. Our rigorous internal review process requires projects to pass through various tollgates for internal approvals at each stage, including Board approval for major projects.

Potential expansion projects must compete for capital in BHP Billiton and are only approved if they meet our strict criteria for investment.

Extraction, processing and transportation

 

  Open-pit and underground mining.

 

  Extracting conventional and unconventional oil and gas.

 

  Processing and refining.

Across our global operations, the diversification of our portfolio of assets by commodity, geography and market continues to be one of our differentiating features. Our goal is to safely operate all our assets at capacity through mining, extracting, processing and transporting commodities.

We continue to set production records at a number of assets. Through the development and use of standard operating practices and technology, we are driving efficiencies through improved capital intensity, labour productivity and increased utilisation of plant and machinery.

Our extraction and processing activities are mindful of our ongoing sustainability obligations, including rehabilitation at the end of the asset life.

Marketing and logistics

BHP Billiton’s Marketing network manages the Group’s revenue line and is responsible for:

 

  Selling the Group’s products and purchasing all major raw materials.

 

  Supporting the Businesses to maximise the value of upstream resources.

 

  Managing the supply chain to customers.

 

  Achieving market clearing prices for the Group’s products.

 

  Developing the Group-wide view of the markets and future pricing.

 

11


Table of Contents

The primary hub for our marketing activities is Singapore, while our marketing of oil and gas is headquartered in Houston, United States. In addition, we have marketers located close to our customers in 14 cities around the world.

Marketing’s responsibilities require an active presence in the various commodities markets, the global freight market and the crude and gas pipeline transportation market, through which we manage the supply chain for our products and develop strong integrated relationships between our Businesses and our customers.

Our market insight is strengthened by the multi-commodity nature of our organisation, our proximity to our customers and the flow of information in our centralised marketing structure.

A description of our risk factors, including those that impact our business model, and our approach to risk management are presented in section 1.7 of this Annual Report.

1.5.3    External factors and trends

Economic outlook

The global economy grew at a moderate rate in FY2014. Momentum in the United States, Japan and the United Kingdom was underpinned by central bank monetary policy. Europe’s economy improved marginally, although the recovery was constrained by high levels of unemployment. Emerging markets, including China, experienced a moderate slowdown.

In a relative sense, the Chinese economy continues to grow strongly with signs that it is rebalancing. Consumption continued to be supported by higher household incomes while fixed asset investment softened, led by the property sector, as the central bank restricted access to credit. Rapid credit growth in the non-bank financial sector remained an important concern for policy makers.

We remain confident in the short-term to medium-term outlook for the Chinese economy. Measured stimulus recently introduced by the government demonstrates their commitment to maintain economic growth above seven per cent. We believe consumption and services will continue to increase in importance, while the market’s role in allocating capital will be enhanced. Greater transparency within the fiscal system is also expected to reshape the relationship between central and local government.

The underlying performance of the US economy continued to improve despite the significant disruption caused by severe weather in the March 2014 quarter. The curtailment of quantitative easing appears to have had a limited impact on sentiment as a solid increase in demand reflects a stronger labour market, rising disposable incomes, and higher equities and housing prices. Business investment has been a weak link in the recovery so far as companies have responded slowly to better economic conditions, despite higher levels of profitability. An increase in capital spending by the global business community will be required to sustain the recovery in the medium term.

The Japanese economy has responded strongly to expansionary monetary and fiscal policy over the past year. Investment spending and wages increased as corporate profits benefited from the depreciation of the Yen, while an increase in the national sales tax in April had a limited impact on consumption. These factors have increased the potential for faster growth in the short term, although a longer-term, sustainable recovery will be contingent on the scale and speed of structural reform.

With regard to the global economy, stronger US growth and an associated tightening of monetary policy could result in the rapid outflow of capital from emerging economies. However, developing nations with sound macroeconomic fundamentals would be less likely to experience a severe impact from this transition.

 

12


Table of Contents

Climate change

The physical impacts of climate change on our operations are uncertain and particular to geographic circumstances. In addition, a number of national governments have already introduced or are contemplating the introduction of regulatory responses to greenhouse gas emissions from the combustion of fossil fuels to address the impacts of climate change. These physical effects and regulatory responses may adversely impact the productivity and financial performance of our operations.

Other external factors and trends

A number of external factors and trends have had and may continue to have a material impact on our financial condition and results of operations, as described in section 1.15.1 of this Annual Report. These factors include commodity prices, exchange rates, changes in product demand and supply, and operating costs.

The chart below presents the movements in annual average prices in our core Business commodities over the past 10 years to 30 June 2014. Over most of this period we have benefited from generally rising commodity prices while our diversified portfolio provides resilience to decreases in the price of some commodities.

Commodity prices 2005–2014

 

LOGO

Commodity prices have generally declined over the past three fiscal years and this trend has continued post 30 June 2014. A summary of the pricing trends for our most significant commodities for FY2014 is presented in section 1.15.1 of this Annual Report, along with movements in the year end commodity price of 10 per cent or more subsequent to 30 June 2014 (as at 31 August 2014).

 

13


Table of Contents

1.5.4    Corporate planning

At BHP Billiton, we have a long-standing and robust corporate planning process, which is central to the effective development and delivery of our strategy.

Our planning process continuously reviews our strategy against a constantly changing external environment and the risks and opportunities this presents, to optimise both our returns to our shareholders, and our broader contribution to society.

Core principles

The corporate planning process is designed with the following core principles:

 

  Board and GMC ownership and regular review of strategy and strategic priorities.

 

  Clear accountabilities – regular engagement through ‘Appraisals’ by the GMC with the Businesses, Marketing and Group Functions.

 

  Alignment – consistent and integrated Business, Marketing and Group Functions planning process with individual plans aggregated to form the overall corporate plan.

 

  Long to short – long-term strategic plans are followed by short-term delivery plans.

 

  Robustness – our plan should be resilient under both a range of long-term scenarios and short-term shock events.

Corporate planning framework

The flowchart below illustrates our corporate planning framework.

 

LOGO

An annual Board Strategic Planning review is the start of each Corporate planning cycle, where the GMC and the Board actively discusses the Group’s strategy. A key outcome is the CEO Message to all employees which sets the long-term direction of the Group and aligns expectations.

 

14


Table of Contents

The Directional Planning (long-term strategic planning) phase begins with the CEO Message and the issuing of long-term scenarios. Businesses use the CEO Message and scenarios to prepare their Directional Plans, which include life of asset resource plans. Plans are discussed with the GMC at the Business Directional Appraisals.

We prepare a Group-wide 20-year Plan which includes input from the Businesses’ Directional Plans. A total annual capital allocation limit is set to maximise total shareholder returns, while ensuring financial risks are appropriately mitigated. Within this capital ceiling, major growth options are optimally sequenced over the 20-year Plan through our capital allocation process.

The capital allocation process includes analysis of net present value (NPV), internal rates of return (IRR), return on capital (ROC) and margin analysis to inform decision-making. This process is further described in section 1.6.3 of this Annual Report. All available growth options are assessed and prioritised to generate a high-value and capital-efficient portfolio which provides flexibility to return excess cash to shareholders. The increased competition for capital has improved our capital productivity.

The Delivery Planning (short-term to mid-term planning) phase begins with the CEO Letter of Intent which provides capital guidance and sets the context for the Business five-year plans and two-year budgets. Again, plans are discussed with the GMC, this time at the Business Delivery Appraisals.

We believe that the rigour of our corporate planning process, combined with the flexibility it provides the Group to quickly respond to an inherently dynamic external environment, is essential to maximise total shareholder returns.

Scenarios

The corporate planning process is underpinned by scenarios that encompass a wide spectrum of potential outcomes for key global uncertainties driven by factors external to BHP Billiton. Designed to interpret technical, economic, political and global governance trends facing the resources industry, the scenarios offer a means by which to explore potential portfolio discontinuities and opportunities, as well as to test the robustness of decisions.

It should be noted that the scenarios do not constitute preferred outcomes for BHP Billiton. The Company’s approach to critical global challenges, such as the importance of addressing climate change, continues to be based on Our Charter values, including our value of Sustainability. Our position on climate change is discussed further in section 1.6.1.

The starting point of our scenario development is the construction of a Central Case, built through an in-depth, bottom up analysis using rigorous processes, benchmarked with external views, thoroughly reviewed and endorsed annually by the GMC and the Board. Currently our Central Case considers expected levels of US economic recovery, progressive development of China and India, integration of developing economies into a multi-polar economic environment, as well as action on climate change centred on national policies with short-term prioritisation to adaptation and a long-term shift to mitigation.

The scenarios are designed to be divergent, but also plausible and internally consistent, spanning different potential future business environments. A description of the key characteristics of each of our scenarios is summarised below:

 

  Good global growth underpinned by significant technological breakthroughs. Climate change science and need to act is acknowledged globally, resulting in global cooperation to mitigate carbon emissions and consumer pull for green products and services.

 

  Strong global growth, liberal trade flows, significant investment in research and technology underpinned by high gross domestic product (GDP), and a coordinated response to addressing climate change.

 

15


Table of Contents
  Solid economic growth, potential new supply from key resource basins failing to meet expectations, climate change remains a secondary issue with research focused on adaptive technology to address greater pollution, and renewable energy technologies progressing above expectations.

 

  A future state enmeshed in stagnation and protectionism, regional conflicts abound, domestic resources are prioritised for consumption even if sub-economic, low investment in research and development, and climate change commitments are abandoned in favour of adaptation.

Alongside scenarios, associated signposts (trends) and triggers (events) allow early awareness for the potential advent of a scenario, offering a powerful decision-making tool. For example, rising GDP per capita in key commodity importing countries is a signpost to an earlier shift to consumption driven economies. Another example of a potential trigger is if an accord on climate change were to be ratified during the 2015 United Nations Framework Convention on Climate Change Conference of the Parties, and then enacted globally.

We believe that our uniquely diversified portfolio is robust, both across these scenarios, and also shorter-term shock events. As an example, in a severely carbon constrained world, we believe there is significant upside for our potash and uranium commodities, and also for our high-quality hard coking coal (lower smelting emissions) and iron ore lump product (direct blast furnace feed), while copper is resilient. In aggregate these mitigate potential negative impacts in other commodities, given the relatively short pay-back periods for most present and future investments in fossil fuel production. Conversely, our portfolio allows us to capture upsides in an environment where developing countries experience strong global growth.

1.6    Strategic priorities

Our Group Management Committee (GMC) maintains a strong focus on the following strategic priorities in order to execute the Company’s strategy. A number of these priorities are monitored by the GMC using the key performance indicators as presented in section 1.10 of this Annual Report.

1.6.1    Continue to operate sustainably

We will continue to operate sustainably with our focus on the following areas:

Protect our people and improve the health and safety of our operations

The health, safety and wellbeing of our people are central to the success of our organisation. Regardless of where our people are located or the type of work they undertake, we strive to create a working environment that is free from occupational illness or injury. Identifying and managing material risk is a critical component of our management approach. By understanding and managing our risks, we provide greater protection for our people, communities and assets.

Support sustainable development of our host communities

We are a global company that values our host communities. We strive to be part of the communities in which we operate and through all our interactions seek to foster meaningful long-term relationships, which respect local cultures and create lasting benefits. Our contribution to our host communities is broad ranging. Through employment, taxes and royalties, we support local, regional and national economies. We purchase local goods and services and develop infrastructure that benefits entire communities.

We voluntarily invest one per cent of our pre-tax profit (calculated on the average of the previous three years’ pre-tax profit) in community programs that aim to have a long-lasting, positive impact on people’s quality of life. This includes implementing new and supporting existing community projects. During FY2014, our voluntary community investment totalled US$241.7 million, comprising US$141.7 million in cash, in-kind support and administrative costs, and a US$100 million contribution to the BHP Billiton Foundation.

 

16


Table of Contents

Strategic approach to climate change

As energy demand continues to increase, the global challenge of climate change remains a priority for our organisation. We are taking action by focusing on reducing our emissions, increasing our preparedness for physical climate impacts and working with others, including industry and governments, to support effective responses to climate change. Our approach to investment decision-making and portfolio management and the diversity of our overall portfolio positions us not only to manage and respond to change, but also to capture opportunities to grow shareholder value over time.

Our position on climate change

We accept the Intergovernmental Panel on Climate Change’s (IPCC) assessment of climate change science which has found that warming of the climate is unequivocal, the human influence is clear and physical impacts are unavoidable.

We believe that:

 

  The world must pursue the twin objective of:

 

    limiting climate change to the lower end of the IPCC emission scenarios in line with current international agreements; while

 

    providing access to the affordable energy required to continue the economic growth essential for maintaining living standards and alleviating poverty.

 

  Under all current plausible scenarios, fossil fuels will continue to be a significant part of the energy mix for decades.

 

  There needs to be an acceleration of effort to drive energy efficiency, develop and deploy low-emissions technology and adapt to the impacts of climate change.

 

  There should be a price on carbon, implemented in a way that addresses competitiveness concerns and achieves lowest cost emissions reductions.

We will:

 

  continue to take action to reduce our emissions;

 

  build resilience of our operations, investments, communities and ecosystems to climate change impacts;

 

  recognising their role as policy makers, seek to enhance the global response by engaging with governments;

 

  work in partnership with resource sector peers to improve sectoral performance and increase industry’s influence in policy development to deliver effective long-term regulatory responses;

 

  through material investments in low-emission technology, contribute to reducing emissions from the use of fossil fuels.

Further information on our sustainability commitments, standards and performance can be found in sections 1.14 of this Annual Report.

Additional information is also available in the Sustainability Report 2014, which can be found online at www.bhpbilliton.com.

1.6.2    Creating a more productive organisation

We are focused on achieving sustainable improvement in productivity across all aspects of our business. We believe our systems, structures, culture, people and portfolio should enable the creation of a competitive

 

17


Table of Contents

advantage by working smarter to safely deliver greater volume growth from existing plant and equipment at lower unit costs.

During the past year, we have continued to implement and embed our Operating Model, which guides how we work, defines how we are organised and enables the measurement of operational and financial performance across the Group. The Operating Model lays the foundation for sustainable productivity gains by supporting the building of capability, eliminating the duplication of effort and enabling the rapid identification and deployment of best practices.

Recognising that culture also drives performance, BHP Billiton is continuing to create an inclusive environment where every employee feels engaged. We want our people to feel listened to, be motivated to contribute to their potential and work together to unlock world-class productivity from the ground up. We support the development of our people and encourage our teams to learn from each other, identify more productive ways of working and achieve functional excellence across the Group.

Following the October 2013 completion of our deployment of 1SAP, our single Group-wide common enterprise resource planning system, we are now using common world-class business processes, standard metrics and reports that are supported by robust data. The implementation of 1SAP across the organisation supports our ability to pursue sustained improvement through the application of standard processes and performance transparency.

Our long-term commitment to improve productivity across the organisation has the potential to create significant value for shareholders and other stakeholders. Our focus on productivity has already resulted in significant improvement in operating performance at each of our major Businesses this year and record output at 12 operations.

Case study: Cost and time reductions in Petroleum’s Onshore US shale drilling and completions

Objective: To reduce the time and cost required to put each well online.

Approach: Opportunities were identified through statistical analysis and comparison against internal best practice and external benchmarks. Improvements in performance were sought in three areas: engineering (changes in the design of each well); operations (changes in how operations are conducted in the field); and supply (shifts in what and how goods and services are procured and delivered).

Outcomes: Rig mobilisation times have been cut by 12 per cent in FY2014 through the development and implementation of an optimised rig move procedure. The average drilling time for a shale gas well has declined in FY2014, while the productivity of hydraulic fracturing crews (stages completed per crew per month) has grown in FY2014.

Productivity results: Overall, total Onshore US shale drilling costs per well decreased by 15 per cent in FY2014.

1.6.3    Disciplined approach to capital management

Our priorities for capital management remain unchanged. The quality of our assets and adherence to our strategy has differentiated our performance and maximised shareholder returns by allocating capital in a disciplined manner.

Our diversified and high-margin portfolio delivers a higher return on capital with lower volatility, when compared with many peers. Over the last 10 years, we have returned US$64 billion to shareholders in the form of dividends and buy-backs.

 

18


Table of Contents

Many of the areas to which we direct our cash flow are interconnected. In order to make capital allocation decisions, we test each decision against a range of short-term and long-term criteria across several scenarios. We aim to optimise for net present value (NPV), return on capital (ROC), internal rate of return (IRR) and margin, while remaining mindful of portfolio construction and cash flow at risk. No single metric can dominate the process given the potential to create imbalances and all alternatives, including an investment in our own shares, actively compete.

Our portfolio remains a key point of difference. However, because it is opportunity-rich, capital discipline is more important. By reducing annual expenditure, we have created even more competition for capital and we have sharpened our focus on our core commodities and our high-margin major basins.

Given our portfolio of long-life orebodies, we also consider the value of future options as we must preserve their value at low cost.

The following factors are considered when making capital allocation decisions:

A strong balance sheet

Our solid ‘A’ credit rating provides flexibility and access to debt capital markets. The Group’s balance sheet continued to strengthen during FY2014. As at 30 June 2014, net debt was US$25.8 billion, a decrease of US$1.7 billion compared to the net debt position at 30 June 2013. As at 30 June 2014, the Group’s cash and cash equivalents on hand were US$8.8 billion.

During FY2014, the Group issued a four tranche Global Bond totalling US$5 billion comprising US$500 million Senior Floating Notes due 2016 paying interest at three-month US dollar LIBOR plus 25 basis points, US$500 million 2.050 per cent Senior Notes due 2018, US$1.5 billion, 3.850 per cent Senior Notes due 2023, and US$2.5 billion 5.000 per cent Senior Notes due 2043.

These funds and our balance sheet capacity were used to meet a series of financing commitments, including debt repayments of US$7.2 billion and dividend payments of US$6.4 billion.

Progressive base dividend

BHP Billiton has a progressive dividend policy. The aim of this policy is to steadily increase or at least maintain our base dividend in US dollars at each half-yearly payment. Our progressive base dividend is the minimum annual distribution that a shareholder should expect and is expected to grow broadly in accordance with the growth of our business.

On 19 August 2014, the Board determined a final dividend for the year of 62 US cents per share. Together with the interim dividend of 59 US cents per share paid to shareholders on 26 March 2014, this brought the total dividend determined for the year to 121 US cents per share, a 4.3 per cent increase over the previous year’s full-year dividend of 116 US cents per share.

 

Year ended 30 June

   2014      2013      2012  

Dividends determined in respect of the period (US cents per share)

        

Interim dividend

     59.0         57.0         55.0   

Final dividend

     62.0         59.0         57.0   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     121.0         116.0         112.0   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

19


Table of Contents

Internal competition for capital investment

By reducing annual capital expenditure and increasing competition for capital within the Group, we have prioritised higher quality growth at a higher average rate of return on incremental investment. We continue to invest selectively in those projects that meet our criteria.

During FY2014, eight projects were completed, including:

 

  Macedon (Petroleum), which delivered first petroleum production in the September 2013 quarter. Our share of development costs was approximately US$1.2 billion.

 

  North West Shelf North Rankin B Gas Compression (Petroleum), which delivered first gas production in the December 2013 quarter. Our share of development costs was approximately US$721 million as of 30 June 2014.

 

  Jimblebar mine expansion (Iron Ore), which delivered first iron ore production in the September 2013 quarter. Our share of development costs was approximately US$3.4 billion.

 

  Port blending facilities and rail yard (Iron Ore), which was completed in the December 2013 quarter. The project was delivered at a cost of US$1.1 billion (BHP Billiton share US$916 million).

 

  Samarco fourth pellet plant (Iron Ore), which delivered first iron ore pellet production in the March 2014 quarter. The final spend of the project was US$3.2 billion (BHP Billiton share US$1.6 billion).

 

  Caval Ridge (Coal), which delivered first metallurgical coal production in the June 2014 quarter. BHP Billiton’s share of the project’s cost was US$1.9 billion.

Eight major projects were in execution at 30 June 2014. Seven of our development projects are brownfield in nature, which are inherently lower risk than new greenfield projects.

Capital expenditure

Capital and exploration expenditure is disclosed for each Business in the table below.

 

Year ended 30 June

   2014      2013      2012  
     US$M      US$M      US$M  

Capital and exploration expenditure (1)

        

Petroleum and Potash

     7,070         8,439         7,063   

Copper

     3,873         4,204         3,889   

Iron Ore

     3,118         6,196         4,745   

Coal

     2,379         3,665         3,277   

Aluminium, Manganese and Nickel

     542         950         2,020   

Group and unallocated items

     21         140         136   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

BHP Billiton Group

     17,003         23,594         21,130   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1) Capital expenditure is presented on a cash basis and excludes capitalised interest, but includes capitalised exploration. Exploration expenditure is capitalised in accordance with our accounting policies, as set out in note 1 ‘Accounting policies’ in the Financial Statements.

Capital expenditure encompasses expenditure on major projects, as set out in section 2.4 of this Annual Report, and capital expenditure on sustaining and other items.

 

20


Table of Contents

Year ended 30 June

   2014     2013     2012  
     US$M     US$M     US$M  

Capital expenditure

      

Growth

     13,130        18,678        14,994   

Sustaining and other

     2,863        3,565        3,643   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

     15,993        22,243        18,637   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Exploration expenditure

      

Petroleum

     600        675        1,355   

Minerals

     410        676        1,138   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

     1,010        1,351        2,493   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total capital and exploration expenditure (cash basis)

     17,003        23,594        21,130   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Add: equity accounted investments

     871        1,493        1,164   

Less: capitalised deferred stripping

     (1,421     (1,650     (1,531

Less: non-controlling interests

     (1,272     (1,146     (970
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total capital and exploration expenditure (BHP Billiton share)

     15,181        22,291        19,793   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

BHP Billiton’s share of capital and exploration expenditure declined by 32 per cent during FY2014 to US$15.2 billion. Our rate of investment is expected to decline further in FY2015 with planned capital and exploration expenditure of approximately US$14.8 billion (BHP Billiton share).

A detailed discussion of our project pipeline (including projects approved after 30 June 2014) is located in section 2.4 of this Annual Report.

Returning excess capital to shareholders

During the last 10 years, we supplemented our progressive base dividend by returning excess capital to shareholders and returned US$23 billion in the form of buy-backs, which is almost 35 per cent of total capital returned.

We have now returned US$64 billion in the form of dividends and buy-backs over the last 10 years, equivalent to an underlying payout ratio of approximately 50 per cent.

We continue to focus on the things we can control to maximise free cash flow, like productivity and the rate at which we invest. The pace at which our balance sheet strengthens, however, will also depend on external factors like prices and foreign exchange rates. We monitor this closely and seek to return excess cash consistently and predictably.

1.6.4    Active management of our portfolio

We are concentrating our efforts on those basins where we enjoy economies of scale and a competitive advantage. Our focus on four major Businesses of Iron Ore, Petroleum, Copper, and Coal, with Potash as a potential fifth, provides the benefits of diversification.

Proposed demerger of assets

On 19 August 2014, we announced a plan to create an independent global metals and mining company based on a selection of our high-quality aluminium, coal, manganese, nickel and silver assets.

 

21


Table of Contents

As a result of the growth of our major Businesses and the Group’s substantial investment in recent years, BHP Billiton now has two great companies embedded within its portfolio. Separating these assets via a demerger has the potential to unlock shareholder value by significantly simplifying the Group.

BHP Billiton’s continued diversification

If the demerger is approved, we would focus almost exclusively on our large, long-life iron ore, copper, coal, petroleum and potash basins. By concentrating on the development and operation of these basins, BHP Billiton expects to reduce costs and improve productivity more quickly.

Following the demerger, BHP Billiton would have a simpler portfolio with fewer assets and a greater focus on upstream operations.

BHP Billiton would remain:

 

  the largest exporter of metallurgical coal;

 

  a global top three producer of iron ore;

 

  a global top four exporter of copper concentrate;

 

  the largest overseas investor in onshore US shale;

 

  the developer of the world’s best undeveloped potash resource in Saskatchewan, Canada.

Consistent with our established strategy, our portfolio provides broad exposure to steelmaking raw materials, copper, energy and potentially agricultural markets and will remain diversified by commodity, geography and market.

Our Charter values and commitment to putting health and safety first, being environmentally responsible and supporting the communities in which we operate will remain unchanged.

We will continue to simplify our portfolio and as part of this process are reviewing our Nickel West, New Mexico Coal and smaller petroleum assets.

A new global metals and mining company

The new company would have assets in five countries. Many of its operations are among the most competitive in their industries. Its assets would include:

 

  BHP Billiton’s integrated Aluminium business;

 

  Cannington silver;

 

  Energy Coal South Africa;

 

  Illawarra metallurgical coal;

 

  Cerro Matoso nickel;

 

  BHP Billiton’s Manganese business.

By tailoring its approach, and retaining some elements of BHP Billiton’s common systems and processes, the new company would be designed to operate safely, reduce overheads and deliver improved performance.

 

22


Table of Contents

Management, board and listings

It is proposed that the Chairman of the new company would be David Crawford, who will retire from the BHP Billiton Board in November 2014. Graham Kerr, BHP Billiton’s Chief Financial Officer, would assume the role of Chief Executive Officer of the new company, based in Perth. It is intended that Keith Rumble will become a Non-executive Director of the new company that BHP Billiton plans to form in the proposed demerger. Mr Rumble would retire from the BHP Billiton Board at the time the shareholders vote on this demerger proposal. The BHP Billiton Board also intends to nominate Xolani Mkhwanazi, currently BHP Billiton’s Chairman South Africa, as a Non-executive Director of the new company.

The importance of South Africa to the new company would be reflected in the formation of its board and management team, as well as its commitment to the country’s economic development and transformation objectives.

The new company is intended to be listed on the Australian Securities Exchange (ASX) with an inward secondary listing on the Johannesburg Stock Exchange (JSE).

A responsible operator

The new company would be committed to responsible environmental management, the safe operation of its assets and to making a positive contribution to its host communities and nations. BHP Billiton’s existing community commitments will be fulfilled, while the new company would foster its own partnerships and establish its own community programs.

BHP Billiton shareholders

BHP Billiton Limited and Plc shareholders would be entitled to 100 per cent of the shares in the new listed company through a pro-rata, in-specie distribution, as well as retaining their existing shares in the Group.

Subject to final Board approval to proceed, shareholder approval and the receipt of satisfactory third party approvals, the demerger is expected to be completed in the first half of the 2015 calendar year.

Targeted divestment program

We also continue to execute a targeted divestment program, with major transactions totalling US$6.7 billion completed since FY2013. The transactions completed during FY2014 included:

 

  the sale of the Pinto Valley mining operation and the associated San Manuel Arizona Railroad Company to Capstone Mining Corp for an aggregate cash consideration of US$653 million;

 

  the sale of our interest in our Onshore US South Midland shale operation, located in the Permian Basin, to EP Energy for a cash consideration of US$153 million;

 

  the sale of Liverpool Bay, comprising a 46.1 per cent interest in five producing offshore oil and gas fields in the Irish Sea, United Kingdom and the Point of Ayr onshore processing plant in northern Wales and associated infrastructure. The sale was completed on 31 March 2014 to ENI ULX Limited for a cash consideration of US$29 million; and

 

  the extension of our Western Australia Iron Ore long-term joint venture relationship with ITOCHU and Mitsui to include Jimblebar, following the issuing of equity on 10 July 2013 in a subsidiary company, for which BHP Billiton received a total consideration of US$1.5 billion in shares and loans of the subsidiary.

 

23


Table of Contents

1.7    Our management of risk

1.7.1    Approach to risk management

We believe the identification and management of risk is central to achieving our corporate purpose of creating long-term shareholder value.

Risk can present itself in many forms, has the potential to impact our health and safety, environment, community, reputation, regulatory, market and financial performance and thereby the achievement of our corporate purpose.

By understanding and managing risk, we provide greater certainty and confidence for our shareholders, employees, customers, suppliers, and for the communities in which we operate. Successful risk management can be a source of competitive advantage.

Our risks are viewed and managed on a Group-wide basis. The natural diversification in our portfolio of commodities, geographies, currencies, assets and liabilities is a key element in our risk management approach.

Risk management is embedded in our critical business activities, functions and processes. Materiality and our tolerance for risk are key considerations in our decision-making.

Risk issues are identified, analysed and assessed in a consistent manner. Performance requirements exist for the identification, assessment, control and monitoring of material risk issues that could threaten our corporate purpose and business plans. These include:

 

  The potential for impacts on the achievement of our corporate purpose and business plans is identified through risk assessments using approved materiality and tolerability criteria. The severity of any risk event is assessed according to a matrix that describes the degree of harm, injury or loss from the most severe impact associated with that risk event, assuming reasonable effectiveness of controls.

 

  A risk assessment (risk identification, risk analysis, including likelihood and impact assessment and risk evaluation) is conducted for material risk issues.

 

  Risk controls are designed, implemented, operated and assessed to produce a residual risk that is tolerable. Performance standards are established for critical controls over material risks with supporting verification processes.

We have established processes that apply when entering or commencing new activities in high-risk countries. Risk assessments and a supporting risk management plan are required to ensure that potential reputation, legal, business conduct and corruption-related exposures are managed and legislative compliance is maintained, including relevant anti-corruption legislation and the application of any sanctions or trade embargos.

Our risk management governance approach is described in sections 3.14.1 and 3.15 of this Annual Report.

1.7.2    Risk factors

We believe that because of the international scope of our operations and the industries in which we are engaged, there are numerous factors that may have an adverse effect on our results and operations. The following describes the material risks that could affect BHP Billiton.

 

24


Table of Contents

External risks

Fluctuations in commodity prices and impacts of ongoing global economic volatility may negatively affect our results, including cash flows and asset values

The prices we obtain for our oil, gas and minerals are determined by, or linked to, prices in world markets, which have historically been subject to substantial volatility. Our usual policy is to sell our products at the prevailing market prices. The diversity provided by our relatively broad portfolio of commodities does not insulate the effects of price changes. Fluctuations in commodity prices can occur due to price shifts reflecting underlying global economic and geopolitical factors, industry demand, increased supply due to the development of new productive resources, technological change, product substitution and national tariffs. We are particularly exposed to price movements in iron ore, coal, copper, and oil and gas. For example, a US$1 per tonne decline in the average iron ore price and US$1 per barrel decline in the average oil price would have an estimated impact on FY2014 profit after taxation of US$112 million and US$54 million, respectively. Volatility in global economic growth, particularly in the developing economies, has the potential to adversely impact future demand and prices for commodities. The impact of potential long-term sustained price shifts and short-term price volatility, including the effects of unwinding the sustained monetary stimulus in the United States, creates the risk that our financial and operating results including cash flows and asset values, will be materially and adversely affected by unforeseen declines in the prevailing prices of our products.

Our financial results may be negatively affected by currency exchange rate fluctuations

Our assets, earnings and cash flows are influenced by a wide variety of currencies due to the geographic diversity of the countries in which we operate. Fluctuations in the exchange rates of those currencies may have a significant impact on our financial results. The US dollar is the currency in which the majority of our sales are denominated. Operating costs are influenced by the currencies of those countries where our mines and processing plants are located and also by those currencies in which the costs of imported equipment and services are determined. The Australian dollar, South African rand, Chilean peso, Brazilian real and US dollar are some of the currencies influencing our operating costs. Over recent years, higher exchange rates (compared to the US dollar) of currencies in which the majority of our operating costs are incurred have and may continue to adversely impact our profit margins. Given the dominant role of the US currency in our affairs, the US dollar is the currency in which we present financial performance. We do not generally believe that active currency hedging provides long-term benefits to our shareholders. From time to time, we consider currency protection measures appropriate in specific commercial circumstances, subject to strict limits established by our Board.

Reduction in Chinese demand may negatively impact our results

The Chinese market has been driving global materials demand and pricing over the past decade. Sales into China generated US$23.3 billion (FY2013: US$20.1 billion) or 34.7 per cent (FY2013: 30.4 per cent) of our revenue in FY2014. The FY2014 sales into China by Business included 64.9 per cent Iron Ore, 17.8 per cent Copper, 8.5 per cent Coal, 6.6 per cent Aluminium, Manganese and Nickel and 2.2 per cent Petroleum. A slowing in China’s economic growth could result in lower prices and less demand for our products and negatively impact our results including cash flows.

Actions by governments or political events in the countries in which we operate could have a negative impact on our business

We have operations in many countries around the globe, which have varying degrees of political and commercial stability. We operate in emerging markets, which may involve additional risks that could have an adverse impact on the profitability of an operation. These risks could include terrorism, civil unrest, nationalisation, renegotiation or nullification of existing contracts, leases, permits or other agreements, restrictions on repatriation of earnings or capital and changes in laws and policy, as well as other unforeseeable risks. Risks relating to bribery and corruption, including possible delays or disruption resulting from a refusal to make so-called facilitation payments, may be prevalent in some of the countries in which we operate. If any of our major operations are affected by one or more of these risks, it could have a negative effect on our operations in those countries, as well as the Group’s overall operating results and financial condition.

 

25


Table of Contents

Our operations are based on material long-term investments that are dependent on long-term fiscal stability and could be adversely impacted by changes in fiscal legislation. The natural resources industry continues to be regarded as a source of tax revenue and can also be impacted by broader fiscal measures applying to business generally.

Our business could be adversely affected by new government regulations, such as controls on imports, exports, prices and greenhouse gas emissions. Increasing requirements relating to regulatory, environmental and social approvals can potentially result in significant delays in construction and may adversely affect the economics of new mining and oil and gas projects, the expansion of existing operations and results of our operations. Infrastructure, such as rail, ports, power and water, is critical to our business operations. We have operations or potential development projects in countries where government-provided infrastructure or regulatory regimes for access to infrastructure, including our own privately operated infrastructure, may be inadequate or uncertain or subject to legislative change. These may adversely impact the efficient operations and expansion of our Businesses.

We operate in several countries where ownership of land is uncertain and where disputes may arise in relation to ownership. In Australia, the Native Title Act 1993 provides for the establishment and recognition of native title under certain circumstances. In South Africa, the Extension of Security of Tenure Act (1997) and the Restitution of Land Rights Act (1994) provide for various landholding rights. Such legislation could negatively affect new or existing projects.

These regulations are complex, difficult to predict and outside our control and could negatively affect our Company, future results and our financial condition.

Business risks

Failure to discover or acquire new resources, maintain reserves or develop new operations could negatively affect our future results and financial condition

The demand for our products and production from our operations results in existing reserves being depleted over time. As our revenues and profits are derived from our oil and gas and minerals operations, our results and financial condition are directly related to the success of our exploration and acquisition efforts, and our ability to generate reserves to meet our production requirements. Exploration activity occurs adjacent to established operations and in new regions, in developed and less-developed countries. These activities may increase land tenure, infrastructure and related political risks. A failure in our ability to discover or acquire new resources, maintain reserves or develop new operations in sufficient quantities to maintain or grow the current level of our reserves could negatively affect our results, financial condition and prospects.

Future deterioration in commodities pricing may make some existing reserves uneconomic. Our actual drilling activities and future drilling budget will depend on our mineral inventory size and quality, drilling results, commodity prices, drilling and production costs, availability of drilling services and equipment, lease expirations, transportation pipelines and other infrastructure constraints, regulatory approvals and other factors.

There are numerous uncertainties inherent in estimating mineral and oil and gas reserves. Geological assumptions about our mineralisation that are valid at the time of estimation may change significantly when new information becomes available. Estimates that the indicated amount of reserves will be recovered or that it will be recovered at the cost we anticipate are based on uncertain assumptions. The uncertain global financial outlook may affect economic assumptions related to reserve recovery and may require reserve restatements. Reserve restatements could negatively affect our results and prospects.

 

26


Table of Contents

Potential changes to our portfolio of assets through acquisitions and divestments may have a material adverse effect on our future results and financial condition

We regularly review the composition of our asset portfolio and from time to time may add assets to the portfolio or divest assets from the portfolio. There are a number of risks associated with such acquisitions or divestments. These include adverse market reaction to such changes or the timing or terms on which such changes are made, the imposition of adverse regulatory conditions and obligations, commercial objectives not being achieved as expected, unforeseen liabilities arising from such changes to the portfolio, sales revenues and operational performance not meeting our expectations, anticipated synergies or cost savings being delayed or not being achieved, inability to retain key staff and transaction-related costs being more than anticipated. These factors could negatively affect our reputation, future results and financial condition.

Increased costs and schedule delays may adversely affect our development projects

Although we devote significant time and resources to our project planning, approval and review process, many of our development projects are highly complex and rely on factors that are outside our control, which may cause us to underestimate the cost or time required to complete a project. For instance, accidents during development projects may cause setbacks or cost overruns, required licences, permits or authorisations to build a project may be unobtainable at anticipated costs, or may be obtained only after significant delay and market conditions may change making a project less profitable than initially projected.

In addition, we may fail to manage projects as effectively as we anticipate and unforeseen challenges may emerge.

Any of these may result in increased capital costs and schedule delays at our development projects, adversely affecting our development projects and impacting anticipated financial returns.

Financial risks

If our liquidity and cash flow deteriorate significantly it could adversely affect our ability to fund our major capital programs

We seek to maintain a solid ‘A’ credit rating as part of our strategy. However, fluctuations in commodity prices and the ongoing global economic volatility may adversely impact our future cash flows and ability to access capital from financial markets at acceptable pricing. If our key financial ratios and credit rating are not maintained, our liquidity and cash reserves, interest rate costs on borrowed debt, future access to financial capital markets and the ability to fund current and future major capital programs could be adversely affected.

We may not recover our investments in mining, oil and gas assets, which may require financial write-downs

One or more of our assets may be impacted by changed market or industry structures, commodity prices, technical operating difficulties, inability to recover our mineral, oil or gas reserves and increased operating cost levels. These may cause us to fail to recover all or a portion of our investment in mining and oil and gas assets and may require financial write-downs, including goodwill adversely impacting our financial results.

The commercial counterparties we transact with may not meet their obligations, which may negatively impact our results

We contract with a large number of commercial and financial counterparties, including end-customers, suppliers and financial institutions. Global economic volatility continues to strain global financial markets, with tighter liquidity in China and uncertain business conditions generally. We maintain a ‘one book’ approach with commercial counterparties to ensure all credit exposures are quantified. Our existing counterparty credit controls may not prevent a material loss due to credit exposure to a major customer or financial counterparty. In addition,

 

27


Table of Contents

customers, suppliers, contractors or joint venture partners may fail to perform against existing contracts and obligations. Non-supply of key inputs, such as tyres, mining and mobile equipment, diesel and other key consumables, may unfavourably impact costs and production at our operations. These factors could negatively affect our financial condition and results of operations.

Operational risks

Cost pressures and reduced productivity could negatively impact our operating margins and expansion plans

Cost pressures may continue to occur across the resources industry. As the prices for our products are determined by the global commodity markets in which we operate, we do not generally have the ability to offset these cost pressures through corresponding price increases, which can adversely affect our operating margins. Notwithstanding our efforts to reduce costs and a number of key cost inputs being commodity price-linked, the inability to reduce costs and a timing lag may adversely impact our operating margins for an extended period.

A number of our operations, such as aluminium and copper, are energy or water intensive and, as a result, the Group’s costs and earnings could be adversely affected by rising costs or by supply interruptions. These could include the unavailability of energy, fuel or water due to a variety of reasons, including fluctuations in climate, significant increases in costs, inadequate infrastructure capacity, interruptions in supply due to equipment failure or other causes and the inability to extend supply contracts on economic terms.

Our Australian-based operations may continue to be affected by the Australian Fair Work Act 2009 as labour agreements expire and businesses are required to collectively bargain with unions. In some instances, labour unions are pursuing wage claims in the bargaining process, and/or claims about union involvement in operational decision-making. Claims or labour disputes may adversely affect productivity and costs. Industrial action in pursuit of claims associated with the bargaining process has occurred or been threatened in some Businesses, and is likely to continue to occur as unions press claims as part of the collective bargaining process.

These factors could lead to increased operating costs at existing operations and could negatively impact our operating margins and expansion plans.

Unexpected natural and operational catastrophes may adversely impact our operations

We operate extractive, processing and logistical operations in many geographic locations, both onshore and offshore. Our key port facilities are located at Port Hedland and Hay Point in Australia. We have 11 underground mines, including seven underground coal mines. Our operational processes may be subject to operational accidents, such as port and shipping incidents, underground mine and processing plant fire and explosion, open-cut pit wall failures, loss of power supply, railroad incidents, loss of well control, environmental pollution and mechanical critical equipment failures. Our operations may also be subject to unexpected natural catastrophes such as earthquakes, flood, hurricanes and tsunamis. Our northwest Western Australia iron ore, Queensland coal and Gulf of Mexico oil and gas operations are located in areas subject to cyclones or hurricanes. Our Chilean copper operations are located in a known earthquake and tsunami zone. Based on our risk management and concerns about the value of external insurance in the natural resource sector, our risk financing (insurance) approach is to minimise or not to purchase external insurance for certain risks, including property damage, business interruption, construction-related risk, marine cargo and primary liability risks. Existing business continuity plans may not provide protection for all of the costs that arise from such events. The impact of these events could lead to disruptions in production, increased costs and loss of facilities more than offsetting external premiums saved, which would adversely affect our financial results and prospects. Where external insurance is purchased, third party claims arising from these events may exceed the limit of liability of the insurance policies we have in place.

 

28


Table of Contents

Our non-operated assets may not comply with our standards

Some of our assets are operated and managed by joint venture partners or by other companies. Management of our non-operated assets may not comply with our management and operating standards, controls and procedures, including our health, safety, environment and community (HSEC) standards. Failure to adopt equivalent standards, controls and procedures at these assets could lead to higher costs and reduced production and adversely impact our results and reputation.

Breaches in our information technology security processes may adversely impact our business activities

We maintain global information technology (IT) systems, consisting of infrastructure, applications and communications networks to support our business activities. These systems could be subject to security breaches (e.g. cyber-crime) resulting in theft, disclosure or corruption of information, including information relating to acquisitions and divestments, strategic decision-making, non-public investment market communications or commercially sensitive information relating to major contracts. Security breaches could also result in misappropriation of funds or disruptions to our operations.

Sustainability risks

Safety, health, environmental and community impacts, incidents or accidents and related regulations may adversely affect our people, operations and reputation or licence to operate

Safety

Potential safety events that may have a material adverse impact on our operations include fire, explosion or rock fall incidents in underground mining operations, personnel conveyance equipment failures in underground operations, aircraft incidents, incidents involving light vehicles and mining mobile equipment, ground control failures, well blowouts, explosions or gas leaks, and accidents involving inadequate isolation and working from heights or lifting operations.

Health

Health risks faced include fatigue, musculoskeletal illnesses and occupational exposure to noise, silica, manganese, diesel exhaust particulate, fluorides, coal tar pitch, nickel and sulphuric acid mist. Longer-term health impacts may arise due to unanticipated workplace exposures or historical exposures of our workforce to hazardous substances. These effects may create future financial compensation obligations.

Infectious diseases such as malaria may have a material adverse impact upon our workers or on our communities, primarily in Africa. Because we operate globally, we may be affected by potential pandemic influenza outbreaks, such as A(H1N1) and avian flu, in any of the regions in which we operate.

Environment

Environmental incidents have the potential to lead to material adverse impacts on our operations. These include uncontrolled tailings containment breaches, subsidence from mining activities, escape of polluting substances and uncontrolled releases of hydrocarbons.

Our operations by their nature have the potential to adversely impact biodiversity, water resources and related ecosystem services. Changes in scientific understanding of these impacts, regulatory requirements or stakeholder expectations may prevent or delay project approvals and result in increased costs for mitigation, offsets or compensatory actions.

We provide for operational closure and site rehabilitation. Our operating and closed facilities are required to have closure plans. Changes in regulatory or community expectations may result in the relevant plans not being adequate. This may increase financial provisioning and costs at the affected operations.

 

29


Table of Contents

Community

Local communities may become dissatisfied with the impact of our operations or oppose our new development projects, including through litigation, potentially affecting costs and production, and in extreme cases viability. Community related risks may include community protests or civil unrest, and may cause delays to proposed developments. Our operations or activities also risk inadvertent breaches of human rights or other international laws or conventions.

HSE legislation

The nature of the industries in which we operate means many of our activities are highly regulated by health, safety and environmental (HSE) laws. As regulatory standards and expectations are constantly developing, we may be exposed to increased litigation, compliance costs and unforeseen environmental rehabilitation expenses.

Legislation requiring manufacturers, importers and downstream users of chemical substances, including metals and minerals, to establish that the substances can be used without negatively affecting health or the environment may impact our operations and markets. These potential compliance costs, litigation expenses, regulatory delays, rehabilitation expenses and operational costs could negatively affect our financial results.

Hydraulic fracturing

Our Onshore US operations involve hydraulic fracturing, an essential and common practice in the oil and gas industry to stimulate production of natural gas and oil from dense subsurface rock formations. Hydraulic fracturing involves using water, sand and a small amount of chemicals to fracture the hydrocarbon-bearing rock formation, to allow flow of hydrocarbons into the wellbore. We routinely apply hydraulic fracturing techniques in our drilling and completion programs.

Attention given to the hydraulic fracturing process could lead to greater opposition to oil and gas production activities using hydraulic fracturing techniques. Increased regulation could impose more stringent permitting, public disclosure and well construction requirements on hydraulic fracturing operations. In the United States, the hydraulic fracturing process is typically regulated by relevant US state regulatory bodies. Some states are considering changes to regulations in relation to permitting, public disclosure, and/or well construction requirements on hydraulic fracturing and related operations, including the possibility of outright bans on the process. Arkansas, Louisiana and Texas (the states in which we currently operate) have adopted various laws, regulations or issued regulatory guidance concerning hydraulic fracturing.

Several US federal agencies are also reviewing or advancing regulatory proposals concerning hydraulic fracturing and related operations. The US Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) commenced a study of the potential impacts of hydraulic fracturing activities on drinking water resources and issued a non-determinative Progress Report in December 2012. A draft report, not including prospective case study work, is expected in late CY2014. The EPA is expected to issue a final report for peer review in CY2016. The EPA’s Office of Inspector General is researching the EPA’s and states’ ability to manage potential threats to water resources from hydraulic fracturing, with a possible longer-term study to follow. The US Bureau of Land Management (BLM) is planning to issue a revised proposed rule in CY2014 that would impose new requirements on hydraulic fracturing operations conducted on federal lands, including the disclosure of chemicals used, wellbore integrity, water use and disposal of flow back water. Activity at the federal level, including the ongoing EPA study, BLM rules and other analysis by federal and state agencies to assess the impacts of hydraulic fracturing could spur additional legislative or regulatory actions.

While we have not experienced a material delay or substantially higher operating costs as a result of current regulatory requirements in our Onshore US operations, we cannot predict whether additional federal, state or local laws or regulations will be enacted and what such actions would require or prohibit. Additional legislation or regulation could subject our operations to delays and increased costs, or prohibit certain activities, which could adversely affect the financial performance of our Onshore US operations.

 

30


Table of Contents

Due to the nature of our operations, HSEC incidents or accidents and related regulations may adversely affect our reputation or licence to operate.

Climate change may impact the value of our Company, and our operations and markets

The physical impacts of climate change and various regulations that seek to address climate change may negatively affect our operations, productivity and the markets in which we sell our products. According to the Intergovernmental Panel on Climate Change (IPCC), fossil fuel-related emissions are a significant source of greenhouse gases contributing to climate change. We produce fossil fuels such as coal, oil and gas for sale to customers, and we use fossil fuels in our mining and processing operations either directly or through the purchase of fossil-fuel based electricity.

A number of national governments have already introduced or are contemplating the introduction of regulatory responses to greenhouse gas emissions from the combustion of fossil fuels to address the impacts of climate change. This includes countries where we have operations such as Australia, the United States, South Africa and Chile, as well as customer markets such as China, India and Europe. From a medium to long-term perspective, we are likely to see some adverse changes in the cost position of our greenhouse gas-intensive assets and energy-intensive assets as a result of regulatory impacts in the countries where we operate. These proposed regulatory mechanisms may impact our operations directly or indirectly through our suppliers and customers. Assessments of the potential impact of future climate change regulation are uncertain given the wide scope of potential regulatory change in the many countries in which we operate. For example, the Australian Government repealed a carbon tax in 2014, the South African Government plans to introduce a carbon tax beginning in 2016 and carbon pricing is being discussed as part of a broader tax reform package in Chile.

There is a potential gap between the current valuation of fossil fuel reserves on the balance sheets of companies and in global equities markets and the reduced value that could result if a significant proportion of reserves were rendered incapable of extraction in an economically viable fashion due to regulatory or market responses to climate change. In such a scenario, reserve assets held on our balance sheet may need to be impaired or written off and our inability to make productive use of such assets may also negatively impact our financial condition and results.

Changing consumer demand towards alternative energy supply options could present a threat to existing fossil fuel markets.

The physical effects of climate change on our operations may include changes in rainfall patterns, water shortages, rising sea levels, increased storm intensities and higher temperatures. These effects may adversely impact the financial performance of our operations.

A breach of our governance processes may lead to regulatory penalties and loss of reputation

We operate in a global environment that encompasses multiple jurisdictions and complex regulatory frameworks. Our governance and compliance processes, which include the review of internal controls over financial reporting and specific internal controls in relation to offers of things of value to government officials and representatives of state-owned enterprises, may not prevent future potential breaches of law, accounting or governance practice. Our Code of Business Conduct, together with our mandatory policies, such as the anti-corruption, trade and financial sanctions and competition policies, may not prevent instances of fraudulent behaviour and dishonesty nor guarantee compliance with legal or regulatory requirements. This may lead to regulatory fines, disgorgement of profits, litigation, loss of operating licences or reputational damage.

 

31


Table of Contents

1.7.3    Management of principal risks

The scope of our operations and the number of industries in which we operate and engage mean that a range of factors may impact our results. Material risks that could negatively affect our results and performance are described in section 1.7.2 of this Annual Report. Our approach to managing these risks is outlined below.

 

Principal risk area

  

Risk management approach

External risks

  
Risks arise from falls in commodity prices and demand in major markets (such as China or Europe) or changes in currency exchange rates and actions by governments and political events that impact long-term fiscal stability.    The diversification of our portfolio of commodities, geographies and currencies is a key strategy for reducing the effects of volatility. Section 1.15.1 describes external factors and trends affecting our results and note 29 ‘Financial risk management’ to the Financial Statements outlines the Group’s financial risk management strategy, including market, commodity, and currency risk. The Financial Risk Management Committee oversees these risks as described in sections 3.15 and 3.16. We also engage with governments and other key stakeholders to ensure the potential adverse impacts of proposed fiscal, tax, resource investment, infrastructure access and regulatory changes are understood and where possible mitigated.

Business risks

  
Risks include the inherent uncertainty of identifying and proving reserves, adding and divesting assets and managing our capital development projects.   

The Group Resource and Business Optimisation function provides governance and technical leadership for Mineral Resource development and Ore Reserves reporting as described in section 2.3.2. Our governance over reporting of Petroleum reserves is described in section 2.3.1.

 

We have established investment approval processes that apply to all major capital projects and asset divestment and acquisitions. The Investment Committee oversees these as described in sections 3.15 and 3.16. The Group Project Management function additionally seeks to ensure that projects are safe, predictable and competitive. We have established project hubs as operating centres for the study and execution of a pipeline of major capital projects using a program management approach.

Financial risks

  
Continued volatility in global financial markets may adversely impact future cash flows, our ability to adequately access and source capital from financial markets and our credit rating. Volatility may impact planned expenditures, as well as the ability to recover investments in mining and oil and gas projects. In addition, the commercial counterparties (customers, suppliers and financial institutions) we transact with may, due to adverse market conditions, fail to meet their contractual obligations.    We seek to maintain a solid ‘A’ credit rating, supported by our portfolio risk management strategy. As part of this strategy, commodity prices and currency exchange rates are not hedged, and wherever possible we take the prevailing market price. We use Cash Flow at Risk analysis to monitor volatilities and key financial ratios. Credit limits and review processes are required to be established for all customers and financial counterparties. The Financial Risk Management Committee oversees these as described in sections 3.15 and 3.16. Note 29 ‘Financial risk management’ to the Financial Statements outlines our financial risk management strategy.

 

32


Table of Contents

Principal risk area

  

Risk management approach

Operational risks

  
Operating cost pressures and reduced productivity could negatively impact operating margins and expansion plans. Non-operated assets may not comply with our standards. Unexpected natural and operational catastrophes may adversely impact our operations. Breaches in IT security processes may adversely impact the conduct of our business activities.   

We seek to ensure that adequate operating margins are maintained through our strategy to own and operate large, long-life, low-cost and expandable upstream assets.

 

The capability to sustain productivity improvements is being further enhanced through continued refinements to our Operating Model. The Operating Model is designed to deliver a simple and scalable organisation, providing a competitive advantage through defining work, organisation and performance measurements. Defined global business processes, including 1SAP, provide a standardised way of working across the organisation. Common processes generate useful data and improve operating discipline. Global sourcing arrangements have been established to ensure continuity of supply and competitive costs for key supply inputs. We seek to influence the application of our standards to non-operated assets.

 

Through the application of our risk management processes, we identify catastrophic operational risks and implement the critical controls and performance requirements to maintain control effectiveness. Business continuity plans are required to be established to mitigate consequences. Consistent with our portfolio risk management approach, we continue to be largely self-insured for losses arising from property damage, business interruption and construction.

 

IT security controls to protect IT infrastructure, applications and communication networks and respond to security incidents are in place and subject to regular monitoring and assessment. To maintain adequate levels of protection, we also continue to monitor the development of threats in the external environment and assess potential responses to those threats.

Sustainability risks

  
HSEC incidents or accidents and related regulations may adversely affect our people, operations and reputation or licence to operate. The potential physical impacts and related responses to climate change may impact the value of our Company, and operations and markets. Given we operate in a challenging global environment straddling multiple jurisdictions, a breach of our governance processes may lead to regulatory penalties and loss of reputation.   

Our approach to sustainability risks is reflected in Our Charter and described in section 1.14. A comprehensive set of Group Level Documents (GLD) set out Group-wide HSEC-related performance requirements to ensure effective management control of these risks.

 

Our approach to corporate planning, investment decision-making and portfolio management provides a focus on the identification, assessment and management of climate change risks. We have been applying an internal price on carbon in our investment decisions for more than a decade. Through a comprehensive and strategic approach to corporate planning, we work with a

 

33


Table of Contents

Principal risk area

  

Risk management approach

  

broad range of scenarios to assess our portfolio, including consideration of a broad range of potential policy responses to and impacts from climate change. Our models suggest that BHP Billiton’s portfolio diversification results in the resilience of our overall asset valuation through all these scenarios.

 

As with our other risks, for climate change risk our Risk Management GLD provides the framework for risk management. Internal audits are conducted to test compliance with GLD requirements and action plans are developed to address any gaps. Key findings are reported to senior management and reports are considered by relevant Board committees.

 

Our Code of Business Conduct sets out requirements related to working with integrity, including dealings with government officials and third parties. Processes and controls are in place for the internal control over financial reporting, including under Sarbanes-Oxley. We have established anti-corruption and antitrust related performance requirements, which are overseen by the Legal and Compliance function. Additionally, the Disclosure Committee oversees our compliance with securities dealing obligations and continuous and periodic disclosure obligations as described in section 3.15 and 3.16.

1.8    Our approach to corporate governance

At BHP Billiton, we have a governance framework that goes beyond an interest in governance for its own sake or the need to simply comply with regulatory requirements. Instead, we believe high-quality governance supports long-term value creation. Simply put, we think good governance is good business, and our approach is to adopt what we consider to be the better of the prevailing governance standards in Australia, the United Kingdom and the United States.

In the same spirit, we do not see governance as just a matter for the Board. Good governance is also the responsibility of senior management and is embedded throughout the organisation.

The diagram below describes the governance framework at BHP Billiton. It shows the interaction between the shareholders and the Board, demonstrates how the Board Committee structure facilitates the interaction between the Board and the CEO and illustrates the flow of delegation from shareholders. We have robust processes in place to ensure the delegation flows through the Board and its committees to the CEO and the GMC and into the organisation. At the same time, accountability flows back upwards from the Company to shareholders. This process helps to ensure alignment with shareholders.

As part of our corporate planning cycle, we have embedded a range of scenarios that are reviewed annually and updated by the Group with the GMC’s involvement. The scenarios, and the governance process supporting them, also form part of the Board agenda.

These scenarios provide a lens to assess the performance of our business portfolio. They include assumptions around carbon and commodity prices, currencies, costs and tax rates and ranges for a number of risks that face the Group, including climate change, global growth, levels of trade, geopolitical situation and technology focus. All of the scenarios are used to inform BHP Billiton’s strategy and the resilience of our diversified asset portfolio over the short and long term.

 

34


Table of Contents

As we set out in section 3 of this Annual Report, while the five committees have accountability for making recommendations to the Board on certain matters, such as remuneration and sustainability, we ensure all Board members have oversight and the opportunity for full discussion of those issues through the committee report-out process to the full Board.

Our Charter is core to the governance framework of BHP Billiton. It embodies our corporate purpose, strategy and values, and defines when we are successful. We foster a culture that values and rewards high ethical standards, personal and corporate integrity and respect for others.

We live the values enshrined in Our Charter and adhere to the standards of conduct required by our Code of Business Conduct.

BHP Billiton governance structure

 

LOGO

Part of the Board’s commitment to high-quality governance is expressed through the approach BHP Billiton takes to engaging and communicating with shareholders. We encourage shareholders to make their views known to us.

Our shareholders are based across the globe. Outside of the Annual General Meetings (AGM), which are an important step in the governance and investor engagement process, the Board uses a range of formal and informal communication channels to understand shareholder views to ensure it can represent shareholders in governing BHP Billiton. Regular proactive engagement with institutional shareholders and investor representative organisations takes place in Australia, South Africa, the United Kingdom and the United States. The purpose of these meetings is to discuss the full range of governance issues, as well as the broad strategy of the Group. They offer an important opportunity to build relationships and to engage directly with governance managers, fund managers and governance advisers.

For more information on our corporate governance processes, refer to section 3 of this Annual Report.

1.9    Our approach to remuneration

Our Remuneration Committee recognises that remuneration has an important role to play in supporting the implementation and achievement of the Group’s strategy and our ongoing performance, aligning the activities of management to the interests of shareholders, and in supporting Our BHP Billiton Charter. The remuneration

 

35


Table of Contents

policy is reviewed annually and, where appropriate, fine-tuned to ensure that it continues to be effective in achieving these goals.

Remuneration at BHP Billiton

The key principles of our remuneration policy, which remain unchanged, are to:

 

  support the execution of the Group’s business strategy in accordance with a risk framework that is appropriate for the organisation;

 

  provide competitive rewards to attract, motivate and retain highly skilled executives willing to work around the world;

 

  apply demanding performance measures, including key financial and non-financial measures of performance;

 

  link a significant component of pay to our performance and the creation of value for our shareholders from relative outperformance;

 

  ensure remuneration arrangements are equitable and facilitate the deployment of people around the Group;

 

  limit severance payments on termination to pre-established contractual arrangements (which do not commit us to making any unjustified payments).

Link to strategy

Our Charter sets out our purpose, strategy, values and how we measure our success. In framing how we remunerate our executives, we are guided by the measures of success contained in Our Charter. They are designed to ensure that executives take a long-term approach to decision-making and to minimise activities that focus only on short-term results at the expense of longer-term business growth and success. The Committee has considered the ways in which risk management and the long-term horizon are reflected throughout BHP Billiton’s remuneration arrangements for all executives, and is satisfied that our approach reinforces the desired behaviours.

This is largely achieved through the Group’s approach to short-term and long-term incentive awards, which comprise a significant portion of total remuneration for our Chief Executive Officer, Andrew Mackenzie, and other members of the Group Management Committee (GMC). The equity component of the short-term incentive award is deferred for a two-year period, and performance under the long-term incentive plan is measured over a five-year period. The actual rewards received by Mr Mackenzie and other members of the GMC therefore reflect the Group’s performance and share price over an extended period.

Our approach

There have been no substantial changes to our underlying approach – we ensure that remuneration outcomes reflect the performance of the Group, Businesses and individuals. This approach has enjoyed a strong level of support from shareholders, with a vote in favour for the Remuneration Report of 97 per cent at last year’s Annual General Meetings.

Our approach to incentive structures has been in place for more than a decade and has served both shareholders and participants well, delivering remuneration outcomes to executives aligned to the performance of the Group and of individuals. BHP Billiton adopted the deferral of a substantial portion of short-term incentive awards in equity in 2003, and a five-year term for long-term incentive awards in 2004. These approaches, which were then market leading, have since become more prevalent and acknowledged as best practice.

Notwithstanding our stable approach, the Committee and the Board continue to pay close attention to shareholders’ views so they can be factored into the Group’s future approach.

 

36


Table of Contents

Summary

Our fundamental philosophies and approaches to remuneration have not changed – we trust that you will agree that our long held, consistent approach to aligning remuneration to performance has served shareholders well.

For more information on our remuneration policies and the remuneration outcomes for members of the GMC and Non-executive Directors, refer to section 4 of this Annual Report.

1.10    Key performance indicators

Our key performance indicators (KPIs) enable us to measure our financial and sustainable development performance. Their relevance to our strategy and our performance against these measures in FY2014 are explained below.

These KPIs are used as measures, directly and indirectly, in the short-term and/or long-term incentive arrangements for remuneration of senior executives. Certain KPIs (denoted with this symbol LOGO ) are used directly to calculate incentive outcomes and others (denoted with this symbol LOGO ) are considered more broadly in determining final overall results.

Our Remuneration Report is contained in section 4 of this Annual Report and provides information on our overall approach to remuneration of executives, including remuneration policies and the remuneration outcomes for members of the GMC and Non-executive Directors.

1.10.1    Sustainability KPIs

TRIF

 

LOGO

 

LOGO

  

Definition

 

Total recordable injury frequency (TRIF) is an indicator in highlighting broad personal injury trends and is calculated based on the number of recordable injuries per million hours worked. This data only includes wholly owned and operated assets or assets operated in a joint venture operation from 1 July 2012 to 30 June 2014.

 

Link to strategy

 

Our overriding commitment is to ensuring the safety and health of our people and this is supported by Our Charter value of Sustainability.

 

FY2014 performance

 

Our TRIF has improved by 21 per cent over the last five years. During FY2014, we improved our TRIF by nine per cent and had no fatalities at our operated assets.

 

For information on our approach to health and safety and our performance, refer to section 1.14 of this Annual Report.

 

37


Table of Contents

GHG emissions

 

LOGO

 

LOGO

  

Definition

 

Greenhouse gas (GHG) emissions are measured according to the World Resources Institute/World Business Council for Sustainable Development Greenhouse Gas Protocol. This data only includes wholly owned and operated assets or assets operated in a joint venture operation from 1 July 2012 to 30 June 2014.

 

Link to strategy

 

The global challenge of climate change remains a priority for our organisation and is core to our strategic decision-making. Our GHG emissions are monitored and our performance is tracked against our target.

 

FY2014 performance

 

The Group’s GHG emissions declined by 1.7 Mt CO2-e to 45.0 Mt CO2-e, which keeps our emissions in line to achieve our target.

 

For additional information on our GHG emissions, including a description of Scope 1 and Scope 2 GHG emissions, refer to section 1.14.4 of this Annual Report.

Community investment

 

LOGO

 

LOGO

  

Definition

 

Our voluntary community investment comprising cash, in-kind support, administrative costs and contributions to the BHP Billiton Foundation and BHP Billiton Sustainable Communities (our corporate charities). Includes BHP Billiton’s equity share for both operated and non-operated joint venture operations.

 

Link to strategy

 

We believe that in addition to operating a responsible and ethical company, we can make a broader contribution to the communities in which we operate and support Our Charter value of Sustainability.

 

FY2014 performance

 

Our voluntary community investment totalled US$241.7 million, comprising US$141.7 million in cash, in-kind support and administrative costs, and a US$100 million contribution to the BHP Billiton Foundation.

 

For additional information on our community investment, refer to section 1.14 of this Annual Report.

 

38


Table of Contents

1.10.2    Financial KPIs

Attributable profit

 

LOGO

 

LOGO

  

Definition

 

Attributable profit represents Profit after taxation attributable to members of BHP Billiton Group.

 

Link to strategy

 

This is a key financial measure that provides insight on the amount of profit available to distribute to shareholders, which aligns to our purpose as presented in Our Charter.

 

FY2014 performance

 

Attributable profit increased by 23 per cent to US$13.8 billion, benefiting from a reduction in the Group’s effective tax rate to 31.5 per cent.

 

For our Consolidated Financial Statements, refer to section 7 of this Annual Report.

 

(1)  Restated in the Financial Statements to be disclosed on the same basis as FY2014.

Underlying EBIT

 

LOGO

 

LOGO

  

Definition

 

Underlying EBIT is earnings before net finance costs, taxation and any exceptional items.

 

Link to strategy

 

This is a key financial measure used across the Group. It gives insight to cost management, production growth and performance efficiency.

 

FY2014 performance

 

Underlying EBIT was unchanged for the year at US$22.9 billion as benefits attributable to productivity initiatives during the period and further volume increases from the successful commissioning and ramp-up of our low-risk, brownfield development projects were offset by the decrease in commodity prices, impact of inflation on costs and an increase in our depreciation and amortisation expense.

 

For a reconciliation of Underlying EBIT to Profit from operations, refer to section 1.11 of this Annual Report. For our Consolidated Financial Statements, refer to section 7 of this Annual Report.

 

(1)  Restated in the Financial Statements to be disclosed on the same basis as FY2014.

 

39


Table of Contents

Net operating cash flow

 

LOGO

 

LOGO

  

Definition

 

Net operating cash flow represents the cash generated by the Group’s consolidated operations, after dividends received, interest, taxation and royalty-related taxation. This figure excludes cash flows relating to investing and financing activities.

 

Link to strategy

 

Net operating cash flow provides insight into how we are managing costs and increasing efficiency and productivity across the Company.

 

FY2014 performance

 

Net operating cash flows after interest and tax increased by 26 per cent to US$25.4 billion. A US$2.6 billion increase in cash generated from operations (after changes in working capital balances) and a US$2.1 billion decrease in net taxes paid were the major contributors to the strong increase.

 

For our Consolidated Financial Statements, refer to section 7 of this Annual Report.

 

(1)  Restated in the Financial Statements to be disclosed on the same basis as FY2014.

1.10.3    Capital Management KPIs

Total Shareholder Return (TSR)

 

LOGO

 

LOGO

  

Definition

 

TSR shows the total return to the shareholder during the year. It combines both movements in share prices and dividends paid (which are assumed to be reinvested).

 

Link to strategy

 

TSR measures performance of the organisation in terms of shareholder wealth generation, which aligns to our purpose as presented in Our Charter, and enables the comparison of our performance with that of our peer companies.

 

FY2014 performance

 

TSR grew 13 per cent as a result of increases in both the BHP Billiton share price and the dividends paid. BHP Billiton outperformed its peer companies by 17.8 per cent from 1 July 2009 to 30 June 2014.

 

40


Table of Contents

Long-term credit rating

 

LOGO

 

LOGO

  

Definition

 

Credit ratings are forward-looking opinions about credit risk. Standard & Poor’s and Moody’s credit ratings express the opinion of each agency about the ability and willingness of BHP Billiton to meet its financial obligations in full and on time.

 

Link to strategy

 

One of BHP Billiton’s priorities for capital management is to maintain a solid ‘A’ credit rating, which indicates the strength of our balance sheet.

 

FY2014 performance

 

BHP Billiton has maintained a long-term credit rating of A+ from Standard & Poor’s and A1 from Moody’s over the last five years.

 

For additional information on our liquidity and capital resources, refer to section 1.15.5 of this Annual Report.

1.11    Summary of consolidated performance

1.11.1    Selected financial information

Our selected financial information reflects the operations of the BHP Billiton Group, and should be read in conjunction with the FY2014 Financial Statements, together with the accompanying notes.

We prepare our consolidated Financial Statements in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS), as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board, and as outlined in note 1 ‘Accounting policies’ to the Financial Statements in this Annual Report. We publish our consolidated Financial Statements in US dollars.

Comparative financial information for FY2013 and FY2012 has been restated for the effects of new accounting standards and interpretations which are effective in the financial year commencing from 1 July 2013 relating to:

 

  IFRS 10/AASB 10 ‘Consolidated Financial Statements’ which is a replacement of IAS 27/AASB 127 ‘Consolidated and Separate Financial Statements’;

 

  IFRS 11/AASB 11 ‘Joint Arrangements’ which is a replacement of IAS 31/AASB 131 ‘Joint Ventures’;

 

  IAS 28 ‘Investments in Associates and Joint Ventures’ which is a replacement of IAS 28 ‘Accounting for Investments in Associates’;

 

  IFRIC 20 ‘Stripping Costs in the Production Phase of a Surface Mine’;

 

  IFRS 13/AASB 13 ‘Fair Value Measurement’; and

 

  Amendments to IAS 19/AASB 119 ‘Employee Benefits’.

The Group has also changed its Exploration and Evaluation Expenditure policy from 1 July 2013 such that all acquisitions of exploration leases are classified as intangible exploration assets or tangible exploration assets based on the nature of the assets acquired. For further detail of the nature and the impact of these changes, on comparative financial information, refer to note 37 ‘Impact of new accounting standards and change in accounting policies’ to the Financial Statements.

 

 

41


Table of Contents

We use several financial measures to monitor the financial performance of our overall strategy. The two key measures are Profit after taxation attributable to members of the BHP Billiton Group (Attributable profit) and Underlying EBIT.

 

Year ended 30 June

US$M

   2014      2013      2012      2011 (5)      2010 (5)  

Consolidated Income Statement

              

Revenue

     67,206         65,953         70,477         71,739         52,798   

Profit from operations

     23,412         21,002         24,600         31,816         20,031   

Profit attributable to members of BHP Billiton Group

     13,832         11,223         15,473         23,648         12,722   

Dividends per ordinary share – paid during the period (US cents)

     118.0         114.0         110.0         91.0         83.0   

Dividends per ordinary share – determined in respect of the period (US cents)

     121.0         116.0         112.0         101.0         87.0   

Earnings per ordinary share (basic) (US cents) (1)

     260.0         210.9         290.7         429.1         228.6   

Earnings per ordinary share (diluted) (US cents) (1)

     259.1         210.2         289.4         426.9         227.8   

Number of ordinary shares (millions)

              

– At period end

     5,348         5,348         5,348         5,350         5,589   

– Weighted average

     5,321         5,322         5,323         5,511         5,565   

– Diluted

     5,338         5,340         5,346         5,540         5,595   

Consolidated Balance Sheet

              

Total assets

     151,413         139,178         129,201         102,920         88,852   

Share capital (including share premium)

     2,773         2,773         2,773         2,771         2,861   

Total equity attributable to members of BHP Billiton Group

     79,143         70,667         65,526         56,762         48,525   

Other financial information

              

Underlying EBITDA (2)

     32,359         30,308         34,617         37,093         24,513   

Underlying EBIT (2)

     22,861         22,930         28,086         31,980         19,719   

Underlying attributable profit (2)

     13,447         12,208         17,173         21,684         12,469   

Underlying basic earnings per share (US cents)

     252.7         229.4         322.6         393.5         224.1   

Capital and exploration expenditure (BHP Billiton share) (3)

     15,181         22,291         19,793         12,387         10,656   

Net operating cash flow (4)

     25,364         20,154         25,259         30,080         16,890   

 

(1) For more information on earnings per share refer to note 8 ‘Earnings per share’ to the Financial Statements.

 

(2) Underlying attributable profit, Underlying EBIT and Underlying EBITDA are used to reflect the underlying performance of BHP Billiton. Underlying attributable profit is Attributable profit excluding any exceptional items. Underlying EBIT is earnings before net finance costs, taxation and any exceptional items. Underlying EBITDA is Underlying EBIT before depreciation, impairments and amortisation. We believe that Underlying attributable profit, Underlying EBIT and Underlying EBITDA provide useful information, but should not be considered as an indication of, or as an alternative to, Attributable profit as an indicator of actual operating performance or as an alternative to cash flow as a measure of liquidity. Underlying EBIT and Underlying EBITDA are included in the FY2014 Consolidated Financial Statements as required by IFRS 8 ‘Operating Segments’.

 

(3)  Represents the share of capital and exploration expenditure attributable to BHP Billiton shareholders on a cash basis. Includes BHP Billiton proportionate share of equity accounted investments; excludes capitalised deferred stripping and non-controlling interests. FY2011 and FY2010 data has not been restated and represents the capital and exploration expenditure of the Group on a cash basis, as published.

 

(4) 

Net operating cash flows are after net interest and taxation. On 1 July 2010, the Group adopted the policy of classifying exploration cash flows which are not recognised as assets as Net operating cash flows.

 

42


Table of Contents
  Previously such cash flows were classified as Net investing cash flows. The change in policy arose from amendments to IAS7/AASB7 ‘Cash Flows’. Comparative figures have been restated.

 

(5)  FY2011 and FY2010 data has not been restated for the effects of new accounting standards and interpretations and other voluntary changes in accounting policy, which are effective in the financial year commencing from 1 July 2013.

Non-IFRS measures

We use a number of non-IFRS measures to assess our performance. Non-IFRS measures include the following:

 

  Underlying attributable profit – comprises Profit after taxation attributable to members of BHP Billiton Group less exceptional items as described in note 3 ‘Exceptional items’ to the Financial Statements.

 

  Underlying basic earnings per share – represents basic earnings per share excluding any exceptional items.

 

  Underlying EBITDA interest coverage – for the purpose of deriving interest coverage, net interest comprises Interest on bank loans and overdrafts, Interest on all other borrowings, Finance lease and hire purchase interest less Interest income.

 

  Adjusted effective tax rate – comprises Total taxation expense excluding remeasurement of deferred tax assets associated with the Minerals Resource Rent Tax (MRRT), exceptional items and exchange rate movements included in taxation expense divided by Profit before taxation and exceptional items.

 

  Underlying EBIT margin – comprises Underlying EBIT excluding third party product profit from operations, divided by revenue excluding third party product revenue.

 

  Underlying EBITDA margin – comprises Underlying EBITDA excluding third party product EBITDA, divided by revenue excluding third party product revenue.

 

  Underlying return on capital – represents net profit after tax, excluding exceptional items and net finance costs (after tax), divided by average capital employed. Capital employed is net assets before net debt.

 

  Free cash flow – comprises Net operating cash flows less Net investing cash flows.

 

  Net debt – comprises Interest bearing liabilities less Cash and cash equivalents.

 

  Net operating assets – represents operating assets net of operating liabilities including the carrying value of equity accounted investments and predominantly excludes cash balances, interest bearing liabilities and deferred tax balances. The carrying value of investments accounted for using the equity accounted method represents the balance of the Group’s investment in equity accounted investments, with no adjustment for any cash balances, interest bearing liabilities and deferred tax balances of the associate.

In addition we analyse our change in revenue and costs using non-IFRS measures as noted in sections 1.15.3 and 2.5.

Financial results for year ended 30 June 2014 compared with year ended 30 June 2013

Revenue in FY2014 was US$67.2 billion, an increase of US$1.2 billion, or 1.9 per cent, from US$66.0 billion in the corresponding period. The revenue increase was primarily reflected in the Iron Ore and Petroleum and Potash Businesses, with increases of US$2.8 billion and US$1.6 billion, respectively. These increases were offset by decreases in our Copper Business of US$669 million, in our Coal Business of US$780 million, in our Aluminium, Manganese and Nickel Business of US$867 million and by the loss of revenue of our disposed former Diamonds and Specialty Products Business of US$325 million.

The increase in revenue in Iron Ore was primarily due to an increase in sales volumes of 17 per cent to 202 Mt, which contributed to an increase in revenue of US$3.2 billion, partially offset by a six per cent decline in average

 

43


Table of Contents

realised price of iron ore to US$103 per wet metric tonne (FOB), which reduced revenue by US$522 million. The increase in revenue in Petroleum was primarily due to an increase in volume of four per cent in FY2014 to 246 MMboe, which contributed to an increase in revenue of US$1.4 billion, and to higher realised prices, which contributed to an additional increase of US$219 million. The decrease in other businesses mainly reflected lower realised prices in our Copper Business (US$1.2 billion), Coal Business (US$1.4 billion) and Aluminium, Manganese and Nickel Business (US$394 million).

Overall, the US$1.2 billion increase in revenue in FY2014 can be attributed to US$5.5 billion related to increased volumes, which are within our control, offset primarily by US$3.3 billion related to prices, which are uncontrollable, US$494 million for ceased and sold operations, and US$202 million for exchange rates.

Total expenses decreased from US$50.0 billion in FY2013 to US$46.5 billion in FY2014. Excluding exceptional items, the majority of which related to impairments in FY2013, total expenses have increased by US$1.6 billion or 3.5 per cent during FY2014 from US$45.0 billion to US$46.5 billion.

 

Year ended 30 June

   2014     2013     2012  
     US$M     US$M     US$M  

Raw materials and consumables used

     8,842        8,926        8,128   

Employee benefits expense

     6,903        7,168        6,035   

External services (including transportation) (1)

     11,736        12,478        14,293   

Third party commodity purchases

     2,935        2,759        3,402   

Net foreign exchange losses/(gains)

     100        (284     (571

Fair value change on derivatives

     (120     79        (141

Government royalties paid and payable

     2,760        2,562        2,880   

Depreciation and amortisation expense

     8,701        7,031        6,431   

Exploration and evaluation expenditure

     716        1,047        1,644   

Impairment of assets (2)

     797        5,496        3,763   

Operating lease rentals

     759        776        658   

Other operating expenses (3)

     2,384        2,002        2,122   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total expenses

     46,513        50,040        48,644   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Less exceptional items

            (5,087     (3,786
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total expenses excluding exceptional items

     46,513        44,953        44,858   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1)  Includes exceptional items of US$ nil (2013: US$96 million; 2012: US$ nil).

 

(2)  Includes exceptional items of US$ nil (2013: US$5,149 million; 2012: US$3,663 million).

 

(3)  Includes exceptional items of US$ nil (2013: credit of US$158 million; 2012: US$ nil).

The majority of the increase relates to non-cash expenses for depreciation and amortisation (US$1.7 billion), impairments not classified as exceptional items (US$450 million) and changes to provisions for mine site rehabilitation (US$300 million). Increases in other non-cash charges also included provisions for restructuring and a lower capitalisation rate for deferred stripping at Escondida and Pampa Norte. Increases in costs attributable to inflation were US$805 million.

Higher expenses associated with increased production across our four major Businesses of US$2.6 billion were more than offset by reduced operating costs. Our focus on reducing operating costs through productivity initiatives saw cost efficiencies in our Businesses, in particular our Coal Business.

 

44


Table of Contents

Reductions in expenses (excluding exceptional items) were evident in Employee benefit expense (US$265 million), External services (US$646 million), Exploration and evaluation expenditure (US$331 million) and Raw materials and consumables (US$84 million). In total operating costs were aided by favourable exchange rate impacts of US$2.0 billion.

Other income decreased from US$3.9 billion in FY2013 to US$1.5 billion. Excluding exceptional items, the majority of which relates to gains on the sale of assets, other income increased from US$788 million to US$973 million.

Profit from operations increased by US$2.4 billion, or 11 per cent, from US$21.0 billion to US$23.4 billion. Exceptional items during FY2014 comprised a gain on sale of our Pinto Valley mining operation of US$551 million (before taxation), compared with net exceptional charges of US$1.9 billion (before taxation) in FY2013. In that context, in FY2014 Profit from operations excluding exceptional items, which we refer to as Underlying EBIT, declined by 0.3 per cent, or US$69 million, to US$22.9 billion.

Underlying EBIT

In discussing the operating results of the Group, we focus on a financial measure we refer to as Underlying EBIT. Underlying EBIT is the key measure that management uses internally to assess the performance of our Businesses, make decisions on the allocation of resources and assess operational management. Management uses this measure because financing structures and tax regimes differ across our assets and substantial components of our tax and interest charges are levied at a Group level rather than an operational level.

We exclude exceptional items from Underlying EBIT in order to enhance the comparability of the measure from period to period and provide clarity into the underlying performance of our operations. Our management monitors exceptional items separately.

The following table reconciles Underlying EBIT to Profit from operations.

 

Year ended 30 June

   2014      2013     2012  
     US$M      US$M     US$M  

Underlying EBIT

     22,861         22,930        28,086   

Exceptional items (before taxation) – refer section 1.15.3

     551         (1,928     (3,486
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Profit from operations (EBIT)

     23,412         21,002        24,600   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Attributable profit increased by 23 per cent to US$13.8 billion due to a decrease of the Group’s effective tax rate from 35.0 per cent to 31.5 per cent. Underlying attributable profit (comprising Profit after taxation attributable to members of BHP Billiton Group less exceptional items) of US$13.4 billion increased due to a decrease in the Group’s adjusted effective tax rate from 34.2 per cent to 32.5 per cent.

Net operating cash flows after interest and tax increased by 26 per cent to US$25.4 billion in FY2014. A US$2.6 billion increase in cash generated from operations (after changes in working capital balances) and a US$2.1 billion decrease in net taxes paid were the major contributors to the strong increase. We delivered a substantial US$8.1 billion increase in free cash flow, being Net operating cash flows less Net investing cash flows, despite weaker commodity prices. In this context, capital and exploration expenditure (BHP Billiton share) declined by 32 per cent to US$15.2 billion in the period.

We finished the period with net debt of US$25.8 billion (2013: US$27.5 billion), which included finance leases of US$1.3 billion (2013: US$137 million), for a gearing ratio of 23 per cent (2013: 27 per cent).

Further analysis of Underlying EBIT for the Businesses is included in section 1.12 and for the Group in section 1.15.3 of this Annual Report.

 

45


Table of Contents

1.11.2    Production performance

A summary of our production volumes for FY2014 and the previous two financial years is shown below. Further details appear in section 2.2 of this Annual Report.

 

Year ended 30 June

   2014      2013      2012  

Total Petroleum production (MMboe)

     246         236         222   

Copper (kt)

     1,727         1,689         1,468   

Iron ore (kt)

     203,564         169,856         159,478   

Metallurgical coal (kt)

     45,078         37,650         33,230   

Energy coal (kt)

     73,492         72,445         74,267   

Alumina (kt)

     5,178         4,880         4,152   

Aluminium (kt)

     1,174         1,179         1,153   

Manganese ores (kt)

     8,302         8,517         7,931   

Manganese alloys (kt)

     646         608         602   

Nickel (kt)

     143         154         158   

1.11.3    Projects and pipeline

Our project pipeline focuses on commodities that are expected to be high-margin and create significant future value. During FY2014, eight projects were completed for a total capital expenditure (subject to finalisation) of US$10.3 billion. At the end of FY2014, we had seven major projects under development in execution and one other project in pre-development phase with a combined budget of US$14.1 billion. This budget does not include an additional US$4.0 billion of capital expenditure that we expect to spend in FY2015 on development of our Onshore US Asset.

For more information on our major projects and pipeline refer to sections 1.12, 2.1 and 2.4 of this Annual Report.

1.12    Our Businesses

The description of our Businesses and a discussion of their performance is set out below.

For further information on our assets, production, results and reserves refer to section 2 of this Annual Report. For further information on the financial results of our Businesses, refer to note 2 ‘Segment reporting’ to the Financial Statements.

1.12.1    Revenue and Underlying EBIT performance by Business

The following tables provide a summary of Revenue and Underlying EBIT for FY2014 and the two prior corresponding periods of our Businesses and the Group. Our use of Underlying EBIT is explained in section 1.11.1.of this Annual Report.

 

Year ended 30 June

   2014     2013      2012  
     US$M     US$M      US$M  

Revenue (1)

       

Petroleum and Potash

     14,833        13,224         12,933   

Copper

     13,868        14,537         13,553   

Iron Ore

     21,356        18,593         20,605   

Coal

     9,115        9,895         12,512   

Aluminium, Manganese and Nickel

     8,411        9,278         9,911   

Group and unallocated items (2)

     (377     426         963   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

BHP Billiton Group

     67,206        65,953         70,477   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

46


Table of Contents

Year ended 30 June

   2014     2013     2012  
     US$M     US$M     US$M  

Underlying EBIT

      

Petroleum and Potash

     5,287        5,636        6,033   

Copper

     5,080        5,639        5,313   

Iron Ore

     12,102        11,109        14,044   

Coal

     386        595        2,612   

Aluminium, Manganese and Nickel

     307        158        (24

Group and unallocated items(2)

     (301     (207     108   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

BHP Billiton Group

     22,861        22,930        28,086   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1)  Includes the sale of third party products.

 

(2)  Includes the Group’s diamonds business (divested effective 10 April 2013), interest in titanium minerals (divested effective 3 September 2012), non-Potash corporate costs incurred by the former Diamonds and Specialty Products Business, consolidation adjustments, unallocated items and external sales of freight and fuel via the Group’s transport and logistics operations.

Year ended 30 June 2014 compared with year ended 30 June 2013

Underlying EBIT for FY2014 was US$22.9 billion, basically unchanged from FY2013.

A substantial reduction in commodity prices reduced Underlying EBIT by US$3.4 billion. This was offset by cost improvements which underpinned a decrease in operating cash costs of US$1.5 billion and a decrease in exploration and business development costs of US$398 million. In addition, higher volumes attributed to our development projects coming on line and through productivity efficiencies at existing assets, primarily in Iron Ore and Petroleum, contributed an additional US$2.9 billion to Underlying EBIT. This was offset by increased depreciation and amortisation which reduced Underlying EBIT by US$1.7 billion.

The use of the term operating cash costs is described in section 1.15.3 of this Annual Report.

1.12.2    Petroleum and Potash Business

Our Petroleum and Potash Business headquartered in Houston, United States, comprises conventional and non-conventional operations located in six countries throughout the world and a potash project based in Saskatchewan, Canada.

 

Year ended 30 June

   2014      2013      2012  
     US$M      US$M      US$M  

Revenue

     14,833         13,224         12,933   

Underlying EBIT

     5,287         5,636         6,033   

Capital expenditure

     6,423         7,675         5,488   

Net operating assets

     39,514         37,525         33,583   

Total petroleum production (MMboe)

     246         236         222   

Our Petroleum Business includes exploration, development, production and marketing activities. We have a high-quality resource base concentrated in the United States and Australia. Our core production operations are primarily located in the US Gulf of Mexico, Onshore US and in Australia. We also have operations in Trinidad and Tobago, Pakistan, Algeria and the United Kingdom. We produce crude oil and condensate, natural gas and natural gas liquids (NGLs). Our petroleum portfolio consisted of conventional oil and gas operations up until 2011, when we moved into the unconventional shale business. Our Onshore US operations evolved from the acquisition of the Fayetteville shale assets from Chesapeake Energy Corporation and the acquisition of Petrohawk Energy Corporation.

 

47


Table of Contents

A summary of our Petroleum and Potash Business’ assets, capital projects and FY2014 performance is presented below.

Description of the Petroleum Business

Our production operations include the following:

Gulf of Mexico (United States)

We operate two fields in the Gulf of Mexico (Shenzi with a 44 per cent interest and Neptune with a 35 per cent interest) and hold non-operating interests in three other fields (Atlantis with a 44 per cent interest, Mad Dog with a 23.9 per cent interest, and Genesis with a 4.95 per cent interest). We have on-going infill drilling in our Gulf of Mexico fields. We completed water injection development projects at Shenzi and Atlantis in CY2013. All the fields are located between 155 and 210 kilometres offshore of the US state of Louisiana. We also own 25 per cent and 22 per cent, respectively, of the companies that own and operate the Caesar oil pipeline and the Cleopatra gas pipeline. Production in FY2014 was 36.1 million barrels of oil equivalent (MMboe) up from 30.6 MMboe in FY2013.

Onshore US (United States)

We produce oil, condensate, NGLs and natural gas in four shale areas: Eagle Ford, Permian, Haynesville and Fayetteville. The Eagle Ford area has two sections, Black Hawk and Hawkville. Much of the Eagle Ford and Permian areas are focused on hydrocarbon liquids. The Haynesville and Fayetteville areas are focused on natural gas. Our combined leasehold acreage onshore in the United States is approximately 1.2 million net acres. Our ownership interests in those leases range from less than one per cent to 100 per cent. At 30 June 2014, we held an interest in approximately 7,700 gross wells and approximately 2,600 net wells. We acted as joint venture operator for approximately 32 per cent of our gross wells. Production in FY2014 was 108.1 MMboe, up from 99.2 MMboe in FY2013.

Oil and gas production from our onshore shale areas is sold domestically in the United States, via connections to intrastate and interstate pipelines. Prices for oil, NGLs and natural gas are based on US regional price indices, including West Texas Intermediate prices for oil, Henry Hub prices for natural gas and Mont Belvieu prices for NGLs.

During FY2014, we sold our interest in our Onshore US South Midland shale operation, located in the Permian Basin, to EP Energy for a cash consideration of US$153 million.

Map of Onshore US and Gulf of Mexico

 

LOGO

 

48


Table of Contents

Map of North West Shelf and Bass Strait

 

LOGO

Bass Strait (Australia)

Together with our 50-50 joint venture partner, Esso Australia (a subsidiary of ExxonMobil), through the Gippsland Basin Joint Venture, we participated in the original discovery of hydrocarbons in 1965 and we have been producing oil and gas from Bass Strait for more than 40 years. The Bass Strait operations are located between 25 and 80 kilometres off the southeastern coast of Australia.

We sell the majority of our Bass Strait crude oil and condensate production to refineries along the east coast of Australia under 12-month term contracts. The contract price is based on the average Dated Brent price. Gas is piped onshore to the joint venture’s Longford processing facility, from which we sell our share of production to domestic distributors under contracts with periodic price reviews.

Production in FY2014 was 34.0 MMboe, down from 36.0 MMboe in FY2013.

North West Shelf (Australia)

We are a joint venture participant in the North West Shelf Project, located approximately 125 kilometres northwest of Dampier in Western Australia. The North West Shelf Project was developed in phases: the domestic gas phase supplies gas to the Western Australia domestic market, mainly under long-term contracts, and a series of liquefied natural gas (LNG) expansion phases supplying LNG to buyers in Japan, South Korea and China under a series of long-term contracts. Gas from North West Shelf is piped to the Karratha Gas Plant for processing. We are also a joint venture partner in four nearby oil fields. All North West Shelf gas and oil joint ventures are operated by Woodside. Production in FY2014 was 28.8 MMboe, down from 30.1 MMboe in FY2013.

Pyrenees (Australia)

We operate six oil fields in Pyrenees, which are located offshore approximately 23 kilometres northwest of Northwest Cape, Western Australia. We had an effective 62 per cent interest in the fields as at 30 June 2014, based on inception to-date production from two permits in which we have interests of 71.43 per cent and 40 per cent, respectively. The project uses a floating, production, storage and off-take (FPSO) facility. The crude oil produced is sold internationally on the spot market. Production in FY2014 was 7.5 MMboe down from 8.5 MMboe in FY2013.

 

49


Table of Contents

Macedon (Australia)

We are the operator of Macedon (71.43 per cent interest), an offshore gas field located approximately 75 kilometres west of Onslow, Western Australia, and a gas processing facility onshore approximately 17 kilometres southwest of Onslow. The operation achieved first gas in August 2013 and consists of four subsea wells, with gas piped onshore to the processing plant. After processing, the gas is delivered into a pipeline and sold domestically under long-term contracts. First year production was 5.5 MMboe.

Greater Angostura (Trinidad and Tobago)

We operate the Greater Angostura field (45 per cent interest in the production sharing contract), an integrated oil and gas development, located offshore, 40 kilometres east of Trinidad. The crude oil is sold on a spot basis to international markets, while the gas is sold domestically under term contracts. Production in FY2014 was 7.5 MMboe, up from 7.4 MMboe in FY2013.

Other

We are the operator at the following operations: Minerva (90 per cent interest), a gas field located 11 kilometres south-southwest of Port Campbell in western Victoria, the Zamzama gas project (38.5 per cent interest) in the Sindh province of Pakistan and the Keith oil and gas field (31.83 per cent interest) in the North Sea. We have non-operating interests in ROD Integrated Development (38 per cent interest), which consists of six satellite oil fields in Algeria, and in the Bruce oil and gas field (16 per cent interest) in the North Sea. Production in FY2014 was 17.3 MMboe, down from 22.3 MMboe in FY2013.

More information on our assets and operations is presented in section 2.1.1 of this Annual Report.

Completed development projects

Macedon

Macedon is a domestic gas development that consists of a 200 million cubic feet per day (MMcf/d) standalone gas plant, four subsea production wells, a 90 kilometre 20-inch wet gas pipeline and a 67-kilometre 20-inch sales gas pipeline. The project was approved in August 2010. First gas occurred in August 2013.

North West Shelf North Rankin gas compression

The North West Shelf gas compression project was approved by the Board in March 2008 to recover remaining lower pressure gas from the North Rankin and Perseus gas fields. The project consisted of a new gas compression platform, North Rankin B, capable of processing 2,500 MMcf/d of gas, which was constructed adjacent to the existing North Rankin A platform, 135 kilometres offshore from Karratha on the northwest coast of Western Australia. The two platforms are connected by a 100-metre long bridge and operate as a single facility. First gas production occurred in October 2013. This project is operated by Woodside, with an equally shared interest between Woodside, BHP Billiton, BP, Chevron, MIMI and Shell.

Development projects in execution at year-end

North West Shelf Greater Western Flank–A

The North West Shelf Greater Western Flank–A (GWF-A) gas project was approved by the Board in November 2011 to recover gas from the near field Goodwyn H and Tidepole fields. The project consists of a five well subsea tie-back of the Goodwyn H and Tidepole fields to the Goodwyn A platform. The Goodwyn A platform is located in 130 metres of water, approximately 130 kilometres offshore from Karratha on the northwest coast of Australia. First gas production is expected in CY2016. Woodside is the operator and we own a 16.67 per cent interest.

 

50


Table of Contents

Bass Strait Longford Gas Conditioning

The Longford Gas Conditioning Plant (LGCP) Project was approved by the Board in December 2012 to enable the production of Turrum reserves plus the production of Kipper and other undeveloped high carbon dioxide content hydrocarbons. The project scope includes a carbon dioxide extraction facility, brownfield tie-ins, an electrical upgrade and multiple supporting utilities. First gas production is expected in CY2016.

Onshore US Development

Drilling and development investment for Onshore US in FY2014 was US$4.2 billion, down from US$4.7 billion in FY2013, with US$3.6 billion (FY2013: US$3.8 billion) spent in the liquids-focused areas of Eagle Ford and Permian, and US$0.6 billion (FY2013: US$0.9 billion) in the gas-focused areas of Haynesville and Fayetteville. The expenditure primarily related to drilling and completion activities at all four areas. Our onshore drilling activity in FY2014 resulted in 413 net development wells completed primarily in the Eagle Ford and Permian areas.

Of the US$4.2 billion, approximately US$400 million was invested in the installation of more than 200 kilometres of pipeline infrastructure and additional gas processing facilities, primarily in our Eagle Ford and Permian areas. The majority of drilling and completion activity in Onshore US was directed towards the liquids-focused Eagle Ford and Permian areas to capitalise on the stronger liquid prices as compared with natural gas prices. At the end of FY2014, more than 85 per cent of drilling activity was conducted in these areas.

More information on our development and capital projects is presented in section 2.4 of this Annual Report.

Exploration and evaluation

Our exploration strategy is to focus on material opportunities, at high working interest, with a bias for liquids and operatorship. While the majority of our expenditure occurs in our two principal offshore areas of activity, the Gulf of Mexico and Western Australia, we also have exploration activities in Trinidad and Tobago, Brazil, South Africa, South East Asia and Onshore US.

We then perform development evaluation activities to determine the technical feasibility and commercial viability of prospective projects after exploration and appraisal.

More information on our development evaluation activities and exploration is presented in section 2.1.1 of this Annual Report.

Description of the Potash Business

Jansen Potash Project

Our Potash strategy is to build a material industry position over the long term.

We hold exploration permits and mining leases, issued by the Government of Saskatchewan, covering more than 14,000 square kilometres of mineral rights in the province of Saskatchewan in Canada. We have progressively explored our permit areas over the past seven years and continue to evaluate their economic development potential. We are converting our exploration permits to long-term leases as these permits mature in order to enable further evaluation. To date, we have secured 4,400 square kilometres under long-term mining leases.

We believe our Jansen Potash Project, a greenfield potash project in south-central Saskatchewan, is the world’s best undeveloped potash resource and is likely to be a low-cost source of supply once fully developed. Investment in Jansen could underpin a potential fifth pillar of BHP Billiton, given the opportunity to develop a multi-decade, multi-mine basin in Saskatchewan.

 

51


Table of Contents

On 20 August 2013, we announced an additional US$2.6 billion investment for Jansen, bringing total approved spending to US$3.8 billion. This investment is funding the excavation and lining of the Project’s production and service shafts, and the installation of surface infrastructure and utilities. The level of expenditure on the Jansen Potash Project in FY2014 was US$596 million.

With our investment premised on the attractive longer-term market fundamentals for potash, we will continue to modulate the pace of development as we seek to time our entrance to meet market demand. The introduction of one or more minority partners, consistent with our approach for certain of our other resource operations, will be considered at the appropriate time.

On the basis of our current projections and assuming Board approval, the Jansen mine is likely to ramp-up to its nameplate capacity of approximately 10 Mtpa of agricultural grade potassium chloride in the decade beyond 2020.

Performance

Petroleum and Potash revenue increased by US$1.6 billion to US$14.8 billion, mainly due to Onshore US, which increased by 43 per cent to US$4.3 billion, and Atlantis, which increased by 80 per cent to US$1.5 billion.

The increase in revenue primarily resulted from an increase in volume of four per cent in FY2014 to 246 MMboe. A 16 MMboe increase in liquids production was underpinned by a 73 per cent increase in Onshore US liquids volumes and a near doubling of production at Atlantis. Natural gas volumes declined by four per cent as the delivery of first gas from Macedon partially offset lower demand at Bass Strait and natural field decline at Haynesville.

The average realised price of natural gas across our portfolio increased by 16 per cent to US$4.35 per thousand standard cubic feet (Mscf). This included a 25 per cent increase in the average realised price of US natural gas to US$4.10 per Mscf. This increase was partially offset by a four per cent decline in the average realised price of oil to US$102 per bbl, a one per cent decline in the average realised price of LNG to US$14.67 per Mscf and a seven per cent decline in the average realised price of natural gas liquids (NGL) to US$42.28 per barrel.

Underlying EBIT for Petroleum decreased by US$115 million to US$5.9 billion in FY2014. Price-related increases, net of price-linked costs, contributed US$113 million to Underlying EBIT and volumes contributed an additional US$994 million, although this was partially offset by an increase in depreciation and amortisation expense at Onshore US that reflected the ramp-up of liquids production and the progressive development of our Permian acreage. In this regard, our position within our focus area in the Permian increased by 25 per cent in the period to 74 thousand net acres.

Additional charges were also recognised during the period, including: a US$184 million impairment of minor Gulf of Mexico assets; a US$143 million adjustment to the Browse divestment proceeds; and a US$112 million UK pension plan expense. The Group also incurred a charge of US$135 million for underutilised gas pipeline capacity, primarily in the Haynesville.

The Onshore US Underlying EBIT for FY2014 was a loss of US$156 million compared with a loss in FY2013 of US$287 million. The Onshore US Underlying EBITDA for FY2014 was US$2.3 billion compared with US$1.5 billion in FY2013. Second half June 2014 EBITDA increased by more than 60 per cent to US$1.4 billion. As a result, Onshore US generated an Underlying EBIT of US$142 million during the second half of FY2014. This included the aforementioned underutilised gas pipeline capacity charges.

In FY2014, approximately 75 per cent of Onshore US drilling and development expenditure of US$4.2 billion was invested in the Eagle Ford, with the majority focused on our Black Hawk acreage. The repetitive, manufacturing-like nature of shale development is ideally suited to our productivity agenda. Drilling costs in the Black Hawk declined by 16 per cent to US$4.2 million per well during the period while spud to sales timing improved by 21 per cent.

 

52


Table of Contents

Of the 24 operated drilling rigs in action at the end of the period (30 June 2013: 40), 17 were in the Eagle Ford (30 June 2013: 31), four were in the Permian (30 June 2013: four), three were in the Haynesville (30 June 2013: four), while no rigs were in the Fayetteville (30 June 2013: one).

A total of 138 net wells were put online in our prolific Black Hawk acreage during FY2014 (FY2013: 66 net wells) with an average 30-day initial production rate of 1,140 boe per day. An average one-year cumulative production rate per well of 208 thousand barrels of oil equivalent (Mboe) for the wells put online in FY2013 reflected advances in completions optimisation and the benefit of restricting initial flow rates. At the end of the period we had 284 net producing wells in the Black Hawk with an average rate of 82.4 Mboe per day achieved in the June 2014 quarter (43.0 Mboe per day in the June 2013 quarter).

Onshore US overview

 

          Liquids-
focused areas
(Eagle Ford
and
Permian)
    Gas-
focused areas
(Haynesville
and
Fayetteville)
    Total  

Year ended 30 June

   2014     2013     2014     2013     2014     2013  

Capital expenditure

   US$ billion      3.6        3.8        0.6        0.9        4.2        4.7   

Production

   MMboe      51.9        33.4        56.2        65.8        108.1        99.2   

Production mix

   Natural gas      36     42     100     100     69     80
  

Natural gas liquids

     22     23                   11     8
   Crude and condensate      42     35                   20     12

Petroleum exploration expenditure for FY2014 was US$600 million, of which US$369 million was expensed. During the period, we signed a production sharing contract for Block 23b (60 per cent interest and operator) and farmed into Blocks 23a and 14 (70 per cent interest and operator) in Trinidad and Tobago.

During the period, we completed the divestment of our 46.1 per cent interest in Liverpool Bay and our South Midland acreage in the Permian basin, Onshore US. Combined proceeds of US$182 million were realised (before customary adjustments) and a gain on sale of US$116 million was recognised in Underlying EBIT.

Potash recorded an Underlying EBIT loss of US$583 million. This included: a US$68 million impairment associated with our decision to allow the exclusivity agreement for Terminal 5 at the Port of Vancouver (US) to lapse; and a US$300 million charge related to the revision of mine site rehabilitation provisions for the Group’s North American closed mines, which are managed by our Potash Business. In addition, exploration expense for Potash was US$47 million, a US$42 million reduction from FY2013.

The Jansen Potash Project was 30 per cent complete at the end of the period with significant progress made on surface infrastructure and shaft excavation continuing.

Outlook

After adjusting for the sale of Liverpool Bay, Petroleum production is forecast to increase by five per cent in FY2015 to 255 MMboe with another 16 MMboe increase in total liquids production projected. Conventional volumes for FY2015 are forecast to remain broadly unchanged.

Petroleum capital expenditure of approximately US$5.6 billion is planned in FY2015. In our Onshore US Asset we will continue to prioritise investment in the liquids-focused Eagle Ford and Permian with up to 120 net wells expected to be put online in the Black Hawk. In our conventional business, we will remain focused on high-return infill drilling opportunities in the Gulf of Mexico and life extension projects at Bass Strait and North West Shelf.

 

53


Table of Contents

A US$750 million exploration program, largely focused on the Gulf of Mexico, Western Australia and the collection of seismic data in Trinidad and Tobago is planned for FY2015.

1.12.3    Copper Business

Our Copper Business, headquartered in Santiago, Chile, is one of the world’s premier producers of copper, silver, lead and uranium, and is a leading producer of zinc. We market five primary products: copper cathodes, copper, lead and zinc concentrates and uranium oxide.

 

Year ended 30 June

   2014      2013      2012  
     US$M      US$M      US$M  

Revenue

     13,868         14,537         13,553   

Underlying EBIT

     5,080         5,639         5,313   

Capital expenditure

     3,757         3,930         3,518   

Net operating assets

     22,231         20,074         16,721   

Production – copper (kt)

     1,727         1,689         1,468   

A summary of our Copper Business’ assets and operations, development projects and FY2014 performance is presented below.

Description of the Copper Business

Our assets consist of the following:

Escondida (Chile)

Our 57.5 per cent owned and operated Escondida mine is the largest producer of copper in the world. Located in the Atacama Desert in northern Chile, Escondida employs approximately 14,000 operational employees and contractors and has the capacity to move in excess of 1.3 million tonnes (Mt) of material per day. Its two open-cut pits feed two concentrator plants, which use grinding and flotation technologies to produce copper concentrate, as well as two leaching operations (oxide and sulphide). In FY2014, our share of Escondida production was 485.7 kilotonnes (kt) of payable copper in concentrate and 177.1 kt of copper cathode. Escondida has a reserve life of 52 years.

Pampa Norte (Chile)

Pampa Norte consists of two wholly owned operations in the Atacama Desert in northern Chile – Spence and Cerro Colorado. During FY2014, Spence produced 152.8 kt of high-quality copper cathodes, using oxide and sulphide ore treatment through leaching, solvent extraction and electrowinning processes. Although production levels at Cerro Colorado have fallen in recent years as grades have declined, production in FY2014 reached 80.3 kt of copper cathode. Spence and Cerro Colorado have reserve lives of 10 and nine years, respectively.

A project, currently being studied, referred to as the Spence Growth Option (SGO), is being conducted to consider exploiting the hypogene sulphide resource with associated molybdenum sulphide by building a 95 kilotonnes per day (ktpd) concentrator at the Spence operation. SGO would extend the mine life by approximately 50 years following the current FY2025 closure date.

Antamina (Peru)

We own 33.75 per cent of Antamina, a large, long-life, low-cost copper and zinc mine in north central Peru. Our share of Antamina’s FY2014 production was 143.5 kt of copper in concentrate and 52.0 kt of zinc in concentrate. Antamina also produces molybdenum and lead/bismuth concentrate, as well as small amounts of silver in the form of by-products. Antamina has a reserve life of 13 years. In FY2014, Antamina commenced execution of a debottlenecking project, to increase milling capacity by 12 per cent to 145 ktpd.

 

54


Table of Contents

Cannington (Australia)

Our wholly owned Cannington mine is one of the world’s largest producers of silver and lead. Located in northwest Queensland, Australia, the underground mine feeds a beneficiation processing facility that extracts silver/lead and zinc concentrates from sulphide ore. In FY2014, Cannington produced concentrates containing186.5 kt of lead, 57.9 kt of zinc and approximately 25.2 million ounces of silver. Cannington has a reserve life of nine years.

Olympic Dam (Australia)

Our wholly owned Olympic Dam mine in South Australia is a producer of copper cathode and uranium oxide and a refiner of gold and silver bullion. The site includes an underground mine, where the primary method of ore extraction is long-hole open stoping with cemented aggregate fill, and an integrated metallurgical processing plant. In FY2014, Olympic Dam produced 184.4 kt of copper cathode, 4.0 kt of uranium oxide, 121.3 kilo-ounces (koz) of refined gold and 972 koz of refined silver. Olympic Dam has a reserve life of 47 years.

A pre-feasibility study is being conducted into the proposed expansion of Olympic Dam. The objective of the study is to identify the full range of development path alternatives for Olympic Dam by investigating all possible mining methods and less capital-intensive designs, including new technologies.

In July 2014, we lodged an application for assessment by the Australian and South Australian Governments to construct and operate a demonstration plant on the existing mining lease at Olympic Dam. This process would enable heap leaching trials to progress to the next phase as part of our efforts to identify an alternative, less capital-intensive process for extracting metals from ore mined underground. Should Government and Board approvals be granted, construction of the demonstration plant is expected to commence in the second half of CY2015. A trial period of 36 months is envisaged, commencing in late 2016.

Divested asset – Pinto Valley (United States)

In October 2013, we completed the sale of our Pinto Valley mining operation and the associated San Manuel Arizona Railroad Company to Capstone Mining Corp. for US$653 million, after working capital adjustments.

More information on our assets and operations is presented in section 2.1.2 of this Annual Report.

Development projects in execution at year-end

Escondida

The Organic Growth Project 1 (OGP1) is the replacement for the Los Colorados concentrator with a new 152 ktpd plant. We expect this project to provide additional processing capacity and allows access to higher-grade ore. OGP1 was approved in February 2012 with budgeted expenditure of US$3.8 billion (BHP Billiton share US$2.2 billion). Project completion is targeted for the first half of CY2015. Work on OGP1 was 79 per cent complete at 30 June 2014.

We approved the Escondida Water Supply (EWS) project in July 2013, which consists of a new 2,500 litres per second sea water desalination facility. This project will provide an alternative water supply to Escondida, as water usage increases upon completion of the 152 ktpd OGP1 copper concentrator. Construction of the new desalination facility commenced in July 2013 and includes the development of two pipelines, four high-pressure pump stations, a reservoir at the mine site and high-voltage infrastructure to support the system. The new facility is expected to be commissioned in 2017 at a cost of US$3.4 billion (BHP Billiton share US$2.0 billion). Prior to completion of the EWS project, water supply for OGP1 will continue to be sourced from existing aquifers and the 500 litres per second desalination plant.

 

55


Table of Contents

The Oxide Leach Area Project (OLAP), involves the creation of a new dynamic leaching pad and mineral handling system that will include several overland conveyors. The new pad is expected to maintain oxide leaching capacity at current levels following the exhaustion of the existing heap leach in CY2014. OLAP was approved in February 2012 with budgeted expenditure of US$721 million (BHP Billiton share US$414 million). A US$212 million increase in the budget of OLAP to US$933 million (BHP Billiton share US$536 million) was approved in March 2014. Work on the project was 93 per cent complete at 30 June 2014, and is expected to be completed in the second half of CY2014.

More information on our development projects is presented in section 2.4 of this Annual Report.

Exploration activities

Our greenfield copper exploration activities during FY2014 were focused on advancing targets within Chile and Peru. Greenfield activities include opportunity identification, application for and acquisition of mineral title, early reconnaissance operations and drilling programs.

Performance

Total copper production in FY2014 increased by two per cent to 1.7 Mt. Escondida copper production increased by two per cent to 1.2 Mt as an improvement in mill throughput and concentrator utilisation offset a nine per cent decline in ore grades. Record mining rates at Olympic Dam underpinned an 11 per cent increase in copper production to 184 kt while Pampa Norte copper production of 233 kt was unchanged from the prior period. Antamina achieved record annual mill throughput and copper production in FY2014.

Copper Business revenue decreased by US$669 million to US$13.9 billion. Revenue for Escondida decreased by six per cent to US$8.1 billion. The decrease in revenue primarily resulted from a five per cent decline in the average realised price of copper to US$3.22 per pound.

Lower average realised prices reduced Underlying EBIT by US$947 million, net of price-linked costs. In contrast, a stronger US dollar against the Chilean peso and Australian dollar increased Underlying EBIT by US$359 million.

Underlying EBIT for FY2014 decreased by US$559 million to US$5.1 billion. Unit cash costs, which we calculate excluding revenue from by-products, at our operated copper assets declined by six per cent during FY2014 despite the impact of the nine per cent reduction in ore grades at Escondida. In this context, productivity cost efficiencies increased Underlying EBIT by US$190 million and reflected insourcing initiatives and the broader optimisation of contractor activities across the business. A reduction in exploration and business development expenditure increased Underlying EBIT by a further US$217 million as the Group sharpened its focus on greenfield copper porphyry targets in Chile and Peru. In contrast, an increase in non-cash charges reflected a lower capitalisation rate for deferred stripping at Escondida and Pampa Norte, and a general increase in depreciation and amortisation, and reduced Underlying EBIT by US$337 million during the period.

Underlying EBIT of Olympic Dam for FY2014 increased by US$38 million to US$34 million, where costs efficiencies offset the decrease in commodities prices.

At 30 June 2014, the Group had 350 kt of outstanding copper sales that were revalued at a weighted average price of US$3.19 per pound. The final price of these sales will be determined in FY2015. In addition, 386 kt of copper sales from FY2013 were subject to a finalisation adjustment in FY2014. These provisional pricing and finalisation adjustments increased Underlying EBIT by US$73 million in FY2014 (FY2013: US$303 million decrease).

A gain on the sale of the Pinto Valley mining operation and the associated San Manuel Arizona Railroad Company of US$385 million (after tax) was recognised in FY2014 and was reported as an exceptional item.

 

56


Table of Contents

Outlook

Total copper production is forecast to increase by five per cent in FY2015 to 1.8 Mt. With further improvements in productivity anticipated, Escondida is on track to produce approximately 1.27 Mt of copper in the period. Copper volumes at Pampa Norte and Olympic Dam are expected to remain at a similar level to FY2014, while lower average copper grades are expected to lead to a reduction in copper production at Antamina in FY2015, consistent with the mine plan.

The commissioning of OGP1, which remains on schedule to commence in the June 2015 quarter, will create 152 ktpd of valuable copper concentrator capacity. The Escondida OLAP and OGP1 are expected to maintain Escondida’s copper production.

1.12.4    Iron Ore Business

Our Iron Ore Business, headquartered in Perth, Australia, is one of the leading iron ore producers in the world. We sell lump and fines products produced in Australia and pellets from our operations in Brazil.

 

Year ended 30 June

   2014      2013      2012  
     US$M      US$M      US$M  

Revenue

     21,356         18,593         20,605   

Underlying EBIT

     12,102         11,109         14,044   

Capital expenditure

     2,949         5,979         4,458   

Net operating assets

     23,390         22,126         17,375   

Production – iron ore (Mt)

     204         170         159   

A summary of our Iron Ore Business’ assets, development projects and FY2014 performance is presented below.

Description of the Iron Ore Business

Our assets consist of the following:

Western Australia Iron Ore (Australia)

Operations at Western Australia Iron Ore (WAIO) involve an integrated system of mines and more than 1,000 kilometres of rail infrastructure and port facilities in the Pilbara region of northern Western Australia, with the headquarters located in Perth. Our focus is to safely maximise output through operating our mines and utilising available infrastructure at our disposal. This includes our plan to continue to grow production following the recent completion of a number of expansion projects and ongoing debottlenecking of the supply chain to underpin further potential growth in capacity to 290 million tonnes per annum (Mtpa).

We have expanded our WAIO operations in response to increasing demand for iron ore, particularly from China. Since 2001, we have completed eight expansion projects to increase our mine, rail and port capacity. Our share of FY2014 production was 193 Mt of ore, which is expected to increase in FY2015 to 211 Mtpa.

We have been transitioning to owner-operated mines since 2011. We completed this transition with the last contractor run site, Orebody 18, finalising its transition during FY2014.

Lump and fines products are sold to steel mills in China, South Korea, Japan, Singapore, Hong Kong, Taiwan, Switzerland and Australia, under long-term and short-term contracts. Contract prices are generally linked to market indices.

In order to establish a consistent, long-term, high-quality lump ore product having a stable grade, we recently transitioned to a blended lump product. The product is a blend of lump ores produced from the Newman, Area C and Jimblebar mining areas, known as Newman Blend lump. During FY2014, 23 per cent of sales were lump and 77 per cent were fines.

 

57


Table of Contents

Our WAIO operations consist of four main joint ventures: Mt Newman, Yandi, Mt Goldsworthy and Jimblebar. Our interest in the joint ventures is 85 per cent with Mitsui and ITOCHU owning the remaining 15 per cent. The joint ventures are unincorporated except Jimblebar, where we diluted our interest in a subsidiary company to 85 per cent in July 2013 for which BHP Billiton received total consideration of US$1.5 billion.

The Mt Newman Joint Venture consists of a number of orebodies joined by conveyors and spur lines to a mining hub at Mt Whaleback. Ore is crushed, beneficiated (where necessary) and blended to create the Newman Blend for lump and fines. The ore is then transported to port using our rail facilities. The Yandi JV comprises the Yandi mine where ore is crushed and screened and then transported by rail on the Newman main line. The Mt Goldsworthy JV consists of the Area C mine in the central Pilbara and the Yarrie mine in northern Pilbara. Ore is crushed and screened at Area C and transported by rail to the hub at Mt Whaleback. Production at Yarrie was suspended on 25 February 2014. The Jimblebar operation was officially opened on 23 April 2014 and comprises the new Jimblebar mine located 40 kilometres east of Newman. Jimblebar delivered first production in the September 2013 quarter and produced 9 Mt during FY2014.

Map of Western Australia Iron Ore

 

LOGO

Our rail operations are controlled from Perth via our integrated remote operations centre which co-locates rail control, port production control, mine dispatch control and mine fixed plant control.

Our port facilities are located on both sides of the harbour at Port Hedland. These facilities consist of Nelson Point and Finucane Island. The port facilities include five ore car dumpers, three screening plants, nine stackers, five reclaimers, stock and blending yards, and eight ship loaders.

The reserve life of our Western Australian mines is 16 years.

 

58


Table of Contents

Samarco (Brazil)

We are a 50–50 joint venture partner with Vale at the Samarco operation in Brazil. Samarco is currently comprised of a mine and two concentrators, located in the state of Minas Gerais, and three pellet plants and a port, located in Anchieta in the state of Espirito Santo. Three 396-kilometre pipelines connect the mine site to the pelletising facilities.

Samarco’s main product is iron ore pellets. Extraction and beneficiation of iron ore is conducted at the Germano facilities in the municipalities of Mariana and Ouro Preto. Ore beneficiation occurs in concentrators after which concentrate is pumped through slurry pipelines to the pellet plant in Ubu, Anchieta. Pellets are independently marketed by Samarco and sold to steelmakers in 20 countries in the Americas, Asia, Africa, the Middle East and Europe, with prices generally linked to market indices. In FY2014, our share of production was 11 Mt of pellets. The reserve life of Samarco is 39 years.

More information on our assets and operations is presented in section 2.1.3 of this Annual Report.

Completed development projects

Western Australia Iron Ore

WAIO has been executing a number of expansion projects in recent years. These projects, approved in March 2011 for a total of US$7.4 billion (BHP Billiton share US$6.6 billion) plus pre-commitment funding of US$2.3 billion (BHP Billiton share US$2.1 billion) were designed to deliver an integrated operation with a minimum capacity of 220 Mtpa (100 per cent basis).

These projects included:

 

  Jimblebar Mine Expansion project to develop the Jimblebar mine and rail links, and procure mining equipment and rolling stock to deliver a capacity of 35 Mtpa. The project costs as at 30 June 2014 amounted to US$3.4 billion (BHP Billiton share); final costs are expected to be delivered below the revised budget of US$3.6 billion;

 

  further development of Port Hedland, including two additional berths and ship loaders, a car dumper, connecting conveyor routes, and associated rail works and rolling stock. The project costs as at 30 June 2014 amounted to US$1.7 billion (BHP Billiton share); final costs are expected to be delivered below the revised budget of US$1.9 billion;

 

  port blending facilities and rail yards to enable ore blending, expand resource life and prepare for the anticipated growth of the business beyond the inner harbour. The project costs as at 30 June 2014 amounted to US$0.9 billion (BHP Billiton share); final costs are expected to be delivered below the revised budget of US$1.0 billion.

Western Australia Iron Ore – Orebody 24 mine

In FY2014, WAIO completed execution of its development of the Orebody 24 mine, located approximately 10 kilometres northeast of Newman. Orebody 24 is a sustaining mine to maintain iron ore production output from the Mt Newman JV operations. The project was approved in November 2011 and included the construction of an ore crushing plant, train loadout facility, rail spur and other associated support facilities. The project was delivered at a cost of US$0.5 billion (BHP Billiton share), subject to finalisation, in the September 2014 quarter versus a budget of US$0.7 billion.

Samarco

During FY2011, Samarco shareholders approved a US$3.5 billion (BHP Billiton share US$1.75 billion) expansion project, consisting of a fourth pellet plant, a new concentrator and a third slurry pipeline. The project

 

59


Table of Contents

is complete, with its first pellet production in March 2014. This has expanded Samarco’s iron ore pellet production capacity from 22.3 Mtpa to 30.5 Mtpa. The final cost of the project was US$3.2 billion (BHP Billiton share US$1.6 billion).

More information on our development projects is presented in section 2.4 of this Annual Report.

Exploration activities

Western Australia

WAIO has a substantial existing reserve base supported by considerable additional mineralisation all within a 250-kilometre radius of our existing infrastructure. This concentration of orebodies also gives WAIO the flexibility to add growth tonnes to existing hub infrastructure and link brownfield developments to our existing mainline rail and port facilities. The total area covered by exploration and mining tenure amounts to 6,500 square kilometres.

Total exploration expenditure in FY2014 amounted to US$166 million.

Guinea Iron Ore

On 29 July 2014 we signed an agreement with ArcelorMittal for the sale of our 41.3 per cent interest in a joint venture that holds the Nimba Mining Concession and four iron ore prospecting permits in southeast Guinea. Completion of the transaction is subject to the receipt of regulatory approval and other customary closing conditions.

Liberia Iron Ore

We have a 100 per cent interest in a Mineral Development Agreement with the Government of Liberia. This enables the further exploration and development of our Liberian iron ore mineral leases.

Performance

Iron Ore revenue increased by US$2.8 billion to US$21.4 billion. Revenue for WAIO increased by US$2.6 billion, an increase of 13.9 per cent. An 18 per cent increase in WAIO sales volumes was the major contributor, which was partially offset by a six per cent decline in average realised price of iron ore to US$103 per wet metric tonne (FOB).

Iron ore production increased by 20 per cent in FY2014 to a record 204 Mt, exceeding initial full-year guidance by more than eight per cent. WAIO production of 225 Mt (100 per cent basis) represents a fourteenth consecutive annual record and was underpinned by the early commissioning of Jimblebar and our productivity agenda, which raised the capacity of our integrated supply chain.

Underlying EBIT for FY2014 increased by US$993 million to US$12.1 billion. The fall in the average realised price of iron ore reduced Underlying EBIT by US$864 million, net of price-linked costs, although this was partially offset by a weaker Australian dollar which increased Underlying EBIT by US$383 million. Iron ore sales, on average, were linked to the index price for the month of shipment, with price differentials reflecting product quality and the increase in WAIO sales volumes, adding US$1.8 billion to Underlying EBIT. Conversely, the progressive ramp-up of several major projects resulted in a US$425 million increase in depreciation and amortisation expense during the period. Having redirected the WAIO supply-chain bottleneck away from the mines and back to the port, WAIO unit costs decreased by six per cent in FY2014 to US$27.53 per tonne. A 12 per cent reduction in unit costs to US$25.89 per tonne was achieved in the June 2014 half year.

 

60


Table of Contents

WAIO unit costs

   FY2014      FY2013      H1 FY2014      H2 FY2014  
     US$M      US$M      US$M      US$M  

Revenue

     21,013         18,452         10,849         10,164   

Underlying EBITDA

     12,988         11,668         6,801         6,187   

Cash costs (gross)

     8,025         6,784         4,048         3,977   

Less: freight

     1,274         856         625         649   

Less: royalties

     1,497         1,192         744         753   

Cash costs (net)

     5,254         4,736         2,679         2,575   

Sales (kt, BHP Billiton share)

     190,843         160,955         91,327         99,516   

Cash cost per tonne (US$)

     27.53         29.42         29.33         25.89   

Outlook

In FY2015, WAIO production is expected to increase by a further 20 Mt to approximately 245 Mt (100 per cent basis). We expect additional productivity gains to support another year of record performance despite the planned tie-in of ship loaders 1 and 2 during the December 2014 half year. Total iron ore production is forecast to increase by 11 per cent in FY2015 to 225 Mt (BHP Billiton share).

Our strategy includes expanding Jimblebar to 55 Mtpa (100 per cent basis) as well as a broader debottlenecking of the supply chain, which is expected to underpin further growth in WAIO supply-chain capacity to 290 Mtpa (100 per cent basis).

1.12.5    Coal Business

Our Coal Business, headquartered in Brisbane, Australia, is the world’s largest supplier of seaborne metallurgical coal, one of the world’s largest suppliers of seaborne energy coal and a significant domestic energy coal supplier in the countries where our mines are located.

 

Year ended 30 June

   2014      2013      2012  
     US$M      US$M      US$M  

Revenue

     9,115         9,895         12,512   

Underlying EBIT

     386         595         2,612   

Capital expenditure

     2,345         3,626         3,103   

Net operating assets

     14,300         13,225         10,663   

Production – metallurgical coal (Mt)

     45         38         33   

Production – energy coal (Mt)

     73         72         74   

A summary of our Coal Business’ assets, development projects and FY2014 performance is presented below.

Description of the Coal Business

Our assets comprise the following:

Queensland Coal (Australia)

Queensland Coal comprises the BHP Billiton Mitsubishi Alliance (BMA) and BHP Billiton Mitsui Coal (BMC) Assets in the Bowen Basin in Central Queensland, Australia.

The Bowen Basin is well positioned to supply the seaborne market because of its high-quality metallurgical coals, which are ideally suited to efficient blast furnace operations, and its geographical proximity to Asian customers. We have access to key infrastructure in the Bowen Basin, including a modern, multi-user rail

 

61


Table of Contents

network, and our own coal loading terminal at Hay Point, located near the city of Mackay. We also have contracted capacity at three other multi-user port facilities including the Port of Gladstone (RG Tanna Coal Terminal), Dalrymple Bay Coal Terminal and Abbot Point Coal Terminal.

Map of Queensland Coal

 

LOGO

BHP Billiton Mitsubishi Alliance – BMA owns and operates open-cut and underground metallurgical coal mines in the Bowen Basin, and also owns and operates the Hay Point Coal Terminal. We share 50–50 ownership with Mitsubishi Development. BMA operates the Goonyella Riverside, Broadmeadow, Daunia, Caval Ridge, Peak Downs, Saraji, Gregory Crinum and Blackwater mines. First production commenced at Caval Ridge in the June 2014 quarter. Our share of total production in FY2014 was 29.3 Mt. The reserve lives of our mines range from 2.8 years at Gregory Crinum to 37 years at Saraji.

BHP Billiton Mitsui Coal – BMC is a subsidiary company owned by BHP Billiton (80 per cent) and Mitsui and Co (20 per cent). BMC owns and operates South Walker Creek and Poitrel open-cut metallurgical coal mines. Total production in FY2014 was 8.3 Mt. The reserve lives of our mines are 15 years at Poitrel and 11 years at South Walker Creek.

Illawarra Coal (Australia)

Our wholly owned Illawarra Coal Asset owns and operates three underground coal mines – Appin, West Cliff and Dendrobium, in the Illawarra region of New South Wales, Australia. The mines supply metallurgical coal to the nearby BlueScope Port Kembla steelworks and to other domestic and export markets. The Appin mine is currently being developed to sustain Illawarra Coal’s production following the end of the mine life at West Cliff.

Coal is exported via the Port Kembla Coal Terminal, in which we own a 16.67 per cent interest. Total production in FY2014 was 7.5 Mt. The reserve lives of our mines range from 2.0 years at West Cliff to 25 years at Appin.

 

62


Table of Contents

Energy Coal South Africa (South Africa)

Energy Coal South Africa (known as BECSA) operates four energy coal mines – Khutala, Klipspruit, Middelburg and Wolvekrans, in the Witbank region in the province of Mpumalanga, South Africa.

BECSA is 90 per cent owned by BHP Billiton, two per cent owned by its employees through an Employee Share Ownership Plan and eight per cent owned by a Broad-Based Black Economic Empowerment (B-BBEE) consortium led by Pembani Group Proprietary Limited.

Production in FY2014 was 30.4 Mt. The reserve lives of our mines range from 5.8 years at Khutala to 23 years at Middelburg.

New Mexico Coal (United States)

We own and operate the San Juan energy coal mine located in the US state of New Mexico. The mine transports its production directly to the nearby San Juan Generating Station. The San Juan mine has a reserve life of 3.5 years, which is the life of the current customer contract. Production for FY2014 was 5.7 Mt.

We also operate the nearby Navajo mine, located on Navajo Nation land in New Mexico. Full ownership of the Navajo Coal Company transferred to the Navajo Transitional Energy Company (NTEC), an entity of the Navajo Nation, effective 30 December 2013. New Mexico Coal and NTEC have entered into a Mine Management Agreement where New Mexico Coal will continue as mine operator until 31 December 2016.

New South Wales Energy Coal (Australia)

Our wholly owned New South Wales Energy Coal Asset owns and operates the Mt Arthur Coal open-cut energy coal mine in the Hunter Valley region of New South Wales, Australia.

New South Wales Energy Coal produced 20 Mt in FY2014 and has a reserve life of 33 years.

Cerrejón (Colombia)

We have a one-third interest in Cerrejón Coal Company, which owns and operates one of the world’s largest open-cut export energy coal mines, located in the La Guajira province of Colombia.

In FY2014, our share of Cerrejón production was approximately 12.3 Mt. Cerrejón has a reserve life of 17 years.

More information on our assets and operations is presented in section 2.1.4 of this Annual Report.

Completed development projects

BMA Expansions

In November 2011, we approved the development of the Caval Ridge mine project, with a revised investment of US$1.9 billion (BHP Billiton share). The Caval Ridge mine is an open-cut dragline and truck and shovel operation, with coal railed to the Hay Point Coal Terminal. First coal at the Caval Ridge mine occurred in the June 2014 quarter and the mine was 100 per cent completed at 30 June 2014.

Cerrejón P40 Project

In August 2011, we announced a US$437 million (BHP Billiton share) investment in the expansion of Cerrejón, known as the P40 Project, which is expected to enable Cerrejón’s thermal coal production to increase by 8 Mtpa to approximately 40 Mtpa. The project scope includes a second berth and dual quadrant ship loader at Cerrejón’s 100 per cent owned and operated Puerto Bolivar, along with necessary mine, rail and associated supply chain

 

63


Table of Contents

infrastructure. Construction commenced in CY2011 and the project handled its first coal in the December 2013 quarter. The port expansion associated with the Cerrejón P40 project is currently being commissioned, although operational issues are expected to constrain capacity to approximately 35 Mtpa (100 per cent basis) in the medium term. At 30 June 2014, the project was 94 per cent complete.

Newcastle Port Third Phase Expansion

In August 2011, we announced a US$367 million (BHP Billiton share) investment in the third stage development of the Newcastle Coal Infrastructure Group’s coal handling facility in Newcastle. The port expansion project is expected to increase total capacity at the coal terminal from 53 Mtpa to 66 Mtpa. This is expected to increase New South Wales Energy Coal’s allocation by 4.6 Mtpa to 19.2 Mtpa. First coal on ship, being the first ship loading through the new facility, was achieved in June 2013, ahead of schedule. At 30 June 2014, the project was 86 per cent complete.

Development projects in execution

BMA Expansions

In March 2011, we approved the expansion of the Hay Point Coal Terminal. The expansion of the terminal will deliver an additional 11 Mt of annual port capacity (100 per cent basis). Following a review of the project during FY2013, first shipment is expected in CY2015 with a revised budget of US$1.5 billion (BHP Billiton share). The project was 87 per cent complete at 30 June 2014.

Appin Area 9 Project

In June 2012, approval was given to invest US$845 million to sustain operations at Illawarra Coal by establishing a replacement mining area at Appin mine. The replacement area will have a production capacity of 3.5 Mtpa and will sustain Illawarra Coal’s production capacity at 9 Mtpa. The Appin Area 9 project was 67 per cent complete at 30 June 2014 and is expected to be operational in CY2016, whereupon it will replace production at the West Cliff mine. The project includes roadway development, new ventilation infrastructure, new and reconfigured conveyors and other mine services.

More information on our development projects is presented in section 2.4 of this Annual Report.

Performance

Metallurgical coal production increased by 20 per cent in FY2014 to a record 45 Mt (BHP Billiton share). Record production and sales volumes at Queensland Coal reflected strong performance across all operations. This included first production from Caval Ridge, the successful ramp-up of Daunia and record production at Peak Downs, Saraji, South Walker Creek and Poitrel. Illawarra Coal production declined by five per cent as an extended outage at the Dendrobium mine impacted performance in the first half of FY2014.

Energy coal production of 73 Mt for FY2014 was broadly unchanged from the prior period. Another year of robust performance was underpinned by a fifth consecutive annual production record at New South Wales Energy Coal and record volumes at Cerrejón. Extended outages at both a local utility and the Richards Bay Coal Terminal led to lower production at Energy Coal South Africa, while Navajo Coal production declined following the permanent closure of three of the five power units at the Four Corners Power Plant.

Coal revenue for FY2014 decreased by US$780 million to US$9.1 billion. Revenue for Illawarra decreased by 31 per cent to US$886 million and revenues for New South Wales Energy Coal and Energy Coal South Africa also decreased; this was partially offset by an increase in revenues for Queensland Coal of five per cent to US$4.7 billion. The decrease in revenues was driven by a 20 per cent reduction in the average price for hard coking coal and 14 per cent reduction in the average price received for both weak coking coal and thermal coal.

 

64


Table of Contents

Underlying EBIT for FY2014 declined by US$209 million to US$386 million despite productivity volume and cost efficiencies of US$1.3 billion being embedded during the period.

A stronger US dollar against both the Australian dollar and South African rand increased Underlying EBIT by US$543 million. This was more than offset by the reduction in the average price, which in total, reduced Underlying EBIT by US$1.4 billion, net of price-linked costs.

A sustainable increase in truck and wash plant utilisation rates underpinned the improvement in productivity while a reduction in labour, contractor and maintenance costs was also achieved. In this context, redundancies totalling US$40 million were recognised in FY2014 while an increase in non-cash charges reduced Underlying EBIT by a further US$497 million. The latter included a US$292 million impairment charge at Energy Coal South Africa. A US$84 million gain on the sale of the Energy Coal South Africa Optimum Coal purchase agreement was also recognised during the period.

Outlook

Metallurgical coal production for FY2015 is expected to increase by four per cent to approximately 47 Mt as the ramp-up of Caval Ridge is completed. Energy coal production for FY2015 is expected to remain broadly unchanged at 73 Mt.

As we will retain control of the Navajo mine until full consideration is received from NTEC, production and financial results for the Navajo mine will continue to be reported by the Group.

1.12.6    Aluminium, Manganese and Nickel Business

Our Aluminium, Manganese and Nickel Business, headquartered in Perth, Australia, is one of the world’s largest integrated producers of aluminium, nickel and manganese ore and alloy.

 

Year ended 30 June

   2014      2013      2012  
     US$M      US$M      US$M  

Revenue

     8,411         9,278         9,911   

Underlying EBIT

     307         158         (24

Capital expenditure

     498         893         1,941   

Net operating assets

     9,322         8,809         13,127   

Production – alumina (kt)

     5,178         4,880         4,152   

Production – aluminium (kt)

     1,174         1,179         1,153   

Production – manganese ores (kt)

     8,302         8,517         7,931   

Production – manganese alloys (kt)

     646         608         602   

Production – nickel (kt)

     143         154         158   

A summary of our Aluminium, Manganese and Nickel Business’ assets, development projects and FY2014 performance is presented below.

Description of the Aluminium, Manganese and Nickel Business

Our assets include the following:

Boddington/Worsley (Australia)

Boddington/Worsley is an integrated bauxite mining/alumina refining operation located in Western Australia. The Boddington bauxite mine supplies bauxite ore to the Worsley alumina refinery via a 51-kilometre long

 

65


Table of Contents

conveying system. We own 86 per cent of the mine and the refinery. Our share of Worsley’s FY2014 production was 3.9 Mt of alumina. Boddington has a reserve life of 17 years.

Hillside and Bayside (South Africa)

Our wholly owned Hillside and Bayside aluminium smelters are located at Richards Bay in South Africa. Hillside is the largest aluminium smelter in the southern hemisphere. In June 2014, Bayside completed the ramp-down of its remaining smelting capacity of 97 ktpa. The Bayside Casthouse continues to operate and began processing liquid metal transfers from Hillside in June 2014. Production in FY2014 for Hillside was 715 kt and Bayside was 89 kt.

Mozal (Mozambique)

We own 47.1 per cent of and operate the Mozal aluminium smelter located near Maputo, Mozambique. Mozal sources power generated by Hydro Cahora Basa via Motraco, a transmission joint venture between Eskom and the national electricity utilities of Mozambique and Swaziland. Our share of Mozal’s FY2014 production was 266 kt.

Alumar (Brazil)

Alumar is an integrated alumina refinery/aluminium smelter. We own 36 per cent of the Alumar refinery and 40 per cent of the smelter. Alcoa operates both facilities. The operations, and their integrated port facility, are located at São Luís in the Maranhão province of Brazil.

The Alumar smelter has currently suspended production from pot lines 2 and 3 reducing overall annual capacity to 124 kilotonnes per annum (ktpa), from 447 ktpa (100 per cent), due to challenging global market conditions in primary aluminium and increased costs. Our share of Alumar’s FY2014 saleable production was 1.3 Mt of alumina and 104 kt of aluminium.

HMM (South Africa)

We own a 44.4 per cent interest in Hotazel Manganese Mines (HMM), which owns the Mamatwan open-cut mine and the Wessels underground mine. In FY2014, the total manganese ore production was 3,526 kt. Wessels has a reserve life of 46 years and Mamatwan has a reserve life of 18 years.

GEMCO (Australia)

Our 60 per cent owned and operated GEMCO operation is an open-cut mining operation, located 16 kilometres from our port facilities at Milner Bay, Northern Territory. These operations, consisting of crushing, screening, washing and dense media separation, combined with its high-grade ore are in relative close proximity to the Asian export markets. FY2014 production of manganese ore was 4,776 kt. GEMCO has a reserve life of 11 years.

Metalloys (South Africa)

Our 60 per cent owned and operated Samancor Manganese Metalloys alloy plant, located in Meyerton, is one of the largest manganese alloy producers in the world. Metalloys produces high- and medium-carbon ferromanganese. Production of manganese alloy in FY2014 was 377 kt.

TEMCO (Australia)

Our 60 per cent owned and operated TEMCO operation, located in Tasmania, is a medium-sized producer of high-carbon ferromanganese, silicomanganese and sinter using ore shipped from GEMCO, primarily using hydroelectric power. Production of manganese alloy in FY2014 was 269 kt.

 

66


Table of Contents

Nickel West (Australia)

Our wholly owned Nickel West Asset in Western Australia consists of an integrated system of mines, concentrators, a smelter and a refinery. Nickel West production in FY2014 was 98.9 kt of contained nickel. On 31 October 2013, production at the Nickel West Leinster Perseverance underground mine was suspended following a significant seismic event. A subsequent review of the incident determined it was unsafe to resume operations.

Cerro Matoso (Colombia)

Our 99.98 per cent owned Cerro Matoso Asset in Colombia combines a lateritic nickel ore deposit with a ferronickel smelter. The smelter produces high-purity, low-carbon ferronickel granules. Cerro Matoso has an estimated reserve life of 15 years. Production in FY2014 was 44.3 kt of nickel in ferronickel form.

More information on our assets and operations is presented in section 2.1.5 of this Annual Report.

Development projects

GEMCO expansion

The US$279 million GEMCO Expansion Project (GEEP2) (BHP Billiton share US$167 million), approved in July 2011, was delivered on time and on budget in the December 2013 quarter. GEEP2 increased GEMCO’s capacity from 4.2 Mtpa to 4.8 Mtpa through the introduction of a dense media circuit by-pass facility. The expansion has also addressed key infrastructure constraints by increasing road and port capacity to 5.9 Mtpa, creating 1.1 Mtpa of additional capacity for future expansions.

More information on our development projects is presented in section 2.4 of this Annual Report.

Performance

Aluminium, Manganese and Nickel revenues decreased by US$867 million to US$8.4 billion. Revenue for Cerro Matoso decreased by 25.9 per cent to US$595 million, driven by a decline in nickel prices by seven per cent and lower production. Production at Cerro Matoso was affected by kiln and furnace outages, and lower nickel grades. Aluminium revenues decreased by 8.5 per cent to US$2.4 billion primarily due to lower average realised prices which declined by six per cent.

Alumina production increased by six per cent in FY2014 to a record 5.2 Mt. The Efficiency and Growth project at Worsley reached nameplate capacity during the year and annual production records were achieved at both the Worsley and Alumar refineries. Aluminium production of 1.2 Mt was unchanged from FY2013 with production records at both Hillside and Mozal offset by lower volumes at Alumar following the phased suspension of 103 kt (BHP Billiton share) of annualised capacity.

Manganese ore production declined by three per cent in FY2014 to 8.3 Mt as GEMCO was affected by higher than usual rainfall during the wet season. Manganese alloy production increased by six per cent in FY2014 compared to FY2013, which was affected by the temporary suspension of operations at TEMCO.

Nickel production declined by seven per cent in FY2014 to 143 kt. Production at Cerro Matoso was affected by kiln and furnace outages, and lower nickel grades. Nickel West production declined by four per cent following the closure of the Perseverance underground mine in November 2013.

Notwithstanding a rebound in nickel and aluminium prices in the second half, lower average realised prices reduced Underlying EBIT by US$409 million during FY2014, net of price-linked costs. More specifically, lower average realised prices for aluminium (down six per cent to US$2,022 per tonne), manganese ore (down four per

 

67


Table of Contents

cent to US$4.64 per dry metric tonne unit), manganese alloy (down six per cent to US$980 per tonne) and nickel (down seven per cent to US$14,925 per tonne) were only partially offset by an increase in the average realised price of alumina (up two per cent to US$307 per tonne).

Underlying EBIT for FY2014 increased by US$149 million to US$307 million. A reduction in headcount and consumable costs, as well as equipment debottlenecking at most assets, contributed to the US$335 million of productivity cost efficiencies embedded during the period. A stronger US dollar against both the Australian dollar and South African rand increased Underlying EBIT by a further US$469 million. In contrast, the cessation of aluminium smelting activities at Bayside (US$167 million) and costs associated with the closure of the Perseverance underground mine at Nickel West (US$174 million) contributed to a decrease in Underlying EBIT of US$341 million.

In May 2014, the Group announced a review of the Nickel West business, comprising the Mt Keith, Cliffs and Leinster mines, its concentrators, the Kalgoorlie smelter and the Kwinana refinery. The review is considering all options for the long-term future of Nickel West, including the potential sale of all or part of the business.

Outlook

Saleable nickel production at Nickel West is expected to decline by four per cent in FY2015 to 95 kt with approximately 55 per cent to be sourced from third party feed. Ferro-nickel production at Cerro Matoso is expected to decline by three per cent to 43 kt as a result of lower grades.

In contemplation of the proposed demerger, BHP Billiton and Anglo American have agreed to make certain changes to the agreement which governs their interests in the Manganese business. BHP Billiton manages and owns 60 per cent of the Manganese business with Anglo American owning the remaining 40 per cent.

Subject to obtaining the required approvals for the agreement, the changes will result in BHP Billiton and Anglo American agreeing to share joint control of the Manganese business. As a result, we will discontinue consolidation of the Manganese business and account for our 60 per cent interest as an equity accounted joint venture. We will therefore derecognise the existing carrying amounts of all assets, liabilities and the non-controlling interest in the Manganese business attributed to Anglo American and initially record our retained 60 per cent interest at fair value. The remeasurement at fair value will give rise to an estimated gain of approximately US$2 billion in the first half of FY2015.

1.13    Our people

People are the foundation of our organisation and underpin our success. We value our people and encourage the development of talented and motivated employees to support the continued performance and growth of our diverse operations. We strive to build a sense of purpose and achievement among all our people in the work we do.

1.13.1    Employees and contractors

By working to Our Charter we align our people around our common purpose and values. Our Charter provides a vital reference point for how we do business, wherever we are in the world, and whatever work we do.

The table below provides the average number of employees and contractors over the last three financial years.

 

Year ended 30 June

   2014      2013      2012  

Employees

     47,044         46,892         43,238   

Contractors

     76,759         79,330         78,813   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     123,803         126,222         122,051   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

68


Table of Contents

The table below shows the gender composition of our workforce, senior leaders and Board over the last three financial years.

 

Year ended 30 June

   2014      2013      2012  

Male employees

     39,517         38,920         35,888   

Female employees

     7,527         7,972         7,350   

Female employees (per cent)

     16         17         17   

Male senior leaders (a)

     317         326         365   

Female senior leaders (a)

     55         40         41   

Female senior leaders (per cent)

     15         11         10   

Male Board members

     12         11         11   

Female Board members

     2         2         2   

Female Board members (per cent)

     14         15         15   

 

(a)  For UK law purposes, we are required to show information for ‘senior managers’ which is defined to include both senior leaders and any persons who are directors of any subsidiary company even if they are not senior leaders. In FY2014, senior leaders comprise the top 372 people in the organisation. There are 33 directors of subsidiary companies who are not senior leaders, comprising 23 males and 10 females. Therefore, for UK law purposes, the total number of senior managers is 340 males and 65 females (16 per cent female).

The tables below provide a breakdown of the weighted average number of employees across the Group, in accordance with our reporting requirements under the UK Companies Act 2006. The calculation includes the Executive Director, 100 per cent of employees of subsidiary companies, and our share of joint operations, for each of the past three financial years. Employees of equity accounted entities are not included. Part-time employees are included on a full-time equivalent basis. Employees of businesses acquired or disposed of during a particular year are included for the period of ownership. Contractors are not included.

On 1 July 2013 the Group adopted IFRS 10 and IFRS 11. This led to the full consolidation of Escondida employees (previously proportionately consolidated) and the exclusion of certain equity accounted entities including Samarco, Antamina and Cerrejón. The comparative periods have been restated on this basis.

The table below provides a breakdown of our average number of employees by Business for each of the last three financial years.

 

Year ended 30 June

   2014      2013      2012  

Petroleum and Potash

     4,207         4,449         4,067   

Copper

     10,070         10,435         9,445   

Iron Ore

     8,035         6,883         4,711   

Coal

     12,318         12,240         11,679   

Aluminium, Manganese and Nickel

     10,775         11,115         11,388   

Group Functions, Marketing and unallocated

     1,639         1,770         1,948   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     47,044         46,892         43,238   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

69


Table of Contents

The table below provides a breakdown of our average number of employees by geographic region for each of the last three financial years.

 

Year ended 30 June

   2014      2013      2012  

Africa

     9,035         9,121         9,358   

Asia

     1,105         1,183         1,114   

Australasia

     23,048         21,977         19,305   

Europe

     146         231         532   

North America

     4,373         5,116         4,117   

South America

     9,337         9,264         8,812   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     47,044         46,892         43,238   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

The increase in Australasian headcount during FY2014 is primarily due to the increase in the Iron Ore Business as a result of the expansion of the Jimblebar operations and additional support required in non-process infrastructure and port and rail operations. The Coal Business also experienced an increase as a result of the addition of the Daunia and Caval Ridge workforce. The decreased headcount in Europe occurred with the closure of offices in The Hague and Antwerp, and in North America with the sale of the diamonds business and sale of the Pinto Valley mining operation. For further information regarding these sales, refer to sections 1.15.3 and 2.1.2 of this Annual Report.

1.13.2    Employee policies and engagement

We are committed to open, honest and productive relationships with our employees. At BHP Billiton, we recognise the most important ingredient for success is our talented and motivated workforce, whose members demonstrate behaviours that are aligned to Our BHP Billiton Charter values.

We have an integrated people strategy to effectively attract, retain and develop talented people. Our approach is outlined in Our Charter, the BHP Billiton Code of Business Conduct and the Group Level Documents (GLDs) that prescribe what we will do and how we will do it. All of these documents are published and accessible to employees.

Effective communication and employee engagement is critical for maintaining open and productive relationships between leaders and employees. Employees receive communication on BHP Billiton goals and performance, as well as on other important issues such as health and safety and the environment and the Code of Business Conduct. Our Code of Business Conduct is founded on Our Charter values, which make an unqualified commitment to working with integrity. Communication is undertaken through a variety of channels, including the internet, intranet, email, newsletters and other means designed to cater for the local environment. Our employees can access our Annual Reports either via the internet or hard copy. Communications tools are also used to facilitate employee feedback, as are a variety of consultative processes. Dispute and grievance handling processes are also in place to assist in equitably addressing workplace issues across the organisation. A business conduct advisory service, EthicsPoint, operates worldwide to allow concerns to be raised about conduct that is out of step with Our Charter values, our policies and procedures or legislation.

Our all-employee share purchase plan, Shareplus, is available to all permanent full-time and part-time employees, and those on fixed-term contracts, except where local regulations limit operation of the scheme. In these instances, alternative arrangements are in place. As at 30 June 2014, 27,401 employees, or approximately 53.1 per cent of those eligible for the April 2014 offer, were participants in Shareplus. The Shareplus employee plan is described in section 4.4.26 of this Annual Report. Short-term and long-term incentive schemes also operate across the Group. Rewards for eligible individuals are predicated on the need to meet targets relating to the Group’s performance in areas such as health, safety and achievement of financial measures and on the personal performance of each employee.

 

70


Table of Contents

Our performance management process aligns individual performance and behaviour to Our Charter and our strategic and operational priorities as well as working to ensure individual and team performance is recognised. Our leaders are accountable for providing feedback and coaching and identifying development needs to help our employees maximise their performance and realise their full potential. In FY2014, 74 per cent of employees participated in a formal performance review process. Due to industrial agreements, not all employees are able to participate in individual performance or reward programs. The importance we place on employee development and training is demonstrated by the significant amount of training our employees undertake.

BHP Billiton is committed to building and maintaining a diverse workforce and providing a work environment in which every employee is treated fairly and with respect. We work actively to avoid discrimination on any basis, including disability. Where an employee suffers some disability while they are employed, we work to identify roles that meet their skill, experience and capability, and in some cases offer retraining. We also offer flexible work practices, where this is possible, taking into account the needs of the employee and those of the particular workplace. The employment packages under our remuneration policy, which must comply with local regulations, are aligned to our business requirements and are designed to be sufficiently attractive to recruit and retain the best people.

1.13.3    Diversity and inclusion at BHP Billiton

Our Charter and GLDs guide all aspects of our management, including diversity and inclusion.

Our GLDs are underpinned by principles that guide our approach to diversity and inclusion. Our GMC and the Board believe that a diverse workforce and inclusive work environment where the unique skills, experiences and perspectives of our people are embraced is pivotal to sustaining performance and increasing productivity. The Board approves the Group’s diversity and inclusion measurable objectives for each financial year and monitors its progress. In relation to gender, they have set a goal of increasing the number of women on the Board. Further details are set out below.

Principles that underpin our approach to diversity and inclusion:

 

  a diverse workforce and an inclusive environment are necessary to the delivery of our strategy that is predicated on diversification by commodity, geography and market;

 

  we aspire to have a workforce that best represents the communities in which our assets are located and our employees live;

 

  actions that support our diversity and inclusion objectives should be consistent with our established approach to talent, performance and reward;

 

  achieving an appropriate level of diversity will require structured programs to support employees from an early career stage in developing the necessary skills and experiences for leadership roles;

 

  creating an inclusive work environment will require every employee and leader to embrace diversity and act in a way that is consistent with Our Charter;

 

  measurable objectives in support of diversity and inclusion will be transparent, fit for purpose and focus on (i) engaging, enabling and developing our workforce and (ii) establishing appropriate representation goals.

Progress against measurable objectives

Progress against our FY2014 commitments is set out below.

 

1. Each Business, Group Function and Marketing will be evaluated on progress in executing the measurable objectives that form part of its multi-year diversity plan.

 

  The performance of each Business, Group Function and Marketing was evaluated as part of the Group’s internal compliance requirements. Results were taken into account in determining variable remuneration.

 

71


Table of Contents
2. Execute the diversity and inclusion strategy and actions approved by the GMC.

 

  Our CEO and management teams reinforced our commitment to diversity and inclusion through internal and external communication channels including town hall meetings, surveys and participation in industry events.

 

  Senior leaders mentored and held talent development conversations with high potential females, females in our graduate program and ethnically diverse talent. Specific actions were captured as part of their development plans.

 

  Employees’ perceived level of inclusion in their teams was measured as part of the employee survey. Results, together with tools to assist action planning were cascaded to business leaders and line managers.

 

  Actions to increase representation of Indigenous people in our workforce included targeted resourcing strategies, training programs and integration initiatives to broaden employment opportunities.

 

  Female representation increased (i) seven percentage points in senior leadership roles to 15 per cent and (ii) one percentage point in our overall workforce representation to 16 per cent from our baseline in 2010. We remain committed to increasing overall female representation, with a specific focus on operational areas.

 

3. Increase female representation by one in each asset and operations leadership team by end of FY2015 (where the business leadership team comprises less than 50 per cent females).

 

  Female representation increased nine percentage points in operational leadership teams from last year.

 

4. Develop recommendations for providing childcare options and flexible work arrangements.

 

  Flexible work recommendations are being piloted in different locations. Childcare options remain a focus for FY2015.

 

5. Increase the proportion of female and Indigenous graduates hired and retained year on year.

 

  Representation of females in our graduate intake increased three percentage points at a global level and six percentage points in Australia from last year. Indigenous Australian representation increased three percentage points. Retention of female graduates that have commenced since 2011 remains stable at 93 per cent.

 

6. Maintain at least a 30 per cent female participation in our Accelerated Leadership Development Program (ALDP).

 

  Female representation in our ALDP cohort remains at 41 per cent.

Continuous improvement

In FY2015, we will continue focusing on creating work environments of greater inclusion and enhancing our gender and diversity profile. We will take the following steps to deliver against this commitment:

 

1. Demonstrate progress against our diversity and inclusion plan to improve our gender and ethnicity profile and increase female representation year on year;

 

2. Demonstrate improvement in creating a work environment of inclusion, as measured by our employee survey.

Each Business, Group Function and Marketing will continue to be evaluated on progress against their multi-year diversity and inclusion plan. Successful completion will be taken into account in determining bonus remuneration and tracked as part of the Group’s internal compliance requirements.

1.14    Sustainability

Our Charter value of Sustainability is core to our strategy and we integrate health, safety, environmental, social and economic factors into our decision-making. Maintaining our licence to operate as a global company is

 

72


Table of Contents

dependent upon gaining access to natural resources and ensuring we earn the trust of our shareholders, employees, contractors, communities, customers and suppliers.

Our approach to sustainability reflects our priority to put health and safety first, be environmentally responsible and provide support to our host communities. In reporting our sustainability performance, we include our impact on the environment and approach to climate change, water stewardship, resource conservation and biodiversity; and our efforts to ensure the broader economic contributions of our operations benefit the regions in which we operate.

The information contained in this section, unless otherwise stated, covers assets that have been wholly owned and operated by BHP Billiton or that have been operated by BHP Billiton in a joint venture operation (operated assets) for FY2014.

1.14.1    Identifying our sustainability issues

To deliver successfully on our strategy we must identify and respond to the sustainability issues that have a direct or indirect impact on our business, to our stakeholders and society at large. Using a materiality assessment process, we identified and prioritised material sustainability issues included in this Annual Report and the Sustainability Report 2014. The following issues are discussed in this Annual Report:

 

Governance

  

Health and safety

  

Environment

  

Society

•     Governance and sustainability

 

•     Identifying and managing our material risks

 

•     Operating with integrity and conducting business transparently

 

•     Addressing climate change

  

•     Keeping our people and operations safe

 

•     Focusing on the health of our people

  

•     Energy and greenhouse gas management

 

•     Biodiversity and land management

 

•     Water stewardship

 

•     Responsibly managing hydraulic fracturing

  

•     Supporting and engaging with our communities

 

•     Free, prior informed consent

 

•     Respecting human rights

 

•     Making a positive contribution to society

Additional information relating to our sustainability performance for FY2014 is available in our Sustainability Report 2014 and can be found online at www.bhpbilliton.com.

1.14.2    Governance

Governance and sustainability

Our Board governs the Group in a manner consistent with Our Charter values, our strategy and our commitment to a transparent and high-quality governance system. The Board has established a number of committees to assist it in exercising its authority and to monitor the performance of the Group. The Sustainability Committee assists the Board in oversight of health, safety, environment, community and climate change matters. This includes overseeing areas relating to risk control, compliance with applicable legal and regulatory requirements and overall health, safety, environment and community (HSEC) performance of the Group.

The Board delegates authority to the CEO to manage the Group in its pursuit of creating long-term shareholder value through the discovery, acquisition, development and marketing of natural resources. Established by the CEO, the GMC is the Group’s most senior executive body. The GMC’s purpose is to provide leadership to the Group, determining its priorities and the way it is to operate, thereby assisting the CEO in pursuing the corporate

 

73


Table of Contents

purpose. The GMC is a forum to debate high-level matters important to the Group and to ensure consistent development of the Group’s strategy.

To link HSEC matters to remuneration, 20 per cent of the FY2014 short-term incentive opportunity for GMC members was based on HSEC performance. This was an increase from 15 per cent in FY2013, reflecting the importance the Board and GMC place on sustainability. The Sustainability Committee assists the Remuneration Committee in determining appropriate HSEC metrics to be included in GMC scorecards and in assessing performance against those measures. The Board also has discretion over both the short-term and long-term incentive opportunities for GMC members and takes into consideration HSEC performance.

Identifying and managing our material risks

In addition to the legal requirements of the countries in which we operate, our approach to sustainability risks is defined by our HSEC-related Group Level Documents (GLDs). These clearly describe our mandatory minimum performance requirements and accountabilities across the Group and are the foundation for developing and implementing management systems at our operations.

Our HSEC-related GLDs outline our approach to the Group’s material sustainability risks and highlight a commitment to international policies, standards and management practices. These include the principles and mandatory requirements of the position statements of the International Council on Mining and Metals (ICMM) Sustainable Development Framework, the United Nations (UN) Global Compact, the UN Declaration of Human Rights and the Voluntary Principles on Security and Human Rights.

We seek to ensure our customers, suppliers, agents, service providers and contractors maintain business practices and workplaces that are aligned with our GLDs. We also provide GLD performance requirements to our non-operated assets and seek to influence the asset to follow these requirements.

Our Risk Management GLD provides the framework for embedding risk identification and management into our business activities, functions and processes. This is the basis of an active and consistent risk-based approach to sustainability. We identify risks we consider material to our organisation and take into consideration the potential health, safety, environmental, community, reputational, legal and financial impacts. The severity of any particular risk is assessed according to the most severe impact associated with a specific risk. The objectives of the risk management process are to understand the nature and residual impact of the material risks for the Group and to ensure they are managed through the verification and effectiveness testing of critical controls. Information relating to the material risks for the Group, including sustainability risks, is available in section 1.7 of this Annual Report.

Operating with integrity and conducting business transparently

To maintain our position as one of the world’s leading companies, we are committed to ethical business practices and high levels of governance in all our dealings. Regardless of the country or culture within which our people work, our Anti-corruption GLD and Code of Business Conduct prohibit bribery and corruption in all our business dealings. Particulars in relation to the Code of Business Conduct and anti-corruption are referred to in section 3.17 in this Annual Report. Specific discussion on legal proceedings is available in section 6 of this Annual Report.

Transparently reporting our payments to governments

We believe that transparency of government revenue from the extraction of natural resources is an important element in the fight against corruption. BHP Billiton has been a supporter of the Extractive Industries Transparency Initiative (EITI) since its inception in 2002 and we continue to engage actively with EITI processes in countries where we operate. In line with our support for the EITI, we have reported in the Sustainability

 

74


Table of Contents

Report 2014, payments of taxes and royalties derived from resource developments on a country-by-country basis. Our payments to governments in FY2014 included US$9.9 billion in company taxes, royalties and certain indirect taxes and approximately US$1.5 billion in taxes collected on behalf of employees. More than 99 per cent of our payments were made to 14 countries. Of these, our largest payments are made in Australia, where we have the majority of our assets.

Sustainability in our supply chain

As a global organisation, we understand our responsibility to ensure we only engage with suppliers who have responsible and ethical business practices. Relationships with our partner suppliers are managed in accordance with relevant contractual arrangements, Our Charter, our Code of Business Conduct, our Anti-corruption GLD and relevant HSEC GLDs.

To identify sustainability risks across our supply chain, we use a risk-based approach within our Supply ‘Source to Contract’ GLD to support our suppliers’ alignment with our HSEC and business conduct requirements. These requirements include zero tolerance of a number of human rights infringements including child labour, inhumane treatment of employees and forced or compulsory labour. Our suppliers are also required to adopt an open attitude towards legitimate activities of trade unions.

Contracted suppliers are assessed on a matrix for commercial dependency versus supplier risk and assigned a tiered segmentation. A procedure to engage with each supplier is developed appropriate to the level of risk.

Closure planning

Closure planning is a key consideration in the planning and development of our projects and operations. We recognise the significant risks associated with poorly managed closure activities and seek to minimise these throughout the life cycle of our operations. In line with our Corporation Alignment Planning GLD, our operations are required to develop and maintain closure plans that address the details of rehabilitation activities for disturbed land, remediation requirements for contaminated land, and end uses for land and infrastructure. Closure plans are also required to include community livelihood opportunities post-closure, design and engineering specifications for structures remaining at closure and human resource strategies addressing retention and transition opportunities for employees. In addition, we require closure plans to be developed as part of our major capital investments to ensure we understand potential closure liabilities and have the opportunity to reduce them during the design stage. The closure plans provide the basis for estimating the closure costs and the associated accounting for closure and rehabilitation obligations. Information on these provisions can be found in note 18 ‘Provisions’ to the Financial Statements in our Annual Report 2014.

An ongoing internal closure planning audit program, established in FY2011, tests the effectiveness of the controls detailed in our Corporation Alignment Planning GLD. Findings from these audits are reported to the relevant Business Presidents, while summary reports are considered by the Sustainability Committee of the Board. During FY2014, 10 audits were conducted and, where required, improvements to the closure plan or provisions were implemented.

Addressing climate change

Addressing climate change is a Board governance and strategic issue. Successful implementation of our strategy requires us to sustainably develop our asset portfolio to deliver superior long-term shareholder returns.

Climate change governance

We recognise our responsibility to take action by focusing on reducing our emissions, increasing our preparedness for physical climate impacts, and working with others, including our industry and governments, to enhance the global response to climate change. To effectively address the challenge of climate change, there

 

75


Table of Contents

must be a significant focus on developing and deploying low-emissions technologies. We will, through material investments in low-emissions technology, contribute to reducing emissions from fossil fuels.

There is uncertainty around the physical impacts of climate change and how the world will respond to these impacts or seek to mitigate climate change. In light of this, our investment decisions are informed by a comprehensive understanding of a range of possible climate change outcomes and the associated risks and opportunities to delivering shareholder value. We use a broad range of scenarios that consider critical global uncertainties (e.g. macroeconomic and geopolitical) and their impacts on supply and demand assumptions to test our portfolio and investment decision-making.

Our approach to addressing climate change is to identify emerging trends, develop strategies, coordinate activity across the businesses and report our performance externally. Our GMC has primary responsibility for the design and implementation of an effective position and response to climate change, and accountability for performance against our climate change metrics. We also seek input and insight from external experts, such as the Forum on Corporate Responsibility.

To reflect updates in scientific knowledge and global regulatory and political responses, we regularly review our position on climate change. We incorporate climate change considerations into our Group scenarios to understand potential impacts on our portfolio. We also conduct annual reviews of performance against Business greenhouse gas (GHG) targets to ensure we are on track to achieve our company target. The Sustainability Committee has considered a range of climate change scenarios and continues to monitor the actions being taken to manage a range of climate change impacts and policy responses.

Our perspective on climate change

We accept the Intergovernmental Panel on Climate Change’s (IPCC) assessment of climate change science, which has found that warming of the climate is unequivocal, the human influence is clear and physical impacts are unavoidable. We believe the world must pursue the twin objectives of limiting climate change to the lower end of the IPCC emission scenarios in line with current international agreements, while providing access to the affordable energy required to continue the economic growth essential for maintaining living standards and alleviating poverty.

We use the IPCC’s findings to build our understanding of the impacts climate change will have on our business and to inform our decision-making. Limiting climate change will require substantial and sustained reductions of GHG emissions. Our view is that an effective, long-term climate change policy framework should use a portfolio of complementary measures to reduce emissions and build resilience. This should include a price on carbon that addresses competitiveness concerns, support for energy-efficiency improvements, and the development and deployment of low-emissions technologies, together with measures to respond to the physical impacts of climate change.

We will continue to take action to reduce our emissions and build the resilience of our operations, investments, communities and ecosystems to the impacts of climate change. Recognising their role as policy makers, we engage with governments to enhance the global response. We work in partnership with resource sector peers to improve sectoral performance and increase industry’s influence in policy development to deliver effective long-term regulatory responses.

The global challenge

Our diverse portfolio is important in meeting global demand for energy. We will continue to adjust the shape of our portfolio to match energy and commodity demand and meet society’s expectations while maximising shareholder returns.

 

76


Table of Contents

Our approach to investment decision-making and portfolio management ensures that climate change risks are identified, assessed and appropriately addressed. We have been applying an internal price on carbon in our investment decisions and portfolio evaluation for more than a decade and were early adopters of this approach. We maintain a view on carbon pricing using a carbon price protocol which we update regularly. Our carbon price protocol tracks the progress of national commitments to tackle climate change throughout the world, including our major operating regions and customer demand centres, and considers various potential scenarios for how global emissions and policy will evolve over time. We look at the potential for reductions in emissions and the cost associated with those reductions to determine an appropriate price level for each relevant country or region. In doing so, we consider the effectiveness of different policies, political situations required to pass legislation, timing to implement reductions and the interaction between policy mechanisms.

Through a comprehensive and strategic approach to corporate planning, we work with a broad range of scenarios to assess our portfolio, including consideration of a range of policy responses to and impacts from climate change. Our work suggests that BHP Billiton’s portfolio diversification provides resilience to our overall asset valuation. The diversity of our overall portfolio, which includes energy (oil, coal and uranium) and minerals (including copper, premium quality iron ore and potash), uniquely positions us to manage and respond to changes and capture opportunities to grow shareholder value over time.

Stranded assets and the ‘carbon bubble’

The potential gap between the current valuation of fossil fuel reserves on the balance sheets of companies and in global equities markets and the reduced value that could result if a significant proportion of reserves were rendered incapable of extraction in an economically viable fashion due to responses to climate change, is known as the ‘carbon bubble’. Although this concept has been discussed by non-government organisations and academics for several years, there has recently been renewed interest in this topic, particularly from ratings agencies and investment analysts. There is, however, little consensus on what specific carbon prices, fossil fuel demand or market prices might trigger this devaluation.

Providing access to the affordable energy required to continue the economic growth is essential for maintaining living standards and alleviating poverty. Under all current plausible scenarios, fossil fuels will continue to be a significant part of the energy mix for decades.

BHP Billiton uses a scenario framework, including for forecasting commodity prices that considers critical global uncertainties (e.g. macroeconomic and geopolitical) and their impacts on supply and demand assumptions. Using a range of carbon prices and commodity demand and pricing assumptions across a variety of internally consistent scenarios, we have determined that BHP Billiton’s overall asset valuation is not at material risk, the pay-back periods for most present and future investments in fossil fuels production are relatively short and the portfolio remains robust.

Mitigation

We have been setting GHG targets for our Businesses since 1996 and have a goal to limit our overall emissions to below our FY2006 baseline by FY2017. Meeting an absolute target is not easy. Growth across our Businesses will increase emissions and we must continually look for opportunities to improve our energy efficiency and implement GHG reduction projects to mitigate this increase. All our Businesses are required to minimise their emissions to reduce our contribution to climate change. They must identify, evaluate and implement all suitable projects that prevent or minimise GHG emissions including in project design and equipment selection. For further information on our GHG emissions reduction projects, please refer to the Sustainability Report 2014.

Adaptation

We recognise that we must ensure our business is resilient and can adapt to physical climate change impacts that will occur. Our assets are long-lived so we take a robust, risk-based approach to managing these impacts. Our

 

77


Table of Contents

assessment of the regional impacts on our Businesses shows that they are already exposed to risks as a result of climate change, including increasing storm intensities, greater water supply variability and an increasing number of high-temperature days. These impacts can affect health and safety, productivity and financial performance. Testing the resilience of our operations to these impacts has already changed the way we work. For example, the identification and assessment of increasing storm intensity and storm surge levels has resulted in raising the height of the trestle at our Hay Point coal port facility in Australia as part of our expansion plans.

We continue to look for enhancements to the Company-wide integrated planning framework to allow better assessment of the physical risks associated with climate change and to ensure resilience is embedded into our business plans and investment decisions. We will also look for opportunities to work in partnership to improve community and ecosystem resilience to the impacts of climate change.

Investing in technology and innovation

To effectively address the challenge of climate change, there must be a significant focus on developing and deploying low-emissions technologies over the next few decades. The rate of technology improvement and subsequent adoption must be faster than the usual commercial timeframes if these technologies are to be available at scale and at acceptable cost to meet the global challenge. Industry and government will need to work together in collaborative partnerships to facilitate this step-change.

We are a foundation member of the Cooperative Research Centre for Greenhouse Gas Technologies, one of the world’s leading collaborative research organisations focused on carbon capture and storage (CCS). We contribute a voluntary levy to the Australian Coal Association Low Emissions Technologies to facilitate the development of low-emissions technologies from coal use, including CCS. We are a member of the Global Carbon Capture and Storage Institute which aims to accelerate the development, demonstration and deployment of CCS globally through knowledge sharing, fact-based advice and advocacy and work to create favourable conditions to implement CCS.

We are developing a more integrated approach to low-emissions technology to provide a roadmap for our investments. We will investigate opportunities for investment across a range of technologies that have the potential to lead to material emission reductions in our operations and across our supply chains. To accelerate deployment of any prospective technologies, we will seek opportunities to partner with governments, industry leaders and key researchers.

Further information on our approach to climate change is available online at www.bhpbilliton.com.

1.14.3    Health and safety

Keeping our people and operations safe

We recognise that the health and safety of our people comes first. This is core to Our Charter and to every aspect of our business. Our people are key to our long-term success and central to improving our HSEC performance.

To understand, manage and, where possible, eliminate the risks in our business, we have appropriate controls in place and provide our people with appropriate training. While eliminating hazards through engineering or physical controls has a strong place in safety management, we understand it is only part of the solution.

Our operations are required to have systems in place to identify and effectively manage foreseeable crises and emergencies. This ensures our operations can deal with potential causalities, to limit harm and to safely return to full function as soon as possible.

Across our business, we undertake annual assessments to verify that critical controls are effective in managing each material risk. During FY2014, we maintained this focus, which included assessing whether the critical controls were being deployed as designed and to the standard required.

 

78


Table of Contents

In FY2014, there were no fatalities reported at our operated assets. Our total recordable injury frequency (TRIF) performance of 4.2 injuries per million hours worked improved by nine per cent compared with FY2013.

Total recordable injury frequency (per million hours worked)

 

Year ended 30 June

   2014      2013      2012  

Total recordable injury frequency (TRIF)

     4.2         4.6         4.7   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Focusing on the health of our people

To prevent occupational illness and injury, we are focused on ensuring the work our people are required to do does not impact their health and that they are fit for work. This means identifying and assessing risks and managing and minimising their impact.

Since FY2012, we have seen an increase in the reporting of musculoskeletal illnesses and in FY2014 we have also seen an increase in noise induced hearing loss case reporting. These changes in reported cases have been driven by the adoption of comprehensive musculoskeletal illness classification processes and the introduction of programs for the early detection of hearing loss at some of our Australian operations. This has resulted in more focus on both of these illnesses.

In FY2014, the incidence of employee occupational illness was 2.84 per million hours worked, an increase of 19 per cent compared with FY2013.

Employee occupational illness incidence (per million hours worked)

 

Year ended 30 June

   2014      2013      2012  

Noise induced hearing loss

     0.68         0.51         0.97   

Musculoskeletal

     1.61         1.24         1.04   

Other illnesses

     0.55         0.64         0.35   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     2.84         2.39         2.36   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Our priority is to control occupational exposures at their source. We are focused on continuously improving our occupational exposure controls. In situations where we cannot control the source, we employ a range of measures, including the provision of personal protective equipment to safeguard our people.

Operations are required to identify and control health risks and to establish an exposure risk profile to harmful agents for employees and for contractors and to review the profile to validate exposure levels and to account for process changes. The implementation of exposure controls is required where exposure potentially exceeds or is anticipated to exceed occupational exposure limits (OELs). We establish our own OELs when we believe local regulatory limits do not provide adequate protection for our workers. If a potential exposure to harmful agents exceeds 50 per cent of the OEL, periodic medical surveillance is required.

In FY2012, we established a health target baseline and committed to reduce potential occupational exposure to carcinogens and airborne contaminants by 10 per cent by FY2017. In FY2014, we recorded a 22 per cent decrease in the number of potential exposures to carcinogens and airborne contaminants, if not for the use of personal protective equipment, compared with our FY2012 baseline. We have therefore currently exceeded our target; however, exposure control remains an area of focus to ensure our reductions are maintained.

1.14.4    Environment

We demonstrate environmental responsibility by minimising our environmental impacts and contributing to enduring benefits to biodiversity, ecosystems and other environmental resources. We classify environmental

 

79


Table of Contents

incidents based on our Risk Severity table. We determine a significant environmental incident as one that causes one or more major impacts to land, biodiversity, ecosystem services, water resources or air, with effects lasting greater than one year. Incidents that may impact any of the environmental attributes listed previously are investigated and remediated according to internal or external requirements. In FY2014 there were no significant environmental incidents reported at our operated assets.

Energy and greenhouse gas management

We strive to continually improve energy and GHG management. Consistent with our Environment GLD, our Businesses are required to identify, evaluate and implement suitable projects that prevent or minimise GHG emissions. We also evaluate and implement GHG emission reduction opportunities in capital project design.

In FY2013, we set a target to maintain our FY2017 GHG emissions below our FY2006 baseline levels, while continuing to grow our business. In FY2014, the Group’s total GHG emissions were 45.0 million tonnes (Mt) of carbon dioxide equivalent (CO2-e), a reduction of 1.7 Mt CO2-e compared to FY2013 (46.7 Mt CO2-e). This keeps us in line to achieve our GHG target. We will continue to focus on the implementation of abatement opportunities within our Businesses to further reduce our GHG emissions.

GHG Scope 1 and 2 (millions of tonnes CO2-e)

 

Year ended 30 June

   2014      2013      2012  

Scope 1 (a)

     22.7         22.0         20.2   

Scope 2 (b)

     22.3         24.7         20.0   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total GHG millions of tonnes CO2-e

     45.0         46.7         40.2   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(a)  Scope 1 refers to direct GHG emissions from our operated assets.

 

(b)  Scope 2 refers to indirect GHG emissions from the generation of purchased electricity and steam that is consumed by our operated assets.

In FY2014, our total energy consumption across the Group increased by six per cent, compared to FY2013, to 343 petajoules. This increase was related to new projects coming online including our Jimblebar iron ore mine in Western Australia and our Daunia coal mine in Queensland, Australia. To further improve energy consumption and GHG emissions we have implemented projects across our Businesses.

In line with requirements of the UK Companies Act 2006, our reported FY2014 GHG intensity was 4.9 tonnes of CO2-e per tonne of copper equivalent production. We believe that attempting to benchmark energy use and/or greenhouse gas emissions on an intensity basis does not meaningfully contribute to an understanding of our performance, given the diverse range of products across our portfolio, fundamental differences in the grade, geology, accessibility and technological processes and changes in output levels that routinely occur in different directions in response to changing market conditions and other factors. Rather than use an intensity metric, we have set ourselves a more challenging goal to limit our overall emissions by setting an absolute target, keeping our FY2017 GHG emissions below our FY2006 baseline while we continue to grow our business.

Biodiversity and land management

Improving our management of land and enhancing biodiversity are essential to operating in a responsible and sustainable manner. We continue to demonstrate environmental responsibility by minimising our environmental impacts and seeking opportunities to contribute to enduring benefits to biodiversity, ecosystems and other environmental resources.

 

80


Table of Contents

Our approach to land access is undertaken on a case-by-case basis and considers the potential environmental, societal, economic or cultural impacts. We consider what land we need for our activities and seek to identify the uses of the land and the stakeholders who may be affected by our activities. We then look at our possible short-term and long-term impacts on that land, including the effects that our use may have on biodiversity, water resources, air and communities.

In FY2013, we established a target to develop and maintain land and biodiversity management plans that include controls to avoid, minimise, rehabilitate and apply compensatory actions as appropriate, to manage the biodiversity and ecosystem impacts of our operations. This target is supported by the requirements of our Environment GLD. In FY2014, all our operations developed land and biodiversity management plans, consistent with our target.

We also have explicit requirements in our Environment GLD to avoid environmental impacts to protect our local and global environment. We continue to monitor the operational effectiveness of our controls. Where actual or reasonably foreseeable residual impacts remain to important biodiversity and ecosystems impacted by our activities, we look to undertake compensatory actions.

In addition to the environmental management actions of our Businesses, we have voluntarily committed to finance the conservation and ongoing management of areas of high biodiversity and ecosystem value that are of national or international conservation significance. We established an alliance with Conservation International to support the delivery of this target and improve our approach to biodiversity management more broadly. As a result, we will improve our environmental performance and broaden our contributions to lasting environmental benefits beyond what could be achieved by our operations alone. As of FY2014, we have committed more than US$30 million to conservation, in addition to the environmental management activities at our operations.

A central part of our approach to managing our impacts on land and biodiversity is the rehabilitation of land no longer required for our activities. Our Businesses are required to maintain rehabilitation plans that support life of asset and closure plans, and to rehabilitate disturbed areas no longer required for operational purposes, consistent with the pre-disturbance land use or alternate land use, taking into account regulatory requirements and stakeholder expectations.

Water stewardship

We recognise the role we have as responsible stewards of the water resources we share with our host communities and the environment. The sustainability of our operations relies on our ability to obtain an appropriate quality and quantity of water, use it responsibly and manage it appropriately, including taking account of natural supply variations.

Across our Businesses, water risks are required to be assessed and managed on a regional basis. In some locations, we operate in arid environments where water scarcity is an ongoing challenge while in other locations, we contend with water excess, water quality or water discharge issues. We anticipate climate change is likely to make the patterns and cycles of water flow less predictable and so we require our operations to implement adaptive responses. Managing our shared water resources is therefore a complex task for our Business.

In line with our Environment GLD, our operations are required to assess direct, indirect and cumulative impacts and risks to water resources as a result of understanding social, cultural, ecological and economic values of these resources at a catchment level within our area of influence. Based on these risks and impacts, controls demonstrating application of the mitigation hierarchy (avoid, minimise and rehabilitate environmental impacts prior to applying compensatory actions) are required to be implemented and monitored for effectiveness. Target environmental outcomes for impacts to water resources consistent with the level of risk are also required. Compensatory actions are applied where residual impacts remain to important water-related biodiversity and ecosystems impacted by our activities to meet our target environmental outcomes and contribute to long-term environmental benefits.

 

81


Table of Contents

Recognising the regional nature of our water risks, we introduced a target in FY2013 requiring our Businesses with water-related material risks, to implement projects to improve the management of water resources. The target allows our Businesses to focus on the water challenges specific to the regions in which they operate. In FY2014, all our operations that identified water-related material risks, implemented at least one project to improve the management of associated water resources.

Being a responsible water steward requires transparent and consistent reporting of water use and impacts. We have played a key role in the development and implementation of the Minerals Council of Australia’s Water Accounting Framework (WAF). The WAF aims to improve data integrity and comparability across the sector to allow a more meaningful analysis on which to base policy making and deliver improved outcomes. Our water reporting is consistent with the WAF approach, and we are working with the ICMM to support broader adoption across industry.

Under the WAF, water is categorised as Type 1 (close to drinking water standards), Type 2 (suitable for some purposes), and Type 3 (unsuitable for most purposes). In FY2014, our total water input (water intended for use) was 347,700 megalitres across the Group, with 84 per cent defined as Type 2 or Type 3. Our use of Type 2 and Type 3 water demonstrates our approach to utilising lower-quality water wherever feasible.

Responsibly managing hydraulic fracturing

The nature of our hydraulic fracturing operations at our North American Eagle Ford, Permian, Haynesville and Fayetteville shale areas means at times we work in close proximity to our host communities. We actively engage with local stakeholders to address public concerns about hydraulic fracturing fluids, groundwater contamination, land and water resources, GHG emissions, increased vehicular traffic and worker exposure to respirable crystalline silica. We continue to investigate ways to reduce or eliminate any potential impacts associated with our activities.

To protect and manage the land and water resources, we conduct environmental assessments prior to the execution of hydraulic fracturing work to minimise the impacts of our operations. In FY2014, we completed a water balance showing inputs, uses, losses, reuse and recycle, and disposal amounts of fresh water for each operation to identify opportunities to reduce water consumption in our hydraulic fracturing operations. We are pursuing non-potable water options, including the use of brackish water, recycled municipal effluents and recycled water from our production wells.

A number of controls are used to manage, minimise and recycle drilling residuals. We use closed loop systems that allows drilling muds to be recycled and lower the potential for contact with the environment. .As part of our commitment to transparency, we publicly report the ingredients of the fracturing fluids for each well completion in the hydraulic fracturing chemical disclosure registry, FracFocus. For a high percentage of our wells, we fully disclose all of the ingredients and additives by name (and Chemical Abstracts Service Number) and provide the maximum percentage of each ingredient present in the fracturing fluid mixture. In a few cases, the service providers who supply the ingredients and conduct our well completions elect to designate a small number of proprietary ingredients as confidential business information. In the Permian area, we pump a blend of produced water and fresh water treated with an advanced oxidation process which utilises ozone, a highly reactive oxidant that kills most bacteria. This process eliminates the need for clay stabiliser and biocide, thereby reducing the number of additives in the fracturing fluid mixture. Every well we drill is checked against our critical controls to ensure well integrity and the safety of our operations.

The majority of our air emissions relate to GHG emissions from fuel combustion and flaring or venting during well construction and production. We are working to reduce emissions by capturing and selling produced natural gas that may otherwise have been vented or flared.

 

82


Table of Contents

1.14.5    Society

Supporting and engaging with our communities

We are a global company that values our host communities. We strive to be part of the communities in which we operate and through all our interactions seek to foster meaningful long-term relationships, which respect local cultures and create lasting benefits. Our contribution to our host communities is broad ranging. Through employment, taxes and royalties, we support local, regional and national economies. We purchase local goods and services and develop infrastructure that benefits entire communities.

From the earliest possible stage of a project’s life, we seek to build trust with our stakeholders. By defining the boundaries of our host communities, we assess the social, economic, political, security and environmental aspects and develop a social baseline, which is required to be updated every five years with changes tracked over time. Stakeholder engagement plans, which identify the interests and relationships of our stakeholders and contain a range of culturally and socially inclusive engagement activities to encourage open communication, are reviewed and updated annually. To ensure our engagement and community development activities are effective and to inform planning activities, our operations are required to complete a community perception survey every three years.

Free prior and informed consent

As one of the 22 member companies of the ICMM, we have worked to develop a progressive position statement on Indigenous Peoples and Mining. This statement, which comes into effect in May 2015, specifically addresses the issue of Free Prior and Informed Consent (FPIC).

FPIC is a concept based on good faith negotiation through which Indigenous peoples can give or withhold their consent using processes consistent with their traditional decision-making practices. Supporting commitments address understanding their rights and interests, building cross-cultural understanding, and agreeing on appropriate engagement processes and participation in decision-making. A number of related commitments address how ICMM members should engage where government is responsible for managing Indigenous peoples’ interests and how to move forward when differences of opinion arise. The ICMM’s position statement recognises the right of governments to ultimately make decisions on development of resources and that, in most countries, neither Indigenous peoples nor other groups have a right to veto projects. Where consent cannot be reached, a host government may decide to proceed with a project after balancing the rights and interests of Indigenous peoples with the wider population. In these circumstances, it will be up to ICMM member companies to determine whether they remain involved with the project.

Through our Community GLD, we require our Businesses to prepare, design and implement Indigenous engagement programs that are consistent with the new ICMM Position Statement on Indigenous Peoples and Mining for new operations or major capital projects that are located on lands traditionally owned by or under customary use of Indigenous peoples and are likely to have significant adverse impacts on Indigenous peoples.

Respecting customary rights

At a very early stage in a project, we seek to identify landowners, occupiers and users who may be affected by our activities. Knowing who is connected to and uses the land is critical to establishing an effective community consultation and engagement program. This helps to ensure people potentially affected by our operations are fully aware of our activities and have an opportunity to express their concerns and aspirations. Arising from this engagement, the operational work plan may be amended to reduce potential impacts on landowners and users.

Surveys are commissioned to identify the customary owners and how the land is being used to ensure these uses are taken into account in our development plans. In instances where land may be used for customary purposes and no formal land title has been issued, information is requested from relevant organisations, including

 

83


Table of Contents

government authorities with responsibilities for customary land uses and Indigenous peoples’ representative organisations, such as land and tribal councils. Further enquiries are also made directly with the people in the area to help identify those with connections to the land.

Respecting and including Indigenous communities

We recognise the traditional rights and values of Indigenous peoples, respect their cultural heritage and provide opportunities for inclusion and advancement. Many of our operations are located on or near Indigenous lands. We support our workers by providing cultural awareness and competency training for employees and contractors who engage with Indigenous peoples from our host communities. Training is developed and delivered in consultation with traditional owners. We also identify who is connected to and uses the land to ensure we establish effective community consultation and engagement programs.

Respecting human rights

We acknowledge our activities have the potential to impact human rights and we address these through our core business practices. We are committed to operating in accordance with the United Nations (UN) Universal Declaration of Human Rights, UN Guiding Principles on Business and Human Rights and the UN Global Compact Principles. We support these commitments through Our Charter and Code of Business Conduct and the performance requirements detailed in our GLDs.

In line with our Community GLD, our human rights due diligence process requires our operations to identify and document key potential human rights risks by completing a human rights impact assessment (HRIA). This includes assessing performance against the articles of the UN Universal Declaration of Human Rights, the UN Global Compact principles and host country legislation governing human rights issues. We require each HRIA to be reviewed on an annual basis. Every three years, each HRIA is required to be verified through an engagement process with stakeholders, and, in medium and high-risk jurisdictions, by a qualified human rights specialist. Where a HRIA identifies a material risk, a human rights management plan is required to be implemented and reviewed annually. Selected employees and contractors receive training on how to comply with our human rights commitments.

Through our commitment to the Voluntary Principles on Security and Human Rights (VPs), we seek to protect people and property from material risks presented by security threats. Performance requirements related to the VPs are implemented through our Security and Emergency Management GLD. Our operations are required to identify security-related material risks to people and property and engage relevant stakeholders to develop and manage security programs that respect human rights and fundamental freedoms.

In addition, we require our operations to conduct a gap analysis annually using the VP’s Implementation Guidance Tool and to implement an improvement plan to close identified gaps. The process also provides an opportunity to further build awareness and understanding of the VPs across the Company.

Making a positive contribution to society

Creating lasting economic and social benefit for our communities is fundamental to our business. This helps create a diversified local economy and ensures our investment continues to benefit the community beyond the life of our operations. We are an active participant in industry and sustainable development forums, such as the ICMM. We seek to understand our socio-economic impact on local communities and host regions through our participation in the ICMM’s Mining: Partnerships for Development initiative. This global initiative builds on the ICMM’s Resource Endowment initiative and seeks to enhance mining’s contribution to development and poverty reduction through multi-stakeholder partnerships.

Wherever we operate, we contribute taxes and royalties to governments which, in turn are used to provide important public services and amenities to their communities. At many of our locations, we also develop

 

84


Table of Contents

infrastructure to support our operations – including roads, aerodromes, emergency response facilities, housing, public amenities, community facilities – which can be accessed and utilised by local communities and businesses.

We are focused on providing training and employment opportunities to our local communities. Given the nature of the work we do, our ability to employ locally can be limited by the availability of industry and technical skills and experience at the local level. Our broader contribution to local economies can be realised through indirect employment and our support of local businesses that provide a range of services and products, which enable our operations to function effectively.

Improving the quality of life in our host communities

A focus on sustainability underpins all our investments in community economic development. This means we are committed to addressing the needs and priorities of the communities in which we operate and seek to invest in projects that will continue to promote benefits to the community after the funding is completed. We work with our host communities to identify the major social issues and development priorities. Using data from a social baseline study and social impact and opportunity assessment, we develop a community development management plan. Community development projects and donations are required to be aligned to the overall community development management plan, implemented in consultation with local stakeholders, and meet our due diligence and anti-corruption requirements.

We voluntarily invest one per cent of our pre-tax profit, calculated on the average of the previous three years’ pre-tax profit, in community programs that aim to have a long-lasting positive impact on people’s quality of life, including implementing new and supporting existing community projects. With a focus on improving quality of life, our community development programs are developed by working openly with governments and the communities in which we operate, and focusing on the needs and resources of our key stakeholders. This is how we are contributing to economic and social development.

During FY2014, our voluntary community investment totalled US$241.7 million, comprising US$141.7 million of cash, in-kind support and administrative costs, and a US$100 million contribution to the BHP Billiton Foundation. The BHP Billiton Foundation was established in FY2013 to identify and support large sustainable development projects in countries and regions of interest to BHP Billiton to complement the local programs managed by our assets. This builds on contributions that have previously been paid to the BHP Billiton Sustainable Communities charitable organisation. At the end of FY2014, BHP Billiton Sustainable Communities had a total of US$70.4 million and the BHP Billiton Foundation had a total of US$179 million in funds available for future sustainable development projects.

Community investment

 

Year ended 30 June

  2014     2013     2012  
    US$M     US$M     US$M  

Expenditure (including in-kind support and administrative costs) (1)

    141.7        139.8        149.1   

Contribution into BHP Billiton Sustainable Communities and BHP Billiton Foundation

    100.0        106.0        65.0   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Community investment

    241.7        245.8        214.1   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1)  Represents BHP Billiton’s equity share for both operated and non-operated joint venture operations.

In FY2014, of the US$141.7 million cash expenditure, 46 per cent was invested in local communities; 44 per cent was invested regionally and 10 per cent was invested in national or international programs in countries where we operate.

 

85


Table of Contents

Ok Tedi

BHP Billiton exited from Ok Tedi Mining Limited (OTML) in February 2002. The exit arrangements included the transfer of BHP Billiton’s shares in OTML to PNG Sustainable Development Program Limited (PNGSDP) and a statutory undertaking protecting BHP Billiton from environmental claims by the PNG Government.

In September 2013, the Papua New Guinea (PNG) Parliament passed laws which compulsorily acquired PNGSDP’s shares in OTML and changed other aspects of the exit arrangements, including the repeal of the protection from environmental claims by the PNG Government. BHP Billiton retains an indemnity from PNGSDP in respect of environmental claims by the PNG Government and certain environmental claims by third parties. This indemnity is secured against the assets of PNGSDP.

Following the passing of the new laws, PNGSDP has commenced legal proceedings and an International Centre for Settlement of Investment Disputes (ICSID) arbitration process against the State of PNG and others.

1.15    Additional information

1.15.1    External factors and trends

The following section describes some of the external factors and trends that have had a material impact on our financial condition and results of operations. We operate our business in a dynamic and changing environment and with information that is rarely complete and exact. We primarily manage the risks discussed in this section under our portfolio risk management approach, which relies on the effects of diversification, rather than individual risk management programs. Details of our risk factors can be found in section 1.7.2 of this Annual Report. Details of our financial risk management strategies and financial instruments outstanding at 30 June 2014 can be found in section 1.7.3 and in note 29 ‘Financial risk management’ to the Financial Statements.

Management monitors particular trends arising from external factors with a view to managing the potential impact on our future financial condition and results of operations. The following external factors could have a material adverse effect on our business and areas where we make decisions on the basis of information that is incomplete or uncertain.

Commodity prices

The prices we obtain for our products represent a key driver of our business, and fluctuations in these commodity prices affect our results, including cash flows and asset values. The estimated impact on FY2014 profit after taxation of changes of commodity prices is set out below.

 

     US$M  

US$1/bbl on oil price

     54   

US¢10/MMBtu on US gas price

     30   

US¢1/lb on copper price

     24   

US$1/t on iron ore price

     112   

US$1/t on metallurgical coal price

     28   

US$1/t on energy coal price

     25   

US$50/t on aluminium price

     36   

US¢10/dmtu on manganese ore price

     26   

US$1/t on manganese alloy price

     1   

US¢1/lb on nickel price

     2   

During FY2014, commodity markets saw some support from a modest improvement in global economic activity, though growth was uneven across different regions. The United States and Japan saw underlying momentum

 

86


Table of Contents

increase, but emerging economies, notably China, saw growth slow. For steelmaking raw materials, supply growth exceeded that of demand resulting in a decrease in prices. Metal commodity prices were relatively stable with the exception of nickel, which experienced a price increase primarily as a result of the Indonesian ore export ban. For energy commodities, US natural gas prices benefited from strong winter demand, while solid demand growth combined with supply disruptions and geopolitical tensions have provided price support for crude oil.

The following table shows prices of our most significant commodities for the years ended 30 June 2014, 2013 and 2012. These prices represent selected quoted prices from the relevant sources as indicated. These prices will differ from the realised prices on the sale of the Group’s production due to differences in quotation periods, quality of products, delivery terms and the range of quoted prices that are used for contracting sales in different markets.

 

Year ended 30 June

   2014
Closing
     2013
Closing
     2012
Closing
     2014
Average
     2013
Average
     2012
Average
 

Aluminium (LME cash) (US$/t)

     1,851         1,731         1,835         1,764         1,938         2,168   

Alumina (1) (US$/t)

     312         318         305         321         327         334   

Copper (LME cash) (US$/lb)

     3.15         3.06         3.45         3.18         3.48         3.71   

Crude oil (Brent) (2) (US$/bbl)

     111.02         102.46         94.50         109.36         108.64         112.49   

Energy coal (3) (US$/t)

     70.89         78.89         89.22         78.38         89.10         111.95   

Natural gas Henry Hub (4) (US$/MMBtu)

     4.39         3.73         2.81         4.25         3.44         3.05   

Natural gas Asian Spot LNG (5) (US$/MMBtu)

     11.28         15.40         14.95         16.38         15.14         16.25   

Iron ore (6) (US$/dmt)

     93.25         116.25         135.25         122.70         127.23         151.17   

Manganese Alloys (7) (US$/t)

     999         1,038         1,160         1,020         1,106         1,177   

Manganese Ores (8) (US$/dmtu)

     4.20         5.54         5.06         4.95         5.29         4.90   

Metallurgical coal (9) (US$/t)

     110.50         130.00         221.50         128.40         159.13         239.18   

Nickel (LME cash) (US$/lb)

     8.49         6.21         7.47         6.88         7.43         8.77   

Ethane (10) (US$/bbl)

     12.02         9.92         12.29         11.92         12.15         27.31   

Propane (11) (US$/bbl)

     44.47         35.52         34.44         48.05         37.31         54.72   

Butane (12) (US$/bbl)

     54.39         49.51         51.29         56.70         61.74         76.72   

 

(1)  Platts PAX Free on Board (FOB) Australia – market price assessment of calcined Metallurgical/ Smelter Grade Alumina.

 

(2)  Platts Dated Brent is a benchmark price assessment of the spot market value of physical cargoes of North Sea light sweet crude oil.

 

(3)  GlobalCoal FOB Newcastle 6,000kcal/kg NCV – typically applies to coal sales in the Asia Pacific market.

 

(4)  Platts Gas based on Henry Hub – typically applies to gas sales in the US gas market.

 

(5)  Platts Liquefied Natural Gas Delivery Ex-Ship (DES) Japan/Korea Marker – typically applies to Asian LNG spot sales.

 

(6)  Platts 62 per cent Fe Cost and Freight (CFR) China – used for fines.

 

(7)  Bulk FerroAlloy high-carbon ferromanganese (HCFeMn) Western Europe DDP.

 

(8)  2014 and 2013 Metal Bulletin manganese ore 44 per cent Mn Cost Insurance Freight (CIF), 2012 CRU CIF China import 43 per cent contained manganese.

 

(9)  Platts Low-Vol hard coking coal Index FOB Australia – representative of high-quality hard coking coals.

 

(10)  OPIS Mont Belvieu non-Tet Ethane – typically applies to ethane sales in the US Gulf Coast market.

 

(11)  OPIS Mont Belvieu non-Tet Propane – typically applies to propane sales in the US Gulf Coast market.

 

(12)  OPIS Mont Belvieu non-Tet Normal Butane – typically applies to butane sales in the US Gulf Coast market.

 

87


Table of Contents

The following summarises the pricing trends of our most significant commodities for FY2014.

Aluminium: The London Metals Exchange (LME) aluminium average cash settlement price decreased by nine per cent during FY2014. Demand continued to increase, but new supply offset the curtailment of high cost capacity. Delays in implementing changes to LME warehouse rules contributed to record high regional premiums ex-China as inventories were constrained by warehouse queues. Since 30 June 2014, the aluminium cash settlement price increased to US$2,114/t on 31 August 2014.

Alumina: The Platts FOB Australia average price decreased by two per cent during FY2014. Although demand grew, driven by the commissioning of new smelters in China, increasing supply outpaced the growth in demand.

Copper: The LME copper average cash settlement price decreased by nine per cent in FY2014. A shortage of copper scrap and growth in Chinese demand supported prices in the first half of the financial year, however, the price decreased in March amid concerns over the liquidation of Chinese stocks. Although seasonal demand strength helped regain some lost ground, strong growth of refined copper production limited price upside.

Crude oil: The Platts Dated Brent crude average price increased by one per cent during FY2014. Prices were supported by increased global demand, constrained Libyan supply, tensions in the Ukraine and a surge of unrest in Iraq in the latter part of the year. Moderating price drivers included slower growth in the Chinese economy during the December quarter of FY2014, combined with some progress towards resolving the deadlock over Iran’s nuclear program.

Energy coal: The Global Coal Newcastle FOB average price decreased by 12 per cent during FY2014. The decrease was driven by weaker import demand growth from India and China, coupled with supply growth from Australia, Russia and Indonesia.

Natural gas Henry Hub: The Platts US Henry Hub natural gas average price increased by 24 per cent during FY2014. The increase was driven by early winter heating demand in the residential and commercial sectors, depleting inventory levels significantly below the five-year average. Storage inventories in June closed 31 per cent below the five-year average at 1,829 billion cubic feet.

Natural gas Asian Spot LNG: The Asian liquefied natural gas average spot price increased by eight per cent during FY2014. The price rise was primarily caused by strong north Asian winter heating demand, combined with the closure of Japanese and South Korean nuclear reactors increasing the need for gas fired power generation in the first half of the year. Supply remained tight throughout the period, as Egypt, Nigeria and Angola experienced supply disruptions. The year-end price decrease of 31 per cent versus the average price for the year was principally due to low North Asian summer demand and new supply coming to market from Papua New Guinea in the second half of the year. Since 30 June 2014, the Asian liquefied natural gas spot price increased to US$12.45/MMBtu on 31 August 2014.

Iron ore: The Platts 62 per cent iron ore CFR China average price declined by four per cent during FY2014. The decrease was driven by seaborne iron ore supply growth which outpaced demand. The price fluctuated between US$89.00/dmt and US$142.50/dmt as large changes occurred in iron ore inventories. Global demand increased in the first half of the year, primarily driven by China’s record pig iron production; however the second half of the year saw demand growth decrease due to flat Chinese growth. Seaborne imports to China increased, primarily driven by supply from Australia and the year-end price decreased 24 per cent versus the average price for the year. Since 30 June 2014, the Platts 62 per cent iron ore CFR China price decreased to US$88/dmt on 31 August 2014.

Manganese: The Metal Bulletin manganese ore China CIF average price decreased by six per cent during FY2014. Demand growth slowed, while South African supply increased amid higher Chinese inventory levels. The year-end price also decreased 15 per cent versus the average price for the year. The Western Europe spot

 

88


Table of Contents

high carbon ferromanganese average price decreased by eight per cent during FY2014. Weaker alloy prices led to decreased production in South Korea and the United States.

Metallurgical coal: The average Platts Low-Vol Hard Coking Coal Index decreased by 19 per cent during FY2014. While demand from traditional markets recovered steadily, the price decrease was mainly driven by continuing supply growth from Australia. The year-end price also decreased 14 per cent versus the average price for the year.

Nickel: The average LME cash settlement nickel price decreased by seven per cent during FY2014. Increased supply growth coming mainly from Chinese nickel pig iron and new production from greenfield projects was greater than demand growth in the first half of the year. The price increase in the second half of the year was driven by decreased low-cost supply due to the Indonesian ore export ban. Demand growth increased, supported by a recovery in stainless steel production in Europe and the United States. The year-end price increased 23 per cent versus the average price for the year.

NGL: The Mont Belvieu ethane average price decreased by two per cent during FY2014 following increases in ethane supply. Mont Belvieu propane average prices increased by 29 per cent during FY2014, supported by a decrease in supply growth. Mont Belvieu butane average prices decreased by eight per cent during FY2014 due to increased butane supply. Since 30 June 2014, the Mont Belvieu ethane price decreased to US$9.92 /bbl on 31 August 2014.

Exchange rates

We are exposed to exchange rate transaction risk on foreign currency sales and purchases, as we believe active currency hedging does not provide long-term benefits to our shareholders. Because a majority of our sales are denominated in US dollars, and the US dollar plays a dominant role in our business, we borrow and hold surplus cash predominantly in US dollars to provide a natural hedge. Operating costs and costs of locally sourced equipment are influenced by fluctuations in local currencies, primarily the Australian dollar, Brazilian real, Chilean peso and South African rand. Foreign exchange gains and losses reflected in operating costs owing to fluctuations in the local currencies relative to the US dollar may potentially offset one another. The US dollar strengthened in the last quarter of FY2013, resulting in a stronger average US dollar during FY2013 compared to FY2014. Overall, the Australian dollar ended the financial year stronger against the US dollar, while the Chilean peso, Brazilian real and South African rand weakened.

We are also exposed to exchange rate translation risk in relation to net monetary liabilities, being our foreign currency denominated monetary assets and liabilities, including debt and other long-term liabilities. Details of our exposure to foreign currency fluctuations are contained within note 29 ‘Financial risk management’ to the Financial Statements.

Changes in product demand and supply

Global demand and supply for the commodities we produce is a key driver of commodity prices, and fluctuations in product demand and supply affect our results, including cash flows and asset values.

The global economy grew at a moderate rate in FY2014. Momentum in the United States, Japan and the United Kingdom was underpinned by central bank monetary policy. Europe’s economy improved marginally, although the recovery was constrained by high levels of unemployment. Emerging markets, including China, experienced a moderate slowdown.

In a relative sense, the Chinese economy continues to grow strongly with signs that it is rebalancing. Consumption continued to be supported by higher household incomes while fixed asset investment softened, led by the property sector, as the central bank restricted access to credit. Rapid credit growth in the non-bank financial sector remained an important concern for policy makers.

 

89


Table of Contents

We remain confident in the short-term to medium-term outlook for the Chinese economy. Measured stimulus recently introduced by the government demonstrates their commitment to maintain economic growth above seven per cent. We believe consumption and services will continue to increase in importance, while the market’s role in allocating capital will be enhanced. Greater transparency within the fiscal system is also expected to reshape the relationship between central and local government.

The underlying performance of the US economy continued to improve despite the significant disruption caused by severe weather in the March quarter of FY2014. The curtailment of quantitative easing appears to have had a limited impact on sentiment as a solid increase in demand reflects a stronger labour market, rising disposable incomes, and higher equities and housing prices. Business investment has been a weak link in the recovery so far as companies have responded slowly to better economic conditions, despite higher levels of profitability. An increase in capital spending will be required to sustain the recovery in the medium term.

The Japanese economy has responded strongly to expansionary monetary and fiscal policy over the past year. Investment spending and wages increased as corporate profits benefited from the depreciation of the yen, while an increase in the national sales tax in April had a limited impact on consumption. These factors have increased the potential for faster growth in the short term, although a longer-term, sustainable recovery will be contingent on the scale and speed of structural reform.

With regard to the global economy, stronger United States growth and an associated tightening of monetary policy could result in the rapid outflow of capital from emerging economies. However, developing nations with sound macroeconomic fundamentals would be less likely to experience a severe impact from this transition.

As anticipated, Chinese crude steel production growth decelerated in response to weakness in the construction sector. On average, we expect the ratio of Chinese crude steel production growth to underlying GDP growth to remain below one, although seasonal factors and policy settings will continue to influence short-term output. Global steel demand growth outside of China is likely to accelerate during the remainder of CY2014.

The supply of low-cost steelmaking raw materials has grown more quickly than demand. As predicted, lower-cost seaborne iron ore supply is increasingly displacing higher cost Chinese domestic production. As this trend continues, the cost curve is likely to flatten as high cost production exits the market. In metallurgical coal, high-cost, uneconomic supply has remained resilient although we do expect to see an increasing number of production cuts, particularly in the United States. Given robust underlying demand growth for premium hard coking coals, pricing for our products is likely to be well supported in the medium and longer term.

Indonesian and Australian exports continue to keep the thermal coal market well supplied, prolonging the weaker pricing environment. While demand from key importing regions remains steady, prices are unlikely to respond unless uneconomic supply exits the market.

In copper, robust demand for refined metal, supply disruptions and a shortage of scrap has ensured that the market remains broadly balanced. We believe the longer-term fundamentals for copper remain compelling as grades decline, rising costs and a scarcity of high-quality future development opportunities are likely to constrain low-cost supply.

Demand growth, supply disruptions and geopolitical tension have continued to support crude oil prices. We expect prices to remain supported by an increase in demand from non-OECD countries, which has recently outstripped growth in demand from OECD countries.

United States natural gas prices benefited from a cold winter, which reduced inventory levels significantly below the five-year average. In the longer term, demand is expected to benefit from increasing industrial use, growth in gas-fired power generation and the commencement of LNG exports. Conversely, high inventory levels at Asian utilities, mild summer temperatures and the commissioning of additional supply have led to a decline in Asia-Pacific LNG prices from their February peak.

 

90


Table of Contents

The nickel price rose sharply during the second half of FY2014 as the Indonesian ore export ban took effect in the March quarter of FY2014. Demand growth remains robust given rising stainless steel production in China, Europe and the United States.

While aluminium demand growth has been strong, new supply continues to offset the curtailment of high cost capacity. However, we expect the premia currently being realised in certain regions to remain at elevated levels as warehouse bottlenecks are likely to take some time to be resolved.

Capital expenditure

Capital expenditure is important in pursuing our strategy through the development of large-scale resource projects and in sustaining our existing operations. Capital expenditure is disclosed for each Business in section 1.6.3 of this Annual Report.

Operating costs

As the prices for our products are determined by the global commodity markets in which we operate, we do not generally have the ability to offset cost pressures through corresponding price increases; therefore, controlling our operating costs is a key driver of our results. Operating costs for the last three years are set out in section 1.11 as well as an analysis of the change in Total expenses. Further analysis of the factors that impacted expenses during FY2014 is set out below and in section 1.15.3.

In discussing the factors that affected Total expenses, we refer to the change in operating cash costs and change in exploration and business development. Collectively we refer to these as change in controllable cash costs. Operating cash costs by definition do not include non-cash costs being depreciation, amortisation, impairments and movements in deferred stripping balances. The change in operating cash costs also excludes the impact of exchange rates and inflation on the actual costs incurred in the corresponding period, changes in fuel and energy costs, changes in exploration and business development costs and one-off items. These items are excluded so as to provide a consistent measurement of changes in costs across all the Businesses based on the factors that are within their control and responsibility.

Change in operating cash costs and change in controllable cash costs are not measures that are recognised under IFRS and they may differ from similarly titled measures reported by other companies. A reconciliation of the movements in Underlying EBIT to the financial statement line items in the Income Statement is included in section 2.5 of this Annual Report.

Our focus on reducing operating costs through productivity initiatives saw a decrease in operating cash costs of US$1.5 billion and a reduction in exploration and business development of US$398 million to give a reduction in controllable cash costs of US$1.9 billion in FY2014. In addition operating costs were aided by favourable exchange rate impacts of US$2.0 billion. These factors were offset by other factors such as inflation (US$805 million) and the production costs associated with higher volumes (US$2.6 billion). With higher depreciation and amortisation charges of US$1.7 billion and higher impairment charges of US$450 million, total expenses excluding exceptional items increased from US$45.0 billion to US$46.5 billion.

Exploration and development of resources

Minerals exploration

Over the past six years, brownfield exploration has increased our reserve base around our portfolio of existing assets in large resource basins, which now provide us with significant growth opportunities. This has allowed us to reduce brownfield exploration expenditure and rationalise our greenfield exploration program.

 

91


Table of Contents

Greenfield minerals (new sites) exploration is focused on advancing targets within Chile and Peru, and is organised through our Copper Business. Greenfield activities include opportunity identification, application for and acquisition of mineral title, early reconnaissance operations and multi-million dollar delineation drilling programs.

In addition to our activities focused on finding new world-class deposits, several of our Businesses undertake brownfield (developments on existing sites) exploration, principally aimed at delineating and categorising mineral deposits near existing operations, and advancing projects through the development pipeline.

Our expenditure on minerals exploration over the last three financial years is set out below.

 

Year ended 30 June

   2014      2013      2012  
     US$M      US$M      US$M  

Greenfield exploration

     46         179         324   

Brownfield exploration

     364         497         814   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total minerals exploration

     410         676         1,138   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

The Group’s minerals exploration expenditure declined by 39 per cent in FY2014 to US$410 million as we sharpened our focus on greenfield copper porphyry targets in Chile and Peru.

Petroleum exploration

We have reduced exploration expenditure in Petroleum over recent years with a sharpened focus on high impact liquids opportunities in the Gulf of Mexico, Western Australia and Trinidad and Tobago.

 

Year ended 30 June

   2014      2013      2012  
     US$M      US$M      US$M  

Petroleum exploration

     600         675         1,355   

Exploration expense

Exploration expense represents that portion of exploration expenditure that is not capitalised in accordance with our accounting policies, as set out in note 1 ‘Accounting policies’ to the Financial Statements.

Exploration expense for each Business over the three-year period is set out below.

 

Year ended 30 June

   2014      2013      2012  
     US$M      US$M      US$M  

Exploration expense (1)

        

Petroleum and Potash

     544         709         1,038   

Copper

     116         274         366   

Iron Ore

     56         74         135   

Coal

     34         39         174   

Aluminium, Manganese and Nickel

     38         53         68   

Group and unallocated items

                     7   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

BHP Billiton Group

     788         1,149         1,788   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1)  Includes US$72 million (2013: US$102 million, 2012: US$144 million) exploration expense previously capitalised, written off as impaired.

Following our focus on productivity and reducing costs, the reduction in the Group’s exploration expense excluding impairment of exploration expense previously capitalised increased Underlying EBIT in FY2014 by US$331 million.

 

92


Table of Contents

Interest rates

We are exposed to interest rate risk on our outstanding borrowings and investments. Our policy on interest rate exposure is for interest on our borrowings to be on a US dollar floating interest rate basis. Deviation from our policy requires the prior approval of our Financial Risk Management Committee and is managed within our Cash Flow at Risk (CFaR) framework, which is described in note 29 ‘Financial risk management’ to the Financial Statements. When required under this strategy, we use interest rate swaps, including cross currency interest rate swaps, to convert a fixed rate exposure to a floating rate exposure. As at 30 June 2014, the Group held US$3.3 billion (2013: US$5.4 billion) of centrally managed fixed interest rate borrowings, as well as US$2.0 billion (2013: US$3.5 billion) of other fixed interest rate borrowings, that have not been swapped to floating interest rates, primarily arising from debt raised during FY2014, debt assumed as part of the acquisition of Petrohawk and debt raised prior to the DLC merger.

Our earnings are sensitive to changes in interest rates on the floating interest rate component of the Group’s net borrowings. Based on the net debt position as at 30 June 2014, taking into account interest rate swaps and cross currency interest rate swaps, it is estimated that a one percentage point increase in the US LIBOR interest rate will decrease the Group’s equity and profit after taxation by US$126 million (2013: decrease of US$128 million). This assumes that the change in interest rates is effective from the beginning of the financial year and the fixed/floating mix and balances are constant over the year. However, interest rates and the net debt profile of the Group may not remain constant over the coming financial year and therefore such sensitivity analysis should be used with care.

Health, safety, environment and community

We operate in an industry where many of our activities are highly regulated by laws governing health, safety and the environment. We are committed to compliance with the laws and regulations of the countries in which we operate and, where applicable, to exceeding legal and other requirements which are less stringent than our own. However, regulatory standards and community expectations are constantly evolving. As a result, we may be exposed to increased litigation, compliance costs and unforeseen environmental rehabilitation expenses, despite our best efforts to work with governments, community groups and scientists to keep pace with regulations, law and public expectations.

Further information about our compliance with HSEC regulations can be found in section 1.14 of this Annual Report.

Insurance

During FY2014, we maintained an insurance program encompassing property damage, business interruption, sabotage and terrorism, marine cargo, construction, directors’ and officers’ liability and public and certain other liabilities. The program includes a combination of self-insurance via subsidiary captive insurance companies, industry mutuals and external market insurance and reinsurance. Mandates are established as to risk retention levels, policy cover and, where applicable, insurance and reinsurance counterparty security. As part of our portfolio risk management approach, we regularly conduct an assessment of maximum foreseeable loss potential, cash flow at risk, loss experience, claims received and insurance premiums paid, and will make adjustments to the balance of self-insurance and external insurance and reinsurance as required.

The Group is largely self-insured for losses arising from property damage and business interruption, sabotage and terrorism, marine cargo, construction and primary public liability. For these risks, we internally insure our Businesses (for wholly owned assets and for our share of joint venture assets) via our captive insurance companies. Any losses incurred will consequently impact the Financial Statements as they arise.

 

93


Table of Contents

1.15.2    Application of critical accounting policies

The preparation of our Financial Statements requires management to make estimates and judgements that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities, the disclosure of contingent liabilities at the date of the Financial Statements and the reported revenue and expenses during the periods presented therein. On an ongoing basis, management evaluates its estimates and judgements in relation to assets, liabilities, contingent liabilities, revenue and expenses. Management bases its estimates and judgements on historical experience and on various other factors it believes to be reasonable under the circumstances, the results of which form the basis of making judgements about the carrying values of assets and liabilities that are not readily apparent from other sources. Actual results may differ from these estimates under different assumptions and conditions.

We have identified the following critical accounting policies under which significant judgements, estimates and assumptions are made and where actual results may differ from these estimates under different assumptions and conditions and may materially affect financial results or the financial position reported in future periods:

 

  reserve estimates;

 

  exploration and evaluation expenditure;

 

  development expenditure;

 

  property, plant and equipment and intangible assets – recoverable amount;

 

  defined benefit pension schemes;

 

  provision for closure and rehabilitation;

 

  taxation.

In accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS), we are required to include information regarding the nature of the estimates and judgements and potential impacts on our financial results or financial position in the Financial Statements. This information can be found in note 1 ‘Accounting policies’ to the Financial Statements.

 

94


Table of Contents

1.15.3    Operating results

The following table describes the approximate impact of the principal factors that affected Underlying EBIT for FY2014 and FY2013.

 

Year ended 30 June

   2014     2013  
     US$M     US$M  

Underlying EBIT as reported in the prior year

     22,930        28,086   

Change in volumes:

    

Productivity

     962        1,257   

Growth

     1,929        707   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 
     2,891        1,964   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net price impact:

    

Change in sales prices

     (3,396     (8,454

Price-linked costs

     (80     582   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 
     (3,476     (7,872
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Change in controllable cash costs:

    

Operating cash costs

     1,524        1,556   

Exploration and business development

     398        949   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 
     1,922        2,505   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Change in other costs:

    

Exchange rates

     1,760        229   

Inflation on costs

     (805     (646

Fuel and energy

     (46     (133

Non-cash

     (2,091     154   

One-off items

            (103
  

 

 

   

 

 

 
     (1,182     (499
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Asset sales

     53        (66

Ceased and sold operations

     (492     (657

Other

     215        (531
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underlying EBIT

     22,861        22,930   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

95


Table of Contents

The method of calculation of the factors that affected Underlying EBIT and the Financial Statement line items of Revenue, Other income and Expenses (excluding net finance costs) that are affected by the factors are as follows.

 

Factor affecting
Underlying EBIT

 

Method of calculation

 

Financial statement
line item affected

Volumes – Growth

  Volume – Growth comprises Underlying EBIT for operations that are new or acquired in the current period minus Underlying EBIT for operations that are new or acquired in the corresponding period, change in volumes for operations identified as a Growth project from the corresponding period to the current period multiplied by the prior year Underlying EBIT margin, and change in volume for Petroleum Business from the corresponding period to the current period multiplied by the prior year Underlying EBIT margin.   Revenue and Expenses

Volumes – Productivity

  Change in volumes for each operation not included in the Growth category from the corresponding period to the current period multiplied by the prior year Underlying EBIT margin.   Revenue and Expenses

Change in sales prices

  Change in average realised price for each operation from the corresponding period to the current period multiplied by current period volumes.   Revenue

Price-linked costs

  Change in price-linked costs for each operation from the corresponding period to the current period multiplied by current period volumes.   Expenses

Operating cash costs

  Change in total costs, other than price-linked costs, exchange rates, inflation on costs, fuel and energy costs, non-cash costs and one-off items as defined below for each operation from the corresponding period to the current period.   Expenses

Exploration and business development

  Exploration and business development expense in the current period minus exploration and business development expense in the corresponding period.   Expenses

Exchange rates

  Change in exchange rate multiplied by current period local currency revenue and expenses. The majority of the Group’s selling prices are denominated in US dollars and so there is little impact of exchange rate changes on Revenue.   Revenue and Expenses

Inflation on costs

  Change in inflation rate applied to expenses, other than depreciation and amortisation, price-linked costs, exploration and business development expenses, expenses in ceased and sold operations and expenses in new and acquired operations.   Expenses

Fuel and energy

  Fuel and energy expense in the current period minus fuel and energy expense in the corresponding period.   Expenses

Non-cash

  Includes non-cash items, mainly depreciation, amortisation, and impairments.   Expenses

One-off items

  Change in cash costs exceeding a predetermined threshold associated with an unexpected event that had not occurred in the last two years and is not reasonably likely to occur within the next two years.   Expenses

 

96


Table of Contents

Factor affecting
Underlying EBIT

 

Method of calculation

 

Financial statement
line item affected

Asset sales

  Profit/loss on the sale of assets or operations in the current period minus profit/loss on sale in the corresponding period.   Other income

Ceased and sold operations

  Underlying EBIT for operations that are ceased or sold operations in the current period minus Underlying EBIT for operations that are ceased or sold in the corresponding period.   Revenue, Other income and Expenses

Other

  Variances not explained by the above factors.   Expenses

A reconciliation of the movements in Underlying EBIT for FY2014 to the financial statement line items in the Income Statement is included in section 2.5 of this Annual Report.

The following commentary describes the principal factors outlined in the table above for FY2014 and FY2013.

Volumes

Volume efficiencies attributed to productivity and the ramp-up of major projects underpinned an increase in production in a number of Businesses in FY2014 and an additional US$2.9 billion in Underlying EBIT. WAIO was the major contributor as the ramp-up of the Jimblebar mining hub and a series of productivity initiatives raised the capacity of our integrated supply chain and supported a US$1.8 billion increase in Underlying EBIT. Despite the impact of natural field decline, stronger volumes in our Petroleum Business generated an additional US$994 million of Underlying EBIT, reflecting 73 per cent growth in Onshore US liquids volumes and a near doubling of production at Atlantis.

Prices

Lower average prices reduced Underlying EBIT by US$3.4 billion in FY2014.

In metallurgical coal, an increase in seaborne supply and the resilience of higher cost, along with uneconomic capacity led to a 20 per cent and 14 per cent decline in the average realised price of hard coking coal and weak coking coal, respectively. The average price received for thermal coal also declined by 14 per cent during the period. In total, lower average realised prices in our Coal Business reduced Underlying EBIT by US$1.5 billion.

A five per cent decline in the average realised price of copper reflected the near-term rebalancing of the market, while the acceleration of low-cost, seaborne iron ore supply growth, predominantly from Australia’s Pilbara region, weighed on prices in the June 2014 half year. In total, lower average realised prices for copper and iron ore reduced Underlying EBIT by US$1.4 billion.

Nickel and aluminium prices rallied towards the end of FY2014 but remained lower on average for the period, reducing Underlying EBIT by a further US$258 million.

The value of diversification was again evident as higher average realised prices for our petroleum products increased Underlying EBIT by US$219 million. In this context, the average price achieved for our natural gas sales book, covering domestic and international markets, increased by 16 per cent.

Price-linked costs decreased Underlying EBIT by US$80 million during the period, primarily reflecting higher royalty charges in our Petroleum and Iron Ore Businesses.

Controllable cash costs

Our focus on improving operating costs through productivity initiatives saw a decrease in operating cash costs of US$1.5 billion and a decrease in exploration and business development costs of US$398 million, to give a decrease in controllable cash costs of US$1.9 billion during FY2014.

 

97


Table of Contents

Operating cash costs

The Group’s commitment to further improve the competitive position of its assets delivered tangible results in FY2014 as operating cash costs declined by US$1.5 billion. A general increase in labour and contractor productivity had the greatest impact, increasing Underlying EBIT by US$1.3 billion.

An improvement in equipment productivity increased Underlying EBIT by a further US$268 million as contract stripping activities were further optimised at Queensland Coal. A reduction in consumable costs in our Aluminium, Manganese and Nickel Business more than accounted for a US$33 million decrease in Group supply costs.

Exploration and business development

The Group’s exploration expenditure declined by 25 per cent in FY2014 to US$1.0 billion as we sharpened our focus on greenfield copper porphyry targets in Chile and Peru, and high impact liquids opportunities in the Gulf of Mexico, Western Australia and Trinidad and Tobago. The associated reduction in the Group’s exploration expense increased Underlying EBIT by US$331 million, while a further decline in business development expenditure increased Underlying EBIT by US$67 million.

Other costs

Exchange rates

A stronger US dollar increased Underlying EBIT by US$1.8 billion and included the restatement of monetary items in the balance sheet, which reduced Underlying EBIT by US$352 million. Average and closing exchange rates for FY2014 and FY2013 are detailed in note 1 ‘Accounting policies’ to the Financial Statements.

Inflation on costs

Inflation had an unfavourable impact on all Businesses and reduced Underlying EBIT by US$805 million during FY2014. This was most notable in Australia, Chile and South Africa, which accounted for over 85 per cent of the total variance.

Non-cash

An increase in non-cash charges reduced Underlying EBIT by US$2.1 billion during the period.

A US$631 million increase in the depreciation and amortisation charge at Onshore US reflected the ramp-up of liquids production and the progressive development of our Permian acreage. We continue to expect the depreciation rate in the Permian to normalise at a lower level as reserves are booked and the production rate grows towards 100 Mboe per day over the medium term. The completion and progressive ramp-up of several major projects in our Iron Ore and Coal Businesses resulted in an US$871 million increase in the depreciation and amortisation expense during the period.

Depreciation and amortisation expense included the following impairment charges: a US$292 million charge at Energy Coal South Africa; a US$184 million charge related to minor Gulf of Mexico assets; and a US$68 million charge associated with our decision to allow the exclusivity agreement for Terminal 5 at the Port of Vancouver (United States) to lapse.

A US$300 million charge related to the revision of mine site rehabilitation provisions for the Group’s North American closed mines and a lower capitalisation rate for deferred stripping at Escondida and Pampa Norte also contributed to the increase in non-cash charges.

Asset sales

The divestment of Liverpool Bay more than accounted for the US$53 million increase in Underlying EBIT related to asset sales.

 

98


Table of Contents

Ceased and sold operations

Underlying EBIT from ceased and sold operations decreased by US$492 million in FY2014 and largely reflected: a US$143 million negative adjustment to the Browse divestment price; the closure of the Nickel West Leinster Perseverance underground mine in November 2013; and the cessation of aluminium smelting activities at Bayside in June 2014.

Other

Other items increased Underlying EBIT by US$215 million and largely reflected an increase in margins at our equity accounted investments and an US$84 million profit related to the sale of the Energy Coal South Africa Optimum Coal purchase agreement. A US$112 million UK pension plan expense in our Petroleum Business is also reported in this category.

Net finance costs

Net finance costs of US$1.2 billion decreased by US$100 million from the prior period. This was primarily related to a decrease of US$245 million in net interest expenses, which was partially offset by a decrease in interest capitalised of US$108 million.

Taxation expense

Total taxation expense, including royalty-related taxation, exceptional items and exchange rate movements, was US$7.0 billion, representing a statutory effective tax rate of 31.5 per cent (30 June 2013: 35.0 per cent).

Government imposed royalty arrangements calculated by reference to profits are reported as royalty-related taxation. The Minerals Resource Rent Tax (MRRT) reduced taxation expense by US$238 million in FY2014 (30 June 2013: increase of US$321 million) as royalty-related credits in the Coal Business more than offset Iron Ore MRRT expense for the period. This included the remeasurement of deferred tax assets associated with the MRRT which decreased taxation expense by US$170 million in the period (30 June 2013: increase of US$207 million).

The Group’s adjusted effective tax rate, which excludes the influence of exchange rate movements, remeasurement of deferred tax assets associated with the MRRT and exceptional items, was 32.5 per cent (30 June 2013: 34.2 per cent).

Adjusted effective tax rate is not an IFRS measure and is reconciled to the statutory effective tax rate below:

 

     2014     2013  

Year ended 30 June

   Profit
before tax
    Income tax
expense
    %     Profit
before tax
     Income tax
expense
    %  
     US$M     US$M           US$M      US$M        

Statutory effective tax rate

     22,236        (7,012     31.5     19,726         (6,906     35.0

Less:

             

Exchange rate movements

            (24               245     

Remeasurement of deferred tax assets associated with the MRRT

            (170               207     

Exceptional items

     (551     166          1,928         (943  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Adjusted effective tax rate

     21,685        (7,040     32.5     21,654         (7,397     34.2
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

99


Table of Contents

Other royalty and excise arrangements that are not profit based are recognised as operating costs within Profit before taxation. These amounted to US$2.8 billion during the period (30 June 2013: US$2.6 billion).

Exceptional items

 

Year ended 30 June 2014

   Gross      Tax     Net  
     US$M      US$M     US$M  

Sale of Pinto Valley

     551         (166     385   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 
     551         (166     385   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

On 11 October 2013, BHP Billiton completed the sale of its Pinto Valley mining operation for a cash consideration of US$653 million, after working capital adjustments. A gain on sale of US$385 million (after tax expense) was recognised in FY2014.

Refer to note 3 ‘Exceptional items’ to the Financial Statements for more information.

 

Year ended 30 June 2013

   Gross     Tax     Net  
     US$M     US$M     US$M  

Exceptional items by category

      

Sale of Yeelirrie uranium deposit

     420               420   

Sale of Richards Bay Minerals

     1,212        (183     1,029   

Sale of diamonds business

     (97     (42     (139

Sale of East and West Browse Joint Ventures

     1,539        (188     1,351   

Impairment of Nickel West assets

     (1,698     454        (1,244

Impairment of Worsley assets

     (2,190     559        (1,631

Impairment of Permian Basin assets

     (266     99        (167

Other impairments arising from capital project review

     (1,006     291        (715

Newcastle steelworks rehabilitation

     158        (47     111   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     (1,928     943        (985
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The Group announced the sale of its wholly owned Yeelirrie uranium deposit resulting in a gain on sale of US$420 million, while the associated tax expense was offset by the recognition of deferred tax benefits on available tax losses.

The Group announced it had completed the sale of its 37.76 per cent effective interest in Richards Bay Minerals resulting in a gain on sale of US$1.0 billion (after tax expense).

The Group announced the sale of its diamonds business, comprising its interests in the EKATI Diamond Mine and Diamond Marketing operations. The transaction was completed on 10 April 2013 for an aggregate cash consideration of US$553 million (after adjustments). An impairment charge of US$139 million (after tax expense) was recognised based on the final consideration.

The Group signed a definitive agreement to sell its 8.33 per cent interest in the East Browse Joint Venture and 20 per cent interest in the West Browse Joint Venture resulting in a gain on sale of US$1.5 billion being recognised in FY2013. The associated tax expense of US$462 million was partly offset by the recognition of deferred tax benefits on available tax losses of US$241 million and the derecognition of deferred tax liabilities of US$33 million. The final sales price was determined during FY2014 requiring a loss of US$143 million recognised in FY2014.

 

100


Table of Contents

As a result of expected continued strength in the Australian dollar and weak nickel prices, the Group recognised an impairment charge of US$1.2 billion (after tax benefit) at Nickel West in FY2013.

The Group recognised an impairment of assets at Worsley as a result of expected continued strength in the Australian dollar and weak alumina prices. A total impairment charge of US$1.6 billion (after tax benefit) was recognised.

An impairment charge of US$167 million (after tax benefit) was recognised as the performance of specific evaluation wells in certain areas of the Permian Basin (United States) did not support economic development.

In FY2013, WAIO refocused its attention on the capital efficient expansion opportunity that exists within the Port Hedland inner harbour, and all early works associated with the outer harbour development option were suspended. This revision to the WAIO development sequence and the change in status of other minor capital projects across the Group resulted in the recognition of impairment charges of US$639 million (after tax benefit) and other restructuring costs of US$76 million (after tax benefit) in FY2013, of which US$580 million (after tax benefit) were related to WAIO.

The Group recognised a decrease of US$158 million (before tax expense) to its rehabilitation obligations in respect of former operations at the Newcastle steelworks (Australia). This followed the completion of the Hunter River Remediation Project and reaching agreement with the Environment Protection Authority in March 2013 regarding the necessary scope of work to repeal the Environmental Classification at Steel River.

Exceptional items during FY2013 are classified by nature as follows:

 

Year ended 30 June 2013

US$M

   Sale of
assets
     Impairment
of goodwill
and other
assets
    Restructuring
costs
    Closure and
rehabilitation
provisions
released
     Gross  

Sale of Yeelirrie uranium deposit

     420                               420   

Sale of Richards Bay Minerals

     1,212                               1,212   

Sale of diamonds business

             (97                    (97

Sale of East and West Browse Joint Ventures

     1,539                               1,539   

Impairment of Nickel West assets

             (1,698                    (1,698

Impairment of Worsley assets

             (2,190                    (2,190

Impairment of Permian Basin assets

             (266                    (266

Other impairments arising from capital project review

             (898     (108             (1,006

Newcastle steelworks rehabilitation

                           158         158   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 
     3,171         (5,149     (108     158         (1,928
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Refer to note 3 ‘Exceptional items’ to the Financial Statements for more information.

 

101


Table of Contents

Third party sales

We differentiate sales of our production from sales of third party products due to the significant difference in profit margin earned on these sales. The table below shows the breakdown between our production and third party products.

 

Year ended 30 June (1)

   2014     2013     2012  
     US$M     US$M     US$M  

Group production

      

Revenue

     64,227        63,067        66,969   

Related operating costs

     (41,410     (40,264     (39,017
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underlying EBIT

     22,817        22,803        27,952   

Underlying EBIT Margin

     35.5     36.2     41.7
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Third party products

      

Revenue

     2,979        2,886        3,508   

Related operating costs

     (2,935     (2,759     (3,374
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating profit

     44        127        134   

Margin on third party products (2)

     1.5     4.4     3.8
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) Excluding exceptional items.

 

(2)  Operating profit divided by revenue.

We engage in third party trading for the following reasons:

 

  Production variability and occasional shortfalls from our own assets means that we sometimes source third party materials to ensure a steady supply of product to our customers.

 

  To optimise our supply chain outcomes, we may buy physical product from third parties.

 

  In order to support the development of liquid markets, we will sometimes source third party physical product and manage risk through both the physical and financial markets.

 

102


Table of Contents

1.15.4    Cash flow analysis

A Consolidated Cash Flow Statement is contained in the Financial Statements. The explanatory notes appear in note 23 ‘Notes to the consolidated cash flow statement’ to the Financial Statements. A summary table has been presented below to show the key sources and uses of cash.

 

Year ended 30 June

   2014     2013     2012  
     US$M     US$M     US$M  

Cash generated from operations

     31,384        28,793        32,987   

Dividends received

     1,284        721        722   

Net interest paid

     (839     (786     (412

Taxation paid

     (6,465     (8,574     (8,038
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net operating cash flows

     25,364        20,154        25,259   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Purchases of property plant and equipment

     (15,993     (22,243     (18,637

Exploration expenditure

     (1,010     (1,351     (2,493

Exploration expenditure expensed and included in operating cash flows

     716        1,047        1,644   

Purchases of intangibles

     (192     (400     (219

Investment in financial assets

     (1,193     (475     (471

Investment in subsidiaries, operations and jointly controlled entities

                   (12,556

Investment in equity accounted investments

     (44     (84     (83

Net proceeds from investing activities

     1,882        4,780        330   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net investing cash flows

     (15,834     (18,726     (32,485
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net proceeds (repayment of)/from interest bearing liabilities

     (910     7,157        8,644   

Share buy-back

                   (83

Dividends paid

     (6,639     (7,004     (6,220

Contribution from non-controlling interest

     1,435        73        101   

Other financing activities

     (354     (424     (403
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net financing cash flows

     (6,468     (198     2,039   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net increase/(decrease) in cash and cash equivalents

     3,062        1,230        (5,187
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net operating cash flows after interest and tax increased by 26 per cent to US$25.4 billion in FY2014. A US$2.6 billion increase in cash generated from operations (after changes in working capital balances) and a US$2.1 billion decrease in net taxes paid were the major contributors to the strong increase. The decrease in net taxes paid was attributed to lower income tax payments in the year of US$1.2 billion in line with our lower effective tax rate and income tax refunds of US$852 million.

Net investing cash outflows decreased by US$2.9 billion to US$15.8 billion during the period. This reflected a US$6.6 billion reduction in capital and exploration expenditure partially offset by a decline in proceeds from asset sales of US$2.9 billion. Expenditure on major growth projects totalled US$13.1 billion, including US$5.6 billion on petroleum projects and US$7.5 billion on minerals projects. Sustaining capital expenditure and other items totalled US$2.9 billion. Exploration expenditure was US$1.0 billion, including US$716 million classified within net operating cash flows.

Net financing cash flows included the proceeds from interest bearing liabilities of US$6.3 billion and contributions from non-controlling interests of US$1.4 billion. Proceeds from interest bearing liabilities included the issuance of a four tranche Global Bond of US$5.0 billion. These inflows were more than offset by debt repayments of US$7.2 billion and dividend payments to our shareholders of US$6.4 billion.

 

103


Table of Contents

1.15.5    Net debt and sources of liquidity

Our policies on debt and treasury management are as follows:

 

  a commitment to a solid ‘A’ credit rating;

 

  gearing to be a maximum of 40 per cent;

 

  diversification of funding sources;

 

  generally to maintain borrowings and excess cash in US dollars.

Gearing and net debt

Net debt, comprising Interest bearing liabilities less Cash and cash equivalents, was US$25.8 billion, which represented a decrease of US$1.7 billion compared with the net debt position at 30 June 2013. Gearing, which is the ratio of net debt to net debt plus net assets, was 23.2 per cent at 30 June 2014, compared with 26.8 per cent at 30 June 2013.

Cash at bank and in hand less overdrafts at 30 June 2014 was US$8.8 billion compared with US$5.7 billion at 30 June 2013. Included within this were short-term deposits at 30 June 2014 of US$7.1 billion compared with US$3.2 billion at 30 June 2013.

Funding sources

During FY2014, the Group issued a four tranche Global Bond totalling US$5.0 billion comprising US$500 million Senior Floating Rate Notes due 2016 paying interest at three month US dollar LIBOR plus 25 basis points, US$500 million 2.050 per cent Senior Notes due 2018, US$1.5 billion 3.850 per cent Senior Notes due 2023, and US$2.5 billion 5.000 per cent Senior Notes due 2043.

None of our Group level borrowing facilities are subject to financial covenants. Certain specific financing facilities in relation to specific Businesses are the subject of financial covenants that vary from facility to facility, but which would be considered normal for such facilities.

Our maturity profile for US dollar bonds, Euro bonds and Australian dollar bonds for the following five years is set out below.

 

Year ended 30 June

   2015      2016      2017      2018      2019  
     US$M      US$M      US$M      US$M      US$M  

USD Bonds

     3,825         1,050         3,250                 2,250   

Euro Bonds

             1,365                         1,706   

AUD Bonds

                             939           
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     3,825         2,415         3,250         939         3,956   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

     Facility
available
2014
     Used
2014
     Unused
2014
     Facility
available

2013
     Used
2013
    Unused
2013
 
     US$M      US$M      US$M      US$M      US$M     US$M  

Commercial paper program (1)

     6,000                 6,000         6,000         (1,330     4,670   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total financing facilities

     6,000               –         6,000         6,000         (1,330     4,670   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) 

The Group has a US$6.0 billion commercial paper program backed by US$6.0 billion of revolving credit facilities. In May 2014, the US$5.0 and US$1.0 billion revolving credit facilities expiring in December 2015 and December 2014, were replaced by a US$6.0 billion revolving credit facility. The new facility has a

 

104


Table of Contents
  five-year maturity with two one-year extension options. The facility is used for general corporate purposes and as backup for the commercial paper programs. The interest rates under these facilities are based on an interbank rate plus a margin. The applicable margin is typical for a credit facility extended to a company with the Group’s credit rating. The Group had no US commercial paper outstanding in the market at the end of the financial year (2013: US$1.3 billion).

Additional information regarding the maturity profile of our debt obligations and details of our standby and support agreements is included in note 29 ‘Financial risk management’ to the Financial Statements.

The Group’s credit ratings are currently A1/P-1 (Moody’s – long-term/short-term) and A+/A-1 (Standard & Poor’s – long-term/short-term). The ratings outlook from both agencies did not change during FY2014.

1.15.6    Other information

Quantitative and qualitative disclosures about market risk

We identified our primary market risks in section 1.15.1 of this Annual Report. A description of how we manage our market risks, including both quantitative and qualitative information about our market risk sensitive instruments outstanding at 30 June 2014, is contained in note 29 ‘Financial risk management’ to the Financial Statements.

Off-balance sheet arrangements and contractual commitments

Information in relation to our material off-balance sheet arrangements, principally contingent liabilities, commitments for capital expenditure and commitments under leases at 30 June 2014 is provided in note 21 ‘Contingent liabilities’ and note 22 ‘Commitments’ to the Financial Statements.

Subsidiary information

Information about our significant subsidiaries is included in note 26 ‘Subsidiaries’ to the Financial Statements.

Related party transactions

Related party transactions are outlined in note 32 ‘Related party transactions’ to the Financial Statements.

Significant changes since the end of the year

Significant changes since the end of the year are outlined in note 36 ‘Subsequent events’ to the Financial Statements.

The Strategic Report is made in accordance with a resolution of the Board.

Jac Nasser AO

Chairman

Dated: 11 September 2014

 

105


Table of Contents

2    Our assets

2.1    Business overview

2.1.1    Petroleum and Potash Business

Our Petroleum and Potash Business headquartered in Houston, United States, comprises conventional and non-conventional operations located in six countries throughout the world and a potash project based in Saskatchewan, Canada.

Petroleum

Our Petroleum Business includes exploration, development, production and marketing activities. We have a high-quality resource base concentrated in the United States and Australia. Our core production operations are primarily located in the US Gulf of Mexico, Onshore US and in Australia. We also have operations in Trinidad and Tobago, Pakistan, Algeria and the United Kingdom. We produce crude oil and condensate, natural gas and natural gas liquids (NGLs).

The Petroleum portfolio consisted of conventional oil and gas operations up until 2011, when we moved into the unconventional shale business. Our Onshore US operations evolved from the acquisition of the Fayetteville shale assets from Chesapeake Energy Corporation and the acquisition of Petrohawk Energy Corporation.

Our overall production for FY2014 was 246.0 million barrels of oil equivalent (MMboe). This was mainly attributable to our US and Australian operations, which produced 144.3 MMboe and 80.0 MMboe, respectively, with the majority of US production coming from Onshore US, which produced 108.1 MMboe. Operations outside Australia and the United States delivered the remaining production volumes. Information relating to our oil and gas reserves is set out in section 2.3.1.

In line with our aim of simplification and a sharper strategic focus, we continue to evaluate our existing portfolio in order to optimise our position around our core business.

 

106


Table of Contents

Our production operations include the following:

United States

 

LOGO

Gulf of Mexico

We operate two fields in the Gulf of Mexico (Shenzi with a 44 per cent interest and Neptune with a 35 per cent interest) and hold non-operating interests in three other fields (Atlantis with a 44 per cent interest, Mad Dog with a 23.9 per cent interest, and Genesis with a 4.95 per cent interest). We have on going infill drilling in our Gulf of Mexico fields. We completed water injection development projects at Shenzi and Atlantis in CY2013. All the fields are located between 155 and 210 kilometres offshore of the US state of Louisiana. We also own 25 per cent and 22 per cent, respectively, of the companies that own and operate the Caesar oil pipeline and the Cleopatra gas pipeline. These pipelines transport oil and gas from the Green Canyon area, where all our Gulf of Mexico fields are located, to connecting pipelines that transport product onshore. Our US oil production is delivered to refineries along the Gulf Coast of the United States.

Onshore US

We produce oil, condensate, NGLs and natural gas in four shale areas: Eagle Ford, Permian, Haynesville and Fayetteville. The Eagle Ford area has two sections, Black Hawk and Hawkville. Our combined leasehold acreage onshore in the United States is approximately 1.2 million net acres. Our ownership interests in those leases range from less than one per cent to 100 per cent. At 30 June 2014, we held an interest in approximately 7,700 gross wells and approximately 2,600 net wells. We acted as joint venture operator for approximately 32 per cent of our gross wells. Production in FY2014 was 108.1 MMboe up from 99.2 MMboe in FY2013.

 

107


Table of Contents

During FY2014, we sold our interest in our Onshore US South Midland shale operation, located in the Permian Basin, to EP Energy for cash consideration of US$153 million.

Shale reservoirs are characterised by low permeability, so it is necessary to stimulate the reservoir to create additional permeability and, therefore, the flow of liquids and gas to the wellbore. Extracting oil and gas from shale involves hydraulic fracturing, which is a process developed to efficiently access supplies of oil and natural gas locked inside dense subsurface rock formations, such as shale. Hydraulic fracturing involves using water, sand and a small amount of chemicals to fracture the hydrocarbon-bearing rock formation to allow the well to produce commercial volumes.

The development phase of an onshore shale operation requires an extensive drilling and completion program, which may include associated gas compression and treatment facilities and connecting pipelines. Shale development has a repetitive, manufacturing-like nature that provides opportunities for increased efficiency. Much of our development of the shale reservoirs utilises horizontal drilling with average lateral lengths between 1,400 and 1,700 metres. We enter into service contracts with third parties to provide drilling and completion services at our operated sites. At the end of FY2014, we had 24 drilling rigs in operation.

Much of the Eagle Ford and Permian areas are focused on hydrocarbon liquids. The Eagle Ford area is located in south Texas, where our leasehold acreage comprises 0.3 million net acres. The Permian area is located in west Texas, where our leasehold acreage currently comprises 0.2 million net acres following the sale of our South Midland interest and other leasehold acquisitions and disposals. Production volume from the Permian area was 3.8 MMboe. The combined production in FY2014 from our liquids-focused Eagle Ford and Permian areas was 51.9 MMboe, up from 33.4 MMboe in FY2013, with a production mix of 42 per cent crude oil and condensate (FY2013: 35 per cent), 36 per cent natural gas (FY2013: 42 per cent) and 22 per cent NGLs (FY2013: 23 per cent).

The Haynesville and Fayetteville areas are focused on natural gas. The Haynesville area is located in northwest Louisiana and east Texas, where our leasehold acreage comprises 0.3 million net acres. The Fayetteville field is located in north central Arkansas, where our leasehold acreage comprises 0.4 million net acres. The Haynesville and Fayetteville areas had combined production in FY2014 of 56.2 MMboe of natural gas (FY2013: 65.8 MMboe).

Oil and gas production from our onshore shale areas is sold domestically in the United States, via connections to intrastate and interstate pipelines. Prices for oil, NGLs and natural gas are based on US regional price indices, including West Texas Intermediate prices for oil, Henry Hub prices for natural gas and Mont Belvieu prices for NGLs.

Australia

LOGO

 

108


Table of Contents

Bass Strait

Together with our 50-50 joint venture partner, Esso Australia (a subsidiary of ExxonMobil), through the Gippsland Basin Joint Venture, we participated in the original discovery of hydrocarbons in 1965 and we have been producing oil and gas from Bass Strait for more than 40 years. The Bass Strait operations are located between 25 and 80 kilometres off the southeastern coast of Australia.

We sell the majority of our Bass Strait crude oil and condensate production to refineries along the east coast of Australia under 12-month term contracts. The contract price is based on the average Dated Brent price. Gas is piped onshore to the joint venture’s Longford processing facility, from which we sell our share of production to domestic distributors under contracts with periodic price reviews.

Minerva

We are the operator of Minerva (90 per cent interest), a gas field located 11 kilometres south-southwest of Port Campbell in western Victoria. The operation consists of two subsea wells, with gas piped onshore to a processing plant. After processing the gas is delivered into a pipeline and sold domestically under long-term contracts.

North West Shelf

We are a joint venture participant in the North West Shelf Project, located approximately 125 kilometres northwest of Dampier in Western Australia. The North West Shelf Project was developed in phases: the domestic gas phase supplies gas to the Western Australian domestic market, mainly under long-term contracts, and a series of liquefied natural gas (LNG) expansion phases supplying LNG to buyers in Japan, South Korea and China under a series of long-term contracts.

We continue to expand our operations in North West Shelf. The North Rankin compression project was completed during FY2014 to recover remaining lower pressure gas from the North Rankin and Perseus gas fields. North Rankin B platform was constructed adjacent to existing North Rankin A platform connected by a 100-metre long bridge and operates as a single facility.

Gas from North West Shelf is piped to the Karratha Gas Plant for processing. Liquefied petroleum gas (LPG), condensate and LNG are transported to market by ship, while domestic gas is transported by the Natural Gas and Pilbara Energy pipelines. We are also a joint venture partner in four nearby oil fields – Cossack, Wanaea, Lambert and Hermes. All North West Shelf gas and oil joint ventures are operated by Woodside.

Pyrenees

We operate six oil fields in Pyrenees, which are located offshore approximately 23 kilometres northwest of Northwest Cape, Western Australia. We had an effective 62 per cent interest in the fields as at 30 June 2014, based on inception-to-date production from two permits in which we have interests of 71.43 per cent and 40 per cent, respectively. The project uses a floating, production, storage and off-take (FPSO) facility. The crude oil produced is sold internationally on the spot market.

Macedon

We are the operator of Macedon (71.43 per cent interest), an offshore gas field located approximately 75 kilometres west of Onslow, Western Australia and a gas processing facility onshore, approximately 17 kilometres southwest of Onslow. The operation achieved first gas in August 2013 and consists of four subsea wells, with gas piped onshore to the processing plant. After processing, the gas is delivered into a pipeline and sold domestically under long-term contracts.

 

109


Table of Contents

Stybarrow

We are the operator of Stybarrow (50 per cent interest), an oil field located 55 kilometres west-northwest of Exmouth, Western Australia. The project uses a FPSO facility. The crude oil produced is sold internationally on the spot market.

Other production operations

Algeria

Our Algerian operations comprise a 38 per cent interest in the ROD Integrated Development, which consists of six satellite oil fields that pump oil back to a dedicated processing train. The oil is sold on a spot basis to international markets. Our interest in ROD is subject to a contractual determination with our joint venture partner ENI, which could result in a future change in our interest under certain conditions.

United Kingdom

We hold a 16 per cent non-operating interest in the Bruce oil and gas field in the North Sea and operate the Keith oil and gas field (31.83 per cent interest), a subsea tie-back, which is processed via the Bruce platform facilities.

We divested our interest in Liverpool Bay (46.1 per cent interest) on 31 March 2014 to ENI ULX Limited for a cash consideration of US$29.1 million (subject to finalisation) and the transfer of the rehabilitation and restoration liability to the buyer. Liverpool Bay was an integrated development consisting of five producing offshore oil and gas fields in the Irish Sea, the Point of Ayr onshore processing plant in northern Wales and associated infrastructure.

Trinidad and Tobago

We operate the Greater Angostura field (45 per cent interest in the production sharing contract), an integrated oil and gas development, located offshore, 40 kilometres east of Trinidad. The crude oil is sold on a spot basis to international markets, while the gas is sold domestically under term contracts. During FY2014 we extended the termination date of our Production Sharing Contract with the Government of Trinidad and Tobago from 2021 to 2026.

Pakistan

We operate the Zamzama gas project (38.5 per cent interest) in the Sindh province of Pakistan. Both gas and condensate are sold domestically under term contracts in accordance with the Pakistan Government’s pricing policies.

 

110


Table of Contents

Information on Petroleum operations

The following table contains additional details of our production operations. This table should be read in conjunction with the production (refer to section 2.2.1) and reserve tables (refer to section 2.3.1).

 

Operation &
location

 

Product

 

Ownership

 

Operator

 

Title, leases or options

 

Nominal production
capacity

 

Facilities, use & condition

United States          
Neptune (Green Canyon 613)            

Offshore

deepwater Gulf of Mexico (1,300m)

  Oil and gas  

BHP Billiton 35%

 

Marathon Oil 30% Woodside Energy 20%

Maxus US Exploration 15%

  BHP Billiton   Lease from US Government as long as oil and gas produced in paying quantities   50 Mbbl/d oil 50 MMcf/d gas   Permanently moored tension leg platform (TLP)
Shenzi (Green Canyon 653)            

Offshore

deepwater Gulf of Mexico

(1,310m)

  Oil and gas  

BHP Billiton 44%

 

Hess Corporation 28% Repsol 28%

  BHP Billiton   Lease from US Government as long as oil and gas produced in paying quantities   100 Mbbl/d oil 50 MMcf/d gas  

Stand-alone TLP

 

Genghis Khan field (part of same geological structure) tied back to Marco Polo TLP

Atlantis (Green Canyon 743)            

Offshore deepwater

Gulf of Mexico

(2,155m)

  Oil and gas  

BHP Billiton 44%

 

BP 56%

  BP   Lease from US Government as long as oil and gas produced in paying quantities   200 Mbbl/d oil 180 MMcf/d gas   Permanently moored semi-submersible platform
Mad Dog (Green Canyon 782)            

Offshore deepwater Gulf of Mexico

(1,310m)

  Oil and gas  

BHP Billiton 23.9%

 

BP 60.5%

Chevron 15.6%

  BP   Lease from US Government as long as oil and gas produced in paying quantities   80 Mbbl/d oil 60 MMcf/d gas   Permanently moored integrated truss spar, facilities for simultaneous production and drilling operations
Genesis (Green Canyon 205)            

Offshore deepwater

Gulf of Mexico

(approximately 790m)

  Oil and gas  

BHP Billiton 4.95%

 

Chevron 56.67% ExxonMobil 38.38%

  Chevron   Lease from US Government as long as oil and gas produced in paying quantities   55 Mbbl/d oil 72 MMcf/d gas   Floating cylindrical hull (spar) moored to seabed with integrated drilling facilities

 

111


Table of Contents

Operation &
location

 

Product

 

Ownership

 

Operator

 

Title, leases or options

 

Nominal production
capacity

 

Facilities, use & condition

Onshore US            

Eagle Ford, south Texas

 

Permian, west Texas

 

Haynesville, northern Louisiana and east Texas

 

Fayetteville, Arkansas

  Oil, condensate, gas and NGL  

BHP Billiton working interest in leases range from <1% to 100%

 

BHP Billiton average net working interest is approximately 34%

 

Largest partners include

Southwestern Energy, XTO, Devon Energy

  BHP Billiton operated approximately 32% of approximately 7,700 wells  

We currently own leasehold interests in approximately 1.2 million net acres:

Eagle Ford – 0.3 million acres

Permian – 0.2 million acres

Haynesville – 0.3 million acres

Fayetteville – 0.4 million acres

Other – 0.1 million acres

 

Leases associated with producing wells remain in place as long as oil and gas is produced in paying quantities

 

Average daily production during FY2014

1,230 MMcf/d gas

60.1 Mbbl/d oil and condensate

31.3 Mbbl/d NGL

 

Eagle Ford – producing oil and gas wells and associated pipeline and compression facilities

 

Permian – oil and gas wells with associated gathering systems, processing plant and compression facilities

 

Haynesville – producing gas wells with a third party operated pipeline network

 

Fayetteville – producing gas wells with associated pipeline and compression infrastructure

 

All production from Onshore US fields is transported to various intrastate and interstate pipelines through multiple interconnects

Australia            
Bass Strait            
Offshore and onshore Victoria   Oil and gas  

Gippsland Basin Joint Venture (GBJV):

BHP Billiton 50%

 

Esso Australia (Exxon Mobil subsidiary) 50%

Oil Basins Ltd 2.5% royalty interest in 19 production licences

 

Kipper Unit Joint Venture (KUJV):

BHP Billiton 32.5% Esso Australia 32.5%

Santos Offshore Pty Ltd 35%

  Esso Australia  

20 production licences and 2 retention leases issued by Australian Government

 

Expire between 2016 and end of life of field

 

One production licence held with Santos Ltd

 

200 Mbbl/d oil

1,075 MMcf/d gas

5,150 tpd LPG

850 tpd ethane

 

20 producing fields with 23 offshore developments (15 steel jacket platforms, 4 subsea developments, 2 steel gravity based mono towers, 2 concrete gravity based platforms)

 

Onshore infrastructure:

– Longford facility (3 gas plants, liquid processing facilities)

– Interconnecting pipelines

– Long Island Point LPG and oil storage facilities

– Ethane pipeline

 

112


Table of Contents

Operation &
location

 

Product

 

Ownership

 

Operator

 

Title, leases or options

 

Nominal production
capacity

 

Facilities, use & condition

Minerva            
Offshore and onshore Victoria   Gas and condensate  

BHP Billiton

 

90% Santos (BOL) 10%

  BHP Billiton   Production licence issued by Australian Government expires 5 years after production ceases   150 TJ/d gas 600 bbl/d condensate  

2 well completions

Single flow line transports gas to onshore gas processing facility

 

Gas plant located approximately 4 kms inland from Port Campbell

North West Shelf

Offshore and onshore Western Australia

 

North Rankin Goodwyn Perseus Angel and Searipple fields

 

Domestic gas, LPG, condensate,

LNG

 

North West Shelf Project is an unincorporated JV

 

BHP Billiton:

8.33% of original domestic gas JV, will ultimately increase to 16.67%

16.67% of Incremental Pipeline Gas (IPG) domestic gas JV 16.67% of original LNG JV

12.5% of China LNG JV 16.67% of LPG JV

 

Other participants: subsidiaries of Woodside, Chevron, BP, Shell, Mitsubishi/Mitsui and China National Offshore Oil Corporation

  Woodside Petroleum Ltd  

9 production licences issued by Australian Government

 

6 expire in 2022 and 3 expire 5 years from end of production

 

North Rankin Complex: 2,500 MMcf/d gas

60 Mbbl/d condensate

 

Goodwyn A platform: 1,450 MMcf/d gas 110 Mbbl/d condensate

 

Angel platform: 960 MMcf/d gas

50 Mbbl/d condensate

 

Withnell Bay gas plant: 600 MMcf/d gas

 

5-train LNG plant: 45,000 tpd LNG

 

Production from North Rankin and Perseus processed through the interconnected North Rankin A and North Rankin B platforms

 

Production from Goodwyn and Searipple processed through Goodwyn A platform

 

4 subsea wells in Perseus field tied into Goodwyn A platform

 

Production from Angel field processed through Angel platform

 

Onshore gas treatment plant at Withnell Bay processes gas for domestic market

 

5-train LNG plant

North West Shelf            

Offshore Western Australia

 

Wanaea

Cossack

Lambert and

Hermes fields

  Oil  

BHP Billiton 16.67%

 

Woodside 33.34%,

BP, Chevron, Japan Australia LNG (MIMI) 16.67% each

  Woodside Petroleum Ltd   3 production licences issued by Australian Government expire in 2014 (currently in renewal), 2018 and 2033, respectively   Production: 60 Mbbl/d Storage: 1 MMbbl   Floating production storage and off-take (FPSO) unit

 

113


Table of Contents

Operation &
location

 

Product

 

Ownership

 

Operator

 

Title, leases or options

 

Nominal production
capacity

 

Facilities, use & condition

Pyrenees            

Offshore Western Australia

 

Crosby

Moondyne

Wild Bull

Tanglehead

Stickle and

Ravensworth fields

  Oil  

WA-42-L permit:

BHP Billiton 71.43%

 

Apache PVG 28.57%

 

WA-43-L permit: BHP Billiton 40%

 

Apache APG Permits 31.5%

Inpex Alpha 28.5%

  BHP Billiton   Production licence issued by Australian Government expires 5 years after production ceases  

Production: 96 Mbbl/d oil

 

Storage: 920 Mbbl

  24 subsea well completions (19 producers, 4 water injectors, 1 gas injector), FPSO
Macedon            
Offshore and onshore Western Australia   Gas and condensate  

WA-42-L permit

BHP Billiton 71.43%

 

Apache PVG 28.57%

  BHP Billiton   Production licence issued by Australian Government expires 5 years after production ceases  

Production: 200 MMcf/d gas

20 bbl/d condensate

 

4 well completions

Single flow line transports gas to onshore gas processing facility

 

Gas plant located approximately 17 km southwest of Onslow

Stybarrow        

Offshore Western Australia

 

Stybarrow and Eskdale fields

  Oil and gas  

BHP Billiton 50%

 

Woodside 50%

  BHP Billiton   Production licence issued by Australian Government expires 5 years after production ceases  

Production: 80 Mbbl/d oil

 

Storage: 900 Mbbl

 

10 subsea well completions (6 producers, 3 water injectors, 1 gas injector)

 

Gas production is reinjected

Other production operations        
Algeria            
ROD Integrated Development            
Onshore Berkine Basin, 900 kilometres southeast of Algiers, Algeria   Oil  

BHP Billiton 45% interest in 401a/402a production sharing contract ENI 55%

 

BHP Billiton effective 38% interest in ROD unitised integrated development ENI 62%

  Joint Sonatrach/ENI entity  

Production sharing contract with Sonatrach (title holder)

 

Expires in 2016 with option for two 5-year extensions under certain conditions specified in the contracts

  Approximately 80 Mbbl/d oil  

Development and production of 6 oil fields

 

2 largest fields (ROD and SFNE) extend into neighbouring blocks 403a, 403d

 

Production through dedicated processing train on block 403

 

114


Table of Contents

Operation &
location

 

Product

 

Ownership

 

Operator

 

Title, leases or options

 

Nominal production
capacity

 

Facilities, use & condition

United Kingdom            
Bruce/Keith            
Offshore North Sea, UK   Oil and gas  

Bruce:

BHP Billiton 16% BP 37% Total SA 43.25% Marubeni 3.75%

 

Keith:

BHP Billiton 31.83% BP 34.84%

Total SA 25% Marubeni 8.33%

 

Bruce – BP

 

Keith – BHP Billiton

  3 production licences issued by UK Government expire in 2015, 2018 and 2046   920 MMcf/d gas  

Integrated oil and gas platform

Keith developed as tie-back to Bruce facilities

Liverpool Bay            

Offshore northwest England, Irish Sea

 

Douglas and Douglas West oil fields,

Lennox

Hamilton

Hamilton North

gas fields

  Oil and gas  

BHP Billiton 46.1%

 

ENI 53.9%

 

BHP Billiton’s interest in Liverpool Bay divested

31 March 2014

  BHP Billiton   3 production licences issued by UK Government expire in 2016, 2025 and 2027   308 MMcf/d gas 70 Mbbl/d oil and condensate  

Integrated development of 5 producing fields

 

Oil treated at Douglas complex then piped to oil storage barge for export by tankers

 

Gas processed at Douglas complex then piped by subsea pipeline to Point of Ayr gas terminal for further processing

 

115


Table of Contents

Operation &
location

 

Product

 

Ownership

 

Operator

 

Title, leases or options

 

Nominal production
capacity

 

Facilities, use & condition

Trinidad and Tobago            
Greater Angostura            
Offshore Trinidad and Tobago   Oil and gas  

BHP Billiton 45%

 

National Gas Company 30%

Chaoyang 25%

  BHP Billiton   Production sharing contract with the Trinidad and Tobago Government entitles us to operate Greater Angostura until 2026  

100 Mbbl/d oil

280 MMcf/d gas

 

Integrated oil and gas development: central processing platform connected to the Kairi-2 platform and gas export platform with 3 satellite wellhead protector platforms and flow lines

 

Oil pipeline from processing platform to storage and export at Guayaguayare

 

Gas supplied to Trinidad and Tobago domestic markets

Pakistan            
Zamzama            

Onshore Sindh Province,

Pakistan

  Gas and condensate  

BHP Billiton 38.5%

 

ENI Pakistan 17.75% PKP Exploration 9.375% PKP Exploration 2 9.375%

Government Holdings 25%

  BHP Billiton   20-year development and production lease from the Pakistan Government expires in 2022 (option to extend 5 years)   500 MMcf/d gas 3,350 bbl/d condensate  

10 production wells

4 process trains

2 front end compression trains

 

116


Table of Contents

Capital projects

United States

Shenzi Water Injection

The Shenzi Water Injection program was approved as part of the original sanctioned Shenzi project, which began production in 2009, to supplement aquifer pressure for additional recovery. The program included drilling and completion of three water injection wells and provides facilities to inject up to 125 thousand barrels per day (Mbbl/d) of water at 7,000 pounds per square inch (psi). The final Water Injector well #3 was drilled and completed in August 2013. The additional recovery resulting from water injection is expected to be approximately 80 million barrels (gross). Our share of final development costs was approximately US$375 million. We are the operator with a 44 per cent interest and Repsol and Hess Corporation each hold a 28 per cent interest.

Atlantis South Water Injection

During the initial Atlantis South development, water injection topsides and subsea facilities were approved and installed. The Atlantis South Water Injection project was later approved in January 2009 to provide pressure support. The water injection project involved the drilling of four subsea water injectors, tying them into the existing infrastructure and commissioning the 75 Mbbl/d of water injection facilities. Project completion took place in June 2013 and our 44 per cent share of the project costs was approximately US$242M. The Atlantis platform is operated by BP and located approximately 190 miles offshore from New Orleans, Louisiana.

Onshore US

BHP Billiton’s Onshore US drilling and development investment in FY2014 was US$4.2 billion, down from US$4.7 billion in FY2013, with US$3.6 billion (FY2013: US$3.8 billion) spent in the liquids-focused areas of Eagle Ford and Permian, and US$0.6 billion (FY2013: US$0.9 billion) in the gas-focused areas of Haynesville and Fayetteville. The expenditure primarily related to drilling and completion activities at all four areas. Our onshore drilling activity in FY2014 resulted in 413 net development wells completed primarily in the Eagle Ford and Permian areas.

Of the US$4.2 billion, approximately US$400 million was spent on the installation of more than 200 kilometres of pipeline infrastructure and additional gas processing facilities, primarily in our Eagle Ford and Permian areas.

The majority of drilling and completion activity in Onshore US was directed towards the liquids-focused Eagle Ford and Permian areas to capitalise on relatively stronger liquid prices as compared with natural gas prices. At the end of FY2014, more than 85 per cent of drilling activity was conducted in these areas.

Our Onshore US capital investment is expected to remain at approximately US$4.0 billion in FY2015, as we continue to optimise our drilling program. This includes an operated rig count of 26 for the period. Approximately 65 per cent of operated drilling activity will be conducted in our liquids-focused acreage in the Eagle Ford area. The remaining activity will occur in the Haynesville and Permian areas, where we are continuing to evaluate our most prospective acreage. Our operated drilling program in the Fayetteville area remains temporarily suspended; however, we continue to invest in wells operated by third parties where we see value.

Australia

Macedon

Macedon is a domestic gas development that consists of a 200 million cubic feet per day (MMcf/d) stand-alone gas plant, four subsea production wells, a 90-kilometre 20-inch wet gas pipeline and a 67-kilometre 20-inch sales

 

117


Table of Contents

gas pipeline. The project was approved in August 2010 at an investment level of US$1.1 billion (BHP Billiton share). First gas occurred in August 2013 with a final development cost of approximately US$1.2 billion (BHP Billiton share).

Bass Strait Kipper gas field development

Initial development of the Kipper gas field in the Gippsland Basin, located offshore Victoria, was approved by the Board in December 2007. A supplemental approval of the development was granted in January 2011. The first phase of the project included two new subsea wells, three new pipelines and platform modifications to supply 10 Mbbl/d of condensate and 80 MMcf/d of gas. Facilities were completed in September 2012; however, first production did not commence due to the need to provide for mercury removal.

Gas and liquids will be processed via the existing Gippsland Basin Joint Venture facilities. The Kipper gas field development is comprised of the Kipper Unit Joint Venture and the Gippsland Basin Joint Venture. We own a 32.5 per cent interest in the Kipper Unit Joint Venture, with Esso Australia (32.5 per cent) and Santos (35 per cent). We own a 50 per cent interest in the Gippsland Basin Joint Venture, with Esso Australia owning the remaining 50 per cent.

Funding for the installation of the mercury treatment facilities of US$120 million was approved in March 2014 with completion expected to occur in CY2016. Our share of costs incurred to 30 June 2014 was US$25 million.

Bass Strait Turrum field development

Further expansion of the Gippsland Basin facilities is underway following approval by the Board in July 2008 of the full field development of the Turrum oil and gas field. A supplemental approval of the development was obtained in January 2011. The project consists of four production and two injection wells and a new platform, Marlin B, linked by a bridge to the existing Marlin A platform. The Turrum field, which has a capacity of 11 Mbbl/d of oil and 200 MMcf/d of gas, is located 42 kilometres offshore in approximately 60 metres of water. Our share of development costs is approximately US$1.4 billion, of which US$ 1.3 billion was incurred as of 30 June 2014. The Turrum field development operates under the Gippsland Basin Joint Venture, in which we own a 50 per cent interest, with Esso Australia owning the remaining 50 per cent. Initial production of low carbon dioxide gas through the Turrum facilities occurred in June 2013. High carbon dioxide production from the Turrum reservoir will come online with completion of the Longford Gas Conditioning Plant in CY2016.

Longford

The Longford Gas Conditioning Plant (LGCP) Project was approved by the Board in December 2012 to enable the production of Turrum reserves plus the production of Kipper and other undeveloped high carbon dioxide content hydrocarbons. The project scope includes a carbon dioxide extraction facility, brownfield tie-ins, an electrical upgrade and multiple supporting utilities. Our share of development costs is approximately US$520 million, of which US$202 million was incurred as of 30 June 2014. First gas production is expected in CY2016. Esso Australia is the operator of the LGCP, owning a 50 per cent interest and BHP Billiton owns the remaining 50 per cent.

North West Shelf North Rankin gas compression project

The North West Shelf gas compression project was approved by the Board in March 2008 to recover remaining lower pressure gas from the North Rankin and Perseus gas fields. The project consisted of a new gas compression platform, North Rankin B, capable of processing 2,500 MMcf/d of gas, which was constructed adjacent to the existing North Rankin A platform, 135 kilometres offshore from Karratha on the northwest coast of Western Australia. The two platforms are connected by a 100-metre long bridge and operate as a single facility. Our share of development costs was approximately US$721 million subject to finalisation. First gas production from this site occurred in October 2013. This project is operated by Woodside, with an equally shared interest between Woodside, BHP Billiton, BP, Chevron, MIMI and Shell.

 

118


Table of Contents

North West Shelf Greater Western Flank–A

The North West Shelf Greater Western Flank–A (GWF-A) gas project was approved by the Board in November 2011 to recover gas from the near field Goodwyn H and Tidepole fields. The project consists of a five well subsea tie-back of the Goodwyn H and Tidepole fields to the Goodwyn A platform. The Goodwyn A platform is located in 130 metres of water, approximately 130 kilometres offshore from Karratha on the northwest coast of Australia. Our share of development costs is approximately US$400 million, of which US$206 million was incurred as of 30 June 2014. First gas production is expected in CY2016. Woodside is the operator and we own a 16.67 per cent interest.

Significant evaluation activities

We perform development evaluation activities to determine the technical feasibility and commercial viability of prospective projects after exploration and appraisal. Our significant recent evaluation activities include the following:

United States

Mad Dog Phase 2

The Mad Dog Phase 2 project is in response to the successful Mad Dog South appraisal well, which confirmed significant hydrocarbons in the southern portion of the Mad Dog field. The project has been sent back to the study phase to re-evaluate the concept. Discussions are ongoing with the operator to potentially modify the development plan. BP is the operator and we hold a 23.9 per cent working interest.

Stampede (formerly known as Knotty Head)

We decided effective April 2014, to withdraw from our 20 per cent non-operated working interest in the Stampede Operating Agreement following the completion of our development planning.

Australia

Scarborough

Development planning for the large Scarborough gas field offshore Western Australia is in progress. We continue to evaluate development options. Esso is the operator of the WA-1-R lease and we hold a 50 per cent working interest. We are the operator and have a 100 per cent working interest in the adjacent Thebe discovery and the WA-346-P block.

North West Shelf Other – Greater Western Flank ‘2’

Planning continues for the development of Greater Western Flank ‘2’. Greater Western Flank ‘2’ represents the second phase of development of the core Greater Western Flank fields, behind the GWF-A development, and is located to the southwest of the existing Goodwyn A platform. Woodside is the operator and we own a 16.67 per cent share.

Exploration and appraisal

Our exploration strategy is to focus on material opportunities, at high working interest, with a bias for liquids and operatorship. While the majority of our expenditure occurs in our two principal areas of activity, the Gulf of Mexico and Western Australia, we also have exploration activities in Trinidad and Tobago, Brazil, South Africa, South East Asia, and Onshore US.

 

119


Table of Contents

Access

In FY2014, we gained access to acreage in Australia, Trinidad and Tobago, Brazil and the Gulf of Mexico region of the United States. In Australia, we farmed into Block 480-P in Western Australia (55 per cent working interest and operator; 12,585 square kilometres). In Trinidad and Tobago, we signed a production sharing contract on Block 23b (60 per cent working interest and operator; 2,579 square kilometres) and farmed into Blocks 23a and 14 (70 per cent working interest and operator; 3,597 square kilometres). In Brazil, we signed a contract on two blocks in the Foz do Amazonas (100 per cent working interest and operator; 3,069 square kilometres). In the Gulf of Mexico, we were awarded eight blocks (100 per cent working interest and operator; 186 square kilometres) after being the highest bidder on Lease Sale 227, held during the March 2013 quarter.

Exploration program expenditure details

In Western Australia, we drilled Bunyip-1 exploration well on Block WA-335P in February 2014 (52.5 per cent working interest and operator). The well discovered gas in the target Triassic Mungaroo section.

Also in Western Australia, we drilled several near field targets that may be tied back to our existing infrastructure. The first of these, Stybarrow East-1 (50 per cent working interest and operator) was spud in December 2013 and discovered a non-commercial quantity of hydrocarbons. A subsequent sidetrack, Stybarrow East-2, was a dry hole. Both wells were plugged and abandoned and costs were expensed. A secondary near field target, Rydal-1 (50 per cent working interest and operator) was drilled in January 2014. The well encountered non-commercial hydrocarbons and was subsequently plugged, abandoned and expensed.

In the Gulf of Mexico, following the discovery of oil in the Raptor-1 well in FY2013 (50 per cent working interest, APC operator), we participated in a sidetrack, which spud in the June 2013 quarter. The sidetrack failed to find hydrocarbons and the costs associated with both the Raptor discovery well and the subsequent sidetrack were expensed as a non-commercial discovery. In the September 2013 quarter, we drilled the Sake exploration well (60 per cent working interest and operator). The well was plugged, abandoned and the costs were expensed in September 2013.

During FY2014, our gross expenditure on exploration was US$600 million, of which US$369 million was expensed.

Exploration and appraisal wells drilled or in the process of drilling during the year:

 

Well

 

Location

 

Target

 

BHP Billiton
equity

 

Spud date

 

Water depth

 

Total well depth

 

Status

Stybarrow

East-1

 

Carnarvon

Basin

WA-32-L

  Oil  

50%

(Operator)

 

10 December

2013

  675 metres   2,533 metres  

Plugged and abandoned

Hydrocarbons encountered

Non-commercial

Stybarrow

East-2

 

Carnarvon

Basin

WA-32-L

  Oil  

50%

(Operator)

 

26 December

2013

  675 metres   2,670 metres  

Plugged and abandoned

Dry hole

Rydal-1

 

Carnarvon

Basin

WA-255P

  Oil  

50%

(Operator)

 

13 January

2014

  752 metres   3,268 metres  

Plugged and abandoned

Hydrocarbons encountered

Non-commercial

Bunyip-1

 

Carnarvon

Basin

WA-335P

  Gas  

52.5%

(Operator)

  4 February 2014   1,187 metres   4,579 metres  

Plugged and abandoned

Hydrocarbons encountered

Under evaluation

Raptor-1/ST-1

 

Gulf of Mexico

DC535

  Oil  

50%

(Anadarko Operator)

 

28 May

2013

  2,490 metres   6,348 metres  

Plugged and abandoned

Hydrocarbons encountered

Non-commercial

Sake-2

  Gulf of Mexico DC726   Oil  

60%

(Operator)

  4 August 2013   1,064 metres   5,597 metres  

Plugged and abandoned

Dry hole

 

120


Table of Contents

In Trinidad and Tobago, we farmed out a 35 per cent interest in Block 5 and 6 to BG International Limited in the June 2014 quarter. We have retained 65 per cent interest and operatorship. Also in Trinidad and Tobago, we commenced acquisition of a 17,719 square kilometre 3D seismic survey in the March 2014 quarter over our seven operated deepwater blocks (Blocks 5, 6, 28, 29, 23a, 23b and 14). We expect the survey to be completed in the first half of FY2015.

In South Africa, we hold the exploration rights to Block 3B/4B, which is located off the country’s west coast. In the September 2013 quarter, we acquired Global Energy Holdings LLC’s 10 per cent interest in the block, bringing our equity in Block 3B/4B to 100 per cent. During the past year we completed the processing of the 10,075 square kilometre 3D seismic survey that was acquired in FY2013. Evaluation of this survey is ongoing.

In India, we hold interests and operate nine offshore blocks acquired during the NELP VII & VIII licensing rounds. Due to the inability to gain unencumbered access to explore and produce hydrocarbons in these blocks we have notified the government of our intent to exit and are currently awaiting government approval. We have retained our 50 per cent non-operated interest (BG operator) in one deep water block acquired during the NELP IX licensing round. All exploration expenditure to date on India has been expensed.

In Malaysia, we relinquished our interest in Block Q in the March 2014 quarter. Also in Malaysia, we are planning acquisition of a 2,940 square kilometre 3D seismic survey over Block SK-2A. The survey is expected to commence in the first half of FY2015.

Following a strategic review in the first half of FY2014, we decided to exit the Philippines. In SC55, we have formally reassigned our 60 per cent interest and operatorship back to Otto. In SC59, we have reassigned our 75 per cent interest and operatorship to the Philippines National Oil Company (PNOC).

Drilling

The number of wells in the process of drilling and/or completion as of 30 June 2014 was as follows:

 

     Exploratory wells      Development wells      Total  
     Gross      Net (1)      Gross      Net (1)      Gross      Net (1)  

Australia

                     5         1         5         1   

United States

                     397         183         397         183   

Other

                     2         1         2         1   

Total

                     404         185         404         185   

 

(1)  Represents our share of the gross well count.

Delivery commitments

We have delivery commitments of natural gas and LNG of approximately 2,353 billion cubic feet through 2031 (74 per cent Australia, seven per cent US and 19 per cent Other) and crude, condensate, and NGL commitments of 15.0 million barrels through 2018 (55 per cent Australia, 43 per cent United States and two per cent Other). We have sufficient proved reserves and production capacity to fulfil these delivery commitments.

Primarily as a result of our recent acquisitions and asset purchases in our Onshore US shale asset, we have obligations for contracted capacity on transportation pipelines and gathering systems for which we are the shipper. We have obligations to gather and transport 1,400 billion cubic feet of natural gas and 23 million barrels of oil in FY2015. The agreements with the gas gatherers and transporters have annual escalation clauses.

Potash

Our Potash strategy is to build a material industry position over the long term.

 

121


Table of Contents

We hold exploration permits and mining leases, issued by the Government of Saskatchewan, covering more than 14,000 square kilometres of mineral rights in the province of Saskatchewan in Canada. We have progressively explored our permit areas over the past seven years and continue to evaluate their economic development potential. We are converting our exploration permits to long-term lease as these permits mature in order to enable further evaluation. To date, we have secured 4,400 square kilometres under long-term mining leases.

We continue to progress our Jansen Potash Project, a greenfield potash project, located approximately 140 kilometres east of Saskatoon in south-central Saskatchewan. We believe Jansen is the world’s best undeveloped potash resource and is likely to be a low-cost source of supply once fully developed. Investment in Jansen could underpin a potential fifth pillar of BHP Billiton, given the opportunity to develop a multi-decade, multi-mine basin in Saskatchewan.

On 20 August 2013, we announced an additional US$2.6 billion investment for Jansen, bringing total approved spending to US$3.8 billion. This investment is funding the excavation and lining of the Project’s production and service shafts, and the installation of essential surface infrastructure and utilities.

The level of expenditure on the Jansen Potash Project in FY2014 was US$596 million, which was lower than the annual instalment of US$800 million previously announced for FY2014. We suspended excavation of the production and service shafts in the December 2013 quarter to enable a thorough review of activities completed and to ensure all learnings were captured and adopted in future works. Shaft excavation resumed in the March 2014 quarter and progressed in a staggered manner to mitigate risk and optimise their development. As at 30 June 2014, the pre-development phase was 30 per cent complete.

During FY2014, we allowed our exclusivity for Terminal 5 at the Port of Vancouver to lapse. We are currently assessing a range of options to meet our port requirements.

With our investment premised on the attractive longer-term market fundamentals for potash, we will continue to modulate the pace of development as we seek to time our entrance to meet market demand. The introduction of one or more minority partners, consistent with our approach for certain of our other resource operations, will be considered at the appropriate time.

On the basis of our current projections and assuming Board approval, the Jansen Potash Project is likely to ramp-up to its nameplate capacity of approximately 10 Mtpa of agricultural grade potassium chloride (KCl) in the decade beyond 2020. The Government of Saskatchewan has issued a Potash Lease Special Agreement (KLSA) for our Jansen Project, which provides long-term security of tenure to allow the ongoing development and subsequent operation of Jansen for the life of the operation.

We are continuing to evaluate other areas for which we have exploration permits in the Saskatchewan potash basin, including Young, Boulder and Melville, through analysis of the extensive data collected from successive exploration programs.

In 2013, the management of the closed mine sites associated with Base Metals North America was transitioned from the Copper to the Potash Business. All locations are in care and maintenance or in various stages of closure.

2.1.2    Copper Business

Our Copper Business, headquartered in Santiago, Chile, is one of the world’s premier producers of copper, silver, lead and uranium, and is a leading producer of zinc. Our portfolio of mining operations includes the Escondida mine in Chile, the world’s largest single producer of copper, and Olympic Dam in South Australia, a major producer of copper and uranium. Our total copper production in FY2014 was 1.7 million tonnes (Mt). Our concentrate production, which represents 58 per cent of total production, results from flotation of sulphide ores mined at our Escondida and Antamina mines. Oxide ores and sulphide ores amenable to leaching are mined and

 

122


Table of Contents

processed into copper cathode, using conventional heap leaching, followed by solvent extraction and electrowinning processes at Escondida, Cerro Colorado and Spence. Copper cathode is also produced at Olympic Dam, where sulphide ores are processed through conventional flotation and the resulting concentrate is further transformed into cathodes through a smelting and refining process.

We market five primary products: copper cathodes, copper, lead and zinc concentrates and uranium oxide. We sell most of our copper cathode production to wire rod mills, brass mills and casting plants around the world under contracts with prices at premiums to the London Metal Exchange (LME) prices. We sell the majority of our uranium oxide to electricity generating utilities, principally in western Europe, North America and east Asia. Uranium is typically sold under a mix of long-term and short-term contracts. We sell most of our copper, lead and zinc concentrates to smelters located in diversified geographic markets such as China, South America, Japan, India and South Korea. Treatment charges and refining charges (collectively referred to as TCRCs) are negotiated with counterparties on a variety of tenors. Some of the ores we mine contain quantities of silver and gold, which remain in the base metal concentrates we sell and are typically subject to payment credits. We sell refined silver and gold from Olympic Dam.

Our five operating assets, which are located in South America and Australia, consist of the following:

Americas

Escondida

Our 57.5 per cent owned and operated Escondida mine is the largest producer of copper in the world. Located in the Atacama Desert in northern Chile, Escondida employs approximately 14,000 operational employees and contractors and has the capacity to move in excess of 1.3 Mt of material per day. Its two open-cut pits feed two concentrator plants, which use grinding and flotation technologies to produce copper concentrate, as well as two leaching operations (oxide and sulphide). In FY2014, our share of Escondida production was 485.7 kilotonnes (kt) of payable copper in concentrate and 177.1 kt of copper cathode. Escondida has a reserve life of 52 years.

The availability of key inputs like power and water at competitive prices is an important focus for our Copper Business. In November 2013, we awarded a long-term energy contract to a consortium consisting of Korea Southern Power Co. and Samsung Construction & Trading Corp. for the development and operation of a 517 MW combined-cycle gas-fired power plant in the town of Mejillones, Chile. The plant, which will be connected to the Northern Interconnected Grid (SING), will supply the increasing demand for electricity at our operations, and is expected to reduce our carbon footprint. Construction work commenced in 2014 with commercial operation expected in the second half of CY2016.

A contract for the supply of natural gas to the Kelar power plant has been finalised with first deliveries under the supply contract with Gas Natural Fenosa scheduled to commence in 2016, simultaneously with the commissioning and commercial operation of the plant.

To address limitations on the availability of water, we desalinate sea water and carefully manage our use and re-use of available water. The recently approved Escondida Water Supply (EWS) project, which involves the construction of a second desalination plant, will reduce our reliance on the region’s aquifers and help meet our environmental commitments. The EWS project is expected to be commissioned in 2017.

Pampa Norte

Pampa Norte consists of two operations – Spence and Cerro Colorado. Copper cathode is produced at both operations following a leaching, solvent extraction and electrowinning process.

Our wholly owned Spence copper mine is located in the Atacama Desert, 162 kilometres northeast of Antofagasta in Chile. During FY2014, Spence produced 152.8 kt of high quality copper cathode, using oxide and sulphide ore treatment through leaching, solvent extraction and electrowinning processes. Spence has a reserve life of 10 years.

 

123


Table of Contents

Our wholly owned Cerro Colorado mine, located in the Atacama Desert, 120 kilometres east of Iquique in Chile, remains a significant producer of copper cathode, although production levels have fallen in recent years as grades have declined. Despite this, production in FY2014 reached 80.3 kt of copper cathode. Cerro Colorado has a reserve life of nine years. The extension of the existing environmental and mining licences to continue to enable Cerro Colorado to operate beyond December 2016 is currently pending approval.

Antamina

We own 33.75 per cent of Antamina, a large, low-cost copper and zinc mine in north central Peru. Our share of Antamina’s FY2014 production was 143.5 kt of copper in concentrate and 52.0 kt of zinc in concentrate. Antamina also produces molybdenum and lead/bismuth concentrate, as well as small amounts of silver in the form of by-products. Antamina has a reserve life of 13 years.

In FY2013, Antamina completed execution of an expansion project, increasing milling capacity to 130 kilotonnes per day (ktpd). In FY2014, following identification of further milling capacity upside, Antamina commenced execution of a debottlenecking project, to increase milling capacity by 12 per cent to 145 ktpd.

Australia

Cannington

Our wholly owned Cannington mine is one of the world’s largest producers of silver and lead. Located in northwest Queensland, Australia, the underground mine feeds a beneficiation processing facility that extracts silver/lead and zinc concentrates from sulphide ore. In FY2014, Cannington produced concentrates containing186.5 kt of lead, 57.9 kt of zinc and approximately 25.2 million ounces of silver. Cannington has a reserve life of nine years.

Olympic Dam

Our wholly owned Olympic Dam mine is a producer of copper cathode and uranium oxide and a refiner of gold and silver bullion. The site includes an underground mine, where the primary method of ore extraction is long-hole open stoping with cemented aggregate fill, and an integrated metallurgical processing plant.

The underground mine extracts copper uranium ore and hauls the ore by an automated train and trucking network feeding underground crushing, storage and ore hoisting facilities. The processing plant consists of two grinding circuits in which high-quality copper concentrate is extracted from sulphide ore through a flotation extraction process. The operation includes a fully integrated metallurgical complex with a grinding and concentrating circuit, hydrometallurgical plant incorporating solvent extraction circuits for copper and uranium, a copper smelter, copper refinery and a recovery circuit for precious metals.

In FY2014, Olympic Dam produced 184.4 kt of copper cathode, 3,988 tonnes of uranium oxide, 121.3 fine kilo-ounces (koz) of refined gold and 972 koz of refined silver. Olympic Dam has a reserve life of 47 years.

Divested assets – Pinto Valley

In October 2013, we completed the sale of our Pinto Valley mining operation in the United States and the associated San Manuel Arizona Railroad Company to Capstone Mining Corp for US$653 million, after working capital adjustments.

As a consequence of the sale, and due to their location in North America, the management of 22 closed sites transferred from our Copper Business to our Potash Business. All locations are no longer actively producing and are in care and maintenance or in various stages of closure.

 

124


Table of Contents

Information on Copper mining operations

The following table contains additional details of our mining operations. This table should be read in conjunction with the production (refer to section 2.2.2) and reserve tables (refer to section 2.3.2).

 

Mine & location

 

Means of access

 

Ownership

 

Operator

  Title, leases or
options
 

History

 

Mine type &
mineralisation

style

 

Power

source

 

Facilities, use &
condition

Americas                
Copper                
Escondida                
Atacama Desert, 170 km southeast of Antofagasta, Chile  

Public road

 

Copper cathode transported by privately owned rail to ports at Antofagasta and Mejillones

 

Copper concentrate transported by Escondida-owned pipelines to its Coloso port facilities

 

BHP Billiton 57.5% of Minera Escondida Limitada (MEL)

 

Rio Tinto 30% JECO Corporation consortium comprising Mitsubishi, JX Nippon Mining and Metals 10% JECO2 Ltd 2.5%

  BHP Billiton   Mining
concession from
Chilean
Government
valid indefinitely
(subject to
payment of
annual fees)
 

Original construction completed in 1990

 

Sulphide leach copper production commenced in 2006

 

2 open-cut pits: Escondida and Escondida Norte

 

Escondida and Escondida Norte mineral deposits are adjacent but distinct supergene enriched porphyry copper deposits

 

Escondida-owned transmission lines connect to Chile’s northern power grid

 

Electricity purchased under contracts expiring 2016 and 2029

 

2 concentrator plants extract copper concentrate from sulphide ore by flotation extraction process

 

2 solvent extraction plants produce copper cathode

 

Nominal capacity: 85.6 Mtpa copper concentrate (nominal milling capacity) and 330 ktpa copper cathode (nominal capacity of tank house)

 

Two 168 km concentrate pipelines 166 km water pipeline

Port facilities at Coloso, Antofagasta

 

125


Table of Contents

Mine & location

 

Means of access

 

Ownership

 

Operator

  Title, leases or
options
 

History

 

Mine type &
mineralisation

style

 

Power

source

 

Facilities, use &
condition

Pampa Norte Spence                
Atacama Desert, 162 km northeast of Antofagasta, Chile  

Public road

 

Copper cathode transported by rail to ports at Mejillones and Antofagasta

  100%   BHP Billiton   Mining
concession from
Chilean
Government valid
indefinitely
(subject to
payment of
annual fees)
 

Development cost of US$1.1 billion approved in 2004

 

First copper produced in 2006

 

Open-cut

 

Enriched and oxidised porphyry copper deposit that presents dominantly in situ copper oxide mineralisation that overlies a near-horizontal sequence of supergene sulphide, transitional sulphide, and lower-most primary (hypogene) sulphide mineralisation

 

Spence-owned transmission lines connect to Chile’s northern power grid

 

Electricity purchased under contract

 

Processing and crushing facilities, separate dynamic (on-off) leach pads, solvent extraction plant, electrowinning plant

 

Nominal capacity of tank house: 170 ktpa copper cathode

Pampa Norte Cerro Colorado                
Atacama Desert, 120 km east of Iquique, Chile  

Public road

 

Copper cathode trucked to port at Iquique

  100%   BHP Billiton   Mining concession
from Chilean
Government valid
indefinitely
(subject to
payment of
annual fees)
 

Commercial production commenced in 1994

 

Expansions in 1996 and 1998

 

Open-cut

 

Enriched and oxidised porphyry copper deposit that presents dominantly in situ copper oxide mineralisation that overlies a near-horizontal sequence of supergene sulphide, transitional sulphide, and lower-most primary (hypogene) sulphide mineralisation

  Long-term contracts with northern Chile power grid  

2 primary, secondary and tertiary crushers, leaching pads, solvent extraction plant, electrowinning plant

 

Nominal capacity of tank house: 86 ktpa copper cathode

 

126


Table of Contents

Mine & location

 

Means of access

 

Ownership

 

Operator

  Title, leases or
options
 

History

 

Mine type &
mineralisation

style

 

Power

source

 

Facilities, use &
condition

Copper and zinc                
Antamina
Andes mountain range, 270 km north of Lima, north central Peru  

Public road

 

Copper and zinc concentrates transported by pipeline to port of Huarmey

 

Molybdenum and lead/bismuth concentrates transported by truck

 

BHP Billiton 33.75% of Compañía Minera Antamina SA

 

Glencore Xstrata 33.75%

Teck 22.5% Mitsubishi 10%

 

Compañía Minera Antamina SA

  Mining rights
from Peruvian
Government held
indefinitely,
subject to
payment of
annual fees and
supply of
information on
investment and
production
 

Commercial production commenced in 2001

 

Capital cost US$2.3 billion (100%)

 

Open-cut

 

Zoned porphyry and skarn deposit with central copper-only ores and an outer band of copper-zinc ore zone

  Long-term contracts with individual power producers  

Primary crusher, concentrator, copper and zinc flotation circuits, bismuth/moly cleaning circuit

 

Nominal milling capacity 52 Mtpa

 

300 km concentrate pipeline Port facilities at Huarmey

Australia                
Silver, lead and zinc                
Cannington
200 km southeast of Mt Isa, Queensland, Australia  

Public road and Group-owned airstrip

 

Product trucked to Yurbi, then by rail to public port

  100%   BHP Billiton   Mining leases
granted by
Queensland
Government
expire in 2029
  Concentrate production commenced in 1997, subsequent projects improved mill throughput and metal recovery   Underground Broken Hill-type silver-lead-zinc sulphide deposit   On-site power station operated under contract  

Beneficiation plant: primary and secondary grinding circuits, pre-flotation circuits, flotation circuits, leaching circuits, concentrate filtration circuit, paste plant

 

Nominal milling capacity: 3.4 Mtpa

 

127


Table of Contents

Mine & location

 

Means of access

 

Ownership

 

Operator

  Title, leases or
options
 

History

 

Mine type &
mineralisation

style

 

Power

source

 

Facilities, use &
condition

Copper and uranium                
Olympic Dam
560 km northwest of Adelaide, South Australia  

Public road

 

Copper cathode trucked to ports

Uranium oxide transported by road to ports

  100%   BHP Billiton   Mining lease
granted by South
Australian
Government
expires in 2036

 

Right of
extension for
50 years (subject
to remaining
mine life)

 

Acquired in 2005 as part of WMC acquisition

 

Copper production began in 1988

 

Nominal milling capacity raised to 9 Mtpa in 1999

 

Optimisation project completed in 2002

 

New copper solvent extraction plant commissioned in 2004

 

Underground

 

Large poly-metallic deposit of iron oxide-copper-uranium-gold mineralisation

  Supplied via 275 kV power line from Port Augusta, transmitted by ElectraNet  

Underground automated train and trucking network feeding crushing, storage and ore hoisting facilities

 

2 grinding circuits

 

Nominal milling capacity: 10.3 Mtpa

 

Flash furnace produces copper anodes, then refined to produce copper cathodes (1)

 

(1)  Electrowon copper cathode and uranium oxide concentrate produced by leaching and solvent extracting flotation tailings.

 

128


Table of Contents

Development projects

Americas

Escondida

The Organic Growth Project 1 (OGP1), is the replacement project for the Los Colorados concentrator with a new 152 ktpd plant. This project is in execution. We expect this project to provide additional processing capacity and allow access to high-grade ore. OGP1 was approved in February 2012 with budgeted expenditure of US$3.8 billion (US$2.2 billion BHP Billiton share). Project completion is targeted for the first half of CY2015. Work on OGP1 was 79 per cent complete at 30 June 2014.

We announced the Escondida Water Supply project (EWS) in July 2013, which consists of a new 2,500 litres per second sea water desalination facility. This project will provide an alternative water supply to Escondida, as water usage increases upon completion of the 152 ktpd OGP1 copper concentrator. Construction of the new desalination facility commenced in July 2013 and includes the development of two pipelines, four high-pressure pump stations, a reservoir at the mine site and high-voltage infrastructure to support the system. The new facility is expected to be commissioned in 2017 at a cost of US$3.4 billion (US$2.0 billion BHP Billiton share). Prior to completion of the EWS project, water supply for OGP1 will continue to be sourced from aquifers and the existing 500 litres per second desalinisation plant.

The Oxide Leach Area Project (OLAP), is also in execution phase. This project involves the creation of a new dynamic leaching pad and mineral handling system that will include several overland conveyors. The new pad is expected to maintain oxide leaching capacity at current levels following the exhaustion of the existing heap leach in CY2014. OLAP was approved in February 2012 with budgeted expenditure of US$721 million (US$414 million BHP Billiton share). A US$212 million increase in the budget of OLAP to US$933 million (US$536 million BHP Billiton share) was approved in March 2014. Work on the project was 93 per cent complete at 30 June 2014, and is expected to be completed in the second half of CY2014.

Pampa Norte

The Spence Growth Option (SGO) project, currently being studied in pre-feasibility stage, plans to exploit the hypogene sulphide resource with associated molybdenum sulphide by building a 95 ktpd concentrator at the current Spence operation. SGO would extend the mine life by 50 years following the current 2025 closure date. As the hypogene ore underlies the supergene reserves currently being exploited, the need for pre-stripping and additional mine maintenance infrastructure is minimised. The option of using existing solvent extraction and electrowinning infrastructure to recover copper by leaching low-grade chalcopyrite ores in parallel to the concentrator is also being considered. SGO would increase the overall copper production at Spence by approximately 220 kilotonnes per annum (ktpa) in the first 10 years.

Olympic Dam

A pre-feasibility study is being conducted regarding the proposed expansion of Olympic Dam. The objective of the study is to identify the full range of development path alternatives for Olympic Dam by investigating all possible mining methods and less capital-intensive designs, including new technologies.

In July 2014, we lodged an application for assessment by the Australian and South Australian Governments to construct and operate a demonstration plant on the existing mining lease at Olympic Dam. This process would enable heap leaching trials to progress to the next phase as part of our efforts to identify an alternative, less capital intensive process for extracting metals from ore mined underground. Should Government and Board approvals be granted, construction of the demonstration plant is expected to commence in the second half of CY2015. A trial period of 36 months is envisaged, commencing in late 2016.

 

129


Table of Contents

Resolution Copper

We hold a 45 per cent interest in the Resolution Copper project in the US state of Arizona, a project which is operated by Rio Tinto (55 per cent interest). Resolution is among the top 10 largest undeveloped copper assets in the world and could eventually become the largest copper producer in North America. In FY2014, Resolution Copper completed a pre-feasibility study into a 120 ktpd underground panel cave operation and processing facility. Further opportunities to economically optimise the project and minimise any technical risks have been identified, and the project plans to study these opportunities. Additionally, a Mine Plan of Operations was submitted to the U.S. Forest Service in November 2013. Approval of the plan would allow mining to occur on lands where the Company currently holds mineral title.

Throughout FY2014, Resolution Copper continued to advance sinking of the No #10 Shaft to gain access to the orebody. Following cooling and ventilation upgrades during FY2014, No #10 Shaft is expected to reach a final depth of 2,116 metres by December 2014. Our share of project expenditure for FY2014 was US$38 million.

Exploration activities

Our greenfield copper exploration activities during FY2014 were focused on advancing targets within Chile and Peru. Greenfield activities include opportunity identification, application for and acquisition of mineral title, early reconnaissance operations and drilling programs.

2.1.3    Iron Ore Business

Our Iron Ore Business is one of the leading iron ore producers in the world. We sell lump and fines products produced in Australia and pellets from our operations in Brazil.

Our two assets consist of the following:

Western Australia Iron Ore

Operations at Western Australia Iron Ore (WAIO) involve an integrated system of mines and more than 1,000 kilometres of rail infrastructure and port facilities in the Pilbara region of northern Western Australia, with our headquarters located in Perth. Our focus is to safely maximise output through operating our mines and utilising available infrastructure at our disposal. This includes our plan to continue to grow production following the recent completion of a number of expansion projects and ongoing debottlenecking of the supply chain to underpin potential further growth in capacity to 290 Mtpa.

We have expanded our WAIO operations in response to increasing demand for iron ore, particularly from China. Since 2001, we have completed eight expansion projects to increase our mine, rail and port capacity. Our share of FY2014 production was 193 Mt of ore, which is expected to increase in FY2015 to 211 Mtpa.

We have been transitioning to owner-operated mines since September 2011 when we acquired the HWE Mining subsidiaries from Leighton Holdings. We completed the transition to owner-operated mines with the last contractor run site, Orebody 18, finalising its transition during FY2014.

Our Pilbara reserve base is relatively concentrated, allowing us to plan our development around a series of integrated mining hubs joined to the orebodies by conveyors or spur lines. This approach enables us to maximise the value of installed infrastructure by using the same processing plant and rail infrastructure for a number of orebodies.

Lump and fines products are sold to steel mills in China, South Korea, Japan, Singapore, Hong Kong, Taiwan, Switzerland and Australia under long-term and short-term contracts. Contract prices are generally linked to market indices.

 

130


Table of Contents

In order to establish a consistent, long-term, high-quality lump ore product with a stable grade, we recently transitioned to a blended lump product. The product is a blend of lump ores produced from the Newman, Area C and Jimblebar mining areas, known as Newman Blend lump. During FY2014, 23 per cent of our sales were lump and 77 per cent were fines.

WAIO operations

Our WAIO operations consist of four main joint ventures: Mt Newman, Yandi, Mt Goldsworthy and Jimblebar. Our interest in the joint ventures is 85 per cent with Mitsui and ITOCHU owning the remaining 15 per cent. The joint ventures are unincorporated except Jimblebar, where we diluted our interest in a subsidiary company to 85 per cent in July 2013 for which BHP Billiton received total consideration of US$1.5 billion.

The Mt Newman Joint Venture (JV) consists of a number of orebodies joined by conveyors and spur lines to a mining hub at Mt Whaleback. Ore is crushed, beneficiated (where necessary) and blended to create the Newman Blend for lump and fines. The ore is then transported to port using Mt Newman JV-owned rail facilities. The Yandi JV comprises the Yandi mine where ore is crushed and screened and then transported by rail on the Newman main line. The Mt Goldsworthy JV consists of the Area C mine in the central Pilbara and the Yarrie mine in northern Pilbara. Ore is crushed and screened at Area C and transported by rail to the hub at Mt Whaleback. Production at Yarrie was suspended on 25 February 2014, following improved productivity at our other mining operations. The Jimblebar operation was officially opened on 23 April 2014 and comprises the new Jimblebar mine located 40 kilometres east of Newman. Jimblebar delivered first production in the September 2013 quarter and produced 9 Mt during FY2014. Jimblebar is expected to deliver phase one capacity of 35 Mtpa by the end of FY2015. Production from Wheelarra, a sublease of the Jimblebar tenement, which was previously processed through Newman, was permanently connected to the Jimblebar processing hub during the period.

All ore is transported by rail on the Mt Newman JV and Mt Goldsworthy JV rail lines to our port facilities. A typical train configuration consists of two locomotives per 124 ore cars, called a rake, with two rakes per train. Each individual ore car carries approximately 128 tonnes of iron ore. Our rail operations are controlled from Perth via our integrated remote operations centre which co-locates rail control, port production control, mine dispatch control and mine fixed plant control.

Our port facilities are located on both sides of the harbour at Port Hedland. These facilities consist of Nelson Point, owned by the Mt Newman JV, and Finucane Island, owned by the Mt Goldsworthy JV. The port facilities include five ore car dumpers, three screening plants, nine stackers, five reclaimers, stock and blending yards, and eight ship loaders. Vessels depart the harbour via a dredged channel that is approximately 45 kilometres long and has a width of 300 metres.

 

131


Table of Contents

Map of WAIO operations

 

LOGO

Along with the other joint venture partners, we have entered into marketing agreements in the form of joint ventures with certain customers. These customer joint ventures, JW4, Wheelarra and POSMAC, involve subleases of part of WAIO’s existing mineral leases. The ore is sold to the existing joint ventures with contractual terms applying to the customers’ share. As a consequence, we are entitled to 85 per cent of production from these subleases and the customer joint ventures are not jointly controlled operations for accounting purposes.

WAIO Mineral Resources and Ore Reserves are reported for the Pilbara as a whole by ore type, to reflect our production of the Newman Blend lump product and our single logistics chain and associated management system. The reserve life of our Western Australian mines is 16 years.

Samarco

We are a 50–50 joint venture partner with Vale at the Samarco operation in Brazil. Samarco is currently comprised of a mine and two concentrators located in the state of Minas Gerais, and three pellet plants and a port located in Anchieta in the state of Espirito Santo. Three 396-kilometre pipelines connect the mine site to the pelletising facilities.

Samarco’s main product is iron ore pellets. Extraction and beneficiation of iron ore is conducted at the Germano facilities in the municipalities of Mariana and Ouro Preto. Conveyor systems are used to extract the ore and convey it from the mines. Ore beneficiation then occurs in concentrators, where crushing, milling, desliming and flotation processes produce iron concentrate. The concentrate leaves the concentrators as slurry and is pumped through the slurry pipelines from the Germano facilities to the pellet plants in Ubu, Anchieta, where the slurry is processed into pellets. The iron ore pellets are then heat treated. The pellet output is stored in a stockpile yard before being shipped out of the Samarco-owned Port of Ubu in Anchieta.

 

132


Table of Contents

Pellets are independently marketed by Samarco and sold to steelmakers in 20 countries in the Americas, Asia, Africa, the Middle East and Europe, with prices generally linked to market indices.

In FY2014, our share of production was 11 Mt of pellets. The reserve life of Samarco is 39 years.

 

133


Table of Contents

Information on Iron Ore mining operations

The following table contains additional details of our mining operations. This table should be read in conjunction with the production (refer to section 2.2.2) and reserve tables (refer to section 2.3.2).

 

Mine & location

 

Means of

access

 

Ownership

 

Operator

 

Title, leases or

options

 

History

 

Mine type &
mineralisation

style

 

Power

source

 

Facilities, use &
condition

Iron ore

Mt Newman Joint Venture                

Pilbara region, Western Australia

 

Mt Whaleback Orebodies 18, 24, 25, 29, 30 and 35

 

Private road

 

Iron ore transported by Mt Newman JV-owned rail to Port Hedland (427 km)

 

BHP Billiton 85%

 

Mitsui ITOCHU Iron 10% ITOCHU Minerals and Energy of Australia 5%

 

BHP Billiton:

Mt Whaleback Orebodies 18, 24, 25, 29, 30 and 35

 

Operatorship of Orebody 18 transitioned to BHP Billiton in July 2014

  Mining lease under the Iron Ore (Mt Newman) Agreement Act 1964 expires in 2030 with right to successive renewals of 21 years  

Production began at Mt Whaleback orebody in 1969

 

Production from Orebodies 18, 24, 25, 29, 30 and 35 complements production from Mt Whaleback

 

First ore from Newman Hub as part of RGP4 construction delivered in 2009

 

Open-cut

 

Bedded ore types classified as per host Archaean or Proterozoic iron formation, which are Brockman and Marra Mamba

  From May 2014 Yarnima power station started supplying approximately two thirds of power, with a supplementary contract with Alinta Dewap Newman power station  

Newman Hub: primary and secondary crushing and screening plants (nominal capacity 60 Mtpa); heavy media beneficiation plant, stockyard blending facility, single cell rotary car dumper, train-loading facility

 

Orebody 25: primary and secondary crushing and screening plant (nominal capacity 10 Mtpa)

Yandi Joint Venture                
Pilbara region, Western Australia  

Private road

 

Iron ore transported by Mt Newman JV-owned rail to Port Hedland (316 km)

 

Yandi JV’s railway spur links Yandi mine to Newman main line

 

BHP Billiton 85%

Mitsui Iron Ore Corporation 7% ITOCHU Minerals and Energy of Australia 8%

  BHP Billiton   Mining lease under the Iron Ore (Marillana Creek) Agreement Act 1991 expires in 2033 with one renewal right to a further 21 years  

Development began in 1991

 

First shipment in 1992

 

Capacity expanded between 1994 and 2013

 

Open-cut

 

Channel Iron Deposits are Cainozoic fluvial sediments

  From May 2014 Yarnima power station started supplying approximately two thirds of power, with a supplementary contract with Alinta Dewap Newman power station  

Three processing plants, primary crusher and overland conveyor (nominal capacity 78 Mtpa)

Ore delivered to two train-loading facilities

 

134


Table of Contents

Mine & location

 

Means of

access

 

Ownership

 

Operator

 

Title, leases or

options

 

History

 

Mine type &
mineralisation

style

 

Power

source

 

Facilities, use &
condition

JW4 Joint Venture                
Pilbara region, Western Australia  

Private road

 

Iron ore on-sold to Yandi JV, then transported via rail to Finucane Island and Nelson Point shipping facilities, Port Hedland

 

BHP Billiton 68%

 

ITOCHU Minerals and Energy of Australia 6.4% Mitsui Iron Ore Corporation 5.6%

JFE Steel Australia 20%

 

Sublease agreement over JW4 deposit

  BHP Billiton   Sublease over part of the mining lease under the Iron Ore (Marillana Creek) Agreement Act 1991 expires in 2033 with one renewal right for a further 21 years  

Operations began in April 2006

 

Ore currently being produced is sold to Yandi JV and blended with Yandi ore

 

Open-cut

 

Channel Iron Deposits are Cainozoic fluvial sediments

  From May 2014 Yarnima power station started supplying approximately two thirds of power, with a supplementary contract with Alinta Dewap Newman power station   Mine site
Jimblebar operation                
Pilbara region, Western Australia   Private road  

BHP Billiton 85%

 

ITOCHU Minerals and Energy of Australia 8%, Mitsui Iron Ore Corporation 7%

  BHP Billiton   Mining lease under the Iron Ore (McCamey’s Monster) Agreement Authorisation Act 1972 expires in 2030 with rights to successive renewals of 21 years  

Production at Jimblebar began in March 1989

 

From 2004, production was transferred to Wheelarra as part of the Wheelarra sublease agreement

 

First ore from newly commissioned Jimblebar mine was delivered in September 2013

 

Open-cut

 

Bedded ore types classified as per host Archaean or Proterozoic banded iron formation, which are Brockman and Marra Mamba

  From May 2014 Yarnima power station started supplying approximately two thirds of power, with a supplementary contract with Alinta Dewap Newman power station   Two primary and secondary crusher, ore handling plant, stockyards and supporting mining hub infrastructure (nominal capacity 55 Mtpa)

 

135


Table of Contents

Mine & location

 

Means of

access

 

Ownership

 

Operator

 

Title, leases or

options

 

History

 

Mine type &
mineralisation

style

 

Power

source

 

Facilities, use &
condition

Wheelarra Joint Venture                
Pilbara region, Western Australia  

Private road

 

Rail spur line to Newman Hub closed and iron ore is now transported via conveyor to Jimblebar mine (6 km)

 

BHP Billiton 51%

 

ITOCHU Minerals and Energy of Australia 4.8% Mitsui Iron Ore Corporation 4.2% Maanshan Iron & Steel Australia 10%

Shagang Australia 10%

Hebei Iron & Steel Australia 10%

Wugang Australia 10%

 

Sublease agreement over Wheelarra deposit

 

BHP Billiton

Operatorship transitioned to BHP Billiton in January 2014

 

Sublease agreement over the Wheelarra deposit of Jimblebar lease with ITOCHU Minerals and Energy of Australia, Mitsui Iron Ore and four separate subsidiaries of Chinese steelmakers

This arrangement, entitles us to 85% of production from the Wheelarra sublease consistent with BHP Billiton ownership in Mt Newman JV

 

Wheelarra JV produces iron ore from Wheelarra deposit of Jimblebar lease

 

Ore produced is processed and blended with Jimblebar ore at Jimblebar mine and then sold to Mt Newman JV

 

Open-cut

 

Bedded ore types classified as per host Archaean or Proterozoic banded iron formation, which is Brockman

  From May 2014 Yarnima power station started supplying approximately two thirds of power, with a supplementary contract with Alinta Dewap Newman power station   Two primary and secondary crusher, ore handling plant, stockyards and supporting mining hub infrastructure (nominal capacity 55 Mtpa)

 

136


Table of Contents

Mine & location

 

Means of

access

 

Ownership

 

Operator

 

Title, leases or

options

 

History

 

Mine type &
mineralisation

style

 

Power

source

 

Facilities, use &
condition

Mt Goldsworthy Joint Venture                

Pilbara region, Western Australia

 

Area C Yarrie Nimingarra

 

Private road

 

Yarrie and Nimingarra iron ore transported by Mt Goldsworthy JV-owned rail to Port Hedland (218 km)

 

Area C iron ore transported by Mt Newman JV-owned rail to Port Hedland (360 km) Mt Goldsworthy JV railway spur links Area C mine to Yandi railway spur

 

BHP Billiton 85%

 

Mitsui Iron Ore Corporation 7% ITOCHU Minerals and Energy of Australia 8%

  BHP Billiton  

4 mineral leases under the Iron Ore (Mt Goldsworthy) Agreement Act 1964 and the Iron Ore (Goldsworthy – Nimingarra) Agreement Act 1972, expire between 2014 and 2028, with rights to successive renewals of 21 years

 

A number of smaller mining leases granted under the Mining Act 1978 expire in 2026

 

Operations commenced at Mt Goldsworthy in 1966 and at Shay Gap in 1973

 

Original Goldsworthy mine closed in 1982

 

Associated Shay Gap mine closed in 1993

 

Mining at Nimingarra mine ceased in 2007, then continued from adjacent Yarrie area

 

Opened Area C mine in 2003

 

Yarrie mine suspended operations in February 2014

 

Area C, Yarrie and Nimingarra all open-cut

 

Bedded ore types classified as per host Archaean or Proterozoic iron formation, which are Brockman, Marra Mamba and Nimingarra

  From May 2014 Yarnima power station started supplying approximately two thirds of power, with a supplementary contract with Alinta Dewap Newman power station  

Ore processing plant, primary crusher and overland conveyor

(nominal capacity: 50 Mtpa)

POSMAC Joint Venture                
Pilbara Region, Western Australia  

Private road

 

Iron ore on-sold to Mt Goldsworthy JV, it is then transported via Mt Goldsworthy JV-owned rail and Mt Newman JV-owned rail to Port Hedland

 

BHP Billiton 65%

 

ITOCHU Minerals and Energy of Australia 8%, Mitsui Iron Ore Corporation 7%

POSCO 20% Sublease agreement over POSMAC deposit

  BHP Billiton   Sublease over part of mineral lease held by Mt Goldsworthy JV under the Iron Ore (Mt Goldsworthy) Agreement Act 1964 with rights to successive renewals of 21 years  

Operations commenced in October 2003

 

Iron ore currently being produced is sold to Mt Goldsworthy JV and blended with Area C ore

 

Open-cut

 

Bedded ore types classified as per host Archaean or Proterozoic iron formation, which is Marra Mamba

  From May 2014 Yarnima power station started supplying approximately two thirds of power, with a supplementary contract with Alinta Dewap Newman power station  

Ore processing plant, primary crusher and overland conveyor

(nominal capacity: 50 Mtpa)

 

137


Table of Contents

Mine & location

 

Means of

access

 

Ownership

 

Operator

 

Title, leases or

options

 

History

 

Mine type &
mineralisation

style

 

Power

source

 

Facilities, use &
condition

Samarco                
Southeast Brazil  

Public road

 

Conveyor belts transport iron ore to beneficiation plant

 

Three slurry pipelines transport concentrate to pellet plants on coast

 

Iron pellets exported via port facilities

 

BHP Billiton 50% of Samarco Mineração SA

 

Vale 50%

  Samarco   Mining concessions granted by Brazilian Government as long as Alegria complex mined according to agreed plan  

Production began at Germano mine in 1977 and at Alegria complex in 1992

 

Second pellet plant built in 1997

 

Third pellet plant, second concentrator and second pipeline built in 2008

 

Fourth pellet plant, third concentrator and third pipeline built in 2014

 

Open-cut

 

Itabirites (metamorphic quartz-hematite rock) and friable hematite ores

 

Samarco holds interests in 2 hydroelectric power plants which supply 20.3% of its electricity

 

Power supply contract with Cemig Geração e Transmissão expires in 2022

  Facilities with capacity to process and pump 24 Mtpa ore concentrate and produce and ship 22.3 Mtpa pellets (100% basis)

 

138


Table of Contents

Development projects

Western Australia Iron Ore

WAIO has been executing a number of expansion projects in recent years. These projects, approved in March 2011 for a total of US$7.4 billion (BHP Billiton share US$6.6 billion) plus pre-commitment funding of US$2.3 billion (BHP Billiton share US$2.1 billion), were designed to deliver an integrated operation with a minimum capacity of 220 Mtpa (100 per cent basis).

These projects included:

 

  the Jimblebar Mine Expansion project to develop the Jimblebar mine and rail links, and procure mining equipment and rolling stock in order to deliver a capacity of 35 Mtpa. Initial production was achieved in the September 2013 quarter. The project costs as at 30 June 2014 amounted to US$3.4 billion (BHP Billiton share); final costs are expected to be delivered below the revised budget of US$3.6 billion;

 

  further development of Port Hedland, including two additional berths and ship loaders, a car dumper, connecting conveyor route, and associated rail works and rolling stock. Initial production was achieved in the December 2012 quarter. The project costs as at 30 June 2014 amounted to US$1.7 billion (BHP Billiton share); final costs are expected to be delivered below the revised budget of US$1.9 billion;

 

  port blending facilities and rail yards to enable ore blending and expand resource life. Initial production was achieved in the December 2013 quarter. The project costs as at 30 June 2014 amounted to US$0.9 billion (BHP Billiton share); final costs are expected to be delivered below the revised budget of US$1 billion.

Western Australia Iron Ore – Orebody 24 mine

In FY2014, WAIO completed execution of its development of the Orebody 24 mine, located approximately 10 kilometres northeast of Newman. Orebody 24 is a sustaining mine to maintain iron ore production output from the Mt Newman JV operations. The project was approved in November 2011 and included the construction of an ore crushing plant, train loadout facility, rail spur and other associated support facilities. The project was delivered at a cost of US$0.5 billion (BHP Billiton share), subject to finalisation, in the September 2014 quarter versus a budget of US$0.7 billion.

Samarco

During FY2011, Samarco shareholders approved a US$3.5 billion (US$1.75 billion BHP Billiton share) expansion project, the Fourth Pellet Plant Project (P4P), consisting of a fourth pellet plant, a new concentrator and a third slurry pipeline. The project is complete, with its first pellet production in March 2014. This has expanded Samarco’s iron ore pellet production capacity from 22.3 Mtpa to 30.5 Mtpa. The final cost of the project was US$3.2 billion (US$1.6 billion BHP Billiton share).

Exploration activities

Western Australia

WAIO has a substantial existing reserve base supported by considerable additional mineralisation all within a 250-kilometre radius of our existing infrastructure. This concentration of orebodies also gives WAIO the flexibility to add growth tonnes to existing hub infrastructure and link brownfield developments to our existing mainline rail and port facilities. The total area covered by exploration and mining tenure amounts to 6,500 square kilometres. This excludes crown leases, and general purpose and miscellaneous licences, which are used for infrastructure space and access.

The majority of deposits are located on five main lease areas held by BHP Billiton and our joint venture partners, as appropriate. Iron ore mineralised materials fall mainly within the Hamersley Ranges of the Pilbara district, with a minor component of the inventory lying within the Pilbara Craton of northwest Western Australia.

 

139


Table of Contents

In FY2014, exploration activity was completed over multiple project areas and deposits. The total drilling carried out amounts to 492,000 metres, composed of reverse circulation drilling of 421,500 metres, diamond drilling of 52,500 metres and hydrology drilling of 18,000 metres consisting of approximately 5,300 drill holes. Total exploration expenditure amounted to US$166 million.

Guinea Iron Ore

BHP Billiton has a 41.3 per cent interest in a joint venture that holds the Nimba Mining Concession and four iron ore prospecting permits in southeast Guinea.

On 29 July 2014, BHP Billiton and ArcelorMittal signed an agreement for the acquisition by ArcelorMittal of BHP Billiton’s 43.5 per cent stake in Euronimba Limited, which holds an effective 95 per cent interest in the Mount Nimba iron ore project in Guinea. Completion of the transaction is subject to the receipt of regulatory approval and other customary closing conditions.

Liberia Iron Ore

BHP Billiton has a 100 per cent interest in a Mineral Development Agreement with the Government of Liberia. This enables the further exploration and development of our Liberian iron ore mineral leases.

2.1.4    Coal Business

Our Coal Business, headquartered in Brisbane, Australia, is the world’s largest supplier of seaborne metallurgical coal, a key input in steel production. Our Coal Business is also one of the largest suppliers of seaborne energy coal (also known as thermal or steaming coal) and a significant domestic energy coal supplier in the countries where its mines are located.

Our export metallurgical coal customers are steel producers around the world, principally in China, India, Japan and Europe. In FY2014, the majority of our metallurgical coal sales contracts were based on annual volumes, with prices largely negotiated on a monthly, index or spot basis.

We are a domestic supplier of energy coal to the electricity generation industry in Australia, South Africa and the United States. Our domestic energy sales are generally made to nearby power stations under long-term fixed price or cost plus arrangements. Export sales are delivered to power generators and industrial users principally in China, India, Japan, Europe and the Middle East, under contracts that are generally index linked or short-term fixed.

Total metallurgical coal production in FY2014 was 45.1 Mt and total energy coal production in FY2014 was 73.5 Mt.

Our assets, located in Australia, South Africa, Colombia and the United States, consist of both open-cut and underground mines. At our open-cut mines, overburden is removed after blasting, using either draglines or truck and shovel. Coal is then extracted using excavators or loaders and loaded onto trucks to be taken to stockpiles. At our underground mines, coal is extracted by either longwall or continuous miner. The coal is then transported to stockpiles on the surface by conveyor. Coal from stockpiles is then crushed, and for a number of the operations, washed and processed through the coal preparation plant. Domestic coal is then transported to the nearby customer via conveyor, truck or rail. Export coal is transported to the port via trucks or trains, and as part of this coal supply chain both single and multi-user rail and port infrastructure is used.

 

140


Table of Contents

Our assets consist of the following:

Queensland Coal

Queensland Coal comprises the BHP Billiton Mitsubishi Alliance (BMA) and BHP Billiton Mitsui Coal (BMC) Assets in the Bowen Basin in Central Queensland, Australia.

The Bowen Basin is well positioned to supply the seaborne market because of its high-quality metallurgical coals, which are ideally suited to efficient blast furnace operations, and its geographical proximity to Asian customers. We have access to key infrastructure in the Bowen Basin, including a modern, multi-user rail network, our own coal loading terminal at Hay Point, located near the city of Mackay. We also have contracted capacity at three other multi-user port facilities including the Port of Gladstone (RG Tanna Coal Terminal), Dalrymple Bay Coal Terminal and Abbot Point Coal Terminal.

Map of Queensland Coal

 

LOGO

BHP Billiton Mitsubishi Alliance

BMA comprises two unincorporated joint ventures – Central Queensland Coal Associates Joint Venture (CQCA) and Gregory Joint Venture. We share 50–50 ownership with Mitsubishi Development.

BMA owns and operates open-cut and underground metallurgical coal mines in the Bowen Basin and also owns and operates the Hay Point Coal Terminal. The terminal consists of coal inloading dump stations, stacker reclaimers and two ship loaders, capable of loading 44 Mtpa of coal. The terminal is undergoing expansion to increase its capacity to 55 Mtpa through the addition of a third ship loader. This infrastructure enables us to blend products from multiple mines of BMA to optimise the value of our production and to satisfy customer requirements.

 

141


Table of Contents

BMA operates the Goonyella Riverside, Broadmeadow, Daunia, Caval Ridge, Peak Downs, Saraji, Gregory Crinum and Blackwater mines. In May 2012, production ceased at Norwich Park mine, following a review of the mine’s viability. In October 2012, production also ceased at the Gregory open-cut mine, part of the Gregory Crinum complex. First production commenced at Caval Ridge in the June 2014 quarter.

Our share of total production in FY2014 was 29.3 Mt. Production figures for BMA include some energy coal (less than three per cent). The reserve lives of our mines range from 2.8 years at Gregory Crinum to 37 years at Saraji. The reserve life for each mine is set out in section 2.3.2.

BHP Billiton Mitsui Coal

BMC is a subsidiary company owned by BHP Billiton (80 per cent) and Mitsui and Co (20 per cent). BMC owns and operates South Walker Creek and Poitrel, both open-cut metallurgical coal mines in the Bowen Basin.

Total production in FY2014 was 8.3 Mt. The reserve lives of our mines are 15 years at Poitrel and 11 years at South Walker Creek. The reserve life for each mine is set out in section 2.3.2.

Illawarra Coal

Our wholly owned Illawarra Coal Asset owns and operates three underground coal mines – Appin, West Cliff and Dendrobium, in the Illawarra region of New South Wales, Australia. The mines supply metallurgical coal to the nearby BlueScope Port Kembla steelworks and to other domestic and export markets. The Appin mine is currently being developed to sustain Illawarra Coal’s production following the end of the mine life at West Cliff.

Coal is exported via the Port Kembla Coal Terminal, in which we own a 16.67 per cent interest. Total production in FY2014 was 7.5 Mt. Production figures for Illawarra Coal include some energy coal (approximately 20 per cent). The reserve lives of our mines range from 2.0 years at West Cliff to 25 years at Appin. The reserve life for each mine is set out in section 2.3.2.

Energy Coal South Africa

Energy Coal South Africa (known as BECSA) operates four energy coal mines – Khutala, Klipspruit, Middelburg and Wolvekrans, in the Witbank region in the province of Mpumalanga, South Africa.

BECSA is 90 per cent owned by BHP Billiton, two per cent owned by its employees through an Employee Share Ownership Plan (ESOP) and eight per cent owned by a Broad-Based Black Economic Empowerment (B-BBEE) consortium led by Pembani Group Proprietary Limited.

Production in FY2014 was 30.4 Mt. The reserve lives of our mines range from 5.8 years at Khutala to 23 years at Middelburg. The reserve life for each mine is set out in section 2.3.2.

In FY2014, approximately 55 per cent of BECSA’s sales were to Eskom, the government-owned electricity utility in South Africa. The remaining production was exported, predominantly to India and China, via the Richards Bay Coal Terminal (RBCT), in which we own a 21 per cent interest.

New Mexico Coal

We own and operate the San Juan energy coal mine located in the US state of New Mexico. The mine transports its production directly to the nearby San Juan Generating Station. The San Juan mine has a reserve life of 3.5 years, which is the life of the current customer contract. Production for FY2014 was 5.7 Mt.

 

142


Table of Contents

We also operate the nearby Navajo mine, located on Navajo Nation land in New Mexico. Full ownership of the Navajo Coal Company transferred to the Navajo Transitional Energy Company (NTEC), an entity of the Navajo Nation, effective 30 December 2013. New Mexico Coal and NTEC have entered into a Mine Management Agreement where New Mexico Coal will continue as mine operator until 31 December 2016.

Navajo mine transports its production directly to the nearby Four Corners Power Plant. Navajo mine reduced capacity during FY2014 from 7.4 Mtpa to 5.4 Mtpa in response to reduced customer demand. Production for FY2014 was 5.1 Mt. As we retain control of the mine until full consideration is paid, production continues to be reported by the Group.

New South Wales Energy Coal

Our wholly owned New South Wales Energy Coal Asset owns and operates the Mt Arthur Coal open-cut energy coal mine in the Hunter Valley region of New South Wales, Australia. New South Wales Energy Coal produced 20 Mt in FY2014 and has a reserve life of 33 years. In FY2014, we delivered approximately seven per cent of Mt Arthur’s production to a local power station and exported the rest, predominantly to Japan and China, via the port of Newcastle.

We own a 35.5 per cent interest in the Newcastle Coal Infrastructure Group, which operates the Newcastle Third Port export coal loading facility. The facility currently has a port expansion project in execution (refer to Development projects). We also have a 1.75 per cent interest in Port Waratah Coal Services Limited, which operates two coal loading facilities at the port of Newcastle.

Cerrejón

We have a one-third interest in Cerrejón Coal Company, which owns and operates one of the world’s largest open-cut export energy coal mines, located in the La Guajira province of Colombia. Cerrejón also owns and operates integrated rail and port facilities through which the majority of production is exported to European, Middle Eastern, North and South American customers. In FY2014, our share of Cerrejón production was approximately 12.3 Mt. Cerrejón has a reserve life of 17 years.

In FY2012, Cerrejón commenced an expansion project (P40), which is ultimately expected to increase our share of production from 10.7 Mtpa to 13.3 Mtpa (refer to Development projects).

 

143


Table of Contents

Information on Coal mining operations

The following table contains additional details of our mining operations. The tables should be read in conjunction with the production (refer to section 2.2.2) and reserves tables (refer to section 2.3.2).

 

Mine & location

 

Means of access

 

Ownership

 

Operator

 

Title, leases or

options

 

History

 

Mine type &
mineralisation

style

 

Power source

 

Facilities, use &
condition

Australia              
Central Queensland Coal Associates Joint Venture                

Bowen Basin, Queensland, Australia

 

Goonyella Riverside Broadmeadow Daunia

Caval Ridge

Peak Downs

Saraji

Blackwater and Norwich Park mines

 

Public road

 

Coal transported by rail to Hay Point, Gladstone, and Abbot Point ports

 

Distances between the mines and port are between 160 km and 315 km

 

BHP Billiton 50%

 

Mitsubishi Development 50%

  BMA  

Mining leases, including undeveloped tenements, expire between 2014 and 2043, renewable for further periods as Queensland Government legislation allows

 

Mining is permitted to continue under the legislation during the renewal application period

 

Goonyella mine commenced in 1971, merged with adjoining Riverside mine in 1989. Operates as Goonyella Riverside

 

Production commenced at:

Peak Downs in 1972

Saraji in 1974

Norwich Park in 1979

Blackwater in 1967

 

Broadmeadow (longwall operations) in 2005 Daunia in 2013 and Caval Ridge in 2014

 

All open-cut except Broadmeadow: longwall underground

 

Bituminous coal is mined from the Permian Moranbah and Rangal Coal measures

 

Products range from premium quality, low volatile, high vitrinite, hard coking coal to medium volatile hard coking coal, to weak coking coal, some pulverised coal injection (PCI) coal and medium ash thermal coal as a secondary product

  Queensland electricity grid under long-term contracts  

On-site beneficiation processing facilities

 

Combined nominal capacity: in excess of 61 Mtpa

 

144


Table of Contents

Mine & location

 

Means of access

 

Ownership

 

Operator

 

Title, leases or

options

 

History

 

Mine type &
mineralisation

style

 

Power source

 

Facilities, use &
condition

Gregory Joint Operation                

Bowen Basin, Queensland, Australia

 

Gregory and Crinum mines

 

Public road

 

Coal transported by rail to Hay Point and Gladstone ports

 

Distances between the mines and port are between 310 km and 370 km

 

BHP Billiton 50%

 

Mitsubishi Development 50%

  BMA  

Mining leases, including undeveloped tenements, expire between 2014 and 2043, renewable for further periods as Queensland Government legislation allows

 

Mining is permitted to continue under the legislation during the renewal application period

 

Production commenced at:

Gregory in 1979

Crinum mine (longwall) in 1997

 

Production at Gregory open-cut mine ceased in October 2012

 

Gregory: open-cut

 

Crinum: longwall underground

 

Bituminous coal is mined from the Permian German Creek Coal measures

 

Product is a high volatile, low ash hard coking coal

  Queensland electricity grid under long-term contracts  

On-site beneficiation processing facility

 

Nominal capacity: in excess of 6 Mtpa

BHP Billiton Mitsui Coal                

Bowen Basin, Queensland, Australia

 

South Walker Creek and Poitrel mines

 

Public road

 

Coal transported by rail to Hay Point and Dalrymple Bay ports

 

Distances between the mines and port are between 135 km and 165 km

 

BHP Billiton 80%

 

Mitsui and Co 20%

  BMC  

Mining leases, including undeveloped tenements expire between 2014 and 2031, and are renewable for further periods as Queensland Government legislation allows

 

Mining is permitted to continue under the legislation during the renewal application period

 

South Walker Creek commenced in 1996

Poitrel commenced in 2006

 

Open-cut

 

Bituminous coal is mined from the Permian Rangal Coal measures

 

Produces a range of coking coal, PCI coal and thermal coal products with medium to high phosphorus and ash properties

  Queensland electricity grid  

South Walker Creek coal beneficiated on-site

 

Nominal capacity: in excess of 5 Mtpa

 

Poitrel mine has Red Mountain joint venture with adjacent Millennium Coal mine to share processing and rail loading facilities

 

Nominal capacity: in excess of 3 Mtpa

 

145


Table of Contents

Mine & location

 

Means of access

 

Ownership

 

Operator

 

Title, leases or

options

 

History

 

Mine type &
mineralisation

style

 

Power source

 

Facilities, use &
condition

Illawarra Coal

Illawarra, New South Wales, Australia

 

Dendrobium Appin and West Cliff mines

 

Public road

 

Coal transported by road or rail to BlueScope Steel’s Port Kembla steelworks or Port Kembla for export

 

Distances between the mines and port are between 8 km and 38 km

  100%   BHP Billiton   Mining leases expire between 2016 and 2033, renewable for further periods as NSW Government legislation allows  

Production commenced at:

Appin in 1962 (longwall operations 1969)

West Cliff in 1976 and Dendrobium in 2005

 

Underground

 

Bituminous coal is mined from the Permian Illawarra Coal Measures

 

Produces premium quality hard coking coal and some thermal coal from the Wongawilli and Bulli seams

  New South Wales electricity grid  

2 beneficiation facilities

 

Nominal capacity: in excess of 9 Mtpa

Mt Arthur Coal

             
Approximately 126 km northwest of Newcastle, New South Wales, Australia  

Public road

 

Domestic coal transported by conveyor to Bayswater Power Station

 

Export coal transported by third party rail to Newcastle port

  100%   BHP Billiton  

Various mining leases and licences expire between 2010 and 2032

 

Renewal is being sought for expired mining leases

 

The original approvals permit mining and other activities to continue during renewal application

 

Production commenced in 2002

 

Government approval permits extraction of up to 36 Mtpa of run of mine coal from underground and open-cut operations, with open-cut extraction limited to 32 Mtpa

 

Open-cut

 

Produces a medium rank bituminous thermal coal (non- coking)

  Local energy providers  

Beneficiation facilities: coal handling, preparation, washing plants

 

Nominal capacity: in excess of 23 Mtpa

 

146


Table of Contents

Mine & location

 

Means of access

 

Ownership

 

Operator

 

Title, leases or

options

 

History

 

Mine type &
mineralisation

style

 

Power source

 

Facilities, use &
condition

South Africa                
Khutala                
100 km east of Johannesburg, Gauteng Province, South Africa  

Public road

 

Domestic coal transported by overland conveyor to Kendal Power Station

 

BHP Billiton 90%

Newshelf 1129 Proprietary Limited (BEE SPV) 8%

Eyami Trust Management Company (RF) Proprietary Limited (ESOP) 2%

  BHP Billiton  

BECSA holds a 100% share of Converted Mining Right, granted October 2011

Mining Right was amended 15 February 2013 to include Portion 16 of Zondagsvlei 9 IS

 

Production commenced in 1984

 

Open-cut operations in 1996

 

Commenced mining thermal/metallurgical coal for domestic market in 2003

 

Combination open-cut and underground

 

Produces a medium rank bituminous thermal coal (non-coking)

  Eskom (national power supplier) under long-term contracts   Underground and open-cut crushers: Nominal capacity: in excess of 12 Mtpa
Middelburg/Wolvekrans                
20 km southeast of Witbank, Mpumalanga Province, South Africa  

Public road

 

Export coal transported to RBCT by third party rail (558 km)

 

Domestic coal transported by conveyor to Duvha Power Station

 

BHP Billiton 90%

Newshelf 1129 Proprietary Limited (BEE SPV) 8%

Eyami Trust Management Company (RF) Proprietary Limited (ESOP) 2%

 

Previous JV (84:16) with Glencore Xstrata Plc (through Tavistock Collieries Pty Limited) was amended in February 2008

  BHP Billiton  

BECSA and Tavistock are joint holders of 3 Converted Mining Rights in the previous JV ratio (84:16)

 

BECSA is the 100% holder of a fourth Converted Mining Right

 

All 4 Rights comprise the Middelburg Mine Complex (1)

 

The Converted Mining Rights were granted during October and December 2011 (2)

 

Production commenced in 1982

 

Middelburg Mines and Duvha Colliery became one operation in 1995

 

Douglas-Middelburg Optimisation project completed in July 2010

 

Mine was split into Middelburg and Wolvekrans during 2011

 

Open-cut

 

Produces a medium rank bituminous thermal coal, most of which can be beneficiated for the European or Asian export markets

  Eskom under long-term contracts  

Beneficiation facilities: tips and crushing plants, 2 export wash plants, middlings wash plant, de-stone plant

 

Nominal capacity: in excess of 17 Mtpa

 

147


Table of Contents

Mine & location

 

Means of access

 

Ownership

 

Operator

 

Title, leases or

options

 

History

 

Mine type &
mineralisation

style

 

Power source

 

Facilities, use &
condition

Klipspruit                
30 km west of Witbank, Mpumalanga Province, South Africa  

Public road

 

Export coal transported to RBCT by third party rail (611 km)

 

BHP Billiton 90%

Newshelf 1129 Proprietary Limited (BEE SPV) 8%

Eyami Trust Management Company (RF) Proprietary Limited (ESOP) 2%

 

Phola Coal Plant in JV with Anglo Inyosi Coal 50%

  BHP Billiton   BECSA holds a Converted Mining Right, granted on 11 October 2011  

Production commenced in 2003

 

Expansion project completed in FY2010, includes 50% share in Phola Coal Plant

 

Open-cut

 

Produces a medium rank bituminous thermal coal, most of which can be beneficiated for the export market

  Eskom, under long-term contracts  

Beneficiation facilities: tip and crushing plant, export wash plant

 

Nominal capacity Phola Coal Processing Plant: in excess of 7 Mtpa

United States

               

San Juan

               
25 km west of Farmington, New Mexico, US  

Public road

 

Coal transported by truck and conveyor to San Juan Generating Station

  100%   BHP Billiton  

Mining leases from federal and state governments

 

Leases viable as long as minimum production criteria achieved

 

Surface mine operations commenced in 1973

 

Development of underground mine to replace open-cut mine approved in 2000

 

Underground

Produces a medium rank bituminous thermal coal (non-coking suitable for the domestic market only)

  San Juan Generating Station  

Coal sized and blended to meet contract quantities and specification

Nominal capacity: 6 Mtpa

               
Navajo                
40 km southwest of Farmington, New Mexico, US  

Public road

 

Coal transported by rail to Four Corners Power Plant

 

BHP Billiton 0%

 

Navajo Transitional Energy Company 100%

  BHP Billiton   Lease held by Navajo Transitional Energy Company  

Production commenced in 1963

Divested FY2014

 

BHP Billiton continues as operator

 

Open-cut

 

Produces a medium rank bituminous thermal coal (non-coking suitable for the domestic market only)

  Four Corners Power Plant  

Stackers and reclaimers used to size and blend coal to meet contract quantities and specification

 

Nominal capacity: 5.4 Mtpa

               

 

148


Table of Contents

Mine & location

 

Means of access

 

Ownership

 

Operator

 

Title, leases or

options

 

History

 

Mine type &
mineralisation

style

 

Power source

 

Facilities, use &
condition

Colombia                
Cerrejón                
La Guajira province, Colombia  

Public road

 

Coal exported by company-owned rail to Puerto Bolivar (150 km)

 

BHP Billiton 33.33%

 

Anglo American 33.33% Glencore Xstrata 33.33%

  Cerrejón Coal Company   Mining leases expire in 2034  

Original mine began producing in 1976

 

BHP Billiton interest acquired in 2000

 

Open-cut

 

Produces a medium rank bituminous thermal coal (non-coking, suitable for the export market)

  Local Colombian power system  

Beneficiation facilities: crushing plant with capacity of 32 Mtpa and washing plant

Nominal capacity: 3 Mtpa

               

 

(1)  This includes the Wolvekrans and Middelburg collieries and excludes the portion Tavistock obtained as a result of the amendment of the Douglas-Tavistock JV agreement.

 

(2)  The JV agreement has been amended so that upon the Department of Mineral Resources amending the Converted Mining Rights, the mining area will be divided into an area wholly owned and operated by Tavistock and an area wholly owned and operated by BECSA as the new Douglas-Middelburg mine. Applications were made in December 2008 to the Department of Mineral Resources to amend the Converted Mining Rights, but a date for execution has not yet been provided. Ministerial consent to amend the Mining Rights has been granted.

 

149


Table of Contents

Development projects

BMA Expansions

In November 2011, we approved the development of the Caval Ridge mine project, with a revised investment of US$1.9 billion (BHP Billiton share). The Caval Ridge mine is an open-cut dragline and truck and shovel operation, with coal railed to the Hay Point Coal Terminal. First coal at the Caval Ridge mine occurred in the June 2014 quarter and the mine was 100 per cent completed at 30 June 2014.

In March 2011, we approved the expansion of the Hay Point Coal Terminal. The expansion of the terminal will deliver an additional 11 Mt of annual port capacity (100 per cent basis). Following a review of the project during FY2013, first shipment is expected in CY2015 with a revised budget of US$1.5 billion (BHP Billiton share). The project was 87 per cent complete at 30 June 2014.

Appin Area 9 Project

In June 2012, approval was given to invest US$845 million to sustain operations at Illawarra Coal by establishing a replacement mining area at Appin mine. The replacement area will have a production capacity of 3.5 Mtpa and will sustain Illawarra Coal’s production capacity at 9 Mtpa. The Appin Area 9 project was 67 per cent complete at 30 June 2014 and is expected to be operational in CY2016, whereupon it will replace production at the West Cliff mine. The project includes roadway development, new ventilation infrastructure, new and reconfigured conveyors and other mine services.

Cerrejón P40 Project

In August 2011, we announced a US$437 million (BHP Billiton share) investment in the expansion of Cerrejón, known as the P40 Project, which is expected to enable Cerrejón’s thermal coal production to increase by 8 Mtpa to approximately 40 Mtpa. The project scope includes a second berth and dual quadrant ship loader at Cerrejón’s 100 per cent owned and operated Puerto Bolivar, along with necessary mine, rail and associated supply chain infrastructure. Construction commenced in CY2011 and the project handled its first coal in the December 2013 quarter. The port expansion associated with the Cerrejón P40 project is currently being commissioned, although operational issues are expected to constrain capacity to approximately 35 Mtpa (100 per cent basis) in the medium term. At 30 June 2014, the project was 94 per cent complete.

Newcastle Port Third Phase Expansion

In August 2011, we announced a US$367 million (BHP Billiton share) investment in the third stage development of the Newcastle Coal Infrastructure Group’s coal handling facility in Newcastle. The port expansion project is expected to increase total capacity at the coal terminal from 53 Mtpa to 66 Mtpa. This is expected to increase New South Wales Energy Coal’s allocation by 4.6 Mtpa to 19.2 Mtpa. First coal on ship, being the first ship loading through the new facility, was achieved in June 2013, ahead of schedule. At 30 June 2014, the project was 86 per cent complete.

IndoMet Coal Project

IndoMet Coal comprises seven coal contracts of work (CCoWs) covering a large metallurgical coal resource in Central and East Kalimantan, Indonesia, which was discovered by BHP Billiton in the 1990s. Following an assessment of the importance of local participation in developing the project, in 2010 we sold a 25 per cent interest in the project to a subsidiary of PT Adaro Energy TBK. We retain 75 per cent of the project and hold management responsibility.

Construction works on infrastructure development for this project is ongoing with initial production from a small mine expected in CY2015.

 

150


Table of Contents

2.1.5    Aluminium, Manganese and Nickel Business

Aluminium

Our Aluminium, Manganese and Nickel Business, headquartered in Perth, Australia, has a portfolio of assets in three stages of the aluminium value chain: mining bauxite, refining bauxite into alumina and smelting alumina into aluminium metal. We are a major producer of aluminium, with total production in FY2014 of 1.2 Mt. We also produced 5.2 Mt of alumina in FY2014.

During FY2014, we consumed 35 per cent of our alumina production in our aluminium smelters and sold the balance to third party smelters. Our alumina and aluminium customers are located mostly in western Europe and Asia. Our alumina sales are a mixture of legacy long-term contract sales at LME-linked prices and long-term contracts priced from an alumina index or spot negotiated prices. Prices for our aluminium sales are generally linked to prevailing LME and premium prices. We have a diversified customer portfolio, with demand driven by end-use consumption in transportation, packaging, construction and household items.

Our assets consist of the following operations:

Boddington/Worsley

Boddington/Worsley is an integrated bauxite mining/alumina refining operation located in Western Australia. The Boddington bauxite mine supplies bauxite ore to the Worsley alumina refinery via a 51-kilometre long conveying system. We own 86 per cent of the mine and the refinery. It is our sole integrated bauxite, mining/alumina refining asset, and one of the largest and lowest cost refineries in the world. Worsley’s Efficiency and Growth project reached nameplate capacity in FY2014, bringing the capacity of the refinery to 4.6 Mtpa (100 per cent) of alumina. Our share of Worsley’s FY2014 production was 3.9 Mt of alumina. Worsley’s export customers include our own Hillside and Mozal smelters in southern Africa. Boddington has a reserve life of 17 years.

Hillside and Bayside

Our wholly owned Hillside and Bayside smelters are located at Richards Bay in South Africa. Hillside is the largest aluminium smelter in the southern hemisphere. Hillside and Bayside imported alumina from our Worsley refinery and Alcoa during FY2014; however, the Alcoa supply was discontinued by 30 June 2014. In June 2014, Bayside completed the ramp-down of its remaining smelting capacity of 97 ktpa. The Bayside Casthouse continues to operate and began processing liquid metal transfers from Hillside in June 2014. Hillside sources power from Eskom, the South African state utility, under long-term contracts, with prices linked to the LME price of aluminium (except for Hillside Potline 3, where the price is linked to the South African and US producer price indices). The Bayside Casthouse sources power from the grid at market rates. Production in FY2014 for Hillside was 715 kt and Bayside was 89 kt.

Mozal

We own 47.1 per cent of and operate the Mozal aluminium smelter located near Maputo, Mozambique. Mozal sources power generated by Hydro Cahora Basa via Motraco, a transmission joint venture between Eskom and the national electricity utilities of Mozambique and Swaziland. Our share of Mozal’s FY2014 production was 266 kt.

Mineração Rio do Norte

We own a 14.8 per cent investment in Mineração Rio do Norte (MRN), which owns and operates a large bauxite mine, located at Porto Trombetas in the province of Pará, Brazil. MRN has a reserve life of 6.1 years.

 

151


Table of Contents

Alumar

Alumar is an integrated alumina refinery/aluminium smelter. We own 36 per cent of the Alumar refinery and 40 per cent of the smelter. Alcoa operates both facilities. The operations, and their integrated port facility, are located at São Luís in the Maranhão province of Brazil. BHP Billiton sources the majority of the bauxite it processes at Alumar from MRN.

The Alumar smelter has currently suspended production from pot lines 2 and 3 reducing overall annual capacity to 124 ktpa, from 447 ktpa (100 per cent), due to challenging global market conditions in primary aluminium and increased costs. During FY2014, approximately 16 per cent of Alumar’s alumina production was used to feed the smelter, while the remainder was exported. Our share of Alumar’s FY2014 saleable production was 1.3 Mt of alumina and 104 kt of aluminium.

 

152


Table of Contents

Information on Aluminium mining operations

The following table contains additional details of our mining operations. This table should be read in conjunction with the production (refer to section 2.2.2) and reserve tables (refer to section 2.3.2).

 

Mine & location

 

Means of access

 

Ownership

 

Operator

 

Title, leases or

options

 

History

 

Mine type &
mineralisation

style

 

Power source

 

Facilities, use &
condition

Bauxite

               
Boddington bauxite mine                
Boddington, 123 km southeast of Perth, Western Australia  

Public road

 

Ore transported to Worsley alumina refinery by a 51 km conveyor

 

BHP Billiton 86%

 

Sojitz Alumina

4%

Japan Alumina Associates 10%

 

Ownership structure of operator as per Worsley JV

  BHP Billiton Worsley Alumina Pty Ltd  

Mining leases from Western Australia Government expire over the period 2014–2032, all with 21-year renewal available. Renewal process in progress for lease that expires in September 2014.

 

2 subleases from Alcoa of Australia

 

Opened in 1983

 

Significantly extended in 2000

 

Open-cut

 

Surficial gibbsite-rich lateritic weathering of Darling Range rocks

  JV-owned power line connected to Worsley alumina refinery site   Crushing plant Nominal capacity: 19 Mtpa bauxite
Mineração Rio do Norte                
Porto Trombetas, 880 km from Belém, the capital of Pará state, Brazil   Sealed road and 28 km of rail connects mine area with Porto Trombetas  

BHP Billiton 14.8%

 

Alcoa and affiliates 18.2% Vale 40%

Rio Tinto Alcan 12%

Votorantim 10%

Hydro 5%

  MRN   Mining rights granted by Brazilian Government until reserves exhausted  

Production commenced in 1979

 

Expanded in 2003

 

Open-cut

 

Lateritic weathering of nepheline syenite occurring primarily as gibbsite in a clay matrix overlain by clay sediments

  On-site fuel oil generators  

Crushing facilities, conveyors, wash plant

 

Nominal capacity: 18 Mtpa washed bauxite

 

153


Table of Contents

Information on Aluminium smelters and refineries

 

Smelter, refinery or
processing plant

 

Location

 

Ownership

 

Operator

 

Title, leases or options

 

Product

 

Nominal production
capacity

 

Power source

Aluminium and alumina

           

Hillside

             

Aluminium smelter

  Richards Bay, 200 km north of Durban, South Africa   100%   BHP Billiton  

Freehold title to property, plant, equipment

Leases over harbour facilities

 

Standard aluminium ingots

 

Liquid metal transferred to Bayside Casthouse

  726 ktpa primary aluminium  

Eskom (national power supplier) under long-term contracts

 

Contract prices for Hillside 1 and 2 linked to LME aluminium price

Prices for Hillside 3 linked to SA and US producer price indices

Bayside

             

Aluminium smelter

 

Richards Bay, 200 km north of Durban,

South Africa

  100%   BHP Billiton   Freehold title to property, plant, equipment   Primary aluminium, slab products   Ramp-down activities completed in June 2014, going forward only the Casthouse will operate processing liquid metal from Hillside  

Power requirements reduced due to closure of Reduction plant

 

Future power supply from grid at market rates

Mozal

             

Aluminium smelter

  17 km from Maputo, Mozambique  

BHP Billiton 47.1% of Mozal SARL

 

Mitsubishi 25% Industrial Development Corporation of South Africa Ltd 24%

Mozambique Government 3.9%

  BHP Billiton  

50-year government concession to use the land

Renewable for 50 years

  Standard aluminium ingots   561 ktpa  

Motraco under long-term contract

 

Contract price-linked to SA producer price index

 

154


Table of Contents

Smelter, refinery or
processing plant

 

Location

 

Ownership

 

Operator

 

Title, leases or options

 

Product

 

Nominal production
capacity

 

Power source

Worsley

             

Alumina refinery

  55 km northeast of Bunbury, Western Australia  

BHP Billiton 86%

 

Sojitz Alumina 4%

Japan Alumina Associates 10%

 

Ownership structure of operator as per Worsley JV

  BHP Billiton Worsley Alumina Pty Ltd  

2,480 ha refinery lease from Western Australia Government expires in 2025

 

21-year renewal available

  Metallurgical grade alumina   4.6 Mtpa   JV-owned on-site coal power station, third party on-site gas-fired steam power generation plant, third party leased on-site multifuel co-generation steam and power generation plant

Alumar

             

Alumina refinery and aluminium smelter

  São Luís, Maranhão, Brazil  

Aluminium smelter: BHP Billiton 40%

 

Alcoa 60% Alumina refinery: BHP Billiton 36% Alcoa and affiliates 54%

Rio Tinto 10%

  Alcoa operates both facilities   All property held freehold   Alumina and aluminium ingots  

Refinery: 3.5 Mtpa alumina

 

Smelter: 124 ktpa primary aluminium (Potline 1)

  Electronorte (Brazilian public power generation concessionaire), under long-term contract

 

155


Table of Contents

Development projects

There were no active aluminium development projects in FY2014.

Manganese

Our Aluminium, Manganese and Nickel Business produces a combination of manganese ores and alloys from sites in South Africa and Australia. We are the world’s largest producer of manganese ore and one of the top global producers of manganese alloy. Manganese alloy is a key input into the steelmaking process. Manganese high-grade ore is particularly valuable to alloy producers because of the value in use differential over low-grade ore. The value in use differential is the degree to which high-grade ore is proportionately more efficient than low-grade ore to process in the production of alloy.

Manganese alloy smelters are a key conduit of manganese alloy and ore into steelmaking and enable us to access markets with an optimal mix of ore and alloy, optimise production to best suit market conditions and give us technical insight into the performance of our ores in smelters.

Approximately 83 per cent of our ore production is sold directly to external customers, predominantly located in China, South Korea and India, and the remainder is used as feedstock in our alloy smelters. Manganese alloy is sold to steel mills, mainly in Europe and North America. Manganese ore and alloy are sold on short-term or spot contracts, with prices linked to published indices. Neither commodity is exchange traded, and prices are largely determined by supply and demand balances. Ore is priced per dry metric tonne unit and referenced to a benchmark ore of 44 per cent manganese grade cost insurance freight (CIF) China. Alloy is priced per tonne, typically on a delivered basis (DDP). Manganese production in FY2014 was 8,302 kt of ore and 646 kt of alloy.

We own and manage all of our manganese mining operations and alloy plants through the Manganese joint ventures with Anglo American. In South Africa, we own 60 per cent of Samancor Holdings (Pty) Ltd which via its wholly owned subsidiary, Samancor Manganese (Pty) Ltd, operates the Metalloys division. Samancor Manganese owns 74 per cent of Hotazel Manganese Mines (Pty) Ltd (HMM), which gives us an effective interest of 44.4 per cent in HMM. The remaining 26 per cent of HMM is owned under the terms of the South African B-BBEE legislation, which reflects our commitment to economic transformation in South Africa. In Australia, we own 60 per cent of Groote Eylandt Mining Company Pty Ltd (GEMCO) and we have an effective interest of 60 per cent in GEMCO’s wholly owned subsidiary, Tasmanian Electro Metallurgical Company Pty Ltd (TEMCO).

Our assets, Manganese Australia and Manganese South Africa, consist of the following:

Mines

HMM

HMM owns the Mamatwan open-cut mine and the Wessels underground mine. Mined ore is processed into a saleable product through a crushing and wet screening operation, with some ore undergoing further processing in the form of dense media separation and sintering. Approximately 25 per cent of the ore mined is beneficiated into alloy at Metalloys, with the rest being exported via road and rail through Port Elizabeth (approximately 950 kilometres) and Durban (approximately 1,100 kilometres). In FY2014, the total manganese ore production was 3,526 kt. Wessels has a reserve life of 46 years and Mamatwan has a reserve life of 18 years.

GEMCO

GEMCO is an open-cut mining operation, located 16 kilometres from our port facilities at Milner Bay, Northern Territory. These operations, consisting of crushing, screening, washing and dense media separation, combined with its high-grade ore are in relative close proximity to the Asian export markets. FY2014 production of manganese ore was 4,776 kt. GEMCO has a reserve life of 11 years.

 

156


Table of Contents

Alloy Plants

Metalloys

The Samancor Manganese Metalloys alloy plant is one of the largest manganese alloy producers in the world. Metalloys produces high- and medium-carbon ferromanganese using ore transported by rail from HMM. Production of manganese alloy in FY2014 was 377 kt.

TEMCO

TEMCO, located in Tasmania, is a medium-sized producer of high-carbon ferromanganese, silicomanganese and sinter using ore shipped from GEMCO, primarily using hydroelectric power. Production of manganese alloy in FY2014 was 269 kt.

 

157


Table of Contents

Information on Manganese mining operations

The following table contains additional details of our mining operations. These tables should be read in conjunction with the production (refer to section 2.2.2) and reserve tables (refer to section 2.3.2).

 

Mine & location

 

Means of access

 

Ownership

 

Operator

 

Title, leases or options

 

History

 

Mine type &
mineralisation

style

 

Power source

 

Facilities, use &
condition

Manganese ore

               
Hotazel Manganese Mines (HMM)                

Kalahari Basin, South Africa

 

Mamatwan and

Wessels mines

 

Public road

 

Most ore and sinter products transported by rail

 

Approximately 34% of ore beneficiated locally, balance exported via Port Elizabeth (approximately 950 km) and Durban (approximately 1,100 km)

 

BHP Billiton

44.4%

 

Anglo American 29.6%

 

Ntsimbintle 9% NCAB 7%

Iziko 5%

HMM Education Trust 5%

  BHP Billiton   Existing New Order Rights valid until 2035  

Mamatwan commissioned in 1964

 

Wessels commissioned in 1973

 

Mamatwan: open-cut

 

Wessels: underground

 

Banded iron manganese ore type

 

Eskom

(national power supplier) under contracts at regulated prices

 

Mamatwan beneficiation plant: primary, secondary and tertiary crushing with associated screening plants

 

Dense medium separator and sinter plant (capacity 1 Mtpa sinter) (1)

 

Wessels: primary and secondary crushing circuits with associated screening (1)

Groote Eylandt Mining Company (GEMCO)

               
Groote Eylandt, Northern Territory, Australia   Ore transported 16 km from concentrator by road train to port at Milner Bay  

BHP Billiton 60%

 

Anglo American 40%

  BHP Billiton  

All leases on Aboriginal land held under Aboriginal Land Rights (Northern Territory) Act 1976

Valid until 2031

  Commissioned in 1965  

Open-cut

 

Sandstone claystone sedimentary manganese ore type

  On-site diesel power generation  

Beneficiation process: crushing, screening, washing and dense media separation

 

Produces lump and fines products Capacity: 4.8 wet Mtpa

 

(1)  Capacity: Mamatwan – approximately 3.5 Mtpa of ore; Wessels – approximately 1 Mtpa of ore.

 

158


Table of Contents

Information on Manganese smelters, refineries and processing plants

 

Smelter, refinery or
processing plant

 

Location

 

Ownership

 

Operator

 

Title, leases or options

 

Product

 

Nominal production
capacity

 

Power source

Manganese alloy

             

Metalloys

             

Manganese alloy plant

(division of Samancor Manganese (Pty) Ltd)

  Meyerton, South Africa  

BHP Billiton 60%

 

Anglo American 40%

  BHP Billiton   Freehold title over property, plant and equipment   Manganese alloys including high-carbon ferromanganese, refined (medium-carbon ferromanganese) alloy  

410 ktpa high-carbon ferromanganese (including hot metal)

90 ktpa medium-carbon ferromanganese

 

Eskom

 

32 MW of internal power generated from furnace off-gases

Tasmanian Electro Metallurgical Company (TEMCO)              

Manganese alloy plant

  Bell Bay, Tasmania, Australia  

BHP Billiton 60%

 

Anglo American 40%

  BHP Billiton   Freehold title over property, plant and equipment   Ferroalloys, including high-carbon ferromanganese, silicomanganese and sinter   150 ktpa high-carbon ferromanganese 120 ktpa silicomanganese 325 ktpa sinter  

Aurora Energy

 

On-site energy recovery unit generates 11 MW for internal use

 

159


Table of Contents

Development projects

GEMCO expansion

The US$279 million GEMCO Expansion Project (GEEP2) (US$167 million BHP Billiton share), approved in July 2011, was delivered on time and on budget in the December 2013 quarter. GEEP2 increased GEMCO’s capacity from 4.2 Mtpa to 4.8 Mtpa through the introduction of a dense media circuit by-pass facility. The expansion has also addressed key infrastructure constraints by increasing road and port capacity to 5.9 Mtpa, creating 1.1 Mtpa of additional capacity for future expansions.

Premium Concentrate (PC02)

In August 2014 a project to build a stand-alone PC02 plant at GEMCO was approved for US$139 million (BHP Billiton share US$83 million). The project is expected to complete by the December 2015 quarter and produce 0.2 Mtpa in FY2016 and ramp-up to 0.5 Mtpa in FY2017.

HMM

The central block development project at the Wessels underground mine is being progressed in two phases. The first phase of the project was commissioned in December 2013 at a cost of US$92.4 million (US$40.7 million BHP Billiton share) and comprised the construction of the ventilation shaft and development of the associated underground ventilation network.

The second phase will complete infrastructure required to expand the mine to 1.5 Mtpa and comprises the development of a run of mine infrastructure handling system for central block, the development and equipping of underground workshops, including materials handling design, procurement and installation. A feasibility study was successfully completed in FY2014 and was approved for execution in July 2014 at a cost of US$30.8 million (US$13.7 million BHP Billiton share). The project is expected to complete in the September 2016 quarter.

Nickel

Our Aluminium, Manganese and Nickel Business primarily supplies nickel products to customers in the stainless steel industry, principally in northern Asia and western Europe. Nickel is an important component of the most commonly used types of stainless steel. We also supply nickel to other markets, including the specialty alloy, foundry, chemicals and refractory material industries. We are a major producer of nickel with total production in FY2014 of 143 kt of contained nickel. We sell our nickel products at various stages including concentrate, matte and metal under a mix of long-term, medium-term and spot volume contracts, with prices linked to the LME nickel price.

Our assets, located in Australia and Colombia, consist of the following operations:

Nickel West

Our wholly owned Nickel West Asset in Western Australia consists of an integrated system of mines, concentrators, a smelter and a refinery. We mine nickel-bearing sulphide ore at our Mt Keith and Cliffs operations, located north of Kalgoorlie. Mt Keith has a reserve life of 5.9 years. Cliffs is an underground mine with a reserve life of 3.2 years. We operate concentrator plants at Mt Keith and at Leinster, which also concentrate ore from Cliffs. On 31 October 2013, production at the Nickel West Leinster Perseverance underground mine was suspended following a significant seismic event. A subsequent review of the incident determined it was unsafe to resume operations. The Rocky’s Reward open-cut mine, near Leinster, provided a temporary alternative ore supply to Nickel West, with mining operations completed in July 2014.

 

160


Table of Contents

We also operate the Kambalda concentrator south of Kalgoorlie, where we source ore through tolling and concentrate purchase arrangements with third parties in the Kambalda region. We also have purchase agreements in place for the direct purchase of concentrate, which we re-pulp, dry and blend with other concentrate processed at Kambalda.

Ore from our Mt Keith mine is concentrated at Mt Keith and then transported by road approximately 110 kilometres to Leinster for drying. Ore from the Cliffs and Leinster mines is concentrated and dried at Leinster. Dry nickel concentrate is then transported via road and rail approximately 375 kilometres to our Kalgoorlie smelter. Concentrate from Kambalda is transported via rail approximately 60 kilometres to our Kalgoorlie smelter.

Small volumes of concentrate are sold into the external market; however, the majority of volumes are processed into nickel matte, containing approximately 65 per cent nickel. In FY2014, we exported approximately 29 per cent of our nickel matte production. The remaining nickel matte is transported, principally by rail, to our Kwinana nickel refinery, a distance of approximately 650 kilometres. The nickel matte is processed into nickel metal in the form of LME grade briquettes and nickel powder, together with a range of saleable by-products.

Nickel West production in FY2014 was 98.9 kt of contained nickel.

Cerro Matoso

Our 99.98 per cent owned Cerro Matoso Asset in Colombia combines a lateritic nickel ore deposit with a ferronickel smelter. The smelter produces high-purity, low-carbon ferronickel granules. Cerro Matoso has an estimated reserve life of 15 years. Production in FY2014 was 44.3 kt of nickel in ferronickel form.

During FY2013, Cerro Matoso successfully extended its mining concessions with the Colombian Government until 2029, with a conditional extension until 2044. The agreement includes an increase in the royalty rate from 12 per cent to 13 per cent. The extension of the contract term to 2044 is conditional on Cerro Matoso increasing processing capacity by 50 per cent by 2022.

 

161


Table of Contents

Information on Nickel mining operations

The following table contains additional details of our mining operations. This table should be read in conjunction with the production (refer to section 2.2.2) and reserve tables (refer to section 2.3.2).

 

Mine & location

 

Means of access

 

Ownership

 

Operator

 

Title, leases or
options

 

History

 

Mine type &
mineralisation
style

 

Power source

 

Facilities, use &
condition

Nickel

               

Mt Keith

485 km north of Kalgoorlie, Western Australia

 

Private road

 

Nickel concentrate transported by road to Leinster nickel operations for drying and on-shipping

  100%   BHP Billiton  

Mining leases granted by Western Australia Government

 

Key leases expire between 2015 and 2034

 

Renewals at government discretion

 

Officially commissioned in 1995 by WMC

 

Acquired in 2005 as part of WMC acquisition

 

Open-cut

 

Disseminated textured magmatic nickel-sulphide mineralisation, associated with a metamorphosed ultramafic intrusion

 

On-site third party leased gas-fired turbines

 

Contracts expire in 2024

 

Natural gas sourced and transported under separate long-term contracts

  Concentration plant with a nominal capacity: 11 Mtpa of ore

Leinster

               
375 km north of Kalgoorlie, Western Australia  

Public road

Nickel concentrate shipped by road and rail to Kalgoorlie nickel smelter

  100%   BHP Billiton  

Mining leases granted by Western Australia Government

Key leases expire between 2019 and 2034

Renewals at government discretion

 

Production commenced in 1979

 

Acquired in 2005 as part of WMC acquisition

 

Perseverance underground mine ceased operations during 2013

 

Open-cut

 

Steeply dipping disseminated and massive textured nickel-sulphide mineralisation, associated with metamorphosed ultramafic lava flows and intrusions

 

On-site third party leased gas-fired turbines

 

Contracts expire in 2024

Natural gas sourced and transported under separate long-term contracts

  Concentration plant with a nominal capacity: 3 Mtpa of ore

 

162


Table of Contents

Mine & location

 

Means of access

 

Ownership

 

Operator

 

Title, leases or
options

 

History

 

Mine type &
mineralisation
style

 

Power source

 

Facilities, use &
condition

Cliffs

               
481 km north of Kalgoorlie, Western Australia  

Private road

 

Nickel ore transported by road to Leinster nickel operations for further processing

  100%   BHP Billiton  

Mining leases granted by Western Australia Government

 

Key leases expire between 2025 and 2028

 

Renewals at government discretion

 

Production commenced in 2008

 

Acquired in 2005 as part of WMC acquisition

 

Underground

 

Steeply dipping massive textured nickel-sulphide mineralisation, associated with metamorphosed ultramafic lava flows

  Supplied from Mt Keith   Mine site

Cerro Matoso

               
Montelibano, Córdoba, Colombia   Public road  

BHP Billiton 99.98%

 

Employees and former employees 0.02%

  BHP Billiton   New terms agreed effective 1 October 2012 until 2029 with conditional extension to 2044 if ore processing capacity is increased 50% by 2022  

Mining commenced in 1980

 

Nickel production started in 1982

 

Ownership increased to 53% in 1989 and to 99.94% in 2007

 

Expansion project to double installed capacity completed in 2001

 

Open-cut

 

Nickel-laterite mineralisation formed from residual weathering of ophiolitic peridotite

 

National electricity grid under contracts expiring in December 2014

 

New supply contract agreed for 2016 to 2018

 

Renewal process for 2015 in progress

 

Domestic natural gas for drier and kiln operation supplied by owned pipeline

 

Gas supply contracts expiring December 2021

 

Ferronickel smelter and refinery integrated with the mine

 

Beneficiation plant: primary and secondary crusher

 

Nominal capacity: 50 ktpa of nickel in ferronickel form

 

Actual production depends on nickel grade from the mine

 

163


Table of Contents

Information on Nickel smelters, refineries and processing plants

 

Smelter, refinery or
processing plant

 

Location

 

Ownership

 

Operator

 

Title, leases or
options

 

Product

 

Nominal production
capacity

 

Power source

Nickel

             

Kambalda

             

Nickel concentrator

  56 km south of Kalgoorlie, Western Australia   100%   BHP Billiton  

Mineral leases granted by Western Australia Government

 

Key leases expire in 2028

 

Renewals at government discretion

  Concentrate containing approximately 14% nickel  

1.6 Mtpa ore

 

Ore sourced through tolling and concentrate purchase arrangements with third parties in Kambalda region

 

On-site third party leased gas-fired turbines supplemented by access to grid power

 

Contracts expire in January 2024

 

Natural gas sourced and transported under separate long-term contracts

Kalgoorlie

             

Nickel smelter

  Kalgoorlie, Western Australia   100%   BHP Billiton   Freehold title over the property   Matte containing approximately 65% nickel   110 ktpa nickel matte  

On-site third party leased gas-fired turbines

 

Contracts expire in January 2024

 

Natural gas sourced and transported under separate long-term contracts

Kwinana

             

Nickel refinery

  30 km south of Perth, Western Australia   100%   BHP Billiton   Freehold title over the property  

LME grade nickel briquettes, nickel powder

 

Also intermediate products, including copper sulphide, cobalt-nickel-sulphide, ammonium-sulphate

  70 ktpa nickel metal   Power is sourced from the local grid which is supplied under a retail contract.

 

164


Table of Contents

Development projects

There were no active nickel development projects in FY2014.

2.1.6    Marketing

BHP Billiton’s Marketing organisation manages the Group’s revenue line and is responsible for:

 

  selling the Group’s products and for purchasing all major raw materials;

 

  supporting the Businesses to maximise the value of upstream resources;

 

  managing the supply chain to customers;

 

  achieving market clearing prices for the Group’s products;

 

  developing the Group-wide view of the markets and future pricing.

Our responsibilities require an active presence in the various commodities markets, the global freight market, and in crude and gas pipeline transportation. We manage the supply chain for our products and develop strong relationships with our customers. We actively manage the levels of finished goods inventory, supply vendor payables and trade receivables, thereby ensuring we do not carry excess working capital. We also manage credit and price risk by assessing customers for creditworthiness while ensuring our sales positions are reflective of the market at the time of delivery by linking to commodity market indices.

Marketing adds value by releasing full economic value of the Group’s products through maximising unit price; minimising the costs of distribution and major traded raw materials that are consumed in the Businesses’ production processes; supporting the Businesses in optimising the value of our resources via our approach to quality and other commercial parameters; and ensuring the Group’s view of long-run markets is well informed and insightful.

Our market insight is strengthened by our proximity to our customers and the flow of information in our centralised marketing structure. We research and analyse the fundamentals of demand and supply and integrate this knowledge into long-run views of the commodity markets, enabling the Group to plan and invest optimally.

The primary hub for our marketing activities is Singapore, while our marketing of oil and gas is headquartered in Houston, United States. The two hub offices incorporate all the functions required to manage marketing and distribution from our Businesses to our customers. In addition, we have marketers located close to our customers in 14 cities across the world. This model enables centralised decision-making supported by regional liaison offices close to our customers that build long-term value-creating relationships.

The consolidation of commercial accountabilities through our centralised model enables the optimisation of our sales positions, provides greater value to distribution activities, and ensures more effective risk management, which improves our commercial capability. Marketing demonstrates leadership in the drive towards improved liquidity and transparency in the markets for many of our commodities through our investments in electronic platforms as physical sales channels, such as the development and introduction of globalORE, globalCOAL and the China Beijing International Mining Exchange. We actively focus on sustaining relationships with our customers to assure our access to market and to sell our products at market prices.

Within the Singapore hub, we have a centralised ocean freight business that manages our in-house freight requirements for the Group. The objective of the freight business is to create a competitive advantage through the procurement of safe, sustainable shipping solutions, which both maximise production throughput and minimise costs through the Group’s supply chains.

As one of the largest global shippers of bulk commodities, we are seen as a key trading partner, allowing us to select among the highest quality freight service providers and ship owners. The scope and scale of our commodity portfolio

 

165


Table of Contents

and extensive fleet of hire chartered vessels allows us to arbitrage and optimise positions to minimise freight costs. This includes flexibility in diverting tonnages between markets; maximising tonnages for both inbound and outbound journeys; and parcelling of commodities.

We are proud of our strong partnerships with our customers. We provide them with reliable supply of product at market-reflective prices. We engage in technical collaboration with many of our customers, to improve our understanding of their needs and help ensure they are able to make optimal use of our products.

 

166


Table of Contents

2.2    Production

2.2.1    Petroleum

The table below details Petroleum’s historical net crude oil and condensate, natural gas and natural gas liquids production, primarily by geographic segment, for each of the three years ended 30 June 2014, 2013 and 2012. We have shown volumes of marketable production after deduction of applicable royalties, fuel and flare. We have included in the table average production costs per unit of production and average sales prices for oil and condensate and natural gas for each of those periods.

 

    BHP Billiton Group share of production
Year ended 30 June
 
        2014             2013             2012      

Production volumes

     

Crude oil and condensate (’000 of barrels)

     

Australia

    23,645        25,922        31,145   

United States

    53,964        38,724        30,824   

Other (5)

    6,452        7,866        9,232   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total crude oil and condensate

    84,061        72,512        71,201   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Natural gas (billion cubic feet)

     

Australia

    287.5        276.13        249.97   

United States

    460.2        489.03        456.69   

Other (5)

    91.6        109.11        115.60   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total natural gas

    839.3        874.27        822.26   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Natural Gas Liquids (1) (’000 of barrels)

     

Australia

    8,448        7,927        7,943   

United States

    13,620        9,575        5,744   

Other (5)

    18        37        398   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total NGL (1)

    22,086        17,539        14,085   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total production of petroleum products (million barrels of oil equivalent) (2)

     

Australia

    80.01        79.87        80.75   

United States

    144.28        129.80        112.69   

Other (5)

    21.74        26.09        28.90   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total production of petroleum products

    246.03        235.76        222.34   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Average sales price

     

Crude oil and condensate (US$ per barrel)

     

Australia

    111.88        110.83        114.33   

United States

    97.57        102.33        106.22   

Other (5)

    108.13        107.46        113.26   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total crude oil and condensate

    102.47        105.91        110.66   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Natural gas (US$ per thousand cubic feet)

     

Australia

    5.20        4.73        4.62   

United States

    4.10        3.29        2.82   

Other (5)

    3.92        4.42        4.13   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total natural gas

    4.35        3.76        3.40   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Natural Gas Liquids (US$ per barrel)

     

Australia

    63.12        63.13        61.61   

United States

    30.28        30.41        45.72   

Other (5)

    32.00        28.61        55.06   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total NGL

    42.28        45.70        54.85   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Average production cost (US$ per barrel of oil equivalent) (3) (4)

     

Australia

    8.18        8.23        7.95   

United States

    7.80        6.27        5.91   

Other (5)

    9.58        8.45        7.84   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Average production cost

    8.08        7.18        6.90   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

167


Table of Contents

 

(1)  LPG and ethane are reported as Natural Gas Liquids (NGL).

 

(2)  Total barrels of oil equivalent (boe) conversion is based on the following: 6,000 scf of natural gas equals one boe.

 

(3)  Average production costs include direct and indirect costs relating to the production of hydrocarbons and the foreign exchange effect of translating local currency denominated costs into US dollars, but excludes ad valorem and severance taxes.

 

(4) Total average production costs reported here do not include the costs to transport our produced hydrocarbons to the point of sale. Total production costs, including transportation costs, but excluding ad valorem and severance taxes, were US$11.70 per boe, US$10.85 per boe, and US$10.00 per boe for the years ended 30 June 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively.

 

(5)  Other is comprised of Algeria, Pakistan, Trinidad and Tobago, and the United Kingdom.

2.2.2    Minerals

The table below details our mineral and derivative product production for all Businesses except Petroleum for the three years ended 30 June 2014, 2013 and 2012. The production numbers represent our share of production, including our proportional share of production for which income is derived from our equity accounted investments, unless otherwise stated. The Group changed its accounting policy for equity accounted investments from 1 July 2013 as set out in note 1 ‘Accounting policies’ and note 37 ‘Impact of new accounting standards and change in accounting policies’ in the Financial Statements. For discussion of minerals pricing during the past three years, refer to section 1.15.1.

 

     BHP Billiton
Group interest
%
     BHP Billiton Group share of production
Year ended 30 June
 
            2014              2013              2012      

Copper Business (1)

           

Copper

           

Payable metal in concentrate (’000 tonnes)

           

Escondida, Chile (2)

     57.5         844.7         831.5         580.5   

Antamina, Peru

     33.75         143.5         139.7         127.0   

Pinto Valley, United States (3)

     100         12.5         16.6           
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total copper concentrate

        1,000.7         987.8         707.5   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Copper cathode (’000 tonnes)

           

Escondida, Chile (2)

     57.5         308.0         297.9         299.1   

Pampa Norte, Chile (4)

     100         233.1         232.6         263.7   

Pinto Valley, United States (3)

     100         0.9         4.9         5.4   

Olympic Dam, Australia

     100         184.4         166.2         192.6   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total copper cathode

        726.4         701.6         760.8   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total copper concentrate and cathode

        1,727.1         1,689.4         1,468.3   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Lead

           

Payable metal in concentrate (’000 tonnes)

           

Cannington, Australia

     100         186.5         213.4         239.1   

Antamina, Peru

     33.75         1.5         1.0         0.8   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total lead

        188.0         214.4         239.9   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

168


Table of Contents
     BHP Billiton
Group interest
%
     BHP Billiton Group share of production
Year ended 30 June
 
            2014              2013              2012      

Zinc

           

Payable metal in concentrate (’000 tonnes)

           

Cannington, Australia

     100         57.9         56.3         54.7   

Antamina, Peru

     33.75         52.0         71.9         57.5   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total zinc

        109.9         128.2         112.2   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Gold

           

Payable metal in concentrate (’000 ounces)

           

Escondida, Chile (2)

     57.5         72.9         71.5         88.5   

Pinto Valley, United States (3)

     100         0.1                   

Olympic Dam, Australia (refined gold)

     100         121.3         113.3         117.8   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total gold

        194.3         184.8         206.3   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Silver

           

Payable metal in concentrate (’000 ounces)

           

Escondida, Chile (2)

     57.5         4,271         2,960         3,341   

Antamina, Peru

     33.75         4,359         3,952         4,272   

Cannington, Australia

     100         25,161         31,062         34,208   

Olympic Dam, Australia (refined silver)

     100         972         880         907   

Pinto Valley, United States (3)

     100         41         59           
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total silver

        34,804         38,913         42,728   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Uranium

           

Payable metal in concentrate (tonnes)

           

Olympic Dam, Australia

     100         3,988         4,066         3,853   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total uranium

        3,988         4,066         3,853   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Molybdenum

           

Payable metal in concentrate (tonnes)

           

Antamina, Peru

     33.75         1,201         1,561         2,346   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total molybdenum

        1,201         1,561         2,346   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Iron Ore Business

           

WAIO

           

Production (’000 tonnes) (5)

           

Newman, Australia

     85         56,915         44,620         39,988   

Yarrie, Australia (6)

     85         836         1,106         768   

Area C Joint Venture, Australia

     85         46,960         44,717         42,425   

Yandi Joint Venture, Australia

     85         68,518         60,054         53,536   

Jimblebar, Australia (7)

     85         8,863                   

Wheelarra, Australia (8)

     85         10,553         8,377         11,338  
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total WAIO

        192,645         158,874         148,055   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Samarco, Brazil

     50         10,919         10,982         11,423   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total iron ore

        203,564         169,856         159,478   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

169


Table of Contents
     BHP Billiton
Group interest
%
     BHP Billiton Group share of production
Year ended 30 June
 
            2014              2013              2012      

Coal Business

           

Metallurgical coal

           

Production (’000 tonnes) (9)

           

Blackwater, Australia

     50         6,730         5,432         4,435   

Goonyella Riverside, Australia

     50         7,330         6,221         5,003   

Peak Downs, Australia

     50         4,909         4,545         3,534   

Saraji, Australia

     50         4,558         3,449         3,053   

Gregory Joint Venture, Australia

     50         2,965         2,523         1,411   

Daunia, Australia

     50         2,201         475           

Caval Ridge, Australia (10)

     50         563                   

Norwich Park, Australia

     50                         1,175   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total BMA

        29,256         22,645         18,611   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

South Walker Creek, Australia (11)

     80         5,246         4,351         4,081   

Poitrel, Australia (11)

     80         3,063         2,712         2,612   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total BHP Billiton Mitsui Coal

        8,309         7,063         6,693   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Queensland Coal

        37,565         29,708         25,304   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Illawarra Coal, Australia

     100         7,513         7,942         7,926   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total metallurgical coal

        45,078         37,650         33,230   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Energy coal

           

Production (’000 tonnes)

           

Navajo, United States (12)

     100         5,127         7,468         7,054   

San Juan, United States

     100         5,685         5,323         5,514   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total New Mexico Coal

        10,812         12,791         12,568   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Middelburg/Wolvekrans, South Africa (13)

     90         13,368         14,669         14,848   

Khutala, South Africa (13)

     90         9,718         9,554         10,863   

Klipspruit, South Africa (13)

     90         7,298         7,404         7,568   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Energy Coal South Africa

        30,384         31,627        33,279   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Mt Arthur Coal, Australia

     100         19,964         18,010         16,757   

Cerrejón, Colombia

     33.3         12,332         10,017         11,663   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total energy coal

        73,492         72,445         74,267   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Aluminium, Manganese and Nickel Business

           

Alumina

           

Saleable production (’000 tonnes)

           

Worsley, Australia

     86         3,916         3,675         2,917   

Alumar, Brazil

     36         1,262         1,205         1,235   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total alumina

        5,178         4,880         4,152   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Aluminium

           

Production (’000 tonnes)

           

Hillside, South Africa

     100         715         665         621   

Bayside, South Africa (14)

     100         89         96         98   

Alumar, Brazil

     40         104         154         170   

Mozal, Mozambique

     47         266         264         264   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total aluminium

        1,174         1,179         1,153   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

170


Table of Contents
     BHP Billiton
Group interest
%
     BHP Billiton Group share of production
Year ended 30 June
 
            2014              2013              2012      

Manganese ores

           

Saleable production (’000 tonnes)

           

Hotazel Manganese Mines, South Africa (15)

     44.4         3,526         3,490         3,625   

GEMCO, Australia (15)

     60         4,776         5,027         4,306   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total manganese ores

        8,302         8,517         7,931   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Manganese alloys

           

Saleable production (’000 tonnes)

           

Metalloys, South Africa (15) (16)

     60         377         374         404   

TEMCO, Australia (15)

     60         269         234         198   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total manganese alloys

        646         608         602   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Nickel

           

Saleable production (’000 tonnes)

           

Cerro Matoso, Colombia

     99.9         44.3         50.8         48.9   

Nickel West, Australia

     100         98.9         103.3         109.0   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total nickel

        143.2         154.1         157.9   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Divested businesses

           

Diamonds

           

Production (’000 carats)

           

EKATI, Canada

     80                 972         1,784   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total diamonds

                972         1,784   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Titanium minerals

           

Production (’000 tonnes)

           

Titanium slag

           

Richards Bay Minerals, South Africa

     37.76                 53         384   

Rutile

           

Richards Bay Minerals, South Africa

     37.76                 6         38   

Zircon

           

Richards Bay Minerals, South Africa

     37.76                 16         100   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total titanium minerals

                75         522   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1)  Metal production is reported on the basis of payable metal.

 

(2)  Shown on 100 per cent basis following the application of IFRS 10 which came into effect from 1 July 2013. BHP Billiton interest in saleable production is 57.5 per cent.

 

(3)  On 11 October 2013 BHP Billiton completed the sale of its Pinto Valley operations.

 

(4)  Includes Cerro Colorado and Spence.

 

(5)  Iron ore production is reported on a wet tonnes basis.

 

(6)  Yarrie ceased production on 25 February 2014.

 

(7)  Shown on 100 per cent basis. BHP Billiton interest in saleable production is 85 per cent.

 

(8)  All production from Wheelarra is now processed via the Jimblebar processing hub.

 

(9)  Metallurgical coal production is reported on the basis of saleable product. Production figures include some thermal coal.

 

171


Table of Contents
(10)  Caval Ridge achieved first production in the June 2014 quarter.

 

(11)  Shown on 100 per cent basis. BHP Billiton interest in saleable production is 80 per cent.

 

(12)  BHP Billiton completed the sale of Navajo Mine on 30 December 2013. As BHP Billiton will retain control of the mine until full consideration is received, production will continue to be reported by the Group.

 

(13)  Shown on 100 per cent basis. BHP Billiton interest in saleable production is 90 per cent.

 

(14)  Aluminium smelting at Bayside ceased with the closure of the final potline in June 2014.

 

(15)  Shown on 100 per cent basis. BHP Billiton interest in saleable production is 60 per cent, except Hotazel Manganese Mines which is 44.4 per cent.

 

(16)  Production includes medium-carbon ferromanganese.

2.3    Reserves

2.3.1    Petroleum reserves

Reserves and production

BHP Billiton Petroleum proved reserves are estimated and reported according to US Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC) standards and have been determined in accordance with SEC Rule 4-10(a) of Regulation S-X. Proved oil and gas reserves are those quantities of crude oil, natural gas and natural gas liquids (NGL), which, by analysis of geoscience and engineering data can be estimated with reasonable certainty to be economically producible from a given date forward from known reservoirs, and under existing economic conditions, operating methods, operating contracts and government regulations. Unless evidence indicates that renewal of existing operating contracts is reasonably certain, estimates of economically producible reserves reflect only the period before the contracts expire. The project to extract the hydrocarbons must have commenced or the operator must be reasonably certain that it will commence within a reasonable time. Developed oil and gas reserves are reserves that can be expected to be recovered through existing wells with existing equipment and operating methods, and through installed extraction equipment and infrastructure operational at the time of the reserve estimate if the extraction is by means not involving a well. As specified in SEC Rule 4-10(a) of Regulation S-X, oil and gas prices are taken as the unweighted average of the corresponding first day of the month prices for the 12 months prior to the ending date of the period covered.

Estimates of oil and gas reserves are inherently imprecise, require the application of judgement and are subject to future revision. Accordingly, financial and accounting measures (such as the standardised measure of discounted cash flows, depreciation, depletion and amortisation charges, the assessment of impairments and the assessment of valuation allowances against deferred tax assets) that are based on reserve estimates are also subject to change.

Proved reserves were estimated by reference to available well and reservoir information, including but not limited to well logs, well test data, core data, production and pressure data, geologic data, seismic data and, in some cases, to similar data from analogous, producing reservoirs. A wide range of engineering and geoscience methods, including performance analysis, well analogues and geologic studies were used to estimate high confidence proved developed and undeveloped reserves in accordance with SEC regulations. For our conventional assets, performance of producing wells was based on rate and pressure decline methods, including material balance, and was supplemented by reservoir simulation models where appropriate. In our Onshore US shale assets, performance of producing wells was based on decline and pressure normalised decline curve analysis methods. For wells that lacked sufficient production history, reserves were estimated using performance-based type curves and offset location analogues with similar geologic and reservoir characteristics. When assessing proved undeveloped locations, a combination of geologic and engineering data, and where appropriate, statistical analysis was used to support the assignment of proved undeveloped reserves. Performance data, along with log and core data, was used to delineate consistent, continuous reservoir characteristics in core areas of the

 

172


Table of Contents

development. Proved undeveloped locations were included in core areas between known data and adjacent to productive wells. Locations where a high degree of certainty could not be demonstrated using the above technologies and techniques, were not categorised as proved.

Proved reserve estimates were attributed to future development projects only where there is a significant commitment to project funding and execution, and for which applicable government and regulatory approvals have been secured or are reasonably certain to be secured. Furthermore, estimates of proved reserves include only volumes for which access to market is assured with reasonable certainty. All proved reserve estimates are subject to revision, either upward or downward, based on new information, such as from development drilling and production activities, or from changes in economic factors, including product prices, contract terms or development plans.

Reserve estimates contained in this section have been estimated with deterministic methodology, with the exception of the North West Shelf gas operation in Australia where probabilistic methodology has been utilised to estimate and aggregate reserves for the reservoirs dedicated to the gas project only. The probabilistic based portion of these reserves totals 30 MMboe (total boe conversion is based on the following: 6,000 scf of natural gas equals 1 boe) and represents approximately one per cent of our total reported proved reserves. Aggregation of proved reserves beyond the field/project level has been performed by arithmetic summation. Due to portfolio effects, aggregates of proved reserves may be conservative. The custody transfer point(s) or point(s) of sale applicable for each field or project are the reference point for reserves. The reserves replacement ratio is the reserves change during the year before production, divided by the production during the year stated as a percentage.

The Petroleum Reserves Group (PRG) is a dedicated group that provides oversight of the reserves’ assessment and reporting processes. It is independent of the various asset teams directly responsible for development and production activities. The PRG is staffed by individuals averaging more than 25 years’ experience in the oil and gas industry. The manager of the PRG, Abhijit Gadgil, is a full-time employee of BHP Billiton and is the individual responsible for overseeing and supervising the preparation of the reserve estimates and compiling the information for inclusion in this Annual Report. He has an advanced degree in engineering and more than 30 years of diversified industry experience in reservoir engineering, reserves assessment, field development and technical management and is a 30-year member of the Society of Petroleum Engineers (SPE). He has also served on the Society of Petroleum Engineers Oil and Gas Reserves Committee. Mr Gadgil has the qualifications and experience required to act as a qualified petroleum reserves evaluator under the Australian Securities Exchange (ASX) Listing Rules. The estimates of petroleum reserves are based on, and fairly represent, information and supporting documentation prepared under the supervision of Mr Gadgil and he has reviewed and agrees with the information included in section 2.3.1 of this Annual Report and has given his prior written consent for its publication. No part of the individual compensation for members of the PRG is dependent on reported reserves.

Petroleum’s reserves are estimated as of 30 June 2014. Reserve assessments for all Petroleum operations were conducted by technical staff within the operating organisation. These individuals meet the professional qualifications outlined by the Society of Petroleum Engineers, are trained in the fundamentals of SEC reserves reporting and the reserves processes and are endorsed by the PRG. Each reserve assessment is reviewed annually by the PRG to ensure technical quality, adherence to internally published Petroleum guidelines and compliance with SEC reporting requirements. Once endorsed by the PRG, all reserves receive final endorsement by senior management and the Risk and Audit Committee prior to public reporting. Our internal Group Risk Assessment and Assurance provides secondary assurance of the oil and gas reserve reporting processes through annual audits.

Production for FY2014 totalled 246 MMboe in sales, which is an increase of 10 MMboe from FY2013. There were an additional 6 MMboe in non-sales production, primarily for fuel consumed in our Petroleum operations. During FY2014, Petroleum added a total of 131 MMboe of proved oil and gas reserves. Excluding net purchases and sales of negative 14 MMboe, proved additions of 145 MMboe replaced 58 per cent of production sales and fuel through extensions, discoveries, and revisions. At 30 June 2014, approximately 47 per cent of our proved reserves were in conventional assets, while approximately 53 per cent were in unconventional assets.

 

173


Table of Contents

New additions from extensions and discoveries totalled 368 MMboe, primarily for new development projects in the North American shale fields where areas with high liquids production and greater value are being targeted. The Eagle Ford shale area contributed 157 MMboe to these new additions, while the Haynesville and Fayetteville areas contributed 131 MMboe. Revisions were negative 222 MMboe and are primarily related to deferral of drilling and adjustments to predicted well performance in undeveloped areas of the Eagle Ford, Permian, Haynesville and Fayetteville areas. The locations of the wells where drilling has been deferred are in relatively dry gas areas and are now planned to be drilled in more than five years’ time, as a result of our refocused drilling plans, and have been reclassified out of proved undeveloped reserves. None of the current unconventional proved undeveloped reserves will be more than five years old at the time they are drilled.

Our proved additions through extensions and revisions for conventional assets excluding purchases and sales totalled 83 MMboe in FY2014. Strong production performance in Macedon and other fields, and the Pyrenees Phase III infill project allowed the addition of 42 MMboe in our Australian operated fields while the non-operated joint interest Bass Strait and North West Shelf fields added 6 MMboe. Our US Gulf of Mexico fields had additions of 16 MMboe from extensions and revisions, while 27 MMboe was added for the extended gas sales project and production performance for the Angostura project in Trinidad and Tobago. During the year, we sold our interest in the Liverpool Bay fields in the UK offshore, which reduced proved reserves by 13 MMboe.

These results are summarised in the tables below, which detail estimated oil, condensate, NGL and natural gas reserves at 30 June 2014, 30 June 2013 and 30 June 2012, with a reconciliation of the changes in each year. Reserves have been calculated using the economic interest method and represent net interest volumes after deduction of applicable royalty. Reserves of 75 MMboe are in two production and risk-sharing arrangements that involve the Group in upstream risks and rewards without transfer of ownership of the products. At 30 June 2014, approximately three per cent of the proved reserves are attributable to those arrangements.

 

174


Table of Contents

Millions of barrels

  Australia     United
States
    Other (b)     Total  

Proved developed and undeveloped oil and condensate reserves (a)

       

Reserves at 30 June 2011

    171.2        257.9        40.8        469.9   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Improved recovery

           33.2               33.2   

Revisions of previous estimates

    8.7        120.6        5.1        134.4   

Extensions and discoveries

    8.8        2.9               11.7   

Purchase/sales of reserves

           32.0               32.0   

Production

    (31.2     (30.8     (9.2     (71.2
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total changes

    (13.6     157.8        (4.1     140.1   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Reserves at 30 June 2012

    157.6        415.7        36.6        610.0   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Improved recovery

           12.6        0.1        12.7   

Revisions of previous estimates

    13.7        (65.7     1.1        (50.9

Extensions and discoveries

    0.2        137.5        0.2        137.9   

Purchase/sales of reserves

           (1.9            (1.9

Production

    (25.9     (38.7     (7.9     (72.5
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total changes

    (12.0     43.8        (6.5     25.4   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Reserves at 30 June 2013

    145.7        459.6        30.1        635.4   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Improved recovery

                           

Revisions of previous estimates

    14.2        (50.0     (0.4     (36.1

Extensions and discoveries

           99.0        0.3        99.3   

Purchase/sales of reserves

           (0.4     (3.5     (3.9

Production

    (23.6     (54.0     (6.5     (84.1
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total changes

    (9.4     (5.4     (10.0     (24.8
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Reserves at 30 June 2014

    136.2        454.2        20.1        610.5   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Developed

       

Proved developed oil and condensate reserves

       

as of 30 June 2011

    116.0        92.2        38.5        246.7   

as of 30 June 2012

    101.5        148.6        36.5        286.6   

as of 30 June 2013

    105.0        209.5        27.7        342.2   

Developed Reserves as of 30 June 2014

    96.5        237.8        14.7        349.0   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Undeveloped

       

Proved undeveloped oil and condensate reserves

       

as of 30 June 2011

    55.2        165.7        2.2        223.1   

as of 30 June 2012

    56.2        267.1        0.1        323.4   

as of 30 June 2013

    40.6        250.1        2.5        293.2   

Undeveloped Reserves as of 30 June 2014

    39.7        216.4        5.4        261.5   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(a)  Small differences are due to rounding to first decimal place.

 

(b)  Other is comprised of Algeria, Pakistan, Trinidad and Tobago, and the United Kingdom.

 

175


Table of Contents

Millions of barrels

   Australia     United
States
    Other (c)     Total  

Proved developed and undeveloped NGL reserves (a)

        

Reserves at 30 June 2011

     102.9        9.6        0.7        113.2   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Improved recovery

            0.9               0.9   

Revisions of previous estimates

     0.2        49.7        (0.1     49.9   

Extensions and discoveries

            2.1               2.1   

Purchase/sales of reserves

            41.9               41.9   

Production (b)

     (7.9     (5.7     (0.4     (14.1
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total changes

     (7.7     89.0        (0.5     80.8   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Reserves at 30 June 2012

     95.2        98.6  (d)      0.2        194.0  (d) 
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Improved recovery

            1.0               1.0   

Revisions of previous estimates

     3.5        (23.3            (19.8

Extensions and discoveries

     0.1        82.2               82.3   

Purchase/sales of reserves

                            

Production (b)

     (7.9     (9.6            (17.5
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total changes

     (4.3     50.3               45.9   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Reserves at 30 June 2013

     90.9        148.9  (d)      0.2        239.9  (d) 
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Improved recovery

                            

Revisions of previous estimates

     (0.3     (25.3     (0.1     (25.7

Extensions and discoveries

            46.9               46.9   

Purchase/sales of reserves

            (0.2            (0.2

Production (b)

     (8.5     (13.6            (22.1
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total changes

     (8.8     7.7        (0.1     (1.2
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Reserves at 30 June 2014

     82.1        156.6  (d)             238.7  (d) 
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Developed

        

Proved developed NGL reserves

        

as of 30 June 2011

     60.3        2.6        0.7        63.6   

as of 30 June 2012

     53.9        22.5        0.2        76.6   

as of 30 June 2013

     54.7        54.1        0.2        108.9   

Developed Reserves as of 30 June 2014

     46.0        75.0               121.0   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Undeveloped

        

Proved undeveloped NGL reserves

        

as of 30 June 2011

     42.6        7.0        0.1        49.7   

as of 30 June 2012

     41.3        76.1               117.4   

as of 30 June 2013

     36.2        94.8               131.0   

Undeveloped Reserves as of 30 June 2014

     36.1        81.5               117.7   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(a)  Small differences are due to rounding to first decimal place.

 

(b) Production includes volumes consumed in operations.

 

(c) Other is comprised of Algeria, Pakistan, Trinidad and Tobago, and the United Kingdom.

 

(d) For 2012, 2013 and 2014, amounts include 1.7, 4.0 and 3.9 million barrels, respectively that are anticipated to be consumed in operations in the United States.

 

176


Table of Contents

Billions of cubic feet

   Australia (c)     United
States
    Other (d)     Total  

Proved developed and undeveloped natural gas reserves (a)

        

Reserves at 30 June 2011

     4,038.1        2,729.8        735.6        7,503.5   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Improved recovery

            3.3               3.3   

Revisions of previous estimates

     90.1        328.1        29.1        447.3   

Extensions and discoveries

     6.6        128.3               134.9   

Purchase/sales of reserves

            3,297.3               3,297.3   

Production (b)

     (276.1     (458.4     (122.6     (857.2
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total changes

     (179.5     3,298.7        (93.5     3,025.7   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Reserves at 30 June 2012

     3,858.6  (e)      6,028.5  (f)      642.1  (g)      10,529.2  (h) 
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Improved recovery

            3.4               3.4   

Revisions of previous estimates

     34.6        (1,159.5     (54.9     (1,179.8

Extensions and discoveries

     8.7        1,675.4               1,684.1   

Purchase/sales of reserves

            (0.5            (0.5

Production (b)

     (299.3     (491.3     (116.3     (906.9
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total changes

     (255.9     27.4        (171.2     (399.7
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Reserves at 30 June 2013

     3,602.6  (e)      6,055.9  (f)      471.0  (g)      10,129.5  (h) 
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Improved recovery

                            

Revisions of previous estimates

     207.9        (1,174.3     3.4        (962.9

Extensions and discoveries

            1,205.9        123.6        1,329.5   

Purchase/sales of reserves

            (1.5     (58.4     (59.9

Production (b)

     (315.2     (462.7     (96.9     (874.8
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total changes

     (107.2     (432.4     (28.4     (568.0
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Reserves at 30 June 2014

     3,495.4  (e)      5,623.5  (f)      442.6  (g)      9,561.5  (h) 
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Developed

        

Proved developed natural gas reserves

        

as of 30 June 2011

     1,754.0        1,122.1        719.9        3,596.0   

as of 30 June 2012

     1,619.0        2,742.5        634.5        4,996.0   

as of 30 June 2013

     2,674.4        3,094.3        471.0        6,239.7   

Developed Reserves as of 30 June 2014

     2,553.7        3,208.3        315.5        6,077.5   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Undeveloped

        

Proved undeveloped natural gas reserves

        

as of 30 June 2011

     2,284.1        1,607.7        15.7        3,907.4   

as of 30 June 2012

     2,239.6        3,286.0        7.6        5,533.2   

as of 30 June 2013

     928.2        2,961.6               3,889.8   

Undeveloped Reserves as of 30 June 2014

     941.7        2,415.2        127.1        3,484.0   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(a) Small differences are due to rounding to first decimal place.

 

(b)  Production includes volumes consumed by operations.

 

(c) Production for Australia includes gas sold as LNG.

 

(d) Other is comprised of Algeria, Pakistan, Trinidad and Tobago, and the United Kingdom.

 

(e)  For 2012, 2013 and 2014, amounts include 397, 387 and 360 billion cubic feet, respectively that are anticipated to be consumed in operations in Australia.

 

(f)  For 2012, 2013 and 2014, amounts include 104, 91 and 185 billion cubic feet, respectively that are anticipated to be consumed in operations in the United States.

 

(g)  For 2012, 2013 and 2014, amounts include 65, 49 and 30 billion cubic feet, respectively that are anticipated to be consumed in operations in Other areas.

 

(h)  For 2012, 2013 and 2014, amounts include 566, 527 and 575 billion cubic feet, respectively that are anticipated to be consumed in operations.

 

177


Table of Contents

Millions of barrels of oil equivalent (a)

   Australia     United
States
    Other (d)     Total  

Proved developed and undeveloped oil, condensate, natural gas and NGL reserves (b)

        

Reserves at 30 June 2011

     947.2        722.4        164.1        1,833.7   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Improved recovery

            34.7               34.7   

Revisions of previous estimates

     23.9        225.0        9.9        258.8   

Extensions and discoveries

     9.9        26.4               36.3   

Purchase/sales of reserves

            623.5               623.5   

Production (c)

     (85.1     (113.0     (30.1     (228.2
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total changes

     (51.3     796.6        (20.2     725.2   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Reserves at 30 June 2012

     895.9  (e)      1,519.0  (f)      143.9  (g)      2,558.8  (h) 
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Improved recovery

            14.2               14.2   

Revisions of previous estimates

     23.0        (282.3     (8.1     (267.3

Extensions and discoveries

     1.8        498.9        0.2        500.9   

Purchase/sales of reserves

            (2.0            (2.0

Production (c)

     (83.7     (130.2     (27.3     (241.2
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total changes

     (59.0     98.7        (35.1     4.7   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Reserves at 30 June 2013

     837.0  (e)      1,617.7  (f)      108.8  (g)      2,563.5  (h) 
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Improved recovery

                            

Revisions of previous estimates

     48.6        (271.0     0.1        (222.4

Extensions and discoveries

            346.8        20.9        367.7   

Purchase/sales of reserves

            (0.9     (13.2     (14.1

Production (c)

     (84.6     (144.7     (22.6     (251.9
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total changes

     (36.1     (69.7     (14.9     (120.6
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Reserves at 30 June 2014

     800.9  (e)      1,548.0  (f)      93.9  (g)      2,442.8  (h) 
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Developed

        

Proved developed oil, condensate, natural gas and NGL reserves

        

as of 30 June 2011

     468.6        281.9        159.2        909.7   

as of 30 June 2012

     425.1        628.2        142.5        1,195.8   

as of 30 June 2013

     605.5        779.2        106.3        1,491.0   

Developed Reserves as of 30 June 2014

     568.1        847.6        67.3        1,483.0   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Undeveloped

        

Proved undeveloped oil, condensate, natural gas and NGL reserves

        

as of 30 June 2011

     478.6        440.5        4.9        924.0   

as of 30 June 2012

     470.8        890.8        1.4        1,363.0   

as of 30 June 2013

     231.5        838.5        2.5        1,072.5   

Undeveloped Reserves as of 30 June 2014

     232.8        700.4        26.6        959.8   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(a)  Barrel oil equivalent conversion based on 6,000 scf of natural gas equals 1 boe.

 

(b)  Small differences are due to rounding to first decimal place.

 

(c)  Production includes volumes consumed by operations.

 

(d)  Other is comprised of Algeria, Pakistan, Trinidad and Tobago and the United Kingdom.

 

178


Table of Contents
(e)  For 2012, 2013 and 2014, amounts include 66, 64 and 60 million barrels equivalent, respectively that are anticipated to be consumed in operations in Australia.

 

(f)  For 2012, 2013 and 2014, amounts include 19, 19 and 35 million barrels equivalent, respectively that are anticipated to be consumed in operations in the United States.

 

(g)  For 2012, 2013 and 2014, amounts include 11, 8 and 5 million barrels equivalent, respectively that are anticipated to be consumed in operations in Other areas.

 

(h)  For 2012, 2013 and 2014, amounts include 96, 92 and 100 million barrels equivalent, respectively that are anticipated to be consumed in operations.

Proved undeveloped reserves

At 30 June 2014, Petroleum had 960 MMboe of proved undeveloped reserves, of which 604 MMboe, or 63 per cent, resided in our North American shale fields, while 356 MMboe or 37 per cent resided primarily in our offshore conventional fields in Australia, the Gulf of Mexico and the Caribbean. Compared to the total proved undeveloped of 1,072 MMboe reported at 30 June 2013, this represents a net reduction of 112 MMboe in proved undeveloped reserves during the year. This reduction was the combined result of development activities that converted proved undeveloped reserves into proved developed, the addition of new North American shale drilling locations, as well as revisions to the proved undeveloped reserves previously reported at 30 June 2013. Our active development program successfully drilled and converted 190 MMboe from proved undeveloped reserves to proved developed reserves during the year. Development activities in our North American shale fields converted 132 MMboe of this amount, while 34 MMboe of proved undeveloped were converted into proved developed in the Atlantis field in the Gulf of Mexico, with the remaining 20 MMboe of conversions in the Pyrenees, Macedon and Minerva fields in Australia.

New additions to proved undeveloped reserves through extensions to existing proven acreage for new planned drilling locations totalled 280 MMboe. Of this amount, 218 MMboe was added in our North American Shale fields for new planned wells, which will be fully drilled within the next five years. Other extensions totalling 41 MMboe occurred in the Atlantis and Mad Dog fields in the US Gulf of Mexico, with the remaining 21 MMboe for the Angostura field Phase III expansion in Trinidad and Tobago. Offsetting these new additions were revisions which reduced proved undeveloped reserves by 203 MMboe. Virtually all of these revisions were in our North American shale fields and resulted from refocusing of our drilling program to target the most productive and highest value drilling locations. This resulted in the deferral of planned drilling for selected locations beyond our five-year plan and reclassification of the related volumes from proved undeveloped into non-proved categories. Technical adjustments reflecting observed well performance also contributed to this reduction.

Of the 960 MMboe currently classified as proved undeveloped at 30 June 2014, 210 MMboe has been reported for five or more years. All of this amount is in our offshore conventional fields that are currently producing or being actively pursued, which are scheduled to start producing within the next five years. The largest component of this is 128 MMboe in the Kipper-Tuna-Turrum project in Bass Strait, Australia. This project is expected to be on production in 2016. The Atlantis field in the Gulf of Mexico contains 39 MMboe, which is actively being drilled. The remainder resides in other Australian offshore fields that have active development plans. Our North American shale fields do not contain any proved undeveloped reserves reported for five or more years. In addition, management plans anticipate drilling all the proved undeveloped reserves in the North American shale fields in the next five years, with none of the proved undeveloped reserves being more than five years old at the time they are drilled.

During FY2014, Petroleum continued timely development of our inventory of proved undeveloped projects by converting 190 MMboe to proved developed reserves. Over the past three years, the conversion of proved undeveloped to developed has totalled 585 MMboe, averaging 195 MMboe per year. In currently producing conventional fields, the remaining proved undeveloped reserves will be developed and brought on stream in a phased manner to best optimise the use of production facilities and to meet sales commitments. During FY2014, Petroleum spent US$6.1 billion on development activities worldwide.

 

179


Table of Contents

2.3.2    Ore Reserves

Ore Reserves are estimates of the amount of ore that can be economically and legally extracted and processed from our mining properties. In order to estimate reserves, assumptions are required about a range of geological, technical and economic factors, including quantities, grades, production techniques, recovery rates, production costs, transport costs, commodity demand, commodity prices and exchange rates. Estimating the quantity and/or grade of Ore Reserves requires the size, shape and depth of ore bodies to be determined by analysing geological data such as drilling samples. Because the economic assumptions used to estimate reserves change from period to period and because additional geological and operational data is generated during the course of operations, estimates of reserves may change from period to period. All of the Ore Reserve figures presented are reported in 100 per cent terms and represent estimates at 30 June 2014 (unless otherwise stated). All tonnes and grade information has been rounded, hence small differences may be present in the totals. Tonnes are reported as dry metric tonnes unless otherwise stated.

Our mineral leases are of sufficient duration (or convey a legal right to renew for sufficient duration) to enable all Ore Reserves on the leased properties to be mined in accordance with current production schedules. Our Ore Reserves may include areas where some additional approvals remain outstanding but where, based on the technical investigations we carry out as part of our mine planning process and our knowledge and experience of the approvals process, we expect that such approvals will be obtained as part of the normal course of business and within the timeframe required by the current life of mine schedule.

The reported Ore Reserves contained in this Annual Report do not exceed the quantities that we estimate could be extracted economically if future prices for each commodity were equal to the average historical prices for the three years to 31 December 2013, using current operating costs. However, we do not use a bauxite, aluminium or alumina price to determine bauxite reserves. The primary criteria for determining bauxite reserves are the feed specifications required by the captive alumina refinery. In addition to these specifications a number of modifying factors are used to differentiate bauxite reserves from other mineralised material. For our Hotazel Manganese Mines, geological stratigraphic controls, cut-off grade and plant feed requirements are used to determine reserves.

Also, in some cases where commodities are produced as by-products (or co-products) with other metals, we use the three-year average historical prices for the combination of commodities produced at the relevant mine in order to verify that each ore reserve is economic. The three-year historical average prices used for each traded commodity to test for impairment of the Ore Reserves contained in this Annual Report are as follows:

 

Commodity Price

       US$

Copper

       3.65/lb

Gold

       1,550/oz

Nickel

       8.39/lb

Silver

       30.07/oz

Lead

       1.00/lb

Zinc

       0.92/lb

Uranium

       47.91/lb

Iron Ore – Fines

Iron Ore – Lump

      

2.194/dmtu

2.361/dmtu

Metallurgical Hard Coking Coal

       200.5/t

Thermal Coal Newcastle (1)

       99.7/t

Thermal Coal Colombia (1)

       88.4/t

 

(1)  Thermal coal prices reported are sourced from the McCloskey Report FOB by region. Newcastle 6000 kcal/tonne Net As Received and Colombia 11,300 British Thermal Units Gross As Received. These are comparable to realised prices used to test for impairment. The realised price for South African Coal used to test for impairment is not aligned with the McCloskey Report price and is not disclosed in this table due to contractual commercial sensitivity.

 

180


Table of Contents

The reported reserves may differ in some respects from the reserves we report in our home jurisdictions of Australia and the UK. Those jurisdictions require the use of the Australasian Code for reporting of Exploration Results, Mineral Resources and Ore Reserves, December 2012 (the JORC Code), which contemplates the use of reasonable investment assumptions in calculating reserve estimates.

Copper Business

Ore Reserves in accordance with Industry Guide 7

 

As at 30 June 2014

    As at 30 June 2013  

Commodity
Deposit (1)(2)(3)(4)

  Ore Type   Proven Ore Reserves     Probable Ore Reserves     Total Ore Reserves     Reserve
Life
(years)
    BHP
Billiton
Interest
%
    Total Ore Reserves     Reserve
Life
(years)
 
    Mt     % TCu     % SCu                 Mt     % TCu     % SCu                 Mt     % TCu     % SCu                     Mt     % TCu     % SCu                

Copper

                                               

Escondida

  Oxide     92        0.88                   53        0.67                   145        0.80                       145        0.81                
  Sulphide     3,540        0.75                   1,610        0.59                   5,150        0.70                   52        57.5        5,100        0.72                   54   
  Sulphide
Leach
    1,650        0.46                   610        0.40                   2,260        0.44                       2,020        0.44                

Cerro Colorado

  Oxide     30        0.59        0.42            73        0.55        0.37            103        0.56        0.38            9.0        100        113        0.59        0.42            9   
  Sulphide     33        0.65        0.13            29        0.66        0.11            62        0.65        0.12                66        0.64        0.13         

Spence

  Oxide     34        0.76        0.53            2.8        0.77        0.63            37        0.76        0.54            10        100        35        0.79        0.57            10   
  Oxide
Low
Solubility
    21        0.96        0.44            12        0.57        0.22            33        0.82        0.36                38        0.83        0.36         
  Sulphide     121        0.96        0.12            32        0.64        0.11            153        0.90        0.12                153        0.92        0.12         
  ROM                              61        0.39        0.09            61        0.39        0.09                85        0.35        0.09         

Pinto Valley (5)

  Sulphide                                                                                              67        0.39                   4   
  Low-grade
Leach
                                                                                   13        0.21                
        Mt     % Cu     kg/t
U3O8
    g/tAu     g/tAg     Mt     % Cu     kg/t
U3O8
    g/tAu     g/tAg     Mt     % Cu     kg/t
U3O8
    g/tAu     g/tAg                 Mt     % Cu     kg/t
U3O8
    g/tAu     g/tAg        

Copper Uranium

                                               

Olympic Dam (6)

  Sulphide     129        1.97        0.59        0.72        4        389        1.82        0.56        0.72        4        518        1.86        0.57        0.72        4        47        100        619        1.76        0.57        0.74        3        56   
        Mt     % Cu     % Zn     g/tAg     ppmMo     Mt     % Cu     % Zn     g/tAg     ppmMo     Mt     % Cu     % Zn     g/tAg     ppmMo                 Mt     % Cu     % Zn     g/tAg     ppmMo        

Copper Zinc

                                               

Antamina

  Sulphide
Cu only
    136        1.00        0.14        9        350        277        0.98        0.17        9        290        413        0.99        0.16        9        310        13        33.75        498        0.92        0.11        9        290        14   
  Sulphide
Cu-Zn
    53        1.12        2.02        18        90        207        0.91        1.86        14        70        260        0.95        1.89        15        74            226        0.96        2.08        15        70     
        Mt     g/tAg     % Pb     % Zn           Mt     g/tAg     % Pb     % Zn           Mt     g/tAg     % Pb     % Zn                       Mt     g/tAg     % Pb     % Zn              

Silver Lead Zinc

                                               

Cannington

  UG
Sulphide
    18        239        6.38        3.92          2.7        240        6.15        4.01          21        239        6.35        3.93          9.0        100        25        247        6.45        3.81          11   

 

181


Table of Contents

 

(1) Cut-off grades:

 

Deposit

  

Ore Type

  

Ore Reserves

Escondida

   Oxide    ³ 0.20%SCu
   Sulphide Leach    ³ 0.30%TCu and lower than variable cut-off grade (V_COG) of concentrator – this is a complementary process to concentrators.
   Concentrator    V_COG – mine plans optimised considering financial and technical parameters in order to maximise Net Present Value.

Cerro Colorado

   Oxide & Sulphide    ³ 0.30%TCu

Spence

   Oxide    ³ 0.30%TCu
   Oxide Low Solubility    ³ 0.30%TCu
   Sulphide    ³ 0.30%TCu
   ROM    ³ 0.10%TCu

Olympic Dam

   Sulphide    Variable between 1.2%Cu and 1.5%Cu

Antamina

   Sulphide Cu only    Net value incorporating all material revenue and cost factors and includes metallurgical recovery (see footnote 4 for averages). Mineralisation at the US$6,000/hr limit averages 0.23%Cu, 7g/tAg, 31ppmMo and 5,530t/hr mill throughput.
   Sulphide Cu-Zn    Net value incorporating all material revenue and cost factors and includes metallurgical recovery (see footnote 4 for averages). Mineralisation at the US$6,000/hr limit averages 0.11%Cu, 0.83%Zn, 12g/tAg and 5,760t/hr mill throughput.

Cannington

   UG Sulphide    Net value cut-off incorporating material revenue and cost factors and includes metallurgical recovery (see footnote 4 for averages). Mineralisation at A$140/t averages 99g/tAg, 4.40%Pb and 2.82%Zn.

Antamina and Cannington: All metals used in net value calculations for the Antamina and Cannington reserves are recovered into concentrate (see footnote 4 for averages) and sold.

 

182


Table of Contents
(2)  Approximate drill hole spacings used to classify the reserves were:

 

Deposit

  

Proven Ore Reserves

  

Probable Ore Reserves

Escondida

   Oxide: 30m x 30m
Sulphide: 50m x 50m
Sulphide Leach: 60m x 60m
   Oxide: 45m x 45m
Sulphide: 90m x 90m
Sulphide Leach: 115m x 115m

Cerro Colorado

   70m x 70m on first kriging pass    120m x 120m on second kriging pass

Spence

   Oxide: maximum 50m x 50m
Sulphide: maximum 75m x 75m
   Oxide and Sulphide: maximum 100m x 100m

Olympic Dam

   Drilling grid of 20m to 30m    Drilling grid of 30m to 70m

Antamina

   30m drill spacing    55m drill spacing

Cannington

   12.5m sectional x 15m vertical    25m sectional x 25m vertical

 

(3)  Ore delivered to process plant.

 

(4)  Metallurgical recoveries for the operations were:

 

Deposit

  

Metallurgical Recovery

Escondida

   Oxide: 70%
Sulphide: 84%
Sulphide Leach: 32%

Cerro Colorado

   74% of TCu

Spence

   Oxide: 73% of TCu
Oxide Low Solubility: 71% of TCu
Sulphide: 72%
ROM: 30%

Olympic Dam

   Cu 94%, U3O8 72%, Au 70%, Ag 64%

Antamina

   Sulphide Cu only: Cu 93%, Zn 0%, Ag 78%, Mo 64%
Sulphide Cu-Zn: Cu 79%, Zn 80%, Ag 69%, Mo 0%

Cannington

   Ag 87%, Pb 86%, Zn 79%

 

(5)  Divestment of Pinto Valley was completed in October 2013.

 

(6)  Olympic Dam – The decrease in reserves was due to changes in Proven and Probable Reserves and a revised stope design process.

 

183


Table of Contents

Iron Ore Business

Ore Reserves in accordance with Industry Guide 7

 

As at 30 June 2014

    As at 30 June 2013  
        Proven Ore Reserves     Probable Ore Reserves     Total Ore Reserves     Reserve
Life
(years)
    BHP
Billiton
Interest
%
    Total Ore Reserves                 Reserve
Life
(years)
 

Commodity
Deposit (3)(4)(5)(6)(7)

 

Ore
Type

  Mt     % Fe     % P     % SiO2     % Al2O3     % LOI     Mt     % Fe     % P     % SiO2     % Al2O3     % LOI     Mt     % Fe     % P     % SiO2     % Al2O3     % LOI         Mt     % Fe     % P     % SiO2     % Al2O3     % LOI    

Iron Ore

                                                       

WAIO (1)(2)(8)(9)

  BKM     700        63.7        0.10        2.9        1.9        3.5        1,400        61.5        0.12        4.1        2.3        5.0        2,100        62.2        0.12        3.7        2.2        4.5        16        88        2,000        62.6        0.11        3.5        2.1        4.3        17   
 

BKM Bene

    90        61.3        0.09        6.7        2.7        1.7        80        60.0        0.09        8.3        2.8        1.8        170        60.7        0.09        7.5        2.7        1.7            160        60.6        0.09        7.5        2.9        1.7     
 

CID

    650        56.3        0.05        6.3        1.8        10.9        190        57.3        0.05        5.7        1.5        10.4        840        56.5        0.05        6.1        1.7        10.8            950        56.6        0.05        6.2        1.6        10.8     
 

MM

    220        62.1        0.07        3.1        1.7        5.7        310        61.0        0.07        3.8        2.0        6.2        530        61.5        0.07        3.5        1.9        6.0            500        61.7        0.07        3.4        1.9        5.9     
 

NIM

    10        59.6        0.06        10.2        1.4        2.5        20        60.0        0.05        10.1        1.0        2.1        30        59.8        0.05        10.2        1.2        2.3            20        59.9        0.06        10.0        1.2        2.3     
      Mt        % Fe        % Pc              Mt        % Fe        % Pc              Mt        % Fe        % Pc                  Mt        % Fe        % Pc           

Samarco JV

  ROM     1,800        40.1        0.05              1,100        38.8        0.05              2,900        39.6        0.05              39        50        3,000        39.7        0.05              40   

 

(1) Western Australia Iron Ore (WAIO) Reserves are reported on a Pilbara basis by ore type to align with our production of the Newman Blend lump product which comprises of BKM, BKM Bene and MM ore types, in addition to other lump and fines products. This also reflects our single logistics chain and associated management system and our equalisation of joint venture equity.

 

(2) WAIO BHP Billiton interest is reported as Pilbara reserve tonnes weighted average across all Joint Ventures.

 

(3)  Approximate drill hole spacings used to classify the reserves were:

 

Deposit

  

Proven Ore Reserves

  

Probable Ore Reserves

WAIO

   50m x 50m    150m x 50m

Samarco JV

   Maximum 150m x 100m    Maximum 300m x 200m

 

(4)  WAIO metallurgical recovery was 100%, except for BKM Bene-Brockman Beneficiated Ore, where recovery was 73% (tonnage basis), Samarco JV recovery was 82% (metal basis).

 

(5)  The reserves grades listed refer to in situ mass percentage on a dry weight basis. WAIO tonnages represent wet tonnes based on the following moisture contents: BKM – 3%, BKM Bene – 3%, CID – 8%, MM – 4%, NIM – 3.5%. For Samarco JV, the reserve tonnages also represent wet tonnes based on a moisture content of 6.5% for ROM. Iron ore is marketed for WAIO as Lump (direct blast furnace feed) and Fines (sinter plant feed) and for Samarco JV as Fines (sinter plant feed), direct reduction and blast furnace pellets.

 

(6)  Cut-off grades: WAIO 50 – 58%Fe for all material types; Samarco JV Fe ³ 22%, Pc £ 0.097% (phosphorous in concentrate) and PPCc £ 7.7% (LOI in concentrate).

 

(7)  Ore delivered to process plant.

 

(8)  The operations to support NIM ore type are currently on care and maintenance.

 

(9)  WAIO reserves are all located on State Agreement mining leases that guarantee the right to mine, except Callawa (NIM), which resides on a standard Western Australian mining lease. Across WAIO, State Government approvals (including environmental and heritage clearances) are required before commencing mining operations in a particular area. Included in the Ore Reserves are select areas where one or more approvals remain outstanding, but where, based on the technical investigations carried out as part of the mine planning process and company knowledge and experience of the approvals process, it is expected that such approvals will be obtained as part of the normal course of business and within the time frame required by the current mine schedule.

 

184


Table of Contents

Coal Business

Ore Reserves in accordance with Industry Guide 7

 

As at 30 June 2014

    As at 30 June 2013  

Commodity
Deposit (1)(2)(3)(4)(5)

 

Mining
Method

 

Coal
Type

  Proven Coal
Reserves
    Probable Coal
Reserves
    Total Coal
Reserves
    Proven Marketable
Coal Reserves
    Probable Marketable
Coal Reserves
    Total Marketable Coal
Reserves
    Reserve
Life
(years)
    BHP
Billiton
Interest %
    Total Marketable Coal
Reserves
    Reserve
Life
(years)
 
      Mt     Mt     Mt     Mt     % Ash     % VM     % S     Mt     % Ash     % VM     % S     Mt     % Ash     % VM     % S         Mt     % Ash     % VM     % S    

Metallurgical Coal

                                               

Queensland Coal

                                               

CQCA JV

                                               

Goonyella Riverside Broadmeadow

  OC   Met     321        224        545        244        9.3        22.7        0.50        160        10.5        22.7        0.50        404        9.8        22.7        0.50        30        50        417        9.8        22.7        0.50        32   
  UG   Met     43        160        203        35        8.0        23.0        0.52        109        9.3        23.6        0.54        144        9.0        23.4        0.54            146        7.0        24.2        0.52     

Peak Downs (6)

  OC   Met     492        548        1,040        296        10.6        22.3        0.60        317        10.3        21.9        0.59        613        10.5        22.1        0.60        34        50        626        10.5        22.1        0.60        34   

Saraji

  OC   Met     386        153        539        240        10.6        18.0        0.60        87        10.6        18.5        0.70        327        10.6        18.1        0.63        37        50        336        10.6        18.1        0.63        39   

Norwich Park (7)

  OC   Met     154        62        216        111        10.3        16.8        0.70        42        10.3        16.4        0.70        153        10.3        16.7        0.70        25        50        153        10.3        16.7        0.70        25   

Blackwater (8)

  OC   Met/Th     143        379        522        126        8.0        26.7        0.40        333        9.1        26.1        0.40        459        8.8        26.3        0.40        30        50        472        8.8        26.3        0.40        35   

Daunia (9)

  OC   Met     88        50        138        72        8.2        20.8        0.36        40        8.4        20.5        0.34        112        8.3        20.7        0.35        25        50        116        8.2        20.7        0.36        32   

Gregory JV

                                               

Gregory Crinum (7)

  OC   Met     6.6        0.3        6.9        5.4        7.0        34.8        0.60        0.2        7.0        35.3        0.60        5.6        7.0        34.8        0.60        2.8        50        5.6        7.0        34.8        0.60        3   
  UG   Met            13        13                                    11        7.2        33.8        0.58        11        7.2        33.8        0.58            14        7.5        33.7        0.60     

BHP Billiton Mitsui

                                               

South Walker Creek (10)

  OC   Met     68        21        89        50        9.0        14.3        0.32        15        9.0        13.9        0.31        65        9.0        14.2        0.32        11        80        85        9.0        14.3        0.30        21   

Poitrel-Winchester (11)

  OC   Met     33        33        66        23        8.3        23.2        0.33        22        8.3        24.0        0.34        45        8.3        23.6        0.34        14        80        38        8.5        23.5        0.34        13   

Illawarra Coal

                                               

Appin

  UG   Met/Th     24        133        157        20        8.9        23.5        0.37        112        8.9        24.9        0.36        132        8.9        24.7        0.36        25        100        134        8.9        24.7        0.36        26   

West Cliff

  UG   Met/Th     5.4        0.4        5.8        3.8        8.9        20.6        0.36        0.3        8.9        20.1        0.36        4.1        8.9        20.6        0.36        2.0        100        5.8        8.9        20.7        0.36        3   

Dendrobium

  UG   Met/Th     21        24        45                                                                                              100                                    10   
  UG   Met                          8.6        9.7        23.8        0.59        9.9        9.7        24.2        0.59        18        9.7        24.0        0.59        8.9          20        9.7        24.0        0.59     
  UG   Th                          5.2        23.0                      6.3        23.0                      12        23.0                          13        23.0                   

 

(1)  Only geophysically logged, fully analysed cored holes with greater than 95% recovery were used to classify the reserves. Drill hole spacings vary between seams and geological domains and were determined in conjunction with geostatistical analyses where applicable. The range of maximum spacings was:

 

Deposit

  

Proven Coal Reserves

  

Probable Coal Reserves

Goonyella Riverside Broadmeadow

   500m to 1,000m plus 3D seismic coverage for UG    1,000m to 2,050m

Peak Downs

   500m to 1,050m    500m to 2,100m

Saraji

   500m to 1,040m    900m to 2,100m

Norwich Park

   500m to 1,400m    1,000m to 2,800m

Blackwater

   500m    500m to 1,000m

Daunia

   500m to 1,000m    1,000m to 2,000m

Gregory Crinum

   850m plus 3D seismic coverage for UG    850m to 1,700m

South Walker Creek

   500m to 800m    1,000m to 1,500m

Poitrel-Winchester

   300m to 950m    550m to 1,850m

Appin

   700m    1,500m

West Cliff

   700m    1,500m

Dendrobium

   700m    1,500m

 

185


Table of Contents
(2)  Product recoveries for the operations were:

 

Deposit

  

Product Recovery

Goonyella Riverside Broadmeadow

   73%

Peak Downs

  

Peak Downs: 62%

Caval Ridge: 56%

Saraji

   61%

Norwich Park

   71%

Blackwater

   88%

Daunia

   80%

Gregory Crinum

   80%

South Walker Creek

   73%

Poitrel-Winchester

   67%

Appin

   84%

West Cliff

   71%

Dendrobium

   67%

 

(3)  Total Coal Reserves are at the moisture content when mined (4% CQCA JV, Gregory JV, BHP Billiton Mitsui; 6% Appin, West Cliff; 7% Dendrobium). Total Marketable Coal Reserves are the tonnes of coal available, at moisture content (9% CQCA JV, Gregory JV, Appin, West Cliff; 9.5% South Walker Creek; 12.0% Poitrel-Winchester; 13.5% Dendrobium Met; 7% Dendrobium Th) and air-dried qualities, for sale after the beneficiation of the Total Coal Reserves.

 

(4)  Cut-off criteria applied were – Goonyella Riverside, Peak Downs, Caval Ridge, Saraji, Norwich Park, Blackwater, Gregory, South Walker Creek ³ 0.5m seam thickness; Broadmeadow ³ 2.5m seam thickness; Daunia, Poitrel-Winchester ³ 0.3m seam thickness; Crinum ³ 2.0m seam thickness; Appin, West Cliff, Dendrobium ³ 1.8m seam thickness.

 

(5)  Coal delivered to wash plant.

 

(6)  Peak Downs – The reserves for Caval Ridge are reported as part of Peak Downs.

 

(7)  Norwich Park and Gregory mines remain on care and maintenance.

 

(8)  Blackwater – The decrease in Reserve Life was due to an increased nominated production rate from 15.4Mtpa in FY2013 to 17.7Mtpa in FY2014.

 

(9)  Daunia – The decrease in Reserve Life was due to an increased nominated production rate from 4.5Mtpa in FY2013 to 5.5Mtpa in FY2014.

 

(10)  South Walker Creek – The decrease in Coal Reserves was mainly due to revised price and cost assumptions. The decrease in Reserve Life was due to the decrease in Coal Reserves and an increased nominated production rate from 5.6Mtpa in FY2013 to 7.9Mtpa in FY2014.

 

(11)  Poitrel-Winchester – The decrease in Reserve Life was due to an increased nominated production rate from 4.2Mtpa in FY2013 to 4.7Mtpa in FY2014.

 

186


Table of Contents

Coal Business

Ore Reserves in accordance with Industry Guide 7

 

As at 30 June 2014

    As at 30 June 2013  

Commodity Deposit (1)(2)(3)(4)(5)

  Mining
Method
  Coal
Type
  Proven
Coal
Reserves
    Probable
Coal
Reserves
    Total
Coal
Reserves
    Proven Marketable Coal
Reserves
    Probable Marketable Coal
Reserves
    Total Marketable Coal Reserves     Reserve
Life
(years)
    BHP
Billiton
Interest %
    Total Marketable Coal Reserves     Reserve
Life
(years)
 
      Mt     Mt     Mt     Mt     % Ash     % VM     % S     KCal/kg
CV
    Mt     % Ash     % VM     % S     KCal/kg
CV
    Mt     % Ash     % VM     % S     KCal/kg
CV
        Mt     % Ash     % VM     % S     KCal/kg
CV
    % Total
Moisture (6)
   

Energy Coal

                                                         

New Mexico

                                                         

San Juan (7)

  UG   Th     21               21        21        17.2          0.99        5,640                                           21        17.2               0.99        5,640        3.5        100        25        22.7               0.85        5,400        8.5        4   

Navajo (7)(8)

  OC   Th     17               17        17        21.8          0.76        4,900                                           17        21.8               0.76        4,900        3.1               22        21.8               0.76        4,900        13.0        3   

South Africa (9)

                                                         

Khutala (10)

  OC   Th     1.4               1.4        1.3        35.7        21.1        1.15        4,640                                           1.3        35.7        21.1        1.15        4,640          90        3.0        34.0        21.6        1.25        4,700        7.0     
  UG   Th     36               36        33        33.6        20.3        0.76        4,440                                           33        33.6        20.3        0.76        4,440        5.8        90        44        34.4        20.1        0.70        4,400        7.0        7   

Wolvekrans (11)

  OC   Th     389        17        406        273        21.8        23.4        0.47        6,010        12        22.5        23.7        0.45        5,950        285        21.8        23.4        0.46        6,010        21        90        328        24.2        22.6        0.48        5,900        8.0        22   

Middelburg (12)

  OC   Th     97               97        80        23.2        23.0        0.47        5,890                                           80        23.2        23.0        0.47        5,890        23        90        93        24.5        22.5        0.50        5,900        8.0        24   

Klipspruit (13)

  OC   Th     43               43        36        23.0        23.3        0.82        5,800                                           36        23.0        23.3        0.82        5,800        6.0        90        47        22.9        23.3        0.61        5,800        8.7        7   

Australia

                                                         

Mt Arthur Coal (14)

  OC   Th     560        464        1,024        445        16.6        30.7        0.57        6,420        372        16.8        29.9        0.50        6,410        817        16.7        30.3        0.54        6,410        33        100        837        16.7        30.3        0.54        6,400        8.7        40   

Colombia

                                                         

Cerrejón (15)

  OC   Th     629        96        725        610        9.4        33.8        0.60        6,180        94        9.0        32.7        0.60        6,110        704        9.3        33.7        0.60        6,170        17        33.33        730        9.3        33.7        0.60        6,200        12.5        19   

 

(1)  Approximate drill hole spacings used to classify the reserves were:

 

Deposit

  

Proven Coal Reserves

  

Probable Coal Reserves

San Juan

   <500m (250m radius from drill hole)    500m to 1,000m (250m to 500m radius from drill hole)

Navajo

   <500m (250m radius from drill hole)    500m to 1,000m (250m to 500m radius from drill hole)

Khutala

   >8 boreholes per 100ha    4 to 8 boreholes per 100ha

Wolvekrans

   >8 boreholes per 100ha    4 to 8 boreholes per 100ha

Middelburg

   >8 boreholes per 100ha    4 to 8 boreholes per 100ha

Klipspruit

   >8 boreholes per 100ha    4 to 8 boreholes per 100ha

Mt Arthur Coal

   <500 m    500m to 1,000m

Cerrejón

   > 6 boreholes per 100ha    2 to 6 boreholes per 100ha

 

(2)  Product recoveries for the operations were:

 

Deposit

  

Product Recovery

San Juan

   100%

Navajo

   100%

Khutala

   92%

Wolvekrans

   70%

Middelburg

   82%

Klipspruit

   84%

Mt Arthur Coal

   79%

Cerrejón

   97%

 

187


Table of Contents
(3)  Cut-off criteria applied were:

 

Deposit

  

Coal Reserves

San Juan

   ³ 3.0m seam thickness, ³ 5,000KCal/kg CV

Navajo

   ³ 0.6m seam thickness

Khutala

   ³ 1.0m seam thickness for OC and ³ 3.6m seam thickness for UG

Wolvekrans

   ³ 1.0m seam thickness, ³ 2,870KCal/kg CV, £ 45% ash, ³ 17.9% volatile matter

Middelburg

   ³ 1.0m seam thickness, ³ 2,870KCal/kg CV, £ 45% ash, ³ 17.9% volatile matter

Klipspruit

   ³ 1.0m seam thickness, varying ³ 3,580KCal/kg to ³ 4,300KCal/kg, £ 45% ash

Mt Arthur Coal

   ³ 0.3m mineable seam thickness, £ 26.5% ash, ³ 50% product yield

Cerrejón

   ³ 0.65m seam thickness

 

(4) Coal delivered to wash plant, except for San Juan, Navajo and Khutala, where coal is not washed.

 

(5) Total Coal Reserves are at the moisture content when mined (8.5% San Juan; 13.0% Navajo; 8.7% Mt Arthur Coal; 12.8% Cerrejón). Total Marketable Coal Reserves are the tonnes of coal available, at moisture content (8.5% San Juan; 13.0% Navajo; 9.3% Mt Arthur Coal; 14.1% Cerrejón) and air-dried qualities, for sale after the beneficiation of the Total Coal Reserves.

 

(6) Total moisture is for Total Marketable Coal Reserves product.

 

(7)  San Juan and Navajo – Coal Reserves were reduced to align with current sales contracts.

 

(8) Navajo – Divestment completed in December 2013. BHP Billiton will remain the mine manager and operator until 2016 and therefore production will continue to be reported.

 

(9)  Tonnages and qualities for Khutala, Wolvekrans, Middelburg and Klipspruit are reported on an air-dried basis.

 

(10)  Khutala – The decrease in Coal Reserves was due to revised extraction factors for underground pillars in structurally disturbed areas.

 

(11) Wolvekrans – The decrease in Marketable Coal Reserves was due to a reduced yield impact as a result of increased loss and dilution in pillar mining areas.

 

(12)  Middelburg – The decrease in Coal Reserves was mainly due to the inclusion of a 100m bufferzone around major powerlines and the exclusion of environmentally sensitive areas.

 

(13) Klipspruit – The decrease in Coal Reserves was due to a lower extraction factor. In addition, the Marketable Coal Reserves decreased due to a revised wash plant efficiency factor used to determine the product yield.

 

(14) Mt Arthur Coal – The decrease in Reserve Life was due to an increased nominated production rate from 26Mtpa in FY2013 to 30.8Mtpa in FY2014.

 

(15) Cerrejón – The decrease in Reserve Life was due to an increased nominated production rate from 40 Mtpa in FY2013 to 41.5 Mtpa in FY2014.

 

188


Table of Contents

Aluminium, Manganese & Nickel Business

Ore Reserves in accordance with Industry Guide 7

 

As at 30 June 2014

    As at 30 June 2013  

Commodity
Deposit (1)(2)(3)(4)

        Proven Ore Reserves     Probable Ore Reserves     Total Ore Reserves     Reserve
Life
(years)
    BHP
Billiton
Interest
%
    Total Ore Reserves     Reserve
Life
(years)
 
  Ore Type     Mt     % A.Al2O3     % R.SiO2     Mt     % A.Al2O3     % R.SiO2     Mt     % A.Al2O3     % R.SiO2         Mt     % A.Al2O3     % R.SiO2    

Bauxite

                               

Australia

                               

Worsley

    Laterite        274        31.0        1.6        22        30.2        1.7        295        31.0        1.6        17        86        301        30.9        1.8        17   

Brazil

                               

MRN (5)(6)

   
 
MRN
Washed
  
  
    79        49.3        4.6        19        49.8        4.8        98        49.4        4.6        6.1        14.8        51        50.9        4.1        3   

 

(1) Cut-off grades – Worsley: variable ranging from 24-29.5%A.Al2O3, £ 3%R.SiO2 and ³ 1m thickness; MRN: ³ 50%TAl2O3, £ 10%TSiO2, ³ 1m thickness and ³ 30% recovery on a weight per cent basis.

 

(2) Ore delivered to process plant.

 

(3) Approximate drill hole spacings used to classify the reserves were:

 

Deposit

  

Proven Ore Reserves

  

Probable Ore Reserves

Worsley

   Maximum 80m    Maximum 160m

MRN

   A bauxite intersection grid of 200m, plus at least 10 samples reached by search ellipsoid. Mining and metallurgical characterisation (test pit/bulk sample), plus a reliable suite of chemical and size distribution data    Those areas with a bauxite intersection grid spacing of less than 400m and/or a 400m spaced grid with a 200m offset fill in, plus a minimum of 7 samples reached by search ellipsoid, plus a reliable suite of chemical and size distribution data

 

(4) Metallurgical recoveries for the operations were:

 

Deposit

  

Estimated Metallurgical Recovery of A.Al2O3

Worsley (Worsley Refinery)

   91%

MRN (Alumar Refinery)

   92%

 

(5) MRN – Washed tonnes and grade represent expected product based on forecast beneficiated yield.

 

(6) MRN – The reserves are located on mining leases that provide MRN the right to mine. Current mining areas have environmental approval to operate. The increase in reserves was due to the approval of mining permits for additional plateaus.

 

189


Table of Contents

Aluminium, Manganese & Nickel Business

Ore Reserves in accordance with Industry Guide 7

 

As at 30 June 2014

    As at 30 June 2013  

Commodity Deposit (1)(2)(3)(4)

  Ore Type   Proven Ore
Reserves
    Probable Ore
Reserves
    Total Ore Reserves     Reserve
Life
(years)
    BHP
Billiton
Interest %
    Total Ore Reserves     Reserve
Life
(years)
 
    Mt     % Mn     % Yield     Mt     % Mn     % Yield     Mt     % Mn     % Yield         Mt     % Mn     % Yield    

Manganese

                               

Australia

                               

GEMCO (5)

  ROM     78        45.0        58        16        42.6        57        94        44.6        58        11        60        101        44.7        59        12   
South Africa (6)       Mt     % Mn     % Fe     Mt     % Mn     % Fe     Mt     % Mn     % Fe                 Mt     % Mn     % Fe        

Wessels

  Lower Body-HG     1.2        48.0        12.2        7.2        47.6        12.3        8.4        47.7        12.3        46        44.4        11        47.6        11.9        48   
  Lower Body-LG     2.2        41.3        11.9        13        41.8        13.2        15        41.7        13.0            13        42.1        13.2     
  Upper Body           46        41.4        18.2        46        41.4        18.2            48        41.5        17.9     

Mamatwan

  M, C, N Zones     19        37.6        4.4        41        37.1        4.5        60        37.3        4.5        18        44.4        65        37.2        4.5        20   
  X Zone     1.6        38.2        4.7        2.4        36.7        4.8        4.0        37.3        4.8            4.0        36.7        4.8     

 

(1) Cut-off grades – GEMCO: ³ 40%Mn washed product and ³ 1m ore thickness; Wessels: ³ 45%Mn for Lower Body-HG, ³ 37.5%Mn for Lower Body-LG and Upper Body; Mamatwan: ³ 35%Mn for M, C, N and X Zones.

 

(2) Approximate drill hole spacings used to classify the reserves were:

 

Deposit

  

Proven Ore Reserves

  

Probable Ore Reserves

GEMCO

   60m x 120m and 60m x 60m    120m x 120m

Wessels

   Defined as rim ±30m wide around mined-out areas, supplemented by some economically viable remnant blocks within mined-out areas    Defined as all ground beyond 30m

Mamatwan

   80m x 80m    160m x 160m

 

(3)  Metallurgical recoveries for the operations were:

 

Deposit

  

Metallurgical Recovery

GEMCO

   See yield in Ore Reserves table

Wessels

   88%

Mamatwan

   96%

 

(4) Ore delivered to process plant.

 

(5) GEMCO – Tonnes are stated as ROM, manganese grades are reported as expected product and should be read together with their respective tonnage yields.

 

(6) Wessels and Mamatwan – Tonnes are stated as wet tonnes.

 

190


Table of Contents

Aluminium, Manganese & Nickel Business

Ore Reserves in accordance with Industry Guide 7

 

As at 30 June 2014

     As at 30 June 2013  

Commodity

Deposit (1)(2)(3)(4)

   Ore Type    Proven Ore
Reserves
     Probable Ore
Reserves
     Total Ore
Reserves
     Reserve
Life
(years)
     BHP
Billiton
Interest
%
     Total Ore
Reserves
     Reserve
Life
(years)
 
      Mt      % Ni      Mt      % Ni      Mt      % Ni            Mt      % Ni     

Nickel

Colombia

                                   

Cerro Matoso (5)

   Laterite      16         1.2         7.7         1.0         24         1.1         15         99.94         43         1.2         28   
   SP      24         1.3                         24         1.3               40         1.2      
   MNR Ore                                                            18         0.2      

Australia – Nickel West

                                   

Leinster (6)

   OC      2.8         1.3         0.2         0.9         3.0         1.3         1.5         100         3.1         1.3         8   
   SP                                                            0.1         2.3      
   UG                                                            9.3         1.8      

Mt Keith (7)

   OC      51         0.6         1.1         0.5         52         0.6         5.9         100         93         0.6         12   
   SP      5.7         0.5         5.5         0.5         11         0.5               20         0.5      

Cliffs

   UG      0.7         2.6         0.9         2.5         1.6         2.6         3.2         100         1.6         2.8         4   

 

(1)  Cut-off grades – Cerro Matoso: ³ 0.7%Ni for Laterite and SP; Leinster: ³ 0.6%Ni for OC, ³ 0.9%Ni for UG and SP; Mt Keith: variable ranging from 0.35-0.40% Ni and ³ 0.18% recoverable Ni for OC and SP; Cliffs: ³ 1.1% Ni for UG.

 

(2)  Approximate drill hole spacings used to classify the reserves were:

 

Deposit

  

Proven Ore Reserves

  

Probable Ore Reserves

Cerro Matoso

   35m or less with three drill holes    35m to 100m with three drill holes

Leinster

   25m x 25m    25m x 50m

Mt Keith

   60m x 40m    80m x 80m

Cliffs

   25m x 25m (and development)    50m x 50m

 

(3)       Metallurgical recoveries for the operations were:

 

Deposit

  

Metallurgical Recovery

Cerro Matoso

   82% (reserves to metal)

Leinster Concentrator (including Cliffs)

   84% at 12% concentrate grade

Mt Keith

   57% at 16% concentrate grade

 

(4)  Ore delivered to process plant.

 

(5)  Cerro Matoso – The decrease in laterite reserves was due to the exclusion of La Esmerelda (environmental licence approval delay), lower nickel price assumptions, an updated geotechnical model, revised processing plant specifications and changed stockpile assumptions.

 

(6)  Leinster – The decrease in reserves was due to suspension of mining at the Perseverance underground mine subsequent to a seismic event in October 2013.

 

(7)  Mt Keith – The decrease in in-situ reserves was due to the exclusion of Stage H2 after testing with current prices.

 

191


Table of Contents

2.4    Major projects

Major projects

At the end of FY2014, BHP Billiton had seven low-risk, relatively brownfield major projects under development and one major ‘pre-development’ project in evaluation (Jansen Potash) with a combined budget of US$14.1 billion. The Group completed the WAIO Jimblebar Mine Expansion and Caval Ridge projects during the year. In addition a further four projects were successfully completed; namely: Macedon; North West Shelf North Rankin B Gas Compression; Samarco Fourth Pellet Plant; and WAIO Port Blending and Rail Yard Facilities. Another two projects, Newcastle Third Port Stage 3 and Cerrejón P40, delivered first coal during the year.

The port expansion associated with the Cerrejón P40 project is currently being commissioned, although operational issues are expected to constrain capacity at approximately 35 Mtpa (100 per cent basis) in the medium term.

A US$212 million increase in the budget of the Escondida Oxide Leach Area Project (OLAP) to US$933 million was approved during the period. The project is now expected to be completed in the second half of CY2014, with no associated impact to production.

In July 2013, BHP Billiton announced an investment of US$3.4 billion to construct a desalination facility which will deliver sustainable water supply to Escondida over the long term. In August 2013, BHP Billiton also approved a US$2.6 billion investment to finish the excavation and lining of the Jansen Potash Project production and service shafts, and to continue the installation of essential surface infrastructure and utilities.

BHP Billiton’s share of capital and exploration expenditure declined by 32 per cent during FY2014, to US$15.2 billion. Capital and exploration expenditure is expected to remain broadly unchanged in the 2015 financial year with a planned investment rate of US$14.8 billion.

Projects completed or delivered first production during the 2014 financial year

 

Business

 

Project

 

Capacity (1)

  Capital
expenditure
(US$M) (1)
    Date of initial production  
      Actual (2)     Budget     Actual     Target  

Petroleum

  Macedon (Australia) 71.43% (operator)   200 million cubic feet of gas per day.     1,200        1,050        Q3 CY13        CY13   
  North West Shelf North Rankin B Gas Compression (Australia) 16.67% (non-operator)   2,500 million cubic feet of gas per day.     721        850        Q4 CY13        CY13   

Iron Ore

  Samarco Fourth Pellet Plant (Brazil) 50%   Increases Samarco iron ore pellet production capacity by 8.3 million tonnes per annum to 30.5 million tonnes per annum.     1,576        1,750        Q1 CY14        H1 CY14   
  WAIO Jimblebar Mine Expansion (Australia) 85%   Increases mining and processing capacity to 35 million tonnes per annum with incremental debottlenecking opportunities to 55 million tonnes per annum.     3,380        3,640  (3)(4)      Q3 CY13        Q4 CY13  (4) 

 

192


Table of Contents

Business

 

Project

 

Capacity (1)

  Capital
expenditure
(US$M) (1)
    Date of initial production  
      Actual (2)     Budget     Actual     Target  
  WAIO Port Blending and Rail Yard Facilities (Australia) 85%   Optimises resource and enhances efficiency across the WAIO supply chain.     916        1,000  (3)(4)      Q4 CY13        H2 CY14   

Coal

  Caval Ridge (Australia) 50%   Greenfield mine development to produce an initial 5.5 million tonnes per annum of export metallurgical coal.     1,706        1,870  (3)      Q2 CY14        CY14   
  Newcastle Third Port Project Stage 3 (Australia) 35.5%   Increases total coal terminal capacity from 53 million tonnes per annum to 66 million tonnes per annum.     367        367        Q3 CY13        CY14   
  Cerrejón P40 Project (Colombia) 33.3%   Increases saleable thermal coal production by 8 million tonnes per annum to approximately 40 million tonnes per annum.     437        437        Q4 CY13        CY13   
     

 

 

   

 

 

     
        10,303        10,964       
     

 

 

   

 

 

     

Projects in execution at the end of the 2014 financial year

 

Business

 

Project

 

Capacity (1)

  Capital expenditure
(US$M) (1)
    Date of initial production  

Projects under development

       Budget          Target  

Petroleum

  North West Shelf Greater Western Flank-A (Australia) 16.67% (non-operator)   To maintain LNG plant throughput from the North West Shelf operations        400           CY16   
  Bass Strait Longford Gas Conditioning Plant (Australia) 50% (non-operator)   Designed to process approximately 400 million cubic feet of high CO2 gas        520           CY16   

Copper

  Escondida Oxide Leach Area Project (Chile) 57.5%   New dynamic leaching pad and mineral handling system. Maintains oxide leaching capacity        933  (4)         H2 CY14  (4) 
  Escondida Organic Growth Project 1 (Chile) 57.5%   Replaces the Los Colorados concentrator with a new 152,000 tonnes per day plant        3,838           H1 CY15   
  Escondida Water Supply (Chile) 57.5%   New desalination facility to ensure continued water supply to Escondida        3,430           CY17   

 

193


Table of Contents

Business

 

Project

 

Capacity (1)

  Capital expenditure
(US$M) (1)
    Date of initial production  

Projects under development

       Budget          Target  

Coal

  Hay Point Stage Three Expansion (Australia) 50%   Increases port capacity from 44 million tonnes per annum to 55 million tonnes per annum and reduces storm vulnerability        1,505  (3)(4)         CY15  (4) 
  Appin Area 9 (Australia) 100%   Maintains Illawarra Coal’s production capacity with a replacement mining domain and capacity to produce 3.5 million tonnes per annum of metallurgical coal        845           CY16   
        

 

 

      
           11,471        
        

 

 

      

Other projects in progress at the end of the 2014 financial year

 

Business

 

Project

 

Capacity (1)

   Capital expenditure
(US$M) (1)
 

Projects under development

           Budget  

Potash

  Jansen Potash (Canada) 100%   Investment to finish the excavation and lining of the production and service shafts, and to continue the installation of essential surface infrastructure and utilities.      2,600   
      

 

 

 
         14,071   
      

 

 

 

 

(1)  Unless noted otherwise, references to capacity are on a 100 per cent basis, references to capital expenditure from subsidiaries are reported on a 100 per cent basis and references to capital expenditure from equity accounted investments and other operations are reported at our equity share.

 

(2)  Number subject to finalisation.

 

(3)  Excludes announced pre-commitment funding.

 

(4)  As per revised budget schedule.

2.5    Business performance

The discussion of results for our Businesses is set out in section 1.12 of this Annual Report with further information below.

2.5.1    Group Revenue and Underlying EBIT

Year ended 30 June 2014 compared with year ended 30 June 2013

An analysis of the financial performance of the Group for FY2014 compared to FY2013 is included in section 1.15.3.

 

194


Table of Contents

The following table reconciles our statutory income statement to the principal factors that affected Underlying EBIT for FY2014.

 

US$M

  Revenue     Total expenses,
other income and
share of equity
accounted
investments
    Profit from
operations
    Exceptional
items
    Underlying
EBIT
 

For the year ended 30 June 2013

         

Revenue

    65,953           

Other income

      3,947         

Expenses excluding net finance costs

      (50,040      

Share of operating profit of equity accounted investments

      1,142         
   

 

 

       

Total expenses, other income and share of equity accounted investments

      (44,951      
     

 

 

     

Profit from operations

        21,002       

Exceptionals items

          1,928     
         

 

 

 

Underlying EBIT

            22,930   

Changes in volumes:

         

Productivity

    2,260        (1,298     962               962   

Growth

    3,221        (1,292     1,929               1,929   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
    5,481        (2,590     2,891               2,891   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net price impact:

         

Change in sales prices

    (3,301     (95     (3,396            (3,396

Price-linked costs

           (80     (80            (80
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
    (3,301     (175     (3,476            (3,476
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Change in controllable cash costs:

         

Operating cash costs

           1,524        1,524               1,524   

Exploration and business development

           398        398               398   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
           1,922        1,922               1,922   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Change in other costs:

         

Exchange rates

    (202     1,962        1,760               1,760   

Inflation on costs

           (805     (805            (805

Fuel and energy

           (46     (46            (46

Non-cash

           (2,091     (2,091            (2,091
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
    (202     (980     (1,182            (1,182
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Asset sales

           53        53               53   

Ceased and sold operations

    (494     2        (492            (492

Exceptional items

           2,479        2,479        (2,479       

Other

    (231     446        215               215   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

For the year ended 30 June 2014

         

Revenue

    67,206           

Other income

      1,524         

Expenses excluding net finance costs

      (46,513      

Share of operating profit of equity accounted investments

      1,195         
   

 

 

       

Total expenses, other income and share of equity accounted investments

      (43,794      
     

 

 

     

Profit from operations

        23,412       

Exceptionals items

          (551  
         

 

 

 

Underlying EBIT

            22,861   

 

195


Table of Contents

Year ended 30 June 2013 compared with year ended 30 June 2012

Revenue in FY2013 was US$66.0 billion, a decrease of US$4.5 billion, or 6.4 per cent, from US$70.5 billion in the corresponding period. The revenue decrease was primarily driven by the Iron Ore and Coal Businesses, with decreases of US$2.0 billion and US$2.6 billion, respectively. The loss of revenue due to the sale of assets previously reported in the former Diamonds and Specialty Products Business (decrease of US$382 million) and the decrease in the Aluminium, Manganese and Nickel Business (US$633 million) were offset by the increase in the Copper Business of US$1.0 billion. The breakdown of revenue by Business for FY2013 and FY2012 is set out in section 1.12.1.

The decrease in revenue in Iron Ore was driven by a 17 per cent fall in the average realised price of iron ore to US$110 per tonne which more than offset record sales volumes at WAIO, which increased 9.6 per cent. The revenue decrease in Coal also reflected lower realised prices as hard coking coal and weak coking coal prices fell 34 per cent and 31 per cent, respectively, partially offset by higher sales volumes driven by a 19 per cent increase (100 per cent basis) in production at Queensland Coal. The revenue increase in Copper was largely driven by an increase in production at Escondida of 28 per cent, partially offset by a five per cent decrease in average realised copper prices to US$3.41 per pound.

Total expenses increased from US$48.6 billion in FY2012 to US$50.0 billion in FY2013. Excluding exceptional items, the majority of which related to impairments in FY2013, total expenses were almost unchanged at US$45.0 billion in FY2013 compared to US$44.9 billion in FY2012.

 

Year ended 30 June

   2013     2012  
     US$M     US$M  

Raw materials and consumables used

     8,926        8,128   

Employee benefits expense

     7,168        6,035   

External services (including transportation) (1)

     12,478        14,293   

Third party commodity purchases

     2,759        3,402   

Net foreign exchange (gains)/losses

     (284     (571

Fair value change on derivatives

     79        (141

Government royalties paid and payable

     2,562        2,880   

Depreciation and amortisation expense

     7,031        6,431   

Exploration and evaluation expenditure

     1,047        1,644   

Impairment of assets (2)

     5,496        3,763   

Operating lease rentals

     776        658   

Other operating expenses (3)

     2,002        2,122   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total expenses

     50,040        48,644   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Less exceptional items

     (5,087     (3,786
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total expenses excluding exceptional items

     44,953        44,858   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1)  Includes exceptional items of US$96 million (2012: US$ nil).

 

(2) Includes exceptional items of US$5,149 million (2012: US$3,663 million).

 

(3)  Includes exceptional items credit of US$158 million (2012: US$ nil).

Reductions in various costs were offset by higher non-cash costs and one-off items. Our focus on reducing operating costs was demonstrated by a decrease of external services costs of US$1.8 billion In addition we reduced exploration and evaluation expenditure by US$597 million. These savings were predominantly offset by higher impairment charges of US$1.7 billion, higher depreciation and amortisation charges of US$600 million and an unfavourable variance in the change in fair value on derivatives of US$220 million. Increases in costs attributable to inflation were US$646 million.

 

196


Table of Contents

Other income increased from US$898 million in FY2012 to US$3.9 billion, mainly due to US$3.2 billion related to sale of Yeelirrie, Richards Bay Minerals and interests in the East and West Browse Joint Ventures, which were all classified as exceptional items. Excluding exceptional items, other income increased from US$598 million to US$788 million.

Profit from operations decreased by US$3.6 billion or 15 per cent from US$24.6 billion to US$21.0 billion. Exceptional items during FY2013 were a charge of US$1.9 billion, mainly comprised of US$3.2 billion (before taxation) of assets sales offset by impairment charges and related costs of US$5.3 billion (before taxation), compared with net exceptional before taxation charges mainly impairment charges, of US$3.5 billion in FY2012.

 

Year ended 30 June

   2013     2012  
     US$M     US$M  

Underlying EBIT

     22,930        28,086   

Exceptional items (before taxation) – refer section 2.5.5 below

     (1,928     (3,486
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Profit from operations (EBIT)

     21,002        24,600   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Attributable profit in FY2013 of US$11.2 billion was negatively affected by an increase in the Group’s effective tax rate from 30.6 per cent to 35.0 per cent. In addition Attributable profit decreased due to an increase in net interest expense and a change in fair value on non-hedging instruments of US$572 million, including financing charges of US$280 million incurred in managing interest rate exposure on debt securities issued during FY2013.

Underlying Attributable profit (comprising Profit after taxation attributable to members of the BHP Billiton Group less exceptional items) of US$12.2 billion decreased by US$5.0 billion from US$17.2 billion in FY2012.

Net operating cash flows of US$20.2 billion declined by 20 per cent from US$25.3 billion in FY2012. A decrease of US$4.2 billion in cash generated from operations, an increase of US$374 million in net interest paid and an income tax refund of US$530 million received in FY2012 were the major contributors to that decline.

2.5.2    Underlying EBIT

Year ended 30 June 2014 compared with year ended 30 June 2013

An analysis of the consolidated EBIT for FY2014 compared to FY2013 is included in section 1.15.3.

Year ended 30 June 2013 compared with year ended 30 June 2012

A description of the impact of the principal factors that affected Underlying EBIT in FY2013 as compared to FY2012 is set out in the table in section 1.15.3.

Underlying EBIT for FY2013 was US$22.9 billion, compared with US$28.1 billion in the corresponding period, a decrease of 18.4 per cent.

Volumes

Strong operating performance across the Group’s major basins in FY2013 delivered an increase in total production volumes in a number of Businesses. This was underpinned by a thirteenth consecutive annual production record at WAIO and a 28 per cent increase in copper production at Escondida. This volume growth was supported by a significant recovery in production at Queensland Coal and a 76 per cent increase in liquids production at our Onshore US Asset.

In this context, stronger sales volumes increased Underlying EBIT by US$2.0 billion in FY2013, of which US$1.3 billion were volume efficiencies attributed to productivity. Increased iron ore, copper and coal sales were

 

197


Table of Contents

the major contributors and together increased Underlying EBIT by US$2.5 billion. In contrast, natural field decline at our conventional Australian oil and gas assets contributed to a US$526 million volume related reduction in Petroleum’s Underlying EBIT.

Prices

Substantially lower prices reduced Underlying EBIT by US$8.5 billion in FY2013. The major contributor to the decline was a 17 per cent reduction in the average realised price of iron ore, which reduced Underlying EBIT by US$3.8 billion. The recovery in low-cost supply led to a significant decline in metallurgical coal prices, which, together with softer energy coal prices, reduced Underlying EBIT by a further US$3.5 billion. Overcapacity in the nickel and aluminium markets, and concerns of a near-term rebalancing in the copper market, also weighed on metals prices and reduced Underlying EBIT by a combined US$1.2 billion.

A 17 per cent increase in the average realised price of US natural gas and a four per cent rise in the average realised price of liquefied natural gas (LNG) benefited Underlying EBIT during the period; however, this was largely offset by a four per cent decrease in the average realised price of oil.

A reduction in price-linked costs increased Underlying EBIT by US$582 million during the period and primarily reflected lower price-linked royalty charges in our Iron Ore and Metallurgical Coal Businesses.

Controllable cash costs

The Group’s concentrated effort to reduce operating costs and drive productivity improvements realised tangible results, with a decrease in controllable cash costs of US$2.5 billion during the period, being a decrease in operating cash costs of US$1.6 billion and a decrease in exploration and business development costs of US$949 million.

Operating cash costs

The reduction in costs was underpinned by a reduction of US$1.6 billion of operating cash costs. A strong focus on contractor usage and rates and a significant reduction in consumables expenditure contributed to the substantial reduction in operating costs at Queensland Coal, which contributed to a US$933 million reduction in operating cash costs. Productivity gains at Escondida associated with a 12 per cent improvement in concentrator throughput following a major maintenance campaign and a 24 per cent increase in the ore grade mined during the period contributed US$653 million to Underlying EBIT. With productivity improvements already well advanced, consisting principally of the improvement plan at Worsley, substantial cost savings of US$368 million were achieved during the period in Aluminium, Manganese and Nickel. These savings were offset by an increase in operating cash costs of US$405 million in Iron Ore which reflects our decision to invest in operating capability prior to the full commissioning and ramp-up of expanded capacity at WAIO.

Exploration and business development

Our increased focus on reducing our cost base in FY2013 and our confidence in the quality and longevity of our asset base led to a substantial US$949 million reduction in the Group’s exploration and business development expenditure. Total exploration expenditure declined by 46 per cent to US$1.4 billion in FY2013, with a focus on greenfield copper porphyry targets in Chile and Peru and oil and gas prospects in the Gulf of Mexico and offshore Western Australia. The associated decline in the Group’s exploration expense increased Underlying EBIT by US$597 million.

A general reduction in business development expenditure increased Underlying EBIT by a further US$352 million in FY2013, primarily in Iron Ore for US$102 million and Coal for US$194 million.

 

198


Table of Contents

Other costs

Exchange rates

A stronger US dollar against several producer currencies, in particular the South African rand, benefited our cost base during the period and increased Underlying EBIT but this was partially offset by the revaluation of monetary items in the balance sheet with year-end exchange rates. In total, exchange rate volatility increased Underlying EBIT by US$229 million.

Average and closing exchange rates for FY2013 and FY2012 are detailed in note 1 ‘Accounting policies’ to the financial statements.

Inflation on costs

Inflation had an unfavourable impact on all Businesses and reduced Underlying EBIT by US$646 million in FY2013. This was most notable in Australia and South Africa, which accounted for over 75 per cent of the total variance.

Non-cash

Non-cash costs had a favourable impact on Underlying EBIT of US$154 million in FY2013. This was principally due to a higher capitalisation rate for deferred stripping mainly in Copper and Iron Ore.

One-off items

The only One-off item was due to higher costs at Escondida relating to major maintenance activities undertaken on the conveyor belt system and at both concentrator plants.

Asset sales

The divestments of Yeelirrie, Richards Bay Minerals, the East and West Browse Joint Ventures and our diamonds business were completed during the period. The gains or losses arising from each sale were reported within exceptional items, and therefore were not included in Underlying EBIT.

The contribution of asset sales to Underlying EBIT declined by US$66 million in FY2013. The variance was largely attributable to a post-closing payment received during FY2012 that followed the divestment of our interests in Cascade and Chinook.

Ceased and sold operations

Underlying EBIT from ceased and sold operations declined by US$657 million in FY2013. The decline largely reflected a reduced contribution, decrease in Underlying EBIT of US$310 million, from EKATI, following the sale of our diamonds business. Ceased and sold operations included a further reduction of Underlying EBIT of US$126 million related to the sale of Pinto Valley mining operation and the associated San Manuel Arizona Railroad Company.

Other

A decrease in our share of operating profit in equity accounted investments primarily contributed to the reduction of Underlying EBIT by US$531 million. Cerrejon profit after taxation decreased by US$177 million to US$117 million mainly due to reduced production and decreased thermal coal prices. Antamina profit after taxation decreased by US$83 million to US$531 million as increased copper production was more than offset by weaker sales prices and general cost pressure over our Copper portfolio. Samarco profit after taxation decreased by US$396 million to US$513 million mainly due to a decrease in sales prices.

These decreases were partially offset by a non-cash adjustment of our Angostura (Trinidad and Tobago) Production Sharing Contract.

 

199


Table of Contents

2.5.3    Net finance costs

Year ended 30 June 2014 compared with year ended 30 June 2013

An analysis of net finance costs for FY2014 compared to FY2013 is included in section 1.15.3.

Year ended 30 June 2013 compared with year ended 30 June 2012

Net finance costs increased to US$1.3 billion from US$668 million in the corresponding period. This was primarily attributable to an increase in net interest expense on higher net debt and financing charges of US$280 million incurred in managing interest rate exposure on debt securities issued in FY2013. The US$280 million was composed of realised fair value losses of US$97 million on non-hedging derivatives recognised in interest on borrowings and unrealised fair value losses of US$183 million on similar instruments. Net interest expense on other debt securities increased net finance costs by an additional US$270 million.

2.5.4    Taxation expense

Year ended 30 June 2014 compared with year ended 30 June 2013

An analysis of taxation expenses for FY2014 compared to FY2013 is included in section 1.15.3.

Year ended 30 June 2013 compared with year ended 30 June 2012

Total taxation expense, including royalty-related taxation, exceptional items and exchange rate movements, was US$6.9 billion, representing an effective tax rate of 35.0 per cent (2012: 30.6 per cent).

Exceptional items decreased taxation expense by US$943 million (2012: decrease of US$1.7 billion), predominantly due to the income tax benefit on impairments of US$1.4 billion, which more than offset the income tax expense associated with divestments of US$371 million, as detailed in section 1.15.3.

Government imposed royalty arrangements calculated by reference to profits are reported as royalty-related taxation. Royalty-related taxation, excluding exceptional items, contributed US$1.2 billion to taxation expense. The Minerals Resource Rent Tax (MRRT) came into effect in Australia on 1 July 2012 and the Group expensed US$321 million of MRRT in FY2013, mainly due to Iron Ore MRRT expense for the period. This included the remeasurement of deferred tax assets associated with the MRRT which increased taxation expense by US$207 million in FY2013.

The Group’s adjusted effective tax rate was 34.2 per cent (2012: 31.8 per cent).

 

Year ended 30 June

   2013     2012  
     Profit
before tax
     Income tax
expense
    %     Profit
before tax
     Income tax
expense
    %  
     US$M      US$M           US$M      US$M        

Statutory effective tax rate

     19,726         (6,906     35.0     23,932         (7,315     30.6

Less:

              

Exchange rate movements

             245                  347     

Remeasurement of deferred tax assets associated with the MRRT

             207                      

Exceptional items

     1,928         (943       3,486         (1,745  
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Adjusted effective tax rate

     21,654         (7,397     34.2     27,418         (8,713     31.8
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other royalty and excise arrangements, which are not profit based, are recognised as operating costs within Profit before taxation. These amounted to US$2.6 billion during the period (2012: US$2.9 billion).

 

200


Table of Contents

2.5.5    Exceptional items

Years ended 30 June 2014 and 30 June 2013

An analysis of the exceptional items for FY2014 and FY2013 are included in section 1.15.3.

 

Year ended 30 June 2012

   Gross     Tax     Net  
     US$M     US$M     US$M  

Exceptional items by category

      

Impairment of Fayetteville goodwill and other assets

     (2,835     996        (1,839

Impairment of Nickel West goodwill and other assets

     (449     94        (355

Suspension or early closure of operations and the change in status of specific projects (1)

     (502     108        (394

Settlement of insurance claims (1)

     300        (90     210   

Recognition of deferred tax assets on enactment of MRRT and PRRT extension legislation in Australia

            637        637   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     (3,486     1,745        (1,741
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1)  Includes amounts attributable to non-controlling interests of US$(34) million (US$7 million tax expense).

As a result of the fall in United States domestic gas prices and the Company’s decision to adjust its development plans, the Group recognised impairments of goodwill and other assets in relation to its Fayetteville shale gas assets. A total impairment charge of US$1.8 billion (after tax benefit) was recognised in FY2012.

The Group recognised impairments of goodwill and other assets at Nickel West as a result of the continued downturn in the nickel price and margin deterioration. A total impairment charge of US$355 million (after tax benefit) was recognised in FY2012.

As part of our regular portfolio review, various operations and projects around the Group were either suspended, closed early or changed in status. These included: the change in status of the Olympic Dam expansion project; the temporary suspension of production at TEMCO and the permanent closure of the Metalloys South Plant in South Africa; the indefinite cessation of production at Norwich Park; and the suspension of other minor capital projects. As a result, impairment charges of US$338 million (after tax benefit), idle capacity costs and inventory write-down of US$28 million (after tax benefit) and other restructuring costs of US$28 million (after tax benefit) were recognised in FY2012, of which US$242 million (after tax benefit) related to Olympic Dam.

During 2008, extreme weather across the central Queensland coalfields affected production from the BMA and BMC operations. The Group settled insurance claims in respect of the lost production and insurance claim income of US$210 million (after tax expense) was recognised in FY2012.

The Australian MRRT and PRRT extension legislation were enacted in March 2012. Under the legislation, the Group is entitled to a deduction against future MRRT and PRRT liabilities based on the market value of its Coal, Iron Ore and Petroleum assets. A deferred tax asset, and an associated net income tax benefit of US$637 million, was recognised in FY2012 to reflect the future deductibility of these market values for MRRT and PRRT purposes, to the extent they were considered recoverable.

 

201


Table of Contents

Exceptional items during FY2012 are classified by nature as follows.

 

Year ended 30 June 2012

US$M

   Impairment of
goodwill and
other assets
    Idle capacity
costs and
inventory
write-downs
    Restructuring
costs
    Insurance
recoveries
     Gross  

Impairment of Fayetteville goodwill and other assets

     (2,835                           (2,835

Impairment of Nickel West goodwill and other assets

     (406     (43                    (449

Suspension or early closure of operations and the change in status of specific projects

     (422     (40     (40             (502

Settlement of insurance claims

                          300         300   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 
     (3,663     (83     (40     300         (3,486
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

2.5.6    Petroleum and Potash Business

Year ended 30 June 2014 compared with year ended 30 June 2013

An analysis of the financial performance of our Petroleum and Potash Business for FY2014 compared to FY2013 is included in section 1.12.2.

Financial information for the Petroleum and Potash Business for FY2014 and FY2013 is presented below.

 

Year ended

30 June 2014

US$ million

  Revenue (i)(ii)     Underlying
EBITDA
    D&A     Underlying
EBIT
    Net
operating
assets
    Capital
expenditure (iii)
    Exploration
gross (iv)
    Exploration
to profit (v)
 

Bass Strait

    1,885        1,555        132        1,423        2,864        259       

North West Shelf (vi)

    2,432        1,599        175        1,424        1,691        193       

Atlantis

    1,535        1,407        335        1,072        2,272        409       

Shenzi

    1,430        1,281        243        1,038        1,598        306       

Mad Dog

    217        171        16        155        461        83       

Onshore US

    4,264        2,270        2,426        (156     26,945        4,226       

Algeria

    465        396        30        366        104        19       

UK (vii)

    155        70        52        18        (38     15       

Exploration

           (369     113        (482     464              

Other (viii)(ix)

    2,027        1,744        735        1,009        1,907        369       
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Petroleum

    14,410        10,124        4,257        5,867        38,268        5,879        600        497   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Potash

           (211     74        (285     2,255        544        47        47   

Other (x)

           (298            (298     (1,009                     
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Petroleum and Potash from Group production

    14,410        9,615        4,331        5,284        39,514        6,423        647        544   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Third party products

    437        3               3                     
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Petroleum and Potash

    14,847        9,618        4,331        5,287        39,514        6,423        647        544   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Statutory adjustments (xi)

    (14     (3     (3                                   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Petroleum and Potash statutory result

    14,833        9,615        4,328        5,287        39,514        6,423        647        544   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

202


Table of Contents

Year ended

30 June 2013

(Republished)

US$ million

  Revenue (i)(ii)     Underlying
EBITDA
    D&A     Underlying
EBIT
    Net
operating
assets
    Capital
expenditure (iii)
    Exploration
gross (iv)
    Exploration
to profit (v)
 

Bass Strait

    1,921        1,564        119        1,445        2,834        526       

North West Shelf

    2,578        1,913        234        1,679        1,880        221       

Atlantis

    853        710        147        563        2,166        419       

Shenzi

    1,614        1,519        283        1,236        1,524        289       

Mad Dog

    276        233        98        135        420        89       

Onshore US

    2,987        1,508        1,795        (287     25,019        4,699       

Algeria

    533        460        18        442        90        22       

UK

    244        95        46        49        45        8       

Exploration

           (522     230        (752     529              

Other (viii)(ix)

    2,032        1,746        282        1,464        1,973        794       
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Petroleum

    13,038        9,226        3,252        5,974        36,480        7,067        675        620   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Potash

           (309     25        (334     1,758        608        89        89   

Other (x)

    18        (15            (15     (713                     
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Petroleum and Potash from Group production

    13,056        8,902        3,277        5,625        37,525        7,675        764        709   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Third party products

    175        11               11                     
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Petroleum and Potash

    13,231        8,913        3,277        5,636        37,525        7,675        764        709   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Statutory adjustments (xi)

    (7     (3     (3                                   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Petroleum and Potash statutory result

    13,224        8,910        3,274        5,636        37,525        7,675        764        709   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(i) Petroleum revenue from Group production includes: crude oil US$8,645 million (2013: US$7,604 million), natural gas US$3,119 million (2013: US$2,842 million), LNG US$1,614 million (2013: US$1,686 million), NGL US$916 million (2013: US$823 million) and other US$102 million (2013: US$76 million).

 

(ii) Includes inter-segment revenue of US$262 million (2013: US$ nil).

 

(iii) Capital expenditure in aggregate comprises Petroleum US$5,600 million growth and US$279 million other (2013: US$6,883 million growth and US$184 million other) and Potash US$533 million growth and US$11 million other (2013: US$597 million growth and US$11 million other).

 

(iv) Includes US$231 million of Petroleum capitalised exploration (2013: US$153 million).

 

(v) Includes US$128 million of Petroleum exploration expenditure previously capitalised, written off as impaired (included in depreciation and amortisation) (2013: US$98 million).

 

(vi) Includes an expense of US$143 million incurred in May 2014 related to the purchase price adjustment for the Browse asset sale completed in the 2013 financial year.

 

(vii) Includes an expense of US$112 million incurred in November 2013 related to the closure of the UK pension plan. Also includes a gain of US$120 million related to the sale of the Liverpool Bay asset in March 2014.

 

(viii)  Includes Macedon, Pyrenees, Stybarrow, Neptune, Minerva, Angostura, Genesis, Pakistan, divisional activities, business development and ceased and sold operations. Also includes the Caesar oil pipeline and the Cleopatra gas pipeline which are equity accounted investments and are reported on a proportionate consolidation basis (with the exception of net operating assets).

 

(ix) Includes an unrealised gain of US$74 million related to Angostura embedded derivative (2013: US$84 million unrealised loss).

 

(x) Includes closed mining and smelting operations in Canada and the United States.

 

203


Table of Contents
(xi) Includes statutory adjustments for the Caesar oil pipeline and the Cleopatra gas pipeline to reconcile the proportionately consolidated business total to the statutory result.

Year ended 30 June 2013 compared with year ended 30 June 2012

Petroleum production increased by six per cent in FY2013, to 236 million barrels of oil equivalent (MMboe) (BHP Billiton share) and included strong performance from Onshore US, which delivered 99 MMboe (BHP Billiton share). The Eagle Ford area contributed 33 per cent of total Onshore US production to become Petroleum’s largest producing field at the end of the period.

Petroleum and Potash revenue increased by US$291 million to US$13.2 billion in FY2013. Revenue for Onshore US grew by US$818 million to US$3.0 billion, an increase of 37.7 per cent. The increase in revenue in Onshore US resulted from higher volumes, which grew by 15.9 per cent. The increase in volume included a 76 per cent increase in higher value liquids production and a seven per cent increase in natural gas production. Increases in revenue at Mad Dog of US$276 million, with recommencement of operations during the year, and an increase at North West Shelf of US$203 million, due to higher LNG sales, were partially offset by reductions in our other assets, primarily due to natural field decline at our operated Australian oil and gas assets.

The average realised price of natural gas across our portfolio increased by 11 per cent in FY2013 to US$3.76 per Mscf. This included a 17 per cent increase in the average realised price of US natural gas to US$3.29 per Mscf. The average realised price of LNG also increased during the period, rising by four per cent to US$14.82 per Mscf. These gains were partially offset by a four per cent decrease in the average realised price of oil to US$106 per barrel. The average realised price of natural gas liquids (NGLs) was US$45.70 per barrel.

Petroleum and Potash Underlying EBIT for FY2013 declined by US$397 million to US$5.6 billion. Petroleum’s Underlying EBIT decreased by US$363 million to US$6.0 billion. The natural field decline at our Australian assets and the negative contribution of Onshore US contributed to a US$526 million volume related reduction in Underlying EBIT. A series of charges, which included Onshore US drill rig contract termination costs and an impairment that followed the suspension of studies and re-evaluation of alternative development options associated with the Mad Dog Phase 2 project, reduced Underlying EBIT by a further US$160 million. In contrast, a US$126 million reduction in exploration and business development expense reflected our sharpened focus on high value oil and gas prospects in the Gulf of Mexico and offshore Western Australia.

The Onshore US Underlying EBIT was a loss of US$287 million compared with a loss of US$140 million in FY2012. The FY2013 loss included a charge for the drill rig termination costs of US$77 million. The FY2012 loss included a gain of US$192 million associated with legacy US gas derivatives. Adjusting for the gains and losses, the loss in Underlying EBIT reduced year-over-year. The reduced loss was primarily due to increased volumes and prices partially offset by higher depreciation and amortisation of US$355 million and higher transportation costs due to higher volumes.

Capital expenditure for our conventional and unconventional operations totalled US$7.1 billion in FY2013. This included US$4.7 billion in Onshore US drilling and development expenditure, with over 80 per cent of drilling activity directed towards the Eagle Ford and Permian areas. While still in its early stages, the Permian evaluation program continues to deliver encouraging results, as demonstrated by the 1 MMboe produced in FY2013.

Petroleum exploration expenditure for FY2013 was US$675 million, of which US$522 million was expensed.

The Potash Business is not in production and had a loss, in Underlying EBIT terms, for FY2013 of US$334 million, which was largely unchanged from the prior period. A reduction in our global potash exploration activity was offset by higher costs associated with the establishment of our Potash Business in Saskatchewan (Canada).

 

204


Table of Contents

2.5.7    Copper Business

Year ended 30 June 2014 compared with year ended 30 June 2013

An analysis of the financial performance of our Copper Business for FY2014 compared to FY2013 is included in section 1.12.3.

Financial information for the Copper Business for FY2014 and FY2013 is presented below.

 

Year ended

30 June 2014

US$ million

  Revenue     Underlying
EBITDA
    D&A     Underlying
EBIT
    Net
operating
assets
    Capital
expenditure (i)
    Exploration
gross
    Exploration
to profit
 

Escondida (ii)

    8,085        4,754        760        3,994        11,779        3,186       

Pampa Norte (iii)

    1,796        785        429        356        2,575        336       

Antamina (iv)

    1,261        818        84        734        1,341        262       

Cannington

    1,079        459        47        412        234        60       

Olympic Dam

    1,777        299        265        34        6,320        167       

Other (iv)(v)

    101        (193     7        (200     (18     13       
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

Total Copper from Group production

    14,099        6,922        1,592        5,330        22,231        4,024       
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

Third party products

    1,030        8               8                     
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Copper

    15,129        6,930        1,592        5,338        22,231        4,024        118        118   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Statutory adjustments (vi)

    (1,261     (344     (86     (258            (267     (2     (2
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Copper statutory result

    13,868        6,586        1,506        5,080        22,231        3,757        116        116   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

Year ended

30 June 2013

(Republished)

US$ million

  Revenue     Underlying
EBITDA
    D&A     Underlying
EBIT
    Net
operating
assets
    Capital
expenditure (i)
    Exploration
gross
    Exploration
to profit
 

Escondida (ii)

    8,596        5,175        649        4,526        9,450        2,859       

Pampa Norte (iii)

    1,913        841        291        550        2,643        348       

Antamina (iv)

    1,295        901        80        821        1,311        326       

Cannington

    1,365        646        40        606        206        39       

Olympic Dam

    1,873        245        249        (4     6,418        399       

Other (iv)(v)

    90        (554     19        (573     46        289       
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

Total Copper from Group production

    15,132        7,254        1,328        5,926        20,074        4,260       
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

Third party products

    700        3               3                     
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Copper

    15,832        7,257       1,328        5,929       20,074        4,260        277        277   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Statutory adjustments (vi)

    (1,295     (372     (82     (290            (330     (3     (3
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Copper statutory result

    14,537        6,885       1,246        5,639       20,074        3,930        274        274   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(i)  Capital expenditure in aggregate comprises US$2,629 million growth and US$1,128 million other (2013: US$2,167 million growth and US$1,763 million other).

 

(ii)  Escondida is consolidated under IFRS 10 and reported on a 100 per cent basis.

 

(iii)  Includes Spence and Cerro Colorado.

 

(iv)  Antamina and Resolution are equity accounted investments and are reported on a proportionate consolidation basis (with the exception of net operating assets).

 

205


Table of Contents
(v)  Predominantly comprises divisional activities, greenfield exploration, business development and ceased and sold operations. Includes Pinto Valley and Resolution. Pinto Valley was sold effective 11 October 2013.

 

(vi)  Includes statutory adjustments for Antamina and Resolution to reconcile the proportionately consolidated business total to the statutory result. Statutory Underlying EBIT includes net finance costs of US$4 million and taxation of US$254 million (2013: net finance costs of US$ nil and taxation of US$290 million).

Year ended 30 June 2013 compared with year ended 30 June 2012

Copper production increased by 10 per cent in FY2013 to 1.7 Mt. Escondida copper production increased by 28 per cent to 1.1 Mt (100 per cent basis) as the average copper grade mined rose to 1.4 per cent and milling rates improved. Record annual copper production at Antamina also contributed to the strong result having benefited from a full-year contribution from the recently expanded concentrator.

Copper revenue increased by US$984 million to US$14.5 billion, largely driven by production increases at Escondida, partially offset by a five per cent decrease in average realised copper prices. Revenue for Escondida increased to US$8.6 billion due to the 28 per cent increase in production, driven by higher average copper grades mined and improved milling rates partially offset by lower average realised prices. This increase was partially offset by decreases at Pampa Norte , Cannington and Olympic Dam in line with lower production and lower average realised prices.

The average realised price of copper for the period declined by five per cent to US$3.41 per pound.

Underlying EBIT for FY2013 increased by US$326 million to US$5.6 billion. Increased sales volumes and operating cash cost savings associated with productivity gains and broader economies of scale increased Underlying EBIT by US$1.1 billion. In this context, strong production growth and a material reduction in operating cash costs contributed to a 15 per cent reduction in unit cash costs at Escondida. In contrast, the external influences of lower prices, inflation and foreign exchange variations reduced Underlying EBIT by US$808 million. Payments associated with major planned maintenance programs at Escondida reduced Underlying EBIT by a further US$103 million.

Revenue for Olympic Dam decreased by US$273 million to US$1.9 billion, primarily due to lower prices and reduced volumes. Price, grade and smelter availability contributed to the decrease in Underlying EBIT from US$214 million in FY2012 to an Underlying EBIT loss of US$4 million in FY2013.

2.5.8    Iron Ore Business

Year ended 30 June 2014 compared with year ended 30 June 2013

An analysis of the financial performance of our Iron Ore Business for FY2014 compared to FY2013 is included in section 1.12.4.

 

206


Table of Contents

Financial information for the Iron Ore Business for FY2014 and FY2013 is presented below.

 

Year ended

30 June 2014

US$ million

  Revenue (i)     Underlying
EBITDA
    D&A     Underlying
EBIT
    Net
operating
assets
    Capital
expenditure (ii)
    Exploration
gross (iii)
    Exploration
to profit (iv)
 

Western Australia
Iron Ore

    21,013        12,988        1,429        11,559        22,278        2,947       

Samarco (v)

    1,634        846        56        790        1,072        424       

Other (vi)

           (54            (54     40              
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

Total Iron Ore from Group production

    22,647        13,780        1,485        12,295        23,390        3,371       
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

Third party products (vii)

    343        (3            (3                  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Iron Ore

    22,990        13,777        1,485        12,292        23,390        3,371        169        56   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Statutory adjustments (viii)

    (1,634     (246     (56     (190            (422              
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Iron Ore statutory result

    21,356        13,531        1,429        12,102        23,390        2,949        169        56   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

Year ended

30 June 2013

(Republished)

US$ million

  Revenue (i)     Underlying
EBITDA
    D&A     Underlying
EBIT
    Net
operating
assets
    Capital
expenditure (ii)
    Exploration
gross (iii)
    Exploration
to profit (iv)
 

Western Australia
Iron Ore

    18,452        11,668        1,004        10,664        21,074        5,979       

Samarco (v)

    1,622        811        61        750        1,037        772       

Other (vi)

           (84            (84     15              
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

Total Iron Ore from Group production

    20,074        12,395        1,065       11,330        22,126       6,751       
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

Third party products (vii)

    141        31               31                     
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Iron Ore

    20,215        12,426        1,065       11,361        22,126       6,751        217        74   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Statutory adjustments (viii)

    (1,622     (313     (61     (252            (772              
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Iron Ore statutory result

    18,593        12,113        1,004       11,109        22,126       5,979        217        74   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(i)  Includes inter-segment revenue of US$213 million (2013: US$55 million).

 

(ii)  Capital expenditure in aggregate comprises US$2,762 million growth and US$187 million other (2013: US$5,848 million growth and US$131 million other).

 

(iii)  Includes US$57 million capitalised exploration (2013: US$143 million).

 

(iv)  Includes a reversal of US$56 million of exploration expenditure previously written off as impaired (included in depreciation and amortisation) (2013: US$ nil).

 

(v)  Samarco is an equity accounted investment and is reported on a proportionate consolidation basis (with the exception of net operating assets).

 

(vi)  Predominantly comprises divisional activities, business development and ceased operations.

 

(vii)  Includes inter-segment and external sales of contracted gas purchases.

 

(viii)  Includes statutory adjustments for Samarco to reconcile the proportionately consolidated business total to the statutory result. Statutory Underlying EBIT includes net finance costs of US$87 million and taxation of US$103 million (2013: net finance costs of US$25 million and taxation of US$227 million).

 

207


Table of Contents

Year ended 30 June 2013 compared with year ended 30 June 2012

Iron ore production increased by seven per cent in FY2013 to 170 Mt (BHP Billiton share). WAIO production of 187 Mt (100 per cent basis) represented a thirteenth consecutive annual production record. The delivery of WAIO’s capital efficient growth program and continued strong operating performance across the supply chain contributed to this record result. The three pellet plants at Samarco continued to operate at capacity during the period.

Iron Ore revenue decreased by US$2.0 billion to US$18.6 billion in FY2013. Revenue for WAIO decreased US$2.0 billion to US$18.5 billion, a decrease of 9.9 per cent. Record sales volumes at WAIO, which increased 9.6 per cent, were more than offset by a 17 per cent fall in the average realised price of iron ore to US$110 per tonne.

Underlying EBIT for FY2013 declined by US$2.9 billion to US$11.1 billion. The increased sales volumes at WAIO increased Underlying EBIT by US$1.5 billion. However, this was more than offset by the fall in the average realised price of iron ore, which reduced Underlying EBIT by US$3.6 billion, net of price-linked costs. WAIO’s export volumes for FY2013 were sold on the basis of shorter term, market-based prices. Revenue for FY2013 reflected the average index price one month prior to the month of shipment, adjusted for product characteristics such as iron and moisture content. Approximately 65 per cent of shipments were delivered on a Cost and Freight (CFR) basis.

Increased operating cash costs associated with labour and contractor costs were the main contributor to the reduction in Underlying EBIT of US$405 million during FY2013. This largely reflected our decision to invest in operating capability prior to the full commissioning and ramp-up of expanded capacity at WAIO. WAIO unit cash costs, including freight and royalty charges of US$856 million and US$1.2 billion, respectively, remained largely unchanged during FY2013.

 

208


Table of Contents

2.5.9    Coal Business

Year ended 30 June 2014 compared with year ended 30 June 2013

An analysis of the financial performance of our Coal Business for FY2014 compared to FY2013 is included in section 1.12.5.

Financial information for the Coal Business for FY2014 and FY2013 is presented below.

 

Year ended

30 June 2014

US$ million

  Revenue     Underlying
EBITDA
    D&A     Underlying
EBIT
    Net
operating
assets
    Capital
expenditure (i)
    Exploration
gross
    Exploration
to profit
 

Queensland Coal

    4,666        949        514        435        9,115        1,790       

Illawarra (ii)

    886        131        170        (39     1,384        309       

Energy Coal South Africa (ii)

    1,279        315        485        (170     989        65       

New Mexico

    520        105        46        59        202        26       

New South Wales Energy Coal (ii)

    1,350        324        150        174        1,392        170       

Colombia (ii)

    814        305        85        220        1,037        133       

Other (iii)

           (166     2        (168     162        34       
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

Total Coal from Group production

    9,515        1,963        1,452        511        14,281        2,527       
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

Third party products

    456        18               18        19              
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Coal

    9,971        1,981        1,452        529        14,300        2,527        34        34   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Statutory adjustments (iv)

    (856     (264     (121     (143            (182              
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Coal statutory result

    9,115        1,717        1,331        386        14,300        2,345        34        34   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

209


Table of Contents

Year ended

30 June 2013

(Republished)

US$ million

  Revenue     Underlying
EBITDA
    D&A     Underlying
EBIT
    Net
operating
assets
    Capital
expenditure (i)
    Exploration
gross
    Exploration
to profit
 

Queensland Coal

    4,452        627        376        251        7,988        2,771       

Illawarra (ii)

    1,287        311        148        163        1,238        357       

Energy Coal South Africa (ii)

    1,457        177        211        (34     1,334        133       

New Mexico

    588        95        49        46        164        28       

New South Wales Energy Coal (ii)

    1,526        314        120        194        1,372        366       

Colombia (ii)

    828        307        65        242        997        265       

Other (iii)

           (158     2        (160     111        85       
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

Total Coal from Group production

    10,138        1,673       971        702       13,204        4,005       
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Third party products

    585        44               44        21              
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

Total Coal

    10,723        1,717       971        746       13,225        4,005        42        42   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Statutory adjustments (iv)

    (828     (237     (86     (151            (379     (3     (3
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Coal statutory result

    9,895        1,480       885        595       13,225        3,626        39        39   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(i) Capital expenditure in aggregate comprises US$1,563 million growth and US$782 million other (2013: US$2,898 million growth and US$728 million other).

 

(ii) Cerrejón, Newcastle Coal Infrastructure Group, Port Kembla Coal Terminal and Richards Bay Coal Terminal are equity accounted investments and are reported on a proportionate consolidation basis (with the exception of net operating assets).

 

(iii) Predominantly comprises divisional activities and greenfield projects.

 

(iv) Includes statutory adjustments for Cerrejón, Newcastle Coal Infrastructure Group, Port Kembla Coal Terminal and Richards Bay Coal Terminal to reconcile the proportionately consolidated business total to the statutory result. Statutory Underlying EBIT includes net finance income of US$1 million and taxation of US$81 million (2013: net finance income of US$1 million and taxation of US$99 million).

Year ended 30 June 2013 compared with year ended 30 June 2012

Metallurgical coal production increased by 13 per cent in FY2013 to 38 Mt. A 19 per cent increase (100 per cent basis) in production at Queensland Coal was underpinned by record annual performance at both Peak Downs and South Walker Creek, and this was achieved despite the indefinite closure of Norwich Park and Gregory. In addition, Illawarra Coal achieved record annual production in FY2013.

Energy coal production increased by two per cent in FY2013 to 72 Mt, which included record annual production from New South Wales Energy Coal following the successful ramp-up of the RX1 project.

 

210


Table of Contents

Coal revenue for FY2013 decreased by US$2.6 billion to US$9.9 billion. Revenue at Queensland Coal decreased US$1.4 billion to US$4.5 billion, a decrease of 24.2 per cent. Volume increases at Queensland Coal were more than offset by the effect of decreases in average realised prices. Hard coking coal and weak coking coal prices fell 34 per cent and 31 per cent, respectively. Revenue at Energy Coal South Africa (BECSA) decreased by US$437 million reflecting reduced production and decreased thermal coal prices, which fell 18 per cent during FY2013. Revenue at New South Wales Energy Coal and New Mexico Coal were in line with FY2012, with volume increases offset by reduced thermal coal prices.

Underlying EBIT for FY2013 declined by US$2.0 billion to US$595 million. The fall in hard coking coal, weak coking coal and thermal coal prices, reduced Underlying EBIT by US$3.2 billion, net of price-linked costs. This was partially offset by increased sales volumes, operating cash cost savings and reduced exploration and business development expenses, which increased Underlying EBIT by US$1.7 billion. A strong focus on contractor usage and rates and a significant reduction in consumables expenditure contributed to the substantial reduction in operating costs at Queensland Coal, as demonstrated by the 30 per cent decline in mine site unit cash costs at BMA.

During FY2013, the Daunia and Broadmeadow Life Extension projects (both Australia) delivered first production, ahead of schedule.

 

211


Table of Contents

2.5.10 Aluminium, Manganese and Nickel Business

Year ended 30 June 2014 compared with year ended 30 June 2013

An analysis of the financial performance of our Aluminium, Manganese and Nickel Business for FY2014 compared to FY2013 is included in section 1.12.6.

Financial information for the Aluminium, Manganese and Nickel Business for FY2014 and FY2013 is presented below.

 

Year ended

30 June 2014

US$ million

  Revenue (i)     Underlying
EBITDA
    D&A     Underlying
EBIT
    Net
operating
assets
    Capital
expenditure (ii)
    Exploration
gross (iii)
    Exploration
to profit (iv)
 

Alumina

    1,548        217        202       15        4,454       60       

Aluminium

    2,398        178        145       33        1,790       41       

Intra-divisional adjustment

    (659                                       
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     
    3,287        395        347       48        6,244       101       
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

Manganese

    2,096        639        163       476        1,613       178       

Nickel West

    1,605        (91     117       (208     534       163       

Cerro Matoso

    595        104        94       10        860       56       

Other (v)

           (36     1       (37     71             
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

Total Aluminium, Manganese and Nickel from Group production

    7,583        1,011        722        289        9,322        498       
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

Third party products

    828        18               18                     
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

Total Aluminium, Manganese and Nickel

    8,411        1,029        722        307        9,322        498        44        38   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Statutory adjustments

                                                       
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Aluminium, Manganese and Nickel statutory result

    8,411        1,029        722        307        9,322        498        44        38   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

212


Table of Contents

Year ended

30 June 2013

(Republished)

US$ million

  Revenue (i)     Underlying
EBITDA
    D&A     Underlying
EBIT
    Net
operating
assets
    Capital
expenditure (ii)
    Exploration
gross (iii)
    Exploration
to profit (iv)
 

Alumina

    1,422        114        239       (125     3,844       157       

Aluminium

    2,620        88        127        (39     2,154        27       

Intra-divisional adjustment

    (638                                       
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     
    3,404        202        366       (164     5,998       184       
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

Manganese

    2,113        623        116        507        1,658        375       

Nickel West

    1,773        (104     210        (314     123        280       

Cerro Matoso

    803        235        79        156        955        50       

Other (v)

           (79     (14     (65     75        4       
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

Total Aluminium, Manganese and Nickel from Group production

    8,093        877        757       120        8,809       893       
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

Third party products

    1,185        38               38                     
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

Total Aluminium, Manganese and Nickel

    9,278        915        757       158        8,809       893        57        53   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Statutory adjustments

                                                       
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Aluminium, Manganese and Nickel statutory result

    9,278        915        757       158        8,809       893        57        53   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(i)  Includes inter-segment revenue of US$5 million (2013: US$20 million).

 

(ii) Capital expenditure in aggregate comprises US$43 million growth and US$455 million other (2013: US$285 million growth and US$608 million other).

 

(iii)  Includes US$6 million capitalised exploration (2013: US$8 million).

 

(iv)  Includes US$ nil exploration expenditure previously capitalised, written off as impaired (included in depreciation and amortisation) (2013: US$4 million).

 

(v)  Predominantly comprises divisional activities and business development.

Year ended 30 June 2013 compared with year ended 30 June 2012

Alumina production increased by 18 per cent in FY2013 to a record 4.9 Mt (BHP Billiton share), underpinned by the ramp-up of the Efficiency and Growth project at Worsley. Aluminium production increased by two per cent to 1.2 Mt (BHP Billiton share), with improved performance at our southern African smelters.

Total manganese ore production increased by seven per cent in FY2013 to a record 8.5 Mt (100 per cent basis) and reflected a substantial improvement in plant availability at GEMCO (Australia). Total manganese alloy volumes were largely unchanged from FY2012. The recovery in TEMCO (Australia) production that followed the temporary suspension of operations in the prior period was offset by the permanent closure of energy-intensive silicomanganese production at Metalloys in January 2012.

 

213


Table of Contents

Nickel production in FY2013 was largely unchanged from the prior period. Strong operating performance at Cerro Matoso was offset by planned maintenance at the Nickel West Kalgoorlie smelter and Kwinana refinery.

Aluminium, Manganese and Nickel revenue decreased by 6.4 per cent, or US$633 million, to US$9.3 billion. The reduction was primarily due to decreases at Nickel West of US$270 million and from sales of third party products of US$398 million. The decrease in revenue was mainly driven by lower realised prices across all parts of the Business. In this context, lower average realised prices for aluminium (down six per cent to US$2,191 per tonne), alumina (down nine per cent to US$302 per tonne), nickel (down 15 per cent to US$16,319 per tonne) and manganese alloy (down 10 per cent to US$1,051 per tonne) were only partially offset by an increase in the average realised price of manganese ore (up nine per cent to US$4.83 per dry metric tonne unit).

Underlying EBIT for FY2013 increased by US$182 million to US$158 million. With productivity improvements already well advanced, consisting principally of the improvement plan at Worsley, substantial controllable cash cost savings of US$442 million were achieved during the period, while a stronger US dollar increased Underlying EBIT by a further US$243 million. In contrast, weaker markets continued to challenge the Business as lower average realised prices contributed to a US$474 million reduction in Underlying EBIT, net of price-linked costs.

The US$167 million (BHP Billiton share) GEEP2 expansion at GEMCO delivered first production during FY2013, ahead of schedule.

 

214


Table of Contents

2.5.11 Cash flow analysis

Year ended 30 June 2014 compared with year ended 30 June 2013

An analysis of the cash flow for FY2014 compared to FY2013 is included in section 1.15.4.

Year ended 30 June 2013 compared with year ended 30 June 2012

 

Year ended 30 June

   2013     2012  
     US$M     US$M  

Cash generated from operations

     28,793        32,987   

Dividends received

     721        722   

Net interest paid

     (786     (412

Taxation paid

     (8,574     (8,038
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net operating cash flows

     20,154        25,259   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Purchases of property plant and equipment

     (22,243     (18,637

Exploration expenditure

     (1,351     (2,493

Exploration expenditure expensed and included in operating cash flows

     1,047        1,644   

Purchases of intangibles

     (400     (219

Investment in financial assets

     (475     (471

Investment in subsidiaries, operations and jointly controlled entities

            (12,556

Investment in equity accounted investments

     (84     (83

Net proceeds from investing activities

     4,780        330   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net investing cash flows

     (18,726     (32,485
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net proceeds (repayment of)/from interest bearing liabilities

     7,157        8,644   

Share buy-back

            (83

Dividends paid

     (7,004     (6,220

Contribution from non-controlling interest

     73        101   

Other financing activities

     (424     (403
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net financing cash flows

     (198     2,039   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net increase/(decrease) in cash and cash equivalents

     1,230        (5,187
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net operating cash flow of US$20.2 billion declined by 20 per cent from US$25.3 billion in FY2012. A decrease of US$4.2 billion in cash flow generated from the operation, an increase of US$374 million in net interest paid and an income tax refund of US$530 million received in FY2012 were the major contributors to that decline.

A US$13.8 billion reduction in net investing cash outflows to US$18.7 billion primarily reflected the acquisition of Petrohawk Energy Corporation in the prior period and a US$4.5 billion increase in proceeds from asset sales. Capital and exploration expenditure totalled US$23.6 billion in FY2013. Expenditure on major growth projects was US$18.7 billion, including US$6.9 billion on Petroleum projects and US$11.8 billion on Minerals projects. Capital expenditure on sustaining and other items was US$3.5 billion. Exploration expenditure was US$1.4 billion, including US$1.0 billion classified within net operating cash flows. The breakdown of capital and exploration expenditure by Business is set out in section 1.6.3.

Net financing cash flows included proceeds from borrowings of US$9.2 billion and were partially offset by debt repayments of US$2.0 billion and dividend payments to our shareholders of US$6.2 billion. Proceeds from

 

215


Table of Contents

borrowings include the issuance of a two tranche Euro bond of €2.0 billion, a two tranche Sterling bond of £1.75 billion, an Australian dollar bond of A$1.0 billion, a Euro bond of €750 million and a Canadian dollar bond of C$750 million.

2.5.12 Net debt and sources of liquidity

Gearing and net debt

Year ended 30 June 2014 compared with year ended 30 June 2013

An analysis of the gearing and net debt for FY2014 compared to FY2013 is included in section 1.15.5.

Year ended 30 June 2013 compared with year ended 30 June 2012

Net debt, comprising Interest bearing liabilities less Cash and cash equivalents, was US$27.5 billion, which represented an increase of US$5.3 billion compared with the net debt position at 30 June 2012. Gearing, which is the ratio of net debt to net debt plus net assets, was 26.8 per cent at 30 June 2013, compared with 24.3 per cent at 30 June 2012. The primary reason for the increase in gearing during FY2013 was due to the issue of bonds during the period.

Cash at bank and in hand less overdrafts at 30 June 2013 was US$5.7 billion compared with US$4.5 billion at 30 June 2012. Included within this were short-term deposits at 30 June 2013 of US$3.2 billion compared with US$3.3 billion at 30 June 2012.

 

216


Table of Contents

3    Corporate Governance Statement

3.1    Governance at BHP Billiton

Dear Shareholder

Welcome to BHP Billiton’s Corporate Governance Statement.

At BHP Billiton, we have a governance framework that goes beyond an interest in governance for its own sake or the need to comply with regulatory requirements. Instead, we believe that high-quality governance supports long-term value creation. Simply put, we think good governance is good business, and our approach is to adopt what we consider to be the better of the prevailing governance standards in Australia, the United Kingdom and the United States.

In the same spirit, we do not see governance as just a matter for the Board. Good governance is also the responsibility of executive management and is embedded throughout the organisation.

The diagram on the following page describes the governance framework at BHP Billiton. It shows the interaction between the shareholders and the Board, demonstrates how the Board Committee structure facilitates the interaction between the Board and the Chief Executive Officer (CEO) and illustrates the flow of delegation from shareholders. We have robust processes in place to ensure that the delegation flows through the Board and its committees to the CEO and Group Management Committee (GMC) and into the organisation. At the same time, accountability flows back upwards from the Company to shareholders. This process helps to ensure alignment with shareholders.

As part of our corporate planning cycle, we have embedded a range of scenarios that are reviewed annually and updated by the Group with the GMC’s involvement. The scenarios, and the governance process supporting them, also form part of the Board agenda.

These scenarios provide a lens to assess the performance of our business portfolio. They include assumptions around carbon and commodity prices, currencies, costs and tax rates and ranges for a number of risks that face the Group, including climate change, global growth, levels of trade, geopolitical situation and technology focus. All of the scenarios are used to inform BHP Billiton’s strategy and the resilience of our diversified asset portfolio over the short and long term.

Regardless of which direction the world may take, we will always be guided by Our Charter values, including our value of Sustainability, in how we operate our business, interact with our stakeholders and plan for the future.

As we set out later in this report, while the five committees have accountability for making recommendations to the Board on certain matters such as remuneration and sustainability, we ensure that all the Board members have oversight and the opportunity for full discussion of those issues through the committee report-out process to the full Board.

Our BHP Billiton Charter is core to the governance framework of BHP Billiton. It embodies our corporate purpose, strategy and values, and defines when we are successful. We foster a culture that values and rewards high ethical standards, personal and corporate integrity and respect for others.

We live the values of Our Charter and adhere to the standards of conduct required by our BHP Billiton Code of Business Conduct.

 

217


Table of Contents

BHP Billiton governance structure

 

LOGO

Appointment of Mr Brinded

We are focused on enhancing the diversity of perspective on the Board. We do this in a structured manner, looking out over a five-year period at the skills, backgrounds, knowledge, experience and diversity on the Board. The right blend of skills, experience and perspective is critical to ensuring the Board oversees BHP Billiton effectively for shareholders. As a result of this process, and as described in last year’s Annual Report, we have been seeking additional upstream oil, gas and shale experience.

We are therefore pleased that Malcolm Brinded joined the Board as a Non-executive Director and member of the Sustainability Committee in April 2014. Mr Brinded served on the Board of Royal Dutch Shell plc between 2002 and 2012. During his 37-year career with Shell, he held leadership roles, including Executive Director of Exploration and Production, Executive Director of Upstream International and UK Country Chair and Managing Director. His appointment reflects the structured and rigorous approach to the Board’s succession and planning.

Ongoing renewal

As part of our ongoing renewal of the Board, we announced in August that David Crawford will be retiring from the Board after the forthcoming Annual General Meetings. Mr Crawford has been appointed Chairman-designate of the new company that BHP Billiton plans to form in a demerger. On behalf of all shareholders, I would like to thank him for his exceptional service to the Board and the Group over many years and wish him all the best for the future. It is also intended that Keith Rumble will become a Non-executive Director of the demerged company, and that he will retire from the BHP Billiton Board at or around the time the demerger is completed (currently scheduled for mid-2015).

In relation to gender diversity, the Board has set a goal of increasing the number of women on the Board to at least three. This remains our target, which we aim to achieve by the end of 2015. More details about the Board’s diversity of skills and experience are set out in section 3.8 of this Annual Report.

Continuous improvement

The Board has a commitment to ongoing improvement. This year, we conducted an externally facilitated review of the Board, and a range of improvements to the Board’s work and effectiveness has been agreed, which are set out in section 3.11. In particular, the formalising of a focused strategy day built around scenarios and sign posts for future developments provides an opportunity for the Board to undertake a deeper dive into a range of strategic and long-term plans.

 

218


Table of Contents

I hope you find this description of our corporate governance useful and look forward to receiving any feedback that fellow shareholders may have.

Jac Nasser AO

Chairman

11 September 2014

3.2    Board of Directors and Group Management Committee

3.2.1    Board of Directors

Jac Nasser AO, BBus, Hon DT, 66

Chairman and Independent Non-executive Director

Director of BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc since June 2006. Appointed Chairman of BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc on 31 March 2010.

Skills and experience: Following a 33-year career with Ford Motor Company in leadership positions in Europe, Australia, Asia, South America and the United States, Mr Nasser served as a member of the Board of Directors and as President and Chief Executive Officer of Ford Motor Company from 1998 to 2001. He has more than three decades of experience in large-scale global businesses and a decade of private equity investment and operating expertise.

Other directorships and offices (current and recent):

 

    Director of 21st Century Fox (since June 2013).

 

    Consultant to One Equity Partners (since March 2013) (Partner from November 2002 until March 2010, Non-Executive Advisory Partner from March 2010 to March 2013).

 

    Member of Australian Prime Minister’s Business Advisory Council (since December 2013).

 

    Member of the International Advisory Council of Allianz Aktiengesellschaft (since February 2001).

 

    Former Director of British Sky Broadcasting Group plc (from November 2002 to November 2012).

Board Committee membership:

 

    Chairman of the Nomination and Governance Committee.

Andrew Mackenzie BSc (Geology), PhD (Chemistry), 57

Non-independent

Director of BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc since May 2013. Mr Mackenzie was appointed Chief Executive Officer on 10 May 2013.

Skills and experience: Mr Mackenzie has over 30 years’ experience in oil and gas, petrochemicals and minerals. He joined BHP Billiton in November 2008 as Chief Executive Non-Ferrous. Prior to BHP Billiton, Mr Mackenzie worked at Rio Tinto, where he was Chief Executive of Diamonds and Minerals, and BP, where he held a number of senior roles, including Group Vice President for Technology and Engineering, and Group Vice President for Chemicals.

 

219


Table of Contents

Other directorships and offices (current and recent):

 

    Director of the Grattan Institute (since May 2013).

 

    Director of the International Council on Mining and Metals (since May 2013).

 

    Former Non-executive Director of Centrica plc (from September 2005 to May 2013).

Board Committee membership:

 

    None.

Malcolm Brinded CBE, MA, 61

Independent Non-executive Director

Director of BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc since April 2014.

Skills and experience: Malcolm has extensive experience in energy, governance and sustainability. He served as a member of the Board of Directors of Royal Dutch Shell plc from 2002 to 2012. During his 37-year career with Shell, he held various leadership positions in the United Kingdom, Europe, the Middle East and Asia, including Executive Director of Exploration and Production, Executive Director of Upstream International and Chairman and Upstream Managing Director of Shell UK.

Other directorships and offices (current and recent):

 

    Director of CH2M Hill Companies, Ltd (since July 2012).

 

    Director of Network Rail Ltd; Network Rail Infrastructure Ltd (since October 2010).

 

    Former Director of Royal Dutch Shell plc (from July 2002 to March 2012, including as a Director of Royal Dutch Petroleum and Shell Transport and Trading Ltd prior to unification of Shell’s corporate structure).

 

    Former Director of Shell Petroleum N.V. (from July 2002 to March 2012).

 

    Chairman of the Shell Foundation (since July 2009 and Trustee since June 2004).

 

    Vice President of The Energy Institute, UK (since October 2013).

Board Committee membership:

 

    Member of the Sustainability Committee.

Malcolm Broomhead MBA, BE, 62

Independent Non-executive Director

Director of BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc since March 2010.

Skills and experience: Mr Broomhead has extensive experience in running industrial and mining companies with a global footprint and broad global experience in project development in many of the countries in which BHP Billiton operates. Mr Broomhead was Managing Director and Chief Executive Officer of Orica Limited from 2001 until September 2005. Prior to joining Orica, Mr Broomhead held a number of senior positions at North Limited, including Managing Director and Chief Executive Officer and, prior to that, held senior management positions with Halcrow (UK), MIM Holdings, Peko Wallsend and Industrial Equity.

Other directorships and offices (current and recent):

 

    Chairman of Asciano Limited (since October 2009).

 

    Former Director of Coates Group Holdings Pty Ltd (from January 2008 to July 2013).

 

220


Table of Contents

Board Committee memberships:

 

    Member of the Sustainability Committee.

 

    Member of the Finance Committee.

Sir John Buchanan BSc, MSc (Hons 1), PhD, 71

Senior Independent Director, BHP Billiton Plc

Director of BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc since February 2003.

Skills and experience: Educated at Auckland, Oxford and Harvard, Sir John Buchanan has broad international business experience gained in large and complex international businesses. Sir John has substantial experience in the petroleum industry and knowledge of the international investor community. Sir John has held various leadership roles in commercial, strategic, financial, operational and marketing positions, including executive experience in different countries. Sir John is a former Executive Director and Group Chief Financial Officer of BP.

Other directorships and offices (current and recent):

 

    Chairman of the International Chamber of Commerce (UK) (since May 2008).

 

    Former Chairman of the UK Trustees for the Christchurch Earthquake appeal (from April 2011 to September 2014).

 

    Former Chairman of Smith & Nephew Plc (from April 2006 to April 2014) and former Deputy Chairman (from February 2005 to April 2006).

 

    Former Chairman of ARM Holdings Plc (UK) (from May 2012 to March 2014).

 

    Former member of Advisory Board of Ondra Bank (from June 2009 to November 2013).

 

    Former Deputy Chairman and Senior Independent Director of Vodafone Group Plc (from July 2006 to July 2012) and Director (from April 2003 to July 2012).

 

    Former Director of AstraZeneca Plc (from April 2002 to April 2010).

Board Committee memberships:

 

    Chairman of the Remuneration Committee.

 

    Member of the Nomination and Governance Committee.

Carlos Cordeiro AB, MBA, 58

Independent Non-executive Director

Director of BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc since February 2005.

Skills and experience: Mr Cordeiro brings to the Board more than 30 years’ experience in providing strategic and financial advice to corporations, financial institutions and governments around the world. Mr Cordeiro was previously Partner and Managing Director of Goldman Sachs Group Inc and Vice Chairman of Goldman Sachs (Asia) LLC.

Other directorships and offices (current and recent):

 

    Non-executive Advisory Director of The Goldman Sachs Group Inc (since December 2001).

 

    Non-executive Vice Chairman of Goldman Sachs (Asia) LLC (since December 2001).

 

221


Table of Contents

Board Committee membership:

 

    Member of the Remuneration Committee.

David Crawford AO, BComm, LLB, FCA, FCPA, 70

Independent Non-executive Director

Director of BHP Limited since May 1994. Director of BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc since June 2001.

Skills and experience: Mr Crawford has extensive experience in risk management and business reorganisation. He has acted as a consultant, scheme manager, receiver and manager and liquidator to very large and complex groups of companies. Mr Crawford was previously Australian National Chairman of KPMG, Chartered Accountants.

Mr Crawford is the Chairman-designate of the new company that BHP Billiton plans to form in the proposed demerger. Mr Crawford will retire from the BHP Billiton Board in November 2014.

Other directorships and offices (current and recent):

 

    Chairman of Australia Pacific Airports Corporation Limited (since May 2012).

 

    Chairman of Lend Lease Corporation Limited (since May 2003) and Director (since July 2001).

 

    Former Chairman (from November 2007 to December 2011) and former Director (from August 2001 to December 2011) of Foster’s Group Limited.

Board Committee membership:

 

    Chairman of the Finance Committee.

Pat Davies BSc (Mechanical Engineering), 63

Independent Non-executive Director

Director of BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc since June 2012.

Skills and experience: Mr Davies has broad experience in the natural resources sector across a number of geographies, commodities and markets. From July 2005 until June 2011, Mr Davies was Chief Executive of Sasol Limited, an international energy, chemical and mining company with operations in 38 countries and listings on the Johannesburg and New York stock exchanges. Mr Davies began his career at Sasol in 1975 and held a number of diverse roles, including managing the group’s oil and gas businesses, before becoming Chief Executive in July 2005. He is a former Director of various Sasol Group companies and joint ventures.

Other directorships and offices (current and recent):

 

    Former Director (from August 1997 to June 2011) and Chief Executive (from July 2005 to June 2011) of Sasol Limited.

Board Committee membership:

 

    Member of the Remuneration Committee.

Carolyn Hewson AO, BEc (Hons), MA (Econ), 59

Independent Non-executive Director

Director of BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc since March 2010.

 

222


Table of Contents

Skills and experience: Ms Hewson is a former investment banker and has over 30 years’ experience in the finance sector. Ms Hewson was previously an Executive Director of Schroders Australia Limited and has extensive financial markets, risk management and investment management expertise. Ms Hewson is a former Director of BT Investment Management Limited, Westpac Banking Corporation, AMP Limited, CSR Limited, AGL Energy Limited, the Australian Gas Light Company, South Australian Water and the Economic Development Board of South Australia.

Other directorships and offices (current and recent):

 

    Member of Australian Federal Government Financial Systems Inquiry (since January 2014).

 

    Director of Stockland Group (since March 2009).

 

    Member of the Advisory Board of Nanosonics Limited (since June 2007).

 

    Former Director of BT Investment Management Limited (from December 2007 to December 2013).

 

    Former Director and Patron of the Neurosurgical Research Foundation (from April 1993 to December 2013).

 

    Former Trustee and Chairman of Westpac Buckland Fund (from January 2011 to December 2013) and Chairman of Westpac Matching Gifts Limited (from August 2011 to December 2013), together known as the Westpac Foundation.

 

    Former Director of Westpac Banking Corporation (from February 2003 to June 2012).

Board Committee memberships:

 

    Member of the Risk and Audit Committee.

 

    Member of the Remuneration Committee.

Lindsay Maxsted DipBus (Gordon), FCA, FAICD, 60

Independent Non-executive Director

Director of BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc since March 2011.

Skills and experience: Mr Maxsted is a corporate recovery specialist who has managed a number of Australia’s largest corporate insolvency and restructuring engagements and, until 2011, continued to undertake consultancy work in the restructuring advisory field. He was the Chief Executive Officer of KPMG Australia between 2001 and 2007. Mr Maxsted is the Board’s nominated ‘audit committee financial expert’ for the purposes of the US Securities and Exchange Commission Rules, and the Board is satisfied that he has recent and relevant financial experience for the purposes of the UK Financial Conduct Authority’s Disclosure and Transparency Rules and the UK Corporate Governance Code.

Other directorships and offices (current and recent):

 

    Chairman of Westpac Banking Corporation (since December 2011) and a Director (since March 2008).

 

    Chairman of Transurban Group (since August 2010) and a Director (since March 2008).

 

    Director and Honorary Treasurer of Baker IDI Heart and Diabetes Institute (since June 2005).

Board Committee membership:

 

    Chairman of the Risk and Audit Committee.

 

    Member of the Finance Committee.

 

223


Table of Contents

Wayne Murdy BSc (Business Administration), CPA, 70

Independent Non-executive Director

Director of BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc since June 2009.

Skills and experience: Mr Murdy has a background in finance and accounting, where he has gained comprehensive experience in the financial management of mining, oil and gas companies during his career with Getty Oil, Apache Corporation and Newmont Mining Corporation. He served as the Chief Executive Officer of Newmont Mining Corporation from 2001 to 2007 and Chairman from 2002 to 2007. Mr Murdy is also a former Chairman of the International Council on Mining and Metals, a former Director of the US National Mining Association and a former member of the Manufacturing Council of the US Department of Commerce.

Other directorships and offices (current and recent):

 

    Director of Weyerhaeuser Company (since January 2009).

 

    Former Director of Qwest Communications International Inc (from September 2005 to April 2011).

Board Committee memberships:

 

    Member of the Risk and Audit Committee.

 

    Member of the Finance Committee.

Keith Rumble BSc, MSc (Geology), 60

Independent Non-executive Director

Director of BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc since September 2008.

Skills and experience: Mr Rumble was previously Chief Executive Officer of SUN Mining, a wholly owned entity of the SUN Group, a principal investor and private equity fund manager in Russia, India and other emerging and transforming markets. Mr Rumble has over 30 years’ experience in the resources industry, specifically in titanium and platinum mining, and is a former Chief Executive Officer of Impala Platinum (Pty) Ltd and former Chief Executive Officer of Rio Tinto Iron and Titanium Inc in Canada. Mr Rumble began his career at Richards Bay Minerals in 1980 and held various management positions before becoming Chief Executive Officer in 1996.

It is intended that Mr Rumble will become a Non-executive Director of the new company that BHP Billiton plans to form in the proposed demerger. Mr Rumble would retire from the BHP Billiton Board at the time the shareholders vote on this demerger proposal.

Other directorships and offices (current and recent):

 

    Director of Enzyme Technologies (Pty) Limited (since September 2011).

 

    Director of Elite Wealth (Pty) Limited (since August 2010).

 

    Board of Governors of Rhodes University (since April 2005).

 

    Trustee of the World Wildlife Fund, South Africa (since October 2006).

 

    Former Director of Aveng Group Limited (from September 2009 to December 2011).

Board Committee membership:

 

    Member of the Sustainability Committee.

 

224


Table of Contents

John Schubert AO, BCh Eng, PhD (Chem Eng), 71

Independent Non-executive Director

Director of BHP Limited since June 2000 and a Director of BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc since June 2001.

Skills and experience: Dr Schubert has considerable experience in the international oil industry, including at Chief Executive Officer level. Dr Schubert has had executive mining and financial responsibilities and was Chief Executive Officer of Pioneer International Limited for six years, where he operated in the building materials industry in 16 countries. Dr Schubert has experience in mergers, acquisitions and divestments, project analysis and management. He was previously Chairman and Managing Director of Esso Australia Limited and President of the Business Council of Australia.

Other directorships and offices (current and recent):

 

    Chairman of Garvan Institute of Medical Research (since May 2013).

 

    Chairman of the Great Barrier Reef Foundation (since November 2004).

 

    Former Chairman of G2 Therapies Pty Limited (from November 2000 to April 2013).

 

    Former Director of Qantas Airways Limited (from October 2000 to November 2012).

 

    Former Chairman (from November 2004 to February 2010) and Director (from October 1991 to February 2010) of Commonwealth Bank of Australia.

Board Committee memberships:

 

    Chairman of the Sustainability Committee.

 

    Member of the Remuneration Committee.

 

    Member of the Nomination and Governance Committee.

Baroness Shriti Vadera MA, 52

Independent Non-executive Director

Director of BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc since January 2011.

Skills and experience: Baroness Vadera brings wide-ranging experience in finance, economics and public policy, as well as extensive experience of emerging markets and international institutions. In recent years, she has undertaken a number of international assignments, including advising on the Eurozone crisis and working with the Korean chair of the G20. Baroness Vadera was a Minister in the British Government from 2007 to 2009 in the Department for International Development, the Business Department and the Cabinet Office, where she was responsible for the response to the global financial crisis. She was on the Council of Economic Advisers, HM Treasury from 1999 to 2007 focusing on business and international economic issues. Prior to her time in the British Government, Baroness Vadera spent 14 years in investment banking at UBS Warburg, where she specialised in advisory work in emerging markets.

Other directorships and offices (current and recent):

 

    Director of AstraZeneca Plc (since January 2011).

Board Committee membership:

 

    Member of the Risk and Audit Committee.

 

225


Table of Contents

Jane McAloon BEc (Hons), LLB, GDipGov, FCIS, 50

President, Governance and Group Company Secretary and Chairman of the Disclosure Committee.

Skills and experience: Ms McAloon was appointed to the Group Management Committee as President, Governance and Group Company Secretary in May 2013 after serving as Group Company Secretary since July 2007. Ms McAloon joined the BHP Billiton Group in September 2006 as Company Secretary for BHP Billiton Limited. Prior to joining BHP Billiton, she held the position of Company Secretary and Group Manager External and Regulatory Services in the Australian Gas Light Company. She previously held various Australian State and Commonwealth government positions, including Director General of the New South Wales Ministry of Energy and Utilities and Deputy Director General for the New South Wales Cabinet Office, as well as working in private legal practice. She is a Non-executive Director of Energy Australia, a Fellow of the Institute of Chartered Secretaries and Fellow of Australian Institute of Company Directors.

3.2.2    Group Management Committee

Andrew Mackenzie BSc (Geology), PhD (Chemistry), 57

Chief Executive Officer and Executive Director

Chairman of the Group Management Committee

Mr Mackenzie commenced as Chief Executive Officer in May 2013. He joined BHP Billiton in November 2008 as Chief Executive Non-Ferrous. Prior to BHP Billiton, he worked at Rio Tinto, where he was Chief Executive of Diamonds and Minerals, and BP, where he held a number of senior roles, including Group Vice President for Technology and Engineering, and Group Vice President for Chemicals. In July 2014 he was elected a Fellow of the Royal Society.

Peter Beaven BAcc, CA, 47

President, Copper

Mr Beaven was appointed President, Copper in May 2013. Previously he was the President of Base Metals and prior to that appointment, in November 2010, President of BHP Billiton’s Manganese business, and Vice President and Chief Development Officer for Carbon Steel Materials. He has wide experience across a range of regions and businesses in BHP Billiton, UBS Warburg, Kleinwort Benson and PricewaterhouseCoopers.

Mr Beaven will be appointed as Chief Financial Officer, effective 1 October 2014.

Tony Cudmore BA (Politics and Economics), 45

President, Corporate Affairs (since 3 March 2014)

Mr Cudmore joined BHP Billiton as President, Corporate Affairs in March 2014. Prior to BHP Billiton, Mr Cudmore worked with ExxonMobil for 13 years and held a wide range of senior and global Corporate Affairs roles in Australia and the United States. Before joining ExxonMobil, Mr Cudmore was a Media Relations and Policy Adviser before becoming Principal Adviser to then Premier of Victoria, The Hon Jeff Kennett MP, followed by his role as Assistant Director of the Australian Institute of Petroleum.

Tim Cutt BSc, 54

President, Petroleum and Potash (since 2 July 2013)

Mr Cutt was appointed President, Petroleum and Potash in July 2013. He joined BHP Billiton in 2007 as the President of the Production Division in the Petroleum business. Mr Cutt was appointed to the position of

 

226


Table of Contents

President, Diamonds and Specialty Products in 2011. Before joining BHP Billiton, Mr Cutt had a successful 24-year career with ExxonMobil in roles of significant oil and gas responsibility, including President of ExxonMobil de Venezuela and President of Hibernia Management and Development Company.

Dean Dalla Valle MBA, 55

President, Coal

Mr Dalla Valle was appointed President, Coal in May 2013. He has 37 years’ experience in BHP Billiton. Mr Dalla Valle was previously the President of the Uranium business for three years and prior to that held the positions of Asset President, Olympic Dam, Asset President, Cannington silver mine and Vice President Ports, Iron Ore. He was also the General Manager of the Appin, Tower and West Cliff Collieries for Illawarra Coal.

Mike Fraser BCom, MBL, 49

President, Human Resources (since 27 August 2013)

Mr Fraser joined BHP Billiton in January 2000. Mr Fraser joined the Group Management Committee in August 2013 as President, Human Resources. He was previously Head of Group Human Resources. Before becoming Head of Human Resources, Mike was Asset President Mozal, based in Mozambique. His previous roles with the Company included Human Resources Vice President for the Aluminium and Energy Coal businesses.

Geoff Healy BEc, LLB, 48

Chief Legal Counsel

Mr Healy joined BHP Billiton as Chief Legal Counsel in June 2013. Prior to BHP Billiton, Mr Healy was a partner at Herbert Smith Freehills for 16 years, and a member of its Global Partnership Council, and worked widely across its network of Australian and international offices. His core field of expertise is complex corporate and regulatory advisory work, risk management, investigations and disputes.

Mike Henry BSc (Chem), 48

President, HSE, Marketing and Technology

Mr Henry joined BHP Billiton in 2003 and has served as President, HSE, Marketing and Technology since May 2013. Prior to this, he was Chief Marketing Officer. His earlier career with BHP Billiton included various business development and marketing roles, including Marketing Director for Petroleum, Marketing Director for Energy Coal and Freight and Vice President, Business Development for the Energy Coal Business. Prior to joining BHP Billiton, Mr Henry worked for Mitsubishi Corporation, where he held a number of commercial roles.

Graham Kerr BBus, FCPA, 43

Chief Financial Officer and Chairman of the Investment Committee and Financial Risk Management Committee

Mr Kerr joined BHP Billiton in 1994 and was appointed Chief Financial Officer in November 2011. Prior to this, he was President of Diamonds and Specialty Products. Mr Kerr has worked in a wide range of finance, treasury and operational roles across the Group, and has held the positions of Chief Financial Officer of Stainless Steel Materials, Vice President, Finance – BHP Billiton Diamonds and Finance Director for the EKATI diamond mine. In 2004, Mr Kerr left BHP Billiton for a two-year period, when he was General Manager Commercial for Iluka Resources Ltd.

In August 2014, Mr Kerr was appointed as Chief Executive Officer-designate of the new company that BHP Billiton plans to form in the proposed demerger. Mr Kerr will retire from the Group Management Committee, and as Chief Financial Officer of BHP Billiton, on 1 October 2014.

 

227


Table of Contents

Jane McAloon BEc (Hons), LLB, GDipGov, FCIS, 50

President, Governance and Group Company Secretary and Chairman of the Disclosure Committee

Ms McAloon was appointed to the Group Management Committee as President, Governance and Group Company Secretary in May 2013, after serving as Group Company Secretary since July 2007. Ms McAloon joined the BHP Billiton Group in September 2006 as Company Secretary for BHP Billiton Limited.

Daniel Malchuk BEng, MBA, 49

President, Aluminium, Manganese and Nickel

Mr Malchuk was appointed President Aluminium, Manganese and Nickel in May 2013. Previously, he was the President of Minerals Exploration, a position he held from July 2012. He worked for the Company between 1996 and 1998 in BHP Copper, in the United States, and has held a number of roles in the Base Metals business since he rejoined BHP Billiton in 2002. In 2006, he took the role of Asset Leader Joint Ventures and a year later was appointed Vice President Strategy and Development in Base Metals.

Jimmy Wilson BSc (Mechanical Engineering), 52

President, Iron Ore

Mr Wilson was appointed President, Iron Ore in March 2012. He has had an extensive career in the mining industry, and held key managerial and operational roles throughout BHP Billiton including President, Energy Coal (2009 – 2012) and President, Stainless Steel Materials (2007 – 2009). Prior to these roles, Mr Wilson was President and Chief Operating Officer Nickel West, President and Chief Operating Officer Samancor Chrome and General Manager of Billiton’s Bayside Aluminium.

Karen Wood BEd, LLB (Hons), 58

President (until 19 August 2014)

Ms Wood joined BHP Billiton in 2001. Her previous positions were President Corporate Affairs, Chief People Officer, Chief Governance Officer, Special Adviser and Head of Group Secretariat and Group Company Secretary. Prior to her retirement from the GMC, she provided advice to the Chief Executive Officer and worked on a range of significant corporate and Board issues. Ms Wood retired from BHP Billiton on 20 August 2014 and will continue to provide advice and assistance, on an ongoing consultancy basis, to the Chief Executive Officer and Board of Directors on several matters including the proposed demerger. Before joining BHP Billiton, she was General Counsel and Company Secretary for Bonlac Foods Limited.

3.3    Shareholder engagement

Part of the Board’s commitment to high-quality governance is expressed through the approach BHP Billiton takes to engaging and communicating with shareholders. We encourage shareholders to make their views known to us.

Our shareholders are based across the globe. Outside of the Annual General Meeting (AGM), which is an important step in the governance and investor engagement process and is described below, the Board uses a range of formal and informal communication channels to understand shareholder views to ensure it can represent shareholders in governing BHP Billiton. Regular proactive engagement with institutional shareholders and investor representative organisations takes place in Australia, South Africa, the United Kingdom and the United States. The purpose of these meetings is to discuss the full range of governance issues, as well as the broad strategy of the Group. They offer an important opportunity to build relationships and to engage directly with governance managers, fund managers and governance advisers. The meetings are led by:

 

  the Chairman, supported by the Group Governance and Company Secretariat team – strategy, governance and remuneration;

 

228


Table of Contents
  the Remuneration Committee Chairman and Senior Independent Director – governance and remuneration;

 

  the CEO, Chief Financial Officer (CFO), senior management and the Investor Relations team – strategy, financial and operating performance. Important briefings are webcast live from our website: www.bhpbilliton.com. During FY2014, meetings between management, shareholders and bondholders were held in Australia, Canada, South Africa, Singapore, the UK and the US as part of our commitment to engage with providers of all types of capital;

 

  the Head of Health, Safety, Environment and Community (HSEC) – HSEC strategy and briefings. Each year, we conduct group and one-on-one meetings with investors focused on key HSEC issues. During FY2014, these took place in Australia and the UK, with group meetings in mainland Europe held by conference call;

 

  Group Governance and Company Secretariat – governance strategy and briefings. The Governance and Company Secretariat team provides a conduit to enable the Board and its committees to remain abreast of evolving investor expectations and to continuously enhance the governance processes of the Group.

The Chairman’s meetings are scheduled throughout the year to ensure continual feedback. This is designed to ensure that issues can be discussed separate to the AGM, and, where appropriate, allows time to respond to feedback and shape new policies for the forthcoming financial year. During FY2014, the Chairman’s meetings included investors in Australia, the UK and the US. Alongside these meetings, Group Governance and Investor Relations met with shareholders in South Africa.

As a Group, we take a coordinated approach to investor engagement, and during the year responded to a wide range of shareholders, their representatives and non-governmental organisations. Issues covered included climate change and strategic risk assessment; water management; hydraulic fracturing; joint venture governance; tax; remuneration; and collective bargaining.

 

229


Table of Contents

Shareholders can contact us at any time through our Investor Relations team, with contact details available on our website: www.bhpbilliton.com. Feedback from shareholders is regularly reported to the Board. Shareholder and analyst feedback is shared with the Board through the Chairman, the Chairman of the Remuneration Committee (also the Senior Independent Director), other Directors, the CEO, the CFO and the Group Company Secretary. In addition, the Head of Investor Relations and Vice President Governance provide regular reports to the Board on shareholder and governance manager feedback and analysis. This approach provides a robust mechanism to ensure Directors are aware of issues raised and have a good understanding of current shareholder views.

 

LOGO

Annual General Meetings

The AGMs are an opportunity for shareholders to ask questions of the Board.

Our Dual Listed Company (DLC) structure means that we hold two AGMs each year. The AGMs are important dates in the BHP Billiton calendar. In October each year, the BHP Billiton Plc meeting is held in the United Kingdom, and in November, the BHP Billiton Limited meeting is held in Australia. These meetings provide an update for shareholders on the Group’s performance and offer an opportunity for shareholders to ask questions and vote. Shareholders vote on important matters affecting the Group, including the election of Directors, any changes to our constitutional documents, the receipt of annual Financial Statements and incentive arrangements for the Executive Director. Shareholders may appoint proxies electronically through our website and may also use the BHP Billiton mobile voting service for smart phones. The Notice of Meeting describes how this can be done. As described above, a key part of our approach to governance is that shareholders’ views are heard and understood. The AGMs provide an important forum to enable this.

Questions can be registered prior to the meeting by completing the relevant form accompanying the Notice of Meeting. Shareholders can also email the Group at investor.relations@bhpbilliton.com. Questions can be lodged ahead of the meeting and the answers to the most frequently asked questions are posted to our website.

Key members of management, including the CEO and CFO, are present and available to answer questions. The External Auditor attends the AGMs and is also available to answer questions.

 

230


Table of Contents

Proceedings at shareholder meetings are webcast live from our website. Copies of the speeches delivered by the Chairman and CEO to the AGMs are released to the stock exchanges and posted to our website. A summary of proceedings and the outcome of voting on the items of business are released to the relevant stock exchanges and posted to our website as soon as they are available following the completion of the BHP Billiton Limited meeting.

 

Information relating to the 2013 AGM is available online at

www.bhpbilliton.com/home/investors/shareholderinfo/Pages/Meetings.aspx.

3.4    Role and responsibilities of the Board

The Board’s role is to represent the shareholders. It is accountable to them for creating and delivering value through the effective governance of the Group. This role requires a high-performing Board, with all Directors contributing to the Board’s collective decision-making processes.

The Board Governance Document is a statement of the practices and processes the Board has adopted to discharge its responsibilities. It includes the processes the Board has implemented to undertake its own tasks and activities; the matters it has reserved for its own consideration and decision-making; the authority it has delegated to the CEO, including the limits on the way in which the CEO can execute that authority; and provides guidance on the relationship between the Board and the CEO.

The Board Governance Document also specifies the role of the Chairman, the membership of the Board and the role and conduct of Non-executive Directors. Further information is at sections 3.5 to 3.8.

 

The Board Governance Document is available online at

www.bhpbilliton.com/home/aboutus/ourcompany/Pages/governance.aspx.

Allocation of decision-making authority

The matters that the Board has specifically reserved for its decision are:

 

  appointments to the position of CEO and approval of the appointment of executives reporting directly to the CEO;

 

  approval of strategy and annual budgets of the Group;

 

  determination of capital and non-capital items in accordance with the approved delegations of authority;

 

  determination and adoption of documents (including the publication of reports and statements to shareholders) that are required by the Group’s constitutional documents, by statute or by other external regulation.

The Board is free to alter the matters reserved for its decision, subject to the limitations imposed by the constitutional documents and the law.

The CEO is delegated authority to take all decisions and actions that further the corporate purpose of creating long-term shareholder value through the discovery, acquisition, development and marketing of natural resources. This is subject to the limits imposed by the Board on the CEO’s decision-making authority and set out in the Board Governance Document, and the matters the Board has specifically reserved for its decision, including in the Group’s authorities framework. The CEO remains accountable to the Board for the authority that is delegated and for the performance of the Group with the expectation that the CEO works in a constructive partnership with the Board. The Board monitors the decisions and actions of the CEO and the performance of the Group to gain assurance that progress is being made towards the corporate purpose within the limits imposed through the

 

231


Table of Contents

Group’s governance assurance framework. The Board also monitors the performance of the Group and assesses its risk profile through its committees. Reports from each of the committees are set out in section 3.14.

The CEO is required to report regularly in a spirit of openness and trust on the progress being made by the Group. The Board and its committees determine the information required from the CEO and any employee or external party, including the External Auditor. Open dialogue between individual members of the Board and the CEO and other members of the management team is encouraged to enable Directors to gain a better understanding of the Group.

Independent advice

The Board and its committees may seek advice from independent experts whenever it is considered appropriate. Individual Directors, with the consent of the Chairman, may seek independent professional advice on any matter connected with the discharge of their responsibilities at the Group’s expense.

Strategic focus and review

Within this framework, at the start of the calendar year, the Board agrees its strategic focus and priorities for the year ahead. This ensures that the work of the Board is aligned with the corporate purpose and takes into account external factors, such as commodity market developments, and changes to the operating and regulatory environment.

The Board also evaluates its activities on a regular basis taking into account:

 

  matters considered by the Board (including time spent on those matters);

 

  legal and governance requirements of the Board and its committees;

 

  feedback from shareholders and other stakeholders;

 

  the outcomes of its evaluation process.

The Board is satisfied that it has discharged its obligations as set out in the Board Governance Document.

Key activities during the year

BHP Billiton’s strategy to own and operate large, long-life, low-cost, expandable, upstream assets diversified by commodity, geography and market remains the foundation for creating shareholder value. At the end of FY2014, the Group had seven major projects and one other project under development with a combined budget of US$14.1 billion. Beyond our current projects in execution, the Board believes that the Group’s diversified portfolio is a point of differentiation and allows us to maintain an internal focus. As we concentrate investment in our major basins, it is expected that fewer projects will pass through our tollgate and prospective investment returns will rise. We believe that an average rate of return of greater than 20 per cent (ungeared, after tax, nominal dollars) is achievable for our favoured development options.

No major growth projects were approved during FY2014. Our commitment to maintain a solid ‘A’ credit rating remains unchanged. Within this context, the Board approved a range of business decisions, including:

 

  the investment of US$1.97 billion (BHP Billiton share) to sustain operations at Escondida in Chile, by constructing a new 2,500 litre per second sea water desalination facility;

 

  the investment of US$2.6 billion, spread over a number of years, to finish the excavation and lining of the Jansen Potash Project production and service shafts, and to continue the installation of essential surface infrastructure and utilities;

 

232


Table of Contents
  the pricing of a four tranche Global Bond comprising US$500 million Senior Floating Rate Notes due 2016, paying interest at three-month US Dollar LIBOR plus 25 basis points, US$500 million 2.050 per cent Senior Notes due 2018, US$1.5 billion 3.850 per cent Senior Notes due 2023 and US$2.5 billion 5.000 per cent Senior Notes due 2043;

 

  the redemption of all outstanding Petrohawk Energy Corporation Senior Notes due 2014 and 2015 with a total aggregate principal value of approximately US$1.4 billion;

 

  the appointment of Mike Fraser as President, Human Resources, and Tony Cudmore as President, Corporate Affairs, as part of the senior management team following the appointment of Andrew Mackenzie as CEO;

 

  after the year-end, the redemption of all outstanding Petrohawk Energy Corporation Senior Notes due 2018 and 2019 with a total aggregate principal value of approximately US$1.8 billion;

 

  also after the year-end, announcing plans to create an independent global metals and mining company based on a demerger of a selection of the Group’s high-quality aluminium, coal, manganese, nickel and silver assets subject to the receipt of satisfactory third party approvals, final Board approval to proceed and shareholder approval; and

 

  the retirement of Graham Kerr from the GMC with effect from 1 October 2014, his appointment as Chief Executive Officer-designate of the planned demerged company, his replacement as BHP Billiton CFO by Peter Beaven, currently President, Copper and the retirement from the GMC of Karen Wood on 19 August 2014.

Board and committee renewal

Another significant activity during the year was Board and committee succession planning and renewal. The Board believes that orderly succession planning and renewal is in the best interests of the Group. During FY2014, Mr Brinded was appointed to the Board, with effect from 15 April 2014, and subsequently joined the Sustainability Committee. In addition, Carolyn Hewson joined the Remuneration Committee in January 2014. As noted above, David Crawford intends to retire from the Board following the BHP Billiton Limited AGM. He has been appointed as Chairman-designate of the planned demerged company. The Board also intends to appoint Keith Rumble to the demerged company Board.

3.5    Board membership

The Board currently has 14 members, each of whom must seek re-election by shareholders annually. Of these, 13, including the Chairman, are independent Non-executive Directors. The Non-executive Directors are considered by the Board to be independent of management and free from any business relationship or other circumstance that could materially interfere with the exercise of objective, unfettered or independent judgement. Further information on the process for assessing independence is in section 3.10.

In terms of Non-executive Directors, the Nomination and Governance Committee retains the services of external recruitment specialists to continue to assist in the identification of potential candidates for the Board.

The Board considers that there is an appropriate balance between Executive and Non-executive Directors to promote shareholder interests and govern the Company effectively. While the Board includes a smaller number of Executive Directors than is common for UK-listed companies, its composition is appropriate for the DLC structure and is in line with Australian-listed company practice. In addition, the Board has extensive access to members of senior management, who frequently attend Board meetings, where they make presentations and engage in discussions with Directors, answer questions, and provide input and perspective on their areas of responsibility. The Board, led by the Chairman, also deliberates in the absence of management at the beginning and end of each meeting.

The Directors of the Group along with their biographical details are set out in section 3.2.1.

 

233


Table of Contents

3.6    Chairman

The Chairman, Jac Nasser, is considered by the Board to be independent. He was appointed Chairman of the Group from 31 March 2010 and has been a Non-executive Director of the Group since 6 June 2006. Mr Nasser was last re-elected at the 2013 AGMs and, in accordance with the Group’s policy that each Director stand for election annually, will stand for re-election in 2014.

The Chairman’s role includes:

 

  leading the Board and ensuring that it is operating to the highest governance standards;

 

  encouraging a culture of openness and debate to foster a high-performing and collegial team of Directors that operates effectively;

 

  ensuring strategic issues, relevant stakeholder and shareholder views are regularly reviewed, clearly understood and underpin the work of the Board;

 

  facilitating the relationship between the Board and the CEO;

 

  ensuring the provision of accurate, timely and clear information;

 

  setting agendas for meetings of the Board, in consultation with the CEO and Group Company Secretary, that focus on the strategic direction and performance of the Group’s business;

 

  ensuring that adequate time is available for discussion on all agenda items;

 

  leading the Board and individual Director performance assessments;

 

  speaking and acting for the Board and representing the Board to shareholders.

The Board considers that none of Mr Nasser’s other commitments (set out in section 3.2.1) interfere with the discharge of his responsibilities to the Group. The Board is satisfied that he makes sufficient time available to serve the Group effectively.

The Group does not have a Deputy Chairman, but has identified John Schubert to act as Chairman should the need arise at short notice.

3.7    Senior Independent Director

The Board has appointed Sir John Buchanan as the Senior Independent Director of BHP Billiton Plc in accordance with the UK Corporate Governance Code. Sir John is available to shareholders who have concerns that cannot be addressed through the Chairman, CEO or CFO. As Senior Independent Director, he also provides a sounding board for the Chairman and serves as an intermediary for other Directors if necessary.

3.8    Director skills, experience and attributes

Skills, experience and attributes required

The Board considers that a diversity of skills, backgrounds, knowledge, experience, geographic location, nationalities and gender is required in order to effectively govern the business. The Board and its Nomination and Governance Committee work to ensure that the Board continues to have the right balance of skills, experience, independence and Group knowledge necessary to discharge its responsibilities in accordance with the highest standards of governance.

In order to govern the Group effectively, Non-executive Directors must have a clear understanding of the Group’s overall strategy, together with knowledge about the Group and the industries in which it operates. Non-executive Directors must be sufficiently familiar with the Group’s core business to be effective contributors to

 

234


Table of Contents

the development of strategy and to monitor performance. Part of the required understanding of strategy and the core business is the requirement to understand the risks that the Group faces and the processes in place to mitigate and manage those risks. We operate in an uncertain external environment, and the Group is exposed to many material risks across its operations, including some that are systemic such as financial risks and climate change. All those risks are factored into the Board’s approach to strategy and its assessment of an optimised portfolio. The risk management governance structure is set out in section 3.15.

The Board Governance Document requires that Directors demonstrate unquestioned honesty and integrity, preparedness to question, challenge and critique, and a willingness to understand and commit to the highest standards of governance. Directors must commit to the collective decision-making processes of the Board. Individual Directors are required to debate issues openly and constructively, and are free to question or challenge the opinions of others. Directors must also commit to active involvement in Board decisions and the application of strategic thought to matters in issue. Directors must be clear communicators and good listeners who actively contribute to the Board in a collegial manner. Each Director must ensure that no decision or action is taken that places his or her interests in front of the interests of the Company.

Directors must be prepared to commit sufficient time and resources to perform their role effectively. The Nomination and Governance Committee takes account of the other positions held by each potential Director candidate. It assesses whether they will have adequate time to devote to the Board, prior to making a recommendation to the Board on whether to appoint them as a Director. In addition, Directors are required to consult with the Chairman before accepting any additional commitments that could conflict with or impact on the time Directors can devote to their role.

The Nomination and Governance Committee is required to assist the Board in ensuring that the Board is comprised of high-calibre individuals whose background, skills, experience and personal characteristics will augment the present Board and meet its future needs and diversity aspirations.

Current Board profile

The following table sets out the key skills and experience of the Directors and the extent to which they are represented on the Board and its committees. As a Board, the Non-executive Directors contribute:

 

  international business and senior executive experience;

 

  relevant operating experience;

 

  understanding of the sectors in which we operate;

 

  knowledge of world capital markets;

 

  regulatory and government policy experience;

 

  an understanding of the health, safety, environmental and community challenges that we face;

 

  experience of managing in the context of uncertainty, and an understanding of the risk environment of the Group, and the potential for risk to impact our health and safety, environment, community, reputation, regulatory, market and financial performance.

The Executive Director brings additional perspectives to the Board’s work through a deep understanding of the Group’s business.

In addition to the skills and experience set out in the table, the Board considers that each Director has the following attributes:

 

  unquestioned honesty and integrity;

 

  a proven track record of creating value for shareholders;

 

235


Table of Contents
  time available to undertake the responsibilities;

 

  an ability to apply strategic thought to matters in issue;

 

  an ability to consider materiality and risk tolerance as key considerations in decision-making;

 

  a preparedness to question, challenge and critique;

 

  a willingness to understand and commit to the highest standards of governance.

 

Skills and experience

  Board     Risk and
Audit
    Nomination
and
Governance
    Remuneration     Sustainability     Finance  

Total Directors

    14 Directors        4 Directors        3 Directors        5 Directors        4 Directors        4 Directors   

Executive leadership

           
Sustainable success in business at a very senior executive level in a successful career.     13 Directors        3 Directors        3 Directors        4 Directors        4 Directors        4 Directors   

Global experience

           
Senior management or equivalent experience in multiple global locations, exposed to a range of political, cultural, regulatory and business environments.     14 Directors        4 Directors        3 Directors        5 Directors        4 Directors        4 Directors   

Governance

           
Commitment to the highest standards of governance, including experience with a major organisation that is subject to rigorous governance standards, and an ability to assess the effectiveness of senior management.     14 Directors        4 Directors        3 Directors        5 Directors        4 Directors        4 Directors   

Strategy / Risk

           
Track record of developing and implementing a successful strategy, including appropriately probing and challenging management on the delivery of agreed strategic planning objectives. Track record in developing an asset or business portfolio over the long term that remains resilient to systemic risk.     14 Directors        4 Directors        3 Directors        5 Directors        4 Directors        4 Directors   

 

236


Table of Contents

Skills and experience

  Board     Risk and
Audit
    Nomination
and
Governance
    Remuneration     Sustainability     Finance  

Financial acumen

           
Senior executive or equivalent experience in financial accounting and reporting, corporate finance and internal financial controls, including an ability to probe the adequacies of financial and risk controls.     14 Directors        4 Directors        3 Directors        5 Directors        4 Directors        4 Directors   

Capital projects

           
Experience working in an industry with projects involving large-scale capital outlays and long-term investment horizons.     12 Directors        3 Directors        3 Directors        3 Directors        4 Directors        4 Directors   

Health, safety and environment

           
Experience related to workplace health and safety, environmental and social responsibility, and community.     13 Directors        4 Directors        3 Directors        4 Directors        4 Directors        4 Directors   

Remuneration

           
Board Remuneration Committee membership or management experience in relation to remuneration, including incentive programs and pensions/superannuation and the legislation and contractual framework governing remuneration.     14 Directors        4 Directors        3 Directors        5 Directors        4 Directors        4 Directors   

Mining

           
Senior executive experience in a large mining organisation combined with an understanding of the Group’s corporate purpose to create long-term shareholder value through the discovery, acquisition, development and marketing of natural resources.     5 Directors        1 Director        0 Directors        1 Director        2 Directors        2 Directors   

 

237


Table of Contents

Skills and experience

  Board     Risk and
Audit
    Nomination
and
Governance
    Remuneration     Sustainability     Finance  

Oil and gas

           
Senior executive experience in the oil and gas industry, including in-depth knowledge of the Group’s strategy, markets, competitors, operational issues, technology and regulatory concerns.     6 Directors        1 Director        2 Directors        3 Directors        2 Directors        1 Director   

Marketing

           
Senior executive experience in marketing and a detailed understanding of the Group’s corporate purpose to create long-term shareholder value through the discovery, acquisition, development and marketing of natural resources.     12 Directors        2 Directors        3 Directors        4 Directors        4 Directors        4 Directors   

Public policy

           
Experience in public and regulatory policy, including how it affects corporations.     14 Directors        4 Directors        3 Directors        5 Directors        4 Directors        4 Directors   

Renewal

The Board plans for its own succession, with the assistance of the Nomination and Governance Committee. In doing this, the Board:

 

  considers the skills, backgrounds, knowledge, experience and diversity of geographic location, nationality and gender necessary to allow it to meet the corporate purpose;

 

  assesses the skills, backgrounds, knowledge, experience and diversity currently represented;

 

  identifies any inadequate representation of those attributes and agrees the process necessary to ensure a candidate is selected who brings them to the Board;

 

  reviews how Board performance might be enhanced, both at an individual Director level and for the Board as a whole.

The Board believes that orderly succession and renewal is achieved as a result of careful planning, where the appropriate composition of the Board is continually under review.

When considering new appointments to the Board, the Nomination and Governance Committee oversees the preparation of a position specification that is provided to an independent recruitment organisation retained to conduct a global search. Independent search firms are instructed to consider a wide range of candidates, including taking into account geographic location, nationality and gender. In addition to the specific skills, knowledge and experience deemed necessary, the specification contains the criteria required by the Board Governance Document.

 

238


Table of Contents

The Board has adopted a letter of appointment that contains the terms on which Non-executive Directors will be appointed, including the basis upon which they will be indemnified. The letter of appointment clearly defines the role of Directors, including the expectations in terms of independence, participation, time commitment and continuous improvement. In summary, Directors are expected to constructively challenge; set the values and standards of the Group; monitor the performance of management and of the Group; satisfy themselves as to the adequacy and integrity of the Financial Statements; and satisfy themselves that the systems for the identification and management of risks are robust and appropriate. Directors are also expected to commit sufficient time to carry out their role and to participate in continuous improvement programs and internal reviews to support ongoing development. The letter of appointment also makes it clear that Directors are required to disclose circumstances that may affect, or be perceived to affect, their ability to exercise independent judgement so that the Board can assess independence on a regular basis.

 

A copy of the terms of appointment is available online at

www.bhpbilliton.com/home/aboutus/ourcompany/Pages/governance.aspx.

Diversity

The Board is committed to ensuring gender diversity is actively pursued and implemented in terms of current and future Board composition. Diversity is a core consideration in ensuring that the Board and its committees have the right balance of skills, experience, independence and Group knowledge necessary to discharge their responsibilities. The right blend of perspectives is critical to ensuring the Board oversees BHP Billiton effectively for shareholders.

In 2011, the Board outlined its aspirational goal of increasing the number of women on the Board to at least three, having appointed Carolyn Hewson and Baroness Shriti Vadera in 2010 and 2011, respectively. The Board remains committed to this goal, and continues to work towards it in a structured manner, looking out over a five-year period. We have used this structured approach now for several years and it provides a robust framework to consider what the Board requires over time, including diversity of gender, background, geography, skills, knowledge and experience.

For the past two years, two executive search firms, JCA Group and Heidrick & Struggles, have produced all-women short lists focused on the United Kingdom, Europe and the United States, which are continually refreshed. The two lists – combined with our skills and experience profile five-year matrix – ensure we maximise the number of female candidates we talk with and consider for appointment. Short-listed candidates are considered by the Nomination and Governance Committee, and during FY2014, the Chairman met regularly with potential female candidates who have a range of backgrounds.

While we are making good progress, our goal is unlikely to be achieved until the end of 2015. Our immediate business imperative in FY2014 has been to appoint an additional Director with skills and experience in the upstream oil and gas sector. The candidate search actively considered both potential female candidates and other diversity considerations, including background, experience and culture. Former Royal Dutch Shell Director, Malcolm Brinded, was appointed to the Board in 2014, bringing specific oil and gas sector experience. The Board also considers that it is important to continue to develop the potential of women at all levels of the Company, and part of the Board’s role is to consider and approve the Group’s measurable objectives, and oversee the Group’s progress towards these objectives. Further information, in relation to the initiatives in place to address diversity across the broader Group, and the impact they are having, is contained in section 1.13.

 

239


Table of Contents

Board skills, experience and diversity

 

LOGO

 

Note: Percentages in the diagram reflect the number of Directors represented in each category.

3.9    Director induction, training and development

The Board considers that the development of industry and Group knowledge is a continuous and ongoing process.

Upon appointment, each new Non-executive Director undertakes an induction program specifically tailored to their needs.

 

A copy of an indicative induction program is available online at

www.bhpbilliton.com/home/aboutus/ourcompany/Pages/governance.aspx.

BHP Billiton’s long-stated strategy is to own and operate large, long-life, low-cost, expandable, upstream assets diversified by commodity, geography and market. The Board’s development activity reflects this diversification through the provision of regular updates to Directors on each of the Group’s commodities, geographies and markets.

 

240


Table of Contents

Non-executive Directors also participate in continuous improvement programs, in accordance with their terms of appointment. Programs are designed to maximise the effectiveness of the Directors throughout their tenure and link in with their individual Director performance evaluations. The Training and Development Program covers a range of matters of a business nature, including environmental, social and governance matters.

Structured opportunities are provided to build knowledge through initiatives such as visits to BHP Billiton sites and briefings provided at Board meetings. Non-executive Directors also build their Group and industry knowledge through the involvement of the GMC and other senior Group employees in Board meetings.

Briefings, site visits and development sessions underpin and support the Board’s work in monitoring and overseeing progress towards the corporate purpose. We therefore continuously build Directors’ knowledge to ensure the Board remains up to date with developments within our Businesses, as well as developments in the markets in which we operate.

During the year, Non-executive Directors participated in the following activities:

 

  briefings intended to provide each Director with a deeper understanding of the activities, environment and key issues and direction of the Businesses. These briefings are provided to the Board by senior executives, including GMC members and other team members with operational and non-operational responsibilities. They are comprehensive briefings on the commodities, assets and markets in which we operate, including HSEC, and public policy considerations. The briefings provided during FY2014 covered petroleum (conventional and non-conventional), copper, coal and marketing. When these briefings were combined with a site visit, they took place on-site, otherwise they took place at Board meetings where the relevant executives joined Directors;

 

  development sessions on specific topics of relevance, such as climate change, commodity markets, world economy, changes in corporate governance standards, Directors’ duties and shareholder feedback. In relation to climate change the Board spent time, along with its committees, considering systemic climate change considerations relating to the resilience of, and opportunities for, the Group’s portfolio and receiving reports on scenarios and sign posts, which point to longer-term directional change and considering actions to manage the implications of climate change;

 

  visits to Khutala Colliery, BECSA, South Africa; Hillside and Bayside, aluminium smelters, South Africa; Worsley, alumina refinery, Australia; and Houston, Petroleum, including briefings on the assets and other relevant issues, and meetings with key personnel;

 

  addresses by external speakers, who are generally experts in their field.

These sessions and site visits provide not only an update on the main Businesses and assets, but also allow an opportunity to discuss, in detail, the changing risk environment and the potential for impacts on the achievement of our corporate purpose and business plans. More detail on the management of principal risks is set out in sections 1.7.3 and 3.15. Director involvement and continuous development through site visits, Business Risk and Audit Committee (Business RAC) meetings and on-site briefings are summarised in the following map.

Business RAC meetings take place twice yearly as part of our financial governance framework. Directors who are members of the Board’s Risk and Audit Committee chair the Business RAC meetings. Further information on Business RACs is at section 3.14.1.

 

241


Table of Contents

Director site visits, on-site briefings and Business RAC meetings 2012-2014

 

LOGO

The Nomination and Governance Committee oversees the Directors’ Training and Development Program, and, as part of the yearly review process, the Chairman discusses development areas with each Director. Board committees in turn review and agree their training needs. The benefit of this approach is that induction and learning opportunities can be tailored to Directors’ committee memberships, as well as the Board’s specific areas of focus. In addition, this approach ensures a coordinated process in relation to succession planning, Board renewal, training and development and committee composition, which are all relevant to the Nomination and Governance Committee’s role in securing the supply of talent to the Board.

In addition, each Board committee provides a standing invitation for any Non-executive Director to attend committee meetings (rather than just limiting attendance to committee members). Committee agendas are provided to all Directors to ensure that Directors are aware of matters to be considered by the committees, and can elect to attend meetings where appropriate.

3.10    Independence

The Board is committed to ensuring a majority of Directors are independent. The Board considers that all the current Non-executive Directors, including the Chairman, are independent.

Process to determine independence

The Board has a policy that it uses to determine the independence of its Directors. This determination is carried out upon appointment, annually and at any other time where the circumstances of a Director change such as to warrant reconsideration.

 

A copy of the policy on Independence of Directors is available online at

www.bhpbilliton.com/home/aboutus/ourcompany/Pages/governance.aspx.

 

242


Table of Contents

Under the policy, an ‘independent’ Director is one who is: ‘independent of management and any business or other relationship that could materially interfere with the exercise of objective, unfettered or independent judgement by the Director or the Director’s ability to act in the best interests of the BHP Billiton Group’.

Where a Director is considered by the Board to be independent, but is affected by circumstances that appear relevant to the Board’s assessment of independence, the Board has undertaken to explain the reasons why it reached its conclusion. In applying the independence test, the Board considers relationships with management, major shareholders, subsidiary and associated companies and other parties with whom the Group transacts business against predetermined materiality thresholds, all of which are set out in the policy. A summary of the factors that may be perceived to impact the independence of certain Directors is set out below.

Tenure

During the year under review, four Directors, David Crawford, John Schubert, Sir John Buchanan and Carlos Cordeiro, have each served on the Board for more than nine years. Dr Schubert, Sir John and Mr Cordeiro are standing for re-election at the 2014 AGMs, having each undergone a formal performance assessment. As noted above, Mr Crawford will retire from the BHP Billiton Board following the BHP Billiton Limited AGM in November 2014.

Dr Schubert was first elected to the Board of BHP Limited in 2000. The Board is of the view that Dr Schubert continues to make a valuable contribution through his role as Chairman of the Sustainability Committee, his roles on the Remuneration and Nomination and Governance Committees, as well as to the work of the Board more broadly. Dr Schubert’s extensive experience as an executive, particularly in the international oil industry, and subsequently as a public company director across multiple industries, adds significantly to the skills and expertise of the Board.

Sir John was first appointed to the Board (and as Senior Independent Director) in February 2003. The Board believes that he continues to act independently in the best interests of the Group. His expertise and broad international experience materially enhance the skills and experience profile of the Board and he continues to make a substantial contribution in his roles, as a member of the Board, Chairman of the Remuneration Committee, a member of the Nomination and Governance Committee and as Senior Independent Director.

Mr Cordeiro was first appointed to the Board in February 2005. The Board is of the view that Mr Cordeiro continues to make a valuable contribution through his role on the Remuneration Committee as well as to the work of the Board. The Board believes that he continues to act independently in the best interests of the Group.

The Board does not believe that Mr Crawford’s, Dr Schubert’s, Sir John’s or Mr Cordeiro’s tenure materially interferes with their ability to act in the best interests of the Group. The Board also believes that each of them has retained independence of character and judgement and has not formed associations with management (or others) that might compromise their ability to exercise independent judgement or act in the best interests of the Group.

Retirement plan

As former Directors of BHP Limited, prior to the merger with Billiton Plc, which formed the Group in 2001, Mr Crawford and Dr Schubert participated in a retirement plan approved by shareholders in 1989. The plan was closed on 24 October 2003. Benefits accrued to that date, together with interest earned on the benefits, have been preserved and will be paid on retirement. The Board does not believe that the independence of any participating Director is compromised as a result of this plan.

Relationships and associations

Lindsay Maxsted was the CEO of KPMG in Australia from 2001 until 2007. The Board considers that this prior relationship with KPMG does not materially interfere with Mr Maxsted’s exercise of objective, unfettered or

 

243


Table of Contents

independent judgement, or his ability to act in the best interests of the BHP Billiton Group. The Board has determined, consistent with its policy on the independence of Directors, that Mr Maxsted is independent. The Board notes in particular that:

 

  at the time of his appointment to the Board, more than three years had elapsed since Mr Maxsted’s retirement from KPMG. The Director independence rules and guidelines that apply to the Group – which are a combination of Australian, UK and US rules and guidelines – all use three years as the benchmark ‘cooling off’ period for former audit firm partners;

 

  Mr Maxsted has no financial (e.g. pension, retainer or advisory fee) or consulting arrangements with KPMG;

 

  Mr Maxsted was not part of the KPMG audit practice after 1980 and, while at KPMG, was not in any way involved in, or able to influence, any audit activity associated with BHP Billiton.

The Board considers Mr Maxsted’s financial acumen and extensive experience in the corporate restructuring field to be important in the discharge of the Board’s responsibilities. His membership of the Board and Chairmanship of the RAC are considered by the Board to be appropriate and desirable.

Mr Crawford was a partner of KPMG in Australia until his retirement in June 2001. He has had no commercial relationship with KPMG since that time and the Board does not consider Mr Crawford’s independence to be compromised as a result of this association that ended more than 13 years ago.

Some of the Directors hold or previously held positions in companies with which we have commercial relationships. Those positions and companies are set out in the Director profiles in section 3.2.1. The Board has assessed all of the relationships between the Group and companies in which Directors hold or held positions and has concluded that in all cases the relationships do not interfere with the Directors’ exercise of objective, unfettered or independent judgement or their ability to act in the best interests of the Group.

A specific instance is Malcolm Broomhead, who, until 29 July 2013, was a Non-executive Director of Coates Group Holdings Pty Limited, a company with which BHP Billiton has commercial dealings. Coates Group provides equipment hire to the mining and resources industry, among others. Prior to and since the appointment of Mr Broomhead as a Director of BHP Billiton, the Board has assessed the relationship between BHP Billiton and Coates Group and remained satisfied that Mr Broomhead was able to apply objective, unfettered and independent judgement and act in the best interests of BHP Billiton. In addition, no commercial dealings with Coates Group were discussed at Board or Board committee level.

A second instance is Mr Crawford, who is an Advisory Board member for the commercial law firm Allens, which advises BHP Billiton on specific matters from time to time, but is not one of BHP Billiton’s relationship law firms. Mr Crawford’s role is as a member of the Advisory Board, a wholly advisory body that does not have decision-making authority for Allens. The Board has assessed the relationship and remains satisfied that Mr Crawford is independent in mind and judgement and is able to apply objective, unfettered and independent judgement and act in the best interests of BHP Billiton. In addition, the allocation of business to Allens was not discussed at Board or Board committee level, and to the extent it is in the future, Mr Crawford will absent himself fully from those deliberations.

A third instance is Malcolm Brinded who is a former executive Director of Royal Dutch Shell Plc, which is a material customer of the BHP Billiton Group. Mr Brinded stepped down from the Board of Shell on 1 April 2012 and left Shell group employment on 30 April 2012. Prior to and since the appointment of Mr Brinded as a Director of BHP Billiton, the Board has assessed the relationship between BHP Billiton and Shell group and remains satisfied that Mr Brinded is able to apply objective, unfettered and independent judgement and act in the best interests of BHP Billiton.

 

244


Table of Contents

Transactions during the year that amounted to related-party transactions with Directors or Director-related entities under International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS) are outlined in note 31 to the Financial Statements.

Executive Director

The Executive Director, Andrew Mackenzie, is not considered independent because of his executive responsibilities. Mr Mackenzie does not hold directorships in any other company included in the ASX 100 or FTSE 100.

Conflicts of interest

The UK Companies Act requires that BHP Billiton Directors avoid a situation where they have, or can have, an unauthorised direct or indirect interest that conflicts, or possibly may conflict, with the Company’s interests, unless approved by non-interested Directors. In accordance with the UK Companies Act, BHP Billiton Plc’s Articles of Association allow the Directors to authorise conflicts and potential conflicts where appropriate. A procedure operates to ensure the disclosure of conflicts and for the consideration and, if appropriate, the authorisation of them by non-conflicted Directors. The Nomination and Governance Committee supports the Board in this process, both by reviewing requests from Directors for authorisation of situations of actual or potential conflict and making recommendations to the Board, and by regularly reviewing any situations of actual or potential conflict that have previously been authorised by the Board, and making recommendations regarding whether the authorisation remains appropriate. In addition, in accordance with Australian law, if a situation arises for consideration in which a Director has a material personal interest, the affected Director takes no part in decision-making.

3.11    Board evaluation

The Board is committed to transparency in determining Board membership and in assessing the performance of Directors. The Board evaluates its performance through a combination of both internal peer and externally facilitated assessments. Contemporary performance measures are considered an important part of this process. Directors’ performance is also measured against their individual development plans.

The Board conducts regular evaluations of its performance, the performance of its committees, the Chairman, individual Directors and the governance processes that support the Board’s work. The Board evaluation process comprises both assessment and review, as summarised in the diagram below. This includes analysis of how the Board and its Directors are functioning, the time spent by the Board considering matters and whether the terms of reference of the Board committees have been met, as well as compliance with the Board Governance Document.

In addition, the evaluation considers the balance of skills, experience, independence and knowledge of the Company and the Board, its overall diversity, including gender, and how the Board works together as a unit.

The assessment of the Board’s performance is conducted by focusing on individual Directors and Board committees in one year and the Board as a whole in the following year. Our approach has been to conduct an externally facilitated review of the Board of Directors and committees at least every two years. As described in last year’s Annual Report, the FY2013 Board assessment was internally rather than externally facilitated. This was to provide an opportunity for the new management structure to become sufficiently established for a meaningful review, while also adhering to our commitment of continuous improvement. We therefore conducted an external assessment of the Board during FY2014, as set out in more detail below.

In addition, each year the Board, with the assistance of the Nomination and Governance Committee, conducts a review of the performance of each Director seeking re-election and uses the results of that review when

 

245


Table of Contents

considering whether to recommend the re-election of each Director. As the Board has adopted a policy of annual election, this effectively means that all Directors are subject to a performance review annually should they wish to remain on the Board.

 

LOGO

Directors provide anonymous feedback on their peers’ performance and individual contributions to the Board, which is passed on to the relevant Director via the Chairman. In respect of the Chairman’s performance, Directors provide feedback directly to either Dr Schubert or Sir John as Senior Independent Director. External independent advisers are engaged to assist these processes, as necessary. The involvement of an independent third party has assisted in the evaluation processes being rigorous, fair and ensuring continuous improvement in the operation of the Board and committees, as well as the contributions of individual Directors.

Director evaluation

The evaluation of individual Directors focuses on the contribution of the Director to the work of the Board and the expectations of Directors as specified in the Group’s governance framework. The performance of individual Directors is assessed against a range of criteria, including the ability of the Director to:

 

  consistently take the perspective of creating shareholder value;

 

  contribute to the development of strategy;

 

  understand the major risks affecting the Group;

 

  provide clear direction to management;

 

  contribute to Board cohesion;

 

  commit the time required to fulfil the role and perform their responsibilities effectively;

 

  listen to and respect the ideas of fellow Directors and members of management.

Board effectiveness

The effectiveness of the Board as a whole and of its committees is assessed against the accountabilities set down in the Board Governance Document and each committee’s terms of reference. Matters considered in evaluations include:

 

  the effectiveness of discussion and debate at Board and committee meetings;

 

  the effectiveness of the Board’s and committees’ processes and relationship with management;

 

  the quality and timeliness of meeting agendas, Board and committee papers and secretariat support;

 

  the composition of the Board and each committee, focusing on the blend of skills, experience, independence and knowledge of the Group and its diversity, including geographic location, nationality and gender.

 

246


Table of Contents

The process is managed by the Chairman, but feedback on the Chairman’s performance is provided to him by Dr Schubert.

Information about the performance review process for executives is set out in section 3.16.

Evaluations conducted in FY2014

During the year under review, the Board conducted an externally facilitated Board assessment, an internal assessment of each Director and an internal committee review to ensure continued compliance with the recently updated committee terms of reference.

Board assessment

The external assessment focused in particular on the Board’s interface with the CEO and senior management; the Board’s priorities; and the focus of the Board committees and their interface with the Board. It also sought the views of the Directors for suggestions for improving the Board’s overall effectiveness. The review was facilitated by JCA Group, and involved an interview with each Director. The findings were discussed in depth by the Board. A range of improvements to the Board’s work and effectiveness will be incorporated into the work of the Board and procedures, including: streamlining of the Board meeting processes and procedures, the introduction of regular Asset President meetings to allow Board members to engage with operating executives on a broad range of issues, and formalisation of the focused Board strategy day. This annual event is built around scenarios and sign posts for future developments and provides an opportunity for the Board to undertake a deeper dive into a range of strategic and long-term plans.

Director assessment

Due to the previous year’s externally facilitated Board assessment, the FY2014 Director assessment was internally facilitated. The overall findings were presented to the Board and discussed. Each Director was provided feedback on their contribution to the Board and its committees. This review supported the Board’s decision to endorse all retiring Directors standing for re-election.

Committee review

During FY2014, an internal review was conducted to confirm continued compliance with each committee’s respective terms of reference, which were updated in FY2013.

During the previous year, we conducted external assessments of the committees, which utilised an electronic survey tool provided by Lintstock, and were focused to draw out views on work, overall effectiveness, decision-making and other processes. Outcomes and recommendations from each committee were considered and approved by the Board prior to implementation.

Enhancements following previous evaluations

Board and committee evaluations conducted in recent years have led to a number of enhancements to Board meeting processes:

 

  Board assessment: Following the internal assessment of the Board in FY2013, a number of changes were introduced to enhance the Board’s work and effectiveness. These included introducing formal strategy days to the Board program to support the discussions of strategy that currently take place between management and the Board at each meeting; implementing an updated plan for Board engagement on strategy, execution and monitoring; effective methods for engaging in the increasing number of Board matters considered out of session; increased use of the committee report-out process, which is used for committee chairmen to summarise the key discussions; new items for the training and development of Directors; and updating the format of materials provided to the Board.

 

247


Table of Contents
  Chairman’s matters: For some time, the Board has held a closed session at the end of Board meetings. An additional closed session has been incorporated so that all Board meetings start with a closed session of all Directors (there are no members of the GMC present other than the Executive Director and the President Governance and Group Company Secretary). This allows the Chairman to outline matters to be considered by the Board and set the context for the meeting. It is also an opportunity for Directors to raise the items of business they believe warrant particular attention or any other relevant issues.

3.12    Board meetings and attendance

The Board meets as often as necessary to fulfil its role. Directors are required to allocate sufficient time to the Group to perform their responsibilities effectively, including adequate time to prepare for Board meetings. During the reporting year, the Board met eight times, with five of those meetings being held in Australia, two in the United Kingdom and one in the United States. Regularly scheduled Board meetings run over three days (including committee meetings and Director training and development sessions).

Members of the GMC and other members of senior management attended meetings of the Board by invitation. Senior managers delivered presentations on the status and performance of our Businesses and matters reserved for the Board, including the approval of budgets, annual Financial Statements and strategy.

Attendance at Board and Board committee meetings during the year ended 30 June 2014 is set out in the table below.

 

     Board      Risk
and Audit
     Nomination and
Governance
     Remuneration      Sustainability      Finance  
     A      B        A          B        A      B      A      B      A      B      A      B  

Malcolm Brinded

     2         2                                                         2         2                   

Malcolm Broomhead

     8         8                                                         7         7         10         10   

John Buchanan

     8         8                         6         6         7         7                                   

Carlos Cordeiro

     8         8                                         7         7                                   

David Crawford

     8         8                                                                         10         10   

Pat Davies

     8         8                                         7         7                                   

Carolyn Hewson

     8         8         9         9                         3         3                                   

Andrew Mackenzie

     8         8                                                                                   

Lindsay Maxsted

     8         8         9         9                                                         10         10   

Wayne Murdy

     8         8         9         9                                                         10         10   

Jac Nasser

     8         8                         6         6                                                   

Keith Rumble

     8         8                                                         7         7                   

John Schubert

     8         8                         6         6         7         7         7         7                   

Shriti Vadera

     8         8         9         9                                                                   

 

Column A – indicates the number of scheduled and ad-hoc meetings held during the period the Director was a member of the Board and/or committee.

Column B – indicates the number of scheduled and ad-hoc meetings attended during the period the Director was a member of the Board and/or committee.

3.13    Director re-election

The Board has adopted a policy consistent with the UK Corporate Governance Code, under which all Directors must seek re-election by shareholders annually, if they wish to remain on the Board. This policy took effect at the 2011 AGMs. The Board believes that annual re-election promotes and supports accountability to shareholders, and the combined voting outcome of the BHP Billiton Plc and BHP Billiton Limited 2013 AGMs meant that each Director received more than 97.5 per cent in support of their re-election.

 

248


Table of Contents

Board support for reappointment is not automatic. Directors who are seeking re-election are subject to a performance appraisal overseen by the Nomination and Governance Committee of the Board. Annual re-election effectively means all Directors are subject to a performance appraisal annually. The Board, on the recommendation of the Nomination and Governance Committee, makes a determination as to whether it will endorse a retiring Director for re-election. The Board will not endorse a Director for re-election if his or her performance is not considered satisfactory. The Board will advise shareholders in the Notice of Meeting whether or not re-election is supported.

BHP Billiton does not apply or implement a ‘no vacancy’ rule in relation to Board appointments. Accordingly, Director candidates can be elected to the Board by ordinary resolution and are not required to out-poll an incumbent Director in order to be elected.

3.14    Board committees

The Board has established committees to assist it in exercising its authority, including monitoring the performance of the Group to gain assurance that progress is being made towards the corporate purpose within the limits imposed by the Board.

Each of the permanent committees has terms of reference under which authority is delegated by the Board.

The office of the Company Secretary provides secretariat services for each of the committees. Committee meeting agendas, papers and minutes are made available to all members of the Board. Subject to appropriate controls and the overriding scrutiny of the Board, committee chairmen are free to use whatever resources they consider necessary to discharge their responsibilities.

Reports from each of the committees follow.

 

The terms of reference for each committee are available online at www.bhpbilliton.com/home/aboutus/ourcompany/Pages/governance.aspx.

3.14.1    Risk and Audit Committee Report

Role and focus

The role of the Risk and Audit Committee (RAC) is to assist the Board in monitoring the decisions and actions of the CEO and the Group and to gain assurance that progress is being made towards the corporate purpose within the limits imposed by the Board, as set out in the Board Governance Document. The RAC discharges its responsibilities by overseeing:

 

  the integrity of the Group’s Financial Statements;

 

  the appointment, remuneration, qualifications, independence and performance of the External Auditor and the integrity of the audit process as a whole;

 

  the plans, performance, objectivity and leadership of the internal audit function and the integrity of the internal audit process as a whole;

 

  the effectiveness of the systems of internal controls and risk management;

 

  the Group’s systems for compliance with applicable legal and regulatory requirements within the RAC’s area of responsibility;

 

  the CEO’s compliance with the relevant CEO limits.

The role of the RAC in the context of the Board’s broader governance framework is summarised in the diagram below. Further information about our approach to risk can be found in sections 1.7 and 3.15 of this Annual Report.

 

249


Table of Contents

BHP Billiton governance structure – Risk and Audit Committee

 

LOGO

The RAC met nine times during the year. Information on meeting attendance by Committee members is included in the table in section 3.12 and information on their qualifications is included in section 3.2.1.

In addition to the regular business of the year, the Committee discussed the proposals for change in the regulatory environment across the jurisdictions in which our securities are listed. These included revisions to the 2012 UK Corporate Governance Code relating to annual reports being fair, balanced and understandable, and the proposals in respect of audit from the European Union and the UK Competition and Markets Authority. Statements relating to tendering of the external audit contract, significant matters relating to the Financial Statements, and the process for evaluating the external audit are set out below.

The RAC continues to monitor regulatory developments in relation to the audit regime and the role of risk and audit committees, and will continue to review and assess how these will impact the Group in the future. In addition, the RAC considered and discussed updates in relation to the ongoing anti-corruption investigation outlined in section 3.17.

Business Risk and Audit committees

To assist management in providing the information necessary to allow the RAC to discharge its responsibilities, Business Risk and Audit committees have been established, incorporating each Business, and for key functional areas such as Marketing and Treasury. These committees, known as Business RACs, operate as committees of management, but are chaired by members of the RAC. The responsible member of the GMC participates in those meetings. Business RACs perform an important monitoring function in the overall governance of the Group.

Significant financial and risk matters raised at Business RAC meetings are reported to the RAC by the Head of Group Reporting and the Head of Group Risk Assessment and Assurance.

Risk and Audit Committee members during the year

 

Name

  

Status

Lindsay Maxsted (Chairman) (a)

   Member for whole period

Carolyn Hewson

   Member for whole period

Wayne Murdy

   Member for whole period

Shriti Vadera

   Member for whole period

 

(a) Mr Maxsted is the Committee’s financial expert nominated by the Board.

 

250


Table of Contents

Activities undertaken during the year

Fair, balanced and understandable

One of the major items of discussion by the RAC during the year were the revisions to the UK Corporate Governance Code, which requires the Directors to confirm that they consider the Annual Report, taken as a whole, is fair, balanced and understandable, and provides the information necessary for shareholders to assess the Group’s performance, business model and strategy.

The Group has a substantial assurance framework for the Annual Report already in place. This includes management representation letters, CEO and CFO certifications, RAC oversight of the Financial Statements and a range of other financial governance procedures focused on the financial section of the Annual Report, together with detailed verification and internal audit procedures for the narrative reporting section of the Report.

The Board requested the RAC provide advice on whether the Annual Report meets the fair, balanced and understandable requirement and, as a result, the RAC terms of reference were updated to reflect this role. The RAC considered it appropriate to use the UK Corporate Governance Code revisions to enhance the existing project plans that support the preparation of the Annual Report suite, in order to provide the Board with appropriate assurance.

As part of the enhanced assurance process, the following is required:

 

  ensuring all individuals involved in the preparation of any part of the Annual Report are briefed on the fair, balanced and understandable requirement, through training sessions for each content manager that detail the key attributes of ‘fair, balanced and understandable’;

 

  formalising the process whereby employees who have been closely involved in the preparation of the Financial Statements review the entire narrative for the fair, balanced and understandable requirement, and sign off an appropriate sub-certification;

 

  having the key members of the team preparing the Annual Report confirm they have taken the fair, balanced and understandable requirement into account and that they have raised, with the Annual Report project team, any concerns they have in relation to meeting this requirement;

 

  amending the Annual Report suite sub-certification to incorporate the requirement;

 

  in relation to the new requirement for the auditor to review parts of the narrative report for consistency with the audited Financial Statements, asking the auditor to raise any issues of inconsistency at an early stage.

As a result of the existing and enhanced process, the RAC, and then the Board, were able to confirm their view that BHP Billiton’s 2014 Annual Report taken as a whole is fair, balanced and understandable. The Board’s statement on the report is on page 209.

Integrity of Financial Statements

In addition to the enhanced process above, the RAC continues to assist the Board in assuring the integrity of the Financial Statements. The RAC evaluates and makes recommendations to the Board about the appropriateness of accounting policies and practices, areas of judgement, compliance with Accounting Standards, stock exchange and legal requirements and the results of the external audit. It reviews the half-yearly and annual Financial Statements and makes recommendations on specific actions or decisions (including formal adoption of the Financial Statements and reports) the Board should consider in order to maintain the integrity of the Financial Statements. From time to time, the Board may delegate authority to the RAC to approve the release of the statements to the stock exchanges, shareholders and the financial community.

The CEO and CFO have certified that the 2014 Financial Statements present a true and fair view, in all material respects, of our financial condition and operating results and are in accordance with applicable regulatory requirements.

 

251


Table of Contents

Significant matters

Another of the new UK Corporate Governance Code provisions that applies to the Group is the requirement to report the significant issues that the RAC considered in relation to the Financial Statements, and how these issues were addressed. During FY2014, the Committee considered the following significant issues:

New accounting standards

The Committee considered and approved accounting policy changes resulting from the application of:

 

  IFRS 10 ‘Consolidated Financial Statements’;

 

  IFRS 11 ‘Joint Arrangements’;

 

  Amendments to IAS 28 ‘Investments in Associates and Joint Ventures’;

 

  IFRIC 20 ‘Stripping Costs in the Production Phase of a Surface Mine’.

Significant consideration was given to the appropriate application of these new and amended standards and interpretations to BHP Billiton. The Committee reviewed management’s analysis and concurred with its recommendations, which resulted in significant changes to the basis of accounting for Escondida, Samarco and Antamina.

Impairment

The Committee reviewed the results of impairment assessments for Nickel West and Worsley assets in Western Australia and concluded that no further impairment charges or reversals were appropriate. In all cases, specific consideration was given to the most recent foreign exchange and price curves. In the case of Nickel West, specific consideration was given to the following:

 

  the impact of the closure of the Leinster Perseverance Underground Mine;

 

  anticipated cost savings;

 

  additional production volumes available from adjacent developments.

Income tax liabilities

The Committee reviewed the measurement and disclosure of contingent liabilities arising from various income tax matters including the following:

 

  transfer pricing issues;

 

  status of income tax audits;

 

  matters not yet subject to specific consideration by taxation authorities but where uncertainty exists in the law.

Divestments

The Committee reviewed the accounting treatment for the sale of Pinto Valley, United States, and concluded that the gain on sale of US$385 million (after tax) required disclosure as an exceptional item. The Committee also reviewed the sale of the BHP Navajo Coal Company and, while binding agreements for the sale have been entered into, determined that the disposal date for accounting purposes will be achieved only when the risks and rewards ultimately transfer to the acquirer.

Closure and rehabilitation provisions

The Committee reviewed the various changes in estimates for closure and rehabilitation provisions recognised during the year. Consideration was given to the results of the most recently completed surveying data, current cost estimates and appropriate inclusion of contingency in cost estimates to allow for both known and residual risks.

 

252


Table of Contents

External Auditor

The RAC manages the relationship with the External Auditor on behalf of the Board. It considers the reappointment of the External Auditor each year, as well as remuneration and other terms of engagement, and makes a recommendation to the Board. There are no contractual obligations that restrict the RAC’s capacity to recommend a particular firm for appointment as auditor.

The last audit tender was in 2002, at which time the Group had three external auditors following the completion of the DLC merger. The tender resulted in KPMG and PricewaterhouseCoopers being appointed as joint auditors for FY2003 and a reduction in audit providers. A competitive audit review was undertaken in 2003, which resulted in KPMG being appointed as the External Auditor by the Board on the recommendation of the RAC.

The lead audit engagement partners in both Australia and the United Kingdom have been rotated every five years. The current Australian audit engagement partner was appointed for the FY2010 year-end, and therefore FY2014 was his last year. There has therefore been a transition period to the new engagement partner who took formal responsibility at the start of FY2015. A new UK audit engagement partner was appointed for the FY2013 year-end, and therefore FY2017 is scheduled to be his last year.

During FY2014, the Committee continued to monitor and discuss the UK and EU developments in regard to audit firm tender and rotation. The Committee is satisfied with the External Auditor’s performance and independence and therefore does not believe a tender in the near term is appropriate. Consistent with the guidance on transitional arrangements published by the UK Financial Reporting Council, the Committee’s current intention is to conduct an audit firm tender for either FY2018 or FY2019.

Evaluation of External Auditor and external audit process

The RAC evaluates the performance of the External Auditor during its term of appointment against specified criteria, including delivering value to shareholders and the Group, and also assesses the effectiveness of the external audit process. It does so through a range of means, including:

 

  the Committee considers the External Audit Plan, in particular to gain assurance that it is tailored to reflect changes in circumstances from the prior year;

 

  throughout the year, the Committee meets with the audit partners, particularly the lead Australian and UK audit engagement partners, without management present;

 

  following the completion of the audit, the Committee considers the quality of the External Auditor’s performance drawing on survey results. The survey is based on a two-way feedback model where the BHP Billiton and KPMG teams assess each other against a range of criteria. The criteria against which the BHP Billiton team evaluates KPMG’s performance include ethics and integrity, insight, service quality, communication and reporting, and responsiveness;

 

  reviewing the terms of engagement of the External Auditor;

 

  discussing with the audit engagement partners the skills and experience of the broader audit team;

 

  reviewing audit quality inspection reports on KPMG published by the UK Financial Reporting Council;

 

  overseeing (and approving where relevant) non-audit services as described below.

The RAC also reviews the integrity, independence and objectivity of the External Auditor. This review includes:

 

  confirming that the External Auditor is, in its judgement, independent of the Group;

 

  obtaining from the External Auditor an account of all relationships between the External Auditor and the Group;

 

253


Table of Contents
  monitoring the number of former employees of the External Auditor currently employed in senior positions within the Group and assessing whether those appointments impair, or appear to impair, the External Auditor’s judgement or independence;

 

  considering whether the various relationships between the Group and the External Auditor collectively impair, or appear to impair, the External Auditor’s judgement or independence;

 

  determining whether the compensation of individuals employed by the External Auditor who conduct the audit is tied to the provision of non-audit services and, if so, whether this impairs, or appears to impair, the External Auditor’s judgement or independence;

 

  reviewing the economic importance of the Group to the External Auditor and assessing whether that importance impairs, or appears to impair, the External Auditor’s judgement or independence.

The External Auditor also certifies its independence to the RAC.

Non-audit services

Although the External Auditor does provide some non-audit services, the objectivity and independence of the External Auditor is safeguarded through restrictions on the provision of these services. For example, certain types of non-audit services may only be undertaken by the External Auditor with the prior approval of the RAC (as described below), while other services may not be undertaken at all, including services where the External Auditor:

 

  may be required to audit its own work;

 

  participates in activities that would normally be undertaken by management;

 

  is remunerated through a ‘success fee’ structure;

 

  acts in an advocacy role for the Group.

The RAC has adopted a policy entitled ‘Provision of Audit and Other Services by the External Auditor’, covering the RAC’s pre-approval policies and procedures to maintain the independence of the External Auditor.

 

Our policy on Provision of Audit and Other Services by the External Auditor is available online at www.bhpbilliton.com/home/aboutus/ourcompany/Pages/governance.aspx.

In addition to audit services, the External Auditor will be permitted to provide other (non-audit) services that are not, and are not perceived to be, in conflict with the role of the External Auditor. In accordance with the requirements of the US Securities Exchange Act and guidance contained in Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (PCAOB) Release 2004-001, certain specific activities are listed in our detailed policy that have been ‘pre-approved’ by the RAC.

The categories of ‘pre-approved’ services are as follows:

 

  Audit services – work that constitutes the agreed scope of the statutory audit and includes the statutory audits of the Group and its entities (including interim reviews). The RAC will monitor the audit services engagements and approve, if necessary, any changes in terms and conditions resulting from changes in audit scope, Group structure or other relevant events.

 

  Audit-related/assurance services – work that is outside the required scope of the statutory audit, but is consistent with the role of the external statutory auditor. This category includes work that is reasonably related to the performance of an audit or review and is a logical extension of the audit or review scope, is of an assurance or compliance nature and is work that the External Auditor must or is best placed to undertake.

 

  Tax services – work of a tax nature that does not compromise the independence of the External Auditor.

 

  Other advisory services – work of an advisory nature that does not compromise the independence of the External Auditor.

 

254


Table of Contents

Activities not listed specifically are therefore not ‘pre-approved’ and must be approved by the RAC prior to engagement, regardless of the dollar value involved. Additionally, any engagement for other services with a value over US$100,000, even if listed as a ‘pre-approved’ service, can only be approved by the RAC, and all engagements for other services, whether ‘pre-approved’ or not, and regardless of the dollar value involved, are reported quarterly to the RAC.

While not specifically prohibited by our policy, any proposed non-audit engagement of the External Auditor relating to internal control (such as a review of internal controls or assistance with implementing the regulatory requirements, including those of the US Securities Exchange Act) must obtain specific prior approval from the RAC. With the exception of the external audit of the Group Financial Statements, any engagement identified that contains an internal control-related element is not considered to be pre-approved. In addition, while the categories shown above include a list of certain pre-approved services, the use of the External Auditor to perform such services shall always be subject to our overriding governance practices as articulated in the policy.

An exception can be made to the above policy where such an exception is in our interests and appropriate arrangements are put in place to ensure the integrity and independence of the External Auditor. Any such exception requires the specific prior approval of the RAC and must be reported to the Board. No exceptions were approved during the year ended 30 June 2014.

In addition, the RAC approved no services during the year ended 30 June 2014 pursuant to paragraph (c)(7)(i)(C) of Rule 2-01 of the SEC Regulation S-X.

Fees paid to the Group’s External Auditor during the year for audit and other services were US$28.2 million, of which 61 per cent comprised audit fees, 34 per cent related to legislative requirements (including Sarbanes-Oxley) and five per cent was for other services. Details of the fees paid are set out in note 35 ‘Auditor’s remuneration’ to the Financial Statements.

Based on the review by the RAC, the Board is satisfied that the External Auditor is independent.

Change in registrant’s certifying accountant

The former auditor of BHP Billiton Plc for the 2013 and 2012 financial years, KPMG Audit Plc, has instigated an orderly wind down of business; accordingly KPMG Audit Plc did not stand for re-election at our annual general meeting on 24 October 2013. A resolution was approved at the annual general meeting for the appointment of KPMG LLP as auditor of BHP Billiton Plc. The decision to change auditor was recommended to the Board of Directors by the Risk and Audit Committee.

During the years ended 30 June 2013 and 30 June 2012, (1) KPMG Audit Plc has not issued any reports on the financial statements of the Group or on the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting that contained an adverse opinion or a disclaimer of opinion, nor were the auditors’ reports of KPMG Audit Plc qualified or modified as to uncertainty, audit scope, or accounting principles, (2) there has not been any disagreement over any matter of accounting principles or practices, financial statement disclosure, or auditing scope or procedures, which disagreement if not resolved to KPMG Audit Plc’s satisfaction would have caused it to make reference to the subject matter of the disagreement in connection with its auditors’ reports, or any “reportable event” as described in Item 16F(a)(1)(v) of Form 20-F.

The Group has provided KPMG Audit Plc with a copy of the foregoing disclosure and has requested that KPMG Audit Plc furnish the Group with a letter addressed to the Securities and Exchange Commission (the “SEC”) stating whether KPMG Audit Plc agrees with such disclosure and, if not, stating the respects in which it does not agree. A copy of KPMG Audit Plc’s letter, dated 25 September 2014, in which KPMG Audit Plc stated that it agrees with such disclosure, is filed herewith as Exhibit 15.1.

There were no changes to the auditor of BHP Billiton Limited during FY2014.

 

255


Table of Contents

Internal Audit

The Internal Audit function is carried out internally by Group Risk Assessment and Assurance (RAA). The role of RAA is to determine whether risk management, control and governance processes are adequate and functioning. The Internal Audit function is independent of the External Auditor. The RAC reviews the mission and charter of RAA, the staffing levels and its scope of work to ensure that it is appropriate in light of the key risks we face. It also reviews and approves the annual internal audit plan and monitors and reviews the overall effectiveness of the internal audit activities.

The RAC also approves the appointment and dismissal of the Head of Group Risk Assessment and Assurance and assesses his or her performance, independence and objectivity. The role of the Head of Group Risk Assessment and Assurance includes achievement of the internal audit objectives, risk management policies and insurance strategy. The position was held throughout the year by Alistair Mytton. Mr Mytton reported to senior management and had all necessary access to management and the RAC.

Effectiveness of systems of internal control and risk management

In delegating authority to the CEO, the Board has established CEO limits set out in the Board Governance Document. Limits on the CEO’s authority require the CEO to ensure that there is a system of control in place for identifying and managing risk in the Group. The Directors, through the RAC, review the systems that have been established for this purpose and regularly review their effectiveness. These reviews include assessing whether processes continue to meet evolving external governance requirements.

The RAC is responsible for the oversight of risk management and reviews the internal controls and risk management systems. In undertaking this role, the RAC reviews the following:

 

  procedures for identifying business and operational risks and controlling their financial impact on the Group and the operational effectiveness of the policies and procedures related to risk and control;

 

  budgeting and forecasting systems, financial reporting systems and controls;

 

  policies and practices put in place by the CEO for detecting, reporting and preventing fraud and serious breaches of business conduct and whistle-blowing procedures;

 

  procedures for ensuring compliance with relevant regulatory and legal requirements;

 

  arrangements for protecting intellectual property and other non-physical assets;

 

  operational effectiveness of the Business RAC structures;

 

  overseeing the adequacy of the internal controls and allocation of responsibilities for monitoring internal financial controls.

For further discussion on our approach to risk management, refer to sections 1.7 and 3.15 of this Annual Report.

During the year, the Board conducted reviews of the effectiveness of the Group’s systems of risk management and internal controls for the financial year and up to the date of this Annual Report in accordance with the UK Corporate Governance Code (including the Turnbull Guidance) and the Principles and Recommendations published by the Australian Securities Exchange (ASX) Corporate Governance Council. These reviews covered financial, operational and compliance controls and risk assessment. During the year, management presented an assessment of the material business risks facing the Group and the level of effectiveness of risk management over the material business risks. The reviews were overseen by the RAC, with findings and recommendations reported to the Board. In addition to considering key risks facing the Group, the Board received an assessment of the effectiveness of internal controls over key risks identified through the work of the Board committees. The Board is satisfied that the effectiveness of the internal controls has been properly reviewed.

 

256


Table of Contents

Management’s assessment of our internal control over financial reporting

Our management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Rule 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f) under the US Securities Exchange Act of 1934). Under the supervision and with the participation of our management, including our CEO and CFO, the effectiveness of the Group’s internal control over financial reporting has been evaluated based on the framework and criteria established in Internal Controls – Integrated Framework, issued by the Sponsoring Organization of the Treadway Commission (COSO). Based on this evaluation, management has concluded that internal control over financial reporting was effective as at 30 June 2014. There were no material weaknesses in the Group’s internal controls over financial reporting identified by management.

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements and, even when determined to be effective, can only provide reasonable assurance with respect to financial statement preparation and presentation. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

BHP Billiton has engaged our independent registered public accounting firms, KPMG and KPMG LLP, to issue an audit report on our internal control over financial reporting for inclusion in the Financial Statements section of this Annual Report on Form 20-F as filed with the SEC.

There have been no changes in our internal control over financial reporting during FY2014 that have materially affected, or are reasonably likely to materially affect, our internal control over financial reporting.

The CEO and CFO have certified to the Board that the Financial Statements are founded on a sound system of risk management and internal control and that the system is operating efficiently and effectively in all material respects.

During the year, the RAC reviewed our compliance with the obligations imposed by the US Sarbanes-Oxley Act, including evaluating and documenting internal controls as required by section 404 of the Act.

Management’s assessment of our disclosure controls and procedures

Our management, with the participation of our CEO and CFO, has performed an evaluation of the effectiveness of the design and operation of our disclosure controls and procedures as of 30 June 2014. Disclosure controls and procedures are designed to provide reasonable assurance that the material financial and non-financial information required to be disclosed by BHP Billiton, including in the reports that it files or submits under the US Securities Exchange Act of 1934, is recorded, processed, summarised and reported on a timely basis and that such information is accumulated and communicated to BHP Billiton’s management, including our CEO and CFO, as appropriate, to allow timely decisions regarding required disclosure. Based on the foregoing, our management, including the CEO and CFO, has concluded that our disclosure controls and procedures are effective in providing that reasonable assurance.

There are inherent limitations to the effectiveness of any system of disclosure controls and procedures, including the possibility of human error and the circumvention or overriding of the controls and procedures. Accordingly, even effective disclosure controls and procedures can only provide reasonable assurance of achieving their control objectives.

Further, in the design and evaluation of our disclosure controls and procedures, our management was necessarily required to apply its judgement in evaluating the cost-benefit relationship of possible controls and procedures.

 

257


Table of Contents

Committee review

An internally facilitated review was conducted during the year to confirm continued compliance with the RAC’s terms of reference. The terms of reference were updated during FY2013, and further updated during FY2014 to reflect the Committee’s role of providing advice to the Board on whether the Annual Report, taken as a whole, is fair, balanced and understandable and provides the information necessary for shareholders to assess the Group’s performance, business model and strategy. As a result of this review, the Committee is satisfied that it has met its terms of reference.

 

The updated terms of reference for the RAC are available online at www.bhpbilliton.com/home/aboutus/ourcompany/Pages/governance.aspx.

3.14.2     Remuneration Committee Report

Role and focus

The role of the Remuneration Committee is to assist the Board in overseeing:

 

  the remuneration policy and its specific application to the CEO and the CEO’s direct reports, and its general application to all employees;

 

  the adoption of annual and longer-term incentive plans;

 

  the determination of levels of reward for the CEO and approval of reward to the CEO’s direct reports;

 

  the annual evaluation of the performance of the CEO, by giving guidance to the Group Chairman;

 

  the preparation of the Remuneration Report for inclusion in the Annual Report;

 

  compliance with applicable legal and regulatory requirements associated with remuneration matters;

 

  the review, at least annually, of remuneration by gender.

The role of the Remuneration Committee in the context of BHP Billiton’s broader governance framework is summarised in the diagram below.

BHP Billiton governance structure – Remuneration Committee*

 

LOGO

 

* The Sustainability, RAC and Finance Committees assist the Remuneration Committee in determining appropriate HSEC, financial and capital projects metrics, respectively, to be included in GMC scorecards and in assessing performance against those measures.

The Remuneration Committee met seven times during the year. Information on meeting attendance by Committee members is included in the table in section 3.12.

 

258


Table of Contents

Full details of the Committee’s work on behalf of the Board, including the review of our remuneration structures conducted by the Committee during FY2014, are set out in the Remuneration Report in section 4.

Remuneration Committee members during the year

 

Name

  

Status

John Buchanan (Chairman)

   Member for whole period

Carlos Cordeiro

   Member for whole period

Pat Davies

   Member for whole period

Carolyn Hewson

   Member since 6 January 2014

John Schubert

   Member for whole period

Committee review

An internally facilitated review was conducted during the year to confirm continued compliance with the Committee’s terms of reference, which were updated during FY2013. As a result of this review, the Committee is satisfied that it has met its terms of reference.

 

The terms of reference for the Remuneration Committee are available online at

www.bhpbilliton.com/home/aboutus/ourcompany/Pages/governance.aspx.

3.14.3    Nomination and Governance Committee Report

Role and focus

The role of the Nomination and Governance Committee is to assist in ensuring that the Board comprises individuals who are best able to discharge the responsibilities of a Director, having regard to the highest standards of governance, the strategic direction of the Group and the diversity aspirations of the Board. It does so by focusing on:

 

  the succession planning process for the Board and its committees, including the identification of the skills, experience, independence and knowledge required on the Board, as well as the attributes required of potential Directors;

 

  the identification of suitable candidates for appointment to the Board, taking into account the skills, experience and diversity required on the Board, and the attributes required of Directors;

 

  the succession planning process for the Chairman;

 

  the succession planning process for the CEO and periodic evaluation of the process;

 

  Board and Director performance evaluation, including evaluation of Directors seeking re-election prior to their endorsement by the Board as set out in sections 3.11 and 3.13;

 

  the provision of appropriate training and development opportunities for Directors;

 

  the independence of Non-executive Directors;

 

  the time required from Non-executive Directors;

 

  the authorisation of situations of actual and potential conflict notified by Directors in accordance with the Articles of Association of BHP Billiton Plc as set out in section 3.10;

 

  the Group’s corporate governance practices;

 

  the preparation of a report by the Committee to be included in the Annual Report.

 

259


Table of Contents

The Board has an aspirational goal of increasing the number of women on the Board to at least three by the end of 2015. The Nomination and Governance Committee continues to take diversity into account in its deliberations and works continuously to identify future candidates for the Board. The appointment this year focused on upstream oil and gas experience, as part of the ongoing five-year plan for Board succession. However, at the same time the Committee has added further emphasis to the need to appoint a female Non-executive Director and has met a number of potential candidates. We are planning on the basis that an appointment will be made before the end of 2015. The target set for Board diversity, and the approach undertaken by the Nominations and Governance Committee, is set out in more detail in section 3.8.

Information regarding the Board’s policy on diversity and the Committee’s role in this regard is set out in sections 3.8 and 3.18.

The Nomination and Governance Committee also oversaw the Director Training and Development Program for FY2014. The Board believes this enhances the Committee’s ongoing consideration and review in relation to the appropriate skills mix for the Board.

The role of the Nomination and Governance Committee in the context of BHP Billiton’s broader governance framework is summarised in the diagram below.

BHP Billiton governance structure – Nomination and Governance Committee

 

LOGO

The Nomination and Governance Committee met six times during the year. Information on meeting attendance by Committee members is included in the table in section 3.12.

There were changes to the composition of the Board during the year, with the appointment of Mr Brinded as a Non-executive Director with effect from 15 April 2014. This followed a process involving the retained services of external recruitment specialists Heidrick & Struggles and JCA Group, who have assisted in the identification of potential candidates for the Board, as set out in section 3.8.

Aside from conducting external searches, in previous years Heidrick & Struggles Leadership Assessment has provided services in respect of Director performance assessment. This year, JCA Group provided non-executive search services and facilitated the external Board assessment. In both cases, the search and assessment services operate independently, and neither firm has any other connection with the Group. In addition, Lintstock, whose services have been used by the Group in prior years for assessment, also has no other connection with the Group.

 

260


Table of Contents

Nomination and Governance Committee members during the year

 

Name

  

Status

Jac Nasser (Chairman)

   Member for whole period

John Buchanan

   Member for whole period

John Schubert

   Member for whole period

Committee review

An internally facilitated review was conducted during the year to confirm continued compliance with the Committee’s terms of reference, which were updated during FY2013. As a result of this review, the Committee is satisfied that it has met its terms of reference.

 

The terms of reference for the Nomination and Governance Committee are available online at www.bhpbilliton.com/home/aboutus/ourcompany/Pages/governance.aspx.

3.14.4    Sustainability Committee Report

Role and focus

The role of the Sustainability Committee is to assist the Board to take reasonable steps in overseeing the:

 

  adequacy of the Group’s HSEC framework, which consists of:

 

  - the CEO limits, which delegate authority to the CEO, including for HSEC matters;

 

  - the Committee itself and its terms of reference;

 

  - a robust independent assurance and audit process, established by the RAC;

 

  - independent legal and specialist advice on HSEC matters;

 

  - the Group’s HSEC Management System;

 

  adequacy of the Group’s HSEC Management System, which is designed and implemented by management. It incorporates the systems and processes, resources, structures and performance standards for the day-to-day identification, management and reporting of HSEC risks and obligations, which are articulated in Group Level Documents (GLDs);

 

  Group’s compliance with applicable legal and regulatory requirements associated with HSEC matters;

 

  Annual Sustainability Report;

 

  performance, resourcing and leadership of the HSEC function;

 

  Group’s performance in relation to HSEC matters, including the HSEC component of the GMC scorecard.

Our approach to sustainability is reflected in Our Charter, which defines our values, purpose and how we measure success, and in our sustainability performance targets, which define our public commitments to safety, health, environment and community. Further information is set out in the Group’s Sustainability Report 2014.

 

A copy of the Sustainability Report and further information is available online at

www.bhpbilliton.com/home/aboutus/sustainability/Pages/default.aspx.

The Committee provides oversight of the preparation and presentation of the Sustainability Report by management, including oversight of internal control systems relevant to the preparation of the Sustainability Report.

 

261


Table of Contents

The role of the Sustainability Committee in the context of BHP Billiton’s broader governance framework is summarised in the diagram below.

BHP Billiton governance structure – Sustainability Committee

 

LOGO

Sustainable development governance

Our approach to HSEC and sustainable development governance is characterised by:

 

  the Sustainability Committee overseeing material HSEC matters and risks across the Group;

 

  management having primary responsibility for the design and implementation of an effective HSEC management system;

 

  management having accountability for HSEC performance;

 

  the HSE and Community functions providing advice and guidance directly, as well as through a series of networks across the Group;

 

  seeking input and insight from external experts such as the BHP Billiton Forum on Corporate Responsibility;

 

  clear links between remuneration and HSEC performance.

The Sustainability Committee met seven times during the year. Information on meeting attendance by Committee members is included in the table in section 3.12.

During the year, the Sustainability Committee continued to assist the Board in its oversight of HSEC issues and performance. This included consideration of strategic environmental and community issues, HSEC audits and trends, and the findings and action items from accidents and other incidents.

 

262


Table of Contents

The key areas on which the Committee, management and the HSE and Community functions focus are outlined in the diagram below.

 

LOGO

In addition to our focus on the health, safety and wellbeing of our people, the Committee spent considerable time considering environment and climate change scenarios and the actions being taken to manage the implications of climate change regulation in light of the Group’s public target for emissions through to FY2017 as set out in section 1.14.2 of this Annual Report.

Climate change

Climate change is treated as a Board-level governance issue with the Sustainability Committee playing a key supporting role. The Committee, along with the Risk and Audit Committee, spends considerable time considering systemic climate change considerations relating to the resilience of, and opportunities for, the Group’s portfolio. The Committee also receives reports on scenarios and sign posts, which point to longer-term directional change and considers actions to manage the implications of climate change on the Company. Further information on our climate change position and how we consider the impacts on our portfolio is set out in section 1.14.2.

Community investment

We also continued to monitor our progress in relation to our community investment, and met our target for investments in community programs, with such investments consisting of cash, in-kind support and administration. This was the equivalent of one per cent of our pre-tax profits, calculated on the average of the previous three years pre-tax profit. During FY2014, our voluntary community investment totalled US$241.7 million, comprising US$141.7 million of cash, in-kind support and administrative costs and a US$100 million contribution to the BHP Billiton Foundation.

The Committee reviewed and recommended to the Board the approval of the annual Sustainability Report for publication. The Sustainability Report identifies our targets for HSEC matters and our performance against those targets, with an emphasis on fact-based measurement and quality data in setting targets.

 

263


Table of Contents

HSEC matters and remuneration

In order to link HSEC matters to remuneration, 20 per cent of the short-term incentive opportunity for GMC members was based on HSEC performance during the year, an increase from 15 per cent in FY2013. The Sustainability Committee assists the Remuneration Committee in determining appropriate HSEC metrics to be included in GMC scorecards, and also assists in relation to assessment of performance against those measures. The Board believes this method of assessment is transparent, rigorous and balanced, and provides an appropriate, objective and comprehensive assessment of performance. Further information on the metrics and their assessment is set out in the Remuneration Report in section 4.

Sustainability Committee members during the year

 

Name

  

Status

John Schubert (Chairman)

   Member for whole period

Malcolm Brinded

   Member from 15 April 2014

Malcolm Broomhead

   Member for whole period

Keith Rumble

   Member for whole period

Committee review

An internally facilitated review was conducted during the year to confirm continued compliance with the Committee’s terms of reference, which were updated during FY2013. As a result of this review, the Committee is satisfied that it has met its terms of reference.

 

The terms of reference for the Sustainability Committee are available online at

www.bhpbilliton.com/home/aboutus/ourcompany/Pages/governance.aspx.

3.14.5    Finance Committee Report

Role and focus

The role of the Finance Committee is to assist the Board in its consideration for approval and ongoing oversight of matters pertaining to:

 

  capital structure and funding;

 

  capital management planning and initiatives, including capital allocation;

 

  due diligence on acquisitions and investments, including proposals that may have a material impact on the Group’s capital position;

 

  matters the Board may refer to the Committee from time to time in connection with the Group’s capital position.

Recognising that the focus of the Committee’s activities encompasses matters of strategy reserved for the Board, the Committee does not, as a matter of course, have a decision-making role. Instead, its focus is to advise the Board and make recommendations. The Board may, where it considers it appropriate, delegate decision-making power to the Committee in relation to specific matters.

 

264


Table of Contents

The role of the Finance Committee in the context of BHP Billiton’s broader governance framework is summarised in the diagram below.

BHP Billiton governance structure – Finance Committee

 

LOGO

The Committee met 10 times during the year. Information on meeting attendance by Committee members is included in the table in section 3.12.

During the year, the Finance Committee continued to assist the work of the Board by considering matters relating to capital structure and funding, capital management planning and initiatives, capital expenditure, divestments and other matters referred to the Committee. In addition, the Committee assisted the Board in its consideration of the creation of a new global metals and mining company to accelerate portfolio simplification. The Committee’s considerations resulted in recommendations to the Board on the matters considered.

Finance Committee members during the year

 

Name

  

Status

David Crawford (Chairman)

   Member for whole period

Malcolm Broomhead

   Member for whole period

Lindsay Maxsted

   Member for whole period

Wayne Murdy

   Member for whole period

Committee review

An internally facilitated review was conducted during the year to confirm continued compliance with the Committee’s terms of reference, which were updated during FY2013. As a result of this review, the Committee is satisfied that it has met its terms of reference.

 

The terms of reference for the Finance Committee are available online at

www.bhpbilliton.com/home/aboutus/ourcompany/Pages/governance.aspx.

 

265


Table of Contents

3.15    Risk management governance structure

We believe the identification and management of risk is central to achieving the corporate purpose of creating long-term shareholder value. Our approach to risk is set out in section 1.7.

The principal aim of the Group’s risk management governance structure and internal control systems is to identify, evaluate and manage business risks, with a view to enhancing the value of shareholders’ investments and safeguarding assets.

Each year, the Board reviews and considers the Group’s risk profile, which covers both operational and strategic risks. The risk profile is assessed to ensure it supports the achievement of the Group’s strategy while maintaining a solid ‘A’ credit rating. The Board’s approach to investment decision-making and portfolio management, and the consideration of risk in that process is set out in sections 1.5.4 and 1.7 and includes a broad range of scenarios to assess our portfolio. This process allows us to be able to continually adjust the shape of our portfolio to match energy and commodity demand and meet society’s expectations while maximising shareholder returns.

The Board has delegated the oversight of risk management to the RAC, although the Board retains overall accountability for the Group’s risk profile. In addition, the Board specifically requires the CEO to implement a system of control for identifying and managing risk. The Directors, through the RAC, review the systems that have been established for this purpose and regularly review their effectiveness. The RAC regularly reports to the Board to enable it to review the Group’s risk framework.

The RAC has established review processes for the nature and extent of material risks taken in achieving our corporate purpose. These processes include the application of materiality and tolerance criteria to determine and assess material risks. Materiality criteria include maximum foreseeable loss and residual risk thresholds and are set at the Group level. Tolerance criteria additionally assess the control effectiveness of material risks.

The diagram below outlines the risk reporting process.

 

LOGO

Management has put in place a number of key policies, processes, performance requirements and independent controls to provide assurance to the Board and the RAC as to the integrity of our reporting and effectiveness of our systems of internal control and risk management. Some of the more significant internal control systems include Board and management committees, Business RACs and internal audit.

 

266


Table of Contents

Business Risk and Audit Committees

The Business RACs assist the RAC to monitor the Group’s obligations in relation to financial reporting, internal control structure, risk management processes and the internal and external audit functions.

Board committees

Directors also monitor risks and controls through the RAC, the Remuneration Committee and the Sustainability Committee.

Management committees

Management committees also perform roles in relation to risk and control. Strategic risks and opportunities arising from changes in our business environment are regularly reviewed by the GMC and discussed by the Board. The Financial Risk Management Committee (FRMC) reviews the effectiveness of internal controls relating to commodity price risk, counterparty credit risk, currency risk, financing risk, interest rate risk and insurance. Minutes of the GMC and the FRMC meetings are provided to the Board. The Investment Committee provides oversight for investment processes across the Company and coordinates the investment toll-gating process for major investments. Reports are made to the Board on findings by the Investment Committee in relation to major capital projects. The Disclosure Committee oversees the Group’s compliance with securities dealing and continuous and periodic disclosure requirements, including reviewing information that may require disclosure through stock exchanges and overseeing processes to ensure information disclosed is timely, accurate and complete.

3.16    Management

Below the level of the Board, key management decisions are made by the CEO, the GMC, other management committees and individual members of management to whom authority has been delegated.

On 27 August 2013, Mike Fraser was appointed to the GMC as President, Human Resources and on 3 March 2014, Tony Cudmore joined the GMC as President, Corporate Affairs.

On 19 August 2014, the Group announced Graham Kerr’s retirement from the GMC with effect from 1 October 2014, his appointment as Chief Executive Officer-designate of the planned demerged company, his replacement as BHP Billiton CFO by Peter Beaven, currently President, Copper, and the retirement from the GMC of Karen Wood with effect from 19 August 2014. Full details and biographies of the GMC are set out in section 3.2.2.

 

267


Table of Contents

The diagram below describes the responsibilities of the CEO and four key management committees.

 

LOGO

Performance evaluation for executives

The performance of executives and other senior employees is reviewed on an annual basis. For the members of the GMC, this review includes their contribution, engagement and interaction at Board level. The annual performance review process that we employ considers the performance of executives against criteria designed to capture both ‘what’ is achieved and ‘how’ it is achieved. All performance assessments of executives consider how effective they have been in undertaking their role; what they have achieved against their specified key performance indicators; how they match up to the behaviours prescribed in our leadership model and how those behaviours align with Our Charter values. The assessment is therefore holistic and balances absolute achievement with the way performance has been delivered. Progression within the Group is driven equally by personal leadership behaviours and capability to produce excellent results.

A performance evaluation as outlined above is conducted for all members of the GMC annually. For the CEO, the performance evaluation was led by the Chairman of the Board on behalf of all the Non-executive Directors, drawing on guidance from the Remuneration Committee.

 

268


Table of Contents

3.17    Business conduct

Code of Business Conduct

We have published the Code of Business Conduct, which reflects Our Charter values, particularly those of Integrity and Respect. It provides clear direction and advice on conducting business internationally, interacting with communities, governments and business partners and general workplace behaviour. The Code of Business Conduct applies to Directors and to all employees, regardless of their position or location. Consultants and contractors are also expected to act in accordance with the Code of Business Conduct.

 

The Code of Business Conduct can be found on our website at

www.bhpbilliton.com/home/aboutus/ourcompany/Pages/codeofbusconduct.aspx.

Anti-corruption investigation

As previously disclosed, BHP Billiton received requests for information in August 2009 from the US Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC). Following that request, the Group commenced an internal investigation and disclosed to relevant authorities evidence that it has uncovered regarding possible violations of applicable anti-corruption laws involving interactions with government officials.

The issues relate primarily to matters in connection with previously terminated exploration and development efforts, as well as hospitality provided as part of the Company’s sponsorship of the 2008 Beijing Olympics. The Group is currently discussing a potential resolution of the matter.

As has been publicly reported, the Australian Federal Police has indicated that it has commenced an investigation and the Group continues to fully cooperate with the relevant authorities.

In light of the continuing nature of the investigations, it is not appropriate at this stage for BHP Billiton to predict outcomes.

Insider trading

We have a Securities Dealing GLD that covers dealings by Directors and identified employees, is consistent with the UK Model Code contained in the UK Financial Conduct Authority Listing Rules and complies with the ASX Listing Rule requirements for a trading policy. The Securities Dealing GLD restricts dealings by Directors and identified employees in shares and other securities during designated prohibited periods and at any time that they are in possession of unpublished price-sensitive information. As part of a regular, planned process, the Securities Dealing GLD is reviewed every two years to ensure it remains current, fit for purpose and in line with our broader governance framework.

 

A copy of the Securities Dealing GLD can be found on our website at

www.bhpbilliton.com/home/aboutus/ourcompany/Pages/governance.aspx.

EthicsPoint, BHP Billiton’s business conduct advisory service

EthicsPoint, BHP Billiton’s business conduct advisory service, has been established so that employees, contractors or members of the community can seek guidance or express concerns on how we work with fellow employees, governments, communities, third parties or how we use our Company resources. Reports can be made anonymously and without fear of retaliation. Arrangements are in place to investigate such matters. Where appropriate, investigations are conducted independently. Levels of activity and support processes for EthicsPoint are monitored, with activity reports presented to the Board. Further information on EthicsPoint can be found in the Code of Business Conduct.

 

269


Table of Contents

Political donations

We maintain a position of impartiality with respect to party politics and do not make political contributions/donations for political purposes to any political party, politician, elected official or candidate for public office. We do, however, contribute to the public debate of policy issues that may affect the Company in the countries in which we operate. As explained in the Directors’ Report, the Australian Electoral Commission (AEC) disclosure requirements are broad, such that amounts that are not political donations can be reportable for AEC purposes. For example, where a political party or organisation owns shares in BHP Billiton, the AEC filing requires the political party or organisation to disclose the dividend payments received for their shareholding.

3.18    Diversity and inclusion at BHP Billiton

Our Charter and Human Resources GLDs guide management on all aspects of human resource management, including diversity and inclusion. Underpinning the GLDs and supporting the achievement of diversity across the Group are principles and measurable objectives that define our approach to diversity and our focus on creating an inclusive work environment.

The Board believes that critical mass is important for diversity and, in relation to gender, has set a goal of increasing the number of women on the Board. See section 3.8 for further details. Alongside Board composition, part of the Board’s role is to consider and approve the Group’s measurable objectives for each financial year, and to oversee the Group’s progress in achieving those objectives. This progress will continue to be disclosed in the Annual Report, along with the proportion of women in our workforce, in senior management positions and on the Board. Further information on diversity, and our employee profile more generally, is set out in section 1.13.

3.19    Market disclosure

We are committed to maintaining the highest standards of disclosure ensuring that all investors and potential investors have the same access to high-quality, relevant information in an accessible and timely manner to assist them in making informed decisions. The Disclosure Committee manages our compliance with market disclosure obligations and is responsible for implementing reporting processes and controls and setting guidelines for the release of information. As part of our commitment to continuous improvement we continue to ensure alignment with best practice as it develops in the jurisdictions in which we are listed.

Disclosure officers have been appointed in the Group’s Businesses, Group Functions and Marketing. These officers are responsible for identifying and providing the Disclosure Committee with referral information about the activities of the Business or functional areas using disclosure guidelines developed by the Committee. The Committee then makes the decision whether a particular piece of information is material and therefore needs to be disclosed to the market.

To safeguard the effective dissemination of information, we have developed a market disclosure and communications document, which outlines how we identify and distribute information to shareholders and market participants.

 

A copy of the Market Disclosure and Communications document is available online at

www.bhpbilliton.com/home/aboutus/ourcompany/Pages/governance.aspx.

Copies of announcements to the stock exchanges on which we are listed, investor briefings, half-yearly Financial Statements, the Annual Report and other relevant information can be found on our website at www.bhpbilliton.com. Any person wishing to receive advice by email of news releases can subscribe at www.bhpbilliton.com.

 

270


Table of Contents

3.20    Remuneration

Details of our remuneration policies and practices and the remuneration paid to the Directors (Executive and Non-executive) and members of the GMC are set out in the Remuneration Report in section 4 of this Annual Report. Shareholders will be invited to consider and to approve the Remuneration Report at the 2014 AGMs. The Australian Corporations Act and the ASX Listing Rules prohibit Directors and members of the GMC from voting on various resolutions relating to Key Management Personnel remuneration, including, for example, the adoption of the Remuneration Report, an increase in the maximum aggregate remuneration payable to the Non-executive Directors and the grant of equity to the Executive Director.

3.21    Directors’ share ownership

Non-executive Directors have agreed to apply at least 25 per cent of their remuneration to the purchase of BHP Billiton shares until they achieve a shareholding equivalent in value to one year’s remuneration. Thereafter, they must maintain at least that level of shareholding throughout their tenure. All dealings by Directors are subject to the Group’s Securities Dealing GLD and are reported to the Board and to the stock exchanges.

Information on our policy governing the use of hedge arrangements over shares in BHP Billiton by both Directors and members of the GMC is set out in section 4.4.2 of this Annual Report.

Details of the shares held by Directors are set out in section 4.4.27 of this Annual Report.

3.22    Company secretaries

Jane McAloon is the President, Governance and Group Company Secretary. Ms McAloon’s qualifications and experience are set out in section 3.2.1. The Group Company Secretary is responsible for developing and maintaining the information systems and processes that enable the Board to fulfil its role. The Group Company Secretary is also responsible to the Board for ensuring that Board procedures are complied with and advising the Board on governance matters. All Directors have access to the Group Company Secretary for advice and services. Independent advisory services are retained by the Group Company Secretary at the request of the Board or Board committees. Other persons appointed to act as company secretary of BHP Billiton Limited or BHP Billiton Plc, or both are Nicole Duncan (BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc); Elizabeth Hobley (BHP Billiton Plc); and Geof Stapledon (BHP Billiton Plc). The Board appoints and removes the company secretaries.

3.23    Conformance with corporate governance standards

Our compliance with the governance standards in our home jurisdictions of Australia and the United Kingdom, and with the governance requirements that apply to us as a result of our New York Stock Exchange (NYSE) listing and our registration with the SEC in the United States, is summarised in this Corporate Governance Statement, the Remuneration Report, the Directors’ Report and the Financial Statements.

The Listing Rules and the Disclosure and Transparency Rules of the UK Financial Conduct Authority require companies listed in the UK to report on the extent to which they comply with the Main Principles and the provisions of the UK Corporate Governance Code (UK Code), and explain the reasons for any non-compliance. The UK Code is available online at www.frc.org.uk/corporate/ukcgcode.cfm.

The Listing Rules of the ASX require Australian-listed companies to report on the extent to which they meet the Corporate Governance Principles and Recommendations published by the ASX Corporate Governance Council (ASX Principles and Recommendations) and explain the reasons for any non-compliance. The ASX Principles and Recommendations are available online at www.asxgroup.com.au/corporate-governance-council.htm.

 

271


Table of Contents

Both the UK Code and the ASX Principles and Recommendations require the Board to consider the application of the relevant corporate governance principles, while recognising that departures from those principles are appropriate in some circumstances. We complied with the provisions set out in the UK Code and with the ASX Principles and Recommendations during the financial period and continue to comply up to the date of this Annual Report.

 

A checklist summarising our compliance with the UK Code and the ASX Principles and Recommendations are available online at www.bhpbilliton.com/home/aboutus/ourcompany/Pages/governance.aspx.

BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc are registrants with the SEC in the United States. Both companies are classified as foreign private issuers and both have American Depositary Shares listed on the NYSE.

We have reviewed the governance requirements currently applicable to foreign private issuers under the Sarbanes-Oxley Act (US), including the rules promulgated by the SEC and the rules of the NYSE and are satisfied that we comply with those requirements.

Section 303A of the NYSE-Listed Company Manual contains a broad regime of corporate governance requirements for NYSE-listed companies. Under the NYSE rules, foreign private issuers, such as ourselves, are permitted to follow home country practice in lieu of the requirements of Section 303A, except for the rule relating to compliance with Rule 10A-3 of the US Securities Exchange Act of 1934 (audit committee independence) and certain notification provisions contained in Section 303A of the Listed Company Manual. Section 303A.11 of the Listed Company Manual, however, requires us to disclose any significant ways in which our corporate governance practices differ from those followed by US companies under the NYSE corporate governance standards. Following a comparison of our corporate governance practices with the requirements of Section 303A of the Listed Company Manual followed by US companies, the following significant difference was identified:

 

  Rule 10A-3 of the US Securities Exchange Act of 1934 requires NYSE-listed companies to ensure that their audit committees are directly responsible for the appointment, compensation, retention and oversight of the work of the external auditor unless the company’s governing law or documents or other home country legal requirements require or permit shareholders to ultimately vote on or approve these matters. While the RAC is directly responsible for remuneration and oversight of the External Auditor, the ultimate responsibility for appointment and retention of the External Auditor rests with our shareholders, in accordance with UK law and our constitutional documents. The RAC does, however, make recommendations to the Board on these matters, which are in turn reported to shareholders.

While the Board is satisfied with its level of compliance with the governance requirements in Australia, the United Kingdom and the United States, it recognises that practices and procedures can always be improved, and there is merit in continuously reviewing its own standards against those in a variety of jurisdictions. The Board’s program of review will continue throughout the year ahead.

3.24    Additional UK disclosure

The information specified in the UK Financial Conduct Authority Disclosure and Transparency Rules, DTR 7.2.6, is located elsewhere in this Annual Report. The Directors’ Report, at section 5.9, provides cross-references to where the information is located.

This Corporate Governance Statement was approved by the Board on 11 September 2014 and signed on its behalf by:

Jac Nasser AO

Chairman

11 September 2014

 

272


Table of Contents

4    Remuneration Report

 

Contents of the Remuneration Report

4.1

  Annual statement by the Remuneration Committee Chairman

4.2

 

Introduction to the Remuneration Report

4.3

 

Remuneration policy report

 

•       Remuneration policy for Executive Directors

 

•       Remuneration policy for Non-executive Directors

4.4

 

Annual report on remuneration

 

•       Remuneration governance

 

•       Remuneration outcomes for the Executive Director (the CEO)

 

•       Remuneration outcomes for Non-executive Directors

 

•       Remuneration for members of the GMC (other than the CEO)

 

•       Other statutory disclosures

Abbreviation

  

Item

AGM

     Annual General Meeting

CEO

     Chief Executive Officer

DEP

     Dividend Equivalent Payment

EBIT

     Earnings Before Interest and Tax

GIS

     Group Incentive Scheme

GMC

     Group Management Committee

GSTIP

     Group Short Term Incentive Plan

HSEC

     Health, Safety, Environment and Community

IFRS

     International Financial Reporting Standards

KMP

     Key Management Personnel

LTI

     Long-Term Incentive

LTIP

     Long-Term Incentive Plan

MAP

     Management Award Plan

MSR

     Minimum Shareholding Requirements

STI

     Short-Term Incentive

STIP

     Short-Term Incentive Plan

TRIF

     Total Recordable Injury Frequency

TSR

     Total Shareholder Return

 

273


Table of Contents

4.1    Annual statement by the Remuneration Committee Chairman

Dear Shareholder

Welcome to BHP Billiton’s Remuneration Report for the financial year to 30 June 2014.

I am pleased to introduce a revised structure to our report this year. The new look is driven by revised disclosure requirements in the UK, together with our constant pursuit of more accessible information. I am equally pleased to report that there has been no change to our underlying remuneration philosophy and no change to how we reflect performance in remuneration outcomes – 2014 marks a decade since the Company introduced its current incentive arrangements.

As BHP Billiton is an Australian / UK dual-listed company, the disclosures in our report must comply with both Australian and UK reporting requirements, which unavoidably leads to a lengthy report. However, the report is intended to be comprehensible as well as comprehensive.

Structure of the 2014 Remuneration Report

This Annual Statement introduces the 2014 Remuneration Report. Following this is the Remuneration Policy Report, which sets out the remuneration policies applicable to Andrew Mackenzie (our CEO and only Executive Director) and our Non-executive Directors.

Our remuneration governance arrangements and the remuneration outcomes for Mr Mackenzie, Non-executive Directors and other members of the GMC are covered in the Annual Report on Remuneration, including the various detailed disclosures required under UK and Australian regulatory regimes.

The new structure of the report allows for a specific binding vote by shareholders in regard to the Remuneration Policy Report for the first time at our 2014 AGMs.

Link to strategy

Our BHP Billiton Charter sets out our purpose, strategy, values and how we measure our success. In framing how we remunerate our executives we are guided by the measures of success contained in Our Charter. They are designed to ensure that executives take a long-term approach to decision-making and to minimise activities that focus only on short-term results at the expense of longer-term business growth and success. The Remuneration Committee has considered the ways in which risk management and the long-term horizon are reflected throughout BHP Billiton’s remuneration arrangements for all executives, and is satisfied that our approach reinforces the desired behaviours.

This is largely achieved through the Group’s approach to short-term and long-term incentive awards, which comprise a significant portion of total remuneration for Mr Mackenzie and other members of the GMC. The equity component of the short-term incentive award is deferred for a two-year period, and performance under the long term incentive plan is measured over a five-year period. The actual rewards received by Mr Mackenzie and other members of the GMC therefore reflect the Group’s performance and share price over an extended period.

Our approach

Despite the report’s new look, there have been no substantial changes to our underlying approach – we ensure that remuneration outcomes reflect the performance of the Group, Businesses and individuals. This approach has enjoyed a strong level of support from shareholders, with a vote in favour for the remuneration report of 97 per cent at last year’s AGMs.

 

274


Table of Contents

Our approach to incentive structures has been in place for more than a decade and has served both shareholders and participants well, delivering remuneration outcomes to executives aligned to the performance of the Group and of individuals. BHP Billiton adopted the deferral of a substantial portion of short-term incentive awards in equity in 2003 and a five-year term for long-term incentive awards in 2004. These approaches, which were then market leading, have since become more prevalent and acknowledged as best practice.

Notwithstanding our stable approach, the Committee and the Board continue to pay close attention to shareholders’ views so they can be factored into the Group’s future approach.

Our remuneration policy in action

Each year, the Committee makes decisions regarding a range of remuneration matters, including any changes in base salary, fees and benefits, and adjudicating on short-term and long-term incentive outcomes relating to Mr Mackenzie and other members of the GMC.

Last year, when Mr Mackenzie was appointed to the CEO role, the Board and Committee believed that some downward rebasing of his remuneration package, relative to that of the former CEO, was appropriate; a view supported by Mr Mackenzie.

This year, following the Committee’s annual review process, the FY2015 base salary of Mr Mackenzie has not been increased. Likewise, other elements of Mr Mackenzie’s total target remuneration (pension contributions, benefits and short-term and long-term incentive targets) will remain the same in FY2015 as in FY2014.

Mr Mackenzie’s annual short-term incentive is at risk. The scorecard against which his performance is assessed is made up of a number of performance measures, including HSEC, financial performance, capital project management and individual personal measures. For FY2014, the Committee has assessed the performance of Mr Mackenzie and concluded it was in excess of target with a bonus outcome of 115.3 per cent, against a target of 100 per cent, a maximum of 150 per cent, and a minimum of zero. This outperformance was mainly due to positive outcomes across a range of HSEC measures, together with above-target production and productivity achievements.

Mr Mackenzie’s long-term incentive is also at risk. BHP Billiton’s business is long term, and decisions are made that are likely to have an impact for many years. It is therefore important that a significant part of senior executives’ pay reflects long-term performance. BHP Billiton’s long-term incentive plan measures performance over five years.

The Committee has now considered performance and vesting outcomes for the long-term incentive award granted in 2009, covering the five years to 30 June 2014. The performance condition benchmarked BHP Billiton’s TSR against the TSR of a tailored comparator group of resources companies. The five-year TSR performance for BHP Billiton was 60.6 per cent, exceeding the weighted average TSR of the comparator group by 17.8 per cent, resulting in a 58 per cent vesting.

The Committee considered whether there were any circumstances that merited it exercising its discretion to reduce this vesting outcome (as was the case last year where the Committee reduced vesting from 100 per cent to 65 per cent). This discretion is an important safeguard in circumstances where the Committee does not believe that the vesting outcome truly reflects performance.

After carefully considering the relative TSR outcome and both Group and individual performance over the vesting period, the Committee determined that the TSR outcome was a fair reflection of performance.

Consistent with the approach for Mr Mackenzie, the base salaries and total target remuneration packages for other GMC members have also been held constant for FY2015. Aligned with this, Non-executive Director fees were again frozen, for the third consecutive year.

 

275


Table of Contents

Summary

This year’s Remuneration Report represents a change in format, structure and content from prior years. However, our fundamental philosophies and approaches to remuneration have not changed – we trust that you will agree that our long held, consistent approach to aligning remuneration to performance has served shareholders well.

As ever, we welcome your comments.             

 

 

 

John Buchanan
Chairman, Remuneration Committee

11 September 2014

4.2    Introduction to the Remuneration Report

The contents of this Remuneration Report are governed by legislation in the United Kingdom and Australia.

The UK Companies Act 2006 and the Large and Medium-sized Companies and Groups (Accounts and Reports) Regulations 2008 (as amended), which are generally described as UK requirements in this Remuneration Report, require BHP Billiton to make certain disclosures in regard to Directors, which for BHP Billiton includes the Non-executive Directors and the Executive Director, being the CEO.

The Australian Corporations Act 2001, Australian Accounting Standards and IFRS require BHP Billiton to make certain disclosures for KMP, defined as those persons having authority and responsibility for planning, directing and controlling the activities of the Group, directly or indirectly. For the purposes of this Remuneration Report, it has been determined that the KMP includes the Non-executive Directors, and the members of the GMC including the CEO.

 

276


Table of Contents

4.2.1    Members of the GMC

The GMC makes key management decisions under the authorities that have been delegated to it by the Board. The composition and structure of the GMC reflects a commitment to a relentless focus on the safe execution of the Group’s strategy, and provides BHP Billiton with the right balance of skills and experience to lead the Group. The members of the GMC during FY2014 are shown in the table below.

 

Name

  

Title

Andrew Mackenzie

   Chief Executive Officer and Executive Director

Peter Beaven

   President, Copper

Tony Cudmore

   President, Corporate Affairs since 3 March 2014

Tim Cutt

   President, Petroleum and Potash since 2 July 2013

Dean Dalla Valle

   President, Coal

Mike Fraser

   President, Human Resources since 27 August 2013

Geoff Healy

   Chief Legal Counsel

Mike Henry

  

President, HSE, Marketing and Technology since 5 May 2014

President, HSEC, Marketing and Technology to 4 May 2014

Graham Kerr

   Chief Financial Officer

Jane McAloon

   President, Governance and Group Company Secretary

Daniel Malchuk

   President, Aluminium, Manganese and Nickel

Jimmy Wilson

   President, Iron Ore

Karen Wood

  

President since 3 March 2014

President, Corporate Affairs from 1 December 2013 to 2 March 2014

President, Public Affairs from 27 August 2013 to 30 November 2013

President, People and Public Affairs to 26 August 2013

 

LOGO Section 3.2.2 for dates of appointment of GMC members

4.2.2    Non-executive Directors

Details of the Non-executive Directors who held office during FY2014 are set out below. Each Non-executive Director held office for the whole of FY2014 unless otherwise indicated.

 

Name

 

Title

 

Name

 

Title

Malcolm Brinded (1)

  Non-executive Director   Lindsay Maxsted   Non-executive Director

Malcolm Broomhead

  Non-executive Director   Wayne Murdy   Non-executive Director

John Buchanan

  Senior Independent Director   Jac Nasser   Chairman

Carlos Cordeiro

  Non-executive Director   Keith Rumble   Non-executive Director

David Crawford

  Non-executive Director   John Schubert   Non-executive Director

Pat Davies

  Non-executive Director   Shriti Vadera   Non-executive Director

Carolyn Hewson

  Non-executive Director    

 

(1)  Malcolm Brinded joined BHP Billiton as a Non-executive Director from 15 April 2014.

 

LOGO Section 3.2.1 for dates of appointment of Non-executive Directors

 

277


Table of Contents

4.3    Remuneration policy report

This section of the report describes the overarching remuneration policy that guides the Remuneration Committee’s decisions. The remuneration policy report is presented as follows.

 

Contents of the remuneration policy report

4.3.1 to 4.3.8    Remuneration policy for Executive Directors

4.3.9                   Remuneration policy for Non-executive Directors

 

LOGO Section 4.4.14 for remuneration policy for the GMC (excluding the CEO)

The contents of this section are determined by new UK legislation, under which this policy report is required to be put to a binding vote at the Group’s 2014 AGMs. Subject to shareholder approval, this remuneration policy will become effective for Directors of BHP Billiton immediately after our final 2014 AGM. Under the UK legislation, the policy will be binding only in regard to the Directors (including the CEO) and not for other members of the GMC. The UK legislation requires BHP Billiton to present the remuneration policy for this vote at least every three years.

Where the remuneration policy report includes cross-references to other sections of the Remuneration Report or the Annual Report, these are solely for the purposes of assisting the reader to locate related information. The referenced information is not part of the remuneration policy report.

Remuneration policy for Executive Directors

BHP Billiton currently has a single Executive Director, being the CEO. Therefore, for simplicity, this section refers only to the CEO. This remuneration policy would, however, apply for any new Executive Director role, in the event that one were created during the life of this remuneration policy. In that case, references in this section to the CEO should be read as being to each Executive Director.

4.3.1    Overarching principles

The Remuneration Committee recognises that remuneration has an important role to play in supporting the implementation and achievement of the Group’s strategy and our ongoing performance, aligning the activities of management to the interests of shareholders, and in supporting Our Charter.

LOGO Inside front cover of the Annual Report: Our Charter sets out our purpose, strategy, values and how we judge our success

The Committee determines the appropriate remuneration for the CEO, taking into account his responsibilities, location, skills, experience and performance within the Group. In doing so, the Committee recognises that levels of remuneration should be sufficient to attract, motivate and retain a highly skilled CEO, but also that the Group should avoid paying more than is necessary for this purpose.

The key principles of our remuneration policy, which remain unchanged, are to:

 

  support the execution of the Group’s business strategy in accordance with a risk framework that is appropriate for the organisation;

 

  provide competitive rewards to attract, motivate and retain highly skilled executives willing to work around the world;

 

  apply demanding performance measures, including key financial and non-financial measures of performance;

 

  link a significant component of pay to our performance and the creation of value for our shareholders from relative outperformance;

 

278


Table of Contents
  ensure remuneration arrangements are equitable and facilitate the deployment of people around the Group;

 

  limit severance payments on termination to pre-established contractual arrangements (which do not commit us to making any unjustified payments).

4.3.2    The purpose of remuneration at BHP Billiton

BHP Billiton’s remuneration arrangements reinforce the achievement of our success, as set out in Our Charter, and are designed to ensure that the CEO takes a long-term approach to decision-making and to minimise activities that focus only on short-term results at the expense of longer-term business growth and success. The Remuneration Committee has considered the ways in which risk management and the long-term horizon are reflected throughout BHP Billiton’s remuneration arrangements for the CEO and all executives, and is satisfied that the approach reinforces the desired behaviours.

This is largely achieved through the Group’s approach to STI and LTI awards, which comprise a significant portion of total remuneration. The equity component of any STI award is deferred for a two-year period, and performance under the LTIP is measured over a five-year period. The actual rewards received by the CEO therefore reflect the Group’s performance and share price over an extended period.

It is the Committee’s view that this provides an appropriate focus on BHP Billiton’s sustained performance beyond the end of the initial measurement period. This approach also provides a transparent mechanism for clawback or adjustment in the event of a restatement of Group results, through changes to the vesting or non-vesting of deferred awards.

In addition, STI and LTI outcomes are not driven by a purely formulaic approach. The Committee holds discretion to determine that awards are not to be provided or vested in circumstances where it would be inappropriate or would provide unintended outcomes. The Committee has no discretion to allow vesting of equity awards when performance conditions have not been satisfied (other than in the event of death or serious injury, disability, illness that prohibits continued employment or total and permanent disablement of the CEO).

4.3.3    Components of remuneration

The following table shows the components of total remuneration, the link to strategy, how each component operates, how performance is assessed and will impact remuneration, and the maximum opportunity for each component.

 

Remuneration component

and link to strategy

  

Operation and performance framework

 

Maximum (1)

Base salary

A competitive base salary is paid in order to attract and retain a high-quality and experienced CEO, and to provide appropriate remuneration for this important role in the Group.

  

•    Base salary is broadly aligned with salaries for comparable roles in global companies of similar global complexity, size, reach and industry, and reflects the CEO’s responsibilities, location, skills, performance, qualifications and experience.

 

•    Base salary is reviewed annually with effect from 1 September. Reviews are informed, but not led, by benchmarking to comparable roles (as above), changes in responsibility and general economic conditions. Substantial weight is also given to the general base salary increases for employees. Base salary is not subject to separate performance conditions.

 

•    Base salary is denominated in US dollars.

  8% increase per annum (annualised), or inflation if higher in Australia.

 

279


Table of Contents

Remuneration component

and link to strategy

  

Operation and performance framework

 

Maximum (1)

  

•    The Remuneration Committee’s discretion in respect of base salary increases applies up to the maximum shown.

 

Pension

Provides a market-competitive level of post-employment benefit to attract and retain a high-quality and experienced CEO.

  

•    Pension contributions are benchmarked to comparable roles in global companies.

 

•    Pension contributions are provided, with a choice of funding vehicles: a defined contribution plan, an unfunded retirement savings plan, an international retirement plan or a self-managed superannuation fund. Alternatively, a cash payment may be provided in lieu.

 

•    The Committee’s discretion in respect of pension contributions applies up to the maximum shown.

  25% of base salary.

Benefits

Provides personal insurances and assistance where BHP Billiton’s structure gives rise to tax obligations across multiple jurisdictions, and a market- competitive level of benefits to attract and retain a high-quality and experienced CEO.

  

•    Benefits may be provided as determined by the Committee. Currently, this includes such items as the costs of private family health insurance, death and disability insurance, car parking, and personal tax return preparation in the required countries where BHP Billiton has requested that the CEO relocate internationally, or where BHP Billiton’s Dual Listed Company structure requires personal tax returns in multiple jurisdictions.

 

•    The CEO may from time to time be accompanied by his spouse/partner on business related travel, including for Board meetings. The costs associated with spouse/partner attendance are met by BHP Billiton. In some instances, they are deemed to be taxable benefits for the CEO. In such cases, BHP Billiton reimburses the CEO for this tax cost.

 

•    The CEO is eligible to participate in Shareplus, which is BHP Billiton’s all- employee share purchase plan. LOGO  Section 4.4.26 for information about Shareplus and the CEO’s participation

 

•    The Committee’s discretion in respect of benefits applies up to the maximums shown.

 

•    A relocation allowance and assistance is provided only where a change of location is made at BHP Billiton’s request. The Group’s mobility policies provide ‘one-off’ payments with no trailing entitlements.

  Benefits as determined by the Committee but to a limit not exceeding 10% of base salary and (if applicable) a one-off taxable relocation allowance up to US$700,000.

 

280


Table of Contents

Remuneration component

and link to strategy

  

Operation and performance framework

 

Maximum (1)

STI    Setting performance measures and targets   Maximum award

The purpose of STI is to focus the CEO’s efforts on those performance measures and outcomes that are priorities for the Group for the relevant financial year, and to motivate the CEO to strive to achieve stretch performance objectives.

 

The performance measures for each year are chosen on the basis that they are expected to have a significant short- and long-term impact on the success of the Group.

 

Deferral of a portion of STI awards in deferred equity over BHP Billiton shares encourages a longer-term focus aligned to that of shareholders.

 

LOGO  Section 4.4.3 for information on MSR for the CEO

 

LOGO  Section 1.10 for a description of KPIs for the Group

  

•    A scorecard of measures is set at the commencement of each financial year.

 

•    The measures and their relative weightings are chosen by the Committee, in their discretion, in order to appropriately drive overall performance for the coming year. Specified financial measures will constitute the largest weighting. The scorecard will also include measures that impact the long-term sustainability of the Group. The Sustainability Committee assists the Remuneration Committee in determining appropriate HSEC measures and weightings.

 

•    We plan to disclose the weightings of HSEC, financial and individual measures around the beginning of each performance period.

 

•    The target is determined for each performance measure, at a level which will motivate the CEO to achieve an appropriately stretching annual performance outcome and which will contribute to the longer-term success of the Group and shareholder wealth. The target for each financial measure is derived from the annual budget as approved by the Board for the relevant financial year.

 

•    For HSEC and for individual measures the target is ordinarily expressed in narrative form and will be disclosed near the beginning of the performance period. For reasons of commercial sensitivity, while we will provide a narrative description of financial target performance in broad terms, the actual target for each financial measure will not be disclosed in advance. However, we plan to disclose the target for each measure retrospectively. In the rare instances where this may not be prudent on grounds of commercial sensitivity, we will seek to explain why and give an indication of when the target may be disclosed.

 

•    Should any other performance measures be added at the discretion of the Committee, we will determine the timing of disclosure of the relevant target with due consideration of commercial sensitivity.

 

LOGO  Section 4.4.6 for details of performance measures and outcomes for 2014

 

LOGO  Section 4.4.11 for details of performance measures for 2015

 

240% of base salary (cash 120% and 120% in deferred equity).

 

Target performance

 

160% of base salary (cash 80% and 80% in deferred equity).

 

Threshold performance

 

80% of base salary (cash 40% and 40% in deferred equity).

 

Minimum award

 

Zero

 

281


Table of Contents

Remuneration component

and link to strategy

  

Operation and performance framework

 

Maximum (1)

   Assessment of performance  
  

•    At the conclusion of the financial year, the CEO’s achievement against each measure is assessed by the Remuneration Committee and the Board, and an STI award determined. If performance is below the Threshold level for any measure, no STI will be provided in respect of that portion of the STI opportunity.

 
  

•    The Remuneration Committee is assisted by the Sustainability Committee in relation to assessment of performance against HSEC measures, and considers guidance provided by other Committees in respect of other measures.

 
  

•    The Board believes this method of assessment is transparent, rigorous and balanced, and provides an appropriate, objective and comprehensive assessment of performance.

 
  

•    In the event that the Remuneration Committee does not consider the level of vesting that would otherwise apply to be a true reflection of the performance of the Group or should it consider that individual performance or other circumstances makes this an inappropriate outcome, it retains the discretion to not provide all or a part of any STI award. This is an important mitigation against the risk of unintended award outcomes.

 
   Delivery of award  
  

•    STI awards are provided under the STIP.

 
  

•    The value of any STI award is provided half in cash and half in an award of the equivalent value of BHP Billiton equity, which is deferred for two years and may be forfeited if the CEO leaves the Group within the deferral period.

 
  

•    The award of deferred equity comprises rights to receive ordinary BHP Billiton shares in the future if the CEO is still employed by BHP Billiton at the end of the deferral period (2). Before vesting (or exercise), these rights are not ordinary shares and do not carry entitlements to ordinary dividends or other shareholder rights; however, a DEP is provided on vested awards (3). The Committee has a discretion to settle STI awards in cash.

 
  

•    Both cash and equity STI awards are subject to malus and clawback as described below this table.

 

 

282


Table of Contents

Remuneration component

and link to strategy

  

Operation and performance framework

 

Maximum (1)

LTI

 

The purpose of the LTI is to focus the CEO’s efforts on the achievement of sustainable long-term value creation and success of the Group (including appropriate management of business risks).

 

It aligns the CEO’s reward with sustained shareholder wealth creation in excess of that of relevant comparator group(s), through the relative TSR performance condition.

 

The provision of LTIP awards over BHP Billiton shares also encourages long-term share exposure for the CEO, and aligns the long-term interests of the CEO and shareholders.

 

Demonstration of this alignment between the interests of the CEO and shareholders is seen through the five-year performance period of the LTI which is consistent with the long-term nature of the resources industry.

 

LOGO  Section 4.4.3 for information on MSR for the CEO

 

LOGO  Section 4.4.21 for a table of awards held under the LTIP

  

Relative TSR performance condition

 

•    The award is subject to a relative TSR performance condition, which must be achieved over a five-year period. Full vesting under the LTIP only occurs where BHP Billiton’s relative TSR (4) significantly outperforms the TSR of the comparator group(s). The comparator group(s) and the weighting between comparator groups will be determined by the Committee in relation to each grant.

 

LOGO  Section 4.4.8 for further detail on LTIP comparator group(s)

 

•    Relative TSR has been chosen as the most appropriate measure as it allows for an objective external assessment over a sustained period on a basis that is familiar to shareholders.

 

Level of performance required for vesting

 

•    None of the award will vest if BHP Billiton’s TSR is below the Peer Group TSR (being the weighted median TSR (6) where the comparator group is a specified group of peer companies) and/or below Index TSR (being the index value where the comparator group is a market index such as the MSCI World index).

 

•    For each award, the Committee will determine the level of relative TSR outperformance required on a per annum basis, or on a compounded basis over the five-year period, against the peer group and/or market index in order for the whole of the LTI award to vest.

 

LOGO  Section 4.4.8 for details of the outperformance required for recent grants

 

•    25% of the award will vest if BHP Billiton’s TSR is equal to the Peer Group TSR and/or Index TSR (as applicable), and vesting occurs on a sliding scale between that point and the point of full vesting.

 

•    There is no retesting if the performance condition is not met. In the event that the Committee does not consider the level of vesting that would otherwise apply based on the Group’s achievement of the relative TSR performance condition to be a true reflection of the underlying performance of the Group, or should it consider that individual performance or other circumstances makes this an inappropriate outcome, it retains the discretion to lapse any portion or all of the award. This is an important mitigation against the risk of unintended vesting outcomes.

 

Normal Maximum Award

 

Face value of 400% of base salary.

 

Exceptional Maximum Award (5)

 

Face value of 488% of base salary.

 

283


Table of Contents

Remuneration component

and link to strategy

  

Operation and performance framework

 

Maximum (1)

LOGO  Section 1.10 for a description of KPIs for the Group   

•    To ensure that the LTI performance conditions continue to support operational excellence, risk management and the execution of the Group’s strategy, the Committee retains discretion to add further performance measures to supplement the existing relative TSR performance condition. Prior to doing so, consultation would be undertaken with key stakeholders. Should this be the case, the vesting of a portion of any LTI award may instead be linked to performance against the new measure(s). The Committee expects that in the event of introducing an additional performance measure(s), the weighting on relative TSR would remain the majority weighting.

 
  

Delivery of award

 

 
  

•    LTI awards are provided under the LTIP approved by shareholders at the 2013 AGMs. When considering the value of the award to be provided, the Committee primarily considers the face value of the award, and also considers its fair value which includes consideration of the performance conditions. (7)

 

 
  

•    The award of deferred equity comprises rights to receive ordinary BHP Billiton shares in the future if the performance and service conditions are met (2). Before vesting (or exercise), these rights are not ordinary shares and do not carry entitlements to ordinary dividends or other shareholder rights; however, a DEP is provided on vested awards (3). The Committee has a discretion to settle LTI awards in cash.

 
  

•    LTI awards are subject to malus and clawback as described below this table.

 

 

LOGO Section 4.3.5 for how the remuneration policy considers other employees

 

(1)  UK regulations require the disclosure of the maximum that may be paid in respect of each remuneration component. Where that is expressed as a maximum annual percentage increase which is annualised it should not be interpreted that it is the Company’s current intention to award an increase of that size in total in any one year, or in each year, and instead it is a maximum required to be disclosed under the regulations.

 

(2) The award may be retained if the CEO has left the Group in certain circumstances.

 

LOGO Section 4.3.8 for payments on loss of office

 

(3)  A DEP is provided when the award vests (or is exercised). The CEO will receive the value of dividends that would have been payable on ordinary BHP Billiton shares over the period from grant to vest (or exercise). The Committee intends that DEP will be provided in the form of shares, although the plan accommodates a cash equivalent. A DEP is not provided in relation to any STI and LTI awards that are forfeited or lapse.

 

(4)  BHP Billiton’s TSR is a weighted average of the TSRs of BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc.

 

(5) 

The maximum award permitted with the LTIP rules (as approved by shareholders at the 2013 AGMs) is expressed as a fair value equal to 200 per cent of base salary. A fair value takes into account the probability of meeting the performance condition and other factors. The current plan design (for FY2014 and FY2015

 

284


Table of Contents
  awards) produces a fair value of 41 per cent of face value. The maximum fair value of 200 per cent of base salary is therefore currently equivalent to a face value of 488 per cent of base salary (488% x 41% = 200%). This is shown as the Exceptional Maximum Award in the table. However, it is current policy to provide a maximum award of 400 per cent of base salary which is therefore shown in the table as the Normal Maximum Award. In any case, all LTI awards to the CEO will only be provided with prior approval by shareholders in the relevant AGMs.

 

(6)  The weighted median TSR means the median outcome when the companies are listed by their TSR, after weighting by market capitalisation.

 

(7)  The fair value is calculated by the Committee’s independent adviser, Kepler Associates. It reflects outcomes weighted by probability, taking into account the difficulty of achieving the performance conditions and the correlation between these and share price appreciation, together with other factors, including volatility and forfeiture risks. The fair value for the current plan design (current comparator groups, outperformance percentage, etc.) is 41 per cent of the face value of an award. This fair value of 41 per cent may change should the Committee vary elements (such as adding a performance measure or altering the level of relative TSR outperformance) not specified in this remuneration policy report. This fair value is different from the fair value used for IFRS disclosures elsewhere in this report. In particular, the IFRS fair value does not take into account forfeiture conditions on the awards.

Malus and clawback

The STIP and LTIP provisions allow the Committee to reduce or clawback awards in the following circumstances:

 

  the participant acting fraudulently or dishonestly or being in material breach of their obligations to the Group;

 

  where BHP Billiton becomes aware of a material misstatement or omission in the financial statements of a Group company or the Group; or

 

  any circumstances occur that the Committee determines in good faith to have resulted in an unfair benefit to the participant.

These malus and clawback provisions apply whether or not awards are made in the form of cash or equity, and whether or not the equity has vested.

Legacy incentive plans under which awards may vest

The remuneration policy approved by shareholders is required to cover awards which were granted under legacy plans and which may vest in the future on their existing terms. Key terms are shown in the table below.

 

Remuneration component
and link to strategy

  

Operation and performance framework

  

Maximum value on
vesting

STI under the GIS

 

The former GIS was replaced by the STIP (described in the previous table) from FY2014. Awards were provided for the same purpose as the STIP.

  

•    The terms of STI awards provided under the GIS were similar to those provided under the STIP.

 

•    Awards were provided to the CEO for performance in FY2013, and are scheduled to vest in August 2015.

 

•     LOGO  Section 4.4.20 for a table of awards held under the GIS

   The face value of the award on vesting plus the value of any associated DEP.

 

285


Table of Contents

Remuneration component
and link to strategy

  

Operation and performance framework

  

Maximum value on
vesting

LTI under the former LTIP

 

The former LTIP was replaced by the new LTIP (described in the previous table) from FY2014. Awards were provided for the same purpose as the new LTIP.

  

•    The terms of LTI awards provided under the former LTIP were similar to those provided under the new LTIP as described in the previous table, including the performance conditions.

 

•    Awards provided to the CEO in December 2010, 2011, and 2012 are due to vest from FY2016 to FY2018 to the extent that the performance conditions are met.

 

•     LOGO  Section 4.4.21 for a table of awards held under the former LTIP

   The face value of the awards on vesting plus the value of any associated DEP.

4.3.4    Approach to recruitment and promotion remuneration

The ongoing remuneration arrangements for a newly recruited or promoted CEO, or for another Executive Director should one be appointed, will reflect the remuneration policy as set out in this report. The ongoing components will therefore comprise base salary, pension contributions, benefits, STI and LTI.

A market competitive level of base salary, benefits and pension contributions will be provided to a newly recruited or promoted CEO, or another Executive Director. The same maximum STI and LTI apply as per the remuneration policy for the current CEO. The combined maximum level of STI and LTI that may be provided is 728 per cent of base salary, which is the combination of the maximum 240 per cent of base salary in STI and the exceptional maximum 488 per cent of base salary in LTI as per the remuneration policy for the CEO.

For external appointments, the Remuneration Committee may determine that it is appropriate to provide additional cash and/or equity components to replace any remuneration forfeited from a former employer. It is anticipated that any foregone equity awards would be replaced by equity. The value of the replacement remuneration would not be any greater than the fair value of the awards forgone (as determined by the Committee’s independent adviser). The Committee would determine appropriate service conditions and performance conditions within BHP Billiton’s framework, taking into account the conditions attached to the forgone award. The Committee is mindful of limiting such payments and not providing any more compensation than is necessary.

For any internal CEO (or another Executive Director) appointments, any entitlements provided under former arrangements will be honoured according to their existing terms.

4.3.5    Consideration of employment conditions elsewhere in the Group

When setting remuneration for the CEO, the Remuneration Committee considers the prevailing market conditions, the competitive environment and the positioning and relativities of pay and employment conditions across the wider BHP Billiton workforce.

The Committee is briefed regularly about the pay and conditions of the wider employee population, and takes into account the annual base salary increases for our employee population when determining any change in the CEO’s base salary. Salary increases in Australia, where the CEO is located, are particularly relevant, as they reflect the local economic conditions.

The principles that underpin the remuneration policy for the CEO are the same as those that apply to other employees, although the CEO’s arrangements have a greater emphasis on performance-related pay and a higher proportion of the CEO’s total remuneration is variable in the form of STI and LTI. Like those for the CEO, the performance measures used to determine STI outcomes for all employees are linked to achievement of the Group’s strategy and behaviours aligned to the values in Our Charter.

 

286


Table of Contents

Although BHP Billiton does not consult directly with employees on Directors’ remuneration, the Group conducts regular employee engagement surveys which give employees an opportunity to provide feedback on remuneration matters. Many employees are ordinary shareholders and have the opportunity to vote on AGM resolutions. In FY2014 more than 27,000 employees enrolled to purchase BHP Billiton shares under Shareplus, our all-employee share plan.

4.3.6    Consideration of shareholder views

Part of the Board’s commitment to high-quality governance is expressed through the approach we take to engaging and communicating with shareholders. We encourage shareholders to make their views known to us.

Our shareholders are based across the globe. Regular proactive engagement on remuneration and governance matters takes place with institutional shareholders and investor representative organisations. This is overseen by the Remuneration Committee Chairman (who is also the Senior Independent Director).

In addition, shareholders can contact us at any time through our Investor Relations team, with contact details available on our website: www.bhpbilliton.com.

Feedback from shareholders and investors is shared with the Board and Remuneration Committee through the Chairman and the Remuneration Committee Chairman and is used as input to decision-making by the Board and the Committee, in respect of executive remuneration policy and application. In particular, this feedback has had a direct bearing on the Committee’s decisions in formulating this remuneration policy report content.

The Committee considers that this approach provides a robust mechanism to ensure Directors are aware of matters raised, have a good understanding of current shareholder views, and formulate policy and make decisions as appropriate.

4.3.7    Potential remuneration outcomes for the CEO

While the Remuneration Committee recognises that market forces necessarily influence remuneration practices, it strongly believes that the fundamental driver of remuneration outcomes should be business performance. It also believes that overall remuneration should be both fair to the individual and commensurate with the expectations of our shareholders.

Accordingly, while target total remuneration is structured to attract and retain a high calibre CEO, the amount of remuneration actually received each year depends on:

 

  the achievement of superior business and individual performance;

 

  generating sustained shareholder value from relative outperformance;

 

  the view of the Committee as to what is fair to the individual and commensurate with shareholder expectations.

STI and LTI are the two components of remuneration that are measured on business performance, with the outcome assessed against pre-determined performance conditions.

The minimum amount the CEO could earn in respect of FY2015 is US$2.217 million, which is fixed remuneration, and made up of his base salary of US$1.700 million, pension contributions of US$0.425 million and benefits of US$0.092 million.

The maximum is US$13.097 million. This assumes he earns the maximum under the STI of US$4.080 million and the normal maximum under the LTI of US$6.800 million. All of these components are shown in the table below at the minimum, target and maximum levels. The normal maximum amount of the LTI has been calculated on the basis of full vesting at the share price on the date of grant. The normal maximum LTI is 400 per cent of base salary.

 

287


Table of Contents

Before deciding on the final outcome for the CEO (and for other members of the GMC), the Committee first considers the outcome against the pre-determined performance conditions. It then applies its overarching discretion. It can exercise discretion downwards only (i.e. to reduce remuneration).

When the CEO was appointed in May 2013, the Board advised him that the Committee would exercise its discretion on the basis of what it considered to be a fair and commensurate remuneration level to decide if the outcome should be reduced.

To be fair to the individual, remuneration levels need to accurately reflect the CEO’s responsibilities and contributions. To be commensurate with the expectations of shareholders, remuneration levels need to reflect the expectations of our shareholders that their Company’s funds would be used to remunerate our employees in a way that is proportionate to both performance and overall value.

In this way, the Committee believes it can set a remuneration level for the CEO that is sufficient to incentivise him and that is also fair to him and commensurate with shareholder expectations and prevailing market conditions. These same considerations led the Committee to set the incoming CEO’s remuneration when he was appointed in 2013 at a lower level than the previous level for this role.

The diagram below shows the relative proportion of each remuneration component for the CEO if the minimum, target and maximum levels of performance were achieved.

 

LOGO

 

(1)  Fixed remuneration comprises base salary (US$1.700 million per annum), pension contributions (25 per cent of base salary) and other benefits (US$0.092 million). The amount included for other benefits is based on FY2014 actual figures for the CEO, excluding non-recurring items.

 

(2)  The STI target amount is based on target performance of 160 per cent of base salary. The STI maximum amount is based on a maximum award of 240 per cent of base salary. The impact of potential future share price movements (up and down) on the value of deferred STI awards is not included.

 

(3)  The LTI amount (target and maximum) is based on the CEO’s normal maximum award equal to the face value of 400 per cent of base salary, which is lower than the maximum permissible award size under the plan rules. The ‘target’ value for the LTI award is based on the fair value of the award, which is 41 per cent of the face value, as this is the expected outcome on the balance of probabilities for the current plan design as calculated by the independent advisor to the Remuneration Committee, Kepler Associates. The minimum value for the LTI award is zero, and applies where the relative TSR of BHP Billiton is lower than the Peer Group and/or Index TSR (as applicable for each grant). The impact of potential future share price movements (up and down) on the value of LTI awards is not included.

 

LOGO Section 4.3.3 for more information on the components of remuneration for the CEO

 

288


Table of Contents

4.3.8    Service contracts and policy on loss of office

The terms of employment for the CEO are formalised in his employment contract. Key terms of the current contract and relevant payments on loss of office are shown below. If a new CEO or another Executive Director was appointed, similar contractual terms would apply, other than where the Remuneration Committee determines that different terms should apply for reasons specific to the individual.

The CEO’s contract has no fixed term. It can be terminated by BHP Billiton on 12 months’ notice. BHP Billiton can terminate the contract immediately by paying base salary plus pension contributions for the notice period. The CEO must give six months’ notice for voluntary resignation. The table below sets out the basis on which payments on loss of office may be made.

 

    

Leaving reason (1) (2)

      Voluntary
resignation
  

Termination for
cause

  

Death, serious
injury, disability
or illness (3)

  

Cessation of
employment with
the agreement of
the Board (4)

Base salary

  

•  Base salary for the notice period will be paid as a lump sum or progressively over the notice period.

  

•  No payment will be made.

  

•  Base salary will be paid for a period of up to four months, after which time employment may cease.

  

•  Base salary for the notice period will be paid as a lump sum or progressively over the notice period.

         

Pension

  

•  Pension contributions for the notice period will be paid as a lump sum or progressively over the notice period.

  

•  No pension contributions will be provided from the date of termination.

  

•  Pension contributions will be paid for a period of up to four months, after which time employment may cease.

  

•  Pension contributions for the notice period will be paid as a lump sum or progressively over the notice period.

         

Benefits

  

•  Applicable benefits may continue to be provided during the notice period.

 

•  Accumulated annual leave entitlements and any statutory payments will also be paid.

 

•  Applicable expenses may be paid for repatriation to the home location where a relocation has been requested by BHP Billiton.

 

  

•  No benefits will be provided.

 

•  Accumulated annual leave entitlements and any statutory payments will be paid.

 

•  Applicable expenses may be paid for repatriation to the home location where a relocation has been requested by BHP Billiton.

 

  

•  Applicable benefits may continue to be provided during the notice period.

 

•  Accumulated annual leave entitlements and any statutory payments will also be paid.

 

•  Applicable expenses may be paid for repatriation to the home location where a relocation has been requested by BHP Billiton.

 

  

•  Applicable benefits may continue to be provided for the relevant year in which employment ceases.

 

•  Accumulated annual leave entitlements and any statutory payments will also be paid.

 

 

289


Table of Contents
    

Leaving reason (1) (2)

      Voluntary
resignation
  

Termination for
cause

  

Death, serious
injury, disability
or illness (3)

  

Cessation of
employment with
the agreement of
the Board (4)

    

• Unvested Shareplus Matched Shares will lapse.

 

  

• Unvested Shareplus Matched Shares will lapse.

  

• Unvested Shareplus Matched Shares will vest in full.

 

  

• Applicable expenses may be paid for repatriation to the home location where a relocation has been requested by BHP Billiton.

 

• Unvested Shareplus Matched Shares will vest in full.

STI

Where CEO leaves during the financial year or after the end of the financial year, but before an award is provided.

  

• No STI will be paid.

  

• No STI will be paid.

  

• The Committee may determine in its discretion to pay an amount in respect of the participant’s performance for that year.

  

• The Committee may determine in its discretion to pay an amount in respect of the participant’s performance for that year.

 

Unvested STIP equity

  

• Will lapse.

  

• Will lapse.

  

• Will vest in full.

  

• Will continue to be held, on the existing terms, for the scheduled deferral period before vesting (subject to a Committee discretion to lapse some or all of the award).

 

• The awards remain subject to malus and clawback.

 

290


Table of Contents
    

Leaving reason (1) (2)

      Voluntary
resignation
  

Termination for
cause

  

Death, serious
injury, disability
or illness (3)

  

Cessation of
employment with
the agreement of
the Board (4)

Vested but unexercised STIP equity   

•  Will remain exercisable for the rest of the exercise period, unless the Committee determines they will lapse.

  

•  Will remain exercisable for the rest of the exercise period, unless the Committee determines they will lapse.

  

•  Will remain exercisable for the rest of the exercise period.

  

•  Will remain exercisable for the rest of the exercise period, or for a reduced exercise period, unless the Committee determines they will lapse.

Unvested GIS equity   

•  Will lapse.

  

•  Will lapse.

  

•  Will vest in full.

  

•  Will vest in full, except in the case of a leaving reason not specified in the plan rules, in which case the Committee has discretion to determine the treatment of equity awards.

Vested GIS Options (with a market-based exercise price) previously provided to the CEO – if still held on leaving.   

•  Will be retained for the scheduled exercise period, and on the existing terms.

  

•  Will lapse.

  

•  Will be retained for the scheduled exercise period, and on the existing terms.

  

•  Will be retained for the scheduled exercise period, and on the existing terms.

LTI

Unvested awards

  

•  Will lapse.

  

•  Will lapse.

  

•  Will vest in full.

  

•  A pro rata portion of unvested awards (based on the proportion of the performance period served) will continue to be held subject to the LTIP rules and terms of grant. The balance will lapse.

 

•  The awards remain subject to malus and clawback.

 

291


Table of Contents
    

Leaving reason (1) (2)

      Voluntary
resignation
  

Termination for
cause

  

Death, serious
injury, disability
or illness (3)

  

Cessation of
employment with
the agreement of
the Board (4)

Vested but unexercised awards   

•  Will remain exercisable for the rest of the exercise period, unless the Committee determines they will lapse.

  

•  Will remain exercisable for the rest of the exercise period, unless the Committee determines they will lapse.

  

•  Will remain exercisable for the rest of the exercise period.

  

•  Will remain exercisable for the rest of the exercise period, or for a reduced exercise period, unless the Committee determines they will lapse.

 

(1)  If the Committee considers it to be necessary, BHP Billiton may enter into agreements with a CEO which may include the settlement of liabilities in return for payment(s), including reimbursement of legal fees subject to appropriate conditions; or to enter into new arrangements with the departing CEO (for example, entering into consultancy arrangements).

 

(2)  In the event of a change in control event (e.g. takeover, compromise or arrangement, winding up of the Company) as defined in the STIP and LTIP rules:

 

    base salary, pension contributions and benefits will be paid until the date of the change of control event;

 

    the Committee may determine that a cash payment be made in respect of performance during the current financial year and all unvested STI equity awards would vest in full; and

 

    the Committee may determine that unvested LTI awards will either vest to the extent that the Committee determines appropriate (with reference to performance against the performance condition up to the date of the change of control event and expectations regarding future performance) or that the awards be lapsed if the Committee determines that the holders will participate in an acceptable alternative employee equity plan as a term of the change of control event.

 

(3)  Defined as occurring when a participant leaves BHP Billiton due to death, serious injury, disability or illness that prohibits continued employment or total and permanent disablement.

 

(4)  Defined as occurring when a participant leaves BHP Billiton due to forced early retirement, retrenchment or redundancy, termination by mutual agreement or retirement with the agreement of the Company, or such other circumstances that do not constitute resignation or termination for cause.

 

292


Table of Contents

Remuneration policy for Non-executive Directors

Our Non-executive Directors are paid in compliance with the UK Corporate Governance Code (2012) and the ASX Corporate Governance Council’s Principles and Recommendations (3rd Edition).

4.3.9    Components of remuneration

The following table shows the components of total remuneration for Non-executive Directors, the link to strategy, how each component operates, and how performance is assessed and will impact remuneration and the maximum opportunity for each component.

 

Remuneration component and link
to strategy

  

Operation and performance
framework

  

Maximum (1)

Fees

• Competitive base fees are paid in order to attract and retain high-quality individuals, and to provide appropriate remuneration for the role undertaken.

 

• Committee fees are provided to recognise the additional responsibilities, time and commitment required.

 

  

• The Chairman is paid a single fee for all responsibilities.

 

• Non-executive Directors are paid a base fee and relevant committee membership fees.

 

• Committee Chairmen and the Senior Independent Director are paid an additional fee to reflect their extra responsibilities.

 

• All fee levels are reviewed annually and any changes are effective from 1 July.

 

• Fees are set at a competitive level with advice on benchmark fees in equivalent size companies provided by external advisers. Fee levels reflect the size and complexity of the Group, the multi-jurisdictional environment arising from the Dual Listed Company structure, the multiple stock exchange listings and the extent of the geographic regions in which the Group operates. The economic environment and the financial performance of the Group are taken into account. Consideration is also given to salary reviews across the rest of the Group.

 

•  LOGO Section 4.4.13 for current fee levels provided to Non- executive Directors

  

8% increase per annum (annualised), or inflation if higher in the location in which duties are primarily performed, on a per fee basis.

 

293


Table of Contents

Remuneration component and link
to strategy

  

Operation and performance
framework

  

Maximum (1)

Pension

• As required by law.

  

• Pension contributions provided on fees only where required by law.

   As required by law.

Benefits

     

Travel allowances

 

• Competitive benefits are paid in order to attract and retain high-quality individuals and adequately compensate for the considerable travel burden.

  

• Non-executive Directors receive travel allowances on a per trip basis reflecting the considerable travel burden imposed on members of the Board as a consequence of the Dual Listed Company structure and the resulting Board meetings in Australia and the UK, along with site visits at our multiple geographic locations.

   8% increase per annum (annualised), or inflation if higher in the location in which duties are primarily performed, on a per-trip basis.

Other benefits

 

• Competitive benefits are paid in order to attract and retain high-quality individuals, and to provide appropriate remuneration for the role undertaken.

 

  

• As a consequence of the Dual Listed Company structure, Non-executive Directors are required to prepare personal tax returns in both Australia and the UK, regardless of whether they reside in one or neither of those countries. They are accordingly reimbursed for the costs of personal tax return preparation in whichever of the UK and/or Australia is not their place of residence (including payment of the tax cost associated with the provision of the benefit).

 

• Non-executive Directors may from time to time be accompanied by their spouse/partner to business meetings. The costs associated with spouse/partner attendance at one business meeting per annum are met by BHP Billiton and, in some instances, they are deemed to be taxable benefits for the Non-executive Director. In such cases BHP Billiton reimburses the Non-executive Director for this tax cost.

   Up to a limit not exceeding 20% of fees.

STI and LTI

  

• Non-executive Directors are not eligible to participate in any STI or LTI arrangements.

  

 

294


Table of Contents

Remuneration component and link
to strategy

  

Operation and performance
framework

   Maximum (1)

Payments on early termination

  

• There are no provisions in any of the Non-executive Directors’ appointment arrangements for compensation payable on early termination of their directorship.

  

 

(1)  UK regulations require the disclosure of the maximum that may be paid in respect of each remuneration component. Where that is expressed as a maximum annual percentage increase which is annualised, it should not be interpreted that it is the Company’s current intention to award an increase of that size in total in any one year, or in each year, and instead it is a maximum required to be disclosed under the regulations.

Approach to recruitment remuneration

The ongoing remuneration arrangements for a newly recruited Non-executive Director will reflect the remuneration policy in place for other Non-executive Directors, as above. The components will therefore comprise fees, pension contributions where required by law and benefits as set out in the table above. No variable remuneration (STI and LTI) will be provided to newly recruited Non-executive Directors.

Letters of appointment and policy on loss of office

The standard letter of appointment for Non-executive Directors is available on our website. The Board has adopted a policy consistent with the UK Corporate Governance Code, under which all Non-executive Directors must seek re-election by shareholders annually, if they wish to remain on the Board. As such no Non-executive Directors seeking re-election have an unexpired term in their letter of appointment.

A Non-executive Director may resign on reasonable notice. No payments are made to Non-executive Directors on loss of office. A legacy arrangement provides accrued retirement benefits under the now closed Retirement Plan of BHP Billiton Limited, and this will continue to be honoured.

LOGO Section 4.4.30 for retirement disclosures for the Non-executive Directors

Considerations when setting Non-executive Director remuneration

When Non-executive Director remuneration is determined, the same considerations in respect of employment conditions elsewhere in the Group and shareholder views, as described in relation to setting remuneration for the CEO, are taken into account.

LOGO Section 4.3.5 for consideration of employment conditions elsewhere in the Group

LOGO Section 4.3.6 for consideration of shareholder views

 

295


Table of Contents

4.4    Annual report on remuneration

This section of the report shows the impact of the remuneration policy in FY2014 and how actual performance outcomes are linked to remuneration outcomes. It is divided as follows:

 

Contents of the annual report on remuneration

4.4.1 to 4.4.4

   Remuneration governance

4.4.5 to 4.4.11

   Remuneration outcomes for the Executive Director (the CEO)

4.4.12 to 4.4.13

   Remuneration outcomes for Non-executive Directors

4.4.14 to 4.4.18

   Remuneration for members of the GMC (other than the CEO)

4.4.19 to 4.4.31

   Other statutory disclosures

Remuneration governance

4.4.1    Board oversight and the Remuneration Committee

The Board is responsible for ensuring that the Group’s remuneration arrangements are equitable and aligned with the long-term interests of BHP Billiton and its shareholders. In performing this function, it is critical that the Board is independent of management when making decisions affecting remuneration of the CEO, the other members of the GMC and the Group’s employees.

The Board has therefore established a Remuneration Committee to assist it in making such decisions. The Committee is comprised solely of Non-executive Directors, all of whom are independent. In order to ensure that it is fully informed, the Committee regularly invites members of management to attend meetings to provide reports and updates. The Committee can draw on services from a range of external sources, including remuneration consultants.

Remuneration Committee

The activities of the Remuneration Committee are governed by Terms of Reference (most recently approved by the Board in June 2013), which are available on our website. The purpose of the Committee is to assist the Board in its oversight of:

 

  the remuneration policy and its specific application to the CEO, the other members of the GMC and its general application to all Group employees;

 

  the determination of levels of reward for the CEO and approval of reward to the other members of the GMC;

 

  the annual evaluation of the performance of the CEO, by providing guidance to the Group Chairman;

 

  communication with shareholders on the Group’s remuneration policy and the Committee’s work on behalf of the Board;

 

  the Group’s compliance with applicable legal and regulatory requirements associated with remuneration matters;

 

  the preparation of the Remuneration Report to be included in the Group’s Annual Report;

 

  the review, at least annually, of remuneration by gender.

 

296


Table of Contents

Remuneration

Committee members

  

•     John Buchanan (Chairman)

•     Carlos Cordeiro

•     Pat Davies

•     John Schubert

•     Carolyn Hewson (appointed 28 January 2014)

Number of meetings in FY2014   

•     Seven

Other individuals who

regularly attended

meetings (1)

  

•     Jac Nasser (Chairman)

•     Andrew Mackenzie (CEO)

•     Karen Wood (President)

•     Mike Fraser (President, Human Resources)

•     Andrew Fitzgerald (Vice President, Group Reward)

•     Jane McAloon (President, Governance and Group Company Secretary)

•     Geof Stapledon (Vice President, Governance)

 

(1)  These individuals were not present when matters associated with their own remuneration were considered.

 

LOGO Section 3.14.2 for further information regarding the Committee

The use of remuneration consultants

The Committee seeks and considers advice from independent remuneration advisors where appropriate. Remuneration consultants are engaged by, and report directly to, the Committee. Potential conflicts of interest are taken into account when remuneration consultants are selected, and their terms of engagement regulate their level of access to, and require their independence from, BHP Billiton’s management. The advice and recommendations of external advisers are used as a guide, but do not serve as a substitute for thorough consideration of the issues by each Director.

Kepler Associates was appointed by the Committee to act as an independent remuneration adviser to provide specialist remuneration advice and does not provide other services to the Group. Kepler Associates is a member of the UK Remuneration Consultants Group, and adheres to its Code of Conduct. During the year, Kepler Associates provided advice and assistance to the Committee on a wide range of matters, including:

 

  advice in regard to remuneration arrangements for the CEO and the members of the GMC;

 

  benchmarking of pay of senior executives against comparable roles at a range of relevant comparator groups, including sector and size peers;

 

  provision of information and commentary on global trends in executive remuneration;

 

  calculation of fair values for accounting and remuneration setting purposes of equity awards and performance analysis for LTI awards;

 

  review of, and commentary on, management proposals;

 

  other ad-hoc support and advice as requested by the Committee.

Kepler Associates is the only remuneration consultant appointed by the Committee.

Remuneration recommendations

As part of its role, Kepler Associates provided ‘remuneration recommendations’ (as defined in the Australian Corporations Act 2001) to the Committee during the year. Each time Kepler Associates provides a remuneration recommendation, Kepler Associates provides a declaration that the remuneration recommendation was made free from undue influence by the individual to whom the recommendation relates. The Board considered the

 

297


Table of Contents

processes outlined above, the constraints incorporated into Kepler Associates’ terms of engagement, the implementation of a comprehensive protocol for the engagement of remuneration advisors and the receipt of the declaration of no undue influence. It is satisfied that the remuneration recommendations received from Kepler Associates were made free from undue influence by any member of the KMP to whom the recommendations related.

Total fees paid to Kepler Associates for the above services for the period from 1 July 2013 to 30 June 2014 were £125,520, of which £51,920 was for attendance at Committee meetings and commentary on management proposals, and a total of £73,600 for the provision of remuneration recommendations and other technical advice and support on executive remuneration.

Management also appoints external firms from time to time to assist with remuneration benchmarking, data provision and the like. While other external firms did provide certain information to management to assist them in deliberations, no remuneration advisor other than Kepler Associates provided remuneration recommendations during the year in relation to KMP.

4.4.2    Prohibition on hedging of BHP Billiton shares and equity instruments

The CEO and other members of the GMC are not allowed to protect the value of any unvested BHP Billiton equity awards allocated to them under employee programmes, or the value of shares and securities held as part of meeting BHP Billiton’s MSR as described below. The policy also prohibits GMC members from using unvested BHP Billiton equity awards as collateral in any financial transaction, including hedging and margin loan arrangements.

Any securities that have vested and are no longer subject to restrictions or performance conditions may be subject to hedging arrangements or used as collateral, provided that consent is obtained from BHP Billiton in advance of the employee entering into the arrangement. BHP Billiton treats compliance with this policy as a serious issue, and takes appropriate measures to ensure that the policy is adhered to.

4.4.3    Share ownership guidelines and the MSR

The share ownership guidelines and the MSR help to ensure that the interests of directors, executives and shareholders remain aligned. For FY2014:

 

  the MSR for the CEO was 500 per cent of annual gross pre-tax base salary and he met the MSR as at the date of this report;

 

  the MSR for other members of the GMC was 300 per cent of annual gross pre-tax base salary and they all met the MSR as at the date of this report apart from Tony Cudmore, Tim Cutt, Geoff Healy and Daniel Malchuk.

The value of equity awards and any other securities for the purposes of the MSR is the market value of the underlying shares. Unvested employee equity awards do not qualify, and neither do any options with a market-based exercise price.

The CEO and other members of the GMC are expected to grow their holdings to the MSR from the scheduled vesting of their employee awards over time. Under the policy, employees are not required to meet the holding requirement before awards are allocated to them. Rather, the MSR is tested at the time that shares are to be sold. The GMC members are entitled to sell sufficient shares to satisfy tax obligations arising from the granting, holding, vesting, exercise or sale of the employee awards or the underlying shares. However, if a GMC member wishes to sell additional shares, they will be prohibited from doing so unless they will meet the MSR after the sale.

 

298


Table of Contents

LOGO Section 4.4.27 for details of share ownership information of the CEO and other members of the GMC

Subject to securities dealing constraints, Non-executive Directors have agreed to apply at least 25 per cent of their remuneration (base fees plus Committee fees) to the purchase of BHP Billiton shares until they achieve a shareholding equivalent in value to one year’s remuneration. Thereafter, they must maintain at least that level of shareholding throughout their tenure. All Non-executive Directors met the MSR as at the date of this report.

LOGO Section 4.4.27 for details of share ownership information of the Non-executive Directors

4.4.4    Statement of voting at the 2013 AGMs

BHP Billiton’s remuneration resolutions have attracted a high level of support by shareholders. Voting in regard to those resolutions put to shareholders at the 2013 AGMs is shown below, in accordance with UK legislation.

 

AGM Resolution

   % vote ‘for’      % vote ‘against’      Votes withheld (1)  

Remuneration Report

     97.28         2.72         19,292,876   

Adoption of new LTIP Rules

     97.22         2.78         41,873,567   

Approval of grants to Executive Director

     97.28         2.72         17,772,663   

 

(1) The sum of votes marked ‘Vote Withheld’ at BHP Billiton Plc’s AGM and votes marked ‘Abstain’ at BHP Billiton Limited’s AGM.

Remuneration outcomes for the Executive Director (the CEO)

The CEO remuneration policy that applied in FY2014 is the same as set out in the remuneration policy report, and the remuneration outcomes described below have therefore been provided in accordance with that same policy.

LOGO Section 4.3 for the remuneration policy for the CEO

4.4.5    Single total figure of remuneration

This section shows a single total figure of remuneration as prescribed under UK requirements. It is a measure of actual remuneration and is not intended to meet IFRS accounting standards.

LOGO Section 4.4.19 for the Statutory IFRS Remuneration table

This measure of remuneration is required to be reported only in relation to the performance of the services of an Executive Director. As Andrew Mackenzie assumed the role of CEO and Executive Director in May 2013, the FY2013 figures therefore relate only to a part-year period.

 

US dollars (’000)

          Base salary      Benefits      STI (1)      LTI      Pension      Total  

Andrew Mackenzie

     FY2014         1,700         92         3,136         2,635         425         7,988   
     FY2013         242         702         256         1,208         60         2,468   

 

(1)  Provided half in cash and half in deferred equity as shown in the table below.

 

299


Table of Contents

For Mr Mackenzie, the single total figure of remuneration is calculated as set out below.

 

    

FY2013 – 10 May to 30 June 2013

  

FY2014

Base salary

   Base salary earned for the period, based on a full-year base salary in the CEO role of US$1.700 million.    Base salary earned from 1 July 2013 to 30 June 2014 based on a full-year base salary of US$1.700 million as Mr Mackenzie did not receive any salary increase for FY2014.

Benefits (1)

LOGO  Section 4.3.3 for policy for specific benefits

   Personal tax return preparation in required countries, a pro-rated portion of private family health insurance, plus the full amount of the US$0.700 million relocation allowance paid in respect of Mr Mackenzie’s move from the UK to Australia.    The full amount of private family health insurance and personal tax return preparation in required countries provided during FY2014, together with spouse business-related travel.

STI

LOGO  Section 4.4.6 for how STI is determined

   A pro-rated portion of STI awarded for FY2013 performance. Half or US$0.128 million was provided in cash in September 2013, and half or US$0.128 million deferred in an equity award, which is due to vest in FY2016.    STI awarded for FY2014 performance. Half or US$1.568 million will be provided in cash in September 2014, and half or US$1.568 million deferred in an equity award (subject to shareholder approval at the 2014 AGMs), which will be due to vest in FY2017.

LTI

LOGO Section 4.4.7 for the LTI performance condition

 

LOGO Section 4.4.8 for LTI awarded during FY2014

   A pro-rated portion of the value of 243,126 LTI awards that vested on 22 August 2013, based on performance during the five-year period to 30 June 2013. The total value of that award (based on a share price on 22 August 2013 of £19.20, converted to US dollars on that date) plus the associated DEP (of US$1.017 million) on the date of vesting and exercise was US$8.480 million.    The value of 69,600 LTI awards that vested on 20 August 2014, based on performance during the five-year period to 30 June 2014. This value of that award is based on a share price on 20 August 2014 of £19.65, (converted to US dollars on that date) plus the associated DEP of US$0.359 million.

Pension

   BHP Billiton’s contribution to defined contribution pension plans during the period at 25% of base salary.    BHP Billiton’s contribution to defined contribution pension plans at 25% of base salary.

 

(1)  Although eligible, the CEO does not currently participate in Shareplus, for reasons of administrative simplicity in terms of stock exchange dealings and announcements.

 

300


Table of Contents

When the components of remuneration are provided

The following graph illustrates the usual time frame for delivery of the components of remuneration. It shows how STI and LTI outcomes are deferred.

 

LOGO

4.4.6    FY2014 STI performance outcomes

The CEO scorecard for the FY2014 performance year is summarised in the following table. A description of each performance measure and the CEO’s level of achievement, as determined by the Committee, are shown below the table. The performance range is set for each measure with the level of performance determined on a range of Threshold (the minimum necessary to qualify for any reward outcome), Target (where the performance requirements are met), and Stretch (where the performance requirements are exceeded).

 

LOGO

HSEC

The HSEC KPI for the CEO is aligned to the Group’s suite of HSEC Five Year Public Targets as set out in BHP Billiton’s Sustainability Report. As it has done for several years, the Remuneration Committee sought guidance from the Sustainability Committee when assessing HSEC performance. The Sustainability Committee reviewed performance against each of the designated measures. Consistent with prior years, the Remuneration Committee then took a holistic view of how the Group had performed in critical areas.

Targets for FY2014

 

  Fatalities, environmental and community incidents: Nil fatalities and nil actual significant environmental and community incidents.

 

  TRIF and occupational illness: Improved performance compared with FY2013 results, with severity and trends to be considered as a moderating influence on the overall HSEC assessment.

 

  Risk management: The Group is to have all material risks with HSEC impacts recorded and controlled, and to have all critical control designs and critical control assessment test plans reviewed by the material risk owners.

 

301


Table of Contents
  Health, environment and community initiatives: All assets to achieve 100 per cent of targets in respect of occupational exposure reduction, water and greenhouse gas reduction and local procurement.

Performance for FY2014

 

  Fatalities, environmental and community incidents: Zero fatalities occurred in FY2014, with a reduction in the number of potential significant events recorded as well. No significant environmental incidents occurred, and while there was a significant community protest at Cerro Matoso (Columbia), it was well managed without any material impact.

 

  TRIF and occupational illness: TRIF performance for FY2014 was a significant improvement over FY2013, with a nine per cent reduction to a TRIF of 4.2 for FY2014, partly offset by an increase in occupational illness outcomes of 14 per cent in FY2014 compared with FY2013.

 

  Risk management: All material HSEC risks that have been identified are recorded, and critical control assessments have been completed.

 

  Health, environment and community initiatives: Greenhouse gas reduction targets set at the commencement of the year were materially exceeded, with outperformance observed across BHP Billiton. Targets set for reducing occupational health exposures, for water management and local procurement plan development and implementation were achieved.

Attributable profit

Profit after taxation attributable to members of the BHP Billiton Group (attributable profit) is the primary measure used by the Board when assessing the Group’s financial performance. For the purposes of assessing the actual reported outcome against a directly comparable target, the attributable profit KPI is adjusted for changes in commodity prices, foreign exchange movements, and exceptional items to ensure that it appropriately measures outcomes that are within the control and influence of the Group and its executives. Of these, changes in commodity prices are ordinarily the most material due to volatility in prices and the impact on Group revenue.

Targets for FY2014

In respect of FY2014, the Board determined a target for attributable profit of US$13.3 billion, after the adjustments described above.

Performance for FY2014

Attributable profit of US$13.8 billion was reported by BHP Billiton, which was in excess of the target. The drivers of this outperformance were higher than expected sales volumes, particularly in Iron Ore and, to a lesser extent, in Coal, together with positive productivity and cost performance across a range of Businesses, particularly in Aluminium, Manganese and Nickel, and in Coal. These gains were partly offset by the impact of non-cash costs in Copper.

Capital project management (cost and schedule)

Capital project management measures based on the cost and the schedule outcomes for major capital projects in execution are considered to be effective measures of the delivery of our project pipeline, and consistent with other companies in our sector. The cost KPI is adjusted for foreign exchange movements to ensure that it appropriately measures outcomes that are within the control and influence of the Group and its executives.

Targets for FY2014

In respect of FY2014, the Board determined a target for cost of US$23.9 billion, after adjusting for foreign exchange movements, and a target for schedule of 36.0 months which are weighted averages of the portfolio of major projects under development.

 

302


Table of Contents

Performance for FY2014

The outcome of US$24.0 billion on cost was slightly behind the target. While the performance outcome on schedule was nominally on target at 36.0 months, the actual outcome was determined to be marginally behind target for the purposes of STI outcomes. While the majority of major capital projects proceeded in accordance with approved targets, cost budgets were exceeded on certain projects in Copper and Iron Ore, while favourable cost outcomes were observed in respect of certain other projects in Coal and Iron Ore. Negative impacts on schedule were observed on certain major capital projects in Copper, Iron Ore and Petroleum and Potash, while certain other projects progressed ahead of approved schedule in Iron Ore and Coal.

Individual performance measures for the CEO

Individual measures for the CEO are determined at the commencement of the financial year. The application of personal, qualitative measures remains an important element of effective performance management. These measures seek to provide a balance between the financial and non-financial performance requirements that maintain our position as a leader in our industry.

Targets for FY2014

The CEO’s individual measures for FY2014 comprised contribution to the overall performance of the Group and the management team, and delivery against projects and initiatives within the scope of the CEO role as set out by the Board, including productivity and cost improvement, enhanced stakeholder relations and portfolio optimisation.

Performance for FY2014

The CEO has completed his first full financial year in the role, and is considered by the Committee to have performed well against the individual measures set at the commencement of the year, as set out above. The CEO has contributed positively to the performance of the Company and the GMC, significant productivity improvements have been achieved during FY2014, relations with stakeholders have improved, and the Group’s portfolio optimisation efforts are progressing well. Accordingly, the Committee is of the view the CEO has performed ahead of target on individual measures.

4.4.7    LTI performance outcomes

LTI vested based on performance to June 2014

The five-year performance period for the 2009 LTI awards ended on 30 June 2014. The CEO’s 2009 LTI comprised 120,000 awards, subject to achievement of the relative TSR performance condition, and any discretion applied by the Remuneration Committee as described below.

Testing the performance condition

For the award to vest in full, BHP Billiton was required to deliver a TSR that exceeded the Peer Group TSR by an average of 5.5 per cent per year for five years, being 30.7 per cent in total compounded over the five-year performance period from 1 July 2009 to 30 June 2014.

LOGO Section 4.3.3 for the definition of Peer Group TSR

In respect of the 2009 LTI, the Peer Group TSR was 42.8 per cent, compared to BHP Billiton’s TSR of 60.6 per cent. Accordingly, BHP Billiton outperformed its peer companies by 17.8 per cent, and therefore 58 per cent of awards vested. As a result, 69,600 of the CEO’s 2009 LTI award (granted under the former LTIP) vested on 20 August 2014. The closing price of ordinary BHP Billiton Limited shares on the LSE on that date was £19.65 and so the value of the vested award was US$2.635 million, including the associated DEP of US$0.359 million in relation to dividends over the five-year performance period in the form of shares (by applying the net cash DEP towards the purchase of ordinary BHP Billiton Limited shares for the CEO).

 

303


Table of Contents

If BHP Billiton’s relative performance had been equal to or less than the Peer Group TSR, then Threshold vesting would not have been achieved, and none of the award would have vested.

LOGO Section 4.4.8 for the 2009 peer group companies

The impact of the TSR outperformance by BHP Billiton was to add US$25 billion of shareholder value from 1 July 2009 to 30 June 2014 over and above the weighted average performance of the comparators, as shown in the graphs below. Starting from the LTI award scheduled to vest next year, being the LTI allocated in 2010, relative TSR will be measured against both a peer group, and also a broader market index.

Application of discretion to reduce vesting

The rules of the LTIP and the terms and conditions of the award give the Committee an overarching discretion to reduce the number of awards that will vest, notwithstanding the fact that the performance condition for partial or full vesting has been met.

In accordance with its overarching discretion, the Committee has considered the TSR outcome in the context of the Group’s performance over the five-year performance period and determined that the recorded TSR outcome is a fair reflection of performance.

This qualitative judgement, which is applied before final vesting is confirmed, is an important risk management aspect to ensure that vesting is not simply driven by a formula that may give unexpected or unintended remuneration outcomes. The Committee considers its discretion carefully each year, taking account of the circumstances that are relevant to the five-year period under consideration.

LOGO Section 4.4.25 for a five-year history of BHP Billiton share prices and dividends

The graphs below show BHP Billiton’s performance under the 2009 LTIP performance condition.

 

LOGO

  

LOGO

 

304


Table of Contents

The graph below shows BHP Billiton’s comparative performance against the ASX 100, FTSE 100 and the MSCI World index.

 

LOGO

LTI vested during FY2014 based on performance to June 2013

As detailed in last year’s Remuneration Report, the five-year performance period for the 2008 LTIP ended on 30 June 2013. For awards to vest in full, BHP Billiton was required to deliver a TSR that exceeded the Peer Group TSR of a by an average of 5.5 per cent per year for five years, being 30.7 per cent in total compounded over the five-year performance period. The Peer Group TSR was negative 44.0 per cent, which compared to BHP Billiton’s TSR of negative 9.4 per cent. As a result, BHP Billiton outperformed its peer companies by 34.6 per cent, and therefore met the requisite performance condition for full vesting.

LOGO Section 4.3.3 for the definition of Peer Group TSR

LOGO Section 4.4.8 for the 2008 peer group companies

As described above, the Committee then considered their overarching discretion under the LTIP rules to reduce the number of awards that vested, notwithstanding the fact that the performance condition for full vesting had been met. The Committee, with the support of the Board, exercised that discretion and reduced vesting by 35 per cent for all participants. Accordingly, 35 per cent of the CEO’s awards did not vest and instead lapsed.

In applying its discretion, the Committee took into account a range of factors, including the negative TSR over the five-year performance period that shareholders have experienced. While the Committee recognised that the TSR was delivered in a difficult business environment, it also felt that more closely aligning the experience of shareholders and executives was important. As always, the Committee also looked at the total remuneration for executives. While the Committee exercised its discretion in respect of the 2008 LTIP vesting, based on its consideration of all relevant factors, this does not imply that the discretion will or will not be exercised to reduce the vesting result in future years.

LOGO Section 4.4.5 for the number and value of vested LTI awards for the CEO

4.4.8    LTI allocated during FY2014

Following shareholder approval at the 2013 AGMs, an LTI award was granted to the CEO on 18 December 2013. The face value and fair value of the award are shown in the table below.

 

Number of LTI
rights (1)

  

Face value

US$ (‘000) (2)

  

Face value

% of salary

  

Fair value

US$ (‘000) (3)

  

Fair value

% of salary

  

% of max (4)

198,514

   6,800    400    2,788    164    82

 

(1)  The number of LTI rights is calculated by dividing the face value by the average closing share price over the 12 months up to and including the grant date (being A$35.33) and rounding down to the nearest number of rights.

 

305


Table of Contents
(2)  The face value of the award was determined as 400 per cent of Andrew Mackenzie’s base salary of US$1.700 million.

 

(3)  The fair value of the award is calculated by multiplying the face value of the award by the fair value factor of 41 per cent (for the current plan design, as determined by Kepler Associates).

 

(4)  The allocation is 82 per cent of the maximum award that may be provided under the LTIP rules. The maximum is a fair value of 200 per cent of base salary, or face value of 488 per cent of base salary, based on the fair value of 41 per cent for the current plan design (488% x 41% = 200%).

Terms of the LTI award

LOGO Section 4.3.3 for the terms of LTI that are set in the remuneration policy for the CEO

In addition to those terms, the Remuneration Committee has determined:

 

  The performance period will be 1 July 2013 to 30 June 2018.

 

  The share price averaging period of six months will be used in the TSR calculations to account for short-term price fluctuations.

 

  BHP Billiton’s performance relative to peers tends to be counter-cyclical. To provide a fair and balanced outcome, TSR relative to the weighted average TSR of sector peer companies selected by the Committee (Peer Group TSR) determined the vesting of 67 per cent of the award. TSR relative to the broad MCSI World index (Index TSR) will determine the vesting of the remaining 33 per cent of the award.

 

  For the whole of either portion of the award to vest, BHP Billiton’s TSR must exceed the Peer Group TSR or the Index TSR (as applicable) by an average of 5.5 per cent per annum. This equates to exceeding average TSR over the five-year performance period by 30.7 per cent. Threshold vesting of each portion of the award occurs where BHP Billiton’s TSR equals the Peer Group TSR or Index TSR (as applicable).

 

  Peer Group TSR is the weighted median TSR for the companies. Each company in the peer group is weighted by market capitalisation to ensure that it is represented appropriately within the TSR calculation. The maximum weighting for any one company is capped at 15 per cent and the minimum is set at one per cent, to reduce sensitivity to any single peer company.

The sector peer group companies for the FY2014 allocations in December 2013 are below, along with those for prior LTI grants.

 

    December
2008 and
2009 (1)
    December
2010 to
2012
    December
2013
 

Resources (75%) (2)

     

Alcoa

                    

Anglo American

                    

Cameco

                    

Consol Energy

          

Fortescue Metals

          

Freeport McMoRan

                    

Glencore Xstrata (3)

                    

Norilsk

                    

Peabody Energy

                    

Rio Tinto

                    

Southern Copper

                    

Teck Cominco

                    

Vale

                    
    December
2008 and
2009 (1)
    December
2010 to
2012
    December
2013
 

Oil and Gas (25%)

     

Andarko Petroleum

          

Apache

                    

BG Group

                    

BP

               

Canadian Natural Res.

          

Chevron

          

ConocoPhillips

          

Devon Energy

                    

EOG Resources

          

Exxon Mobil

               

Occidental Petroleum

          

Shell

               

Woodside Petroleum

                    
 

 

306


Table of Contents

 

(1)  In 2008 and 2009, the share price averaging period used in the TSR calculations to account for short-term price fluctuations was 3 months. This was extended to 6 months from the December 2010 grants.

 

(2)  This peer group was the only comparator group for the 2008 and 2009 LTIP grants. The Index TSR was introduced as a secondary comparator (for 33 per cent of the award) from the December 2010 grant.

 

(3)  GlencoreXstrata has replaced Xstrata in the peer group for December 2008 to 2012 awards from the merger of Glencore and Xstrata in May 2013.

4.4.9    CEO remuneration and returns to shareholders

Five-year CEO remuneration

The table below shows the total remuneration earned by Andrew Mackenzie and Marius Kloppers over the last five years, along with the proportion of maximum opportunity earned in relation to each type of incentive. As Mr Mackenzie assumed the role of CEO in May 2013, the FY2013 total remuneration shown relates only to the period 10 May to 30 June 2013. The FY2013 total remuneration for Mr Kloppers relates only to the period 1 July 2012 to 10 May 2013.

LOGO Section 4.4.5 for the methodology used to calculate the single total figure of remuneration as used in this table

 

Financial year

   FY2010      FY2011      FY2012      FY2013      FY2014  

Andrew Mackenzie

              

Total remuneration (single figure, $’000)

                             2,468         7,988   

STI (% of maximum)

                             47         77   

LTI (% of maximum)

                             65         58   

Marius Kloppers

              

Total remuneration (single figure, $’000)

     14,789         15,755         16,092         15,991           

STI (% of maximum)

     71         69         0         47           

LTI (% of maximum)

     100         100         100         65           

Five-year TSR

The graph below shows BHP Billiton’s TSR against the performance of relevant indices over the same five-year period. The indices shown in the graph were chosen as being broad market indices which include companies of a comparable size and complexity to BHP Billiton.

 

LOGO

 

307


Table of Contents

4.4.10    Change in CEO’s remuneration in FY2014

The table below sets out the CEO’s base salary, benefits and STI amounts earned in respect of FY2014, with the percentage change from FY2013. The table also shows the average change in each element for employees of the Group in Australia (being approximately 26,500 employees). This has been chosen by the Committee as the most appropriate comparison, as the CEO is located in Australia.

 

           Base salary      Benefits      STI  

CEO

     $’000        1,700         92         3,136   
     % change  (1)      0.0         (87.0)         23.2   

Australian employees

     % change (average)        2.3         (10.0)         17.9   

 

(1)  The percentage changes for the CEO have been determined with reference to annualised numbers for FY2013.

4.4.11    Remuneration for the CEO in FY2015

Subject to approval of the remuneration policy by shareholders at the 2014 AGMs, the remuneration for the CEO in FY2015 will be provided in accordance with that policy.

LOGO Section 4.3.3 for the remuneration policy for the CEO

Base salary increase in September 2014

Base salary is reviewed annually, and increases are applicable from 1 September. The CEO will not receive a base salary increase in September 2014 and it will remain unchanged at US$1.700 million per annum for FY2015.

FY2015 STI performance measures

STI awards will be determined and provided on the same basis as set out for FY2014, and the HSEC, attributable profit, capital project management and individual performance measures are unchanged.

LOGO Section 4.4.6 for a description of STI for FY2014, including the performance measures

The performance measures set out in the table below have been set by the Remuneration Committee for the CEO in FY2015.

 

Performance measure

   Weighting     

Target performance

HSEC

     20%      

• Fatalities, Environment and Community Incidents: Nil fatalities and nil actual significant environmental and community incidents.

     

• TRIF and Occupational Illness: Improved performance compared with FY2014 results, with severity and trends to be considered as a moderating influence on the overall HSEC assessment.

     

• HSEC Risk Management: Each Business is to have all material risks with HSEC impacts recorded and controlled. For all material risks Businesses to have all critical control designs and critical control assessment test plans reviewed by the material risk owner.

 

308


Table of Contents

Performance measure

   Weighting     

Target performance

             

• Health, Environment and Community Initiatives: All assets to achieve 100% of planned targets in respect of occupational exposure reduction, water and greenhouse gas projects reduction and local procurement and cultural awareness targets.

Attributable profit

(adjusted for commodity prices foreign exchange movements and exceptional items)

     40%      

• For reasons of commercial sensitivity, the target for attributable profit will not be disclosed in advance; however, we plan to disclose targets and outcomes retrospectively. In the rare instances where this may not be prudent or grounds of commercial sensitivity, we will explain why and give an indication of when they will be disclosed.

Capital project management

(cost and schedule)

     20%      

• For reasons of commercial sensitivity, the targets for capital project management cost and schedule will not be disclosed in advance; however, we plan to disclose targets and outcomes retrospectively. In the rare instances where this may not be prudent or grounds of commercial sensitivity, we will explain why and give an indication of when they will be disclosed.

Individual performance

     20%      

• The CEO’s individual measures for FY2015 comprise contribution to BHP Billiton’s overall performance and the management team, and the delivery of projects and initiatives within the scope of the CEO role as set out by the Board, including portfolio optimisation and simplification, capital management, improvement in leadership capabilities and employee engagement throughout the Group, and GMC member development and succession.

FY2015 LTI award

On the advice of the Committee, the Board has proposed an FY2015 LTI award for the CEO with a face value of US$6.800 million, being 400 per cent of the CEO’s base salary. Taking into account the performance condition as represented by the fair value factor of 41 per cent, the fair value of these awards is US$2.788 million.

The FY2015 LTI award will use the same performance and service conditions, vesting schedule and peer groups as the FY2014 LTI award.

LOGO Section 4.4.8 for a description of LTI for FY2014

If approved by shareholders, this FY2015 LTI award will be granted following the AGMs (i.e. in or around December 2014). The number of awards will be notified to shareholders at the time that they are provided.

 

309


Table of Contents

Remuneration outcomes for Non-executive Directors

The remuneration policy for the Non-executive Directors set out in the remuneration policy report also applied in FY2014, and the remuneration outcomes described below have therefore been provided in accordance with that same policy.

LOGO Section 4.3.9 for the remuneration policy for the Non-executive Directors

The maximum aggregate fees payable to Non-executive Directors (including the Chairman) was approved by shareholders at the 2008 AGMs at US$3.8 million per annum. This sum includes base fees, committee fees and pension contributions. Travel allowances and non-monetary benefits are not included in this limit.

4.4.12    Single total figure of remuneration

This section shows a single total figure of remuneration as prescribed under UK requirements. It is a measure of actual remuneration. As Non-executive Directors do not receive any equity awards as part of their remuneration, this table also meets the requirements of the Australian Corporations Act 2001 and relevant accounting standards.

 

US dollars (’000)

          Fees (1)      Benefits (2)      Pension (3)      Total  

Malcolm Brinded (4)

     2014         42         15                 57   

Malcolm Broomhead

     2014         230         75         12         317   
     2013         230         59         12         301   

John Buchanan

     2014         263         84                 347   
     2013         263         67                 330   

Carlos Cordeiro

     2014         198         103                 301   
     2013         198         115                 313   

David Crawford

     2014         230         69         12         311   
     2013         230         88         12         330   

Pat Davies

     2014         198         88                 286   
     2013         198         118                 316   

Carolyn Hewson

     2014         214         48         12         274   
     2013         203         60         10         273   

Lindsay Maxsted

     2014         263         53         14         330   
     2013         263         69         14         346   

Wayne Murdy

     2014         235         113                 348   
     2013         235         161                 396   

Jac Nasser

     2014         1100         114                 1214   
     2013         1100         107                 1207   

Keith Rumble

     2014         198         129                 327   
     2013         198         154                 352   

John Schubert

     2014         243         45         13         301   
     2013         243         90         12         345   

Shriti Vadera

     2014         203         79                 282   
     2013         203         93                 296   

 

(1) Fees include the annual base fee, plus additional fees as applicable for the Senior Independent Director, Committee Chairs and Committee memberships.

 

LOGO Section 4.4.13 for details of the fee structure for FY2013 and FY2014

 

(2)

The majority of the amounts disclosed for benefits are travel allowances for each Non-executive Director: amounts of between US$15,000 and US$112,000 (US$59,000 and US$119,000 for FY2013). In addition, amounts of between US$ nil and US$5,000 (US$ nil and US$5,000 for FY2013) are included in respect of

 

310


Table of Contents
  tax return preparation; amounts of between US$ nil and US$32,000 (US$ nil and US$25,000 for FY2013) are included in respect of costs associated with spouse/partner attendance at a business meeting location; and amounts of between US$ nil and US$19,000 (US$ nil and US$16,000 for FY2013) are included in respect of reimbursement of the tax cost associated with the provision of taxable benefits.

 

(3) BHP Billiton Limited made minimum superannuation contributions of 9.25 per cent of fees for FY2014 in accordance with Australian superannuation legislation (increasing to 9.5 per cent of fees paid in FY2015).

 

(4) The FY2014 remuneration for Malcolm Brinded relates to part of that year only, as he joined the Board on 15 April 2014.

4.4.13     Non-executive Directors’ remuneration in FY2015

Subject to approval of the remuneration policy by shareholders at the 2014 AGMs, the remuneration for the Non-executive Directors in FY2015 will be provided in accordance with that policy.

LOGO Section 4.3.9 for the remuneration policy for the Non-executive Directors

Fees for the Non-executive Directors are determined by the Chairman and the CEO. The Non-executive Directors do not take part in these discussions. Fees for the Chairman are determined by the Board on the recommendation of the Remuneration Committee.

Fees for the Non-executive Directors and Chairman were reviewed in June 2014 and benchmarked against peer companies, with the assistance of externally provided benchmark data. As a result of the review, a decision was taken to keep FY2015 fees unchanged from FY2014. The table below sets out the fee levels for FY2015, and the changes in fee levels since FY2011.

 

Levels of fees and travel allowances
for Non-executive Directors
(in US dollars)

   From 1 July
2010
     From 1 July
2011
     From 1 July
2012
     From 1 July
2013
     From 1 July
2014
 

Base annual fee

     154,000         170,000         170,000         170,000         170,000   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Plus additional fees for:

              

Senior Independent Director of BHP Billiton Plc

     35,000         48,000         48,000         48,000         48,000   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Committee Chair:

              

Risk and Audit

     55,000         60,000         60,000         60,000         60,000   

Finance (1)

                     60,000         60,000         60,000   

Remuneration

     40,000         45,000         45,000         45,000         45,000   

Sustainability

     40,000         45,000         45,000         45,000         45,000   

Nomination

    
 
No additional
fees
 
  
    
 
No additional
fees
 
  
    
 
No additional
fees
 
  
    
 
No additional
fees
 
  
    
 
No additional
fees
 
  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Committee membership:

              

Risk and Audit

     30,000         32,500         32,500         32,500         32,500   

Finance (1)

                     32,500         32,500         32,500   

Remuneration

     25,000         27,500         27,500         27,500         27,500   

Sustainability

     25,000         27,500         27,500         27,500         27,500   

Nomination

    
 
No additional
fees
 
  
    
 
No additional
fees
 
  
    
 
No additional
fees
 
  
    
 
No additional
fees
 
  
    
 
No additional
fees
 
  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Travel allowance: (2)

              

Greater than 3 but less than 10 hours

     7,000         7,000         7,000         7,000         7,000   

10 hours or more

     15,000         15,000         15,000         15,000         15,000   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Chairman’s remuneration

     1,000,000         1,100,000         1,100,000         1,100,000         1,100,000   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

311


Table of Contents

 

(1)  The Finance Committee was created on 23 April 2012, and the fees shown are annualised and commenced from that date.

 

(2) In relation to travel for Board business, the time thresholds relate to the flight time to travel to the meeting location (i.e. one way flight time). Until 30 June 2011, the time frames were ‘Greater than 3 but less than 12 hours’ and ‘12 hours or more’.

Remuneration for members of the GMC (other than the CEO)

The information in this section contains details of the remuneration policy that guided the Remuneration Committee’s decisions and resulted in the remuneration outcomes for members of the GMC, other than the CEO (or any other Executive Directors should any be appointed in future).

LOGO Section 4.2.1 for members of the GMC

The remuneration policy and structures for the other members of the GMC are essentially the same as those already described for the CEO in previous sections of the Remuneration Report. Where this is the case, to avoid repetition, this section of the report cross references that prior content.

4.4.14    Remuneration policy

In designing and determining the remuneration for members of the GMC, the Remuneration Committee applies the Group’s remuneration policy. This contains the key principles that support and reinforce the Group’s strategy and ongoing performance and align activities of management with the interests of shareholders.

LOGO Section 4.3.1 and 4.3.2 for overarching principles and purpose of remuneration at BHP Billiton

The Remuneration Committee considers the appropriate total remuneration for each member of the GMC by examining the remuneration provided to comparable roles in organisations of similar global complexity, size, reach and industry.

Each year, the Committee’s independent adviser, Kepler Associates, sources and consolidates relevant remuneration data for comparable roles, in relevant organisations and markets. The adviser prepares a comparison to current GMC remuneration, but does not make specific recommendations regarding the level of individual executives’ remuneration.

LOGO Section 4.4.1 for more information on services provided by Kepler Associates

From this market comparison, the Committee determines the appropriate remuneration for each individual, taking into account their responsibilities, location, skills, qualifications, experience and performance within the Group. In doing so, the Committee recognises that levels of remuneration should be sufficient to attract, motivate and retain high quality, experienced executives, but also that the Group should avoid paying more than is necessary for this purpose.

4.4.15    Components of remuneration

The components of remuneration for members of the GMC are the same as the CEO, with any differences described below.

LOGO Section 4.3.3 for the components of CEO remuneration (including how remuneration links to strategy, how each component operates and how performance is assessed)

 

312


Table of Contents

Fixed remuneration

As for the CEO, the other members of the GMC receive:

 

  A competitive base salary that is appropriate to the role and attracts and retains high quality executives.

 

  Pension contributions to a maximum of 25 per cent of base salary.

 

  Relocation allowance and other benefits as determined by the Remuneration Committee, and of a similar nature to those received by the CEO, or as otherwise determined by local policy or practice in the location where the GMC member is located.

LOGO Section 4.4.19 for details of significant components of fixed remuneration for each member of the GMC

STI

Members of the GMC are entitled to participate in the STIP on the same basis as the CEO.

LOGO Section 4.3.3 for details of the STIP, including the setting of performance measures, assessment of performance, and delivery of awards in cash and deferred equity (including terms in relation to malus and clawback)

LOGO Section 4.3.8 for the terms of STI awards on cessation of employment

The performance measures for members of the GMC are similar to those of the CEO, as determined by the Committee. However, the weighting of each performance measure will vary to reflect the focus required from each GMC role. In particular, there are different weightings for GMC members with specific Business responsibilities. The relevant performance measures and weightings and the performance outcomes for FY2014 (as assessed by the Committee) are set out in the diagram below.

LOGO Section 4.4.6 for a comparable table of performance measures and outcomes for the CEO

LOGO Section 4.4.19 for details of the STI amount provided to each member of the GMC for FY2014 performance

 

313


Table of Contents

FY2014 performance measures and outcomes

 

LOGO

The description of the STI outcomes for the CEO explains the FY2014 performance outcomes against targets for HSEC, attributable profit, EBIT and capital project management. This includes the material variations from target performance for BHP Billiton and for its separate Businesses, which correspond to the Business outcomes shown in the diagram above.

Individual measures are determined at the commencement of the financial year. These comprise each individual’s contribution to the GMC, delivery against projects and initiatives within the scope of his or her role, and his or her contribution to the overall performance of the Group. Personal performance of other GMC members was reviewed against these measures by the Committee and, on average, was considered marginally above target, with a range of 21 to 23 per cent against a target of 20 per cent.

LTI

Other members of the GMC receive LTI awards under the LTIP, which are made on the same basis and with the same performance hurdles and vesting conditions as those provided to the CEO.

LTI awards granted to other members of the GMC generally have a maximum face value of 350 per cent of base salary, which is a fair value of 143.5 per cent of base salary under the current plan design (with an expected value of 41 per cent, taking into account the performance condition: 350% x 41% = 143.5%). The exception is for Jane McAloon and Tony Cudmore, for whom the maximum face value is 300 per cent of base salary (or a fair value of 123.0 per cent of base salary).

LOGO Section 4.3.3 for details of the LTIP, including the relative TSR performance condition, and the level of performance required for vesting (including terms in relation to malus and clawback)

LOGO Section 4.3.8 for the terms of LTI awards on cessation of employment

 

314


Table of Contents

LOGO Section 4.4.7 for details of the performance outcomes for the 2009 LTIP

LOGO Section 4.4.21 for details of LTI awards, that vested during FY2014

Shareplus all-employee share purchase plan

Like the CEO, other members of the GMC are also eligible to participate in Shareplus. For administrative simplicity in regard to stock exchange dealings and announcements, the other members of the GMC do not currently participate in Shareplus.

LOGO Section 4.4.26 for information about Shareplus and the current holdings of GMC members

4.4.16    Remuneration mix

The Group approach to remuneration for members of the GMC is that a significant portion should be ‘at risk’ to provide strong alignment between remuneration outcomes and the interests of BHP Billiton shareholders.

The diagram below sets out the relative mix of each remuneration component for other members of the GMC. Each component is determined as a percentage of base salary (at the minimum, target and maximum levels of performance-based remuneration).

 

LOGO

 

(1)  Base salary earned by each member of the GMC is set out in section 4.4.19.

 

(2)  As for the CEO, the minimum STI award is zero, with an award of 80 per cent of base salary in cash and 80 per cent in deferred equity for target performance, and a maximum award of 120 per cent cash and 120 per cent deferred equity for exceptional performance against KPIs.

LOGO Section 4.4.19 for actual cash STI awards for FY2014 performance, which are shown in the annual cash incentive column of the table

 

(3)  Other members of GMC have a maximum LTI award with a face value of 350 per cent of base salary as shown in the chart, with the exception of Jane McAloon and Tony Cudmore, who each have a maximum LTI award with a face value of 300 per cent of base salary.

LOGO Section 4.4.21 for actual LTI awards for FY2014, which were granted on 18 December 2013

4.4.17    Employment contracts

The terms of employment for other members of the GMC are formalised in employment contracts, which have no fixed term. They typically outline the components of remuneration paid to the individual, but do not prescribe how remuneration levels are to be modified from year-to-year. A GMC employment contract may be terminated by BHP Billiton on up to 12 months’ notice. BHP Billiton can terminate a contract immediately by making a

 

315


Table of Contents

payment of up to 12 months’ base salary plus pension contributions for the relevant period. The GMC member must give six months’ notice for voluntary resignation.

LOGO Section 4.2.1 for members of the GMC (including the date they commenced in their role if during the current financial year)

4.4.18    Arrangements for a GMC member leaving the Group after 30 June 2014

Karen Wood retired from BHP Billiton on 20 August 2014

Karen Wood retired from her role as President on the GMC on 19 August 2014 and from BHP Billiton on 20 August 2014. Ms Wood has received base salary, pension contributions and applicable benefits up to the date of her retirement. She received no payments in lieu of notice upon retirement, but has been paid the value of the pension and superannuation funds that she has accumulated during her service with the Group. When determining the STI awards for GMC members, the Remuneration Committee resolved that Ms Wood would receive a FY2014 short-term incentive award in the form of cash, which was assessed by the Committee, based on her performance. No deferral period will apply in respect of this cash STI award. Upon her retirement, the unvested deferred shares allocated to her in respect of the FY2013 GIS award vested to her in full. In accordance with the Group’s usual practice, Ms Wood’s unvested LTIP awards were pro-rated, to reflect the percentage of the performance period that had elapsed to 20 August 2014. The vesting of the retained pro-rated awards will be determined by the Committee at the relevant time in future years. The awards will only vest if the performance condition is met at the end of each five-year performance period, subject to the Committee’s ability to reduce vesting through its discretion under the plan rules.

The arrangements for GMC members leaving the Group are within the approval provided by shareholders at the 2011 and 2013 AGMs in regard to Australian termination benefits legislation, including the provision of performance-based remuneration in accordance with the rules of the relevant incentive plans. Ms Wood will continue to provide advice and assistance to the CEO on a consultancy basis.

 

316


Table of Contents

Other statutory disclosures

This section provides details of any additional statutory disclosures required by Australian or UK regulations that have not been included in the previous sections of the Remuneration Report.

4.4.19    GMC remuneration table

The table below has been prepared in accordance with relevant accounting standards. Remuneration data for all members of the GMC are pro-rated for the periods of FY2013 and FY2014 that each individual served as a member of the GMC. An explanation of the share-based payments terms used in the table is provided following the table and associated footnotes. Comparative FY2013 figures for many of the current members of the GMC therefore relate only to a small portion of the year following their appointment to the GMC. Tony Cudmore, Tim Cutt and Mike Fraser joined the GMC during FY2014 and there is no relevant FY2013 comparison.

More information on the policy and operation of each element of remuneration is provided in prior sections of this report.

 

Share-based payments

The figures included in the shaded columns of the statutory table below for share-based payments were not actually provided to the KMP during FY2013 or FY2014. These amounts are calculated in accordance with accounting standards and are the amortised IFRS fair values of equity and equity-related instruments that have been granted to the executives, either in relation to FY2013 and FY2014 performance or that of prior financial years. Please refer to sections 4.4.20 to 4.4.26 for information on awards allocated during FY2013 and FY2014. A further explanation of the share-based payments terms used in the table is provided following the table and its associated footnotes.

 

            Short-term benefits      Post-
employment
benefits
     Share-based payments (6)      Total  

US dollars (’000)

          Base
salary (1)
     Annual cash
incentive (2)
     Non-
monetary
benefits (3)
     Other
benefits (4)
     Retirement
benefits (5)
     Value of STI
and Shareplus
awards (7)
     Value of LTI
awards (8)
    

Executive Directors

                          

Andrew Mackenzie

     2014         1,700         1,568         92                 425         992         2,346         7,123   
     2013         1,271         899         10         700         431         902         888         5,101   

Other GMC members

                          

Peter Beaven

     2014         1,000         850         17                 250         588         1,342         4,047   
     2013         142         77         1                 36         69         159         484   

Tony Cudmore

     2014         247         223                         62         30         22         584   

Tim Cutt

     2014         1,000         867         12         550         250         525         1,173         4,377   

Dean Dalla Valle

     2014         1,000         936                         250         565         1,173         3,924   
     2013         142         60                 100         36         62         119         519   

Mike Fraser

     2014         717         656         13                 179         284         604         2,453   

Geoff Healy

     2014         1,000         914         29                 250         294         271         2,758   
     2013         77                                 19                         96   

Mike Henry

     2014         1,083         1,015         20                 271         816         1,365         4,570   
     2013         1,000         817         11         700         250         687         1,231         4,696   

Graham Kerr

     2014         1,083         1,006         68                 271         828         1,383         4,639   
     2013         1,000         897         4                 250         642         1,285         4,078   

Jane McAloon

     2014         750         686                         188         402         796         2,822   
     2013         106         41                         27         42         76         292   

Daniel Malchuk

     2014         871         797         29                 218         441         817         3,173   
     2013         121         51         3         475         31         42         64         787   

Jimmy Wilson

     2014         1,000         951                         250         647         1,342         4,190   
     2013         142         75                         36         77         159         489   

Karen Wood

     2014         1,000         922                         250         711         1,542         4,425   
     2013         1,005         741         16                 333         740         1,881         4,716   

 

317


Table of Contents

 

(1)  Base salaries shown in this table reflect the amounts paid over the 12-month period from 1 July 2013 to 30 June 2014. No changes to salaries occurred during FY2014 except as follows:

 

    Mike Fraser and Tony Cudmore were appointed to the GMC during the year on base salaries of US$0.850 million and US$0.750 million respectively; and

 

    Daniel Malchuk’s base salary increased from US$0.850 million to US$1.000 million (consistent with other Business Presidents) on 10 May 2014, reflecting the development in the role since his appointment on 10 May 2013.

LOGO Section 4.3.3 and 4.4.15 for base salary policy and operation

 

(2)  Annual cash incentive is the cash portion of STI awards earned in respect of performance during each financial year.

LOGO Section 4.3.3, 4.4.6 and 4.4.15 for STI policy and operation and for FY2014 STI outcomes

STI is provided half in cash and half in deferred equity (which are included in the share-based payments columns of the table). The minimum possible value awarded to each individual is nil. The maximum STI is 240 per cent of base salary (120 per cent in cash and 120 per cent in deferred equity). For FY2014 GMC members earned the following STI awards as a percentage of the maximum (the remaining portion has not been earned (i.e. has been ‘forfeited’)): Andrew Mackenzie 77 per cent, Peter Beaven 71 per cent, Tony Cudmore 76 per cent, Tim Cutt 72 per cent, Dean Dalla Valle 78 per cent, Mike Fraser 76 per cent, Geoff Healy 76 per cent, Mike Henry 77 per cent, Graham Kerr 76 per cent, Jane McAloon 76 per cent, Daniel Malchuk 76 per cent, Jimmy Wilson 79 per cent and Karen Wood 77 per cent.

 

(3)  Non-monetary benefits are non-pensionable and include such items as health and other insurances and fees for tax return preparation (if required in multiple jurisdictions).

 

(4)  Other benefits are non-pensionable and included one-off relocation allowances (with no trailing entitlements) provided to Andrew Mackenzie, Mike Henry and Daniel Malchuk in FY2013 and to Tim Cutt in FY2014 in regard to their international relocations, and to Dean Dalla Valle in FY2013 in regard to his domestic relocation.

 

(5)  Retirement benefits are 25 per cent of base salary for each GMC member.

 

(6)  The percentage of the total remuneration for FY2014, which is made up of equity awards, ranges from 9 per cent for Tony Cudmore to 51 per cent for Karen Wood.

 

(7)  The amounts shown in this column are described in the section below these notes. They may include awards paid in the form of cash where the individual ceases employment prior to the scheduled allocation date of the STI awards (in December 2014 for FY2014 awards). Footnote (2) shows the percentage of the FY2014 STI award not earned (i.e. ‘forfeited’) as a percentage of the maximum award. These share-based payments may also be forfeited after allocation in specific circumstances as described in section 4.3.8 and therefore, the minimum possible value of the awards is nil. The maximum possible value cannot be determined as it depends on future share price movements, but is estimated by the IFRS fair value used for accounting purposes in this table.

LOGO Section 4.4.20,4.4.23 and 4.4.26 for the actual numbers of awards allocated to and held by members of the GMC

 

(8)  The amounts shown in this column are described in the section below these notes. These share-based payments may also be forfeited after allocation in specific circumstances as described in section 4.3.8 and therefore the minimum possible value of the awards is nil. The maximum possible value cannot be determined as it depends on future share price movements, but is estimated by the IFRS fair value used for accounting purposes in this table.

LOGO Section 4.4.21, 4.4.22 and 4.4.24 for the actual numbers of awards allocated to the GMC

This column also includes an amount allocated to remuneration in FY2013 and in FY2014 in respect of awards received by Mr Mackenzie on commencement of employment with BHP Billiton, which vested during FY2013. The final value of the awards will be determined at the time that Mr Mackenzie chooses to redeem the award, and this column will incorporate an annual true-up amount until that time. Full details of the award and the relevant terms and conditions were provided in the FY2013 Annual Report.

  

 

318


Table of Contents

The value of STI and Shareplus awards shown in the table includes:

 

  the estimated IFRS fair value of STI awards provided as deferred equity or cash settled share-based payments under the GIS, GSTIP and STIP;

LOGO Section 4.4.20 and 4.4.23 for awards allocated to each individual

 

  the IFRS fair value of the STI awards is estimated at grant date by discounting the total value of the shares that will be issued in the future using the risk-free interest rate for the period to the date of award. Participants who are provided with awards under the GIS are entitled to a DEP in lieu of the dividends that would have been payable on ordinary BHP Billiton shares over the period from the allocation date to the time they receive ordinary shares in BHP Billiton. Prior to FY2011 awards, a similar DEP entitlement applied to GSTIP awards. This is not the case with awards allocated since October 2011. From FY2011, there was a change in accounting policy to account for the DEP from cash-settled to equity-settled. STI awards are granted to GMC participants following the relevant AGMs (awards to the CEO are subject to shareholder approval). If employment ceases prior to that scheduled allocation of equity awards, the value of the awards may be provided in cash, but would still be included in this column of the table. Once awarded, there is a vesting condition that requires participants to remain in employment for a further two years. Accordingly, the number of securities (if any) that will ultimately vest cannot be determined until the service period has been completed. The IFRS fair value of STI awards is apportioned to annual remuneration based on the expected future service period, which is normally three years (being the performance year in which the STI is earned and the subsequent two-year service period). The vesting of STI awards may be accelerated in the event of leaving the Group, in which case the expected future service period is amended;

 

  the estimated IFRS fair value of rights to Matched Shares acquired during each share purchase period under the Shareplus program. These rights are acquired on each of the quarterly share purchase dates under the program (grant dates), and the IFRS fair value is apportioned to annual remuneration based on the future service period required for the Matched Shares to be allocated (i.e. the vesting date of the rights). Where entitlements to the Matched Shares are accelerated on leaving the Group, the expected future service period is amended.

LOGO Section 4.4.26 for awards under Shareplus

The value of LTI awards shown in the table includes:

 

  the estimated IFRS fair value of awards provided under the LTIP, MAP and as Transitional GMC awards which are defined as equity-settled share-based payments; LOGO Section 4.4.21, 4.4.22 and 4.4.24 for awards allocated to each individual

 

  the amount in respect of each award under the LTIP is the estimated IFRS fair value of the award as determined by Kepler Associates using a Monte Carlo simulation methodology taking account of the performance condition, the term of the award, the share price at grant date, the expected price volatility of the underlying share, the risk-free interest rate for the term of the award and the value of the DEP that will be received on exercise of the award. The IFRS fair value of each award is apportioned to annual remuneration in equal amounts to each of the years in the expected future service period, which is normally five years. Where entitlements to LTI awards are preserved on leaving the Group, the expected future service period is amended.

Equity awards

The following sections set out the interests held by members of the GMC under the Group’s employee equity plans. Each equity award is a right to acquire one ordinary share in BHP Billiton Limited or in BHP Billiton Plc upon satisfaction of the vesting conditions. The vesting conditions will include performance and/or service requirements as relevant to the purpose of the award and as described in each of the following sections. The value of awards over BHP Billiton Limited shares is shown in Australian dollars and the value of awards over BHP Billiton Plc shares is shown in pounds sterling for awards over shares on the LSE and in South African rand for awards over shares on the JSE.

 

319


Table of Contents

Dividend Equivalent Payments

The awards are not ordinary shares and do not carry entitlements to ordinary dividends or other shareholder rights. Dividends are not received by the executives during the vesting period. For awards provided under the GIS and the LTIP, a DEP is provided to cover dividends that would have been payable on ordinary BHP Billiton shares over the period from the allocation date to the time that the holder receives ordinary shares in BHP Billiton in respect of the award (on vesting or on exercise). A DEP is only provided in relation to awards that have vested upon satisfaction of the relevant conditions. This payment is not made in relation to any securities that are forfeited or lapse.

The Securities Dealing GLD governs and restricts dealing arrangements and the provision of shares on vesting or exercise of awards.

Equity awards provided for GMC service

4.4.20    STI awards under the GIS

Awards under the GIS will not deliver any value to the holder for at least two years from the beginning of the financial year in which they are granted (unless the executive’s employment with the Group ends earlier in specific circumstances, such as on death, serious injury, disability or illness, retirement with the agreement of BHP Billiton and redundancy/retrenchment).

At the 2013 AGMs, shareholders approved a new STIP which applies from FY2014. Awards have not yet been allocated under the STIP. The terms and conditions of the new STIP are largely the same as those of the GIS.

 

320


Table of Contents

Name

  Date of grant     Option
Exercise
price
payable (1)
    At
1 July
2013
    Granted     Vested     Lapsed     Exercised     At
30 June
2014
    Date award
may vest (2)
    Market
price on
date of
grant (3)
    Market
price on
date of
vesting (4)
    Market
price on
date of
exercise (5)
    Aggregate
gain on
awards
(’000) (5)
    DEP on
awards
(’000) (6)
 

Executive Director

                           

Andrew Mackenzie

    18 Dec 2013                      28,157                             28,157        Aug 2015        A$35.79                               
    5 Dec 2012               20,023                                    20,023        Aug 2014        £19.98                               
    5 Dec 2011               39,230               39,230               39,230               21 Aug 2013        £20.12        £18.73        £18.73        £735        US$88   
    6 Dec 2010      £ 23.71        30,389                                    30,389        2 Oct 2012        £24.40        £19.45                        
    16 Dec 2009      £ 18.68        16,119                             16,119               25 Aug 2011        £19.06        £19.44        £18.73        £1        US$64   
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

             

Total

        105,761        28,157        39,230               55,349        78,569               
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

             

Other members of the GMC

  

                         

Peter Beaven

    18 Dec 2013                      2,423                             2,423        Aug 2015        A$35.79                               

Dean Dalla Valle

    18 Dec 2013                      1,895                             1,895        Aug 2015        A$35.79                               

Mike Henry

    18 Dec 2013                      25,594                             25,594        Aug 2015        A$35.79                               
    5 Dec 2012               15,058                                    15,058        Aug 2014        £19.98                               
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

             

Total

        15,058        25,594                             40,652               
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

             

Graham Kerr

    18 Dec 2013                      28,101                             28,101        Aug 2015        A$35.79                               
    5 Dec 2012               13,230                                    13,230        Aug 2014        A$34.29                               
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

             

Total

        13,230        28,101                             41,331               
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

             

Jane McAloon

    18 Dec 2013                      1,270                             1,270        Aug 2015        A$35.79                               

Daniel Malchuk

    18 Dec 2013                      1,598                             1,598        Aug 2015        A$35.79                               

Jimmy Wilson

    18 Dec 2013                      2,360                             2,360        Aug 2015        A$35.79                               

Karen Wood

    18 Dec 2013                      23,231                             23,231        Aug 2015        A$35.79                               
    5 Dec 2012               15,685                                    15,685        Aug 2014        A$34.29                               
    5 Dec 2011               28,539               28,539               28,539               21 Aug 2013        A$37.26        A$35.74        A$35.74        A$1,020        US$64   
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

             

Total

        44,224        23,231        28,539               28,539        38,916               
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

             

 

(1)  Under the GIS, each employee could nominate to receive a portion of their award in the form of options with a market-based exercise price. Where an individual has made this choice, the option exercise price payable is shown. The exercise price is determined by the weighted average price at which BHP Billiton shares were traded over the one week up to and including the date of grant. A greater number of options were allocated if an individual chose this alternative (as opposed to choosing awards with no exercise price).

 

(2) Awards will vest on, or as soon as practicable after, the first non-prohibited period date occurring after 30 June of the second financial year after allocation, if the conditions for vesting are met (including the relevant service conditions). The estimated vesting month is shown in the table. The expiry date of awards is the day prior to the third anniversary of that vesting date.

 

(3)  The market price shown for the December 2013 grant is the closing price of BHP Billiton shares on 18 December 2013. No price is payable by the individual for acquiring the award at the time of grant. The grant date IFRS fair value of the awards is estimated as at the start of the vesting period, being 1 July 2013, and was A$29.01.

 

(4)  The awards granted under the GIS in December 2011 became fully vested on 21 August 2013 as the service conditions were met. The price shown is the closing price of BHP Billiton shares on that date.

 

(5)  The market price shown (and used for calculating the aggregate gain of the total award) is the closing price of BHP Billiton shares on the date that the individual exercised their award.

 

(6) The amounts shown in this column are the value of the DEP paid on the awards.

 

321


Table of Contents

4.4.21    LTI awards under the LTIP

Awards under the LTIP will not deliver any value to the holder for at least five years from the beginning of the financial year in which they are granted (unless the executive’s employment with the Group ends earlier in specific circumstances, such as on death, serious injury, disability or illness).

A new LTIP was approved by shareholders at the 2013 AGMs and was effective for grants from December 2013. The terms and conditions of the new LTIP, including the performance conditions, are described in sections 4.3.3 and 4.3.8 and are largely the same as the former LTIP. The rules are available on the BHP Billiton website.

 

Name

  Date of grant     At
1 July
2013
    Granted     Vested     Lapsed     Exercised     At
30 June
2014
    Date award
may vest (1)
    Market
price on
date of
grant (2)
    Market
price on
date of
vesting (3)
    Market
price on
date of
exercise (4)
    Aggregate
gain on
awards
(’000) (4)
     DEP on
awards
(’000) (5)
 

Executive Director

  

                        

Andrew Mackenzie

    18 Dec 2013               198,514                             198,514        Aug 2018        A$35.79                                
    5 Dec 2012        140,326                                    140,326        Aug 2017        £19.98                                
    5 Dec 2011        146,510                                    146,510        Aug 2016        £20.12                                
    6 Dec 2010        120,000                                    120,000        Aug 2015        £24.40                                
    14 Dec 2009        120,000                                    120,000        Aug 2014        £19.06                                
    4 Dec 2008        325,839               211,795        114,044        211,795               21 Aug 2013        £10.60        £18.73        £18.73        £3,967         US$1,017   
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

              

Total

      852,675        198,514        211,795        114,044        211,795        725,350                
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

              

Other members of the GMC

  

                        

Peter Beaven

    18 Dec 2013               102,176                             102,176        Aug 2018        A$35.79                                

Tony Cudmore

    3 Mar 2014               22,273                             22,273        Aug 2018        A$37.40                                

Tim Cutt

    18 Dec 2013               102,176                             102,176        Aug 2018        A$35.79                                

Dean Dalla Valle

    18 Dec 2013               102,176                             102,176        Aug 2018        A$35.79                                

Mike Fraser

    18 Dec 2013               86,850                             86,850        Aug 2018        A$35.79                                

Geoff Healy

    18 Dec 2013               102,176                             102,176        Aug 2018        A$35.79                                

Mike Henry

    18 Dec 2013               112,394                             112,394        Aug 2018        A$35.79                                
    5 Dec 2012        121,179                                    121,179        Aug 2017        £19.98                                
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

              

Total

      121,179        112,394                             233,573                
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

              

Graham Kerr

    18 Dec 2013               112,394                             112,394        Aug 2018        A$35.79                                
    5 Dec 2012        108,939                                    108,939        Aug 2017        A$34.29                                
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

              

Total

      108,939        112,394                             221,333                
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

              

 

322


Table of Contents

Name

  Date of grant     At
1 July
2013
    Granted     Vested     Lapsed     Exercised     At
30 June
2014
    Date award
may vest (1)
    Market
price on
date of
grant (2)
    Market
price on
date of
vesting (3)
    Market
price on
date of
exercise (4)
    Aggregate
gain on
awards
(’000) (4)
    DEP
on
awards
(’000) (5)
 

Jane McAloon

    18 Dec 2013               65,684                             65,684        Aug 2018        A$35.79                               

Daniel Malchuk

    18 Dec 2013               86,850                             86,850        Aug 2018        A$35.79                               

Jimmy Wilson

    18 Dec 2013               102,176                             102,176        Aug 2018        A$35.79                               

Karen Wood

    18 Dec 2013               102,176                             102,176        Aug 2018        A$35.79                               
    5 Dec 2012        90,234                                    90,234        Aug 2017        A$34.29                               
    5 Dec 2011        85,027                                    85,027        Aug 2016        A$37.26                               
    6 Dec 2010        75,000                                    75,000        Aug 2015        A$44.53                               
    1 Feb 2010        90,000                                    90,000        Aug 2014        A$39.20                               
    4 Dec 2008        175,000               113,750        61,250        50,813        62,937        21 Aug 2013        A$27.50        A$35.74        A$35.74        A$1,816        US$244   
    14 Dec 2007        64,187                             64,187               2 Oct 2012        A$42.05        A$33.54        A$35.74        A$2,294        US$344   
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

             

Total

      579,448        102,176        113,750        61,250        115,000        505,374               
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

             

 

(1)  Awards will vest on, or as soon as practicable after, the first non-prohibited period date occurring after 30 June of the fifth financial year after allocation if the conditions for vesting are met (including if the relevant performance condition is achieved). The estimated vesting month is shown in the table. The expiry date of awards is the day prior to the fifth anniversary of that vesting date.

 

(2)  The market price shown for the grants made in FY2014 is the closing price of BHP Billiton shares on the relevant date of grant. No price is payable by the individual for acquiring the award at the time of grant. The grant date IFRS fair value of the awards is estimated as at the start of the vesting period, being 1 July 2013, using a Monte Carlo simulation, and was A$12.35.

 

(3)  65 per cent of the LTIP awards granted in December 2008 became fully vested on 21 August 2013, following the performance condition being fully achieved and the Remuneration Committee considering its discretion over the vesting outcome, as described in section 4.3.3. The remaining 35 per cent of the LTIP awards lapsed and cannot be exercised by the previous holders. The price shown is the closing price of BHP Billiton shares on the vesting date.

 

(4)  The market price shown (and used for calculating the aggregate gain) is the closing price of BHP Billiton shares on the date that the individual exercised their LTIP award. No price is payable by the individual for exercising the award.

 

(5) The amounts shown in this column are the value of the DEP paid on awards.

4.4.22    Transitional GMC awards

As the MAP awards that are allocated to individuals in their non-GMC management positions have a three-year service condition, and the LTIP awards provided to GMC members have a five-year service and performance condition, as a transitional step, the Committee may determine that new GMC members recruited from within BHP Billiton receive Transitional GMC awards to bridge the gap between the two programs.

Transitional GMC awards have two tranches. Tranche one has a three-year service and performance condition. Tranche two has a four-year service and performance condition. The Remuneration Committee has absolute discretion to determine if the performance condition has been met and whether any, all or part of the award will vest (or otherwise lapse), having regard to (but not limited to) BHP Billiton’s TSR over the three- or four-year performance period (respectively), the participant’s contribution to Group outcomes and the participant’s personal performance (with guidance on this assessment from the CEO). No DEP is payable on these awards.

 

323


Table of Contents

The treatment of Transitional GMC awards on cessation of employment will depend on the circumstances and is similar to those for LTIP awards. If the participant’s employment ceases due to dismissal or resignation, any unvested awards will lapse immediately. If the reason for cessation is death, serious injury, disability or illness, then the awards will vest in full on the date of cessation. If the participant retires from the Group with the agreement of BHP Billiton, is made redundant or employment is terminated by mutual agreement, then a proportion of the award (pro-rated to reflect the percentage of the performance period that has elapsed) will continue on foot and vest, subject to the performance condition, on the future vesting date. The remaining portion of the award will lapse. In all other circumstances, the Committee in its absolute discretion will determine the portion of the award that vests (or lapses).

 

Name

  Date of grant   At
1 July
2013
    Granted     Vested     Lapsed     Exercised     At
30 June
2014
    Date award
may vest (1)
    Market
price on
date of

grant (2)
    Market
price on
date of

vesting
    Aggregate
gain on
awards
(’000)
 

Peter Beaven

  18 Dec 2013            18,245                             18,245        Aug 2017        A$35.79                 
  18 Dec 2013            18,245                             18,245        Aug 2016        A$35.79                 
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

         

Total

             36,490                             36,490           
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

         

Tim Cutt

  18 Dec 2013            18,245                             18,245        Aug 2017        A$35.79                 
  18 Dec 2013            18,245                             18,245        Aug 2016        A$35.79                 
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

         

Total

             36,490                             36,490           
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

         

Dean Dalla Valle

  18 Dec 2013            18,245                             18,245        Aug 2017        A$35.79                 
  18 Dec 2013            18,245                             18,245        Aug 2016        A$35.79                 
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

         

Total

             36,490                             36,490           
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

         

Mike Fraser

  18 Dec 2013            15,508                             15,508        Aug 2017        A$35.79                 
  18 Dec 2013            15,508                             15,508        Aug 2016        A$35.79                 
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

         

Total

             31,016                             31,016           
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

         

Mike Henry

  5 Dec 2012     19,930                                    19,930        Aug 2016        £19.98                 
  5 Dec 2012     19,930                                    19,930        Aug 2015        £19.98                 
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

         

Total

      39,860                                    39,860           
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

         

Graham Kerr

  5 Dec 2012     17,917                                    17,917        Aug 2016        A$34.29                 
  5 Dec 2012     17,917                                    17,917        Aug 2015        A$34.29                 
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

         

Total

      35,834                                    35,834           
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

         

Jane McAloon

  18 Dec 2013            13,684                             13,684        Aug 2017        A$35.79                 
  18 Dec 2013            13,684                             13,684        Aug 2016        A$35.79                 
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

         

Total

             27,368                             27,368           
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

         

Daniel Malchuk

  18 Dec 2013            15,508                             15,508        Aug 2017        A$35.79                 
  18 Dec 2013            15,508                             15,508        Aug 2016        A$35.79                 
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

         

Total

             31,016                             31,016           
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

         

Jimmy Wilson

  18 Dec 2013            18,245                             18,245        Aug 2017        A$35.79                 
  18 Dec 2013            18,245                             18,245        Aug 2016        A$35.79                 
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

         

Total

             36,490                             36,490           
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

         

 

324


Table of Contents

 

(1)  The holding period for each award ends on 30 June in the year the award ‘may vest’ if the conditions for vesting are met as described above the table. Awards will vest on or as soon as practicable after the first non-prohibited period date occurring after 30 June of the third financial year after allocation (for tranche one) and the fourth financial year after vesting (for tranche two) if the conditions for vesting are met as described above. The estimated vesting month is shown in the table. No exercise requirement or expiry date applies to these awards and there is no price payable by the individual on vesting. Where performance conditions are not met at vesting, awards will lapse.

 

(2)  The market price shown for the December 2013 grant is the closing price of BHP Billiton shares on 18 December 2013. No price is payable by the individual for acquiring the award at the time of grant. The grant date IFRS fair values of the awards are estimated at the start of the vesting period, being 1 July 2013, and were A$28.09 for tranche one, and A$27.20 for tranche two.

Equity awards provided for pre-GMC service

4.4.23    STI awards under the GSTIP

The table below shows GSTIP awards that were held by the executives at the time that they were appointed to the GMC or which were allocated in relation to performance and service before they became GMC members.

Prior to their appointment as members of the GMC, the individuals shown in the table below received STl awards under the GSTIP which has applied for the non-GMC management of BHP Billiton since the awards allocated in FY2009 (in relation to FY2008 performance).

The terms and conditions of the GSTIP awards are essentially the same as those provided under the GIS. Under both plans, participants must satisfy applicable STl performance conditions in order to be eligible for any award. Due to changes in the GSTIP, which applied to all participants in that plan, no DEP is payable on the GSTIP awards that were allocated in FY2012 (in relation to FY2011 performance) or since that time.

 

Name

  Date of grant     Option
Exercise
price
payable (1)
    At
1 July
2013
    Granted     Vested     Lapsed     Exercised     At
30 June
2014
    Date award
may vest (2)
    Market
price on
date of
grant (3)
    Market
price on
date of
vesting (4)
    Market
price on
date of
exercise (5)
    Aggregate
gain on
awards
(’000) (5)
    DEP on
awards
(’000) (6)
 

Awards under the GSTIP

                           

Peter Beaven

    18 Dec 2013                      12,082                             12,082        Aug 2015        A$35.79                               
    31 Oct 2012               13,756                                    13,756        Aug 2014        A$34.25                               
    31 Oct 2011               13,256               13,256               13,256               21 Aug 2013        A$37.80        A$35.74        A$35.74        A$474          
    29 Oct 2010               10,596                             10,596               23 Aug 2012        A$41.92        A$33.41        A$35.74        A$379        US$33   
    30 Oct 2009      A$ 38.41        10,002                             10,002               25 Aug 2011        A$37.45        A$38.61        A$37.23        (A$12     US$46   
    30 Oct 2009               8,335                             8,335               25 Aug 2011        A$37.45        A$38.61        A$35.74        A$298        US$33   
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

             

Total

        55,945        12,082        13,256               42,189        25,838               
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

             

Tim Cutt

    18 Dec 2013                      10,637                             10,637        Aug 2015        A$35.79                               
    14 Nov 2012               11,402                                    11,402        Aug 2014        A$33.73                               
    31 Oct 2011               10,917               10,917               10,917               21 Aug 2013        A$37.80        A$35.74        A$35.74        A$390          
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

             

Total

        22,319        10,637        10,917               10,917        22,039               
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

             

Dean Dalla Valle

    18 Dec 2013                      10,009                             10,009        Aug 2015        A$35.79                               
    31 Oct 2012               12,407                                    12,407        Aug 2014        A$34.25                               
    31 Oct 2011               13,561               13,561               13,561               21 Aug 2013        A$37.80        A$35.74        A$35.74        A$485          
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

             

Total

        25,968        10,009        13,561               13,561        22,416               
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

             

 

325


Table of Contents

Name

  Date of grant     Option
Exercise
price
payable (1)
    At
1 July
2013
    Granted     Vested     Lapsed     Exercised     At
30 June
2014
    Date award
may vest (2)
    Market
price on
date of
grant (3)
    Market
price on
date of
vesting (4)
    Market
price on
date of
exercise (5)
    Aggregate
gain on
awards
(’000) (5)
    DEP on
awards
(’000) (6)
 

Mike Fraser (7)

    18 Dec 2013                      5,020                             5,020        Aug 2015        A$35.79                               
    31 Oct 2012               3,831                                    3,831        Aug 2014        £19.86                               
    29 Oct 2010               5,470                             5,470               23 Aug 2012        ZAR246.68        ZAR258.16        ZAR303.12        ZAR1,658        US$20   
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

             

Total

        9,301        5,020                      5,470        8,851               
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

             

Mike Henry (8)

    22 Aug 2013               5,715                                    5,715        Aug 2014        A$35.37                               
    31 Oct 2011               16,566               16,566               16,566               21 Aug 2013        £19.68                               
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

             

Total

        22,281               16,566               16,566        5,715               
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

             

Graham Kerr (8)

    22 Aug 2013               4,501                                    4,501        Aug 2014        A$35.37                               
    31 Oct 2011               11,963               11,963               11,963               21 Aug 2013        A$37.80        A$35.74        A$35.74        A$428          
    30 Oct 2009      A$ 38.41        17,345                             17,345               25 Aug 2011        A$37.45        A$38.61        A$36.80        (A$28     US$79   
    30 Oct 2009               4,818                             4,818               25 Aug 2011        A$37.45        A$38.61        A$35.74        A$172        US$19   
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

             

Total

        38,627               11,963               34,126        4,501               
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

             

Jane McAloon

    18 Dec 2013                      6,709                             6,709        Aug 2015        A$35.79                               
    14 Nov 2012               8,698                                    8,698        Aug 2014        A$33.73                               
    31 Oct 2011               9,119               9,119               9,119               21 Aug 2013        A$37.80        A$35.74        A$35.74        A$326          
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

             

Total

        17,817        6,709        9,119               9,119        15,407               
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

             

Daniel Malchuk

    18 Dec 2013                      8,577                             8,577        Aug 2015        A$35.79                               
    31 Oct 2012               6,884                                    6,884        Aug 2014        A$34.25                               
    31 Oct 2011               8,855               8,855               8,855               21 Aug 2013        A$37.80        A$35.74        A$35.74        A$316          
    29 Oct 2010               4,791                             4,791               23 Aug 2012        A$41.92        A$33.41        A$35.74        A$171        US$15   
    30 Oct 2009               5,939                             5,939               25 Aug 2011        A$37.45        A$38.61        A$35.74        A$212        US$24   
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

             

Total

        26,469        8,577        8,855               19,585        15,461               
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

             

Jimmy Wilson

    18 Dec 2013                      12,466                             12,466        Aug 2015        A$35.79                               
    31 Oct 2012               16,611                                    16,611        Aug 2014        A$34.25                               
    31 Oct 2011               16,127               16,127               16,127               21 Aug 2013        A$37.80        A$35.74        A$35.74        A$576          
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

             

Total

        32,738        12,466        16,127               16,127        29,077               
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

             

 

(1)  Prior to FY2011, each employee could nominate to receive a portion of their award in the form of options with a market-based exercise price. Where an individual has made this choice, the option exercise price payable is shown. The exercise price is determined by the weighted average price at which BHP Billiton shares were traded over the one week up to and including the date of grant. A greater number of options were allocated if an individual chose this alternative (as opposed to choosing awards with no exercise price to pay).

 

(2)  Awards will vest and become exercisable on, or as soon as practicable after, the first non-prohibited period date occurring after 30 June of the second financial year after allocation, if the conditions for vesting are met (including the relevant service conditions). The estimated vesting month is shown in the table. Where applicable, the expiry date of awards is the day prior to the third anniversary of that vesting date.

 

(3)  The market price shown for grants made during FY2014 is the closing price of BHP Billiton shares on the relevant date of grant. No price is payable by the individual for acquiring the award at the time of grant. The grant date IFRS fair value of the awards is estimated as at the start of the vesting period, being 1 July 2013, and was A$29.01 No exercise requirement or expiry date applies to these awards (as described above the table).

 

326


Table of Contents
(4)  The awards granted under the GSTIP in October 2011 became fully vested on 21 August 2013 as the service conditions were met. The price shown is the closing price of BHP Billiton shares on that date.

 

(5)  The market price shown (and used for calculating the aggregate gain of the total award) is the closing price of BHP Billiton shares on the date that the individual exercised their award.

 

(6)  The amounts shown in this column are the value of the DEP paid on the awards.

 

(7)  The opening balance shown for Mike Fraser reflects his holdings on 27 August 2013 (rather than on 1 July 2013) being the date he joined the GMC.

 

(8)  The awards shown for Mike Henry and Graham Kerr with a grant date of 22 August 2013 had this allocation date due to administrative reasons, but were made on the same basis as if they had been made on 5 December 2012.

4.4.24    LTI awards under the MAP and LTIP

The table below shows awards that were held by the executives at the time that they were appointed to the GMC.

Prior to their appointment as members of the GMC, the individuals listed in the tables below received LTI awards:

 

  under the MAP which has applied for the non-GMC management of BHP Billiton since FY2009;

 

  prior to that under the LTIP, which applied to non-GMC management (as well as to the GMC members) before the MAP was introduced.

LOGO Section 4.4.21 for details of LTIP awards allocated for GMC service

The vesting of MAP awards is subject to a service condition of continued employment with the Group through to the vesting date as shown in the table. Where a participant resigns or is terminated for cause prior to the vesting date, their unvested MAP awards are forfeited. If a participant’s employment ends due to death, illness or injury, a pro rata number of unvested Restricted Shares will vest based on the portion of the relevant vesting period served. Due to changes in the MAP, which applied to all participants in that plan, no DEP is payable on the MAP awards that were allocated in FY2012 or since that time.

 

Name

  Date of grant     At
1 July
2013
    Granted     Vested     Lapsed     Exercised     At
30 June
2014
    Date award
may vest (1)
    Market
price on
date of
grant (2)
    Market
price on
date of
vesting (3)
    Market
price on
date of
exercise (4)
    Aggregate
gain on
awards
(’000) (4)
    DEP on
awards
(’000) (5)
 

Awards under the MAP

                         

Peter Beaven

    31 Oct 2012        34,250                                    34,250        Aug 2015        A$34.25                               
    31 Oct 2011        31,700                                    31,700        Aug 2014        A$37.80                               
    29 Oct 2010        30,500               30,500               30,500               21 Aug 2013        A$41.92        A$35.74        A$35.74        A$1,090        US$101   
    30 Oct 2009        21,000                             21,000               23 Aug 2012        A$37.45        A$33.41        A$35.74        A$751        US$96   
    19 Nov 2008        21,000                             21,000               25 Aug 2011        A$23.20        A$38.61        A$35.74        A$751        US$84   
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

             

Total

      138,450               30,500               72,500        65,950               
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

             

Tim Cutt

    14 Nov 2012        27,000                                    27,000        Aug 2015        A$33.73                               
    31 Oct 2011        25,000                                    25,000        Aug 2014        A$37.80                               
    29 Oct 2010        24,000               24,000               24,000               21 Aug 2013        A$41.92        A$35.74        A$35.74        A$858        US$76   
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

             

Total

      76,000               24,000               24,000        52,000               
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

             

 

327


Table of Contents

Name

  Date of grant     At
1 July
2013
    Granted     Vested     Lapsed     Exercised     At
30 June
2014
    Date award
may vest (1)
    Market
price on
date of
grant (2)
    Market
price on
date of
vesting (3)
    Market
price on
date of
exercise (4)
    Aggregate
gain on
awards
(’000) (4)
    DEP on
awards
(’000) (5)
 

Dean Dalla Valle

    31 Oct 2012        27,000                                    27,000        Aug 2015        A$34.25                               
    31 Oct 2011        25,000                                    25,000        Aug 2014        A$37.80                               
    29 Oct 2010        19,500               19,500               19,500               21 Aug 2013        A$41.92        A$35.74        A$35.74        A$697        US$61   
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

             

Total

      71,500               19,500               19,500        52,000               
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

             

Mike Fraser (6)

    22 Aug 2013        10,045                                    10,045        Aug 2015        A$35.37                               
    31 Oct 2011        11,330                                    11,330        Aug 2014        £19.68                               
    29 Oct 2010        9,250               9,250               9,250               21 Aug 2013        ZAR246.68        ZAR301.99        ZAR303.12        ZAR2,804        US$35   
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

             

Total

      30,625               9,250               9,250        21,375               
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

             

Mike Henry

    25 Nov 2011        5,900                                    5,900        Aug 2014        £17.60                               
    31 Oct 2011        29,500                                    29,500        Aug 2014        £19.68                               
    29 Oct 2010        19,500               19,500               19,500               21 Aug 2013        £22.14        £18.73        £18.73        £365        US$61   
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

             

Total

      54,900               19,500               19,500        35,400               
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

             

Graham Kerr

    25 Nov 2011        9,750                                    9,750        Aug 2014        A$34.05                               
    31 Oct 2011        20,250                                    20,250        Aug 2014        A$37.80                               
    29 Oct 2010        19,500               19,500               19,500               21 Aug 2013        A$41.92        A$35.74        A$35.74        A$697        US$61   
    19 Nov 2008        21,000                             21,000               25 Aug 2011        A$23.20        A$38.61        A$35.74        A$751        US$101   
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

             

Total

      70,500               19,500               40,500        30,000               
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

             

Jane McAloon

    14 Nov 2012        17,900                                    17,900        Aug 2015        A$33.73                               
    31 Oct 2011        16,600                                    16,600        Aug 2014        A$37.80                               
    29 Oct 2010        11,000               11,000               11,000               21 Aug 2013        A$41.92        A$35.74        A$35.74        A$393        US$35   
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

             

Total

      45,500               11,000               11,000        34,500               
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

             

Daniel Malchuk

    31 Oct 2012        21,900                                    21,900        Aug 2015        A$34.25                               
    31 Oct 2011        9,600                                    9,600        Aug 2014        A$37.80                               
    29 Oct 2010        9,250               9,250               9,250               21 Aug 2013        A$41.92        A$35.74        A$35.74        A$331        US$34   
    30 Oct 2009        7,000                             7,000               23 Aug 2012        A$37.45        A$33.41        A$35.74        A$250        US$29   
    19 Nov 2008        7,000                             7,000               25 Aug 2011        A$23.20        A$38.61        A$35.74        A$250        US$28   
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

             

Total

      54,750               9,250               23,250        31,500               
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

             

Jimmy Wilson

    31 Oct 2012        34,250                                    34,250        Aug 2015        A$34.25                               
    31 Oct 2011        31,700                                    31,700        Aug 2014        A$37.80                               
    29 Oct 2010        30,500               30,500               30,500               21 Aug 2013        A$41.92        A$35.74        A$35.74        A$1,090        US$96   
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

             

Total

      96,450               30,500               30,500        65,950               
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

             

 

328


Table of Contents

Name

  Date of grant     At
1 July
2013
    Granted     Vested     Lapsed     Exercised     At
30 June
2014
    Date award
may vest (1)
    Market
price on
date of
grant (2)
    Market
price on
date of
vesting (3)
    Market
price on
date of
exercise (4)
    Aggregate
gain on
awards
(’000) (4)
    DEP on
awards
(’000) (5)
 

Awards under the LTIP

                         

Peter Beaven

    14 Dec 2007        40,000                             35,000        5,000        23 Aug 2012        A$42.05        A$33.41        A$35.74        A$1,251        US$252   
    7 Dec 2006        40,000                             40,000               25 Aug 2011        A$26.40        A$38.61        A$35.74        A$1,430        US$230   
    5 Dec 2005        40,000                                    40,000        25 Aug 2010        A$22.03        A$37.44                        
    3 Dec 2004        40,000                             40,000               12 Aug 2009        A$15.28        A$37.99        A$35.74        A$1,430        US$188   
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

             

Total

      160,000                             115,000        45,000               
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

             

Graham Kerr

    7 Dec 2006        20,000                             20,000               25 Aug 2011        A$26.40        A$38.64        A$35.74        A$715        US$115   
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

             

Total

      20,000                             20,000                      
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

             

Daniel Malchuk

    14 Dec 2007        7,500                             7,500               23 Aug 2012        A$42.05        A$33.41        A$35.74        A$268        US$40   
    7 Dec 2006        5,000                             5,000               25 Aug 2011        A$26.40        A$38.61        A$35.74        A$179        US$30   
    5 Dec 2005        5,000                             5,000               25 Aug 2010        A$22.03        A$37.44        A$35.74        A$179        US$29   
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

             

Total

      17,500                             17,500                      
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

             

Jimmy Wilson

    14 Dec 2007        80,000                             22,500        57,500        23 Aug 2012        A$42.05        A$33.41        A$35.74        A$804        US$121   
    7 Dec 2006        80,000                             80,000               25 Aug 2011        A$26.40        A$38.61        A$35.74        A$2,859        US$460   
    3 Dec 2004        13,400                             13,400               12 Aug 2009        ZAR66.00        ZAR207.28        ZAR303.12        ZAR4,062        US$84   
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

             

Total

      173,400                             115,900        57,500               
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

             

 

(1)  Awards will vest on, or as soon as practicable after, the first non-prohibited period date occurring after 30 June of the third (MAP awards) or fifth (LTIP awards) financial year after allocation, if the conditions for vesting are met (including the relevant service conditions). The estimated vesting month is shown in the table. Where applicable, expiry date of awards is the day prior to the third (MAP awards) or fifth (LTIP awards) anniversary of that vesting date.

 

(2)  The market price shown for grants made during FY2014 is the closing price of BHP Billiton shares on the relevant date of grant. No price is payable by the individual for acquiring the award at the time of grant. The grant date IFRS fair value of the awards is estimated as at the start of the vesting period, being 1 July 2013, and was A$28.09. No exercise requirement or expiry date applies to these awards (as described above the table).

 

(3)  The awards granted under the MAP in October 2010 became fully vested on 21 August 2013 as the service conditions were met. The price shown is the closing price of BHP Billiton shares on that date.

 

(4)  The market price shown (and used for calculating the aggregate gain of the total award) is the closing price of BHP Billiton shares on the date that the individual exercised their award. No price is payable by the individual for exercising the award.

 

(5)  The amounts shown in this column are the value of the DEP paid on the awards

 

(6)  The opening balance shown for Mike Fraser reflects his holdings on 27 August 2013 (rather than on 1 July 2013) being the date he joined the GMC. The awards shown with a grant date of 22 August 2013 hold this allocation date due to administrative reasons, but were made on the same basis as if they had been made on 31 October 2012.

 

329


Table of Contents

4.4.25    Estimated value range of equity awards

The current face value of STI and LTI awards allocated during FY2014 and yet to vest (to be disclosed under the Australian Corporations Act 2001) is the number of awards as set out in the previous tables multiplied by the current share price of BHP Billiton Limited or BHP Billiton Plc as applicable.

The actual value that may be received by participants in the future cannot be determined as it is dependent on, and therefore fluctuates with, the share prices of BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc at the date that any particular award is exercised. The table below provides five-year share price history for BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc, history of dividends paid and the Group’s earnings.

Five-year share price, dividend and earnings history

 

        

FY2010

   

FY2011

   

FY2012

   

FY2013

   

FY2014

 
BHP Billiton Limited    Share price at beginning of year     A$33.96        A$36.94        A$43.97        A$31.72        A$30.94   
   Share price at end of year     A$37.65        A$43.80        A$31.45        A$31.37        A$35.90   
   Dividends paid     A$0.95        A$0.95        A$1.03        A$1.10        A$1.29   

BHP Billiton Plc

   Share price at beginning of year     £13.75        £17.28        £24.39        £18.30        £17.15   
   Share price at end of year     £17.54        £24.47        £18.06        £16.82        £18.90   
   Dividends paid     £0.53        £0.58        £0.69        £0.73        £0.73   
BHP Billiton    Attributable profit (US$M)     12,722        23,648        15,473        11,223        13,832   

The highest share price during FY2014 was A$39.38 for BHP Billiton Limited shares and £19.95 for BHP Billiton Plc shares. The lowest share prices during FY2014 were A$30.94 and £16.67, respectively.

4.4.26    Awards of Matched Shares under the Shareplus all-employee share purchase plan

Like all permanent employees, members of the GMC are eligible to participate in Shareplus, an all-employee share purchase plan. For administrative simplicity in regard to stock exchange dealings and announcements, no GMC members currently participate. This table shows Shareplus holdings previously accumulated by members of the GMC, including during the period before they joined the GMC.

Participants in Shareplus contribute from their post-tax base salary (capped at US$5,000 per year) to acquire shares in BHP Billiton Limited or in BHP Billiton Plc. For each share purchased, the participant receives a right to acquire a Matched Share, which vests provided the participant remains employed by BHP Billiton on the third anniversary of the start of the relevant Shareplus Plan Year.

Differences in exchange rates in relation to the base salaries of the participants in previous financial years and the currencies of each securities exchange result in minor differences in the numbers of shares allocated.

 

Name

   Shareplus
plan year
     Vesting date      At
1 July
2013
     Granted (1)      Vested (2)      At
30 June
2014
 

Executive Director

                 

Andrew Mackenzie

     2012         Apr 2015         41                         41   
     2011         Aug 2014         170                         170   
        

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

           211                         211   
        

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Other members of the GMC

                 

Peter Beaven

     2012         Apr 2015         108                         108   
     2011         Aug 2014         128                         128   
        

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

           236                         236   
        

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

330


Table of Contents

Name

   Shareplus
plan year
     Vesting date      At
1 July
2013
     Granted (1)      Vested (2)      At
30 June
2014
 

Tim Cutt (3)

     2012         Apr 2015         84                         84   
     2011         Aug 2014         54                         54   
        

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

           138                         138   
        

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Dean Dalla Valle

     2012         Apr 2015         113                         113   
     2011         Aug 2014         149                         149   
        

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

           262                         262   
        

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Mike Fraser (4)

     2012         Apr 2015         89                         89   
     2011         Aug 2014         178                         178   
        

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

           267                         267   
        

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Mike Henry

     2012         Apr 2015         39                         39   
     2011         Aug 2014         179                         179   
        

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

           218                         218   
        

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Graham Kerr

     2012         Apr 2015         38                         38   
     2011         Aug 2014         150                         150   
        

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

           188                         188   
        

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Jane McAloon

     2012         Apr 2015         103                         103   
     2011         Aug 2014         138                         138   
        

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

           241                         241   
        

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Jimmy Wilson

     2012         Apr 2015         106                         106   
     2011         Aug 2014         150                         150   
        

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

           256                         256   
        

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Karen Wood

     2012         Apr 2015         39                         39   
     2011         Aug 2014         149                         149   
        

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

           188                         188   
        

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1)  No Matched Shares were allocated to GMC members during FY2014.

 

(2)  The scheduled vesting of rights acquired during the 2011 Shareplus Plan Year (i.e. from salary contributions from June 2011 to May 2012) in April 2014 was delayed as members of the GMC were in a prohibited period. These Matched Shares have since vested, on 20 August 2014.

 

(3)  Tim Cutt’s Shareplus awards are held over ADRs on the NYSE. Each ADR is equivalent to two ordinary shares in BHP Billiton Limited.

 

(4)  Mike Fraser participated in the cash based equivalent of Shareplus during 2011 and 2012 when he was located in Mozambique where local jurisdictional requirements prevent the operation of a share based plan.

Other disclosures

4.4.27    Ordinary share holdings and transactions

The number of ordinary shares in BHP Billiton Limited or in BHP Billiton Plc held directly, indirectly or beneficially, by each individual (including shares held in the name of the spouse, superannuation fund, nominee and/or other controlled entities) are shown in table below as at 30 June 2014. In addition, there have been no changes in the interests of any Directors in the period to 11 August 2014 (being one month prior to the date of the notice of the 2014 AGMs). These are ordinary shares held without performance conditions or restrictions and are

 

331


Table of Contents

included in MSR calculations for each individual. MSR calculations for members of the GMC (including the CEO) also include any vested but unexercised employee awards as shown in previous sections of the report.

 

    BHP Billiton Limited Shares     BHP Billiton Plc Shares  
    Held at 1
July 2013
    Purchased     Received     Sold     Held at 30
June 2014
    Held at 1
July 2013
    Purchased     Received     Sold     Held at 30
June 2014
 

Executive Director

                     

Andrew Mackenzie

                                       72,619               267,144        137,842        201,921   

Other members of the GMC

  

                   

Peter Beaven

    73,533               229,689        118,621        184,601                                      

Tony Cudmore

                                                                     

Tim Cutt (1)

    17,466               34,917        16,142        36,241                                      

Dean Dalla Valle

    109,663               33,061        15,668        127,056                                      

Mike Fraser (2)

                                       148,282               14,720        2,453        160,549   

Geoff Healy

    3,000                             3,000                                      

Mike Henry

    18,696                             18,696        75,564               36,066               111,630   

Graham Kerr

    49,598               94,626        49,640        94,584                                      

Jane McAloon

    36,070               20,119        9,535        46,654                                      

Daniel Malchuk

                  60,335        7,648        52,687                                      

Jimmy Wilson

    1,552               149,127        34,564        116,115        59,301               13,400        13,400        59,301   

Karen Wood

    313,013               143,539        88,539        368,013                                      

Non-executive Directors

                     

Malcolm Brinded (3)

                                       12,000                             12,000   

Malcolm Broomhead

    9,000                             9,000                                      

John Buchanan

                                       20,000                             20,000   

Carlos Cordeiro (1)

    6,550                             6,550                                      

David Crawford

    33,127                             33,127        6,000                             6,000   

Pat Davies

                                       27,170                             27,170   

Carolyn Hewson

    7,000        7,000                      14,000                                      

Lindsay Maxsted

    3,000        3,500                      6,500                                      

Wayne Murdy (1)

    8,000                             8,000        14,000                             14,000   

Jac Nasser (1)

    10,400                             10,400        81,200                             81,200   

Keith Rumble

                                       14,500        6,180                      20,680   

John Schubert

    23,675                             23,675                                      

Shriti Vadera

                                       9,000                             9,000   

 

(1)  The following BHP Billiton Limited shares and BHP Billiton Plc shares are held in the form of American Depositary Shares: Tim Cutt (470 BHP Billiton Limited), Carlos Cordeiro (3,275 BHP Billiton Limited), Wayne Murdy (4,000 BHP Billiton Limited; 7,000 BHP Billiton Plc) and Jac Nasser (5,200 BHP Billiton Limited; 40,600 BHP Billiton Plc).

 

(2)  The opening balance shown for Mike Fraser reflects his holdings on 27 August 2013 (rather than 1 July 2013) being the date he joined the GMC.

 

(3)  The opening balance shown for Malcolm Brinded reflects his holdings on 15 April 2014 (rather than 1 July 2013) being the date that he was appointed to the Board.

4.4.28    Payments to past Directors

UK regulations require the disclosure of payments to past Directors (1).

As foreshadowed in the 2013 Remuneration Report, the following payments were made to Marius Kloppers (CEO and Executive Director until 10 May 2013):

 

  325,000 LTI awards, granted in 2008, vested on 21 August 2013. The closing price of ordinary BHP Billiton Limited shares on that date was A$35.74 and so the value of the vested award was US$12.051 million (including the related DEP of US$1.560 million).

 

  123,250 LTI awards, granted in 2009, vested on 20 August 2014. The closing price of ordinary BHP Billiton Limited shares on that date was A$38.13 and so the value of the vested award was US$5.883 million (including the related DEP of US$0.636 million).

 

332


Table of Contents
  For the period 10 May to 1 October 2013, base salary, pension contributions and applicable benefits were provided.

There were no payments made for loss of office in FY2014.

 

(1)  The Remuneration Committee has adopted a de minimis threshold of US$7,500 in relation to disclosure of payments to past Directors under UK requirements.

4.4.29    Relative importance of spend on pay

The table below sets out the total spend on employee remuneration during FY2014 (and the prior year), compared with other significant expenditure items. The table includes items as prescribed in the UK requirements. BHP Billiton has included tax payments and purchases of property, plant and equipment, being the most significant other outgoings in monetary terms.

 

US dollars million

   FY2014      FY2013  

Aggregate employee benefits expense LOGO Section 7.1.6 Note 5

     7,038         7,356   

Dividends paid to BHP Billiton shareholders LOGO Section 7.1.4

     6,387         6,167   

Share buy-backs LOGO Section 7.1.4

               

Income tax paid and royalty-related taxation paid (net of refunds) LOGO Section 7.1.4

     6,465         8,574   

Purchases of property, plant and equipment LOGO Section 7.1.4

     15,993         22,243   

4.4.30    Retirement disclosures for the Non-executive Directors

The following table sets out the accrued retirement benefits under the now-closed Retirement Plan of BHP Billiton Limited. The Retirement Plan was closed on 24 October 2003 and entitlements that had accumulated in respect of each of the participants were frozen. These will be paid on retirement. An earnings rate equal to the five-year Australian Government Bond Rate is being applied to the frozen entitlements from that date.

 

US dollars (’000)

     Completed service at
30 June 2014 (years)
       Change in lump sum
entitlement during
the year (1)
       Lump sum entitlement at  
               30 June 2014        30 June 2013  

David Crawford

       20           41           601           560   

John Schubert

       14           20           300           280   

 

(1)  No further entitlements have accrued since the closure of the Retirement Plan in 2003. The movement reflects the application of the earnings rate and foreign exchange rate (the translation from Australian dollars to US dollars for the Remuneration Report) to the lump sum entitlement at the date of closure.

4.4.31     Transactions with KMP

During the financial year, there were no purchases by KMP from the Group (2013: US$ nil; 2012: US$ nil).

There are no amounts payable at 30 June 2014 (2013: US$ nil).

Loans with KMP

There are US$ nil loans (2013: US$ nil) with KMP.

Transactions with personally related entities

A number of Directors of the Group hold or have held positions in other companies, where it is considered they control or significantly influence the financial or operating policies of those entities. There have been no transactions with those entities and no amounts were owed by the Group to personally related entities (2013: US$ nil).

 

333


Table of Contents

This Remuneration Report was approved by the Board on 11 September 2014 and signed on its behalf by:

 

 

John Buchanan
Chairman, Remuneration Committee
11 September 2014

 

334


Table of Contents

5    Directors’ Report

The information presented by the Directors in this Directors’ Report relates to BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc and their subsidiaries. Section 1 Strategic Report (which includes the Chairman’s Review in section 1.3 and the Chief Executive Officer’s Report in section 1.4, and incorporates the operating and financial review), section 2 Our Assets, section 3 Corporate Governance Statement, section 4 Remuneration Report, section 7 Financial Statements and section 9 Shareholder information of this Annual Report are each incorporated by reference into, and form part of, this Directors’ Report.

The Directors confirm, on the advice of the Risk and Audit Committee, that they consider the Annual Report (including the Financial Statements), taken as a whole, is fair, balanced and understandable and provides the information necessary for shareholders to assess the Group’s performance, business model and strategy.

5.1    Review of operations, principal activities and state of affairs

A review of the operations of the Group during FY2014, the results of those operations during FY2014 and the expected results of those operations in future financial years, are set out in section 1, in particular in sections 1.1, 1.3 to 1.5, 1.11, 1.12 and 1.15 and other material in this Annual Report. Information on the development of the Group and likely developments in future years also appears in those sections of this Annual Report.

Our principal activities during FY2014 were exploration, development, production and processing of minerals (in respect of iron ore, metallurgical and energy coal, copper, aluminium, manganese, uranium, nickel, silver and potash), and exploration, development and production of conventional and unconventional oil and gas. No significant changes in the nature of the Group’s principal activities occurred during FY2014.

Information in relation to significant changes in the state of affairs of the Group that occurred during FY2014 and significant post-balance date events is set out below and in sections 1.12 and 2.1 of this Annual Report.

 

  On 1 July 2013 Mike Yeager retired from the Group Management Committee (GMC) and from his role as Group Executive and Chief Executive – Petroleum and Tim Cutt joined the GMC as President, Petroleum and Potash on 2 July 2013. During FY2014, we made further announcements relating to GMC changes: Mike Fraser joined the GMC as President, Human Resources on 27 August 2013 and Tony Cudmore joined the GMC as President, Corporate Affairs on 3 March 2014.

 

  On 25 July 2013 we announced the investment of US$1.97 billion (BHP Billiton share) to sustain operations at Escondida in Chile by constructing a new 2,500 litre per second seawater desalination plant. On 23 July 2014 we announced the seawater desalination plant was on schedule and budget, with 12 per cent of the overall project complete.

 

  On 20 August 2013 we announced the investment of US$2.6 billion to finish the excavation and lining of the Jansen Potash Project’s production and services shafts, and to continue the installation of essential surface infrastructure and utilities. We made further announcements in FY2014 that the investment will be spread over a number of years with the timeframes for both shaft completions being extended with no changes to the budget or long-term development plans. On 19 August 2014 we announced the overall project was 30 per cent complete and on budget.

 

  On 26 September 2013 we announced the pricing of US$5.0 billion Global Bonds (four tranches) under the debt shelf registration statement, which had previously been filed with the US Securities and Exchange Commission.

 

  On 2 January 2014 we announced the redemption of Petrohawk Energy Corporation 10.5 per cent Senior Notes due 2014 and 7.875 per cent Senior Notes due 2015. The total aggregate principal value of the notes redeemed was approximately US$1.4 billion.

 

335


Table of Contents
  On 15 April 2014 Malcolm Brinded was appointed as a Non-executive Director of BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc. In accordance with the Constitution of BHP Billiton Limited and the Articles of Association of BHP Billiton Plc, Mr Brinded will seek election at the 2014 Annual General Meetings.

 

  On 14 July 2014 we announced the redemption of Petrohawk Energy Corporation 7.25 per cent Senior Notes due 2018 and 6.25 per cent Senior Notes due 2019. The total aggregate principal value of the notes to be redeemed was approximately US$1.8 billion.

 

  On 19 August 2014 we announced the proposal to create a new global metals and mining company based on a demerger of a selection of the Group’s high-quality aluminium, coal, manganese, nickel and silver assets to accelerate portfolio simplification. We also announced that shareholders will have the opportunity to vote on the proposal once all necessary approvals are in place.

 

  On 19 August 2014, following the announcement in relation to creating a new global metals and mining company, we announced that Graham Kerr, currently Chief Financial Officer, is appointed Chief Executive Officer-designate of the new company. Graham will retire from the GMC on 1 October 2014 and will be replaced as Chief Financial Officer by Peter Beaven, currently President, Copper.

 

  On 19 August 2014 Karen Wood retired from the GMC from her role as President, Corporate.

No other matter or circumstance has arisen since the end of FY2014 that has significantly affected or is expected to significantly affect the operations, the results of operations or state of affairs of the Group in future years.

5.2    Share capital and buy-back programs

At the Annual General Meetings held in 2013, shareholders authorised BHP Billiton Plc to make on-market purchases of up to 213,618,545 of its ordinary shares, representing 10 per cent of BHP Billiton Plc’s issued share capital at that time. During FY2014, we did not make any on-market or off-market purchases of BHP Billiton Limited shares or BHP Billiton Plc shares under any share buy-back program. As at the date of this Directors’ Report there are no current on-market buy-backs.

Shareholders will be asked at the 2014 Annual General Meetings to renew this authority. The Directors have no present intention to exercise this authority, if granted.

Some of our executives receive rights over BHP Billiton shares as part of their remuneration arrangements. Entitlements may be satisfied by the transfer of existing shares, which are acquired on-market, or in respect of some entitlements, by the issue of new shares.

 

336


Table of Contents

The shares in column ‘A’ below were purchased to satisfy awards made under the various BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc employee share schemes during FY2014.

 

Period

  A
Total
number of
shares
purchased
    B
Average
price paid

per share (1)
US$
    C
Total
number of
shares
purchased
as part of
publicly
announced
plans or
programs
    D
Maximum number of shares that
may yet be purchased under the
plans or programs
 
                      BHP Billiton
Limited (2)
   

BHP Billiton

Plc

 

1 Jul 2013 to 31 Jul 2013

    717,947        28.76                      213,618,545  (3) 

1 Aug 2013 to 31 Aug 2013

    5,203,727        33.22                      213,618,545  (3) 

1 Sep 2013 to 30 Sep 2013

    1,716,615        32.17                      213,618,545  (3) 

1 Oct 2013 to 31 Oct 2013

    137,549        37.39                      213,618,545  (3) 

1 Nov 2013 to 30 Nov 2013

    1,079,604        34.31                      213,618,545  (4) 

1 Dec 2013 to 31 Dec 2013

                                213,618,545  (4) 

1 Jan 2014 to 31 Jan 2014

    26,417        30.53                      213,618,545  (4) 

1 Feb 2014 to 28 Feb 2014

    4,236        35.41                      213,618,545  (4) 

1 Mar 2014 to 31 Mar 2014

    1,037,212        32.30                      213,618,545  (4) 

1 Apr 2014 to 30 Apr 2014

                                213,618,545  (4) 

1 May 2014 to 31 May 2014

    30,208        32.43                      213,618,545  (4) 

1 Jun 2014 to 30 Jun 2014

    1,231,380        34.35                      213,618,545  (4) 
 

 

 

   

 

 

       

 

 

 

Total

    11,184,895        32.96                      213,618,545  (4) 
 

 

 

   

 

 

       

 

 

 

 

(1)  The shares were purchased in the currency of the stock exchange on which the purchase took place, and the sale price has been converted into US dollars at the exchange rate on the day of purchase.

 

(2)  BHP Billiton Limited is able to buy-back and cancel BHP Billiton Limited shares within the ‘10/12 limit’ without shareholder approval in accordance with section 257B of the Australian Corporations Act 2001. Any future on-market share buy-back program will be conducted in accordance with the Australian Corporations Act 2001 and with the ASX Listing Rules.

 

(3)  At the Annual General Meetings held during 2012, shareholders authorised BHP Billiton Plc to make on-market purchases of up to 213,618,545 of its ordinary shares, representing 10 per cent of BHP Billiton Plc’s issued capital at the time.

 

(4)  At the Annual General Meetings held during 2013, shareholders authorised BHP Billiton Plc to make on-market purchases of up to 213,618,545 of its ordinary shares, representing 10 per cent of BHP Billiton Plc’s issued capital at the time.

5.3    Results, financial instruments and going concern

Information about our financial position and financial results is included in the Financial Statements in this Annual Report. The income statement shows profit attributable to BHP Billiton members of US$13.8 billion compared with US$11.2 billion in FY2013.

 

337


Table of Contents

The Group’s business activities, together with the factors likely to affect its future development, performance and position are discussed in section 1 of this Annual Report. In addition, sections 1.5 to 1.7 and 3.15, and note 29 ‘Financial risk management’ to the Financial Statements detail the Group’s capital management objectives, its approach to financial risk management and exposure to financial risks, liquidity and borrowing facilities.

The Directors, having made appropriate enquiries, have a reasonable expectation that the Group has adequate resources to continue in operational existence for the foreseeable future. Therefore they continue to adopt the going concern basis of accounting in preparing the annual Financial Statements.

5.4    Directors

The Directors who served at any time during or since the end of the financial year are Jac Nasser, Andrew Mackenzie, Malcolm Brinded, Malcolm Broomhead, John Buchanan, Carlos Cordeiro, David Crawford, Pat Davies, Carolyn Hewson, Lindsay Maxsted, Wayne Murdy, Keith Rumble, John Schubert and Shriti Vadera. Further details of the Directors of BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc are set out in section 3.2 of this Annual Report. These details include the period for which each Director held office up to the date of this Directors’ Report, their qualifications, experience and particular responsibilities, the directorships held in other listed companies since 1 July 2011, and the period for which each directorship has been held.

Mr Brinded was appointed as a Non-executive Director of BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc with effect from 15 April 2014 and, in accordance with the Constitution of BHP Billiton Limited and the Articles of Association of BHP Billiton Plc, he will seek election at the 2014 Annual General Meetings.

The number of meetings of the Board and its Committees held during the year and each Director’s attendance at those meetings are set out in section 3.12 of this Annual Report.

5.5    Remuneration and share interests

5.5.1    Remuneration

The policy for determining the nature and amount of emoluments of members of the GMC (including the Executive Director) and the Non-executive Directors and information about the relationship between that policy and our performance are set out in sections 4.3 and 4.4 of this Annual Report.

The remuneration tables contained in section 4.4 of this Annual Report set out the remuneration of members of the GMC (including the Executive Director) and the Non-executive Directors.

5.5.2    Directors

The information contained in section 4.4.27 and section 5.17 of this Directors’ Report sets out the relevant interests in shares in BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc of the Directors who held office during FY2014, at the beginning and end of FY2014, and in relation to all Directors in office as at the date of this Directors’ Report, their relevant interests in shares in BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc as at the date of this Directors’ Report. No rights over shares in BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc are held by any of the Non-executive Directors. Interests held by the Executive Director under employee equity plans as at 30 June 2014 are set out in the tables showing interests in incentive plans contained in section 4.4 and note 31 ‘Key Management Personnel’ to the Financial Statements of this Annual Report.

We have not made available to any Director any interest in a registered scheme.

The former Directors of BHP Limited participated in a retirement plan under which they were entitled to receive a payment on retirement calculated by reference to years of service. This plan was closed on 24 October 2003, and benefits accrued to that date are held by BHP Billiton Limited and will be paid on retirement. Further information about this plan and its closure are set out in section 4.4.30 of this Annual Report.

 

338


Table of Contents

5.5.3    GMC members

The information contained in section 4.4.27 and section 5.18 of this Directors’ Report sets out the relevant interests held by those senior executives who were members of the GMC (other than the Executive Director) during FY2014 in shares of BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc at the beginning and end of FY2014, and at the date of this Directors’ Report. Interests held by members of the GMC under employee equity plans as at 30 June 2014 are set out in the tables showing interests in incentive plans contained in section 4.4 and note 31 ‘Key Management Personnel’ to the Financial Statements of this Annual Report.

5.6    Secretaries

Jane McAloon is the Group Company Secretary. Details of her qualifications and experience are set out in section 3.2 of this Annual Report. The following people also act as company secretaries of BHP Billiton Limited, BHP Billiton Plc or both (as indicated): Nicole Duncan BA (Hons), LLB (BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc), Geof Stapledon, BEc, LLB (Hons), DPhil, FCIS (BHP Billiton Plc) and Elizabeth Hobley, BA (Hons), ACIS (BHP Billiton Plc). Each such individual has experience in a company secretariat role or other relevant fields arising from time spent in such roles within BHP Billiton, large listed companies or other relevant entities.

5.7    Indemnities and insurance

Rule 146 of the BHP Billiton Limited Constitution and Article 146 of the BHP Billiton Plc Articles of Association require each Company to indemnify to the extent permitted by law, each Director, Secretary or Executive Officer of BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc respectively against liability incurred in, or arising out of, the conduct of the business of the Company or the discharge of the duties of the Director, Secretary and Executive Officer. The Directors named in section 3.2 of this Annual Report, the Executive Officers and the Company Secretaries of BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc have the benefit of this requirement, as do individuals who formerly held one of those positions.

In accordance with this requirement, BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc have entered into Deeds of Indemnity, Access and Insurance (Deeds of Indemnity) with each of their respective Directors. The Deeds of Indemnity are qualifying third party indemnity provisions for the purposes of the UK Companies Act 2006.

We have a policy that we will, as a general rule, support and hold harmless an employee, including an employee appointed as a Director of a subsidiary who, while acting in good faith, incurs personal liability to others as a result of working for us.

From time to time, we engage our External Auditor, KPMG, to conduct non-statutory audit work and provide other services in accordance with our policy on the provision of other services by the External Auditor. The terms of engagement typically include an indemnity in favour of KPMG:

 

  against all losses, claims, costs, expenses, actions, demands, damages, liabilities or any proceedings (liabilities) incurred by KPMG in respect of third party claims arising from a breach by the Group under the engagement terms;

 

  for all liabilities KPMG has to the Group or any third party as a result of reliance on information provided by the Group that is false, misleading or incomplete.

We have insured against amounts that we may be liable to pay to Directors, Company Secretaries or certain employees pursuant to Rule 146 of the Constitution of BHP Billiton Limited and Article 146 of the Articles of Association of BHP Billiton Plc or that we otherwise agree to pay by way of indemnity. The insurance policy also insures Directors, Company Secretaries and some employees against certain liabilities (including legal costs) they may incur in carrying out their duties for us.

 

339


Table of Contents

We have paid premiums for this Directors’ and Officers’ insurance of US$2,088,352 net during FY2014.

No indemnity in favour of a current or former officer of BHP Billiton Limited or BHP Billiton Plc, or in favour of the External Auditor, has been called on during FY2014.

5.8    Employee policies

We are committed to open, honest and productive relationships with our employees. At BHP Billiton, we recognise the most important ingredient for success is our talented and motivated workforce, whose members demonstrate behaviours that are aligned to Our BHP Billiton Charter values.

Further information in relation to employee engagement and employee policies, including communications and disabilities, can be found in section 1.13.2.

5.9    Corporate governance

The UK Financial Conduct Authority’s Disclosure and Transparency Rules (DTR 7.2) require that certain information be included in a corporate governance statement set out in the Directors’ Report. BHP Billiton has an existing practice of issuing a separate corporate governance statement as part of its Annual Report. The information required by the Disclosure and Transparency Rules and the UK Financial Conduct Authority’s Listing Rules (LR 9.8.6) is located in section 3 of this Annual Report, with the exception of the information referred to in LR 9.8.6 (1), (3) and (4) and DTR 7.2.6, which is located in sections 5.2, 5.3, 5.17 and 5.20 of this Annual Report.

5.10    Dividends

A final dividend of 62 US cents per share will be paid on 23 September 2014, resulting in total dividends in respect of FY2014 of 121 US cents per share. Details of the dividends paid and the dividend policy are set out in sections 1.6.3 and 9.7 of this Annual Report.

5.11    Auditors

A resolution to reappoint KPMG LLP as the auditor of BHP Billiton Plc will be proposed at the 2014 Annual General Meetings in accordance with section 489 of the UK Companies Act 2006.

During FY2014 Mr Maxsted was the only officer of BHP Billiton who previously held the role of director or partner of the Group’s External Auditor at a time when the Group’s External Auditor conducted an audit of the Group. Mr Maxsted’s prior relationship with KPMG is set out in section 3.10 of this Annual Report. Mr Maxsted was not part of the KPMG audit practice after 1980 and, while at KPMG, was not in any way involved in, or able to influence, any audit activity associated with BHP Billiton.

Each person who held the office of Director at the date the Board resolved to approve this Directors’ Report makes the following statements:

 

  so far as the Director is aware, there is no relevant audit information of which the Group’s External Auditor is unaware; and

 

  the Director has taken all steps that he or she ought to have taken as a Director to make him or herself aware of any relevant audit information and to establish that the Group’s External Auditor is aware of that information.

This confirmation is given pursuant to Section 418 of the UK Companies Act 2006 and should be interpreted in accordance with and subject to these provisions.

 

340


Table of Contents

5.12    Non-audit services

Details of the non-audit services undertaken by our External Auditor, including the amounts paid for non-audit services, are set out in note 35 ‘Auditor’s remuneration’ to the Financial Statements of this Annual Report. All non-audit services were approved in accordance with the process set out in the Policy on Provision of Audit and Other Services by the External Auditor, and no non-audit services were carried out which were specifically excluded by the Policy on Provision of Audit and Other Services by the External Auditor. Based on advice provided by the Risk and Audit Committee, the Directors have formed the view that the provision of non-audit services is compatible with the general standard of independence for auditors, and that the nature of non-audit services means that auditor independence was not compromised. Further information about our policy in relation to the provision of non-audit services by the auditor is set out in section 3.14.1 of this Annual Report.

5.13    Political donations

No political contributions/donations for political purposes were made to any political party, politician, elected official or candidate for public office during FY2014. (1)

 

(1)  Note that Australian Electoral Commission (AEC) disclosure requirements are broad, such that amounts that are not political donations can be reportable for AEC purposes. For example, where a political party or organisation owns shares in BHP Billiton, the AEC filing requires the political party or organisation to disclose the dividend payments received for their shareholding.

5.14    Exploration, research and development

Companies within the Group carry out exploration and research and development necessary to support their activities. Further details are provided in sections 1.6.3, 1.12, 1.15.1, 2.1 and 2.3.2 of this Annual Report.

5.15    Class order

BHP Billiton Limited is a company of a kind referred to in Australian Securities and Investments Commission Class Order No. 98/100, dated 10 July 1998. Amounts in this Directors’ Report and the Financial Statements, except estimates of future expenditure or where otherwise indicated, have been rounded to the nearest million dollars in accordance with that Class Order.

5.16    Proceedings on behalf of BHP Billiton Limited

No proceedings have been brought on behalf of BHP Billiton Limited, nor any application made under section 237 of the Australian Corporations Act 2001.

5.17    Directors’ shareholdings

Except for Mr Maxsted and Mr Mackenzie, as at the date of this Directors’ Report, the information pertaining to shares in BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc held directly, indirectly or beneficially, by Directors is the same as set out in the table in section 4.4.27. Where applicable, the information includes shares held in the name of a spouse, superannuation fund, nominee and/or other controlled entities.

As at the date of this Directors’ Report, Mr Maxsted indirectly holds 8,000 shares in BHP Billiton Limited and Mr Mackenzie holds (either directly, indirectly or beneficially) 266,164 shares in BHP Billiton Plc.

5.18    GMC members’ shareholdings (other than Directors)

As at 30 June 2014, the information pertaining to shares in BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc held directly, indirectly or beneficially, by those senior executives who were members of the GMC during FY2014 (other than the Executive Director) is set out in the table in section 4.4.27. Where applicable, the information includes shares held in the name of a spouse, superannuation fund, nominee and/or other controlled entities.

 

341


Table of Contents

As at the date of this Directors’ Report, the information pertaining to shares in BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc held directly, indirectly or beneficially, by those senior executives who were members of the GMC during FY2014 (other than the Executive Director) is as follows and, where applicable, the information includes shares held in the name of a spouse, superannuation fund, nominee and/or other controlled entities:

 

GMC Member (1) (2)

  

BHP Billiton entity

   As at date of
Directors’ Report
 

Peter Beaven

  

BHP Billiton Limited

BHP Billiton Plc

    

 

184,473

  

  

Tony Cudmore

  

BHP Billiton Limited

BHP Billiton Plc

    

 


  

  

Tim Cutt (3)

  

BHP Billiton Limited

BHP Billiton Plc

    

 

56,459

  

  

Dean Dalla Valle

  

BHP Billiton Limited

BHP Billiton Plc

    

 

126,907

  

  

Mike Fraser

  

BHP Billiton Limited

BHP Billiton Plc

    

 


172,696

  

  

Geoff Healy

  

BHP Billiton Limited

BHP Billiton Plc

    

 

3,000

  

  

Mike Henry

  

BHP Billiton Limited

BHP Billiton Plc

    

 

21,879

162,632

  

  

Graham Kerr

  

BHP Billiton Limited

BHP Billiton Plc

    

 

119,272

  

  

Jane McAloon

  

BHP Billiton Limited

BHP Billiton Plc

    

 

59,581

  

  

Daniel Malchuk

  

BHP Billiton Limited

BHP Billiton Plc

    

 

66,307

  

  

Jimmy Wilson

  

BHP Billiton Limited

BHP Billiton Plc

    

 

115,965

59,301

  

  

 

(1)  New members appointed to the GMC during FY2014: Tim Cutt (appointed 2 July 2013), Mike Fraser (appointed 26 August 2013) and Tony Cudmore (appointed 15 January 2014).

 

(2)  Karen Wood ceased to be a member of the GMC on 19 August 2014. The disclosed holdings as at 30 June 2014 set out in section 4.4.27 of the Annual Report reflect her holdings as at the date of ceasing to be a member of the GMC.

 

(3)  736 BHP Billiton Limited shares are held in the form of 368 American Depositary Shares.

5.19    Performance in relation to environmental regulation

A significant environmental incident is one with a severity rating of four and above based on our internal severity rating scale (tiered from one to seven by increasing severity). An environmental incident with a severity level four is one that causes a major impact/s to land, biodiversity, ecosystem services, water resources or air, with effects lasting greater than one year. There were no significant environmental incidents reported at our operated assets in FY2014.

Fines and prosecutions

In FY2014, BHP Billiton received nine fines at our operated assets, with a total value of US$128,898.

A fine of US$94,455 was levied at Energy Coal South Africa’s Khutala Colliery, which self-reported a non-compliance against its environmental impact assessment requirements defined by the National Environmental Management Act. As a result, the asset has appointed an independent Environmental Control Officer and introduced a strengthened land disturbance permit procedure.

 

342


Table of Contents

NSW Energy Coal incurred three fines totalling US$6,971 at its Mt Arthur Operations for blasting penalty infringements outside the manufacturer’s recommended sleep time, failure to comply with the approved erosion and sediment control plan and carrying out dumping operations on an elevated and exposed area during adverse weather conditions. Actions are in place to prevent these infringements occurring again.

The five other fines, totalling US$27,472, were levied in North and South America, where our operations were cited for activities in relation to regulatory breaches against permit requirements and for loss of containment. The impacted assets are reviewing measures to prevent these incidents from occurring in the future.

Greenhouse gas emissions

The UK Companies Act 2006 requires, to the extent practicable, the Company to obtain relevant information on the Company’s annual quantity of greenhouse gas emissions which is reported in tonnes of carbon dioxide equivalent. The Company’s total 2014 greenhouse gas emissions and intensity are set out in sections 1.10 and 1.14.4 of this Annual Report.

Further information in relation to environmental performance, including environmental regulation, can be found in section 1.14.4 of this Annual Report and in the Sustainability Report available online at www.bhpbilliton.com.

5.20    Share capital, restrictions on transfer of shares and other additional information

Information relating to BHP Billiton Plc’s share capital structure, restrictions on the holding or transfer of its securities or on the exercise of voting rights attaching to such securities, certain agreements triggered on a change of control and the existence of branches of BHP Billiton outside of the United Kingdom, is set out in the following sections of this Annual Report:

 

  Section 1.2 (BHP Billiton locations)

 

  Section 5.2 (Share capital and buy-back programs)

 

  Section 9.3 (Organisational structure)

 

  Section 9.4 (Material contracts)

 

  Section 9.5 (Constitution)

 

  Section 9.6 (Share ownership)

 

  Section 9.11 (Government regulations)

 

  Note 19 ‘Share capital’ and note 33 ‘Employee share ownership plans’ to the Financial Statements of this Annual Report.

Further details of all unvested equity awards as at the date of this Directors’ Report, including shares issued upon exercise of equity awards, are set out in note 33 ‘Employee share ownership plans’ to the Financial Statements of this Annual Report. Details of movements in share capital during and since the end of the financial year are set out in note 19 ‘Share capital’ to the Financial Statements of this Annual Report.

The Directors’ Report is made in accordance with a resolution of the Board.

Jac Nasser AO

Chairman

Andrew Mackenzie

Chief Executive Officer

Dated: 11 September 2014

 

343


Table of Contents

6    Legal proceedings

We are involved from time to time in legal proceedings and governmental investigations of a character normally incidental to our business, including claims and pending actions against us seeking damages or clarification of legal rights and regulatory inquiries regarding business practices. In many cases, insurance or other indemnification protection afforded to us relates to such claims and may offset the financial impact on the Group of a successful claim.

This section summarises the significant legal proceedings and investigations in which we are currently involved.

Rio Algom Pension Plan

In June 2003, Alexander E Lomas, a retired member of the Rio Algom Limited Pension Plan for Salaried Employees (Pension Plan), filed a Notice of Application in a representative capacity in the Ontario Superior Court of Justice Commercial List against Rio Algom Limited (RAL) and the Plan Trustee alleging certain improprieties in their administration of the Pension Plan and use of Pension Plan funds from January 1966 onward.

Mr Lomas sought relief, both quantified and unquantified, for himself and those Pension Plan members he purported to represent in respect of a number of alleged breaches committed by RAL, including allegations of breach of employment contracts, breach of trust, and breach of the Trust Agreement underlying the Pension Plan. In particular:

 

  Mr Lomas sought US$117 million (C$125 million) on account of monies alleged to have been improperly paid out or withheld from the Pension Plan, together with compound interest calculated from the date of each alleged wrongdoing; and

 

  punitive, aggravated and exemplary damages in the sum of US$1.9 million (C$2 million).

Mr Lomas purported to represent members of the defined benefits portion of the Pension Plan. In 2005, the defined contribution members of the Pension Plan were included as parties to this action.

Between October 2006 and March 2010, various motions and appeals were argued by the parties. Among other things, these motions and appeals resulted in an order that the portion of the Application seeking an order directing RAL to apply for a wind-up of the Pension Plan be struck out of the Application.

In January 2014, the Court ordered that Ray Larson be substituted for Mr Lomas as the applicant in the Application. This motion was not opposed by RAL.

On 11 March 2014, RAL entered into a settlement with Mr Larson and other members of a committee of retired members of the Pension Plan. Subject to certain conditions being satisfied or waived, the settlement agreement provides for termination of the Pension Plan, the dismissal of the Application and releases from liability and subject to regulatory approval, the sharing of the surplus remaining in the Pension Plan upon wind-up between RAL and Pension Plan members and other persons entitled to benefits from the Pension Plan as at 11 March 2014, and those persons who had an entitlement under the Pension Plan at any time after 11 June 2003, but received payment of the commuted value of their entitlement under the Pension Plan prior to 11 March 2014. Court approval of the settlement agreement was granted on 25 June 2014.

Class actions concerning Cerrejón privatisation

The non-government organisation, Corporación Colombia Transparente (CCT), brought three separate class actions (Popular Actions 1,029, 1,032 and 1,048) against various defendants in connection with the privatisation of 50 per cent of the Cerrejón Zona Norte (CZN) mining complex in Colombia in 2002. The mining complex is

 

344


Table of Contents

currently owned by CZN and Carbones del Cerrejón Limited (CDC). Our subsidiary Billiton Investment 3 BV owns a 33 per cent share in CDC, and our subsidiaries Billiton Investment 3 BV and Billiton Investment 8 BV (BHP Billiton Shareholders) collectively own a 33.33 per cent share in CZN.

CCT alleges, in part, that the defendants failed to comply with the privatisation process, and that the offer price for shares in CZN between Stages 1 and 2 of the privatisation process was not correctly adjusted for inflation.

Our share of the alleged adjustment of the CZN share price would be approximately US$4.41 million. In the alternative, CCT seeks declaration that the privatisation is null and void and forfeiture of the transfer price paid, of which our share would be approximately US$147.14 million. In both instances, CCT also seeks unquantified sanctions, including payment of stamp taxes, an award of 15 per cent of all monies recovered by the defendants, together with interest on all amounts at the maximum rate authorised by law.

Popular Action 1,048 was dismissed in December 2008. Popular Action 1,032, the CZN action, was originally dismissed on 18 February 2011, the Court determining that there were no irregularities in the privatisation of the Cerrejón Zona Norte mining complex.

CCT’s request for a reconsideration of the judgment was denied. In March 2011, CCT filed an appeal against the dismissal. This appeal was dismissed in February 2013 and the plaintiff filed for a revision of the judgment. Revision of judgment is a new avenue of review introduced by the Columbian Administrative Code that applies to the last instance judgments and may be used when the plaintiff believes certain issues were not considered in the decision. In January 2014, the request for revision was denied and the action is therefore concluded. Popular Action 1,029 was dismissed in December 2008. Despite the fact that this dismissal was final, the plaintiff filed a tutela action at the Council of State challenging the dismissal and obtained from the Council of State a decision ordering the first instance judge to continue with the action. Neither CZN nor BHP Billiton shareholders were informed of this action. In August 2013, at the request of the defendants, the Council of State annulled the steps that had been taken in the proceeding and the defendants filed a reply to the action. The tutela action was then subsequently dismissed; however, an appeal has been filed against the dismissal.

A separate class action arising out of the privatisation of the CZN mining complex has been brought by Mr Martín Nicolás Barros Choles, against various defendants including CDC.

Mr Choles claims that the transfer of rights by CDC to CZN was ineffective because it only involved a transfer of shares and not the transfer of the underlying rights in the properties and assets used in the CZN mining complex. Consequently, he is seeking orders that CDC pays for the use and lease of the properties and assets until November 2009, and that from that date the properties and assets of the Cerrejón project revert to the State. This action remains in the discovery phase.

Investigations

As previously disclosed, BHP Billiton received requests for information in August 2009 from the US Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC). Following that request, the Group commenced an internal investigation and disclosed to relevant authorities evidence that it has uncovered regarding possible violations of applicable anti-corruption laws involving interactions with government officials.

The issues relate primarily to matters in connection with previously terminated exploration and development efforts, as well as hospitality provided as part of the Company’s sponsorship of the 2008 Beijing Olympics. The Group is currently discussing a potential resolution of the matter.

As has been publicly reported, the Australian Federal Police has indicated that it has commenced an investigation and the Group continues to fully cooperate with the relevant authorities.

In light of the continuing nature of the investigations it is not appropriate at this stage for BHP Billiton to predict outcomes.

 

345


Table of Contents

7    Financial Statements

Refer to the pages beginning on page F-1 in this annual report.

 

346


Table of Contents

8    Glossary

8.1    Mining, oil and gas-related terms

 

Term

  

Definition

2D

   Two dimensional.

3D

   Three dimensional.

Alumina

   Aluminium oxide (Al2O3). Alumina is produced from bauxite in the refining process. Alumina is then converted (reduced) in an electrolysis cell to produce aluminium metal.

Ash

   Inorganic material remaining after combustion.

AusIMM

   The Australasian Institute of Mining and Metallurgy.

Bauxite

   The chief ore of aluminium.

Beneficiation

   The process of physically separating ore from gangue prior to subsequent processing of the beneficiated ore.

Brownfield

   An exploration or development project located within an existing mineral province, which can share infrastructure and management with an existing operation.

Coal Reserves

   The same meaning as Ore Reserves, but specifically concerning coal.

Coking coal

   Used in the manufacture of coke, which is used in the steelmaking process by virtue of its carbonisation properties. Coking coal may also be referred to as metallurgical coal.

Competent Person

   A minerals industry professional who is a Member or Fellow of The Australasian Institute of Mining and Metallurgy, or of the Australian Institute of Geoscientists, or of a ‘Recognised Professional Organisation’ (RPO), as included in a list available on the JORC and ASX websites. These organisations have enforceable disciplinary processes, including the powers to suspend or expel a member. A Competent Person must have a minimum of five years’ relevant experience in the style of mineralisation or type of deposit under consideration and in the activity that the person is undertaking (JORC Code, 2012).

Condensate

   A mixture of hydrocarbons that exist in gaseous form in natural underground reservoirs, but which condense to form a liquid at atmospheric conditions.

Copper cathode

   Electrolytically refined copper that has been deposited on the cathode of an electrolytic bath of acidified copper sulphate solution. The refined copper may also be produced through leaching and electrowinning.

Crude oil

   A mixture of hydrocarbons that exist in liquid form in natural underground reservoirs, and remain liquid at atmospheric pressure after being produced at the well head and passing through surface separating facilities.
Cut-off grade    A nominated grade above which is defined an Ore Reserve or Mineral Resource. For example, the lowest grade of mineralised material that qualifies as economic for estimating an Ore Reserve.

 

347


Table of Contents

Term

  

Definition

CQCA

   Central Queensland Coal Associates.
Dated Brent    A benchmark price assessment of the spot market value of physical cargoes of North Sea light sweet crude oil.
Electrowinning/electrowon    An electrochemical process in which metal is recovered by dissolving a metal within an electrolyte and plating it onto an electrode.
Energy coal    Used as a fuel source in electrical power generation, cement manufacture and various industrial applications. Energy coal may also be referred to as steaming or thermal coal.
Ethane    A component of natural gas. Where sold separately, is largely ethane gas that has been liquefied through pressurisation. One tonne of ethane is approximately equivalent to 26.8 thousand cubic feet of gas.
FAusIMM    Fellow of the Australasian Institute of Mining and Metallurgy.
Field    An area consisting of a single reservoir or multiple reservoirs all grouped on or related to the same individual geological structural feature and/or stratigraphic condition. There may be two or more reservoirs in a field that are separated vertically by intervening impervious strata, or laterally by local geologic barriers, or by both. Reservoirs that are associated by being in overlapping or adjacent fields may be treated as a single or common operational field. The geological terms structural feature and stratigraphic condition are intended to identify localised geological features as opposed to the broader terms of basins, trends, provinces, plays, areas-of-interest, etc. (per SEC Regulation S-X, Rule 4-10).
Flotation    A method of selectively recovering minerals from finely ground ore using a froth created in water by specific reagents. In the flotation process, certain mineral particles are induced to float by becoming attached to bubbles of froth and the unwanted mineral particles sink.
FPSO (Floating, production, storage and off-take)    A floating vessel used by the offshore oil and gas industry for the processing of hydrocarbons and for storage of oil. An FPSO vessel is designed to receive hydrocarbons produced from nearby platforms or subsea templates, process them and store oil until it can be offloaded onto a tanker.
Grade    Any physical or chemical measurement of the characteristics of the material of interest in samples or product.
Greenfield    The development or exploration located outside the area of influence of existing mine operations/infrastructure.
GSSA    Geological Society of South Africa
Heap leach(ing)    A process used for the recovery of metals such as copper, nickel, uranium and gold from low-grade ores. The crushed material is laid on a slightly sloping, impermeable pad and leached by uniformly trickling (gravity fed) a chemical solution through the beds to ponds. The metals are recovered from the solution.

 

348


Table of Contents

Term

  

Definition

ICSID (International Centre for Settlement of Investment Disputes)    ICSID is an autonomous international institution that provides facilities and services to support conciliation and arbitration of international investment disputes between investors and States. ICSID was established under the Convention on the Settlement of Investment Disputes between States and Nationals of Other States (the ICSID Convention), with over 140 member States.

Kriging

   A geostatistical method of estimating resources based on a mathematical function known as a semivariogram.

Leaching

   The process by which a soluble metal can be economically recovered from minerals in ore by dissolution.

LNG (Liquefied natural gas)

   Consists largely of methane that has been liquefied through chilling and pressurisation. One tonne of LNG is approximately equivalent to 45.9 thousand cubic feet of natural gas.

LOI (Loss on ignition)

   A measure of the percentage of volatile matter (liquid or gas) contained within a mineral or rock. LOI is determined to calculate loss in mass during pyroprocessing.

LPG (Liquefied petroleum gas)

   Consists of propane and butane and a small amount (less than two per cent) of ethane that has been liquefied through pressurisation. One tonne of LPG is approximately equivalent to 11.6 barrels of oil.

MAIG

   Member of the Australian Institute of Geoscientists.

Marketable Coal Reserves

   Represents beneficiated or otherwise enhanced coal product where modifications due to mining, dilution and processing have been considered, must be publicly reported in conjunction with, but not instead of, reports of Coal Reserves. The basis of the predicted yield to achieve Marketable Coal Reserves must be stated (JORC Code, 2012).

MAusIMM

   Member of the Australasian Institute of Mining and Metallurgy.

Metallurgical coal

   A broader term than coking coal, which includes all coals used in steelmaking, such as coal used for the pulverised coal injection process.

Mineralisation

   Any single mineral or combination of minerals occurring in a mass, or deposit, of economic interest.

Modifying Factors

   Considerations used to convert Mineral Resources to Ore Reserves. These include, but are not restricted to, mining, processing, metallurgical, infrastructure, economic, marketing, legal, environmental, social and governmental factors.

NGL (Natural gas liquids)

   Consists of propane, butane and ethane – individually or as a mixture.

OC/OP (Open-cut/open-pit)

   Surface working in which the working area is kept open to the sky.

Ore Reserves

   The economically mineable part of a Measured and/or Indicated Mineral Resource. It includes diluting materials and allowances for losses, which may occur when the material is mined or extracted and is defined by studies at Pre-Feasibility or Feasibility

 

349


Table of Contents

Term

  

Definition

   level as appropriate that include application of Modifying Factors. Such studies demonstrate that, at the time of reporting, extraction could reasonably be justified.

PEGNL

   Association of Professional Engineers and Geoscientists of Newfoundland and Labrador.

Probable Ore Reserves

   Reserves for which quantity and grade and/or quality are computed from information similar to that used for proven reserves, but the sites for inspection, sampling, and measurement are farther apart or are otherwise less adequately spaced. The degree of assurance, although lower than that for proven reserves, is high enough to assume continuity between points of observation.

Proved oil and gas reserves

   Those quantities of oil, gas, and natural gas liquids, which, by analysis of geoscience and engineering data, can be estimated with reasonable certainty to be economically producible – from a given date forward, from known reservoirs, and under existing economic conditions, operating methods, and government regulations – prior to the time at which contracts providing the right to operate expire, unless evidence indicates that renewal is reasonably certain, regardless of whether deterministic or probabilistic methods are used for the estimation (from SEC Modernization of Oil and Gas Reporting, 2009).

Proven Ore Reserves

   Reserves for which quantity and grade and/or quality are computed from information similar to that used for proven reserves, but the sites for inspection, sampling, and measurement are farther apart or are otherwise less adequately spaced. The degree of assurance, although lower than that for proven reserves, is high enough to assume continuity between points of observation.
Qualified petroleum reserves and resources evaluator    A qualified petroleum reserves and resources evaluator, as defined in Chapter 19 of the ASX Listing Rules.

Reserve life

   Current stated Ore Reserves estimate divided by the current approved nominated production rate as at the end of the financial year.

Run of mine product

   Product mined in the course of regular mining activities.

SACNASP

   South African Council for Natural Scientific Professions.

SAIMM

   The Southern African Institute of Mining and Metallurgy.

SME reg’d member

   Registered member of the Society of Mining, Metallurgy and Exploration.

Solvent extraction

   A method of separating one or more metals from a leach solution by treating with a solvent that will extract the required metal, leaving the others. The metal is recovered from the solvent by further treatment.

Spud

   Commence drilling of an oil or gas well.

SP (Stockpile)

   An accumulation of ore or mineral built up when demand slackens or when the treatment plant or beneficiation equipment

 

350


Table of Contents

Term

  

Definition

   is incomplete or temporarily unable to process the mine output; any heap of material formed to create a buffer for loading or other purposes or material dug and piled for future use.

Tailings

   Those portions of washed or milled ore that are too poor to be treated further or remain after the required metals and minerals have been extracted.

TLP (Tension leg platform)

   A vertically moored floating facility for production of oil and gas.

Total Coal Reserves

   Run of mine reserves as outputs from the mining activities.

Total Ore Reserves

   Proven Ore Reserves plus Probable Ore Reserves.

8.2    Non-mining, oil and gas terms

 

Term

  

Definition

A$

   Australian dollars being the currency of the Commonwealth of Australia.

ADR (American Depositary Receipt)

   Instruments that trade on the NYSE.

ADS (American Depositary Share)

   A share issued under a deposit agreement that has been created to permit US-resident investors to hold shares in non-US companies and trade them on the stock exchanges in the United States. One ADS is equal to two BHP Billiton Limited shares. Similarly one ADS is equal to two BHP Billiton Plc ordinary shares. ADSs are evidenced by American Depositary Receipts, or ADRs, which are the instruments that trade on the NYSE.
ASIC (Australian Securities and Investments Commission)    The Australian Government agency that enforces laws relating to companies, securities, financial services and credit in order to protect consumers, investors and creditors.

ASX (Australian Securities Exchange)

   ASX is a multi-asset class vertically integrated exchange group that functions as a market operator, clearing house and payments system facilitator. It oversees compliance with its operating rules, promotes standards of corporate governance among Australia’s listed companies and helps educate retail investors.

Australian Tax Treaty

   A tax convention between Australia and the United States as to the avoidance of double taxation.

BHP Billiton

   Being both companies in the Dual Listed Company structure, BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc.

BHP Billiton Limited share

   A fully paid ordinary share in the capital of BHP Billiton Limited.

BHP Billiton Limited shareholders

   The holders of BHP Billiton Limited shares.

BHP Billiton Limited Special Voting Share

   A single voting share issued to facilitate joint voting by shareholders of BHP Billiton Limited on Joint Electorate Actions.

BHP Billiton Plc equalisation share

   A share that has been authorised to be issued to enable a distribution to be made by BHP Billiton Plc Group to the BHP Billiton Limited Group should this be required under the terms of the DLC merger.

 

351


Table of Contents

Term

  

Definition

BHP Billiton Plc 5.5 per cent preference share    Shares that have the right to repayment of the amount paid up on the nominal value and any unpaid dividends in priority of any other class of shares in BHP Billiton Plc on a return of capital or winding up.

BHP Billiton Plc share

   A fully paid ordinary share in the capital of BHP Billiton Plc.

BHP Billiton Plc shareholders

   The holders of BHP Billiton Plc shares.

BHP Billiton Plc Special Voting Share

   A single voting share issued to facilitate joint voting by shareholders of BHP Billiton Plc on Joint Electorate Actions.

Board

   The Board of Directors of BHP Billiton.

Business

   Refers to one of BHP Billiton’s Petroleum and Potash; Copper; Iron Ore; Coal; Aluminium, Manganese and Nickel Business Groups formed in May 2013. Collectively, they are referred to as the Businesses.

CEO

   Chief Executive Officer.
CFR (Cost and freight... named port of destination)    The seller must pay the costs and freight necessary to bring the goods to the named port of destination, but the risk of loss of, or damage to the goods, as well as any additional costs due to events occurring after the time the goods have been delivered on board the vessel, is transferred from the seller to the buyer when the goods pass the ship’s rail in the port of shipment. The CFR term requires the seller to clear the goods for shipment.

Community investment

   Contributions made to support communities in which we operate or have an interest. Our contributions to community programs comprise cash, in-kind support and administration costs. Our targeted level of contribution is one per cent of pre-tax profit calculated on the average of the previous three years’ pre-tax profit as reported.

CSG (Customer Sector Group)

   Prior to 10 May 2013, referred to as a BHP Billiton product-based global business unit.

CY20XX

   Refers to the calendar year ending 31 December 20XX, where XX is the two-digit number of the year.

Dividend Record Date

   The date, determined by a company’s board of directors, by when an investor must be recorded as an owner of shares in order to qualify for a forthcoming dividend.

DLC

   Dual Listed Company.

DLC merger

   The Dual Listed Company merger between BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc on 29 June 2001.

DLC structure

   The corporate structure resulting from the DLC merger.

EBIT

   Earnings before net finance costs and taxation.
EITI (Extractive Industries Transparency Initiative)    An international initiative dedicated to the enhancement of transparency around the payments of taxes and royalties derived from resource development.

 

352


Table of Contents

Term

  

Definition

FOB (Free on board... named port of shipment)    The seller delivers when the goods pass the ship’s rail at the named port of shipment. This means that the buyer has to bear all costs and risks of loss of, or damage to the goods from that point. The FOB term requires the seller to clear the goods for export. This term can be used only for sea or inland waterway transport.

FPIC (Free prior informed consent)

   A principle requiring that individuals and communities should be informed – in appropriate, accessible language – about projects that might take place on their land. It also guarantees that they are given the opportunity to give or withhold their consent to a project before it commences.

FY20XX

   Refers to the financial year ending 30 June 20XX, where XX is the two-digit number for the year.

GAAP

   Generally accepted accounting principles.

Gearing

   The ratio of net debt to net debt plus net assets.

GHG (Greenhouse gas)

   For BHP Billiton reporting purposes, these are the aggregate anthropogenic carbon dioxide equivalent emissions of carbon dioxide (CO2), methane (CH4), nitrous oxide (N2O), hydrofluorocarbons (HFCs), perfluorocarbons (PFCs) and sulphur hexafluoride (SF6).

Group

   BHP Billiton Limited, BHP Billiton Plc and their subsidiaries.

Group Function

  

Group Functions act as agents of the Group Management Committee (GMC). They operate under a defined set of mandates that relate to:

 

•   the governance of BHP Billiton;

 

•   the CEO limits established by the BHP Billiton Board;

 

•   the activities necessary to improve the effectiveness of the Group.

GLD (Group Level Document)

   The documents that give effect to the mandatory requirements arising from the BHP Billiton Operating Model as approved by the GMC. They describe the mandatory minimum performance requirements and accountabilities for definitive business obligations, processes, functions and activities across BHP Billiton.

GMC (Group Management Committee)

   The executive management group within BHP Billiton as determined by the CEO. Its role is defined by the GMC Terms of Reference.
IFRS (International Financial Reporting Standards)    Accounting standards as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board.

JSE

   Johannesburg Stock Exchange.

JV

   Joint venture.

KMP (Key Management Personnel)

   Persons having authority and responsibility for planning, directing and controlling the activities of the Group, directly or indirectly (including Executive Directors), and Non-executive Directors. For BHP Billiton it includes the GMC.

 

353


Table of Contents

Term

  

Definition

KPI (Key Performance Indicator)

   Used to measure the performance of the Group, individual businesses and executives in any one year.

LME

   London Metal Exchange.

LSE

   London Stock Exchange.

Major capital projects

   Projects where the investment commitment exceeds the Group approval threshold, or complexity or associated reputational risk or exposure necessitates review at a Group level (and within the Group investment process).

Marketing

   Refers to the BHP Billiton staff, processes and activities that provide marketing services to the whole organisation.

NYMEX (New York Mercantile Exchange)

   A New York physical futures exchange that trades energy commodities (i.e. crude oil and natural gas) and precious metals in futures and options markets.

NYSE

   New York Stock Exchange.

OEL (Occupational exposure limit)

   The concentration of a substance or agent, exposure to which, according to current knowledge, should not cause adverse health effects nor cause undue discomfort to nearly all workers.

Occupational illness

   An illness that occurs as a consequence of work-related activities or exposure. It includes acute or chronic illnesses or diseases, which may be caused by inhalation, absorption, ingestion or direct contact.

OSHA

   United States Government Occupational Safety and Health Administration.

Platts

   Platts is a global provider of energy, petrochemicals, metals and agriculture information, and a premier source of benchmark price assessments for those commodity markets.

Project investment

   Total budgeted capital expenditure on growth projects under development at year-end. Refer to section 2.4 Major projects, for a full listing of these growth projects.

Quality-of-life indicators

   Measures of people’s overall wellbeing, including material well-being (standard of living) and non-material components such as the quality of the environment, national security, personal safety, and political and economic freedoms.

Quoted

   In the context of American Depositary Shares (ADS) and listed investments, the term ‘quoted’ means ‘traded’ on the relevant exchange.

REi (Resource Endowment initiative)

   An initiative of the International Council on Mining and Metals to enhance industry’s socio-economic contribution to the countries and communities where organisations such as BHP Billiton operate, by better understanding the factors that either inhibit or promote social and economic development linked to large-scale mining projects.

ROCE (Return on capital employed)

   Calculated as earnings from operations, excluding exceptional items and net finance costs (after tax), divided by average capital

 

354


Table of Contents

Term

  

Definition

   employed. Average capital employed is calculated as net assets less net debt.
SEC (United States Securities and Exchange Commission)    United States regulatory commission that aims to protect investors, maintain fair, orderly and efficient markets and facilitate capital formation.

Senior manager

   An employee who has responsibility for planning, directing or controlling the activities of the entity or a strategically significant part of it. In the Strategic Report, senior manager includes senior leaders and any persons who are directors of any subsidiary company even if they are not senior leaders.

Shareplus

   All-employee share purchase plan.

Strate

   South Africa’s Central Securities Depositary for the electronic settlement of financial instruments.

TRIF (Total recordable injury frequency)

   The sum of (fatalities + lost-time cases + restricted work cases + medical treatment cases) x 1,000,000 ÷ actual hours worked. Stated in units of per million hours worked. BHP Billiton adopts the US Government Occupational Safety and Health Administration guidelines for the recording and reporting of occupational injury and illnesses. Excludes non-operated assets.

TSR (Total shareholder return)

   TSR measures the return delivered to shareholders over a certain period through the change in share price and any dividends paid. It is the measure used to compare BHP Billiton’s performance to that of other relevant companies under the LTIP.

UKLA (United Kingdom Listing Authority)

   Term used when the UK Financial Conduct Authority (FCA) acts as the competent authority under Part VI of the UK Financial Services and Markets Act (FSMA).

Underlying EBIT

   Calculated as earnings before net finance costs, taxation and any exceptional items.

Underlying EBIT margin

   Calculated as Underlying EBIT excluding third party EBIT, divided by revenue net of third party product revenue.

US$

   The Group’s reporting currency and the functional currency of the majority of its operations is the US dollar, as this is assessed to be the principal currency of the economic environments in which they operate.

WTI (West Texas Intermediate)

  

A mixture of hydrocarbons that exists in liquid phase in natural underground reservoirs and remains liquid at atmospheric pressure after passing through surface separating facilities. Crude oil is refined to produce a wide array of petroleum products, including heating oils; gasoline, diesel and jet fuels; lubricants; asphalt; ethane, propane, and butane; and many other products used for their energy or chemical content.

 

West Texas Intermediate refers to a crude stream produced in Texas and southern Oklahoma that serves as a reference or ‘marker’ for pricing a number of other crude streams and which is traded in the domestic spot market at Cushing, Oklahoma.

 

355


Table of Contents

8.3    Terms used in reserves and resources

 

Term

  

Definition

A.Al2O3

   available alumina

Ag

   Silver

Al2O3

   Alumina

Anth

   Anthracite

Au

   Gold

Cu

   Copper

CV

   calorific value

Fe

   Iron

Fe2O3

   iron oxide

Insol

   Insolubles

K2O

   potassium oxide

KCl

   potassium chloride

Met

   metallurgical coal

MgO

   magnesium oxide

Mn

   manganese

Mo

   molybdenum

Ni

   nickel

P

   phosphorous

Pb

   lead

Pc

   phosphorous in concentrate

R.SiO2

   reactive silica

S

   sulphur

SCu

   soluble copper

SiO2

   silica

TCu

   total copper

Th

   thermal coal

U3O8

   uranium oxide

VM

   volatile matter

Zn

   zinc

 

356


Table of Contents

8.4    Units of measure

 

Abbreviation

  

Description

%

   percentage or per cent

bbl/d

   barrels per day

boe

   barrels of oil equivalent – 6,000 scf of natural gas equals 1 boe

dmt

   dry metric tonne

dmtu

   dry metric tonne unit

g/t

   grams per tonne

ha

   hectare

kcal/kg

   kilocalories per kilogram

kg/tonne or kg/t

   kilograms per tonne

km

   kilometre

koz

   kilo-ounce

kV

   kilovolt

kt

   kilotonnes

ktpa

   kilotonnes per annum

ktpd

   kilotonnes per day

kdwt

   thousand deadweight tonnes

m

   metre

ML

   megalitre

mm

   millimetre

MMboe

   million barrels of oil equivalent

MMBtu

   million British thermal units – 1 scf of natural gas equals 1,010 Btu

MMcf/d

   million cubic feet per day

Mbbl/d

   thousand barrels per day

MMbbl/d

   million barrels per day

MMcm/d

   million cubic metres per day

Mscf

   thousand standard cubic feet

Mt

   million tonnes

Mtpa

   million tonnes per annum

MW

   megawatt

psi

   pounds per square inch

ppm

   parts per million

scf

   standard cubic feet

t

   tonne

TJ

   terajoule

TJ/d

   terajoules per day

tpa

   tonnes per annum

tpd

   tonnes per day

tph

   tonnes per hour

wmt

   wet metric tonnes

 

357


Table of Contents

9    Shareholder information

9.1    History and development

BHP Billiton Limited (formerly BHP Limited and before that The Broken Hill Proprietary Company Limited) was incorporated in 1885 and is registered in Australia with ABN 49 004 028 077. BHP Billiton Plc (formerly Billiton Plc) was incorporated in 1996 and is registered in England and Wales with registration number 3196209. Successive predecessor entities to BHP Billiton Plc have operated since 1860.

Since 29 June 2001, we have operated under a Dual Listed Company (DLC) structure. Under the DLC structure, the two parent companies, BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc operate as a single economic entity, run by a unified Board and management team. More details of the DLC structure can be found in section 9.3.2 of this Annual Report.

BHP Billiton Limited has a primary listing on the Australian Securities Exchange (ASX) in Australia. BHP Billiton Plc has a premium listing on the UK Listing Authority’s Official List and its ordinary shares are admitted to trading on the London Stock Exchange (LSE) in the United Kingdom and a secondary listing on the Johannesburg Stock Exchange (JSE) in South Africa. In addition, BHP Billiton Limited American Depositary Receipts (ADRs) and BHP Billiton Plc ADRs trade on the New York Stock Exchange (NYSE) in the United  States.

9.2    Markets

As at the date of this Annual Report, BHP Billiton Limited has a primary listing on the Australian Securities Exchange (ASX) in Australia and BHP Billiton Plc has a premium listing on the UK Listing Authority’s Official List and its ordinary shares are admitted to trading on the London Stock Exchange (LSE). BHP Billiton Plc also has a secondary listing on the Johannesburg Stock Exchange (JSE) in South Africa.

In addition, BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc are listed on the New York Stock Exchange (NYSE) in the United States. Trading on the NYSE is via American Depositary Shares (ADSs), each representing two ordinary shares evidenced by American Depositary Receipts (ADRs). Citibank N.A. (Citibank) is the Depositary for both ADR programs. BHP Billiton Limited’s ADSs have been listed for trading on the NYSE (ticker BHP) since 28 May 1987 and BHP Billiton Plc’s since 25  June 2003 (ticker BBL).

9.3    Organisational structure

9.3.1    General

The BHP Billiton Group consists of the BHP Billiton Limited Group and the BHP Billiton Plc Group as a combined enterprise, following the completion of the Dual Listed Company (DLC) merger in June 2001. Refer to note 26‘Subsidiaries’ to the Financial Statements for a list of BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc significant subsidiaries.

The BHP Billiton DLC merger was designed to place shareholders of both companies in a position where they effectively have an interest in a single group that combines the assets, and is subject to the liabilities, of both companies. BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc have each retained their separate corporate identities and maintain separate stock exchange listings, but they are operated and managed as if they are a single unified economic entity, with their Boards and senior executive management comprising the same people.

9.3.2    DLC structure

The principles of the BHP Billiton DLC are reflected in the BHP Billiton Sharing Agreement and include the following:

 

  the two companies are to operate as if they are a single unified economic entity, through Boards of Directors that comprise the same individuals and a unified senior executive management;

 

358


Table of Contents
  the Directors of both companies will, in addition to their duties to the company concerned, have regard to the interests of BHP Billiton Limited shareholders and BHP Billiton Plc shareholders as if the two companies were a single unified economic entity and, for that purpose, the Directors of each company take into account in the exercise of their powers the interests of the shareholders of the other;

 

  certain DLC equalisation principles must be observed. These are designed to ensure that for so long as the Equalisation Ratio between a BHP Billiton Limited share and a BHP Billiton Plc share is 1:1, the economic and voting interests in the combined BHP Billiton Group resulting from the holding of one BHP Billiton Limited share are equivalent to that resulting from one BHP Billiton Plc share. Further details are set out in the sub-section ‘Equalisation of economic and voting rights’ below.

Additional documents that affect the DLC include:

 

  BHP Billiton Limited Constitution

 

  BHP Billiton Plc Articles of Association

 

  BHP Billiton Special Voting Shares Deed

 

  BHP Billiton Limited Deed Poll Guarantee

 

  BHP Billiton Plc Deed Poll Guarantee.

Australian Foreign Investment Review Board (FIRB) conditions

The Treasurer of Australia approved the DLC merger subject to certain conditions, the effect of which was to require that, among other things, BHP Billiton Limited continues to:

 

  be an Australian company, which is managed from Australia;

 

  ultimately manage and control the companies conducting the business that was conducted by it at the time of the merger for as long as those businesses form part of the BHP Billiton Group.

The conditions have effect indefinitely, subject to amendment of the Australian Foreign Acquisitions and Takeovers Act 1975 or any revocation or amendment by the Treasurer of Australia. If BHP Billiton Limited no longer wishes to comply with these conditions, it must obtain the prior approval of the Treasurer. Failure to comply with the conditions attracts substantial penalties under the Foreign Acquisitions and Takeovers Act 1975.

Equalisation of economic and voting rights

BHP Billiton Limited shareholders and BHP Billiton Plc shareholders have economic and voting interests in the combined BHP Billiton Group. The economic and voting interests represented by a share in one company relative to the economic and voting interests of a share in the other company are determined by reference to a ratio known as the Equalisation Ratio. Presently, the economic and voting interests attached to each BHP Billiton Limited share and each BHP Billiton Plc share are the same, since the Equalisation Ratio is 1:1. The Equalisation Ratio would change if either BHP Billiton Limited or BHP Billiton Plc returned value to only its shareholders and no matching action was taken.

This means that the amount of any cash dividend paid by BHP Billiton Limited in respect of each BHP Billiton Limited share is normally matched by an equivalent cash dividend by BHP Billiton Plc in respect of each BHP Billiton Plc share, and vice versa. If one company has insufficient profits or is otherwise unable to pay the agreed dividend, BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc will, as far as practicable, enter into such transactions as are necessary to enable both companies to pay the agreed amount of pre-tax dividends per share.

 

359


Table of Contents

Joint Electorate Actions

Under the terms of the DLC agreements, the BHP Billiton Limited Constitution and the BHP Billiton Plc Articles of Association have implemented special voting arrangements so that the shareholders of both companies vote together as a single decision-making body on matters affecting the shareholders of each company in similar ways (such matters are referred to as Joint Electorate Actions). For so long as the Equalisation Ratio remains 1:1, each BHP Billiton Limited share will effectively have the same voting rights as each BHP Billiton Plc share on Joint Electorate Actions.

A Joint Electorate Action requires approval by ordinary resolution (or special resolution if required by statute, regulation, applicable listing rules or other applicable requirements) of BHP Billiton Limited and also of BHP Billiton Plc. Both the BHP Billiton Limited ordinary shareholders and the holder of the BHP Billiton Limited Special Voting Share vote as a single class and, in the case of BHP Billiton Plc, the BHP Billiton Plc ordinary shareholders and the holder of the BHP Billiton Plc Special Voting Share vote as a single class.

Class Rights Actions

In the case of certain actions in relation to which the two bodies of shareholders may have divergent interests (referred to as Class Rights Actions), the company wishing to carry out the Class Rights Action requires the prior approval of the shareholders in the other company voting separately and, where appropriate, the approval of its own shareholders voting separately. Depending on the type of Class Rights Action undertaken, the approval required is either an ordinary or special resolution of the relevant company.

These voting arrangements are secured through the constitutional documents of the two companies, the BHP Billiton Sharing Agreement, the BHP Billiton Special Voting Shares Deed and rights attaching to a specially created Special Voting Share issued by each company and held in each case by a Special Voting Company. The shares in the Special Voting Companies are held legally and beneficially by Law Debenture Trust Corporation Plc.

Cross guarantees

BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc have each executed a Deed Poll Guarantee, pursuant to which creditors entitled to the benefit of the BHP Billiton Limited Deed Poll Guarantee and the BHP Billiton Plc Deed Poll Guarantee will, to the extent possible, be placed in the same position as if the relevant debts were owed by both BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc on a combined basis.

Restrictions on takeovers of one company only

The BHP Billiton Limited Constitution and the BHP Billiton Plc Articles of Association have been drafted to ensure that, except with the consent of the Board, a person cannot gain control of one company without having made an equivalent offer to the shareholders of both companies on equivalent terms. Sanctions for breach of these provisions would include withholding of dividends, voting restrictions and the compulsory divestment of shares to the extent a shareholder and its associates exceed the relevant threshold.

 

360


Table of Contents

9.4    Material contracts

DLC agreements

On 29 June 2001, BHP Billiton Limited (then known as BHP Limited) and BHP Billiton Plc (then known as Billiton Plc) merged by way of a DLC structure. To effect the DLC, BHP Limited and Billiton Plc (as they were then known) entered into the following agreements designed to place the shareholders of both companies in a position where they effectively have an interest in a single group that combines the assets, and is subject to all the liabilities, of both companies:

 

  BHP Billiton Sharing Agreement

 

  BHP Billiton Special Voting Shares Deed

 

  BHP Billiton Limited Deed Poll Guarantee

 

  BHP Billiton Plc Deed Poll Guarantee.

The effect of each of these agreements and the manner in which they operate are described in section 9.3 of this Annual Report.

9.5    Constitution

The following text summarises the Constitution of BHP Billiton Limited and the Articles of Association of BHP Billiton Plc. The effect of the Constitution of BHP Billiton Limited and the Articles of Association of BHP Billiton Plc is, so far as possible, identical. Where the term ‘BHP Billiton’ is used in this description of the Constitution and Articles of Association, it can be read to mean either BHP Billiton Limited or BHP Billiton Plc.

Certain provisions of the Constitution of BHP Billiton Limited and the Articles of Association of BHP Billiton Plc can only be amended where such amendment is approved by special resolution either:

 

  by approval as a Class Rights Action, where the amendment results in a change to an ‘Entrenched Provision’; or

 

  otherwise, as a Joint Electorate Action.

A description of Joint Electorate Actions and Class Rights Actions is contained under the heading ‘Equalisation of economic and voting rights’ in section 9.3.2 of this Annual Report.

9.5.1    Directors

The management and control of the business and affairs of BHP Billiton are vested in the Board of Directors, which may exercise all powers of BHP Billiton, other than those which are required to be exercised or done by BHP Billiton in a general meeting.

9.5.2    Power to issue securities

BHP Billiton may, pursuant to the Constitution and Articles of Association, issue any shares or other securities (including redeemable shares) with preferred, deferred or other special rights, obligations or restrictions as and when the Directors may determine and on any other terms the Directors consider appropriate, provided that:

 

  any such issue does not affect any special rights conferred on the holders of any shares;

 

  any such issue is subject to the provisions regarding shareholder approval in the Constitution and Articles of Association;

 

  the rights attaching to a class other than ordinary shares are expressed at the date of issue.

 

361


Table of Contents

9.5.3     Restrictions on voting by Directors

A Director may not vote in respect of any contract or arrangement or any other proposal in which he or she has a material personal interest. A Director shall not be counted in the quorum at a meeting in relation to any resolution on which he or she is not entitled to vote.

In addition, under the UK Companies Act 2006, a Director has a duty to avoid a situation in which he or she has (or can have) a direct or indirect interest that conflicts (or may conflict) with the interests of the company. The duty is not infringed, if among other things, the situation is authorised by non-interested Directors. The Articles of Association of BHP Billiton Plc enable the Board to authorise a matter that might otherwise involve a Director breaching his or her duty to avoid conflicts of interest. An interested Director may not vote or be counted towards a quorum for a resolution authorising such a situation. Where the Board gives such authorisation, the Board may prohibit, or may establish regulations which prohibit, the relevant Director from voting on any matter relating to the conflict. The Board has adopted procedures to manage these voting restrictions.

Subject to applicable laws, a Director is entitled to vote, and be counted in the quorum, in respect of any resolution concerning any of the following matters, namely where the material personal interest:

 

  arises because the Director is a shareholder of BHP Billiton and is held in common with the other shareholders of BHP Billiton;

 

  arises in relation to the Director’s remuneration as a Director of BHP Billiton;

 

  relates to a contract BHP Billiton is proposing to enter into that is subject to approval by the shareholders and will not impose any obligation on BHP Billiton if it is not approved by the shareholders;

 

  arises merely because the Director is a guarantor or has given an indemnity or security for all or part of a loan, or proposed loan, to BHP Billiton;

 

  arises merely because the Director has a right of subrogation in relation to a guarantee or indemnity referred to above;

 

  relates to a contract that insures, or would insure, the Director against liabilities the Director incurs as an officer of BHP Billiton, but only if the contract does not make BHP Billiton or a related body corporate the insurer;

 

  relates to any payment by BHP Billiton or a related body corporate in respect of an indemnity permitted by law, or any contract relating to such an indemnity; or

 

  is in a contract, or proposed contract with, or for the benefit of, or on behalf of, a related body corporate and arises merely because the Director is a director of a related body corporate.

9.5.4    Loans by Directors

Any Director may lend money to BHP Billiton at interest with or without security or may, for a commission or profit, guarantee the repayment of any money borrowed by BHP Billiton and underwrite or guarantee the subscription of shares or securities of BHP Billiton or of any corporation in which BHP Billiton may be interested without being disqualified as a Director and without being liable to account to BHP Billiton for any commission or profit.

9.5.5    Retirement of Directors

In 2011, the Board adopted a policy consistent with the UK Corporate Governance Code, under which all Directors must, if they wish to remain on the Board, seek re-election by shareholders annually. This policy took effect at the 2011 Annual General Meetings (AGMs), and replaced the previous system, as set out in the Constitution and Articles of Association, under which Directors were required to submit themselves to shareholders for re-election at least every three years.

 

362


Table of Contents

9.5.6    Rights attaching to shares

Dividend rights

Under English law, dividends on shares may only be paid out of profits available for distribution. Under Australian law, dividends on shares may only be paid out of net assets, provided that the payment is fair and reasonable to the company’s shareholders as a whole and the payment of the dividend does not materially prejudice the company’s ability to pay its creditors. The Constitution and Articles of Association provide that payment of any dividend may be made in any manner, by any means and in any currency determined by the Board.

All unclaimed dividends may be invested or otherwise used by the Board for the benefit of whichever of BHP Billiton Limited or BHP Billiton Plc declared that dividend, until claimed or, in the case of BHP Billiton Limited, otherwise disposed of according to law. In the case of BHP Billiton Plc, any dividend unclaimed after a period of 12 years from the date on which such dividend was declared or became due for payment shall be forfeited and shall revert to BHP Billiton Plc.

Voting rights

Voting at any general meeting of BHP Billiton Limited shareholders can, in the first instance, be conducted by a show of hands unless a poll is demanded by any of the following (except in relation to the election of a chairman of a meeting or, unless the Chairman otherwise determines, the adjournment of a meeting), or is otherwise required (as outlined below):

 

  the Chairman;

 

  any shareholder under the law; or

 

  the holder of the BHP Billiton Limited Special Voting Share.

Voting at any general meeting of BHP Billiton Plc can, in the first instance, be conducted by a show of hands unless a poll is demanded by any of the following (except in relation to the election of a chairman of a meeting or, unless the Chairman otherwise determines, the adjournment of a meeting) or is otherwise required (as outlined below):

 

  the Chairman;

 

  not less than five members present in person or by proxy and entitled to vote;

 

  a member or members present in person or by proxy and representing not less than five per cent of the total voting rights of all the members having the right to vote at the meeting; or

 

  the holder of the BHP Billiton Plc Special Voting Share.

As described under the heading ‘Equalisation of economic and voting rights’ in section 9.3.2 of this Annual Report, certain matters may be decided as Joint Electorate Actions or Class Rights Actions. Any matter considered by shareholders at an AGM of BHP Billiton Limited or BHP Billiton Plc constitutes a Joint Electorate Action and shall therefore be decided on a poll. Therefore, in practice, generally all items of business at AGMs are decided by way of a poll.

In addition, at any general meeting a resolution, other than a procedural resolution, put to the vote of the meeting on which the holder of the relevant BHP Billiton Special Voting Share is entitled to vote shall be decided on a poll.

For the purposes of determining which shareholders are entitled to attend or vote at a meeting of BHP Billiton Plc or BHP Billiton Limited, and how many votes such shareholder may cast, the relevant company will specify

 

363


Table of Contents

in any notice of meeting a time, not more than 48 hours before the time fixed for the meeting, by which a shareholder must be entered on the Register of Shareholders in order to have the right to attend or vote at the relevant meeting.

Shareholders who wish to appoint a proxy to attend, vote or speak at a meeting of BHP Billiton Plc or BHP Billiton Limited (as appropriate) on their behalf, must deposit the relevant form appointing a proxy in accordance with the instructions contained in any notice of meeting, so as to be received in the specified manner not less than 48 hours before the time appointed for holding the meeting to which the appointment of a proxy relates.

Rights to share in BHP Billiton Limited’s profits

The rights attached to the shares of BHP Billiton Limited, as regards the participation in the profits available for distribution, are as follows:

 

  The holders of any preference shares shall be entitled, in priority to any payment of dividend to the holders of any other class of shares, to a preferred right to participate as regards dividends up to but not beyond a specified amount in distribution.

 

  Subject to the special rights attaching to any preference shares, but in priority to any payment of dividends on all other classes of shares, the holder of the Equalisation Share (if any) shall be entitled to be paid such dividends as are declared or paid thereon.

 

  Any surplus remaining after payment of the distributions above shall be payable to the holders of BHP Billiton Limited ordinary shares and the BHP Billiton Limited Special Voting Share in equal amounts per share.

Rights to share in BHP Billiton Plc’s profits

The rights attached to the shares of BHP Billiton Plc, in relation to the participation in the profits available for distribution, are as follows:

 

  The holders of the cumulative preference shares shall be entitled, in priority to any payment of dividend to the holders of any other class of shares, to be paid a fixed cumulative preferential dividend (Preferential Dividend) at a rate of 5.5 per cent per annum, to be paid annually in arrears on 31 July in each year or, if any such date shall be a Saturday, Sunday or public holiday in England, on the first business day following such date in each year. Payments of Preferential Dividends shall be made to holders on the register at any date selected by the Directors up to 42 days prior to the relevant fixed dividend date.

 

  Subject to the rights attaching to the cumulative preference shares, but in priority to any payment of dividends on all other classes of shares, the holder of the BHP Billiton Plc Special Voting Share shall be entitled to be paid a fixed dividend of US$0.01 per annum, payable annually in arrears on 31 July.

 

  Subject to the rights attaching to the cumulative preference shares and the BHP Billiton Plc Special Voting Share, but in priority to any payment of dividends on all other classes of shares, the holder of the Equalisation Share shall be entitled to be paid such dividends as the Board may decide to pay thereon.

 

  Any surplus remaining after payment of the distributions above shall be payable to the holders of the BHP Billiton Plc ordinary shares in equal amounts per BHP Billiton Plc ordinary share.

9.5.7    Right on a return of assets on liquidation

On a return of assets on liquidation of BHP Billiton Limited, the assets of BHP Billiton Limited remaining available for distribution among shareholders, after giving effect to the payment of all prior ranking amounts owed to all creditors and holders of preference shares, and to all prior ranking statutory entitlements, shall be applied in paying to the holders of the BHP Billiton Limited Special Voting Share and the Equalisation Share

 

364


Table of Contents

(if any) an amount of up to A$2.00 on each such share, on an equal priority with any amount paid to the holders of BHP Billiton Limited ordinary shares, and any surplus remaining shall be applied in making payments solely to the holders of BHP Billiton Limited ordinary shares in accordance with their entitlements.

On a return of assets on liquidation of BHP Billiton Plc, subject to the payment of all prior ranking amounts owed to the creditors of BHP Billiton Plc and to all prior ranking statutory entitlements, the assets of BHP Billiton Plc to be distributed on a winding-up shall be distributed to the holders of shares in the following order of priority:

 

  To the holders of the cumulative preference shares, the repayment of a sum equal to the nominal capital paid up or credited as paid up on the cumulative preference shares held by them and accrual, if any, of the Preferential Dividend, whether such dividend has been earned or declared or not, calculated up to the date of commencement of the winding-up.

 

  To the holders of the BHP Billiton Plc ordinary shares and to the holders of the BHP Billiton Plc Special Voting Share and the Equalisation Share, the payment out of surplus, if any, remaining after the distribution above of an equal amount for each BHP Billiton Plc ordinary share, the BHP Billiton Plc Special Voting Share and the Equalisation Share, if issued, subject to a maximum in the case of the BHP Billiton Plc Special Voting Share and the Equalisation Share of the nominal capital paid up on such shares.

9.5.8    Redemption of preference shares

If BHP Billiton Limited at any time proposes to create and issue any preference shares, the preference shares may be issued on the terms that they are to be redeemed or, at the option of either or both BHP Billiton Limited and the holder, are liable to be redeemed, whether out of share capital, profits or otherwise.

The preference shares confer on the holders the right to convert the preference shares into ordinary shares if, and on the basis, the Board determines at the time of issue of the preference shares.

The preference shares are to confer on the holders:

 

  the right (on redemption and on a winding-up) to payment in cash in priority to any other class of shares of (i) the amount paid or agreed to be considered as paid on each of the preference shares; (ii) the amount, if any, equal to the aggregate of any dividends accrued but unpaid and of any arrears of dividends; and

 

  the right, in priority to any payment of dividend on any other class of shares, to the preferential dividend.

There is no equivalent provision in the Articles of Association of BHP Billiton Plc although as noted in section 9.5.2, above, BHP Billiton can issue preference shares which are subject to a right of redemption on terms the Board considers appropriate.

9.5.9    Capital calls

Subject to the terms on which any shares may have been issued, the Board may make calls on the shareholders in respect of all monies unpaid on their shares. BHP Billiton has a lien on every partly paid share for all amounts payable in respect of that share. Each shareholder is liable to pay the amount of each call in the manner, at the time and at the place specified by the Board (subject to receiving at least 14 days’ notice specifying the time and place for payment). A call is considered to have been made at the time when the resolution of the Board authorising the call was passed.

9.5.10    Borrowing powers

Subject to relevant law, the Directors may exercise all powers of BHP Billiton to borrow money, and to mortgage or charge its undertaking, property, assets (both present and future) and all uncalled capital or any part or parts

 

365


Table of Contents

thereof and to issue debentures and other securities, whether outright or as collateral security for any debt, liability or obligation of BHP Billiton or of any third party.

9.5.11    Changes to rights of shareholders

Rights attached to any class of shares issued by either BHP Billiton Limited or BHP Billiton Plc can only be varied (whether as a Joint Electorate Action or a Class Rights Action) where such variation is approved both:

 

  by the Company that issued the relevant shares, as a special resolution; and

 

  by the holders of the issued shares of the affected class, either by a special resolution passed at a separate meeting of the holders of the issued shares of the class affected, or with the written consent of members with at least 75 per cent of the votes of that class.

9.5.12    Conditions governing general meetings

All provisions relating to general meetings apply with any necessary modifications to any special meeting of any class of shareholders that may be held. Therefore, the following information relates equally to general meetings and any special meeting of any class of shareholders.

The Board may and shall on requisition in accordance with applicable laws call a general meeting of the shareholders at the time and place or places and in the manner determined by the Board. No shareholder may convene a general meeting of BHP Billiton except where entitled under law to do so. Any Director may convene a general meeting whenever the Director thinks fit. General meetings can also be cancelled, postponed or adjourned, where permitted by law or the Constitution or Articles of Association. Notice of a general meeting must be given to each shareholder entitled to vote at the meeting and such notice of meeting must be given in the form and manner in which the Board thinks fit. Five shareholders of the relevant company present in person or by proxy constitute a quorum for a meeting. A shareholder who is entitled to attend and cast a vote at a general meeting of BHP Billiton may appoint a person as a proxy to attend and vote for the shareholder in accordance with the law.

9.5.13    Limitations on rights to own securities

Neither the Constitution of BHP Billiton Limited nor the Articles of Association of BHP Billiton Plc impose any limitations on the rights to own securities other than restrictions that reflect the takeovers codes under relevant Australian and UK law. In addition, the Australian Foreign Acquisitions and Takeovers Act 1975 imposes a number of conditions that restrict foreign ownership of Australian-based companies.

Share control limits imposed by the Constitution and the Articles of Association, as well as relevant laws, are described in sections 9.11.2 and 9.3.2 of this Annual Report.

9.5.14    Documents on display

You can consult reports and other information about BHP Billiton Limited that it has filed pursuant to the rules of the Australian Securities Exchange (ASX) at www.asx.com.au. You can consult reports and other information filed for publication by BHP Billiton Plc pursuant to the rules of the UK Listing Authority at the Authority’s document viewing facility (the National Storage Mechanism) at www.morningstar.co.uk/uk/NSM. Information filed on the ASX, or pursuant to the rules of the UK Listing Authority is not incorporated by reference into this Annual Report. The documents referred to in this Annual Report as being available on our website, www.bhpbilliton.com, are not incorporated by reference and do not form part of this Annual Report.

BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc both file annual and special reports and other information with the US Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC). These filings are available on the SEC website at www.sec.gov.

 

366


Table of Contents

You may also read and copy any document that either BHP Billiton Limited or BHP Billiton Plc files at the SEC’s public reference room located at 100 F Street, NE, Washington, DC 20549. Please call the SEC at 1-800-SEC-0330 or access the SEC website at www.sec.gov for further information on the public reference room.

9.6    Share ownership

Share capital

The details of the share capital for both BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc are presented in Note 19 ‘Share capital’ in the Financial Statements and remain current as at 22 August 2014.

Major shareholders

The tables in section 4.4.27 and the information set out in sections 5.17 and 5.18 of this Annual Report present information pertaining to the shares in BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc held by Directors and members of the Group Management Committee (GMC).

Neither BHP Billiton Limited nor BHP Billiton Plc is directly or indirectly controlled by another corporation or by any government. Other than as described in section 9.3.2, no major shareholder possesses voting rights that differ from those attaching to all of BHP Billiton Limited’s voting securities.

Substantial shareholders in BHP Billiton Limited

As at 22 August 2014, there are no substantial shareholders in BHP Billiton Limited. A substantial shareholder is a person who (together with associates) has a relevant interest in five per cent or more of voting rights conferred by ordinary shares in BHP Billiton Limited. Notifications to BHP Billiton Limited under section 671B of the Corporations Act 2001 indicate that no person (together with their associates) beneficially owned more than five per cent of BHP Billiton Limited’s voting securities.

Substantial Shareholders in BHP Billiton Plc

The following table shows holdings of three per cent or more of voting rights conferred by BHP Billiton Plc’s ordinary shares as notified to BHP Billiton Plc under the UK Disclosure and Transparency Rule 5. (1)

 

Title of class

 

Identity of person
or group

  Date of last notice   Number owned      Percentage of
total voting rights (2)
 
    Date
received
  Date of
change
     2014     2013     2012  

Ordinary shares

  Aberdeen Asset Managers Limited   30 June
2014
  31 March
2014
    133,883,328         6.34              

Ordinary shares

  BlackRock, Inc.   3 December
2009
  1 December
2009
    213,014,043         10.08     10.08     10.08

 

(1)  There has been no change in the holdings of three per cent or more of the voting rights in BHP Billiton Plc’s shares notified to BHP Billiton Plc as at the date of this Annual Report.

 

(2) The percentages quoted are based on the total voting rights conferred by ordinary shares in BHP Billiton Plc as at the date of the Annual Report each year of 2,112,071,796 (2014) and 2,112,071,796 (2012 and 2013).

 

367


Table of Contents

The following table shows holdings of Directors and members of the GMC of BHP Billiton Plc who were in office as at 30 June 2014, as a group, of BHP Billiton Plc’s voting securities as at that date. (1)

 

Title of class

  

Identity of person or group

   Number owned     

Percentage of
total voting rights
at 30 June 2014 (2)

 

Ordinary shares

   Directors and Executives as a group      723,451         0.03

 

(1) As at the date of this Annual Report, the Directors and members of the GMC who were in office at 30 June 2014 held 0.04 per cent of the total ordinary share voting rights of BHP Billiton Plc (Number owned: 850,843).

 

(2) The percentages quoted are based on the total voting rights of ordinary shares in BHP Billiton Plc of 2,112,071,796.

Twenty largest shareholders as at 22 August 2014 (as named on the Register of Shareholders) (1)

 

BHP Billiton Limited   Number of fully
paid shares
    % of issued
capital
 
1.   HSBC Australia Nominees Pty Limited     580,069,546        18.06   
2.   JP Morgan Nominees Australia Limited     493,708,553        15.38   
3.   National Nominees Ltd     279,035,779        8.69   
4.   Citicorp Nominees Pty Limited <BHP Billiton ADR Holders A/C>     200,154,676        6.23   
5.   Citicorp Nominees Pty Ltd     144,522,993        4.50   
6.   BNP Paribas Noms Pty Ltd     66,415,472        2.07   
7.   Citicorp Nominees Pty Limited <Colonial First State Inv A/C>     36,766,575        1.14   
8.   Aust Mutual Prov Society     24,144,150        0.75   
9.   Australian Foundation Investment Company Limited     13,990,941        0.44   
10.   HSBC Custody Nominees (Australia) Limited <NT-Comnwlth Super Corp A/C>     13,984,916        0.44   
11.   UBS Wealth Management     13,138,628        0.41   
12.   BNP Paribas Nominees Pty Ltd <Agency Lending DRP A/C>     9,275,120        0.29   
13.   Computershare Nominees CI Ltd <ASX Shareplus Control A/C>     8,586,884        0.27   
14.   Argo Investments Limited     8,065,004        0.25   
15.   RBC Investor Services Australia Nominees Pty Limited <PI Pooled A/C>     7,073,914        0.22   
16.   National Nominees Limited <DB A/C>     6,926,358        0.22   
17.   Computershare Trustees Jey Ltd < RE 3000101 A/C>     6,843,005        0.21   
18.   RBC Investor Services Australia Nominees Pty Limited <BK Cust A/C>     6,550,059        0.20   
19.   Bond Street Custodians Limited     5,884,026        0.18   
20.   Navigator Australia Ltd <MLC Investment Settlement A/C>     5,776,473        0.18   
   

 

 

   

 

 

 
      1,930,913,072        60.14   
   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

368


Table of Contents
BHP Billiton Plc   Number of fully
paid shares
    % of issued
capital
 
1.   PLC Nominees (Proprietary) Limited (2)     363,932,699        17.04   
2.   State Street Nominees Limited <OM02>     96,811,610        4.53   
3.   Chase Nominees Limited     90,836,599        4.25   
4.   The Bank of New York (Nominees) Limited     82,462,791        3.86   
5.   Chase Nominees Limited <LEND>     73,705,274        3.45   
6.   State Street Nominees Limited <OM04>     70,118,416        3.28   
7.   GEPF Equity     67,947,072        3.18   
8.   Nortrust Nominees Limited     58,025,085        2.72   
9.   Vidacos Nominees Limited <CLRLUX2>     49,220,595        2.30   
10.   National City Nominees Limited     45,555,961        2.13   
11.   State Street Nominees Limited <OD64>     38,827,954        1.82   
12.   Lynchwood Nominees Limited <2006420>     38,310,348        1.79   
13.   HSBC Global Custody Nominee (UK) Limited <357206>     36,209,783        1.70   
14.   Industrial Development Corporation of South Africa     33,804,582        1.58   
15.   BNY Mellon Nominees Limited <BSDTGUSD>     30,735,445        1.44   
16.   Nutraco Nominees Limited <492762>     23,979,189        1.12   
17.   Nutraco Nominees Limited <781221>     22,930,000        1.07   
18.   Nortrust Nominees Limited <SLEND>     22,760,910        1.07   
19.   Roy Nominees Limited <999999>     21,097,861        0.99   
20.   Computershare Nominees Pty Ltd     16,865,810        0.79   
   

 

 

   

 

 

 
      1,284,137,984        60.11   
   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) The largest holder on the South African register of BHP Billiton Plc, is the Strate nominee in which the majority of shares in South Africa (including some of the shareholders included in this list) are held in dematerialised form.

 

(2) Many of the twenty largest shareholders shown for BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc hold shares as a nominee or custodian. In accordance with the reporting requirements, the tables reflect the legal ownership of shares and not the details of the underlying beneficial holders.

United States share ownership as at 30 June 2014

 

    BHP Billiton Limited     BHP Billiton Plc  
    Number of
Shareholders
    %     Number of
shares
    %     Number of
Shareholders
    %     Number of
shares
    %  

Classification of holder

               

Registered holders of voting securities

    1,728        0.30        4,752,247        0.14        66        0.30        103,209        0.01   

ADR holders

    1,202        0.23        195,937,364  (1)      6.1        184        0.93        47,399,620  (2)      2.24   

 

(1) These shares translate to 97,968,682 ADRs.

 

(2) These shares translate to 23,699,810 ADRs.

 

369


Table of Contents

Geographical distribution of shareholders and shareholdings as at 22 August 2014

 

    BHP Billiton Limited     BHP Billiton Plc  
    Number of
Shareholders
    %     Number of
shares
    %     Number of
Shareholders
    %     Number of
shares
    %  

Registered address

               

Australia

    554,637        96.25        3,138,694,670        97.73        481        2.04        1,244,093        0.06   

New Zealand

    13,079        2.27        34,571,262        1.08        40        0.17        112,343        0.01   

United Kingdom

    2,994        0.52        8,485,842        0.26        20,098        85.44        1,749,491,835        81.89   

United States

    1,737        0.30        4,748,562        0.15        69        0.29        97,393        0.01   

South Africa

    131        0.02        234,160        0.01        1,502        6.39        382,755,922        17.92   

Other

    3,642        0.63        24,956,609        0.78        1,333        5.67        2,483,868        0.11   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

    576,220        100.00        3,211,691,105        100.00        23,523        100.00        2,136,185,454        100.00   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Distribution of shareholdings by size as at 22 August 2014

 

    BHP Billiton Limited     BHP Billiton Plc  
    Number of
Shareholders
    %     Number of
shares (1)
    %     Number of
Shareholders
    %     Number of
shares (1)
    %  

Size of holding

               

1 – 500 (2)

    257,655        44.71        58,549,553        1.82        12,883        54.77        3,203,269        0.15   

501 – 1,000

    111,769        19.40        85,968,746        2.68        4,794        20.38        3,520,204        0.16   

1,001 – 5,000

    160,931        27.93        360,013,381        11.21        3,858        16.40        7,751,488        0.36   

5,001 – 10,000

    26,521        4.60        187,271,116        5.83        437        1.86        3,083,295        0.14   

10,001 – 25,000

    14,375        2.49        216,472,195        6.74        349        1.48        5,586,860        0.26   

25,001 – 50,000

    3,209        0.56        110,083,509        3.43        193        0.82        7,031,471        0.33   

50,001 – 100,000

    1,137        0.20        77,910,360        2.43        234        0.99        16,747,258        0.78   

100,001 – 250,000

    453        0.08        65,223,012        2.03        284        1.21        44,975,481        2.11   

250,001 – 500,000

    82        0.01        27,095,771        0.84        145        0.62        52,250,236        2.45   

500,001 – 1,000,000

    35        0.01        24,713,833        0.77        117        0.50        80,650,327        3.78   

1,000,001 and over

    53        0.01        1,998,389,629        62.22        229        0.97        1,911,385,565        89.48   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

    576,220        100.00        3,211,691,105        100.00        23,523        100.00        2,136,185,454        100.00   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) One ordinary share entitles the holder to one vote.

 

(2) Number of BHP Billiton Limited shareholders holding less than a marketable parcel (A$500) based on the market price of A$37.80 as at 22 August 2014 was 4,870.

 

    BHP Billiton Limited     BHP Billiton Plc  
    Number of
Shareholders
    %     Number of
shares
    %     Number of
Shareholders
    %     Number of
shares
    %  

Classification of holder

               

Corporate

    156,647        27.19        2,252,285,413        70.13        13,816        58.73        2,122,547,470        99.36   

Private

    419,573        72.81        959,405,692        29.87        9,707        41.27        13,637,984        0.64   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

    576,220        100.00        3,211,691,105        100.00        23,523        100.00        2,136,185,454        100.00   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

370


Table of Contents

9.7    Dividends

Policy

We have a progressive dividend policy that seeks to steadily increase or at least to maintain the dividend in US dollars at each half-yearly payment.

We declare our dividends and other distributions in US dollars as it is our main functional currency. BHP Billiton Limited pays its dividends in Australian dollars, UK pounds sterling, New Zealand dollars or US dollars, depending on the country of residence of the shareholder. BHP Billiton Plc pays its dividends in UK pounds sterling to shareholders registered on its principal register in the United Kingdom and in South African rand to shareholders registered on its branch register in South Africa. If shareholders on the United Kingdom register wish to receive dividends in US dollars, they must complete the appropriate election form and return it to the BHP Billiton Share Registrar in the United Kingdom no later than close of business on the Dividend Record Date.

Currency conversions will be based on the foreign currency exchange rates on the Record Date, except for the conversion into South African rand, which will take place on the last day to trade (cum dividend) on the JSE.

Aligning the currency conversion date with the Record Date (for all currencies except the conversion into South African rand, which takes place on and is aligned to the last day to trade on the JSE as explained above) enables a high level of certainty around the currency required to pay the dividend and helps to eliminate the Group’s exposure to movements in exchange rates since the number of shares on which dividends are payable (and the elected currency) is final at close of business on the Record Date.

Aligning the final date to receive currency elections (currency election date) with the Record Date further simplifies the process.

Payments

BHP Billiton Limited shareholders may have their cash dividends paid directly into a nominated bank, building society or credit union, depending on the shareholder’s country of residence as shown below.

 

Country where shareholder is resident

  

Financial institution

Australia

   Bank, building society, credit union

United Kingdom

   Bank, building society

New Zealand

   Bank

United States

   Bank

Shareholders from the abovementioned locations who do not provide their direct credit details and shareholders with registered addresses outside Australia, the United Kingdom, New Zealand and the United States will receive dividend payments by way of a cheque in Australian dollars.

BHP Billiton Plc shareholders may have their cash dividends paid directly into a bank or building society by completing a dividend mandate form, which is available from the BHP Billiton Share Registrar in the United Kingdom or South Africa.

 

371


Table of Contents

9.8    Share price information

The following tables show the share prices for the period indicated for ordinary shares and ADSs for each of BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc. The share prices are the highest and lowest closing market quotations for ordinary shares reported on the Daily Official List of the ASX and LSE respectively, and the highest and lowest closing prices for ADSs quoted on the NYSE, adjusted to reflect stock dividends.

BHP Billiton Limited

 

         Ordinary shares      American Depositary Shares (1)  

BHP Billiton Limited

   High A$      Low A$      High US$      Low US$  

FY2009

     44.40         21.10         82.86         24.62   

FY2010

     44.63         32.14         82.86         49.54   

FY2011

     49.55         36.98         102.68         62.42   

FY2012

     44.95         30.60         96.80         60.87   

FY2013

  First quarter      34.22         30.18         72.28         61.84   
  Second quarter      37.40         32.93         78.44         67.78   
  Third quarter      39.00         32.76         80.46         68.43   
  Fourth quarter      35.27         30.65         71.09         57.38   

FY2014

  First quarter      37.33         30.94         70.02         56.32   
  Second quarter      38.24         34.62         72.81         63.73   
  Third quarter      39.38         35.20         70.82         62.76   
  Fourth quarter      38.40         35.28         72.40         66.38   
         Ordinary shares      American Depositary Shares (1)  

BHP Billiton Limited

   High A$      Low A$      High US$      Low US$  

Month of January 2014

     38.20         35.93         68.20         62.99   

Month of February 2014

     39.38         35.28         70.82         62.76   

Month of March 2014

     37.80         35.20         68.58         63.86   

Month of April 2014

     38.40         37.05         72.40         69.16   

Month of May 2014

     38.30         37.01         71.97         67.88   

Month of June 2014

     36.59         35.28         69.26         66.38   

Month of July 2014

     39.10         36.00         73.50         69.20   

Month of August 2014

     39.68         36.67         72.76         68.23   

 

(1)  Each ADS represents the right to receive two BHP Billiton Limited ordinary shares.

The total market capitalisation of BHP Billiton Limited at 30 June 2014 was A$115.3 billion (US$108.3 billion equivalent), which represented approximately 7.53 per cent of the total market capitalisation of the ASX All Ordinaries Index. The closing price for BHP Billiton Limited ordinary shares on the ASX on that date was A$35.90.

 

372


Table of Contents

BHP Billiton Plc

 

         Ordinary shares     American Depositary Shares (1)  

BHP Billiton Plc

  High UK pence     Low UK pence     High US$     Low US$  

FY2009

    1,841.00        752.50        74.18        21.16   

FY2010

    2,334.50        1,287.50        70.95        41.88   

FY2011

    2,631.50        1,684.50        85.47        51.61   

FY2012

    2,521.50        1,667.00        80.69        51.30   

FY2013

   First quarter     2,049.00        1,751.00        66.19        54.76   
  

Second quarter

    2,156.50        1,873.00        70.37        60.10   
  

Third quarter

    2,236.00        1,915.00        72.07        58.06   
  

Fourth quarter

    2,001.00        1,673.00        60.15        51.27   

FY2014

   First quarter     1,994.50        1,666.50        62.80        50.29   
  

Second quarter

    1,983.00        1,754.50        63.79        56.84   
  

Third quarter

    1,979.00        1,759.00        65.78        57.24   
  

Fourth quarter

    1,995.00        1,850.00        66.73        62.35   
         Ordinary shares     American Depositary Shares (1)  

BHP Billiton Plc

  High UK pence     Low UK pence     High US$     Low US$  

Month of January 2014

    1,890.00        1,772.00        62.12        58.36   

Month of February 2014

    1,979.00        1,759.00        65.78        57.24   

Month of March 2014

    1,927.00        1,778.50        64.18        58.61   

Month of April 2014

    1,961.00        1,882.00        65.60        62.90   

Month of May 2014

    1,995.00        1,868.00        66.73        62.65   

Month of June 2014

    1,938.00        1,850.00        66.06        62.35   

Month of July 2014

    2,096.00        1,944.50        71.02        66.39   

Month of August 2014

    2,067.00        1,891.00        69.52        63.04   

 

(1)  Each ADS represents the right to receive two BHP Billiton Plc ordinary shares.

The total market capitalisation of BHP Billiton Plc at 30 June 2014 was £41.4 billion (US$70.5 billion equivalent), which represented approximately 1.80 per cent of the total market capitalisation of the FTSE All-Share Index. The closing price for BHP Billiton Plc ordinary shares on the LSE on that date was £18.90.

 

373


Table of Contents

9.9    American Depositary Receipts fees and charges

We have American Depositary Receipts (ADR) programs for BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc.

Depositary fees

Citibank serves as the depositary bank for both of our ADR programs. ADR holders agree to the terms in the deposit agreement filed with the SEC for depositing ADSs or surrendering the ADSs for cancellation and for certain services as provided by Citibank. Holders are required to pay all fees for general depositary services provided by Citibank in each of our ADR programs, as set forth in the tables below.

Standard depositary fees:

 

Depositary service

  

Fee payable by the ADR holders

Issuance of ADSs upon deposit of shares

   Up to US$5.00 per 100 ADSs (or fraction thereof) issued

Delivery of Deposited Securities against surrender of ADSs

   Up to US$5.00 per 100 ADSs (or fraction thereof) surrendered

Distribution of Cash Distributions

   No fee

Corporate actions depositary fees:

 

Depositary service

  

Fee payable by the ADR holders

Cash Distributions (i.e. sale of rights, other entitlements, return of capital)

   Up to US$2.00 per 100 ADSs (or fraction thereof) held

Distribution of ADSs pursuant to exercise of rights to purchase additional ADSs. Excludes stock dividends and stock splits

   Up to US$5.00 per 100 ADSs (or fraction thereof) held

Distribution of securities other than ADSs or rights to purchase additional ADSs (i.e. spin-off shares)

   Up to US$5.00 per 100 ADSs (or fraction thereof) held

Distribution of ADSs pursuant to an ADR ratio change in which shares are not distributed

   No fee

Fees payable by the Depositary to the Issuer

Citibank has provided BHP Billiton net reimbursement of US$1.4 million in FY2014 for ADR program-related expenses for both of BHP Billiton’s ADR programs (FY2013 US$1.6 million). ADR program-related expenses include legal and accounting fees, listing fees, expenses related to investor relations in the United States, fees payable to service providers for the distribution of material to ADR holders, expenses of Citibank as administrator of the ADS Direct Plan and expenses to remain in compliance with applicable laws.

Citibank has further agreed to waive other ADR program-related expenses for FY2014, amounting to less than US$0.03 million, which are associated with the administration of the ADR programs (FY2013 less than US$0.03 million).

Our ADR programs trade on the NYSE under the stock tickers BHP and BBL for the BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc programs, respectively. As of 30 June 2014, there were 97,994,434 ADRs on issue and outstanding in the BHP Billiton Limited ADR program and 23,715,933 ADRs on issue and outstanding in the BHP Billiton Plc ADR program. Both of the ADR programs have a 2:1 ordinary shares to ADR ratio.

 

374


Table of Contents

9.10    Taxation

The taxation discussion below describes the material Australian, UK and US federal income tax consequences to a US holder of owning BHP Billiton Limited ordinary shares or ADSs or BHP Billiton Plc ordinary shares or ADSs. The discussion below also outlines the potential South African tax issues for US holders of BHP Billiton Plc shares that are listed on the JSE.

The following discussion is not relevant to non-US holders of BHP Billiton Limited ordinary shares or ADSs or BHP Billiton Plc ordinary shares or ADSs. By its nature, the commentary below is of a general nature and we recommend that holders of ordinary shares or ADSs consult their own tax advisers regarding the Australian, UK, South African and US federal, state and local tax and other tax consequences of owning and disposing of ordinary shares and ADSs in their particular circumstances.

For purposes of this commentary, a US holder is a beneficial owner of ordinary shares or ADSs who is, for US federal income tax purposes:

 

  a citizen or resident alien of the US;

 

  a corporation (or other entity treated as a corporation for US federal income tax purposes) that is created or organised under the laws of the US or any political subdivision thereof;

 

  an estate, the income of which is subject to US federal income taxation regardless of its source; or

 

  a trust:

 

  (a) if a court within the US is able to exercise primary supervision over its administration and one or more US persons have the authority to control all of its substantial decisions; or

 

  (b) that has made a valid election to be treated as a US person for tax purposes.

This discussion of material tax consequences for US holders is based on the Australian, UK, US and South African laws currently in effect, the published practice of tax authorities in those jurisdictions and the double taxation treaties and conventions currently in existence. These laws are subject to change, possibly on a retroactive basis.

US holders in BHP Billiton Limited

(a) Australian taxation

Dividends

Dividends (including other distributions treated as dividends for Australian tax purposes) paid by BHP Billiton Limited to a US holder that is not an Australian resident for Australian tax purposes will generally not be subject to Australian withholding tax if they are fully franked (broadly, where a dividend is franked, tax paid by BHP Billiton Limited is imputed to the shareholders).

Dividends paid to such US holders, which are not fully franked, will generally be subject to 15 per cent Australian withholding tax only to the extent (if any) that the dividend is neither:

 

  franked; nor

 

  declared by BHP Billiton Limited to be conduit foreign income. (Broadly, this means that the relevant part of the dividend is declared to have been paid out of foreign source amounts received by BHP Billiton Limited that are not subject to tax in Australia, such as dividends remitted to Australia by foreign subsidiaries).

 

375


Table of Contents

The Australian withholding tax outcome described above applies to US holders who are eligible for benefits under the Tax Convention between Australia and the US as to the Avoidance of Double Taxation (the Australian Tax Treaty). Otherwise, the rate of Australian withholding tax may be 30 per cent.

In contrast, dividends (including other distributions treated as dividends for Australian tax purposes) paid by BHP Billiton Limited to a US holder may instead be taxed by assessment in Australia if the US holder:

 

  is an Australian resident for Australian tax purposes (although the tax will generally be limited to 15 per cent where the US holder is eligible for benefits under the Australian Tax Treaty as a treaty resident of the US and any franking credits may be creditable against their Australian income tax liability); or

 

  carries on business through a permanent establishment in Australia and the dividend is effectively connected with that permanent establishment (in which case any franking credits may be creditable against their Australian income tax liability); or

 

  performs independent personal services from a ‘fixed base’ situated in Australia and the dividend is effectively connected with that ‘fixed base’.

Sale of ordinary shares and ADSs

Gains made by US holders on the sale of ordinary shares or ADSs will generally not be taxed in Australia.

However, the precise Australian tax treatment of gains made by US holders on the sale of ordinary shares or ADSs generally depends on whether or not the gain is an Australian sourced gain of an income nature for Australian income tax purposes.

Where the gain is Australian sourced and of an income nature, a US holder will generally only be liable to Australian income tax on an assessment basis (whether or not they are also an Australian resident for Australian tax purposes) if:

 

  they are not eligible for benefits under the Australian Tax Treaty; or

 

  they are eligible for benefits under the Australian Tax Treaty but the gain constitutes any of the following:

 

    business profits of an enterprise attributable to a permanent establishment situated in Australia through which the enterprise carries on business in Australia; or

 

    income or gains from the alienation of property that form part of the business property of a permanent establishment of an enterprise that the US holder has in Australia, or pertain to a fixed base available to the US holder in Australia for the purpose of performing independent personal services; or

 

    income derived from the disposition of shares in a company, the assets of which consist wholly or principally of real property (which includes rights to exploit or to explore for natural resources) situated in Australia, whether such assets are held directly, or indirectly through one or more interposed entities.

Where the gain is either not Australian sourced or is not of an income nature, the US holder will generally only be liable to Australian capital gains tax on an assessment basis if they acquired (or are deemed to have acquired) their shares or ADSs after 19 September 1985 and one or more of the following applies:

 

  the US holder is an Australian resident for Australian tax purposes; or

 

  the ordinary shares or ADSs have been used by the US holder in carrying on a business through a permanent establishment in Australia; or

 

 

the US holder (either alone or together with associates) directly or indirectly owns or owned 10 per cent or more of the issued share capital of BHP Billiton Limited at the time of the disposal or throughout a

 

376


Table of Contents
 

12-month period during the two years prior to the time of disposal and, at the time of the disposal, the sum of the market values of BHP Billiton Limited’s assets that are taxable Australian real property (held directly or through interposed entities) exceeds the sum of the market values of BHP Billiton Limited’s assets (held directly or through interposed entities) that are not taxable Australian real property at that time (which, for these purposes, includes mining, quarrying or prospecting rights in respect of minerals, petroleum or quarry materials situated in Australia – and the Government has announced that it may be extended to associated information and goodwill); or

 

  the US holder is an individual who is not eligible for benefits under the Australian Tax Treaty as a treaty resident of the US and elected on becoming a non-resident of Australia to continue to have the ordinary shares or ADSs subject to Australian capital gains tax.

The comments above on the sale of ordinary shares and ADSs do not apply:

 

  to temporary residents of Australia who should seek advice that is specific to their circumstances;

 

  if the proposed Investment Management Regime (IMR) applies to the US holder. In this regard, the Australian Government has announced proposals to exempt from Australian income tax and capital gains tax gains made on disposals by certain categories of non-resident funds – called IMR foreign funds – of (relevantly) portfolio interests in Australian public companies. The exemptions would apply to gains made by IMR foreign funds that are treated as companies for Australian tax purposes as well as gains made by non-resident investors in IMR foreign funds that are treated as trusts and partnerships for Australian tax purposes. These reforms are not yet law and, if enacted, their start date is uncertain.

Stamp duty, gift, estate and inheritance tax

Australia does not impose any stamp duty, gift, estate or inheritance taxes in relation to transfers or gifts of shares or ADSs or upon the death of a shareholder.

(b) US taxation

This section describes the material US federal income tax consequences to a US holder of owning ordinary shares or ADSs. It applies only to ordinary shares or ADSs that are held as capital assets for tax purposes. This section does not apply to a holder of ordinary shares or ADSs that is a member of a special class of holders subject to special rules, including a dealer in securities, a trader in securities that elects to use a mark-to-market method of accounting for its securities holdings, a tax-exempt organisation, a life insurance company, a person liable for alternative minimum tax, a person who actually or constructively owns 10 per cent or more of the voting stock of BHP Billiton Limited, a person that holds ordinary shares or ADSs as part of a straddle or a hedging or conversion transaction, a person that purchases or sells ordinary shares or ADSs as part of a wash sale for tax purposes, or a person whose functional currency is not the US dollar.

If a partnership holds the ordinary shares or ADSs, the US federal income tax treatment of a partner generally will depend on the status of the partner and the tax treatment of the partnership. A partner in a partnership holding the ordinary shares or ADSs should consult its tax adviser with regard to the US federal income tax treatment of an investment in the ordinary shares or ADSs.

This section is in part based on the representations of the Depositary and the assumption that each obligation in the deposit agreement and any related agreement will be performed in accordance with its terms.

In general, for US federal income tax purposes, a holder of ADSs will be treated as the owner of the ordinary shares represented by those ADSs. Exchanges of ordinary shares for ADSs, and ADSs for ordinary shares, generally will not be subject to US federal income tax.

 

377


Table of Contents

Dividends

Under US federal income tax laws and subject to the Passive Foreign Investment Company (PFIC) rules discussed below, a US holder must include in its gross income the amount of any dividend paid by BHP Billiton Limited out of its current or accumulated earnings and profits (as determined for US federal income tax purposes) plus any Australian tax withheld from the dividend payment even though the holder does not receive it. The dividend is taxable to the holder when the holder, in the case of ordinary shares, or the Depositary, in the case of ADSs, actually or constructively receives the dividend.

Dividends paid to a non-corporate US holder on shares or ADSs will be taxable at the preferential rates applicable to long-term capital gains provided the US holder holds the shares or ADSs for more than 60 days during the 121-day period beginning 60 days before the ex-dividend date and does not enter into certain risk reduction transactions with respect to the shares or ADSs during the abovementioned holding period. However, a non-corporate US holder that elects to treat the dividend income as ‘investment income’ pursuant to Section 163(d)(4) of the US Internal Revenue Code will not be eligible for such preferential rates. In the case of a corporate US holder, dividends on shares and ADSs are taxed as ordinary income and will not be eligible for the dividends received deduction generally allowed to US corporations in respect of dividends received from other US corporations.

Distributions in excess of current and accumulated earnings and profits, as determined for US federal income tax purposes, will be treated as a non-taxable return of capital to the extent of the holder’s tax basis, determined in US dollars, in the ordinary shares or ADSs and thereafter as a capital gain.

The amount of any cash distribution paid in any foreign currency will be equal to the US dollar value of such currency, calculated by reference to the spot rate in effect on the date such distribution is received by the US holder or, in the case of ADSs, by the Depositary, regardless of whether and when the foreign currency is in fact converted into US dollars. If the foreign currency is converted into US dollars on the date received, the US holder generally should not recognise foreign currency gain or loss on such conversion. If the foreign currency is not converted into US dollars on the date received, the US holder will have a basis in the foreign currency equal to its US dollar value on the date received, and generally will recognise foreign currency gain or loss on a subsequent conversion or other disposal of such currency. Such foreign currency gain or loss generally will be treated as US source ordinary income or loss for foreign tax credit limitation purposes.

Subject to certain limitations, Australian tax withheld in accordance with the Australian Treaty and paid over to Australia will be creditable against an individual’s US federal income tax liability. Special rules apply in determining the foreign tax credit limitation with respect to dividends that are taxed at the preferential rates applicable to long-term capital gains. To the extent a refund of the tax withheld is available to a US holder under Australian law or under the Australian Treaty, the amount of tax withheld that is refundable will not be eligible for credit against the holder’s US federal income tax liability. A US holder that does not elect to claim a US foreign tax credit may instead claim a deduction for Australian income tax withheld, but only for a taxable year in which the US holder elects to do so with respect to all foreign income taxes paid or accrued in such taxable year.

Dividends will be income from sources outside the US, and generally will be ‘passive category’ income or, for certain taxpayers, ‘general category’ income, which are treated separately from each other for the purpose of computing the foreign tax credit allowable to a US holder. In general, a taxpayer’s ability to use foreign tax credits may be limited and is dependent on the particular circumstances. US holders should consult their tax advisers with respect to these matters.

Sale of ordinary shares and ADSs

Subject to the PFIC rules discussed below, a US holder who sells or otherwise disposes of ordinary shares or ADSs will recognise a capital gain or loss for US federal income tax purposes equal to the difference between the

 

378


Table of Contents

US dollar value of the amount realised and the holder’s tax basis, determined in US dollars, in those ordinary shares or ADSs. The gain or loss will generally be income or loss from sources within the US for foreign tax credit limitation purposes. The capital gain of a non-corporate US holder is generally taxed at preferential rates where the holder has a holding period greater than 12 months in the shares or ADSs sold. There are limitations on the deductibility of capital losses.

The US dollar value of any foreign currency received upon a sale or other disposition of ordinary shares or ADSs will be calculated by reference to the spot rate in effect on the date of sale or other disposal (or, in the case of a cash basis or electing accrual basis taxpayer, on the settlement date). A US holder will have a tax basis in the foreign currency received equal to that US dollar amount, and generally will recognise foreign currency gain or loss on a subsequent conversion or other disposal of the foreign currency. This foreign currency gain or loss generally will be treated as US source ordinary income or loss for foreign tax credit limitation purposes.

Passive Foreign Investment Company rules

We do not believe that the BHP Billiton Limited ordinary shares or ADSs will be treated as stock of a PFIC for US federal income tax purposes, but this conclusion is a factual determination that is made annually at the end of the year and thus may be subject to change. If BHP Billiton Limited were treated as a PFIC, any gain realised on the sale or other disposition of ordinary shares or ADSs would in general not be treated as a capital gain. Instead, a US holder would be treated as if it had realised such gain and certain ‘excess distributions’ ratably over its holding period for the ordinary shares or ADSs and would be taxed at the highest tax rate in effect for each such year to which the gain was allocated, together with an interest charge in respect of the tax attributable to each such year. In addition, dividends received with respect to ordinary shares or ADSs would not be eligible for the special tax rates applicable to qualified dividend income if BHP Billiton Limited were a PFIC either in the taxable year of the distribution or the preceding taxable year, but instead would be taxable at rates applicable to ordinary income. Assuming the shares or ADSs are ‘marketable stock’, a US holder may mitigate the adverse tax consequences described above by electing to be taxed annually on a mark-to-market basis with respect to such shares or ADSs.

US Holders in BHP Billiton Plc

(a) UK taxation

Dividends

Under UK law, no UK tax is required to be withheld at source from dividends paid on ordinary shares or ADSs.

Sale of ordinary shares and ADSs

US holders will not be liable for UK tax on capital gains realised on disposal of ordinary shares or ADSs unless:

 

  they are resident in the UK; or

 

  they carry on a trade, profession or vocation in the UK through a branch or agency for the year in which the disposal occurs and the shares or ADSs have been used, held or acquired for the purposes of such trade (or profession or vocation), branch or agency. In the case of a trade, the term ‘branch’ includes a permanent establishment.

An individual who ceases to be a resident in the UK for tax purposes while owning shares or ADSs and then disposes of those shares or ADSs while not a UK resident may become subject to UK tax on capital gains if he/she:

 

  had sole UK residence in the UK tax year preceding his/her departure from the UK;

 

  had sole UK residence at any time during at least four of the seven UK tax years preceding his/her year of departure from the UK; and

 

  subsequently becomes treated as having sole UK residence again before five complete UK tax years of non-UK residence have elapsed from the date he/she left the UK.

 

379


Table of Contents

In this situation US holders will generally be entitled to claim US tax paid on such a disposition as a credit against any corresponding UK tax payable.

UK inheritance tax

Under the current UK – US Inheritance and Gift Tax Treaty, ordinary shares or ADSs held by a US holder who is domiciled for the purposes of the UK – US Inheritance and Gift Tax Treaty in the US, and is not for the purposes of the UK – US Inheritance and Gift Tax Treaty a national of the UK, will generally not be subject to UK inheritance tax on the individual’s death or on a chargeable gift of the ordinary shares or ADSs during the individual’s lifetime, provided that any applicable US federal gift or estate tax liability is paid, unless the ordinary shares or ADSs are part of the business property of a permanent establishment of the individual in the UK or, in the case of a shareholder who performs independent personal services, pertain to a fixed base situated in the UK. Where the ordinary shares or ADSs have been placed in trust by a settlor who, at the time of settlement, was a US resident shareholder, the ordinary shares or ADSs will generally not be subject to UK inheritance tax unless the settlor, at the time of settlement, was not domiciled in the US and was a UK national. In the exceptional case where the ordinary shares or ADSs are subject to both UK inheritance tax and US federal gift or estate tax, the UK – US Inheritance and Gift Tax Treaty generally provides for double taxation to be relieved by means of credit relief.

UK stamp duty and stamp duty reserve tax

Under applicable legislation, UK stamp duty or stamp duty reserve tax (SDRT) is, subject to certain exemptions, payable on any issue or transfer of shares to the Depositary or their nominee where those shares are for inclusion in the ADR program at a rate of 1.5 per cent of their price (if issued), the amount of any consideration provided (if transferred on sale) or their value (if transferred for no consideration). However, from 1 October 2009, this 1.5 per cent charge has generally ceased to apply to issues of shares into European Union (EU) depositary receipt systems and into EU clearance systems. Further, the First-tier Tribunal has held that the 1.5 per cent SDRT charge on a transfer of shares to an issuer of American Depositary Receipts (as an integral part of a fresh capital raising) was incompatible with European Union law. Her Majesty’s Revenue and Customs has confirmed that it will no longer seek to impose the 1.5 per cent SDRT charge on the issue of shares (or, where it is integral to the raising of new capital, the transfer of shares) to a depositary receipt issuer or a clearance service, wherever located. The law in this area may still be susceptible to change. We recommend advice should be sought in relation to paying the 1.5 per cent SDRT or stamp duty charge in any circumstances.

No SDRT would be payable on the transfer of an ADS. No UK stamp duty should be payable on the transfer of an ADS provided that the instrument of transfer is executed and remains at all times outside the UK. Transfers of ordinary shares to persons other than the Depositary or their nominee will give rise to stamp duty or SDRT at the time of transfer. The relevant rate is currently 0.5 per cent of the amount payable for the shares. The purchaser normally pays the stamp duty or SDRT.

Special rules apply to transactions involving intermediates and stock lending.

(b) US taxation

This section describes the material US federal income tax consequences to a US holder of owning ordinary shares or ADSs. It applies only to ordinary shares or ADSs that are held as capital assets for tax purposes. This section does not apply to a holder of ordinary shares or ADSs that is a member of a special class of holders subject to special rules, including a dealer in securities, a trader in securities who elects to use a mark-to-market method of accounting for its securities holdings, a tax-exempt organisation, a life insurance company, a person liable for alternative minimum tax, a person who actually or constructively owns 10 per cent or more of the voting stock of BHP Billiton Plc, a person that holds ordinary shares or ADSs as part of a straddle or a hedging or conversion transaction, a person that purchases or sells ordinary shares or ADSs as part of a wash sale for tax purposes, or a person whose functional currency is not the US dollar.

 

380


Table of Contents

If a partnership holds the ordinary shares or ADSs, the US federal income tax treatment of a partner generally will depend on the status of the partner and the tax treatment of the partnership. A partner in a partnership holding the ordinary shares or ADSs should consult its tax adviser with regard to the US federal income tax treatment of an investment in the ordinary shares or ADSs.

This section is in part based on the representations of the Depositary and the assumption that each obligation in the deposit agreement and any related agreement will be performed in accordance with its terms.

In general, for US federal income tax purposes, a holder of ADSs will be treated as the owner of the ordinary shares represented by those ADSs. Exchanges of ordinary shares for ADSs, and ADSs for ordinary shares generally will not be subject to US federal income tax.

Dividends

Under US federal income tax laws and subject to the PFIC rules discussed below, a US holder must include in its gross income the gross amount of any dividend paid by BHP Billiton Plc out of its current or accumulated earnings and profits (as determined for US federal income tax purposes). The dividend is taxable to the holder when the holder, in the case of ordinary shares, or the Depositary, in the case of ADSs, actually or constructively receives the dividend.

Dividends paid to a non-corporate US holder on shares or ADSs will be taxable at the preferential rates applicable to long-term capital gains provided that the US holder holds the shares or ADSs for more than 60 days during the 121-day period beginning 60 days before the ex-dividend date, and does not enter into certain risk reduction transactions with respect to the shares or ADSs during the abovementioned holding period. However, a non-corporate US holder that elects to treat the dividend income as ‘investment income’ pursuant to Section 163(d)(4) of the Internal Revenue Code will not be eligible for such preferential rates. In the case of a corporate US holder, dividends on shares and ADSs are taxed as ordinary income and will not be eligible for the dividends received deduction generally allowed to US corporations in respect of dividends received from other US corporations.

Distributions in excess of current and accumulated earnings and profits, as determined for US federal income tax purposes, will be treated as a non-taxable return of capital to the extent of the holder’s tax basis, determined in US dollars, in the ordinary shares or ADSs and thereafter as a capital gain.

The amount of any cash distribution paid in any foreign currency will be equal to the US dollar value of such currency, calculated by reference to the spot rate in effect on the date such distribution is received by the US holder or, in the case of ADSs, by the Depositary, regardless of whether and when the foreign currency is in fact converted into US dollars. If the foreign currency is converted into US dollars on the date received, the US holder generally should not recognise foreign currency gain or loss on such conversion. If the foreign currency is not converted into US dollars on the date received, the US holder will have a basis in the foreign currency equal to its US dollar value on the date received, and generally will recognise foreign currency gain or loss on a subsequent conversion or other disposal of such currency. Such foreign currency gain or loss generally will be treated as US source ordinary income or loss for foreign tax credit limitation purposes.

Dividends will be income from sources outside the US, and generally will be ‘passive category’ income or, for certain taxpayers, ‘general category’ income, which are treated separately from each other for the purpose of computing the foreign tax credit allowable to a US holder. In general, a taxpayer’s ability to use foreign tax credits may be limited and is dependent on the particular circumstances. US holders should consult their own tax advisers with respect to these matters.

 

381


Table of Contents

Sale of ordinary shares and ADSs

Subject to the PFIC rules discussed below, a US holder who sells or otherwise disposes of ordinary shares or ADSs will recognise a capital gain or loss for US federal income tax purposes equal to the difference between the US dollar value of the amount realised and the holder’s tax basis, determined in US dollars, in those ordinary shares or ADSs. The gain or loss will generally be income or loss from sources within the US for foreign tax credit limitation purposes. The capital gain of a non-corporate US holder is generally taxed at preferential rates where the holder has a holding period greater than 12 months in the shares or ADSs sold. There are limitations on the deductibility of capital losses.

The US dollar value of any foreign currency received upon a sale or other disposition of ordinary shares or ADSs will be calculated by reference to the spot rate in effect on the date of sale or other disposal (or, in the case of a cash basis or electing accrual basis taxpayer, on the settlement date). A US holder will have a tax basis in the foreign currency received equal to that US dollar amount, and generally will recognise foreign currency gain or loss on a subsequent conversion or other disposal of the foreign currency. This foreign currency gain or loss generally will be treated as US source ordinary income or loss for foreign tax credit limitation purposes.

Passive Foreign Investment Company rules

We do not believe that the BHP Billiton Plc ordinary shares or ADSs will be treated as stock of a PFIC for US federal income tax purposes, but this conclusion is a factual determination that is made annually at the end of the year and thus may be subject to change. If BHP Billiton Plc were treated as a PFIC, any gain realised on the sale or other disposition of ordinary shares or ADSs would in general not be treated as a capital gain. Instead, a US holder would be treated as if it had realised such gain and certain ‘excess distributions’ ratably over its holding period for the ordinary shares or ADSs and would be taxed at the highest tax rate in effect for each such year to which the gain was allocated, together with an interest charge in respect of the tax attributable to each such year. In addition, dividends received with respect to ordinary shares or ADSs would not be eligible for the special tax rates applicable to qualified dividend income if BHP Billiton Plc were a PFIC either in the taxable year of the distribution or the preceding taxable year, but instead would be taxable at rates applicable to ordinary income. Assuming the shares or ADSs are ‘marketable stock’, a US holder may mitigate the adverse tax consequences described above by electing to be taxed annually on a mark-to-market basis with respect to such shares or ADSs.

(c) South African taxation

Dividends

As from 1 April 2012, it is possible that US holders of BHP Billiton Plc shares or ADSs that remain South African residents may be subject to South African Dividends Tax, at a maximum rate of 15 per cent, on any dividends received from shares listed on the JSE. The South African Dividends Tax will be withheld from the gross amount of the dividend paid to the shareholder.

No South African Dividends Tax is required to be withheld from cash dividends provided the dividends are paid to, inter alia, non-South African tax resident shareholders or South African tax resident corporate shareholders (including South African pension, provident, retirement annuity and benefit funds). However, these dividends will only be exempt from South African Dividends Tax if these types of shareholders provide the requisite exempt declarations to the regulated intermediaries making the cash dividend payments.

Dividends Tax is nevertheless required to be withheld on dividends paid on ordinary shares and ADSs of BHP Billiton Plc listed on the JSE, where such dividends are paid to South African tax resident shareholders who are natural persons (individuals) or trusts, other than closure rehabilitation trusts.

Except for certain exclusions, generally speaking such dividends paid to South African tax resident natural persons or trusts are exempt from South African income tax and as such, the Dividends Tax may be considered as a final and non-creditable levy.

 

382


Table of Contents

Sale of ordinary shares and ADSs

A US holder who or which is tax resident in South Africa would be liable for income tax on any profit on disposal of ordinary shares or ADSs, or capital gains tax on any gain on disposal of ordinary shares or ADSs, depending on whether the shares and ADSs are held on revenue or capital account.

Income tax is payable on any profit on disposal of ordinary shares or ADSs held by a non-resident US holder where the profit is of a revenue nature and sourced in South Africa unless relief is afforded under the Double Tax Agreement concluded between South Africa and the US. In such a case, the profit would only be taxed in South Africa if it is attributable to a permanent establishment of that US holder in South Africa.

Where the ordinary shares or ADSs are not held on revenue account, non-resident US holders will not be liable for South African tax on capital gains realised on the disposal of ordinary shares or ADSs unless:

 

  such US Holders are tax resident in South Africa;

 

  the shares or ADSs are held in a company, where 80 per cent or more of the market value of those shares or ADSs is attributable (at the time of disposal of those shares or ADSs) directly or indirectly to immovable property situated in South Africa, held otherwise than as trading stock; or

 

  the US holder’s interest (the shares or ADSs in BHP Billiton Plc) is attributable to a permanent establishment which the US holder has in South Africa.

A US holder who holds ordinary shares or ADSs connected to a permanent establishment in South Africa will recognise a capital gain or loss for South African income tax purposes equal to the difference between the Rand value of the amount realised and the holder’s tax basis, determined in Rand, in those ordinary shares or ADSs. The holder’s tax basis will generally be equal to the cost that was incurred to acquire the shares, if such shares were acquired after 1 October 2001. The capital gain of a non-resident’s permanent establishment in South Africa will be taxed at an effective rate of 18.6 per cent.

Securities Transfer Tax

South African Securities Transfer Tax is levied at 0.25 per cent in respect of the transfer of ordinary shares or ADSs. The tax is levied on the amount of consideration at which the ordinary share or ADS is transferred or, where no value is declared, the closing price of the ordinary shares or ADSs. The tax is ultimately borne by the person to whom that ordinary share or ADS is transferred.

9.11    Government regulations

Government regulations touch all aspects of our operations. However, the geographical diversity of our operations reduces the risk that any one set of government regulations would have a material effect on our business, taken as a whole.

The ability to extract minerals, oil and natural gas is fundamental to BHP Billiton. In most jurisdictions, the rights to undeveloped mineral or petroleum deposits are owned by the state. In those jurisdictions, we rely upon the rights granted to us by the government that owns the mineral, oil or natural gas. These rights usually take the form of a lease or licence, which gives us the right to access the land and extract the product. The terms of the lease or licence, including the time period for which it is effective, are specific to the laws of the relevant government. Generally, we own the product we extract and royalties or similar taxes are payable to the government. In certain jurisdictions in which we operate, such as Trinidad and Tobago, a production sharing contract (PSC) governs the relationship between the government and companies concerning how much of the oil and gas extracted from the country each will receive. In production sharing contracts the government awards rights for the execution of exploration, development and production activities to the company. The company bears the financial risk of the initiative and explores, develops and ultimately produces the field as required.

 

383


Table of Contents

When successful, the company is permitted to use the money from a certain set percentage of produced oil and gas to recover capital and operational expenditures, known as ‘cost oil’. The remaining production is known as ‘profit oil’ and is split between the government and the company at a rate determined by the government and set out in the PSC.

Related to the ability to extract is the ability to process the minerals, oil or natural gas. Again, we rely upon the relevant government to grant the rights necessary to transport and treat the extracted material in order to ready it for sale.

Underlying our business of extracting and processing natural resources is the ability to explore for those natural resources. Typically, the rights to explore for minerals, oil and natural gas are granted to us by the government that owns those natural resources that we wish to explore. Usually, the right to explore carries with it the obligation to spend a defined amount of money on the exploration or to undertake particular exploration activities.

Although onshore oil and gas rights in the United States can be derived from government (state and federal) mineral rights, they are primarily derived from private ownership of the rights, which is the case for our onshore oil and gas rights. Oil and gas rights primarily take the form of a lease, but also can be owned onshore outright in fee. If the rights granted are by lease, we are afforded the rights to access, explore, extract, produce and market the oil and gas for a period of years and then generally so long thereafter as there is oil or gas production or operations on the leased lands.

Governments also impose obligations on us in respect of environmental protection, land rehabilitation, occupational health and safety, and the rights and interests of Indigenous peoples with which we must comply in order to continue to enjoy the right to conduct our operations within that jurisdiction. These obligations often require us to make substantial expenditures to minimise or remediate the environmental impact of our operations, to ensure the safety of our employees and contractors and the like. Environmental protection, land rehabilitation and occupational health and safety onshore in the United States are principally regulated by the government and to a lesser degree, if applicable, by the lease contract with the landowner. For further information on these types of obligations, refer to section 1.14 of this Annual Report.

Of particular note are the following regulatory regimes:

9.11.1    Uranium production in Australia

To mine, process, transport and sell uranium from within Australia, we are required to hold possession and export permissions, which are also subject to regulation by the Australian Government or bodies that report to the Australian Government.

To possess nuclear material, such as uranium, in Australia, a Permit to Possess Nuclear Materials (Possession Permit) must be held pursuant to the Australian Nuclear Non-Proliferation (Safeguards) Act 1987 (Non-Proliferation Act). A Possession Permit is issued by the Australian Safeguards and Non-Proliferation Office, an office established under the Non-Proliferation Act, which administers Australia’s domestic nuclear safeguards requirements and reports to the Australian Government.

To export uranium from Australia, a Permit to Export Natural Uranium (Export Permit) must be held pursuant to the Australian Customs (Prohibited Exports) Regulations 1958. The Export Permit is issued by the Minister for Resources and Energy.

A special transport permit is required under the Non-Proliferation Act by a party that transports nuclear material from one specified location to another specified location. As we engage service providers to transport uranium, those service providers are required to hold a special transport permit.

 

384


Table of Contents

9.11.2    Exchange controls and shareholding limits

BHP Billiton Plc

There are no laws or regulations currently in force in the United Kingdom that restrict the export or import of capital or the remittance of dividends to non-resident holders of BHP Billiton Plc’s shares, although the Group does operate in some other jurisdictions where remittances of funds could be affected as they are subject to exchange control approvals. There are certain sanctions adopted by the UK Government which implement resolutions of the Security Council of the United Nations and sanctions imposed by the European Union (EU) against certain countries, entities and individuals and may restrict the export or import of capital or the remittance of dividends to certain non-resident holders of BHP Billiton Plc’s shares. Any enforcement of financial sanctions by the UK Government would be initiated by HM Treasury. Such sanctions may be in force from time to time and include those against:

(i) certain entities and/or individuals associated with Afghanistan, Belarus, the Central African Republic, Cote d’Ivoire, the Democratic People’s Republic of Korea (North Korea), the Democratic Republic of Congo, Egypt, Eritrea, the Republic of Guinea, the Republic of Guinea-Bissau, Iran, Lebanon, Liberia, the Russian Federation, Somalia, South Sudan, Sudan, Syria, Tunisia, Ukraine, Zimbabwe and the previous regimes of Iraq, Libya and Yugoslavia;

(ii) individuals indicted by the International Criminal Tribunal for the former Yugoslavia;

(iii) entities and individuals linked with the Taliban, Al-Qaeda and other terrorist organisations.

There are no restrictions under BHP Billiton Plc’s Articles of Association or (subject to the effect of any sanctions) under English law that limit the right of non-resident or foreign owners to hold or vote BHP Billiton Plc’s shares.

There are certain restrictions on shareholding levels under BHP Billiton Plc’s Articles of Association described under the heading ‘BHP Billiton Limited’ below.

BHP Billiton Limited

From time to time, the United Nations Security Council and the Australian Government impose international sanctions on certain countries and organisations. The countries and organisations that are currently subject to United Nations sanctions are certain individuals or entities linked with the Taliban, Al-Qaeda and associated individuals and entities, other designated individuals and entities associated with terrorism, certain entities and individuals associated with the Central African Republic, the Democratic Republic of Congo, Cote d’Ivoire, the Democratic People’s Republic of Korea (North Korea), Eritrea, Guinea-Bissau, Iran, Iraq, Lebanon, Liberia, Libya, Sudan, Somalia and Yemen. The countries currently subject to the Australian Government’s autonomous sanctions are Myanmar, the Democratic People’s Republic of Korea (North Korea), Fiji, the former Federal Republic of Yugoslavia, Iran, Libya, Syria, Ukraine and Zimbabwe. The controls impose certain approval and reporting requirements on transactions involving such countries, entities and individuals and/or assets controlled or owned by them. Certain transfers into or out of Australia of amounts greater than A$10,000 in any currency may also be subject to reporting requirements. In addition, under the Australian Banking (Foreign Exchange) Regulations 1959, the Reserve Bank of Australia may impose restrictions on certain financial transactions and require the consent of the Reserve Bank of Australia for the movement of funds into and out of Australia. No such restrictions are currently in place.

Remittances of any dividends, interest or other payments by BHP Billiton Limited to non-resident holders of BHP Billiton Limited’s securities are not restricted by exchange controls or other limitations, save that in certain circumstances, BHP Billiton may be required to withhold Australian taxes.

There are no limitations, either under the laws of Australia or under the Constitution of BHP Billiton Limited, on the right of non-residents to hold or vote BHP Billiton Limited ordinary shares other than as set out below.

 

385


Table of Contents

The Australian Foreign Acquisitions and Takeovers Act 1975 (the FATA) restricts certain acquisitions of interests in shares in BHP Billiton. Generally, under the FATA, the prior approval of the Australian Treasurer must be obtained for proposals by a foreign person (either alone or together with associates) to acquire control of 15 per cent or more of the voting power or issued shares in BHP Billiton Limited.

The FATA also empowers the Treasurer to make certain orders prohibiting acquisitions by foreign persons in BHP Billiton Limited (and requiring divestiture if the acquisition has occurred) where he considers the acquisition to be contrary to the national interest and the 15 per cent threshold referred to above would be exceeded as a result. Such orders may also be made in respect of acquisitions by foreign persons where two or more foreign persons (and their associates) in aggregate already control 40 per cent or more of the issued shares or voting power in BHP Billiton Limited.

There are certain other statutory restrictions, and restrictions under BHP Billiton Limited’s Constitution and BHP Billiton Plc’s Articles of Association, that apply generally to acquisitions of shares in BHP Billiton (i.e. the restrictions are not targeted at foreign persons only). These include restrictions on a person (and associates) breaching a voting power threshold of:

 

  20 per cent in relation to BHP Billiton Limited on a ‘stand-alone’ basis, i.e. calculated as if there were no Special Voting Share and only counting BHP Billiton Limited’s ordinary shares.

 

  30 per cent of BHP Billiton Plc. This is the threshold for a mandatory offer under Rule 9 of the UK takeover code and this threshold applies to all voting rights of BHP Billiton Plc (therefore including voting rights attached to the BHP Billiton Plc Special Voting Share).

 

  30 per cent in relation to BHP Billiton Plc on a ‘stand-alone’ basis, i.e. calculated as if there were no Special Voting Share and only counting BHP Billiton Plc’s ordinary shares.

 

  20 per cent in relation to the BHP Billiton Group, calculated having regard to all the voting power on a joint electorate basis, i.e. calculated on the aggregate of BHP Billiton Limited’s and BHP Billiton Plc’s ordinary shares.

Under BHP Billiton Limited’s Constitution and BHP Billiton Plc’s Articles of Association, sanctions for breach of any of these thresholds, other than by means of certain ‘permitted acquisitions’, include withholding of dividends, voting restrictions and compulsory divestment of shares to the extent a shareholder and its associates exceed the relevant threshold.

9.12    Ancillary information for our shareholders

Information for BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc shareholders is provided in the BHP Billiton Group Annual Report 2014 and the Summary Review 2014.

This Annual Report provides the detailed financial data and information on the BHP Billiton Group’s performance required to comply with the reporting regimes in Australia, the United Kingdom and the United States. There are no specific disclosure requirements for the Summary Review, which is published as a communication for shareholders.

Shareholders of BHP Billiton Limited will receive a copy of the Annual Report or the Summary Review if they have requested a copy. Shareholders of BHP Billiton Plc will receive the Annual Report if they have requested a copy. ADR holders may view all documents online at www.bhpbilliton.com or opt to receive a hard copy by application to Citibank Shareholder Services, details as listed on the inside back cover of the Annual Report.

Change of shareholder details and enquiries

Shareholders wishing to contact BHP Billiton on any matter relating to their shares or ADR holdings are invited to telephone the appropriate office of the BHP Billiton Share Registrar or Transfer Office listed on the inside back cover of the Annual Report.

 

386


Table of Contents

Any change in shareholding details should be notified by the shareholder to the relevant Registrar in a timely manner.

Shareholders can also access their current shareholding details and change many of those details online at www.bhpbilliton.com. The website requires shareholders to quote their Shareholder Reference Number (SRN) or Holder Identification Number (HIN) in order to access this information.

Alternative access to the Annual Report and Summary Review

We offer an alternative for all shareholders who wish to be advised of the availability of the Annual Report and Summary Review through our website via an email notification. By providing an email address through our website, shareholders will be notified by email when the Annual Report and Summary Review have been released. Shareholders will also receive notification of other major BHP Billiton announcements by email. Shareholders requiring further information or to make use of this service, should visit our website www.bhpbilliton.com.

ADR holders wishing to receive a hard copy of the Annual Report 2014 can do so by accessing citibank.ar.wilink.com or by calling Citibank Shareholder Services during normal business hours. ADR holders may also contact the adviser that administers their investments. Holders of BHP Billiton Plc shares dematerialised into Strate should liaise directly with their Central Securities Depository Participant (CSDP) or broker.

Key dates for shareholders

The following table sets out future dates in the next financial and calendar year of interest to our shareholders. If there are any changes to these dates, all relevant stock exchanges (refer to section 9.2) will be notified.

 

Date

  

Event

23 September 2014

   Final Dividend Payment Date

23 October 2014

  

BHP Billiton Plc Annual General Meeting in London

Venue:

The Queen Elizabeth II Conference Centre

Broad Sanctuary

Westminster

London SW1P 3EE

United Kingdom

Time: 11.00 am (local time)

Details of the business of the meeting are contained in the separate Notice of Meeting

20 November 2014

  

BHP Billiton Limited Annual General Meeting in Adelaide

Venue:

Adelaide Entertainment Centre

Corner Port Road and Adam Street

Hindmarsh

South Australia

Australia

Time: 10.00 am (local time)

Details of the business of the meeting are contained in the separate Notice of Meeting

24 February 2015

   Interim Results Announced

13 March 2015

   Interim Dividend Record Date

31 March 2015

   Interim Dividend Payment Date

25 August 2015

   Annual Results Announced

 

387


Table of Contents

Corporate Directory

BHP Billiton Group Registered Offices

BHP Billiton Limited

Australia

BHP Billiton Centre

171 Collins Street

Melbourne VIC 3000

Telephone 1300 554 757 (within Australia)

+61 3 9609 3333 (outside Australia)

Facsimile +61 3 9609 3015

BHP Billiton Plc

United Kingdom

Neathouse Place

London SW1V 1LH

Telephone +44 20 7802 4000

Facsimile +44 20 7802 4111

Group Company Secretary

Jane McAloon

BHP Billiton Corporate Centres

South Africa

6 Hollard Street

Marshalltown

Johannesburg 2107

Telephone +27 11 376 9111

Facsimile +27 11 838 4716

Chile

Cerro El Plomo 6000

Piso 18

Las Condes 7560623

Santiago

Telephone +56 2 2579 5000

Facsimile +56 2 2207 6517

United States

Our agent for service in the United States is Maria Isabel Reuter at:

1360 Post Oak Boulevard, Suite 150

Houston, TX 77056-3020

Telephone +1 713 961 8500

Facsimile +1 713 961 8400

 

388


Table of Contents

Marketing Offices

Singapore

10 Marina Boulevard, #50-01

Marina Bay Financial Centre, Tower 2

Singapore 018983

Telephone +65 6421 6000

Facsimile +65 6421 7000

Share Registrars and Transfer Offices

Australia

BHP Billiton Limited Registrar

Computershare Investor Services Pty Limited

Yarra Falls, 452 Johnston Street

Abbotsford VIC 3067

Postal Address – GPO Box 2975

Melbourne VIC 3001

Telephone 1300 656 780 (within Australia)

+61 3 9415 4020 (outside Australia)

Facsimile +61 3 9473 2460

Email enquiries:

www.investorcentre.com/bhp

United Kingdom

BHP Billiton Plc Registrar

Computershare Investor Services PLC

The Pavilions, Bridgwater Road

Bristol BS99 6ZZ

Telephone +44 844 472 7001

Facsimile +44 870 703 6101

Email enquiries:

www.investorcentre.co.uk/contactus

South Africa

BHP Billiton Plc Branch Register

and Transfer Secretary

Computershare Investor Services

(Pty) Limited

70 Marshall Street

Johannesburg 2001

Postal Address – PO Box 61051

Marshalltown 2107

Telephone +27 11 373 0033

Facsimile +27 11 688 5217

Email enquiries:

web.queries@computershare.co.za

Holders of shares dematerialised

into Strate should contact their

CSDP or stockbroker.

 

389


Table of Contents

New Zealand

Computershare Investor Services Limited

Level 2/159 Hurstmere Road

Takapuna Auckland

Postal Address – Private Bag 92119

Auckland 1142

Telephone +64 9 488 8777

Facsimile +64 9 488 8787

United States

Computershare Trust Company, N.A.

250 Royall Street

Canton, MA 02021

Postal Address – PO Box 43078

Providence, RI 02940-3078

Telephone +1 888 404 6340

(toll-free within US)

Facsimile +1 312 601 4331

ADR Depositary, Transfer Agent and Registrar

Citibank Shareholder Services

PO Box 43077

Providence, RI 02940-3077

Telephone +1 781 575 4555 (outside of US) +1 877 248 4237 (+1-877-CITIADR)

(toll-free within US)

Facsimile +1 201 324 3284

Email enquiries:

citibank@shareholders-online.com

Website: www.citi.com/dr

BHP Billiton is a Dual Listed Company comprising BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc. The two entities continue to exist as separate companies but operate as a combined Group known as BHP Billiton.

The headquarters of BHP Billiton Limited and the global headquarters of the combined BHP Billiton Group are located in Melbourne, Australia. BHP Billiton Plc is located in London, United Kingdom. Both companies have identical Boards of Directors and are run by a unified management team. Throughout this publication, the Boards are referred to collectively as the Board. Shareholders in each company have equivalent economic and voting rights in the BHP Billiton Group as a whole.

Throughout this Annual Report, the terms BHP Billiton, the Company and the Group refer to the combined group, including both BHP Billiton Limited and subsidiary companies and BHP Billiton Plc and subsidiary companies.

 

390


Table of Contents

10    Exhibits

Exhibits marked “*” have been filed as exhibits to this annual report on Form 20-F. Remaining exhibits have been incorporated by reference as indicated.

Exhibit 1    Constitution

 

1.1 Constitution of BHP Billiton Limited (1)

 

1.2 Memorandum and Articles of Association of BHP Billiton Plc. (1)

Exhibit 4    Material Contracts

 

4.1 DLC Structure Sharing Agreement, dated 29 June 2001, between BHP Limited and Billiton Plc. (2)

 

4.2 SVC Special Voting Shares Deed, dated 29 June 2001, among BHP Limited, BHP SVC Pty Limited, Billiton Plc, Billiton SVC Limited and The Law Debenture Trust Corporation p.l.c. (2)

 

4.3 SVC Special Voting Shares Amendment Deed, dated 13 August 2001, among BHP Limited, BHP SVC Pty Limited, Billiton Plc, Billiton SVC Limited and The Law Debenture Trust Corporation p.l.c. (2)

 

4.4 Deed Poll Guarantee, dated 29 June 2001, of BHP Limited (2)

 

4.5 Deed Poll Guarantee, dated 29 June 2001, of Billiton Plc (2)

 

4.6 Form of Service Agreement for Specified Executive (referred to in this Annual Report as the Key Management Personnel) (3)

 

4.7 BHP Billiton Ltd Group Incentive Scheme Rules 2004, dated August 2008 (4)

 

4.8 BHP Billiton Ltd Long Term Incentive Plan Rules, dated November 2010 (1)

 

4.9 BHP Billiton Plc Group Incentive Scheme Rules 2004, dated August 2008 (4)

 

4.10 BHP Billiton Plc Long Term Incentive Plan Rules, dated November 2010 (1)

 

4.11 Agreement and Plan of Merger by and among BHP Billiton Limited, BHP Billiton Petroleum (North America) Inc., North America Holdings II Inc. and Petrohawk Energy Corporation, dated 14 July 2011. (5)

Exhibit 8    List of Subsidiaries

 

*8.1 List of subsidiaries of BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc

Exhibit 12    Certifications (section 302)

 

*12.1 Certification by Chief Executive Officer, Mr Andrew Mackenzie, dated 25 September 2014

 

*12.2 Certification by Chief Financial Officer, Mr Graham Kerr, dated 25 September 2014

Exhibit 13    Certifications (section 906)

 

*13.1 Certification by Chief Executive Officer, Mr Andrew Mackenzie, dated 25 September 2014

 

*13.2 Certification by Chief Financial Officer, Mr Graham Kerr, dated 25 September 2014

Exhibit 15    Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

 

*15.1 Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firms KPMG and KPMG Audit Plc for incorporation by reference of audit reports in registration statements on Form F-3 and Form S-8

 

391


Table of Contents

Exhibit 95    Mine Safety Health Administration

 

*95.1 Disclosure of Mine Safety and Health Administration (“MSHA”) Safety Data.

 

Footnotes

 

(1)  Previously filed as an exhibit to BHP Billiton’s annual report on Form 20-F for the year ended 30 June 2011 on 21 September 2011.

 

(2)  Previously filed as an exhibit to BHP Billiton’s annual report on Form 20-F for the year ended 30 June 2001 on 19 November 2001.

 

(3)  Previously filed as an exhibit to BHP Billiton’s annual report on Form 20-F for the year ended 30 June 2013 on 25 September 2013.

 

(4)  Previously filed as an exhibit to BHP Billiton’s annual report on Form 20-F for the year ended 30 June 2008 on 15 September 2008.

 

(5)  Previously filed as an exhibit to BHP Billiton Limited’s tender offer statement on schedule TO on 15 July 2011.

 

392


Table of Contents

SIGNATURE

The registrants hereby certify that they meet all of the requirements for filing on Form 20-F and that they have duly caused and authorised the undersigned to sign this annual report on their behalf.

BHP Billiton Limited

BHP Billiton Plc

/s/ Graham Kerr

Graham Kerr

Chief Financial Officer

Date: 25 September 2014

 

393


Table of Contents

7    Financial Statements

 

Contents     

7.1 Consolidated Financial Statements

   F-1

7.1.1 Consolidated Income Statement

   F-1

7.1.2 Consolidated Statement of Comprehensive Income

   F-2

7.1.3 Consolidated Balance Sheet

   F-3

7.1.4 Consolidated Cash Flow Statement

   F-4

7.1.5 Consolidated Statement of Changes in Equity

   F-5

7.1.6 Notes to Financial Statements

   F-7

7.2 Not required for US reporting

   F-123

7.3 Directors’ declaration

   F-123

7.4  Statement of Directors’ Responsibilities in respect of the Annual Report and the Financial Statements

   F-124

7.5 Not required for US reporting

   F-125

7.6 Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firms

   F-126

7.7 Supplementary oil and gas information – unaudited

   F-130

 

Notes to Financial Statements     
1    Accounting policies    F-7
2    Segment reporting    F-25
3    Exceptional items    F-30
4    Other income    F-34
5    Expenses    F-35
6    Net finance costs    F-36
7    Income tax and deferred tax    F-37
8    Earnings per share    F-41
9    Dividends    F-41
10    Trade and other receivables    F-43
11    Other financial assets    F-44
12    Inventories    F-45
13    Property, plant and equipment    F-46
14    Intangible assets    F-48
15    Trade and other payables    F-51
16    Interest bearing liabilities    F-51
17    Other financial liabilities    F-52
18    Provisions    F-52
19    Share capital    F-54
20    Other equity    F-56
21    Contingent liabilities    F-59
22    Commitments    F-60
23    Notes to the consolidated cash flow statement    F-61
24    Business combinations    F-63
25    Assets and liabilities held for sale    F-64
26    Subsidiaries    F-65
27    Investments accounted for using the equity method    F-68
28    Interests in joint operations    F-72
29    Financial risk management    F-73
30    Pension and other post-retirement obligations    F-90
31    Key management personnel    F-97
32    Related party transactions    F-97
33    Employee share ownership plans    F-99
34    Employees    F-110
35    Auditor’s remuneration    F-111
36    Subsequent events    F-111
37    Impact of new accounting standards and change in accounting policies    F-113


Table of Contents

7.1    Consolidated Financial Statements

7.1.1    Consolidated Income Statement for the year ended 30 June 2014

 

     Notes      2014     2013     2012  
            US$M    

US$M

Restated

   

US$M

Restated

 

Revenue

         

Group production

        64,227        63,067        66,969   

Third party products

     2         2,979        2,886        3,508   
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Revenue

     2         67,206        65,953        70,477   

Other income

     4         1,524        3,947        898   

Expenses excluding net finance costs

     5         (46,513     (50,040     (48,644

Share of operating profit of equity accounted investments

     27         1,195        1,142        1,869   
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Profit from operations

        23,412        21,002        24,600   
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Comprising:

         

Group production

        23,368        20,875        24,466   

Third party products

        44        127        134   
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
        23,412        21,002        24,600   
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Financial expenses

        (1,273     (1,384     (836

Financial income

        97        108        168   
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net finance costs

     6         (1,176     (1,276     (668
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Profit before taxation

        22,236        19,726        23,932   
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income tax expense

        (6,538     (5,714     (7,053

Royalty-related taxation (net of income tax benefit)

        (474     (1,192     (262
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total taxation expense

     7         (7,012     (6,906     (7,315
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Profit after taxation

        15,224        12,820        16,617   
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Attributable to non-controlling interests

        1,392        1,597        1,144   

Attributable to members of BHP Billiton Group

        13,832        11,223        15,473   
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Basic earnings per ordinary share (cents)

     8         260.0        210.9        290.7   

Diluted earnings per ordinary share (cents)

     8         259.1        210.2        289.4   
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Dividends per ordinary share – paid during the period (cents)

     9         118.0        114.0        110.0   

Dividends per ordinary share – determined in respect of the period (cents)

     9         121.0        116.0        112.0   
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The accompanying notes form part of these financial statements.

 

F-1


Table of Contents

7.1.2    Consolidated Statement of Comprehensive Income for the year ended 30 June 2014

 

    Notes     2014     2013     2012  
          US$M    

US$M

Restated

    US$M
Restated
 

Profit after taxation

      15,224        12,820        16,617   

Other comprehensive income

       

Items that may be reclassified subsequently to the income statement:

       

Available for sale investments:

       

Net valuation losses taken to equity

      (15     (101     (32

Net valuation gains transferred to the income statement

      (14     (1     (2

Cash flow hedges:

       

Gains/(losses) taken to equity

      681        223        (320

(Gains)/losses transferred to the income statement

      (678     73        205   

Exchange fluctuations on translation of foreign operations taken to equity

      (1     2        19   

Tax recognised within other comprehensive income

    7        3        (76     23   
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total items that may be reclassified subsequently to the income statement

      (24     120        (107
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Items that will not be reclassified to the income statement:

       

Actuarial gains/(losses) on pension and medical schemes

      57        61        (250

Tax recognised within other comprehensive income

    7        12        (16     66   
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total items that will not be reclassified to the income statement

      69        45        (184
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total other comprehensive income/(loss)

      45        165        (291
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total comprehensive income

      15,269        12,985        16,326   
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Attributable to non-controlling interests

      1,392        1,599        1,146   

Attributable to members of BHP Billiton Group

      13,877        11,386        15,180   
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The accompanying notes form part of these financial statements.

 

F-2


Table of Contents

7.1.3    Consolidated Balance Sheet as at 30 June 2014

 

     Notes      2014     2013  
            US$M    

US$M

Restated

 

ASSETS

       

Current assets

       

Cash and cash equivalents

     23         8,803        5,677   

Trade and other receivables

     10         6,741        6,310   

Other financial assets

     11         87        161   

Inventories

     12         6,013        5,821   

Assets classified as held for sale

     25                286   

Current tax assets

        318        267   

Other

        334        431   
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total current assets

        22,296        18,953   
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Non-current assets

       

Trade and other receivables

     10         1,867        1,998   

Other financial assets

     11         2,349        1,719   

Inventories

     12         463        619   

Property, plant and equipment

     13         108,787        100,565   

Intangible assets

     14         5,439        5,496   

Investments accounted for using the equity method

     27         3,664        3,675   

Deferred tax assets

     7         6,396        6,069   

Other

        152        84   
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total non-current assets

        129,117        120,225   
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total assets

        151,413        139,178   
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

LIABILITIES

       

Current liabilities

       

Trade and other payables

     15         10,145        10,860   

Interest bearing liabilities

     16         4,262        5,088   

Liabilities classified as held for sale

     25                220   

Other financial liabilities

     17         16        210   

Current tax payable

        919        1,158   

Provisions

     18         2,504        2,372   

Deferred income

        218        231   
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total current liabilities

        18,064        20,139   
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Non-current liabilities

       

Trade and other payables

     15         113        286   

Interest bearing liabilities

     16         30,327        28,099   

Other financial liabilities

     17         303        582   

Deferred tax liabilities

     7         7,066        6,312   

Provisions

     18         9,891        8,178   

Deferred income

        267        291   
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total non-current liabilities

        47,967        43,748   
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities

        66,031        63,887   
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net assets

        85,382        75,291   
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

EQUITY

       

Share capital – BHP Billiton Limited

     19         1,186        1,186   

Share capital – BHP Billiton Plc

     19         1,069        1,069   

Treasury shares

     19         (587     (540

Reserves

     20         2,927        1,970   

Retained earnings

     20         74,548        66,982   
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total equity attributable to members of BHP Billiton Group

        79,143        70,667   

Non-controlling interests

     20         6,239        4,624   
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total equity

        85,382        75,291   
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

The accompanying notes form part of these financial statements.

The financial statements were approved by the Board of Directors on 11 September 2014 and signed on its behalf by:

 

Jac Nasser AO

   Andrew Mackenzie

Chairman

   Chief Executive Officer

 

F-3


Table of Contents

7.1.4    Consolidated Cash Flow Statement for the year ended 30 June 2014

 

     Notes      2014     2013     2012  
            US$M    

US$M

Restated

    US$M
Restated
 

Operating activities

         

Profit before taxation

        22,236        19,726        23,932   

Adjustments for:

         

Non-cash or non-operating exceptional items

        (551     1,893        3,417   

Depreciation and amortisation expense

        8,701        7,031        6,431   

Net gain on sale of non-current assets

        (95     (46     (118

Impairments of property, plant and equipment, financial assets and intangibles

        797        330        100   

Employee share awards expense

        247        210        270   

Net finance costs

        1,176        1,276        668   

Share of operating profit of equity accounted investments

        (1,195     (1,142     (1,869

Other

        (83     (21     (376

Changes in assets and liabilities:

         

Trade and other receivables

        (252     1,037        1,755   

Inventories

        (54     (70     16   

Trade and other payables

        77        (767     (187

Net other financial assets and liabilities

        (49     119        (27

Provisions and other liabilities

        429        (783     (1,025
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash generated from operations

        31,384        28,793        32,987   

Dividends received

        34        11        10   

Dividends received from equity accounted investments

        1,250        710        712   

Interest received

        136        140        221   

Interest paid

        (975     (926     (633

Income tax refunded

        852               530   

Income tax paid

        (6,445     (7,618     (7,492

Royalty-related taxation refunded

        216                 

Royalty-related taxation paid

        (1,088     (956     (1,076
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net operating cash flows

        25,364        20,154        25,259   
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Investing activities

         

Purchases of property, plant and equipment

        (15,993     (22,243     (18,637

Exploration expenditure

        (1,010     (1,351     (2,493

Exploration expenditure expensed and included in operating cash flows

        716        1,047        1,644   

Purchase of intangibles

        (192     (400     (219

Investment in financial assets

        (1,193     (475     (471

Investment in subsidiaries, operations and joint operations, net of their cash

                      (12,556

Investment in equity accounted investments

        (44     (84     (83
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash outflows from investing activities

        (17,716     (23,506     (32,815

Proceeds from sale of property, plant and equipment

        114        2,338        146   

Proceeds from financial assets

        956        240        178   

Proceeds from divestment of subsidiaries, operations and joint operations, net of their cash

        812        502        6   

Proceeds from sale or partial sale of equity accounted investments

               1,700          
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net investing cash flows

        (15,834     (18,726     (32,485
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Financing activities

         

Proceeds from interest bearing liabilities

        6,251        9,157        12,817   

Proceeds/(settlements) from debt related instruments

        37        14        (180

Repayment of interest bearing liabilities

        (7,198     (2,014     (3,993

Proceeds from ordinary shares

        14        21        21   

Contributions from non-controlling interests

        1,435        73        101   

Purchase of shares by Employee Share Ownership Plan (ESOP) Trusts

        (368     (445     (424

Share buy-back – BHP Billiton Plc

                      (83

Dividends paid

        (6,387     (6,167     (5,877

Dividends paid to non-controlling interests

        (252     (837     (343
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net financing cash flows

        (6,468     (198     2,039   
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net increase/(decrease) in cash and cash equivalents

        3,062        1,230        (5,187

Cash and cash equivalents, net of overdrafts, at the beginning of the financial year

        5,667        4,454        9,671   

Foreign currency exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents

        23        (17     (30
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash and cash equivalents, net of overdrafts, at the end of the financial year

     23         8,752        5,667        4,454   
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The accompanying notes form part of these financial statements.

 

F-4


Table of Contents

7.1.5    Consolidated Statement of Changes in Equity for the year ended 30 June 2014

 

     Attributable to members of BHP Billiton Group              
     Share capital                                 

US$M

   BHP
Billiton
Limited
     BHP
Billiton

Plc
     Treasury
shares
    Reserves     Retained
earnings
    Total     Non-
controlling
interests
    Total
equity
 

Balance as at 1 July 2013

     1,186         1,069         (540     1,970        66,982        70,667        4,624        75,291   

Total comprehensive income

                            (24     13,901        13,877        1,392        15,269   

Transactions with owners:

                  

Purchase of shares by ESOP Trusts

                     (368                   (368            (368

Employee share awards exercised net of employee contributions

     . –                 321        (221     (91     9               9   

Employee share awards forfeited

                            (32     32                        

Accrued employee entitlement for unexercised awards

                            247               247               247   

Distribution to option holders

                            (2            (2     (2     (4

Dividends

                                   (6,276     (6,276     (252     (6,528

Equity contributed

                            989               989        477        1,466   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance as at 30 June 2014

     1,186         1,069         (587     2,927        74,548        79,143        6,239        85,382   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Restated

                  

Balance as at 1 July 2012

     1,186         1,069         (533     1,912        61,892        65,526        3,789        69,315   

Total comprehensive income

                            77        11,309        11,386        1,599        12,985   

Transactions with owners:

                  

Purchase of shares by ESOP Trusts

                     (445                   (445            (445

Employee share awards exercised net of employee contributions

                     438        (243     (178     17               17   

Employee share awards forfeited

                            (17     17                        

Accrued employee entitlement for unexercised awards

                            210               210               210   

Issue of share options to non-controlling interests

                            49               49               49   

Dividends

                                   (6,076     (6,076     (837     (6,913

Equity contributed

                                                 73        73   

Divestment of equity accounted investment

                            (18     18                        
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance as at 30 June 2013

     1,186         1,069         (540     1,970        66,982        70,667        4,624        75,291   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-5


Table of Contents
     Attributable to members of BHP Billiton Group              
     Share capital                                

US$M

   BHP
Billiton
Limited
     BHP
Billiton

Plc
    Treasury
shares
    Reserves     Retained
earnings
    Total     Non-
controlling
interests
    Total
equity
 

Restated

                 

Balance as at 1 July 2011

     1,183         1,070        (623     2,001        52,731        56,362        2,825        59,187   

Total comprehensive income

                           (163     15,343        15,180        1,146        16,326   

Transactions with owners:

                 

Proceeds from the issue of shares

     3                                     3               3   

BHP Billiton Plc shares cancelled

             (1     83        1        (83                     

Purchase of shares by ESOP Trusts

                    (424                   (424            (424

Employee share awards exercised net of employee contributions

                    431        (189     (213     29               29   

Employee share awards forfeited

                           (8     8                        

Accrued employee entitlement for unexercised awards

                           270               270               270   

Dividends

                                  (5,894     (5,894     (343     (6,237

Equity contributed

                                                161        161   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance as at 30 June 2012

     1,186         1,069        (533     1,912        61,892        65,526        3,789        69,315   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

The accompanying notes form part of these financial statements.

 

F-6


Table of Contents

7.1.6    Notes to Financial Statements

1    Accounting policies

Dual Listed Companies’ structure and basis of preparation of financial statements

Merger terms

On 29 June 2001, BHP Billiton Limited (previously known as BHP Limited), an Australian-listed company, and BHP Billiton Plc (previously known as Billiton Plc), a United Kingdom (UK) listed company, entered into a Dual Listed Company (DLC) merger. This was effected by contractual arrangements between the Companies and amendments to their constitutional documents.

The effect of the DLC merger is that BHP Billiton Limited and its subsidiaries (the BHP Billiton Limited Group) and BHP Billiton Plc and its subsidiaries (the BHP Billiton Plc Group) operate together as a single for-profit economic entity (the Group). Under the arrangements:

 

  the shareholders of BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc have a common economic interest in both Groups;

 

  the shareholders of BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc take key decisions, including the election of Directors, through a joint electoral procedure under which the shareholders of the two Companies effectively vote on a joint basis;

 

  BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc have a common Board of Directors, a unified management structure and joint objectives;

 

  dividends and capital distributions made by the two Companies are equalised;

 

  BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc each executed a deed poll guarantee, guaranteeing (subject to certain exceptions) the contractual obligations (whether actual or contingent, primary or secondary) of the other incurred after 29 June 2001 together with specified obligations existing at that date.

If either BHP Billiton Limited or BHP Billiton Plc proposes to pay a dividend to its shareholders, then the other Company must pay a matching cash dividend of an equivalent amount per share to its shareholders. If either Company is prohibited by law or is otherwise unable to declare, pay or otherwise make all or any portion of such a matching dividend, then BHP Billiton Limited or BHP Billiton Plc will, so far as it is practicable to do so, enter into such transactions with each other as the Boards agree to be necessary or desirable so as to enable both Companies to pay dividends as nearly as practicable at the same time.

The DLC merger did not involve the change of legal ownership of any assets of BHP Billiton Limited or BHP Billiton Plc, any change of ownership of any existing shares or securities of BHP Billiton Limited or BHP Billiton Plc, the issue of any shares or securities or any payment by way of consideration, save for the issue by each Company of one special voting share to a trustee company which is the means by which the joint electoral procedure is operated.

Accounting for the DLC merger

The basis of accounting for the DLC merger was established under Australian and UK Generally Accepted Accounting Practice (GAAP), pursuant to the requirements of the Australian Securities and Investments Commission (ASIC) Practice Note 71 ‘Financial Reporting by Australian Entities in Dual Listed Company Arrangements’, an order issued by ASIC under section 340 of the Corporations Act 2001 on 2 September 2002, and in accordance with the UK Companies Act 1985. In accordance with the transitional provisions of IFRS 1/AASB 1 ‘First-time Adoption of International Financial Reporting Standards’, the same basis of accounting is applied under International Financial Reporting Standards. Accordingly, these financial statements consolidate the Group as follows:

 

  Assets and liabilities of the BHP Billiton Limited Group and the BHP Billiton Plc Group were consolidated at the date of the merger at their existing carrying amounts.

 

F-7


Table of Contents
  Results for the years ended 30 June 2014, 30 June 2013 and 30 June 2012 are of the consolidated entity comprising the BHP Billiton Limited Group and the BHP Billiton Plc Group.

Basis of preparation

This general purpose financial report for the year ended 30 June 2014 has been prepared on a going concern basis and in accordance with the requirements of the Australian Corporations Act 2001, the UK Companies Act 2006 and with:

 

  Australian Accounting Standards, being Australian equivalents to International Financial Reporting Standards and interpretations as issued by the Australian Accounting Standards Board (AASB) effective for the year ended 30 June 2014;

 

  International Financial Reporting Standards and interpretations as adopted by the European Union (EU) effective as of 30 June 2014;

 

  International Financial Reporting Standards and interpretations as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board effective as of 30 June 2014.

The above accounting standards and interpretations are collectively referred to as ‘IFRS’ in this report.

The principal accounting standards or interpretations that have been adopted for the first time in these financial statements are:

 

  IFRS 10/AASB 10 ‘Consolidated Financial Statements’ which is a replacement of IAS 27/AASB 127 ‘Consolidated and Separate Financial Statements’;

 

  IFRS 11/AASB 11 ‘Joint Arrangements’ which is a replacement of IAS 31 ‘Joint Ventures’;

 

  IFRIC 20 ‘Stripping Costs in the Production Phase of a Surface Mine’;

 

  IFRS 13/AASB 13 ‘Fair Value Measurement’; and

 

  Amendments to IAS 19/AASB 119 ‘Employee Benefits’.

In addition, the Group has early-adopted amendments to IAS 36/AASB 136 ‘Impairment of Assets’. The amendment has been adopted early in conjunction with the initial adoption of IFRS 13 ‘Fair Value Measurement’, as it reverses the unintended requirement in that standard to disclose the recoverable amount of every cash-generating unit to which significant goodwill has been allocated. Under the amendment, the recoverable amount of cash-generating units to which significant goodwill has been allocated is required to be disclosed only when an impairment loss has been recognised or reversed.

The Group has also changed its Exploration and Evaluation Expenditure policy from 1 July 2013 such that all acquisitions of exploration leases are classified as intangible exploration assets or tangible exploration assets based on the nature of the assets acquired.

The impact of the above changes on the financial statements is described in detail in note 37 ‘Impact of new accounting standards and change in accounting policies’.

The following new accounting standard and interpretation are not yet effective but may have an impact on the Group in financial years commencing from 1 July 2014:

 

  Amendments to IAS 32/AASB 132 ‘Financial Instruments: Presentation’ clarify the criteria for offsetting financial assets and liabilities.

 

  IFRIC 21 ‘Levies’ confirms that a liability to pay a levy is only recognised when the activity that triggers the payment occurs.

 

F-8


Table of Contents

The Group is currently in the process of determining the potential impact of adopting the above standard and interpretation. The standard and interpretation are available for early adoption in the 30 June 2014 financial year as permitted by the Australian Corporations Act 2001, but have not been applied in the preparation of these financial statements. Both the standard and interpretation have been endorsed by the EU and hence are available for early adoption in the EU.

The following new accounting standards are not yet effective but may have an impact on the Group in financial years commencing from 1 July 2015 or later:

 

  IFRS 15/AASB 15 ‘Revenue from Contracts with Customers’ which modifies the determination of when to recognise revenue and how much revenue to recognise. The core principle is that an entity recognises revenue to depict the transfer of promised goods and services to the customer of an amount that reflects the consideration to which the entity expects to be entitled in exchange for those goods or services.

 

  IFRS 9/AASB 9 ‘Financial Instruments’ modifies the classification and measurement of financial assets. It includes a single, principles-based approach for the classification of financial assets, which is driven by cash flow characteristics and the business model in which an asset is held. It also introduces a new expected loss impairment model requiring expected losses to be recognised when financial instruments are first recognised. The new standard also modifies hedge accounting to align the accounting treatment with risk management practices of an entity.

The Group is currently in the process of determining the potential impact of adopting the above standards. These standards have not been applied in the preparation of these financial statements. Neither of these standards have been endorsed by the EU or issued by the AASB and hence are not available for early adoption in the EU or under the Australian Corporations Act 2001.

Basis of measurement

The financial statements are drawn up on the basis of historical cost principles, except for derivative financial instruments and certain other financial assets, which are carried at fair value.

Rounding of amounts

Amounts in these financial statements have, unless otherwise indicated, been rounded to the nearest million dollars.

Currency of presentation

All amounts are expressed in millions of US dollars, unless otherwise stated, consistent with the predominant functional currency of the Group’s operations.

Consistent application of accounting policies

The accounting policies have been consistently applied by all entities included in the Group consolidated financial statements and are consistent with those applied in all prior years presented.

Comparatives

Where applicable, comparatives have been adjusted to measure or present them on the same basis as current period figures.

Principles of consolidation

The financial statements of the Group include the consolidation of BHP Billiton Limited, BHP Billiton Plc and their respective subsidiaries. Subsidiaries are entities controlled by either parent entity. Control exists where

 

F-9


Table of Contents

either parent entity is exposed, or has rights to, variable returns from its involvement with the subsidiary and has the ability to affect those returns through its power over the subsidiary. A parent entity has power over the subsidiary, when it has existing rights to direct the relevant activities of the subsidiary. The relevant activities are those which significantly affect the subsidiary’s returns. The ability to approve the operating and capital budget of a subsidiary and the ability to appoint key management personnel are decisions that demonstrate that the Group has the existing rights to direct the relevant activities of a subsidiary. Subsidiaries are included in the consolidated financial report from the date control commences until the date control ceases. Where the Group’s interest is less than 100 per cent, the interest attributable to outside shareholders is reflected in non-controlling interests. The effects of all transactions between entities within the Group have been eliminated.

Joint arrangements

The Group undertakes a number of business activities through joint arrangements. Joint arrangements exist when two or more parties have joint control. Joint control is the contractually agreed sharing of control of an arrangement, which exists only when decisions about the relevant activities require the unanimous consent of the parties sharing control. The Group’s joint arrangements are of two types:

Joint operations

Joint operations are joint arrangements in which the parties with joint control have rights to the assets and obligations for the liabilities relating to the arrangement. The activities of a joint operation are primarily designed for the provision of output to the parties to the arrangement, indicating that:

 

  the parties have the rights to substantially all the economic benefits of the assets of the arrangement; and

 

  all liabilities are satisfied by the joint participants through their purchases of that output. This indicates that, in substance, the joint participants have an obligation for the liabilities of the arrangement.

The financial statements of the Group include its share of the assets in joint operations, together with its share of the liabilities, revenues and expenses arising jointly or otherwise from those operations and its revenue derived from the sale of its share of output from the joint operation. All such amounts are measured in accordance with the terms of each arrangement, which are usually in proportion to the Group’s interest in the joint operation.

Joint ventures

Joint ventures are joint arrangements in which the parties with joint control of the arrangement have rights to the net assets of the arrangement. A separate vehicle, not the parties, will have the rights to the assets and obligations to the liabilities, relating to the arrangement. More than an insignificant share of output from a joint venture is sold to third parties which indicates that the joint venture is not dependent on the parties to the arrangement for funding and that the parties to the arrangement have no obligation for the liabilities of the arrangement.

Joint ventures are accounted for using the equity method. Under the equity method the joint venture is recorded initially at cost to the Group, including the value of any goodwill on acquisition. In subsequent periods, the carrying amount of the joint venture is adjusted to reflect the Group’s share of its post-acquisition profit or loss and other comprehensive income. After application of the equity method, including recognising the Group’s share of the joint ventures’ results, the value of the investment will be assessed for impairment if there is objective evidence that an impairment of the investment may have occurred. Where the Group’s investment in a joint venture is nil after having applied equity accounting principles (and the Group has no legal or constructive obligation to make further payments, nor has made payments on behalf of the joint venture), dividends received from the joint venture will be recognised in the Group’s result as a ‘Share of operating profit of equity accounted investments’.

 

F-10


Table of Contents

Associates

Associates are entities in which the Group holds significant influence. Significant influence is the power to participate in the financial and operating policy decisions of an entity but is not control or joint control. If the Group holds 20 per cent or more of the voting power of an entity, it is presumed that the Group has significant influence, unless it can be clearly demonstrated that this is not the case. Significant influence can also arise when the Group has less than 20 per cent of voting power but it can be demonstrated that the Group has the power to participate in the financial and operating policy decisions of the associate.

Investments in associates are accounted for using the equity method as described above. The Group uses the term ‘equity accounted investments’ to refer to associates and joint ventures collectively.

Business combinations

Business combinations that occurred between 1 July 2004 and 30 June 2009 were accounted for by applying the purchase method of accounting, whereby the purchase consideration of the combination is allocated to the identifiable net assets acquired. Business combinations prior to 1 July 2004 have been accounted for in accordance with the Group’s previous policies under Australian GAAP and UK GAAP and have not been restated.

Business combinations undertaken from 1 July 2010 are accounted for by applying the acquisition method of accounting, whereby the identifiable assets, liabilities and contingent liabilities (identifiable net assets) are measured on the basis of fair value at the date of acquisition.

Goodwill

Where the fair value of consideration paid for a business combination exceeds the fair value of the Group’s share of the identifiable net assets acquired, the difference is treated as purchased goodwill. Where the fair value of the Group’s share of the identifiable net assets acquired exceeds the cost of acquisition, the difference is immediately recognised in the income statement. The recognition and measurement of goodwill attributable to a non-controlling interest in a business combination is determined on a transaction by transaction basis. Goodwill is not amortised, however, its carrying amount is assessed annually against its recoverable amount as explained below under ‘Impairment and reversal of impairment of non-current assets’. On the subsequent disposal or termination of a previously acquired business, any remaining balance of associated goodwill is included in the determination of the profit or loss on disposal or termination.

Intangible assets

Amounts paid for the acquisition of identifiable intangible assets, such as software and licences, are capitalised at the fair value of consideration paid and are recorded at cost less accumulated amortisation and impairment charges. Identifiable intangible assets with a finite life are amortised on a straight-line basis over their expected useful life, which is typically no greater than eight years. The Group has no identifiable intangible assets for which the expected useful life is indefinite.

Foreign currencies

The Group’s reporting currency and the functional currency of the majority of its operations is the US dollar as this is assessed to be the principal currency of the economic environments in which they operate.

Transactions denominated in foreign currencies (currencies other than the functional currency of an operation) are recorded using the exchange rate ruling at the date of the underlying transaction. Monetary assets and liabilities denominated in foreign currencies are translated using the rate of exchange prevailing at year-end and

 

F-11


Table of Contents

the gains or losses on retranslation are included in the income statement, with the exception of foreign exchange gains or losses on foreign currency provisions for site closure and rehabilitation, which are capitalised in property, plant and equipment for operating sites.

Exchange variations resulting from the retranslation at closing rate of the net investment in each subsidiary, joint arrangement and associate, arising after 1 July 2004, are accounted for in accordance with the policy stated below. Exchange variations arising before this date were transferred to retained earnings on 1 July 2004, being the date of transition to IFRS.

Subsidiaries, joint arrangements and associates that have functional currencies other than US dollars are foreign operations and translate their income statement items to US dollars using the exchange rate prevailing at the date of each transaction. Assets and liabilities are translated using exchange rates prevailing at year-end. Exchange variations resulting from the retranslation at closing rate of the net investment in foreign operations, together with differences between their income statement items translated at actual and closing rates, are recognised in the foreign currency translation reserve. For the purpose of foreign currency translation, the net investment in a foreign operation is determined inclusive of foreign currency intercompany balances for which settlement is neither planned nor likely to occur in the foreseeable future. The balance of the foreign currency translation reserve relating to a foreign operation that is disposed of, or partially disposed of, is recognised in the income statement at the time of disposal.

Share-based payments

The fair value at grant date of equity-settled share awards is charged to the income statement over the period for which the benefits of employee services are expected to be derived. The corresponding accrued employee entitlement is recorded in the employee share awards reserve. The fair value of awards is calculated using an option pricing model which considers the following factors:

 

  exercise price;

 

  expected life of the award;

 

  current market price of the underlying shares;

 

  expected volatility;

 

  expected dividends;

 

  risk-free interest rate;

 

  market-based performance hurdles;

 

  non-vesting conditions.

Where awards are forfeited because non-market based vesting conditions are not satisfied, the expense previously recognised is proportionately reversed. Where shares in BHP Billiton Limited or BHP Billiton Plc are acquired by on-market purchases prior to settling vested entitlements, the cost of the acquired shares is carried as treasury shares and deducted from equity. Where awards are satisfied by delivery of acquired shares, any difference between their acquisition cost and the remuneration expense recognised is charged directly to retained earnings. The tax effect of awards granted is recognised in income tax expense, except to the extent that the total tax deductions are expected to exceed the cumulative remuneration expense. In this situation, the excess of the associated current or deferred tax is recognised in other comprehensive income and forms part of the employee share awards reserve.

 

F-12


Table of Contents

Sales revenue

Revenue from the sale of goods and disposal of other assets is recognised when persuasive evidence (usually in the form of an executed sales agreement) of an arrangement exists and;

 

  there has been a transfer of risks and rewards to the customer;

 

  no further work or processing is required by the Group;

 

  the quantity and quality of the goods has been determined with reasonable accuracy;

 

  the price is fixed or determinable;

 

  collectability is reasonably assured.

Revenue is therefore generally recognised when title passes. In the majority of sales for most commodities, sales agreements specify that title passes on the bill of lading date, which is the date the commodity is delivered to the shipping agent. For these sales, revenue is recognised on the bill of lading date. For certain sales (principally coal sales to adjoining power stations and diamond sales), title passes and revenue is recognised when the goods have been delivered.

In cases where the terms of the executed sales agreement allow for an adjustment to the sales price based on a survey of the goods by the customer (for instance an assay for mineral content), recognition of the sales revenue is based on the most recently determined estimate of product specifications.

For certain commodities, the sales price is determined on a provisional basis at the date of sale and adjustments to the sales price subsequently occurs based on movements in quoted market or contractual prices up to the date of final pricing. The period between provisional invoicing and final pricing is typically between 60 and 120 days. Revenue on provisionally priced sales is recognised based on the estimated fair value of the total consideration receivable. The revenue adjustment mechanism embedded within provisionally priced sales arrangements has the character of a commodity derivative. Accordingly, the fair value of the final sales price adjustment is re-estimated continuously and changes in fair value are recognised as an adjustment to revenue. In all cases, fair value is estimated by reference to forward market prices.

Revenue is not reduced for royalties and other taxes payable from the Group’s production.

The Group separately discloses sales of Group production from sales of third party products because of the significant difference in profit margin earned on these sales.

Exploration and evaluation expenditure

Exploration and evaluation activity involves the search for mineral and petroleum resources, the determination of technical feasibility and the assessment of commercial viability of an identified resource. Exploration and evaluation activity includes:

 

  researching and analysing historical exploration data;

 

  gathering exploration data through topographical, geochemical and geophysical studies;

 

  exploratory drilling, trenching and sampling;

 

  determining and examining the volume and grade of the resource;

 

  surveying transportation and infrastructure requirements;

 

  conducting market and finance studies.

Administration costs that are not directly attributable to a specific exploration area are charged to the income statement. Initial payments for the acquisition of intangible lease assets are capitalised and amortised over the term of the permit.

 

F-13


Table of Contents

Exploration and evaluation expenditure (including amortisation of capitalised licence and lease costs) is charged to the income statement as incurred except in the following circumstances, in which case the expenditure may be capitalised:

 

  In respect of minerals activities:

 

    The exploration and evaluation activity is within an area of interest which was previously acquired as an asset acquisition or in a business combination and measured at fair value on acquisition; or

 

    The existence of a commercially viable mineral deposit has been established.

 

  In respect of petroleum activities:

 

    The exploration and evaluation activity is within an area of interest for which it is expected that the expenditure will be recouped by future exploitation or sale; or

 

    Exploration and evaluation activity has not reached a stage which permits a reasonable assessment of the existence of commercially recoverable reserves.

Capitalised exploration and evaluation expenditure considered to be a tangible asset is recorded as a component of property, plant and equipment at cost less impairment charges. Otherwise, it is recorded as an intangible asset (such as certain licence and lease arrangements). In determining whether the purchase of an exploration licence or lease is an intangible asset or a component of property, plant and equipment, consideration is given to the substance of the item acquired not its legal form. Licences or leases purchased which allow exploration over an extended period of time meet the definition of an intangible exploration lease asset where they cannot be reasonably associated with a known resource (minerals) or reserves (petroleum). All capitalised exploration and evaluation expenditure is monitored for indications of impairment. When a potential impairment is indicated, assessment is performed for each area of interest in conjunction with the group of operating assets (representing a cash-generating unit) to which the exploration is attributed. Exploration areas in which reserves have been discovered but require major capital expenditure before production can begin, are continually evaluated to ensure that commercial quantities of reserves exist or to ensure that additional exploration work is under way or planned. To the extent that capitalised expenditure is no longer expected to be recovered, it is charged to the income statement.

Development expenditure

When proved reserves are determined and development is sanctioned, capitalised exploration and evaluation expenditure is reclassified as assets under construction, and is disclosed as a component of property, plant and equipment. All subsequent development expenditure is capitalised and classified as assets under construction, provided commercial viability conditions continue to be satisfied. Development expenditure is net of proceeds from the sale of ore extracted during the development phase. On completion of development, all assets included in assets under construction are reclassified as either plant and equipment or other mineral assets.

Property, plant and equipment

Property, plant and equipment is recorded at cost less accumulated depreciation and impairment charges. Cost is the fair value of consideration given to acquire the asset at the time of its acquisition or construction and includes the direct cost of bringing the asset to the location and condition necessary for operation and the estimated future cost of closure and rehabilitation of the facility.

Other mineral assets

Other mineral assets comprise:

 

  capitalised exploration, evaluation and development expenditure (including development stripping) for properties now in production;

 

F-14


Table of Contents
  mineral rights and petroleum interests acquired;

 

  capitalised production stripping (as described below in ‘Overburden removal costs’).

Depreciation of property, plant and equipment

The carrying amounts of property, plant and equipment are depreciated to their estimated residual value over the estimated useful lives of the specific assets concerned, or the estimated life of the associated mine, field or lease, if shorter. Estimates of residual values and useful lives are reassessed annually and any change in estimate is taken into account in the determination of remaining depreciation charges. Depreciation commences on the date of commissioning. The major categories of property, plant and equipment are depreciated on a unit of production and/or straight-line basis using estimated lives indicated below. However, where assets are dedicated to a mine, field or lease and are not readily transferable, the below useful lives are subject to the lesser of the asset category’s useful life and the life of the mine, field or lease:

 

•       Buildings

          25 to 50 years

•       Land

          not depreciated

•       Plant and equipment

          3 to 30 years straight-line

•       Mineral rights and petroleum interests

          based on reserves on a unit of production basis

•       Capitalised exploration, evaluation and development  expenditure

          based on reserves on a unit of production basis

Leased assets

Assets held under lease, which result in the Group receiving substantially all the risks and rewards of ownership of the asset (finance leases), are capitalised at the lower of the fair value of the property, plant and equipment or the estimated present value of the minimum lease payments.

The corresponding finance lease obligation is included within interest bearing liabilities. The interest component is charged to financial expenses over the lease term to reflect a constant rate of interest on the remaining balance of the obligation.

Operating lease assets are not capitalised and rental payments are included in the income statement on a straight-line basis over the lease term. Provision is made for the present value of future operating lease payments in relation to surplus lease space, when it is first determined that the space will be of no probable future benefit. Operating lease incentives are recognised as a liability when received and subsequently reduced by allocating lease payments between rental expense and reduction of the liability.

Impairment and reversal of impairment of non-current assets

Formal impairment tests are carried out annually for goodwill. In addition, formal impairment tests for all assets are performed when there is an indication of impairment. The Group conducts an internal review of asset values annually, which is used as a source of information to assess for any indications of impairment or reversal of previously recognised impairment losses. External factors, such as changes in expected future prices, costs and other market factors, are also monitored to assess for indications of impairment or reversal of previously recognised impairment losses. If any such indication exists, an estimate of the asset’s recoverable amount is calculated, being the higher of fair value less direct costs of disposal and the asset’s value in use.

If the carrying amount of the asset exceeds its recoverable amount, the asset is impaired and an impairment loss is charged to the income statement so as to reduce the carrying amount in the balance sheet to its recoverable

 

F-15


Table of Contents

amount. A reversal of a previously recognised impairment loss is limited to the lesser of the amount that would not cause the carrying amount to exceed (a) its recoverable amount; or (b) the carrying amount that would have been determined (net of depreciation) had no impairment loss been recognised for the asset or cash-generating unit.

Fair value is determined as the amount that would be obtained from the sale of the asset in an orderly transaction between market participants. Fair value for mineral assets is generally determined as the present value of the estimated future cash flows expected to arise from the continued use of the asset, including any expansion prospects, and its eventual disposal, using assumptions that an independent market participant may take into account. These cash flows are discounted at an appropriate rate to arrive at a net present value of the asset.

Value in use is determined as the present value of the estimated future cash flows expected to arise from the continued use of the asset in its present form and its eventual disposal. Value in use is determined by applying assumptions specific to the Group’s continued use and cannot take into account future development. These assumptions are different to those used in calculating fair value and consequently the value in use calculation is likely to give a different result (usually lower) to a fair value calculation.

In testing for indications of impairment and performing impairment calculations, assets are considered as collective groups and referred to as cash-generating units. Cash-generating units are the smallest identifiable group of assets, liabilities and associated goodwill that generate cash inflows that are largely independent of the cash inflows from other assets or groups of assets.

The impairment assessments are based on a range of estimates and assumptions, including:

 

Estimates/assumptions:   Basis:

•       Future production

  •     proved and probable reserves, resource estimates and, in  certain cases, expansion projects

•       Commodity prices

    forward market and contract prices, and longer-term price  protocol estimates

•       Exchange rates

    current (forward) market exchange rates

•       Discount rates

    cost of capital risk-adjusted appropriate to the resource

Overburden removal costs

The process of removing overburden and other mine waste materials to access mineral deposits is referred to as stripping. In open-pit mining, stripping costs are accounted for separately for each component of an ore body. A component is a specific section within an ore body that is made more accessible by the stripping activity. The identification of components is dependent on the mine plan and will often comprise a separate pushback or phase identified in the plan.

There are two types of stripping activity:

 

  Development stripping is the initial overburden removal during the development phase to obtain access to a mineral deposit that will be commercially produced.

 

  Production stripping is the interburden removal during the normal course of production activity. Production stripping commences after the first saleable minerals have been extracted from the component.

Development stripping costs are capitalised as a development stripping asset when:

 

  It is probable that future economic benefits associated with the asset will flow to the entity; and

 

  The costs can be measured reliably.

 

F-16


Table of Contents

Production stripping can give rise to two benefits being the extraction of ore in the current period and improved access to the ore body component in future periods. To the extent that the benefit is the extraction of ore the stripping costs are recognised as an inventory cost. To the extent the benefit is improved access to future ore, the stripping costs are recognised as a production stripping asset if the following criteria are met:

 

  It is probable that the future economic benefit (improved access to ore) will flow to the entity;

 

  The component of the ore body for which access has been improved can be identified; and

 

  The costs relating to the stripping activity can be measured reliably.

Production stripping costs are allocated between the inventory produced and the production stripping asset using a life-of- component waste to ore (or mineral contained) strip ratio. When the current strip ratio is greater than the life-of-component ratio a portion of the stripping costs is capitalised to the production stripping asset.

The development and production stripping assets are depreciated on a units of production basis based on the proven and probable reserves of the relevant components. Stripping assets are classified as other mineral assets in property, plant and equipment.

Inventories

Inventories, including work in progress, are valued at the lower of cost and net realisable value. Cost is determined primarily on the basis of average costs. For processed inventories, cost is derived on an absorption costing basis. Cost comprises cost of purchasing raw materials and cost of production, including attributable mining and manufacturing overheads. In respect of minerals inventory, quantities are assessed primarily through surveys and assays. In respect of petroleum inventory, quantities are derived through flow rate or tank volume measurement; volume calculation and composition is derived via sample analysis.

Finance costs

Finance costs are expensed as incurred except where they relate to the financing of construction or development of qualifying assets requiring a substantial period of time to prepare for their intended future use, in which case finance costs are capitalised up to the date when the asset is ready for its intended use. The amount of finance costs capitalised (before the effects of income tax) for the period is determined by applying the interest rate applicable to appropriate borrowings outstanding during the period, to the average amount of capitalised expenditure for the qualifying assets during the period.

Taxation

Taxation on the profit or loss for the year comprises current and deferred tax. Taxation is recognised in the income statement except to the extent that it relates to items recognised directly in equity, in which case the tax is recognised in equity.

Current tax is the expected tax payable on the taxable income for the year using rates enacted or substantively enacted at period end, and includes any adjustment to tax payable in respect of previous years.

Deferred tax is provided using the balance sheet liability method, providing for the tax effect of temporary differences between the carrying amount of assets and liabilities for financial reporting purposes and the amounts used for tax assessment or deduction purposes. Where an asset has no deductible or depreciable amount for income tax purposes, but has a deductible amount on sale or abandonment for capital gains tax purposes, that amount is included in the determination of temporary differences. The tax effect of certain temporary differences is not recognised, principally with respect to: goodwill; temporary differences arising on the initial recognition of assets or liabilities (other than those arising in a business combination or in a manner that initially impacted

 

F-17


Table of Contents

accounting or taxable profit); and temporary differences relating to investments in subsidiaries, joint ventures and associates to the extent that the Group is able to control the reversal of the temporary difference and it is probable that the temporary difference will not reverse in the foreseeable future. The amount of deferred tax recognised is based on the expected manner and timing of realisation or settlement of the carrying amount of assets and liabilities, with the exception of items that have a tax base solely derived under capital gains tax legislation, using tax rates enacted or substantively enacted at period end. To the extent that an item’s tax base is solely derived from the amount deductible under capital gains tax legislation, deferred tax is determined as if such amounts are deductible in determining future assessable income.

A deferred tax asset is recognised only to the extent that it is probable that future taxable profits will be available against which the asset can be utilised. Deferred tax assets are reviewed at each balance sheet date and amended to the extent that it is no longer probable that the related tax benefit will be realised. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are offset when they relate to income taxes levied by the same taxation authority and the Group has both the right and the intention to settle its current tax assets and liabilities on a net or simultaneous basis.

Royalties and resource rent taxes are treated as taxation arrangements when they have the characteristics of a tax. This is considered to be the case when they are imposed under government authority and the amount payable is calculated by reference to revenue derived (net of any allowable deductions) after adjustment for temporary differences. For such arrangements, current and deferred tax is provided on the same basis as described above for other forms of taxation. Obligations arising from royalty arrangements that do not satisfy these criteria are recognised as current provisions and included in expenses.

Provision for employee benefits

Provision is made in the financial statements for all employee benefits, including on costs. In relation to industry-based long service leave funds, the Group’s liability, including obligations for funding shortfalls, is determined after deducting the fair value of dedicated assets of such funds.

Liabilities for unpaid wages and salaries are recognised in sundry creditors. Current entitlements to annual leave and accumulating sick leave accrued for services up to the reporting date are recognised in provision for employee benefits and are measured at the amounts expected to be paid. Entitlements to non-accumulating sick leave are recognised when the leave is taken.

The current liability for long service leave (for which settlement within 12 months of the reporting date cannot be deferred) is recognised in the current provision for employee benefits and is measured in accordance with annual leave described above. The non-current liability for long service leave is recognised in the non-current provision for employee benefits and measured as the present value of expected future payments to be made in respect of services provided by employees up to the reporting date. Consideration is given to expected future wage and salary levels, experience of employee departures and periods of service. Expected future payments are discounted using market yields at the reporting date on national government bonds with terms to maturity and currency that match, as closely as possible, the estimated future cash outflows.

Superannuation, pensions and other post-retirement benefits

The Group operates or participates in a number of pension (including superannuation) schemes throughout the world. The funding of the schemes complies with local regulations. The assets of the schemes are generally held separately from those of the Group and are administered by trustees or management boards.

For defined contribution schemes or schemes operated on an industry-wide basis where it is not possible to identify assets attributable to the participation by the Group’s employees, the pension charge is calculated on the basis of contributions payable.

 

F-18


Table of Contents

For defined benefit schemes, the cost of providing pensions is charged to the income statement so as to recognise current and past service costs, interest cost on defined benefit obligations, and the effect of any curtailments or settlements, net of returns on plan assets. Actuarial gains and losses are recognised directly in equity. An asset or liability is consequently recognised in the balance sheet based on the present value of defined benefit obligations less the fair value of plan assets, except that any such asset cannot exceed the present value of expected refunds from and reductions in future contributions to the plan. Defined benefit obligations are estimated by discounting expected future payments using market yields at the reporting date on high-quality corporate bonds in countries that have developed corporate bond markets. However, where developed corporate bond markets do not exist, the discount rates are selected by reference to national government bonds. In both instances, the bonds are selected with terms to maturity and currency that match, as closely as possible, the estimated future cash flows.

Certain Group companies provide post-retirement medical benefits to qualifying retirees. In some cases the benefits are provided through medical care schemes to which the Group, the employees, the retirees and covered family members contribute. In some schemes there is no funding of the benefits before retirement. These schemes are recognised on the same basis as described above for defined benefit pension schemes.

Closure and rehabilitation

The mining, extraction and processing activities of the Group normally give rise to obligations for site closure or rehabilitation. Closure and rehabilitation works can include facility decommissioning and dismantling; removal or treatment of waste materials; site and land rehabilitation. The extent of work required and the associated costs are dependent on the requirements of relevant authorities and the Group’s environmental policies.

Provisions for the cost of each closure and rehabilitation program are recognised at the time that environmental disturbance occurs. When the extent of disturbance increases over the life of an operation, the provision is increased accordingly. Costs included in the provision encompass all closure and rehabilitation activity expected to occur progressively over the life of the operation and at or after the time of closure, for disturbance existing at the reporting date. Routine operating costs that may impact the ultimate closure and rehabilitation activities, such as waste material handling conducted as an integral part of a mining or production process, are not included in the provision. Costs arising from unforeseen circumstances, such as the contamination caused by unplanned discharges, are recognised as an expense and liability when the event gives rise to an obligation which is probable and capable of reliable estimation.

The timing of the actual closure and rehabilitation expenditure is dependent upon a number of factors such as the life and nature of the asset, the operating licence conditions, the principles of Our BHP Billiton Charter and the environment in which the mine operates. Expenditure may occur before and after closure and can continue for an extended period of time dependent on closure and rehabilitation requirements. The majority of the expenditure is expected to be paid over periods of up to 50 years with some payments into perpetuity.

Closure and rehabilitation provisions are measured at the expected value of future cash flows, discounted to their present value and determined according to the probability of alternative estimates of cash flows occurring for each operation. Discount rates used are specific to the country in which the operation is located. Significant judgements and estimates are involved in forming expectations of future activities and the amount and timing of the associated cash flows. Those expectations are formed based on existing environmental and regulatory requirements or, if more stringent, Group environmental policies which give rise to a constructive obligation.

When provisions for closure and rehabilitation are initially recognised, the corresponding cost is capitalised as an asset, representing part of the cost of acquiring the future economic benefits of the operation. The capitalised cost of closure and rehabilitation activities is recognised in property, plant and equipment and depreciated accordingly. The value of the provision is progressively increased over time as the effect of discounting unwinds, creating an expense recognised in financial expenses.

 

F-19


Table of Contents

Closure and rehabilitation provisions are also adjusted for changes in estimates. Those adjustments are accounted for as a change in the corresponding capitalised cost, except where a reduction in the provision is greater than the undepreciated capitalised cost of the related assets, in which case the capitalised cost is reduced to nil and the remaining adjustment is recognised in the income statement. In the case of closed sites, changes to estimated costs are recognised immediately in the income statement. Changes to the capitalised cost result in an adjustment to future depreciation. Adjustments to the estimated amount and timing of future closure and rehabilitation cash flows are a normal occurrence in light of the significant judgements and estimates involved. Factors influencing those changes include:

 

  revisions to estimated reserves, resources and lives of operations;

 

  developments in technology;

 

  regulatory requirements and environmental management strategies;

 

  changes in the estimated extent and costs of anticipated activities, including the effects of inflation and movements in foreign exchange rates;

 

  movements in interest rates affecting the discount rate applied.

Financial instruments

All financial assets are initially recognised at the fair value of consideration paid. Subsequently, financial assets are carried at fair value or amortised cost less impairment. Where non-derivative financial assets are carried at fair value, gains and losses on remeasurement are recognised directly in equity unless the financial assets have been designated as being held at fair value through profit or loss, in which case the gains and losses are recognised directly in the income statement. Financial assets are designated as being held at fair value through profit or loss where this is necessary to reduce measurement inconsistencies for related assets and liabilities. All financial liabilities other than derivatives are initially recognised at fair value of consideration received net of transaction costs as appropriate (initial cost) and, with the exception of financial liabilities which have been designated in fair value hedging relationships, are subsequently carried at amortised cost.

Derivatives, including those embedded in other contractual arrangements but separated for accounting purposes because they are not clearly and closely related to the host contract, are initially recognised at fair value on the date the contract is entered into and are subsequently remeasured at their fair value. The method of recognising the resulting gain or loss on remeasurement depends on whether the derivative is designated as a hedging instrument, and, if so, the nature of the item being hedged. The measurement of fair value is based on quoted market prices. Where no price information is available from a quoted market source, alternative market mechanisms or recent comparable transactions, fair value is estimated based on the Group’s views on relevant future prices, net of valuation allowances to accommodate liquidity, modelling credit and other risks implicit in such estimates.

Forward exchange contracts and interest rate swaps held for hedging purposes are accounted for as either cash flow or fair value hedges. Derivatives embedded within other contractual arrangements and the majority of commodity-based transactions executed through derivative contracts do not qualify for hedge accounting.

Fair value hedges

Changes in the fair value of derivatives that are designated and qualify as fair value hedges are recorded in the income statement, together with any changes in the fair value of the hedged asset or liability that are attributable to the hedged risk. Any difference between the change in fair value of the derivative and the hedged risk constitutes ineffectiveness of the hedge and is recognised immediately in the income statement.

 

F-20


Table of Contents

Cash flow hedges

The effective portion of changes in the fair value of derivatives that are designated and qualify as cash flow hedges is recognised in equity in the hedging reserve. The gain or loss relating to the ineffective portion is recognised immediately in the income statement.

Amounts accumulated in equity are recycled to the income statement in the periods when the hedged item affects profit or loss. However, when the forecast transaction that is hedged results in the recognition of a non-financial asset (for example, plant and equipment purchases) or a non-financial liability, the gains and losses previously deferred in equity are transferred from equity and included in the measurement of the initial carrying amount of the asset or liability.

When a hedging instrument expires or is sold or terminated, or when a hedge ceases to meet the criteria for hedge accounting, any cumulative gain or loss existing in equity at that time remains in equity and is recognised when the forecast transaction is ultimately recognised in the income statement. When a hedged forecast transaction is no longer expected to occur, the cumulative hedge gain or loss that was reported in equity is immediately transferred to the income statement.

Derivatives that do not qualify for hedge accounting

Certain derivative instruments do not qualify for hedge accounting. Changes in the fair value of any derivative instrument that does not qualify for hedge accounting are recognised immediately in the income statement.

Available for sale and trading investments

Available for sale and trading investments are measured at fair value. Gains and losses on the remeasurement of trading investments are recognised directly in the income statement. Gains and losses on the remeasurement of available for sale investments are recognised directly in equity and subsequently recognised in the income statement when realised by sale or redemption, or when a reduction in fair value is judged to represent an impairment.

Application of critical accounting policies and estimates

The preparation of the consolidated financial statements requires management to make judgements and estimates and form assumptions that affect the amounts of assets, liabilities, contingent liabilities, revenues and expenses reported in the financial statements. On an ongoing basis, management evaluates its judgements and estimates in relation to assets, liabilities, contingent liabilities, revenue and expenses. Management bases its judgements and estimates on historical experience and on other factors it believes to be reasonable under the circumstances, the results of which form the basis of the reported amounts that are not readily apparent from other sources. Actual results may differ from these estimates under different assumptions and conditions.

The Group has identified the following critical accounting policies under which significant judgements, estimates and assumptions are made and where actual results may differ from these estimates under different assumptions and conditions and may materially affect financial results or the financial position reported in future periods.

Further details of the nature of these assumptions and conditions may be found in the relevant notes to the financial statements.

Reserve estimates

Reserves are estimates of the amount of product that can be economically and legally extracted from the Group’s properties. In order to estimate reserves, estimates are required for a range of geological, technical and economic factors, including quantities, grades, production techniques, recovery rates, production costs, transport costs, commodity demand, commodity prices and exchange rates.

 

F-21


Table of Contents

Estimating the quantity and/or grade of reserves requires the size, shape and depth of ore bodies or fields to be determined by analysing geological data such as drilling samples. This process may require complex and difficult geological judgements to interpret the data.

The Group determines and reports ore reserves in Australia and the United Kingdom under the principles incorporated in the Australasian Code for Reporting Exploration Results of Mineral Resources and Ore Reserves December 2012 known as the JORC Code, and the Australian Securities Exchange (ASX) Listing Rules 2012 for minerals. The JORC Code requires the use of reasonable investment assumptions when reporting reserves. As a result, management will form a view of forecast sales prices, based on current and long-term historical average price trends. For example, if current prices remain above long-term historical averages for an extended period of time, management may assume that lower prices will prevail in the future and as a result, those lower prices are used to estimate reserves under the JORC Code. Lower price assumptions generally result in lower estimates of reserves.

Reserve reporting requirements for SEC (United States of America) filings are specified in Industry Guide 7, which requires economic assumptions to be based on current economic conditions (which may differ from assumptions based on reasonable investment assumptions). Accordingly, for SEC filings, we test our reserve estimates derived under JORC against assumed ‘current economic conditions’. ‘Current economic conditions’ are based on the three-year average of historical contract and market prices for commodities such as iron ore and coal, and the three-year average of historical market prices for commodities that are traded on the London Metal Exchange, such as copper and nickel. However, we only report a different reserve in the United States if, based on the United States SEC pricing assumptions test, the reserve will be lower than that reported under JORC in Australia and the United Kingdom.

Oil and gas reserves reported in Australia and the United Kingdom, and the United States for SEC filing purposes, are based on the average of prices prevailing on the first day of each month for the past 12 months as required under the SEC Rules ‘Modernisation of Oil & Gas Reporting’.

Because the economic assumptions used to estimate reserves change from period to period, and because additional geological data is generated during the course of operations, estimates of reserves may change from period to period. Changes in reported reserves may affect the Group’s financial results and financial position in a number of ways, including the following:

 

  Asset recoverable amounts may be affected due to changes in estimated future cash flows.

 

  Depreciation, depletion and amortisation charged in the income statement may change where such charges are determined on the units of production basis, or where the useful economic lives of assets change.

 

  Overburden removal costs recorded on the balance sheet or charged to the income statement may change due to changes in stripping ratios or the units of production basis of depreciation.

 

  Decommissioning, site restoration and environmental provisions may change where changes in estimated reserves affect expectations about the timing or cost of these activities.

 

  The carrying amount of deferred tax assets may change due to changes in estimates of the likely recovery of the tax benefits.

Exploration and evaluation expenditure

The Group’s accounting policy for exploration and evaluation expenditure results in certain items of expenditure being capitalised for an area of interest where it is considered likely to be recoverable by future exploitation or sale or where the activities have not reached a stage which permits a reasonable assessment of the existence of reserves. This policy requires management to make certain estimates and assumptions as to future events and circumstances, in particular whether an economically viable extraction operation can be established. Any such

 

F-22


Table of Contents

estimates and assumptions may change as new information becomes available. If, after having capitalised the expenditure under the policy, a judgement is made that recovery of the expenditure is unlikely, the relevant capitalised amount will be written off to the income statement.

Development expenditure

Development activities commence after project sanctioning by the appropriate level of management. Judgement is applied by management in determining when a project is economically viable. In exercising this judgement, management is required to make certain estimates and assumptions similar to those described above for capitalised exploration and evaluation expenditure. Any such estimates and assumptions may change as new information becomes available. If, after having commenced the development activity, a judgement is made that a development asset is impaired, the appropriate amount will be written off to the income statement.

Property, plant and equipment and Intangible assets – recoverable amount

In accordance with the Group’s accounting policy, each asset or cash-generating unit is evaluated every reporting period to determine whether there are any indications of impairment or reversal of previously recognised impairment losses. If any such indication exists, a formal estimate of recoverable amount is performed. Where carrying amount exceeds recoverable amount an impairment loss is recognised. A reversal of previously recognised impairment loss is limited to the lesser of the amount that would not cause the increased carrying amount to exceed (a) its recoverable amount; or (b) the carrying amount that would have been determined (net of depreciation) had no impairment loss been recognised for the asset or cash-generating unit. The recoverable amount of an asset or cash-generating group of assets is measured at the higher of fair value less costs of disposal and value in use.

The determination of fair value and value in use requires management to make estimates and assumptions about expected production and sales volumes, commodity prices (considering current and historical prices, price trends and related factors), reserves (see ‘Reserve estimates’ above), operating costs, closure and rehabilitation costs and future capital expenditure. These estimates and assumptions are subject to risk and uncertainty; hence there is a possibility that changes in circumstances will alter these projections, which may impact the recoverable amount of the assets. In such circumstances, some or all of the carrying amount of the assets may be further impaired or the impairment charge reduced with the impact recorded in the income statement.

Defined benefit pension schemes

The Group’s accounting policy for defined benefit pension schemes requires management to make judgements as to the nature of benefits provided by each scheme and thereby determine the classification of each scheme. For defined benefit schemes, management is required to make annual estimates and assumptions about future returns on classes of scheme assets, future remuneration changes, employee attrition rates, administration costs, changes in benefits, inflation rates, exchange rates, life expectancy and expected remaining periods of service of employees. In making these estimates and assumptions, management considers advice provided by external advisers, such as actuaries. Where actual experience differs to these estimates, actuarial gains and losses are recognised directly in equity. Refer to note 30 ‘Pension and other post-retirement obligations’ for details of the key assumptions.

Provision for closure and rehabilitation

The Group’s accounting policy for the recognition of closure and rehabilitation provisions requires significant estimates and assumptions such as: requirements of the relevant legal and regulatory framework; the magnitude of possible contamination; and the timing, extent and costs of required closure and rehabilitation activity. These uncertainties may result in future actual expenditure differing from the amounts currently provided.

 

F-23


Table of Contents

The provision recognised for each site is periodically reviewed and updated based on the facts and circumstances available at the time. Changes to the estimated future costs for operating sites are recognised in the balance sheet by adjusting both the closure and rehabilitation asset and provision. For closed sites, changes to estimated costs are recognised immediately in the income statement.

In addition to the uncertainties noted above, certain closure and rehabilitation activities are subject to legal disputes and depending on the ultimate resolution of these issues, the final liability for these matters could vary.

Taxation

The Group’s accounting policy for taxation, including royalty-related taxation, requires management’s judgement as to the types of arrangements considered to be a tax on income in contrast to an operating cost. Judgement is also required in assessing whether deferred tax assets and certain deferred tax liabilities are recognised on the balance sheet. Deferred tax assets, including those arising from unrecouped tax losses, capital losses, foreign tax credits and temporary differences, are recognised only where it is considered more likely than not that they will be recovered, which is dependent on the generation of sufficient future taxable profits. Deferred tax liabilities arising from temporary differences in investments, caused principally by retained earnings held in foreign tax jurisdictions, are recognised unless repatriation of retained earnings can be controlled and are not expected to occur in the foreseeable future.

Assumptions about the generation of future taxable profits and repatriation of retained earnings depend on management’s estimates of future cash flows. These depend on estimates of future production and sales volumes, commodity prices, reserves, operating costs, closure and rehabilitation costs, capital expenditure, dividends and other capital management transactions. Judgements are also required about the application of income tax legislation and its interaction with income tax accounting principles. These judgements and assumptions are subject to risk and uncertainty, hence there is a possibility that changes in circumstances will alter expectations, which may impact the amount of deferred tax assets and deferred tax liabilities recognised on the balance sheet and the amount of other tax losses and temporary differences not yet recognised. In such circumstances, some or all of the carrying amount of recognised deferred tax assets and liabilities may require adjustment, resulting in a corresponding credit or charge to the income statement.

Exchange rates

The following exchange rates relative to the US dollar have been applied in the financial statements:

 

     Average
year ended
30 June 2014
     Average
year ended
30 June 2013
     Average
year ended
30 June 2012
     As at
30 June 2014
     As at
30 June 2013
     As at
30 June 2012
 

Australian dollar (a)

     0.92         1.03         1.03         0.94         0.92         1.00   

Brazilian real

     2.29         2.04         1.78         2.20         2.18         2.08   

Canadian dollar

     1.07         1.00         1.00         1.07         1.05         1.03   

Chilean peso

     532         479         492         551         504         510   

Colombian peso

     1,935         1,814         1,825         1,881         1,923         1,807   

Euro

     0.74         0.77         0.75         0.73         0.77         0.80   

South African rand

     10.39         8.84         7.77         10.60         10.00         8.41   

UK pound sterling

     0.62         0.64         0.63         0.59         0.66         0.64   

 

(a)  Displayed as US$ to A$1 based on common convention.

 

F-24


Table of Contents

2 Segment reporting

Business segments

The Group operates five Businesses aligned with the commodities which we extract and market, reflecting the structure used by the Group’s management to assess the performance of the Group.

 

Reportable segment

  

Principal activities

Petroleum and Potash   

Exploration, development and production of oil and gas

Potash pre-development

Copper    Mining of copper, silver, lead, zinc, molybdenum, uranium and gold
Iron Ore    Mining of iron ore
Coal    Mining of metallurgical coal and thermal (energy) coal
Aluminium, Manganese and Nickel   

Mining of bauxite, refining of bauxite into alumina and smelting of alumina into aluminium metal

Mining of manganese ore and production of manganese metal and alloys

Mining and production of nickel products

Group and unallocated items represent Group centre functions, unallocated operations and consolidation adjustments. Exploration and technology activities are recognised within relevant segments.

It is the Group’s policy that inter-segment sales are made on a commercial basis.

 

F-25


Table of Contents
     Petroleum
and Potash
    Copper     Iron Ore     Coal     Aluminium,
Manganese

and Nickel
    Group and
unallocated
items/
eliminations (f)
    BHP
Billiton
Group
 
US$M                                           

Year ended 30 June 2014

              

Revenue

              

Group production

     14,022        12,838        20,882        8,659        7,583               63,984   

Third party products

     437        1,030        130        456        823        103        2,979   

Rendering of services

     112               131                             243   

Inter-segment revenue

     262               213               5        (480       
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total revenue (a)

     14,833        13,868        21,356        9,115        8,411        (377     67,206   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underlying EBITDA (b)

     9,615        6,586        13,531        1,717        1,029        (119     32,359   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Depreciation and amortisation

     (3,951     (1,418     (1,464     (1,039     (670     (159     (8,701

Impairment (losses)/reversals

     (377     (88     35        (292     (52     (23     (797
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underlying EBIT (b)

     5,287        5,080        12,102        386        307        (301     22,861   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Comprising:

              

Group production

     5,288        4,634        11,498        218        289        (305     21,622   

Third party products

     3        8        (3     18        18               44   

Share of operating profit of equity accounted investments

     (4     438        607        150               4        1,195   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underlying EBIT (b)

     5,287        5,080        12,102        386        307        (301     22,861   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net finance costs (c)

                 (1,176

Exceptional items (d)

                 551   
              

 

 

 

Profit before taxation

                 22,236   
              

 

 

 

Capital expenditure

     6,423        3,757        2,949        2,345        498        21        15,993   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Investments accounted for using the equity method (e)

     115        1,386        1,069        1,089               5        3,664   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total assets (e)

     47,046        24,690        27,412        18,863        12,713        20,689        151,413   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities (e)

     7,532        2,459        4,022        4,563        3,391        44,064        66,031   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-26


Table of Contents
     Petroleum
and Potash
    Copper     Iron Ore     Coal     Aluminium,
Manganese

and Nickel
    Group and
unallocated
items/
eliminations (f)
    BHP
Billiton
Group
 
US$M                                           

Year ended 30 June 2013

              

Revenue

              

Group production

     12,951        13,837        18,331        9,310        8,093        326        62,848   

Third party products

     175        700        86        585        1,165        175        2,886   

Rendering of services

     98               121                             219   

Inter-segment revenue

                   55               20        (75       
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total revenue (a)

     13,224        14,537        18,593        9,895        9,278        426        65,953   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underlying EBITDA (b)

     8,910        6,885        12,113        1,480        915        5        30,308   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Depreciation and amortisation

     (3,068     (1,197     (917     (885     (772     (192     (7,031

Impairment (losses)/reversals

     (206     (49     (87            15        (20     (347
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underlying EBIT (b)

     5,636        5,639        11,109        595        158        (207     22,930   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Comprising:

              

Group production

     5,616        5,181        10,565        410        120        (231     21,661   

Third party products

     11        3        31        44        38               127   

Share of operating profit of equity accounted investments

     9        455        513        141               24        1,142   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underlying EBIT (b)

     5,636        5,639        11,109        595        158        (207     22,930   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net finance costs (c)

                 (1,276

Exceptional items (d)

                 (1,928
              

 

 

 

Profit before taxation

                 19,726   
              

 

 

 

Capital expenditure

     7,675        3,930        5,979        3,626        893        140        22,243   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Investments accounted for using the equity method (e)

     130        1,351        1,044        1,150                      3,675   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total assets (e)

     44,383        22,623        25,877        17,568        12,092        16,635        139,178   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities (e)

     6,858        2,549        3,751        4,343        3,283        43,103        63,887   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-27


Table of Contents
     Petroleum
and Potash
    Copper     Iron Ore     Coal     Aluminium,
Manganese

and Nickel
    Group and
unallocated
items/
eliminations (f)
    BHP
Billiton
Group
 
US$M  

Year ended 30 June 2012

              

Revenue

              

Group production

     12,617        13,090        20,171        11,638        8,334        706        66,556   

Third party products

     230        463        86        856        1,563        310        3,508   

Rendering of services

     86               309        18                      413   

Inter-segment revenue

                   39               14        (53       
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total revenue (a)

     12,933        13,553        20,605        12,512        9,911        963        70,477   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underlying EBITDA (b)

     9,097        6,203        14,815        3,340        809        353        34,617   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Depreciation and amortisation

     (3,045     (960     (771     (730     (811     (114     (6,431

Impairment (losses)/reversals

     (19     70               2        (22     (131     (100
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underlying EBIT (b)

     6,033        5,313        14,044        2,612        (24     108        28,086   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Comprising:

              

Group production

     6,023        4,800        13,104        2,195        (43     4        26,083   

Third party products

     3        (9     31        90        19               134   

Share of operating profit of equity accounted investments

     7        522        909        327               104        1,869   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underlying EBIT (b)

     6,033        5,313        14,044        2,612        (24     108        28,086   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net finance costs (c)

                 (668

Exceptional items (d)

                 (3,486
              

 

 

 

Profit before taxation

                 23,932   
              

 

 

 

Capital expenditure

     5,488        3,518        4,458        3,103        1,941        129        18,637   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Investments accounted for using the equity method (e)

     129        1,073        876        1,103                      3,181   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total assets (e)

     39,937        20,417        21,214        15,635        16,759        15,239        129,201   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities(e)

     6,354        3,696        3,839        4,972        3,632        37,393        59,886   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(a)  Revenue not attributable to reportable segments comprises the sale of freight and fuel to third parties, as well as revenues from unallocated operations described in footnote (f).

 

(b)  Underlying EBIT is earnings before net finance costs, taxation and any exceptional items. Underlying EBIT is reported net of the Group’s share of net finance costs and taxation of equity accounted investments. Underlying EBITDA is Underlying EBIT before depreciation, impairments and amortisation.

 

F-28


Table of Contents
(c)  Refer to note 6 Net finance costs.

 

(d)  Refer to note 3 Exceptional items.

 

(e)  Total segment assets and liabilities of businesses represent operating assets and operating liabilities including the carrying amount of equity accounted investments and predominantly excludes cash balances, interest bearing liabilities and deferred tax balances. The carrying amount of investments accounted for using the equity method represents the balance of the Group’s investment in equity accounted investments, with no adjustment for any cash balances, interest bearing liabilities and deferred tax balances of the equity accounted investment.

 

(f)  Includes the Group’s diamonds business (divested effective 10 April 2013), interest in titanium minerals (divested effective 3 September 2012), non-Potash corporate costs incurred by the former Diamonds and Specialty Products business, consolidation adjustments and unallocated items.

 

 

 

F-29


Table of Contents

Geographical information

 

     Revenue by location of customer  
     2014      2013      2012  
     US$M      US$M      US$M  

Australia

     3,957         4,591         5,300   

United Kingdom

     1,284         1,598         378   

Rest of Europe

     4,767         5,609         6,649   

China

     23,287         20,079         21,670   

Japan

     7,143         8,147         9,095   

India

     2,798         2,581         3,751   

South Korea

     4,789         4,483         5,773   

Rest of Asia

     5,137         6,176         5,605   

North America

     10,149         8,510         7,896   

South America

     2,212         2,181         2,165   

Southern Africa

     1,143         1,311         1,415   

Rest of world

     540         687         780   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     67,206         65,953         70,477   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

     Non-current assets by location of assets  
     2014      2013      2012  
     US$M      US$M      US$M  

Australia

     60,408         56,173         53,809   

United Kingdom

     516         436         359   

North America

     35,845         33,844         28,094   

South America

     15,926         13,695         11,003   

Southern Africa

     4,570         5,081         6,316   

Rest of world

     3,107         3,208         4,335   

Unallocated assets (a)

     8,745         7,788         6,358   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     129,117         120,225         110,274   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(a) Unallocated assets comprise deferred tax assets and other financial assets.

3    Exceptional items

Exceptional items are those items where their nature and amount is considered material to the financial statements. Such items included within the Group’s profit for the year are detailed below.

 

Year ended 30 June 2014

   Gross      Tax     Net  
     US$M      US$M     US$M  

Exceptional items by category

       

Sale of Pinto Valley

     551         (166     385   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 
     551         (166     385   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-30


Table of Contents

Exceptional items are classified by nature as follows:

 

Year ended 30 June 2014

   Sale of
assets
     Gross  
     US$M      US$M  

Sale of Pinto Valley

     551         551   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
     551         551   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Sale of Pinto Valley:

On 11 October 2013, the Group announced it had completed the sale of its Pinto Valley mining operation for cash consideration of US$653 million, after working capital adjustments. A gain on sale of US$385 million (after tax expense) was recognised in the year ended 30 June 2014.

 

Year ended 30 June 2013

  Gross     Tax     Net  
    US$M     US$M     US$M  

Exceptional items by category

     

Sale of Yeelirrie uranium deposit

    420               420   

Sale of Richards Bay Minerals

    1,212        (183     1,029   

Sale of diamonds business

    (97     (42     (139

Sale of East and West Browse Joint Ventures

    1,539        (188     1,351   

Impairment of Nickel West assets

    (1,698     454        (1,244

Impairment of Worsley assets

    (2,190     559        (1,631

Impairment of Permian Basin assets

    (266     99        (167

Other impairments arising from capital project review

    (1,006     291        (715

Newcastle steelworks rehabilitation

    158        (47     111   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
    (1,928     943        (985
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Exceptional items are classified by nature as follows:

 

Year ended 30 June 2013

  Sale of
assets
    Impairment
of goodwill
and other
assets
    Restructuring
costs
    Closure and
rehabilitation
provisions
released
    Gross  
    US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M  

Sale of Yeelirrie uranium deposit

    420                             420   

Sale of Richards Bay Minerals

    1,212                             1,212   

Sale of diamonds business

           (97                   (97

Sale of East and West Browse Joint Ventures

    1,539                             1,539   

Impairment of Nickel West assets

           (1,698                   (1,698

Impairment of Worsley assets

           (2,190                   (2,190

Impairment of Permian Basin assets

           (266                   (266

Other impairments arising from capital project review

           (898     (108            (1,006

Newcastle steelworks rehabilitation

                         158        158   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
    3,171        (5,149     (108     158        (1,928
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-31


Table of Contents

Sale of Yeelirrie uranium deposit:

On 27 August 2012, the Group announced the sale of its wholly owned Yeelirrie uranium deposit and the transaction was completed on 19 December 2012. A gain on sale of US$420 million was recognised in the year ended 30 June 2013, while the associated tax expense was offset by the recognition of deferred tax benefits on available tax losses of US$126 million.

Sale of Richards Bay Minerals:

On 7 September 2012, the Group announced it had completed the sale of its 37.76 per cent effective interest in Richards Bay Minerals. A gain on sale of US$1,029 million (after tax expense) was recognised in the year ended 30 June 2013.

Sale of diamonds business:

On 13 November 2012, the Group announced the sale of its diamonds business, comprising its interests in the EKATI Diamond Mine and Diamond Marketing operations. The transaction was completed on 10 April 2013 for an aggregate cash consideration of US$553 million (after adjustments). An impairment charge of US$139 million (after tax expense) was recognised based on the final consideration.

Sale of East and West Browse Joint Ventures:

On 12 December 2012, the Group signed a definitive agreement to sell its 8.33 per cent interest in the East Browse Joint Venture and 20 per cent interest in the West Browse Joint Venture. A gain on sale of US$1,539 million was recognised in the year ended 30 June 2013. The associated tax expense of US$462 million was partly offset by the recognition of deferred tax benefits on available tax losses of US$241 million and the derecognition of deferred tax liabilities of US$33 million. The transaction was completed on 7 June 2013.

Impairment of Nickel West assets:

As a result of expected continued strength in the Australian dollar and weak nickel prices, the Group recognised an impairment charge of US$1,244 million (after tax benefit) in the year ended 30 June 2013.

Impairment of Worsley assets:

The Group recognised an impairment of assets at Worsley as a result of expected continued strength in the Australian dollar and weak alumina prices. A total impairment charge of US$1,631 million (after tax benefit) was recognised in the year ended 30 June 2013.

Impairment of Permian Basin assets:

An impairment charge of US$167 million (after tax benefit) was recognised as the performance of specific evaluation wells in certain areas of the Permian Basin (US) do not support economic development.

Other impairments arising from capital project review:

In the year ended 30 June 2013, WAIO refocused its attention on the capital-efficient expansion opportunity that exists within the Port Hedland inner harbour and all early works associated with the outer harbour development option were suspended. This revision to the WAIO development sequence and the change in status of other minor capital projects across the Group has resulted in the recognition of impairment charges of US$639 million (after tax benefit) and other restructuring costs of US$76 million (after tax benefit) in the year ended 30 June 2013.

 

F-32


Table of Contents

Newcastle steelworks rehabilitation:

The Group recognised a decrease of US$158 million (before tax expense) to its rehabilitation obligations in respect of former operations at the Newcastle steelworks (Australia). This followed the completion of the Hunter River Remediation Project and reaching agreement with the Environment Protection Authority in March 2013 regarding the necessary scope of work to repeal the Environmental Classification at Steel River.

 

Year ended 30 June 2012

   Gross     Tax     Net  
     US$M     US$M     US$M  

Exceptional items by category

      

Impairment of Fayetteville goodwill and other assets

     (2,835     996        (1,839

Impairment of Nickel West goodwill and other assets

     (449     94        (355

Suspension or early closure of operations and the change in status of specific projects (a)

     (502     108        (394

Settlement of insurance claims (a)

     300        (90     210   

Recognition of deferred tax assets on enactment of MRRT and PRRT extension legislation in Australia

            637        637   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     (3,486     1,745        (1,741
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(a)  Includes gross amounts attributable to non-controlling interest of US$(34) million (US$7 million tax expense).

Exceptional items are classified by nature as follows:

 

Year ended 30 June 2012

  Impairment
of goodwill
and other
assets
    Idle capacity
costs and
inventory
write-downs
    Restructuring
costs
    Insurance
recoveries
    Gross  
    US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M  

Impairment of Fayetteville goodwill and other assets

    (2,835                          (2,835

Impairment of Nickel West goodwill and other assets

    (406     (43                   (449

Suspension or early closure of operations and the change in status of specific projects

    (422     (40     (40            (502

Settlement of insurance claims

                         300        300   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
    (3,663     (83     (40     300        (3,486
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Impairment of Fayetteville goodwill and other assets:

As a result of the fall in United States domestic gas prices and the Company’s decision to adjust its development plans, the Group recognised impairments of goodwill and other assets in relation to its Fayetteville shale gas assets. A total impairment charge of US$1,839 million (after tax benefit) was recognised in the year ended 30 June 2012.

Impairment of Nickel West goodwill and other assets:

The Group recognised impairments of goodwill and other assets at Nickel West as a result of the continued downturn in the nickel price and margin deterioration. A total impairment charge of US$355 million (after tax benefit) was recognised in the year ended 30 June 2012.

 

F-33


Table of Contents

Suspension or early closure of operations and the change in status of specific projects:

As part of our regular portfolio review, various operations and projects around the Group were either suspended, closed early or changed in status. These included the change in status of the Olympic Dam expansion project; the temporary suspension of production at TEMCO and the permanent closure of the Metalloys South Plant in South Africa; the indefinite cessation of production at Norwich Park; and the suspension of other minor capital projects. As a result, impairment charges of US$338 million (after tax benefit), idle capacity costs and inventory write-down of US$28 million (after tax benefit) and other restructuring costs of US$28 million (after tax benefit) were recognised in the year ended 30 June 2012.

Settlement of insurance claims:

During 2008, extreme weather across the central Queensland coalfields affected production from the BHP Billiton Mitsubishi Alliance (BMA) and BHP Billiton Mitsui Coal (BMC) operations. The Group settled insurance claims in respect of the lost production and insurance claim income of US$210 million (after tax expense) was recognised in the year ended 30 June 2012.

Recognition of deferred tax assets on enactment of MRRT and PRRT extension legislation in Australia:

The Australian Minerals Resource Rent Tax (MRRT) and Petroleum Resource Rent Tax (PRRT) extension legislation was enacted in March 2012. Under the legislation, the Group is entitled to a deduction against future MRRT and PRRT liabilities based on the market value of its coal, iron ore and petroleum assets. A deferred tax asset, and an associated net income tax benefit of US$637 million, was recognised in the year ended 30 June 2012 to reflect the future deductibility of these market values for MRRT and PRRT purposes, to the extent they were considered recoverable.

4    Other income

 

     2014     2013      2012  
     US$M     US$M      US$M  

Dividend income

     31        16         10   

Royalties

     18        35         28   

(Losses)/gains on sale of property, plant and equipment (a)

     (35     1,984         101   

Gains/(losses) on sale of investments

     8        9         (2

Gains on divestment of equity accounted investments (b)

            1,212           

Gains on divestment of subsidiaries and operations (c)

     673                19   

Commission income

     85        93         131   

Insurance recoveries (d)

     41        16         304   

Other income

     703        582         307   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total other income

     1,524        3,947         898   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(a)  Includes exceptional items of US$ nil (2013: US$1,947 million; 2012: US$ nil). Refer to note 3 Exceptional items.

 

(b) Includes exceptional items of US$ nil (2013: US$1,212 million; 2012: US$ nil). Refer to note 3 Exceptional items.

 

(c) Includes exceptional items of US$551 million (2013: US$ nil; 2012: US$ nil). Refer to note 3 Exceptional items.

 

(d) Includes exceptional items of US$ nil (2013: US$ nil; 2012: US$300 million). Refer to note 3 Exceptional items.

 

F-34


Table of Contents

5    Expenses

 

     2014     2013     2012  
     US$M     US$M     US$M  

Changes in inventories of finished goods and work in progress

     (128     180        317   

Raw materials and consumables used

     8,842        8,926        8,128   

Employee benefits expense

     6,903        7,168        6,035   

External services (including transportation) (a)

     11,736        12,478        14,293   

Third party commodity purchases

     2,935        2,759        3,402   

Net foreign exchange losses/(gains)

     100        (284     (571

Research and development costs before crediting related grants

     43        64        75   

Fair value change on derivatives (b)

     (120     79        (141

Impairment of available for sale financial assets

            1        1   

Reversal of previously impaired financial assets

     (2              

Government royalties paid and payable

     2,760        2,562        2,880   

Depreciation and amortisation expense

     8,701        7,031        6,431   

Exploration and evaluation expenditure incurred and expensed in the current period

     716        1,047        1,644   

Exploration and evaluation expenditure previously capitalised, written off as unsuccessful or abandoned (c)

     167        1,099        144   

Reversal of previously written off capitalised exploration and evaluation expenditure

     (56              

Impairment of property, plant and equipment (d)

     623        4,456        3,114   

Reversal of previously impaired property, plant and equipment

            (67     (71

Impairment of goodwill and other intangible assets (e)

     65        7        575   

Operating lease rentals

     759        776        658   

All other operating expenses (f)

     2,469        1,758        1,730   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total expenses

     46,513        50,040        48,644   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

     2014     2013     2012  
     US$M     US$M     US$M  

Aggregate employee benefits expense

      

Wages, salaries and redundancies

     6,143        6,625        5,564   

Employee share awards (g)

     239        214        258   

Social security costs

     7        7        12   

Pensions and other post-retirement obligations – refer to note 30

     649        510        456   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     7,038        7,356        6,290   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Less employee benefits expense classified as exploration and evaluation expenditure above

     (135     (188     (255
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Employee benefits expense

     6,903        7,168        6,035   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(a)  Includes exceptional items of US$ nil (2013: US$96 million; 2012: US$ nil). Refer to note 3 Exceptional items.

 

(b)  Fair value change on derivatives includes realised gains of US$49 million (2013: US$51 million realised gains; 2012: US$126 million realised losses) and unrealised gains of US$71 million (2013: US$130 million unrealised losses; 2012: US$267 million unrealised gains).

 

(c)  Includes exceptional items of US$ nil (2013: US$832 million; 2012: US$ nil). Refer to note 3 Exceptional items.

 

F-35


Table of Contents
(d)  Includes exceptional items of US$ nil (2013: US$4,310 million; 2012: US$3,088 million). Refer to note 3 Exceptional items.

 

(e)  Includes exceptional items of US$ nil (2013: US$7 million; 2012: US$575 million). Refer to note 3 Exceptional items.

 

(f)  Includes exceptional items of US$ nil (2013: decrease of US$158 million; 2012: US$ nil). Refer to note 3 Exceptional items.

 

(g)  Employee share awards expense is US$238.544 million (2013: US$213.671 million; 2012: US$257.583 million).

6    Net finance costs

 

     2014     2013     2012  
     US$M     US$M     US$M  

Financial expenses

      

Interest on bank loans and overdrafts (a)

     14        13        19   

Interest on all other borrowings (a) (b)

     708        965        641   

Finance lease and hire purchase interest

     55        11        37   

Dividends on redeemable preference shares

                     

Discounting on provisions and other liabilities

     475        478        485   

Net interest expense on post-retirement employee benefits

     22        19        26   

Interest capitalised (c)

     (182     (290     (272

Fair value change on hedged loans

     328        (505     345   

Fair value change on hedging derivatives

     (292     489        (381

Fair value change on non-hedging derivatives (b)

     101        183        (11

Exchange variations on net debt

     44        21        (53
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     1,273        1,384        836   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Financial income

      

Interest income (d)

     (97     (108     (168
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     (97     (108     (168
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net finance costs

     1,176        1,276        668   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(a)  Interest on bank loans and overdrafts, and other borrowings, relates to financial liabilities carried at amortised cost.

 

(b)  Interest on all other borrowings includes financial income of US$52 million of realised fair value changes on non-hedging derivatives used to manage interest rate exposure on debt securities (2013: expense of US$97 million; 2012: US$ nil). The fair value change on non-hedging derivatives includes the unrealised fair value changes on similar instruments. The total fair value changes on non-hedging derivatives amounted to an expense of US$49 million (2013: expense of US$280 million; 2012: gain of US$11 million).

 

(c)  Interest has been capitalised at the rate of interest applicable to the specific borrowings financing the assets under construction or, where financed through general borrowings, at a capitalisation rate representing the average interest rate on such borrowings. For the year ended 30 June 2014, the capitalisation rate was 1.82 per cent (2013: 2.24 per cent; 2012: 2.83 per cent).

 

(d)  Interest income relates to financial assets carried at amortised cost.

 

F-36


Table of Contents

7    Income tax and deferred tax

 

     2014     2013     2012  
     US$M     US$M     US$M  

Total taxation expense comprises:

      

Current tax expense

     6,586        7,399        7,889   

Deferred tax expense/(benefit)

     426        (493     (574
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     7,012        6,906        7,315   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total taxation expense attributed to geographical jurisdiction:

      

UK

     (44     84        (70

Australia

     4,871        4,512        5,837   

Rest of world

     2,185        2,310        1,548   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     7,012        6,906        7,315   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

     2014     2013     2012  
     %     US$M     %     US$M     %     US$M  

Factors affecting income tax expense for the period

            

Income tax expense differs to the standard rate of corporation tax as follows:

            

Profit before taxation

       22,236          19,726          23,932   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Tax on profit at standard rate of 30 per cent

     30.0        6,671        30.0        5,918        30.0        7,180   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Tax on remitted and unremitted foreign earnings

     0.8        169        0.6        109        0.8        181   

Non-deductible depreciation, amortisation and exploration expenditure (a)

     0.3        84        1.1        222        0.6        150   

Non-tax-effected operating losses and capital gains

     0.1        28        (0.3     (56     0.7        169   

Tax rate changes

     0.1        20        0.4        68                 

Tax rate differential on foreign income

     0.1        15        (0.4     (74     (1.2     (287

Exchange variations and other translation adjustments

     (0.1     (24     1.2        245        1.4        347   

Initial recognition of tax assets (b)

     (0.2     (45     (1.9     (370     (0.6     (136

Amounts (over)/under provided in prior years

     (0.4     (81     (0.2     (36     0.3        72   

Investment and development allowance

     (1.0     (225     (1.3     (260     (0.9     (224

Tax effect of share of profits of equity accounted investments (c)

     (1.6     (359     (1.7     (343     (2.3     (561

Other

     1.3        285        1.5        291        0.7        162   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income tax expense

     29.4        6,538        29.0        5,714        29.5        7,053   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Royalty-related taxation (net of income tax benefit) (d)

     2.1        474        6.0        1,192        1.1        262   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total taxation expense

     31.5        7,012        35.0        6,906        30.6        7,315   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(a)  Includes exceptional expense of US$ nil (2013: US$152 million; 2012: US$ nil). Refer to note 3 Exceptional items.

 

(b)  Includes exceptional benefit of US$ nil (2013: US$367 million; 2012: US$ nil). Refer to note 3 Exceptional items.

 

(c)  The share of profits of equity accounted investments is net of income tax. This item removes the prima facie tax effect on such profits.

 

F-37


Table of Contents
(d)  Includes exceptional benefit of US$ nil (2013: US$33 million; 2012: US$637 million). Refer to note 3 Exceptional items.

Income tax recognised in other comprehensive income is as follows:

 

     2014     2013     2012  
     US$M     US$M     US$M  

Income tax effect of:

      

Items that may be reclassified subsequently to the income statement:

      

Available for sale investments:

      

Net valuation losses/gains taken to equity

     2        13        (12

Net valuation gains transferred to the income statement

     2                 

Cash flow hedges:

      

Gains/losses taken to equity

     (204     (67     96   

Gains/losses transferred to the income statement

     203        (22     (61

Exchange fluctuations on translation of foreign operations taken to equity

                     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income tax credit/(charge) relating to items that may be reclassified subsequently to the income statement

     3        (76     23   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Items that will not be reclassified to the income statement:

      

Actuarial gains/losses on pension and medical schemes

     (6     (23     76   

Employee share awards transferred to retained earnings on exercise

     18        49        46   

Net accrued employee entitlement for share awards

            (42     (56
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income tax credit/(charge) relating to items that will not be reclassified to the income statement

     12        (16     66   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total income tax credit/(charge) relating to components of other comprehensive income (a)

     15        (92     89   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(a)  Included within total income tax relating to components of other comprehensive income is US$(1) million relating to deferred taxes and US$16 million relating to current taxes (2013: US$(139) million and US$47 million; 2012: US$44 million and US$45 million).

The movement for the year in the Group’s net deferred tax position is as follows:

 

     2014     2013     2012  
     US$M     US$M     US$M  

Net deferred tax (liability)/asset

      

At the beginning of the financial year

     (243     (611     1,766   

Income tax (charge)/credit recorded in the income statement

     (426     493        574   

Income tax (charge)/credit recorded directly in equity

     (1     (139     44   

Acquisition and divestment of subsidiaries and operations

                   (2,996

Transferred to liabilities held for sale

            60          

Exchange variations and other movements

            (46     1   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

At the end of the financial year

     (670     (243     (611
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-38


Table of Contents

The composition of the Group’s net deferred tax asset and liability recognised in the balance sheet and the deferred tax expense charged/(credited) to the income statement is as follows:

 

    Deferred
tax assets
    Deferred tax
liabilities
    Charged/(credited)
to the income statement
 
        2014             2013             2014             2013             2014             2013             2012      
    US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M  

Type of temporary difference

             

Depreciation

    (514     606        6,375        7,000        495        532        (100

Exploration expenditure

    669        662        (102     (105     (4     (14     (101

Employee benefits

    389        355        (173     (176     (32     23        31   

Closure and rehabilitation

    1,658        1,513        (794     (589     (353     (72     (31

Resource rent tax

    1,580        1,028        1,907        1,861        (506     484        (335

Other provisions

    433        59        (59     (22     (411     34        43   

Deferred income

    (32     (22     (11     (13     12        (74     178   

Deferred charges

    (575     (374     307        282        226        302        326   

Investments, including foreign tax credits

    1,906        1,859        1,765        1,420        298        133        127   

Foreign exchange gains and losses

    (261     (431     76        64        (158     (239     (16

Non tax-depreciable fair value adjustments, revaluations and mineral rights

    (5     (11     89        76        8        (25     (63

Tax-effected losses

    1,159        961        (2,192     (3,001     605        (1,588     (762

Other

    (11     (136     (122     (485     246        11        129   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

    6,396        6,069        7,066        6,312        426        (493     (574
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The composition of the Group’s unrecognised deferred tax assets and liabilities is as follows:

 

     2014      2013  
     US$M      US$M  

Unrecognised deferred tax assets

     

Tax losses and tax credits

     1,572         1,484   

Deductible temporary differences relating to MRRT and PRRT

     19,528         19,419   

Other deductible temporary differences

     3,395         3,350   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total unrecognised deferred tax assets

     24,495         24,253   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Unrecognised deferred tax liabilities

     

Taxable temporary differences relating to unrecognised deferred tax asset for MRRT and PRRT

     5,858         5,826   

Investments in subsidiaries

     2,153         2,174   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total unrecognised deferred tax liabilities

     8,011         8,000   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

F-39


Table of Contents

Tax losses

At 30 June 2014, the Group had income and capital tax losses with a tax benefit of US$1,053 million (2013: US$1,021 million) which are not recognised as deferred tax assets. The Group recognises the benefit of tax losses only to the extent of anticipated future taxable income or gains in relevant jurisdictions. The gross amount of tax losses carried forward that have not been tax effected expire as follows:

 

Year of expiry

   Australia      UK      Rest of
world
     Total  
     US$M      US$M      US$M      US$M  

Income tax losses

           

Later than two years and not later than five years

                     2,443         2,443   

Later than five years and not later than ten years

                     40         40   

Later than ten years and not later than twenty years

                     339         339   

Unlimited

     3         436         252         691   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     3         436         3,074         3,513   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Capital tax losses

           

Later than two years and not later than five years

                     239         239   

Unlimited

     1,797         26         26         1,849   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Gross amount of tax losses not recognised

     1,800         462         3,339         5,601   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Tax effect of total losses not recognised

     540         95         418         1,053   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Tax credits

At 30 June 2014, the Group had US$519 million of tax credits that have not been recognised (2013: US$463 million). Of the US$519 million of tax credits, US$383 million expires later than five years and not later than ten years, US$41 million expires later than ten years and not later than twenty years. The remainder of the tax credits do not have an expiration date.

Temporary differences relating to MRRT and PRRT

At 30 June 2014, the Group had US$19,528 million of unrecognised deductible temporary differences (2013: US$19,419 million) relating to the Australian MRRT and PRRT with a corresponding unrecognised deferred tax liability for income tax purposes of US$5,858 million (2013: US$5,826 million). Recognition of a deferred tax asset for MRRT and PRRT depends on benefits expected to be obtained from the deduction against MRRT and PRRT liabilities.

Other deductible temporary differences

At 30 June 2014, the Group had deductible temporary differences for which deferred tax assets of US$3,395 million (2013: US$3,350 million) have not been recognised because it is not probable that future taxable profits will be available against which the Group can utilise the benefits. The deductible temporary differences do not expire under current tax legislation.

Temporary differences associated with investments in subsidiaries

At 30 June 2014, deferred tax liabilities of US$2,153 million (2013: US$2,174 million) associated with undistributed earnings of subsidiaries have not been recognised because the Group is able to control the timing of the reversal of the temporary differences and it is not probable that such differences will reverse in the foreseeable future.

 

F-40


Table of Contents

8    Earnings per share

 

     2014      2013      2012  

Basic earnings per ordinary share (US cents)

     260.0         210.9         290.7   

Diluted earnings per ordinary share (US cents)

     259.1         210.2         289.4   

Basic earnings per American Depositary Share (US cents) (a)

     520.0         421.8         581.4   

Diluted earnings per American Depositary Share (US cents) (a)

     518.2         420.4         578.8   

Basic earnings (US$M)

     13,832         11,223         15,473   

Diluted earnings (US$M)

     13,832         11,223         15,473   

The weighted average number of shares used for the purposes of calculating diluted earnings per share reconciles to the number used to calculate basic earnings per share as follows:

 

Weighted average number of shares

   2014      2013      2012  
     Million      Million      Million  

Basic earnings per ordinary share denominator (b)

     5,321         5,322         5,323   

Shares and options contingently issuable under employee share ownership plans (c)

     17         18         23   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Diluted earnings per ordinary share denominator (d)

     5,338         5,340         5,346   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(a)  Each American Depositary Share (ADS) represents two ordinary shares.

 

(b)  The calculation of the number of ordinary shares used in the computation of basic earnings per share is the aggregate of the weighted average number of ordinary shares of BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc outstanding during the period after deduction of the number of shares held by the Billiton share repurchase scheme, the Billiton Employee Share Ownership Plan Trust, the BHP Bonus Equity Plan Trust, the BHP Billiton Limited Executive Incentive Scheme Trust and the BHP Billiton Limited Employee Equity Trust.

 

(c)  Included in the calculation of fully diluted earnings per share are shares contingently issuable under Employee Share Ownership Plans.

 

(d)  Diluted earnings per share calculation excludes 183,181 of instruments (2013: 357,498; 2012: 711,751) which are considered antidilutive.

9    Dividends

 

    2014     2013     2012  
    US$M     US$M     US$M  

Dividends paid/payable during the period

     

BHP Billiton Limited

    3,793        3,662        3,559   

BHP Billiton Plc – Ordinary shares

    2,483        2,404        2,335   
                             – Preference shares (a)                     
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
    6,276        6,066        5,894   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Dividends determined in respect of the period

     

BHP Billiton Limited

    3,887        3,721        3,621   

BHP Billiton Plc – Ordinary shares

    2,555        2,446        2,376   
                             – Preference shares (a)                     
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
    6,442        6,167        5,997   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-41


Table of Contents
    2014     2013     2012  
    US cents     US cents     US cents  

Dividends paid during the period (per share)

     

Prior year final dividend

    59.0        57.0        55.0   

Interim dividend

    59.0        57.0        55.0   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
    118.0        114.0        110.0   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Dividends determined in respect of the period (per share)

     

Interim dividend

    59.0        57.0        55.0   

Final dividend

    62.0        59.0        57.0   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
    121.0        116.0        112.0   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Dividends are determined after period end in the announcement of the results for the period. Interim dividends are determined in February and paid in March. Final dividends are determined in August and paid in September. Dividends determined are not recorded as a liability at the end of the period to which they relate. Subsequent to year-end, on 19 August 2014, BHP Billiton determined a final dividend of 62.0 US cents per share (US$3,301 million), which will be paid on 23 September 2014 (30 June 2013: final dividend of 59.0 US cents per share – US$3,147 million; 30 June 2012: final dividend of 57.0 US cents per share – US$3,049 million).

Each American Depositary Share (ADS) represents two ordinary shares of BHP Billiton Limited or BHP Billiton Plc. Dividends determined on each ADS represent twice the dividend determined on BHP Billiton ordinary shares.

BHP Billiton Limited dividends for all periods presented are, or will be, fully franked based on a tax rate of 30 per cent.

 

    2014     2013     2012  
    US$M     US$M     US$M  

Franking credits as at 30 June

    13,419        10,516        7,494   

Franking (debits)/credits arising from the (refund)/payment of current tax

    (29     824        2,547   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total franking credits available (b)

    13,390        11,340        10,041   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(a)  5.5 per cent dividend on 50,000 preference shares of £1 each determined and paid annually (30 June 2013: 5.5 per cent; 30 June 2012: 5.5 per cent).

 

(b)  The payment of the final 2014 dividend determined after 30 June 2014 will reduce the franking account balance by US$853 million.

 

F-42


Table of Contents

10    Trade and other receivables

 

     2014     2013  
     US$M     US$M  

Current

    

Trade receivables

     4,735        4,531   

Provision for doubtful debts

     (115     (116
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total trade receivables

     4,620        4,415   

Employee Share Plan loans (a)

     4        2   

Loans to equity accounted investments

     284        13   

Interest bearing loans receivable

     3        30   

Other receivables

     1,830        1,850   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total current receivables (b)

     6,741        6,310   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Non-current

    

Employee Share Plan loans (a)

     2        9   

Loans to equity accounted investments

     921        1,196   

Interest bearing loans receivable

     334        278   

Other receivables

     610        515   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total non-current receivables (b)

     1,867        1,998   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

     2014     2013  
     US$M     US$M  

Movement in provision for doubtful debts

    

At the beginning of the financial year

         116            121   

Charge/(credit) for the year:

    

Underlying charge to the income statement

            2   

Released to the income statement

     (1       

Utilisation

            (7
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

At the end of the financial year

     115        116   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(a)  Under the terms of the BHP Billiton Limited Employee Share Plan, shares have been issued to employees for subscription at the weighted average market price less a discount not exceeding 5 per cent. Interest free employee loans are full recourse and are available to fund the purchase of such shares for a period of up to 20 years, repayable by application of dividends or an equivalent amount. Refer to note 33 Employee share ownership plans.

 

(b)  Disclosures relating to receivables from related parties are set out in note 32 Related party transactions.

 

F-43


Table of Contents

11    Other financial assets

 

     2014      2013  
     US$M      US$M  

Current

     

At fair value

     

Cross currency and interest rate swaps

     12         64   

Forward exchange contracts

             1   

Commodity contracts

     18         30   

Other derivative contracts

     57         29   

Shares – available for sale

             37   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total current other financial assets

     87         161   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Non-current

     

At fair value

     

Cross currency and interest rate swaps

     1,471         898   

Commodity contracts

     7         19   

Other derivative contracts

     214         166   

Shares – available for sale

     512         497   

Other investments – available for sale (a)

     145         139   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total non-current other financial assets

     2,349         1,719   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(a)  Includes investments held by BHP Billiton Energy Coal South Africa Rehabilitation Trust Fund. The future realisation of this investment is intended to fund environmental obligations relating to the closure of the South African coal operations, and consequently this investment, while under the Group’s control, is not available for the general purposes of the Group. Any income from this investment is reinvested or applied to meet these obligations. The Group retains responsibility for these environmental obligations until such time as the former mine sites have been rehabilitated in accordance with the relevant environmental legislation. These obligations are therefore included under non-current provisions. Refer to note 18 Provisions.

 

F-44


Table of Contents

12    Inventories

 

          2014      2013  
          US$M      US$M  

Current

        

Raw materials and consumables

   – at net realisable value (a)      39         5   
   – at cost      2,161         1,993   
     

 

 

    

 

 

 
        2,200         1,998   
     

 

 

    

 

 

 

Work in progress

   – at net realisable value (a)      185         322   
   – at cost      2,269         2,033   
     

 

 

    

 

 

 
        2,454         2,355   
     

 

 

    

 

 

 

Finished goods

   – at net realisable value (a)      239         220   
   – at cost      1,120         1,248   
     

 

 

    

 

 

 
        1,359         1,468   
     

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total current inventories

     6,013         5,821   
     

 

 

    

 

 

 

Non-current

        

Raw materials and consumables

   – at net realisable value (a)              47   
   – at cost      225         436   
     

 

 

    

 

 

 
        225         483   
     

 

 

    

 

 

 

Work in progress

   – at net realisable value (a)      4         7   
   – at cost      130         112   
     

 

 

    

 

 

 
        134         119   
     

 

 

    

 

 

 

Finished goods

   – at net realisable value (a)                
   – at cost      104         17   
     

 

 

    

 

 

 
        104         17   
     

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total non-current inventories

     463         619   
     

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(a)  US$95 million of inventory write-downs were recognised during the year (2013: US$62 million; 2012: US$56 million). Inventory write-downs of US$69 million made in previous periods were reversed during the year (2013: US$18 million; 2012: US$ nil).

 

F-45


Table of Contents

13    Property, plant and equipment

 

Year ended 30 June 2014

  Land and
buildings
    Plant and
equipment
    Other
mineral
assets
    Assets
under
construction
    Exploration
and
evaluation
    Total  
    US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M  

Cost

           

At the beginning of the financial year

    10,446        81,304        32,117        23,560        2,823        150,250   

Additions

    5        2,564        1,424        14,028        99        18,120   

Disposals

    (78     (521     (253            (80     (932

Divestment of subsidiaries and operations

    (9     (1,882     (247                   (2,138

Transferred to assets held for sale

    (2     (27            24               (5

Exchange variations taken to reserve

           4               2               6   

Transfers and other movements

    3,298        18,849        (219     (22,288     (23     (383
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

At the end of the financial year

    13,660        100,291        32,822        15,326        2,819        164,918   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Accumulated depreciation and impairments

           

At the beginning of the financial year

    2,950        37,138        8,171               1,426        49,685   

Charge for the year

    584        6,653        1,203               3        8,443   

Impairments for the year

    153        397        73               167        790   

Reversal of impairments

                                (56     (56

Disposals

    (14     (459     (230            (80     (783

Divestment of subsidiaries and operations

           (1,699     (215                   (1,914

Transferred to assets held for sale

                                         

Exchange variations taken to reserve

           7                             7   

Transfers and other movements

    6        828        (890     15               (41
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

At the end of the financial year

    3,679        42,865        8,112        15        1,460        56,131   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net book value at 30 June 2014

    9,981        57,426        24,710        15,311        1,359        108,787   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-46


Table of Contents

Year ended 30 June 2013

  Land and
buildings
    Plant and
equipment
    Other
mineral
assets
    Assets
under
construction
    Exploration
and
evaluation
    Total  
    US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M  

Cost

           

At the beginning of the financial year

    8,749        68,062        32,986        20,286        2,219        132,302   

Additions

    45        123        1,707        19,861        496        22,232   

Disposals

    (178     (717     (35            (54     (984

Divestment of subsidiaries and operations

                                         

Transferred to assets held for sale

    (224     (1,404     (1,044     (175     (42     (2,889

Exchange variations taken to reserve

           (75            (3            (78

Transfers and other movements

    2,054        15,315        (1,497     (16,409     204        (333
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

At the end of the financial year

    10,446        81,304        32,117        23,560        2,823        150,250   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Accumulated depreciation and impairments

           

At the beginning of the financial year

    2,488        29,629        7,273        58        621        40,069   

Charge for the year

    445        4,419        1,953               4        6,821   

Impairments for the year

    356        3,246        854               1,099        5,555   

Reversal of impairments

    (12     (55                          (67

Disposals

    (156     (647     (28            (4     (835

Divestment of subsidiaries and operations

                                         

Transferred to assets held for sale

    (193     (796     (845                   (1,834

Exchange variations taken to reserve

           (68                          (68

Transfers and other movements

    22        1,410        (1,036     (58     (294     44   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

At the end of the financial year

    2,950        37,138        8,171               1,426        49,685   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net book value at 30 June 2013

    7,496        44,166        23,946        23,560        1,397        100,565   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-47


Table of Contents

14    Intangible assets

 

    2014     2013  
    Goodwill     Other
intangibles
    Total     Goodwill     Other
intangibles
    Total  
    US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M  

Cost

           

At the beginning of the financial year

    4,105        2,246        6,351        4,105        2,132        6,237   

Additions

           291        291               119        119   

Disposals

           (3     (3            (13     (13

Divestments of subsidiaries and operations

    (23            (23                     

Impairments for the year

    (48            (48                     

Transfers and other movements

           (17     (17            8        8   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

At the end of the financial year

    4,034        2,517        6,551        4,105        2,246        6,351   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Accumulated amortisation and impairments

           

At the beginning of the financial year

           855        855               651        651   

Disposals

           (3     (3            (13     (13

Charge for the year

           258        258               210        210   

Impairments for the year

           17        17               7        7   

Transfers and other movements

           (15     (15                     
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

At the end of the financial year

           1,112        1,112               855        855   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total intangible assets

    4,034        1,405        5,439        4,105        1,391        5,496   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The carrying amount of goodwill has been allocated to the cash-generating units (CGUs), or groups of CGUs, as follows:

 

Cash-generating units

   2014     2013  
     US$M     US$M  

Onshore US

     3,568        3,591   

Other

     466        514   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 
     4,034        4,105   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Impairment testing of goodwill

For the purpose of impairment testing, goodwill has been allocated to CGUs, or groups of CGUs, that are expected to benefit from the synergies of the business combination and which represent the level at which management will monitor and manage the goodwill.

Onshore US

The goodwill of US$3,591 million that arose from the acquisition of Petrohawk Energy Corporation in 2011 has been allocated to the Onshore US group of CGUs which comprises the Eagle Ford, the Permian Basin, Haynesville and Fayetteville CGUs. During the period, the Group disposed its interest in South Midland (within the Permian Basin). Goodwill of US$23 million was allocated to South Midland to calculate the loss on disposal. Accordingly, goodwill allocated to the Onshore US group of CGUs is US$3,568 million.

The Onshore US group of CGUs comprises the natural gas and liquid reserves and resources, production wells and associated infrastructure including gathering systems and processing facilities in the Eagle Ford, Haynesville

 

F-48


Table of Contents

and the Permian areas in Texas and Louisiana (US) and the Fayetteville area in Arkansas (US). The Onshore US group of CGUs is part of the Petroleum and Potash reportable segment. The Onshore US group of CGUs was tested for impairment after testing each of the individual CGUs that it comprises.

The recoverable amount of the Onshore US group of CGUs was determined based on fair value less costs of disposal (FVLCD). FVLCD was determined as the present value of the estimated future cash flows (expressed in real terms) expected to arise from the continued use of the assets (life of asset), including any expansion prospects, and its eventual disposal, using assumptions that an independent market participant may take into account. These cash flows were discounted using a real after tax discount rate that reflected current market assessments of the time value of money and the risks specific to the CGU.

The determination of FVLCD was most sensitive to the following assumptions:

 

  Production volumes

 

  Crude oil prices

 

  Natural gas prices

 

  Discount rate

Production volumes – estimated production volumes were based on detailed data for the fields and took into account development plans for the fields established by management as part of the long-term planning process. Production volumes are dependent on variables, such as the recoverable quantities of hydrocarbons, the production profile of the hydrocarbons, the cost of the development of the infrastructure necessary to recover the hydrocarbons, the production costs, the contractual duration of the production leases and the selling price of the hydrocarbons produced. As each producing field has specific reservoir characteristics and economic circumstances, the cash flows of the fields were computed using appropriate individual economic models and key assumptions established by management. The production profiles used were consistent with the resource volumes approved as part of the Group’s process for the estimation of proved reserves and total resources.

Crude oil and natural gas prices – key assumptions for oil and gas prices were derived from forward price curves and long-term views of global supply and demand, building upon past experience of the industry and consistent with external sources. These prices were adjusted to arrive at appropriate consistent price assumptions for different qualities of oil and gas, or where appropriate, contracted oil and gas prices were applied.

The crude oil and natural gas prices used in the FVLCD determinations were either lower or within the following range of prices published by market commentators:

 

     2014     2013  

Crude oil price (US$/bbl)

     88.00 – 107.79        71.00 – 125.00   

Natural gas price (US$/MMBtu)

     3.84 – 5.84        4.45 – 6.51   

Discount rate – in arriving at the FVLCD, a real post-tax discount rate of 6.0 per cent (2013: 5.9 per cent) was applied to the post-tax cash flows expressed in real terms. This discount rate was derived from the Group’s post-tax weighted average cost of capital (WACC), with appropriate adjustments made to reflect the risks specific to the CGU.

Year ended 30 June 2014

The impairment tests for the individual Eagle Ford, the Permian Basin, Haynesville and Fayetteville CGUs indicated that no impairments or reversal of prior impairments were required. The impairment test of the Onshore US group of CGUs indicated that the recoverable amount of the Onshore US group of CGUs exceeded its carrying amount by US$598 million and no impairment was required.

 

F-49


Table of Contents

The table below shows the key assumptions used in the FVLCD as well as the amount by which each key assumption must change in isolation in order for the estimated recoverable amount to be equal to the carrying amount of the Onshore US group of CGUs, including goodwill. Owing to the complexity of the analysis caused by relationships between each key assumption, such that a change in one would cause a change in several other inputs to the calculation, the analysis below was performed for each assumption individually.

 

     Assumptions used in
FVLCD
     Change required for the carrying
amount to equal the recoverable
amount
 

Production volumes

     Management’s long-term plan         decrease of 1.2

Crude oil prices (US$/bbl)

     79.42 – 92.83         decrease of 5.1

Natural gas prices (US$/MMBtu)

     4.07– 5.57         decrease of 3.5

Discount rate

     6.0      increase of 20 basis points   

Year ended 30 June 2013

The impairment tests for the individual Eagle Ford, Haynesville and Fayetteville CGUs indicated that no impairments were required. However, an impairment of US$266 million was recognised in relation to the Permian Basin. In the prior year, the Permian Basin had been identified as one CGU. However, the current development plan identifies two distinct regions that would have to be developed independently: North Reeves/Pecos region (Delaware Basin) and South Midland (Midland Basin) region. Management also noted that each region has a separate and distinctive basin; they are geographically distant; and they do not share common infrastructure. Accordingly, management determined that each region represents a separate CGU. The US$266 million impairment relates to the South Midland CGU and was recognised against property, plant and equipment. Refer to note 3 ‘Exceptional items’ for further discussion.

The impairment test of the Onshore US group of CGUs was therefore performed after the Permian assets were written down to their recoverable amount (which was based on FVLCD measured using discounted cash flow projections). The result indicated that the recoverable amount of the Onshore US group of CGUs exceeded its carrying amount including goodwill by US$4,104 million and no further impairment was required.

The table below shows the key assumptions used in the FVLCD as well as the amount by which each key assumption must change in isolation in order for the estimated recoverable amount to be equal to the carrying amount of the Onshore US group of CGUs, including goodwill. Owing to the complexity of the analysis caused by relationships between each key assumption, such that a change in one would cause a change in several other inputs to the calculation, the analysis below was performed for each assumption individually.

 

     Assumptions used in
FVLCD
     Change required for the carrying
amount to equal the recoverable
amount
 

Production volumes

     Management’s long-term plan         decrease of 7

Crude oil prices (US$/bbl)

     82.50 – 91.54         decrease of 23

Natural gas prices (US$/MMBtu)

     4.14 – 5.66         decrease of 18

Discount rate

     5.9      increase of 160 basis points   

 

F-50


Table of Contents

Other

Goodwill held by other CGUs is US$466 million (2013: US$514 million), representing less than one per cent of net assets at 30 June 2014 (2013: less than one per cent). The goodwill has been allocated across a number of CGUs in different reportable segments, with no CGU accounting for more than US$200 million of total goodwill.

15    Trade and other payables

 

     2014      2013  
     US$M      US$M  

Current

     

Trade creditors

     6,973         7,601   

Other creditors

     3,172         3,259   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total current payables

     10,145         10,860   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Non-current

     

Other creditors

     113         286   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total non-current payables

     113         286   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

16    Interest bearing liabilities

 

     2014      2013  
     US$M      US$M  

Current

     

Unsecured bank loans (a)

     81         74   

Notes and debentures (a)

     4,002         3,531   

Commercial paper

             1,330   

Secured bank loans (a) (b)

             20   

Finance leases

     93         29   

Unsecured other

     35         94   

Unsecured bank overdrafts and short-term borrowings

     51         10   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total current interest bearing liabilities

     4,262         5,088   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Non-current

     

Unsecured bank loans (a)

     1,381         1,012   

Notes and debentures (a)

     27,245         26,728   

Redeemable preference shares (c)

             15   

Finance leases

     1,291         108   

Unsecured other (a)

     410         236   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total non-current interest bearing liabilities

     30,327         28,099   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(a)  Includes US$75 million (2013: US$66 million) share of bank loans and other borrowings arranged by joint operations to fund the financing of joint operations. While the Group chose to finance the joint operations directly and not to participate in the external borrowing programs arranged by the joint operations, it recognises its share of those borrowings in accordance with the terms of each arrangement, which are usually in proportion to the Group’s interest in the joint operation. A corresponding amount is recognised in interest bearing loans receivables. Refer to note 10 Trade and other receivables, reflecting the direct funding of the Group’s contribution to each joint operation.

 

F-51


Table of Contents
(b)  Secured bank loans for 2013 includes US$20 million secured by a pledge over the assets of the Mozal SARL joint operation. The bank loan was repaid during the 2014 financial year. As at 30 June 2014, the pledge over the assets has not yet been released.

 

(c)  Redeemable preference shares for 2013 comprised 150 Series A preferred shares issued by BHP Billiton Foreign Holdings Inc. at US$100,000 each fully paid, cumulative and non-participating. The shares were redeemed at par at the option of BHP Billiton Foreign Holdings Inc. during the 2014 financial year.

17    Other financial liabilities

 

     2014      2013  
     US$M      US$M  

Current

     

Cross currency and interest rate swaps, and swaptions

             173   

Forward exchange contracts

             1   

Commodity contracts

             20   

Other derivative contracts

     16         16   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total current other financial liabilities

     16         210   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Non-current

     

Cross currency and interest rate swaps

     273         553   

Commodity contracts

     9         8   

Other derivative contracts

     21         21   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total non-current other financial liabilities

     303         582   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

18    Provisions

 

     2014      2013  
     US$M      US$M  

Current

     

Employee benefits (a)

     1,727         1,621   

Restructuring (b)

     26         46   

Closure and rehabilitation (c)

     368         370   

Post-retirement employee benefits (d)

     23         6   

Other

     360         329   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total current provisions

     2,504         2,372   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Non-current

     

Employee benefits (a)

     247         260   

Restructuring (b)

             1   

Closure and rehabilitation (c)

     8,927         7,247   

Post-retirement employee benefits (d)

     519         548   

Other

     198         122   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total non-current provisions

     9,891         8,178   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(a)  The expenditure associated with total employee benefits will occur in a pattern consistent with when employees choose to exercise their entitlement to benefits.

 

(b)  Total restructuring provisions include provisions for business terminations and office closures.

 

(c)  Total closure and rehabilitation provisions include provisions for closed sites of US$1,514 million (2013: US$1,075 million).

 

F-52


Table of Contents
(d)  The provision for post-retirement employee benefits includes pension liabilities of US$117 million (2013: US$139 million) and post-retirement medical benefit liabilities of US$425 million (2013: US$415 million). Refer to note 30 Pension and other post-retirement obligations. The non-current provision includes Non-executive Directors’ retirement benefits of US$1 million (2013: US$1 million).

 

    Employee
benefits
    Restructuring     Closure and
rehabilitation
    Post-retirement
employee
benefits
    Other     Total  
    US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M  

At the beginning of the financial year

    1,881        47        7,617        554        451        10,550   

Amounts capitalised

                  1,194                      1,194   

Dividends determined

                                6,276        6,276   

Charge/(credit) for the year:

           

Underlying

    1,602        48        413        183        388        2,634   

Discounting

    7               465                      472   

Net interest expense

                         22               22   

Exchange variations

    (14            (17     (2     77        44   

Released during the year

    (21     (16     (35     (1     (141     (214

Actuarial gains taken to retained earnings

                         (57            (57

Exchange variations taken to reserve

                  10        (1            9   

Utilisation

    (1,455     (69     (219     (151     (85     (1,979

Dividends paid

                                (6,387     (6,387

Divestments of subsidiaries and operations

                  (145                   (145

Transferred to liabilities held for sale

    3               (2     1               2   

Transfers and other movements

    (29     16        14        (6     (21     (26
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

At the end of the financial year

    1,974        26        9,295        542        558        12,395   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-53


Table of Contents

19    Share capital

 

    BHP Billiton Limited     BHP Billiton Plc  
    2014     2013     2012     2014     2013     2012  
    US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M  

Share capital

           

At the beginning of the financial year

    1,186        1,186        1,183        1,069        1,069        1,070   

Shares bought back and cancelled (a)

                                       (1

Proceeds from the issue of shares

                  3                        
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

At the end of the financial year

    1,186        1,186        1,186        1,069        1,069        1,069   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Treasury shares

           

At the beginning of the financial year

    (8     (8     (1     (532     (525     (622

Purchase of shares by ESOP Trusts

    (290     (330     (318     (78     (115     (106

Employee share awards exercised following vesting

    247        330        311        74        108        120   

Shares bought back (a)

                                         

Shares cancelled (a)

                                       83   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

At the end of the financial year (b)

    (51     (8     (8     (536     (532     (525
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
    BHP Billiton Limited     BHP Billiton Plc (c)  
    2014
Shares (d)
    2013
Shares (d)
    2012
Shares (d)
    2014
Shares (d)
    2013
Shares (d)
    2012
Shares (d)
 

Share capital issued

           

Ordinary shares fully paid

    3,211,691,105        3,211,691,105        3,211,691,105        2,136,185,454        2,136,185,454        2,136,185,454   

Comprising:

           

– Shares held by the public

    3,210,206,876        3,211,448,985        3,211,448,985        2,110,945,784        2,111,078,268        2,111,273,967   

– Treasury shares

    1,484,229        242,120        242,120        25,239,670        25,107,186        24,911,487   

Special Voting Share of no par value (e)

    1        1        1         

5.5% Preference shares of £1 each (f)

          50,000        50,000        50,000   

Special Voting Share of US$0.50 par value (e)

          1        1        1   

 

    BHP Billiton Limited     BHP Billiton Plc  
    2014
Shares
    2013
Shares
    2012
Shares
    2014
Shares
    2013
Shares
    2012
Shares
 

Movement in shares held by the public

           

Opening number of shares

    3,211,448,985        3,211,448,985        3,211,607,567        2,111,078,268        2,111,273,967        2,110,963,849   

Shares issued on the exercise of Group Incentive Scheme awards

                  36,418                        

Purchase of shares by ESOP Trusts

    (8,621,160     (9,545,296     (8,077,647     (2,563,735     (3,761,193     (3,055,030

Employee share awards exercised following vesting

    7,379,051        9,545,296        7,882,647        2,431,251        3,565,494        3,365,148   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Closing number of shares (g)

    3,210,206,876        3,211,448,985        3,211,448,985        2,110,945,784        2,111,078,268        2,111,273,967   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-54


Table of Contents
    BHP Billiton Limited     BHP Billiton Plc  
    2014
Shares
    2013
Shares
    2012
Shares
    2014
Shares
    2013
Shares
    2012
Shares
 

Movement in Treasury shares

           

Opening number of shares

    242,120        242,120        47,120        25,107,186        24,911,487        27,403,342   

Purchase of shares by ESOP Trusts

    8,621,160        9,545,296        8,077,647        2,563,735        3,761,193        3,055,030   

Employee share awards exercised following vesting

    (7,379,051     (9,545,296     (7,882,647     (2,431,251     (3,565,494     (3,365,148

Shares cancelled (a)

                                       (2,181,737
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Closing number of shares

    1,484,229        242,120        242,120        25,239,670        25,107,186        24,911,487   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(a)  On 15 November 2010, BHP Billiton announced the reactivation of the remaining US$4.2 billion component of its previously suspended US$13 billion buy-back program and subsequently announced an expanded US$10 billion capital management program on 16 February 2011. This expanded program was completed on 29 June 2011 through a combination of on-market and off-market buy-backs. In accordance with the UK Companies Act 2006 and the resolutions passed at the 2010 Annual General Meetings, BHP Billiton Limited purchased fully paid shares in BHP Billiton Plc on-market and then transferred those shares to BHP Billiton Plc for nil consideration and cancellation. BHP Billiton Plc shares bought back as part of this program prior to 29 June 2011 but cancelled after 30 June 2011 were accounted for as Treasury shares within the share capital of BHP Billiton Plc.

 

(b)  Treasury shares include US$ nil and US$2 million held by subsidiaries in respect of ESOP Trusts for BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc respectively (2013: US$ nil and US$1 million; 2012: US$ nil and US$ nil).

 

(c)  An Equalisation Share (US$0.50 par value) has been authorised to be issued to enable a distribution to be made by BHP Billiton Plc Group to the BHP Billiton Limited Group should this be required under the terms of the DLC merger. The Directors have the ability to issue the Equalisation Share if required under those terms. The Constitution of BHP Billiton Limited allows the Directors of that Company to issue a similar Equalisation Share. There has been no movement in this class of share.

 

(d)  The total number of BHP Billiton Limited shares of all classes is 3,211,691,106 of which 99.99 per cent are ordinary shares fully paid (2013: 3,211,691,106, 99.99 per cent; 2012: 3,211,691,106, 99.99 per cent). The total number of BHP Billiton Plc shares of all classes is 2,136,235,455 of which 99.99 per cent are ordinary shares of US$0.50 par value (2013: 2,136,235,455, 99.99 per cent; 2012: 2,136,235,455, 99.99 per cent). Any profit remaining after payment of preferred distributions is available for distribution to the holders of BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc ordinary shares in equal amounts per share.

 

(e)  Each of BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc issued one Special Voting Share to facilitate joint voting by shareholders of BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc on Joint Electorate Actions. There has been no movement in these shares.

 

(f)  Preference shares have the right to repayment of the amount paid up on the nominal value and any unpaid dividends in priority to the holders of any other class of shares in BHP Billiton Plc on a return of capital or winding up. The holders of preference shares have limited voting rights if payment of the preference dividends are six months or more in arrears or a resolution is passed changing the rights of the preference shareholders. There has been no movement in these shares, all of which are held by JP Morgan Limited.

 

(g)  During the period 1 July 2014 to 11 September 2014, no fully paid ordinary shares in BHP Billiton were issued on the exercise of Group Incentive Scheme awards.

 

F-55


Table of Contents

20    Other equity

 

     2014     2013     2012  
     US$M     US$M     US$M  

Reserves

      

Share premium account (a)

      

At the beginning of the financial year

     518        518        518   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

At the end of the financial year

     518        518        518   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Foreign currency translation reserve (b)

      

At the beginning of the financial year

     55        53        34   

Exchange fluctuations on translation of foreign operations taken to equity

     (1     2        19   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total other comprehensive income

     (1     2        19   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

At the end of the financial year

     54        55        53   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Employee share awards reserve (c)

      

At the beginning of the financial year

     605        697        680   

Net deferred tax arising on accrued employee entitlement for share awards

            (42     (56
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total other comprehensive income

            (42     (56

Employee share awards exercised net of employee contributions

     (221     (243     (189

Employee share awards forfeited

     (32     (17     (8

Accrued employee entitlement for unexercised awards

     247        210        270   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

At the end of the financial year

     599        605        697   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Hedging reserve – cash flow hedges (d)

      

At the beginning of the financial year

     127        (80       

Gains/(losses) taken to equity

     681        223        (320

(Gains)/losses transferred to the income statement

     (678     73        205   

Deferred tax relating to cash flow hedges

     (1     (89     35   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total other comprehensive income

     2        207        (80
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

At the end of the financial year

     129        127        (80
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Financial assets reserve (e)

      

At the beginning of the financial year

     140        230        276   

Net valuation losses on available for sale investments taken to equity

     (15     (103     (32

Net valuation gains on available for sale investments transferred to the income statement

     (14     (1     (2

Deferred tax relating to revaluation gains and losses

     4        14        (12
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total other comprehensive income

     (25     (90     (46
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

At the end of the financial year

     115        140        230   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Share buy-back reserve (f)

      

At the beginning of the financial year

     165        165        164   

BHP Billiton Plc shares cancelled

                   1   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

At the end of the financial year

     165        165        165   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Non-controlling interest contribution reserve (g)

      

At the beginning of the financial year

     360        329        329   

Issue of share options to non-controlling interests

            49          

Distribution to option holders

     (2              

Equity contributed

     989                 

Divestment of equity accounted investment

            (18       
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

At the end of the financial year

     1,347        360        329   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total reserves

     2,927        1,970        1,912   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-56


Table of Contents
     2014     2013     2012  
     US$M     US$M     US$M  

Retained earnings

      

At the beginning of the financial year

     66,982        61,892        52,731   

Profit after taxation

     13,832        11,223        15,473   

Actuarial gains/(losses) on pension and medical schemes

     57        60        (253

Tax recognised within other comprehensive income

     12        26        123   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total comprehensive income

     13,901        11,309        15,343   

BHP Billiton Plc shares cancelled – refer to note 19 Share capital

                   (83

Employee share awards exercised, net of employee contributions and forfeitures

     (59     (161     (205

Dividends

     (6,276     (6,076     (5,894

Divestment of equity accounted investment

            18          
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

At the end of the financial year

     74,548        66,982        61,892   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     2014     2013     2012  
     US$M     US$M     US$M  

Non-controlling interests

      

At the beginning of the financial year

     4,624        3,789        2,825   

Profit after taxation

     1,392        1,597        1,144   

Net valuation gains on available for sale investments taken to equity

            2          

Actuarial gains on pension and medical schemes

            1        3   

Tax recognised within other comprehensive income

            (1     (1
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total comprehensive income

     1,392        1,599        1,146   

Distribution to option holders

     (2              

Dividends

     (252     (837     (343

Equity contributed

     477        73        161   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

At the end of the financial year

     6,239        4,624        3,789   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(a)  The share premium account represents the premium paid on the issue of BHP Billiton Plc shares recognised in accordance with the UK Companies Act 2006.

 

(b)  The foreign currency translation reserve represents exchange differences arising on the translation of non-US dollar functional currency operations within the Group into US dollars.

 

(c)  The employee share awards reserve represents the accrued employee entitlements to share awards that have been charged to the income statement and have not yet been exercised.

 

(d)  The hedging reserve represents hedging gains and losses recognised on the effective portion of cash flow hedges. The cumulative deferred gain or loss on the hedge is recognised in the income statement when the hedged transaction impacts the income statement, or is recognised as an adjustment to the cost of non-financial hedged items.

 

(e)  The financial assets reserve represents the revaluation of available for sale financial assets. Where a revalued financial asset is sold or impaired, the relevant portion of the reserve is transferred to the income statement.

 

(f)  The share buy-back reserve represents the par value of BHP Billiton Plc shares which were purchased and subsequently cancelled. The cancellation of the shares creates a non-distributable reserve.

 

(g)  The non-controlling interest contribution reserve represents the excess of consideration received over the book value of net assets attributable to the equity instruments when acquired by non-controlling interests.

 

F-57


Table of Contents

Summarised financial information relating to each of the Group’s subsidiaries with non-controlling interests (NCI) that are material to the Group, before any intra-group eliminations, is shown below:

 

2014

US$M

  BHP Iron
Ore
(Jimblebar)
Pty Ltd (a)
    Minera
Escondida
Limitada
    Samancor
Holdings
(Proprietary)
Limited
    Groote
Eylandt
Mining
Company
Pty Ltd
    Other
individually
immaterial
subsidiaries
    Intra-group
eliminations
    Total  

BHP Billiton share (per cent)

    85.0        57.5        60.0        60.0         
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

       

Current assets (b)

    626        2,793        17        154         

Non-current assets (b)

    4,006        10,803        1,175        1,178         

Current liabilities

    (495     (1,034     (7     (125      

Non-current liabilities

    (1,481     (2,075            (225      
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

       

Net assets

    2,656        10,487        1,185        982         
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net assets attributable to NCI

    388        4,457        474        393        529        (2     6,239   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Revenue

    994        8,706               990         

Profit after taxation

    204        3,007        (1     261         

Other comprehensive income

                                 
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

       

Total comprehensive income

    204        3,007        (1     261         
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Profit after taxation attributable to NCI

    22        1,278               104        (9     (3     1,392   

Other comprehensive income attributable to NCI

                                                

Dividends paid to NCI

           74               120        58               252   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

2013

US$M

                                         

BHP Billiton share (per cent)

    100.0        57.5        60.0        60.0         
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

       

Current assets (b)

           2,597        18        635         

Non-current assets (b)

           8,361        1,175        1,085         

Current liabilities

           (1,384     (6     (543      

Non-current liabilities

           (1,911            (156      
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

       

Net assets

           7,663        1,187        1,021         
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net assets attributable to NCI

           3,253        475        408        486        2        4,624   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Revenue

           8,826               935         

Profit after taxation

           3,309        (5     349         

Other comprehensive income

                                 
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

       

Total comprehensive income

           3,309        (5     349         
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Profit after taxation attributable to NCI

           1,406        (2     108        70        15        1,597   

Other comprehensive income attributable to NCI

                                2               2   

Dividends paid to NCI

           782               32        23               837   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-58


Table of Contents

2012

US$M

  BHP Iron
Ore
(Jimblebar)
Pty Ltd (a)
    Minera
Escondida
Limitada
    Samancor
Holdings
(Proprietary)
Limited
    Groote
Eylandt
Mining
Company
Pty Ltd
    Other
individually
immaterial
subsidiaries
    Intra-group
eliminations
    Total  

BHP Billiton share (per cent)

    100.0        57.5        60.0        60.0         
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

       

Revenue

           7,155               798         

Profit after taxation

           2,506        (21     186         

Other comprehensive income

                                 
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total comprehensive income

           2,506        (21     186         
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

       

Profit after taxation attributable to NCI

           1,065        (11     74        5        11        1,144   

Other comprehensive income attributable to NCI

                                2               2   

Dividends paid to NCI

           287               48        8               343   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(a)  The Group has an effective interest of 92.5 per cent in BHP Iron Ore (Jimblebar) Pty Ltd, however by virtue of the shareholder agreement with ITOCHU Minerals & Energy of Australia Pty Ltd and Mitsui & Co. Iron Ore Exploration & Mining Pty Ltd, our interest in the Jimblebar mining operation is 85 per cent which is consistent with the other respective joint operations at Western Australia Iron Ore.

 

(b)  Whilst the Group controls these subsidiaries, the non-controlling interests hold certain protective rights which restrict the Group’s ability to sell assets held by these subsidiaries, or use the assets in other subsidiaries and operations owned by the Group. These subsidiaries are also restricted from paying dividends without the approval of the non-controlling interests.

21    Contingent liabilities

Contingent liabilities at balance date, not otherwise provided for in the financial statements, are categorised as arising from:

 

     2014      2013  
     US$M      US$M  

Associates and joint ventures

     

Bank guarantees (a)

               

Actual or potential litigation (b)

     1,651         1,390   

Other

     11         8   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total associates and joint ventures

     1,662         1,398   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Subsidiaries and joint operations

     

Bank guarantees (a)

     23         24   

Actual or potential litigation (b)

     1,602         1,313   

Other

     89         48   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total subsidiaries and joint operations

     1,714         1,385   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total contingent liabilities

     3,376         2,783   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(a)  The Group has entered into various counter-indemnities of bank and performance guarantees related to its own future performance in the normal course of business.

 

(b) 

Actual or potential litigation, including tax-related amounts, predominantly relate to a number of actions against the Group, none of which are individually significant and where the liability is not probable and

 

F-59


Table of Contents
  therefore the Group has not provided for such amounts in these financial statements. Additionally, there are a number of legal claims or potential claims against the Group, the outcome of which cannot be foreseen at present, and for which no amounts have been included in the table above.

In addition to the amounts reported above, following requests for information in August 2009 from the US Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC), the Group commenced an internal investigation and disclosed to relevant authorities evidence that it has uncovered regarding possible violations of applicable anti-corruption laws involving interactions with government officials.

The issues relate primarily to matters in connection with previously terminated exploration and development efforts, as well as hospitality provided as part of the Company’s sponsorship of the 2008 Beijing Olympics. The Group is currently discussing a potential resolution of the matter.

As has been publicly reported, the Australian Federal Police has indicated that it has commenced an investigation and the Group continues to fully cooperate with the relevant authorities.

In light of the continuing nature of the investigations it is not appropriate at this stage for BHP Billiton to predict outcomes, and therefore no amount has been included in the contingent liabilities above.

22    Commitments

 

     2014     2013  
     US$M     US$M  

Capital expenditure commitments

     4,798        5,175   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Lease expenditure commitments

    

Finance leases (a)

    

Due not later than one year

     203        59   

Due later than one year and not later than two years

     195        56   

Due later than two years and not later than three years

     193        50   

Due later than three years and not later than four years

     163        47   

Due later than four years and not later than five years

     153        19   

Due later than five years

     1,709        36   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total commitments under finance leases

     2,616        267   

Future financing charges

     (1,174     (57

Right to reimbursement from joint operations partner

     (58     (73
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Finance lease liability

     1,384        137   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating leases (b)

    

Due not later than one year

     833        973   

Due later than one year and not later than two years

     560        774   

Due later than two years and not later than three years

     433        561   

Due later than three years and not later than four years

     227        406   

Due later than four years and not later than five years

     202        211   

Due later than five years

     1,272        1,466   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total commitments under operating leases

     3,527        4,391   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(a)  Finance leases include leases of power generation and transmission assets. Lease payments are subject to inflation escalation clauses on which contingent rentals are determined. The leases contain extension and renewal options.

 

(b)  Operating leases include leases of property, plant and equipment. Rental payments are generally fixed, but with inflation escalation clauses on which contingent rentals are determined. Certain leases contain extension and renewal options.

 

F-60


Table of Contents

23    Notes to the consolidated cash flow statement

Cash and cash equivalents

For the purpose of the consolidated cash flow statement, cash equivalents include highly liquid investments that are readily convertible to cash and with a maturity of less than 90 days, bank overdrafts and interest bearing liabilities at call.

 

    2014     2013     2012  
    US$M     US$M     US$M  

Cash and cash equivalents comprise:

     

Cash

    1,726        2,521        1,206   

Short-term deposits

    7,077        3,156        3,268   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total cash and cash equivalents (a) (b)

    8,803        5,677        4,474   

Bank overdrafts and short-term borrowings – refer to note 16 Interest bearing liabilities

    (51     (10     (20
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total cash and cash equivalents, net of overdrafts

    8,752        5,667        4,454   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(a) Cash and cash equivalents include US$738 million (2013: US$674 million; 2012: US$326 million) which is restricted by legal or contractual arrangements. This amount includes contributions made during the period of US$100 million (2013: US$106 million) to the BHP Billiton Foundation and US$ nil to BHP Billiton Sustainable Communities Trust (2013: US$ nil). These trusts hold US$342 million of cash and cash equivalents that can only be used to fund community development programmes and is not available for use by the wider Group (2013: US$284 million).

 

(b) Cash and cash equivalents include US$600 million (2013: US$794 million) which is subject to restrictions imposed by governments where approval is required to repatriate cash out of a country.

Significant non-cash investing and financing transactions

Property, plant and equipment of US$1,268 million (2013: US$ nil; 2012: US$28 million) was acquired under finance leases.

Property, plant and equipment of US$ nil (2013: US$49 million; 2012: US$ nil) was acquired under vendor financing arrangements.

Divestment of subsidiaries, operations, joint operations and equity accounted investments

The Group disposed of the following subsidiaries, operations, joint operations and equity accounted investments during the year ended:

30 June 2014

 

  Pinto Valley and San Manuel Arizona Railroad Company

 

  Liverpool Bay

 

  South Midland (Onshore US – Midland Basin)

 

  Kelar SA

30 June 2013

 

  Richards Bay Minerals

 

  EKATI

 

F-61


Table of Contents

30 June 2012

 

  Gulf of Mexico assets – West Cameron, Starlifter and Mustang

Details of the divestment of subsidiaries, operations, joint operations and equity accounted investments are as follows:

 

     2014     2013     2012  
     US$M     US$M     US$M  

Assets

      

Cash and cash equivalents

            51          

Trade and other receivables

     2        1          

Other financial assets

     2                 

Investments accounted for using the equity method

                     

Inventories

     74        209          

Property, plant and equipment

     452        668        1   

Intangible assets

     23                 

Deferred tax assets

     3        77          
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total assets

     556        1,006        1   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Liabilities

      

Trade and other payables

     (62     (10       

Current tax payable

     (2     (3       

Provisions

     (320     (302     (14

Deferred tax liabilities

            (138       

Deferred income

     (27              
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities

     (411     (453     (14
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net assets/(liabilities) disposed

     145        553        (13
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Less non-controlling interest share of net assets disposed

                     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

BHP Billiton share of net assets/(liabilities) disposed

     145        553        (13
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Gross cash consideration

     812        2,253        6   

Less cash and cash equivalents disposed

            (51       
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash consideration received

     812        2,202        6   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Less repayment of intercompany loan (a)

            (488       

Add deferred consideration

     6                 
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Gains on sale of subsidiaries, operations, joint operations and equity accounted investments

     673        1,212        19   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(a)  Repayment of intercompany financing facilities which became external upon transition to IFRS 11 ‘Joint Arrangements’.

Acquisition of subsidiaries and operations

In addition to the business combinations described in note 24 ‘Business combinations’, the Group acquired the following subsidiaries and operations during the year ended:

30 June 2014

There were no acquisitions of subsidiaries or operations.

 

F-62


Table of Contents

30 June 2013

There were no acquisitions of subsidiaries or operations.

30 June 2012

 

  CEU Hawkville LLC

Details of the acquisitions of subsidiaries and operations, excluding those acquired through business combinations, refer to note 24 ‘Business combinations’, are as follows:

 

     2014      2013      2012  
     US$M      US$M      US$M  

Assets

        

Trade and other receivables

                     3   

Other current assets

                     3   

Property, plant and equipment

                     89   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Assets acquired

                     95   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Cash consideration paid

         –             –         95   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Sale of non-controlling interest in subsidiary

30 June 2014

On 20 June 2013, BHP Billiton announced an extension of its long-term WAIO joint venture relationship with ITOCHU Corporation (ITOCHU) and Mitsui & Co., Ltd. (Mitsui). The transaction was completed on 10 July 2013 and aligned interests across the WAIO supply chain. Under the terms of the agreement, ITOCHU and Mitsui purchased shares in BHP Iron Ore (Jimblebar) Pty Ltd providing them with an eight per cent and seven per cent non-controlling interest (NCI), respectively, in the Jimblebar mining hub and resource. The equity proceeds of US$1,337 million is included in the ‘Contributions from non-controlling interests’ item of the Consolidated Cash Flow Statement. The difference of US$971 million between the equity proceeds and the initial measurement of NCI of US$366 million is included in the non-controlling interest contribution reserve.

30 June 2013

There were no sales of interests in subsidiaries to non-controlling interests.

30 June 2012

There were no sales of interests in subsidiaries to non-controlling interests.

24    Business combinations

Major business combinations completed during the year ended 30 June 2014

There were no major business combinations.

Major business combinations completed during the year ended 30 June 2013

There were no major business combinations.

 

F-63


Table of Contents

Major business combinations completed during the year ended 30 June 2012

The following business combinations were completed during the year.

Petrohawk Energy Corporation

In August 2011, the Group acquired all of the issued shares and outstanding shares of Petrohawk Energy Corporation Inc. (Petrohawk) for total consideration of US$12,005 million.

Petrohawk is an oil and natural gas company based in the United States. It owns a number of shale gas assets in Texas and Louisiana and associated midstream pipeline systems. This acquisition provides the Group with operated positions in the resource areas of the Eagle Ford, the Permian Basin and Haynesville.

Goodwill of US$3,591 million has been recognised in respect of the acquisition. The goodwill is attributable to the expected synergies to be realised through managing the portfolio of both the acquired assets and the Group’s existing assets, and to the measurement of deferred income taxes based on nominal amounts rather than fair value.

HWE Mining

On 30 September 2011, the Group acquired the HWE mining services business (HWE Mining) for total consideration of US$449 million.

The acquisition relates to the mining equipment and related assets that serviced the Area C, Yandi and Orebody 23/25 operations and is consistent with the Group’s previously stated intention to move the WAIO business from contract mining to owner-operator mining.

Goodwill of US$187 million has been recognised in respect of the acquisition. The goodwill is attributable to the skilled workforce and the expected synergies to result from an in-house mining workforce, improved safety and the management of costs.

25    Assets and liabilities held for sale

The Group classified the following subsidiaries and operations as held for sale during the year ended:

30 June 2014

There were no assets or liabilities held for sale at 30 June 2014.

30 June 2013

Pinto Valley

On 29 April 2013, the Group signed a definitive agreement to sell its Pinto Valley mining operation (Pinto Valley) and the associated San Manuel Arizona Railroad Company (SMARRCO) to Capstone Mining Corp. The sale completed on 11 October 2013 for a total cash consideration of US$653 million.

Diamonds business

On 13 November 2012, the Group announced the sale of its diamonds business, comprising its interests in the EKATI Diamond Mine and Diamond Marketing operations to Dominion Diamond Corporation (formerly Harry Winston Diamond Corporation). The sale completed on 10 April 2013 for a total amount paid of US$553 million, comprising of a purchase price of US$500 million plus purchase price adjustments of US$53 million.

 

F-64


Table of Contents

East and West Browse Joint Ventures

On 12 December 2012, the Group signed a definitive agreement to sell its 8.33 per cent interest in the East Browse Joint Venture and 20 per cent interest in the West Browse Joint Venture to PetroChina International Investment (Australia) Pty Ltd. The sale completed on 7 June 2013 for a total cash consideration of US$1.70 billion, comprising of a purchase price of US$1.63 billion and purchase price adjustments of US$0.07 billion.

The remaining assets and liabilities classified as current assets and liabilities held for sale are presented in the table below:

 

     2014      2013  
     US$M      US$M  

Assets

     

Trade and other receivables

             17   

Inventories

             43   

Property, plant and equipment

             223   

Deferred tax assets

             3   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total assets

         –         286   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Liabilities

     

Trade and other payables

             41   

Current tax payable

             2   

Provisions

             177   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total liabilities

             220   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net assets

             66   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

There were no assets or liabilities held for sale at 30 June 2014. Amounts presented for 30 June 2013 represented the assets and liabilities of the Pinto Valley mining operation and the associated San Manuel Arizona Railroad Company.

26    Subsidiaries

Significant subsidiaries of the Group, which are those with the most significant contribution to the Group’s net profit or net assets, are as follows:

 

            Effective
interest
 

Significant subsidiaries (a)

  Country of
incorporation
 

Principal activity

  2014
%
    2013
%
 

BHP Billiton Aluminium Australia Pty Ltd

  Australia   Bauxite mining and alumina refining     100        100   

BHP Billiton Aluminium (RAA) Pty Ltd

  Australia   Bauxite mining and alumina refining     100        100   

BHP Billiton Aluminium (Worsley) Pty Ltd

  Australia   Bauxite mining and alumina refining     100        100   

BHP Billiton Canada Inc.

  Canada   Diamond mining and potash pre-development     100        100   

BHP Billiton Direct Reduced Iron Pty Ltd

  Australia   Hot briquette iron plant (closed)     100        100   

BHP Billiton Energy Coal South Africa Proprietary Limited (b)

  South Africa   Coal mining     100        100   

BHP Billiton Finance BV

  Netherlands   Finance     100        100   

BHP Billiton Finance Ltd

  Australia   Finance     100        100   

BHP Billiton Finance (USA) Ltd (c)

  Australia   Finance     100        100   

BHP Billiton Freight Singapore Pte Limited

  Singapore   Freight services     100        100   

 

F-65


Table of Contents
            Effective
interest
 

Significant subsidiaries (a)

  Country of
incorporation
 

Principal activity

  2014
%
    2013
%
 

BHP Billiton Group Operations Pty Ltd

  Australia   Administrative services     100        100   

BHP Billiton International Services Limited

  UK   Service company     100        100   

BHP Billiton International Trading (Shanghai) Co., Ltd.

  China   Marketing and logistic services     100        100   

BHP Billiton IO Mining Pty Ltd

  Australia   Holding company     100        100   

BHP Billiton Iron Ore Pty Ltd

  Australia   Service company     100        100   

BHP Billiton Marketing AG

  Switzerland   Marketing and trading     100        100   

BHP Billiton Marketing Asia Pte Ltd.

  Singapore   Marketing support and services     100        100   

BHP Billiton Marketing Inc.

  US   Marketing and trading     100        100   

BHP Billiton Metais SA

  Brazil   Alumina refining and aluminium smelting     100        100   

BHP Billiton MetCoal Holdings Pty Ltd

  Australia   Holding company     100        100   

BHP Billiton Minerals Pty Ltd

  Australia   Iron ore, coal, silver, lead and zinc mining     100        100   

BHP Billiton Mitsui Coal Pty Ltd

  Australia   Coal mining     80        80   

BHP Billiton New Mexico Coal Inc.

  US   Holding company     100        100   

BHP Billiton Nickel West Pty Ltd

  Australia   Nickel mining, smelting, refining and administrative services     100        100   

BHP Billiton Olympic Dam Corporation Pty Ltd

  Australia   Copper and uranium mining     100        100   

BHP Billiton Petroleum (Americas) Inc.

  US   Hydrocarbons exploration and production     100        100   

BHP Billiton Petroleum (Arkansas) Inc.

  US   Hydrocarbons production     100        100   

BHP Billiton Petroleum (Australia) Pty Ltd

  Australia   Hydrocarbons production     100        100   

BHP Billiton Petroleum (Bass Strait) Pty Ltd

  Australia   Hydrocarbons production     100        100   

BHP Billiton Petroleum (Deepwater) Inc.

  US   Hydrocarbons exploration, development and production     100        100   

BHP Billiton Petroleum (Eagle Ford Gathering) LLC

  US   Hydrocarbons exploration and production     75        75   

BHP Billiton Petroleum (Fayetteville) LLC

  US   Hydrocarbons exploration and production     100        100   

BHP Billiton Petroleum (International Exploration) Pty Ltd

  Australia   Hydrocarbons development and production     100        100   

BHP Billiton Petroleum (KCS Resources), LLC

  US   Hydrocarbons exploration and production     100        100   

BHP Billiton Petroleum (New Ventures) Corporation

  Canada   Hydrocarbons exploration and production     100        100   

BHP Billiton Petroleum (North West Shelf) Pty Ltd

  Australia   Hydrocarbons production     100        100   

BHP Billiton Petroleum (Sabah) Corporation

  Canada   Hydrocarbons exploration and production     100        100   

BHP Billiton Petroleum (Tx Gathering) LLC

  US   Hydrocarbons exploration and production     100        100   

BHP Billiton Petroleum (Victoria) Pty Ltd

  Australia   Hydrocarbons development     100        100   

BHP Billiton Petroleum Great Britain Limited

  UK   Hydrocarbons production     100        100   

BHP Billiton Petroleum Properties (N.A.) LP

  US   Hydrocarbons exploration and production     100        100   

BHP Billiton Petroleum Pty Ltd

  Australia   Hydrocarbons exploration and production     100        100   

BHP Billiton SA Limited

  South Africa   Holding and service company     100        100   

BHP Billiton Shared Services Malaysia Sdn. Bhd.

  Malaysia   Service company     100        100   

BHP Billiton SSM Development Pty Ltd

  Australia   Holding company     100        100   

BHP Billiton (Trinidad – 2C) Ltd

  Canada   Hydrocarbons development     100        100   

BHP Chile Inc.

  Chile   Service company     100        100   

BHP Coal Pty Ltd

  Australia   Holding company and coal mining     100        100   

BHP Copper Inc.

  US   Copper mining, development and reclamation     100        100   

BHP Escondida Inc.

  US   Holding company     100        100   

BHP Iron Ore (Jimblebar) Pty Ltd (d)

  Australia   Iron ore mining     85        100   

 

F-66


Table of Contents
            Effective
interest
 

Significant subsidiaries (a)

  Country of
incorporation
 

Principal activity

  2014
%
    2013
%
 

BHP Navajo Coal Company (e)

  US   Coal mining            100   

BHP Petroleum (Pakistan) Pty Ltd

  Australia   Hydrocarbons production     100        100   

BHP Queensland Coal Investments Pty Ltd

  Australia   Holding company and coal mining     100        100   

Billiton Aluminium SA (Pty) Limited

  South Africa   Aluminium smelting     100        100   

Broken Hill Proprietary (USA) Inc.

  US   Service company     100        100   

Cerro Matoso SA

  Colombia   Nickel mining and ferronickel smelting     99.9        99.9   

Compania Minera Cerro Colorado Limitada

  Chile   Copper mining     100        100   

Dendrobium Coal Pty Ltd

  Australia   Coal mining     100        100   

Endeavour Coal Pty Ltd

  Australia   Coal mining     100        100   

Groote Eylandt Mining Company Pty Ltd

  Australia   Manganese mining     60        60   

Hillside Aluminium (Pty) Limited

  South Africa   Aluminium smelting     100        100   

Hotazel Manganese Mines (Proprietary) Limited (b)

  South Africa   Manganese ore mining and processing     54.6        54.6   

Hunter Valley Energy Coal Pty Ltd

  Australia   Coal mining     100        100   

Illawarra Coal Holdings Pty Ltd

  Australia   Coal mining     100        100   

Illawarra Services Pty Ltd

  Australia   Coal mining     100        100   

Minera Escondida Limitada (f)

  Chile   Copper mining     57.5        57.5   

Minera Spence SA

  Chile   Copper mining     100        100   

Petrohawk Energy Corporation

  US   Hydrocarbons exploration and production     100        100   

PT Lahai Coal

  Indonesia   Coal exploration     75        75   

Rio Algom Limited

  Canada   Holding Company     100        100   

Samancor AG

  Switzerland   Marketing     60        60   

Samancor Manganese (Proprietary) Limited

  South Africa   Manganese mining and manganese alloys     60        60   

San Juan Coal Company

  US   Coal mining     100        100   

Tasmanian Electro Metallurgical Company Pty Ltd

  Australia   Manganese alloys     60        60   

UMAL Consolidated Pty Ltd

  Australia   Holding company and coal mining     100        100   

Winwell Resources LLC

  US   Holding company     100        100   

WMC Finance (USA) Limited

  Australia   Finance     100        100   

 

(a) A complete list of the Group’s subsidiaries will be attached to BHP Billiton Plc’s annual return made to the UK Registrar of Companies.

 

(b) The Group’s effective interest in BHP Billiton Energy Coal South Africa Proprietary Limited will reduce to 90 per cent and effective interest in Hotazel Manganese Mines (Proprietary) Limited will reduce to 44.4 per cent pursuant to Broad-Based Black Economic Empowerment transactions in South Africa.

 

(c) The BHP Billiton Finance (USA) Ltd is 100 per cent owned by BHP Billiton Limited. BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc have each fully and unconditionally guaranteed BHP Billiton Finance (USA) Ltd’s debt securities.

 

(d) The Group has an effective interest of 92.5 per cent in BHP Iron Ore (Jimblebar) Pty Ltd, however by virtue of the shareholder agreement with ITOCHU Minerals & Energy of Australia Pty Ltd and Mitsui & Co. Iron Ore Exploration & Mining Pty Ltd, our interest in the Jimblebar mining operation is 85 per cent which is consistent with the other respective joint operations at Western Australia Iron Ore.

 

(e) The Group divested its 100 per cent effective interest in BHP Navajo Coal Company in October 2013 but will remain as the manager and operator of Navajo Mine through to 2016. As BHP Billiton will retain control of the mine until full consideration is received from the buyer, the financial results of the Navajo mine will continue to be consolidated by the Group.

 

(f)

As the Group has the ability to direct the relevant activities at Minera Escondida Limitada, it has control over the entity. The assessment of the most relevant activity in this contractual arrangement is subject to

 

F-67


Table of Contents
  judgement. The Group establishes the mine plan and the operating budget and has the ability to appoint the key management personnel, demonstrating that the Group has the existing rights to direct the relevant activities of Minera Escondida Limitada.

27    Investments accounted for using the equity method

The Group’s interests in equity accounted investments with the most significant contribution to the Group’s net profit or net assets are listed below:

 

                               

Shareholdings in
associates and joint
ventures (a) (b)

 

Country of
incorporation
/principal place
of business

  Associate or
joint venture
 

Principal activity

  Reporting
date (c)
    Ownership
interest (c)
 
          2014
%
    2013
%
 

Caesar Oil Pipeline Company LLC (Caesar) (d)

  US   Associate   Hydrocarbons transportation     31 May        25        25   
Cleopatra Gas Gathering Company LLC (Cleopatra) (d)   US   Associate   Hydrocarbons transportation     31 May        22        22   

Compañía Minera Antamina SA (Antamina) (d)

  Peru   Associate   Copper and zinc mining     30 June        33.75        33.75   

Samarco Mineração SA (Samarco)

  Brazil   Joint venture   Iron ore mining     31 December        50        50   

Carbones del Cerrejón LLC (Cerrejón) (d)

  Anguilla/ Colombia   Associate   Coal mining in Colombia     31 December        33.33        33.33   
Newcastle Coal Infrastructure Group Pty Limited (NCIG) (d)   Australia   Associate   Coal export terminal     30 June        35.5        35.5   

Richards Bay Minerals (e)

  South Africa   Joint venture   Minerals sands mining processing     31 December                 

 

(a)  A complete list of investments in associates and joint ventures will be attached to BHP Billiton Plc’s annual return made to the UK Registrar of Companies.

 

(b)  The Group is restricted in its ability to make dividend payments from its investments in associates and joint ventures as any such payments require the approval of all investors in the associates and joint ventures.

 

(c)  The ownership interest at the Group’s and the associates’ or joint ventures’ reporting dates are the same. When the annual financial reporting date is different to the Group’s, financial information is obtained as at 30 June in order to report on an annual basis consistent with the Group’s reporting date.

 

(d)  Voting in relation to relevant activities, determined to be the approval of the operating and capital budgets, does not require unanimous consent of all participants to the arrangement, therefore joint control does not exist. Instead, because the Group has the power to participate in the financial and operating policies of the investee, these investments are accounted for as associates.

 

(e)  Richards Bay Minerals comprises two legal entities, Richards Bay Mining (Proprietary) Limited and Richards Bay Titanium (Proprietary) Limited, in each of which the Group had a 50 per cent interest and which function as a single economic entity. After deducting non-controlling interests in subsidiaries of Richards Bay Minerals, the Group’s effective interest in the operations of Richards Bay Minerals was 37.76 per cent up to the date of its effective disposal on 3 September 2012.

 

F-68


Table of Contents

Year ended 30 June 2014

  Investment in
associates
    Investment in joint
ventures
    Total equity accounted
investments
 
    US$M     US$M     US$M  

At the beginning of the financial year

    2,631        1,044        3,675   

Share of operating profit of equity accounted investments

    588        607        1,195   

Investment in equity accounted investments

    44               44   

Dividends received from equity accounted investments

    (669     (581     (1,250

Other

    1        (1       
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

At the end of the financial year

    2,595        1,069        3,664   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

Year ended 30 June 2013

   Investment in
associates
    Investment in joint
ventures
    Total equity accounted
investments
 
     US$M     US$M     US$M  

At the beginning of the financial year

     2,305        876        3,181   

Share of operating profit of equity accounted investments

     616        526        1,142   

Investment in equity accounted investments

     84               84   

Dividends received from equity accounted investments

     (363     (347     (710

Other

     (11     (11     (22
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

At the end of the financial year

     2,631        1,044        3,675   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-69


Table of Contents

The following table summarises the financial information relating to each of the Group’s significant equity accounted investments:

 

     Associates     Joint ventures      Total  

2014

   Antamina     Cerrejón     Individually
immaterial
    Samarco     Individually
immaterial
    
     US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M      US$M  

Current assets

     953        1,030          1,216  (a)      

Non-current assets

     4,060        2,992          5,937        

Current liabilities

     (465     (268       (1,637 ) (b)      

Non-current liabilities

     (668     (812       (4,310 ) (c)      
  

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

      

Net assets – 100%

     3,880        2,942          1,206       
  

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

      

Net assets – BHP Billiton share

     1,309        981          603       

Adjustments to net assets related to accounting policy adjustments

     32        84          466        
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Carrying amount of investments accounted for using the equity method

     1,341       1,065        189        1,069            –         3,664   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Revenue – 100%

     3,736       2,444          3,269       

Profit/(loss) from operations – 100%

     1,414       373          1,337  (d)      
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Share of operating profit/(loss) of equity accounted investments (e)

     476       115        (3 )     607              1,195   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Comprehensive income – 100%

     1,414       373          1,337       
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Share of comprehensive income – BHP Billiton share in equity accounted investments

     476       115        (3 )     607              1,195   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Dividends received from equity accounted investments

     446       187        36       581              1,250   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

F-70


Table of Contents
    Associates     Joint ventures        

2013

  Antamina     Cerrejón     Individually
immaterial
    Samarco     Individually
immaterial
    Total  
    US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M  

Current assets

    1,108        1,166          883 (a)     

Non-current assets

    3,596        2,886          4,997       

Current liabilities

    (350     (239       (1,558 ) (b)     

Non-current liabilities

    (569     (682       (3,134 ) (c)     
 

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

     

Net assets – 100%

    3,785        3,131          1,188       
 

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

     

Net assets – BHP Billiton share

    1,277        1,043          594       

Adjustments to net assets related to accounting policy adjustments

    34        94          450       
 

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

     

Carrying amount of investments accounted for using the equity method

    1,311        1,137        183       1,044               3,675   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Revenue – 100%

    3,836        2,482          3,219       

Profit/(loss) from operations – 100%

    1,490        378          1,365  (d)     
 

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

     

 

 

 

Share of operating profit/(loss) of equity accounted investments (e)

    531        117        (32 )     513       13        1,142   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Comprehensive income – 100%

    1,490        378          1,365      
 

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

     

 

 

 

Share of comprehensive income – BHP Billiton share in equity accounted investments

    531       117        (32 )     513       13        1,142   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Dividends received from equity accounted investments

    261       69        33       345       2        710   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
    Associates     Joint ventures        

2012

  Antamina     Cerrejón     Individually
immaterial
    Samarco     Individually
immaterial
    Total  
    US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M  

Revenue – 100%

    3,656       3,256         3,963      

Profit/(loss) from operations – 100%

    1,618       906         1,783  (d)     
 

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

     

Share of operating profit/(loss) of equity accounted investments

    614       294       (35 )     909       87       1,869  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Comprehensive income – 100%

    1,618       906         1,783      
 

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

     

Share of comprehensive income – BHP Billiton share in equity accounted investments

    614       294       (35     909       87       1,869  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Dividends received from equity accounted investments

    203       107       39       338       25       712  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(a)  Includes cash and cash equivalents of US$571 million (2013: US$212 million).

 

(b)  Includes current financial liabilities (excluding trade and other payables and provisions) of US$369 million (2013: US$1,359 million).

 

(c)  Includes non-current financial liabilities (excluding trade and other payables and provisions) of US$3,961 million (2013: US$2,939 million).

 

(d)  Includes depreciation and amortisation of US$113 million (2013: US$121 million; 2012: US$110 million), interest income of US$6 million (2013: US$3 million; 2012: US$ nil), interest expense of US$181 million (2013: US$54 million; 2012: US$53 million) and income tax expense of US$207 million (2013: US$317 million; 2012: US$472 million).

 

F-71


Table of Contents
(e)  The unrecognised share of losses for the period was US$66 million (2013: profit of US$52 million) which increased the cumulative losses to US$199 million (2013: decrease to US$133 million).

 

     Group share  
     2014      2013  
     US$M      US$M  

Share of contingent liabilities relating to joint ventures

     1,547         1,299   

Share of commitments relating to joint ventures

     2,024         2,095   

28    Interests in joint operations

Significant joint operations of the Group, which are those with the most significant contributions to the Group’s net profit or net assets, are as follows:

 

            Effective interest  

Significant joint
operations

 

Country of
operation

 

Principal activity

  2014
%
    2013
%
 

Atlantis

  US   Hydrocarbons exploration and production     44        44   

Bass Strait

  Australia   Hydrocarbons production     50        50   

Greater Angostura

  Trinidad and Tobago   Hydrocarbons production     45        45   

Liverpool Bay (a)

  UK   Hydrocarbons production            46.1   

Macedon (b)

  Australia   Hydrocarbons exploration and production     71.43        71.43   

Mad Dog

  US   Hydrocarbons exploration and production     23.9        23.9   

Minerva (b)

  Australia   Hydrocarbons exploration and production     90        90   

Neptune

  US   Hydrocarbons exploration and production     35        35   

North West Shelf

  Australia   Hydrocarbons production     8.33 – 16.67        8.33 – 16.67   

Onshore US (b)

  US   Hydrocarbons exploration and production     <0.1 – 100        <0.1 – 100   

Pyrenees (b)

  Australia   Hydrocarbons exploration and production     40 – 71.43        40 – 71.43   

ROD Integrated Development

  Algeria   Hydrocarbons exploration and production     38 – 45        38 – 45   

Shenzi

  US   Hydrocarbons exploration and production     44        44   

Stybarrow

  Australia   Hydrocarbons exploration and production     50        50   

Zamzama

  Pakistan   Hydrocarbons exploration and production     38.5        38.5   

Mt Goldsworthy (c)

  Australia   Iron ore mining     85        85   

Mt Newman (c)

  Australia   Iron ore mining     85        85   

Yandi (c)

  Australia   Iron ore mining     85        85   

Central Queensland Coal Associates

  Australia   Coal mining     50        50   

Gregory

  Australia   Coal mining     50        50   

Phola Coal Processing Plant (Pty) Ltd (d)

  South Africa   Coal handling and processing plant     50        50   

Alumar

  Brazil   Alumina refining     36        36   
    Aluminium smelting     40        40   

Mozal SARL (d)

  Mozambique   Aluminium smelting     47.1        47.1   

Worsley (b)

  Australia   Bauxite mining and alumina refining     86        86   

EKATI (e)

  Canada   Diamond mining              

 

(a)  The Group divested its 46.1 per cent interest in Liverpool Bay effective 31 March 2014.

 

F-72


Table of Contents
(b)  Whilst the Group holds a greater than 50 per cent interest in these joint operations, all the participants in these joint operations approve the operating and capital budgets and therefore the Group has joint control over the relevant activities of these arrangements.

 

(c)  These contractual arrangements are controlled by the Group and do not meet the definition of joint operations. However, as they are formed by contractual arrangement and are not entities, the Group recognises its share of assets, liabilities, revenue and expenses arising from these arrangements.

 

(d)  These joint arrangements are separate vehicles however they are classified as joint operations as the participants to the arrangements are entitled to receive output, not dividends, from the arrangements.

 

(e)  The Group divested its 80 per cent interest in EKATI effective 10 April 2013.

 

(f)  Assets held in joint operations subject to significant restrictions are as follows:

 

     Group share  
     2014      2013  
     US$M      US$M  

Current assets

     6,112         3,899   

Non-current assets

     77,341         78,363   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total assets (i)

     83,453         82,262   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

  (i)  Whilst the Group is unrestricted in its ability to sell a share of its interest in these joint operations, it does not have the right to sell individual assets which are used in these joint operations without the unanimous consent of the other participants. The assets in these joint operations are also restricted to the extent that they are only available to be used by the joint operation itself and not by other operations of the Group.

29    Financial risk management

Financial risk management strategy

The financial risks arising from the Group’s operations comprise market, liquidity and credit risk. These risks arise in the normal course of business, and the Group manages its exposure to them in accordance with the Group’s portfolio risk management strategy. The objective of the strategy is to support the delivery of the Group’s financial targets while protecting its future financial security and flexibility by taking advantage of the natural diversification provided by the scale, diversity and flexibility of the Group’s operations and activities.

A Cash Flow at Risk (CFaR) framework is used to measure the aggregate and diversified impact of financial risks upon the Group’s financial targets. The principal measurement of risk is CFaR measured on a portfolio basis, which is defined as the worst expected loss relative to projected business plan cash flows over a one-year horizon under normal market conditions at a confidence level of 95 per cent.

Market risk

The Group’s activities expose it to market risks associated with movements in interest rates, foreign currencies and commodity prices. Under the strategy outlined above, the Group seeks to achieve financing costs, currency impacts, input costs and commodity prices on a floating or index basis. This strategy gives rise to a risk of variability in earnings which is measured under the CFaR framework.

 

F-73


Table of Contents

In executing the strategy, financial instruments are potentially employed in three distinct but related activities. The following table summarises these activities and the key risk management processes:

 

Activity

 

Key risk management processes

1       Risk mitigation

   
On an exception basis, hedging for the purposes of mitigating risk related to specific and significant expenditure on investments or capital projects will be executed if necessary to support the Group’s strategic objectives.     Execution of transactions within approved mandates.

2       Economic hedging of commodity sales, operating costs and debt instruments

   
Where Group commodity production is sold to customers on pricing terms that deviate from the relevant index target, and where a relevant derivatives market exists, financial instruments may be executed as an economic hedge to align the revenue price exposure with the index target.     Measuring and reporting the exposure in customer commodity contracts and issued debt instruments.
Where debt is issued in a currency other than the US dollar and/or at a fixed interest rate, fair value and cash flow hedges may be executed to align the debt exposure with the Group’s functional currency of US dollars and/or to swap to a floating interest rate. As part of this strategy swaptions may also be used.     Executing hedging derivatives to align the total group exposure to the index target.

3       Strategic financial transactions

   
Opportunistic transactions may be executed with financial instruments to capture value from perceived market over/under valuations.     Exposures managed within value at risk and stop loss limits.
    Execution of transactions within approved mandates.

Primary responsibility for identification and control of financial risks, including authorising and monitoring the use of financial instruments for the above activities and stipulating policy thereon, rests with the Financial Risk Management Committee under authority delegated by the Group Management Committee.

Interest rate risk

The Group is exposed to interest rate risk on its outstanding borrowings and investments from the possibility that changes in interest rates will affect future cash flows or the fair value of fixed interest rate financial instruments. Interest rate risk is managed as part of the portfolio risk management strategy.

The majority of the Group’s debt is raised under central borrowing programs. The Group has entered into interest rate swaps and cross currency interest rate swaps to convert most of the centrally managed debt into US dollar floating interest rate exposures. As at 30 June 2014, the Group holds US$3,319 million (2013: US$5,377 million) of centrally managed fixed interest rate borrowings as well as US$2,018 million (2013: US$3,533 million) of other fixed interest rate borrowings that have not been swapped to floating interest rates, arising from debt raised during the financial year ended 30 June 2014, debt assumed as part of the acquisition of Petrohawk Energy Corporation and debt raised prior to the DLC merger. The Group’s earnings are sensitive to changes in interest rates on the floating interest rate component of the Group’s net borrowings.

 

F-74


Table of Contents

The fair value of interest rate swaps and cross currency interest rate swaps in hedge relationships used to hedge both interest rate and foreign currency risks are as follows:

 

     Fair value  
     2014     2013  
     US$M     US$M  

Interest rate swaps

    

US dollar swaps

    

Pay floating/receive fixed

    

Not later than one year

     12        36   

Later than one year but not later than two years

     114        14   

Later than two years but not later than five years

     202        307   

Later than five years

     60        (56

US dollar swaps

    

Pay fixed/receive floating

    

Not later than one year

            1   

Later than one year but not later than two years

     3          

Later than two years but not later than five years

     8        15   

Later than five years

     198        365   

Australian dollar swaps

    

Pay fixed/receive floating

    

Later than two years but not later than five years

            2   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cross currency interest rate swaps

    

UK pound sterling to US dollar swaps

    

Pay floating/receive fixed

    

Later than five years

     (7     (136

UK pound sterling to US dollar swaps

    

Pay fixed/receive fixed

    

Later than five years

     131        (22

Australian dollar to US dollar swaps

    

Pay floating/receive fixed

    

Later than two years but not later than five years

     (80     (117

Canadian dollar to US dollar swaps

    

Pay fixed/receive fixed

    

Later than five years

     (36     (31

Euro to US dollar swaps

    

Pay floating/receive fixed

    

Not later than one year

            27   

Later than two years but not later than five years

     169          

Later than five years

     327        33   

Euro to US dollar swaps

    

Pay fixed/receive fixed

    

Later than one year but not later than two years

     20          

Later than two years but not later than five years

            (45

Later than five years

     89        16   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Swaptions

    

Pay floating/receive fixed

    

Not later than one year

            (173
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total fair value of derivatives

     1,210        236   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-75


Table of Contents

Based on the net debt position as at 30 June 2014, taking into account interest rate swaps, cross currency interest rate swaps and swaptions, it is estimated that a one percentage point increase in the US LIBOR interest rate will decrease the Group’s equity and profit after taxation by US$126 million (2013: decrease of US$128 million). This assumes that the change in interest rates is effective from the beginning of the financial year and the fixed/floating mix and balances are constant over the year. However, interest rates and the net debt profile of the Group may not remain constant over the coming financial year and therefore such sensitivity analysis should be used with care.

Currency risk

The US dollar is the functional currency of most operations within the Group and as a result currency exposures arise from transactions and balances in currencies other than the US dollar. The Group’s potential currency exposures comprise:

 

  translational exposure in respect of non-functional currency monetary items; and

 

  transactional exposure in respect of non-functional currency expenditure and revenues.

The Group’s foreign currency risk is managed as part of the portfolio risk management strategy.

Translational exposure in respect of non-functional currency monetary items

Monetary items, including financial assets and liabilities, denominated in currencies other than the functional currency of an operation are periodically restated to US dollar equivalents, and the associated gain or loss is taken to the income statement. The exception is foreign exchange gains or losses on foreign currency denominated provisions for closure and rehabilitation at operating sites, which are capitalised in property, plant and equipment.

The following table shows the foreign currency risk arising from financial assets and liabilities, which are denominated in currencies other than the US dollar:

 

Net financial (liabilities)/assets – by currency of denomination

   2014     2013  
     US$M     US$M  

Australian dollars

     (4,684     (4,104

Chilean peso

     (267     113   

South African rand

     62        251   

Other

     (56     109   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

     (4,945     (3,631
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

The principal non-functional currencies to which the Group is exposed are the Australian dollar, Chilean peso and South African rand. Based on the Group’s net financial assets and liabilities as at 30 June 2014, a weakening of the US dollar against these currencies as illustrated in the table below, with all other variables held constant, would (decrease)/increase profit after taxation and equity as follows:

 

     2014 US$M     2013 US$M  

Currency movement

   Profit
after taxation
    Equity     Profit
after taxation
    Equity  
        

1 cent movement in Australian dollar

     (31     (31     (27     (27

10 pesos movement in Chilean peso

     (3     (3     1        1   

0.2 rand movement in South African rand

     (3     1        (2     3   

 

F-76


Table of Contents

The Group’s financial asset and liability profile may not remain constant and therefore these sensitivities should be used with care.

Transactional exposure in respect of non-functional currency expenditure and revenues

Certain operating and capital expenditure is incurred by some operations in currencies other than their functional currency. To a lesser extent, certain sales revenue is earned in currencies other than the functional currency of operations, and certain exchange control restrictions may require that funds be maintained in currencies other than the functional currency of the operation. These currency risks are managed as part of the portfolio risk management strategy. When required under this strategy the Group enters into forward exchange contracts.

The net fair value of forward exchange contracts outstanding to manage short-term foreign currency cash flows relating to operating activities is an asset of US$ nil and a liability of US$ nil (2013: an asset of US$1 million and a liability of US$1 million).

Commodity price risk

Contracts for the sale and physical delivery of commodities are executed whenever possible on a pricing basis intended to achieve a relevant index target. Where pricing terms deviate from the index, derivative commodity contracts may be used when available to return realised prices to the index. Contracts for the physical delivery of commodities are not typically financial instruments and are carried in the balance sheet at cost (typically at nil); they are therefore excluded from the fair value and sensitivity tables below. Accordingly, the financial instrument exposures set out in the tables below do not represent all of the commodity price risks managed according to the Group’s objectives. Movements in the fair value of contracts included in the tables below are offset by movements in the fair value of the physical contracts, however only the former movement is recognised in the Group’s income statement prior to settlement. The risk associated with commodity prices is managed as part of the portfolio risk management strategy.

Financial instruments with commodity price risk included in the following tables are those entered into for the following activities:

 

  economic hedging of prices realised on commodity contracts as described above;

 

  purchases and sales of physical contracts that can be cash-settled; and

 

  derivatives embedded within other supply contracts.

All such instruments are carried in the balance sheet at fair value.

 

F-77


Table of Contents

Forward commodity and other derivative contracts

 

     2014      2013  
     Fair value
of asset
     Fair value
of liability
     Fair value
of asset
    Fair value
of liability
 
     US$M      US$M      US$M     US$M  

Aluminium

     54         7         71        6   

Copper

     7         16         14        10   

Zinc

                            1   

Silver

                            1   

Nickel

     17         5         17        6   

Iron ore

                            9   

Energy coal

             1                7   

Petroleum

             6                19   

Gas

     218         11         142          

Freight

                            6   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

     296         46         244        65   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Comprising:

          

Current

     75         16         59        36   

Non-current

     221         30         185        29   

The Group’s exposure at 30 June 2014 to the impact of movements in commodity prices upon the financial instruments, other than those designated as embedded derivatives, is set out in the following table:

 

         2014      2013  
   

Units of exposure

   Net
exposure

receive/
(deliver) (a)
     Impact on equity
and profit after

taxation of 10%
increase in

market price
     Net
exposure

receive/
(deliver)
    Impact on
equity and
profit after

taxation of 10%
increase in

market price
 
                US$M            US$M  

Aluminium

  Tonnes (’000s)                      2          

Copper

  Tonnes (’000s)                      (12     8   

Lead

  Tonnes (’000s)                      (2       

Nickel

  Tonnes (’000s)                      (1     1   

Iron ore

  Tonnes (’000s)                      (44     1   

Energy coal

  Tonnes (’000s)                      255        (2

Freight

  Time charter days                      (4,863     7   

 

(a)  Exposures on volumes are nil for 30 June 2014 as long and short positions are equal.

 

F-78


Table of Contents

Provisionally priced commodity sales contracts

Not included in the above tables are provisionally priced sales volumes for which price finalisation, referenced to the relevant index, is outstanding at the reporting date. Provisional pricing mechanisms embedded within these sales arrangements have the character of a commodity derivative and are carried at fair value through profit and loss as part of trade receivables. The Group’s exposure at 30 June 2014 to the impact of movements in commodity prices upon provisionally invoiced sales volumes is set out in the following table.

 

          2014      2013  
    

Units of exposure

   Net exposure
(deliver)/
receive
    Impact on equity
and profit after
taxation of 10%
increase in

market price
     Net exposure
(deliver)/
receive
    Impact on equity
and profit after
taxation of 10%
increase in

market price
 
                US$M            US$M  

Copper

   Tonnes (’000s)      (350     246         (329     155   

Zinc

   Tonnes (’000s)      (11     2         (7     1   

Lead

   Tonnes (’000s)      (29     6         (59     12   

Gold

   Ounces      (19,401     2         (8,976     1   

Silver

   Ounces (’000s)      (5,072     10         (8,340     15   

Nickel

   Tonnes (’000s)      (3     5         (6     8   

Iron Ore

   Tonnes (’000s)      (588     5                  

The sensitivities in the above tables have been determined as the absolute impact on fair value of a 10 per cent increase in commodity prices at each reporting date, while holding all other variables, including foreign currency and exchange rates, constant.

The relationship between commodity prices and foreign currencies is complex and movements in foreign exchange rates can impact commodity prices. The sensitivities should therefore be used with care.

Liquidity risk

The Group’s liquidity risk arises from the possibility that it may not be able to settle or meet its obligations as they fall due and is managed as part of the portfolio risk management strategy. Operational, capital and regulatory requirements are considered in the management of liquidity risk, in conjunction with short-term and long-term forecast information.

Additional liquidity risk arises on debt related derivatives due to the possibility that a market for derivatives might not exist in some circumstances. To counter this risk the Group only uses derivatives in highly liquid markets.

The Group’s strong credit profile, diversified funding sources and committed credit facilities ensure that sufficient liquid funds are maintained to meet its daily cash requirements. The Group’s policy on counterparty credit exposure ensures that only counterparties of a high credit standing are used for the investment of any excess cash.

During the year ended 30 June 2014, Moody’s Investors Service made no change to the Group’s long-term credit rating of A1 (the short-term credit rating is P-1). Standard & Poor’s made no change to the Group’s long-term credit rating of A+ (the short-term credit rating is A-1).

There were no defaults on loans payable during the period.

 

F-79


Table of Contents

Standby arrangements and unused credit facilities

Details of major standby and support arrangements are as follows:

 

     Facility
available
2014
     Used
2014
     Unused
2014
     Facility
available
2013
     Used
2013
    Unused
2013
 
     US$M      US$M      US$M      US$M      US$M     US$M  

Commercial paper program (a)

     6,000                 6,000         6,000         (1,330     4,670   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total financing facilities

     6,000           –         6,000         6,000         (1,330     4,670   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(a)  The Group has a US$6.0 billion commercial paper program backed by US$6.0 billion of revolving credit facilities. In May 2014 the US$5.0 billion and US$1.0 billion revolving credit facilities expiring in December 2015 and December 2014 were replaced by a US$6.0 billion revolving credit facility. The new facility has a five-year maturity with two one-year extension options. The facility is used for general corporate purposes and as backup for the commercial paper programs. The interest rates under these facilities are based on an interbank rate plus a margin. The applicable margin is typical for a credit facility extended to a company with the Group’s credit rating. The Group had US$ nil US commercial paper outstanding in the market at the end of the financial year (2013: US$1.3 billion).

Maturity profile of financial liabilities

The maturity profile of the Group’s financial liabilities based on the contractual amounts, taking into account the derivatives related to debt, is as follows:

 

2014

  Bank loans,
debentures
and

other loans
    Expected
future
interest
payments
    Derivatives
related to
net debt
    Other
derivatives
    Obligations
under
finance
leases
    Other
financial
liabilities (a)
    Total  
    US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M  

Due for payment:

             

In one year or less or on demand

    4,165        665        (180     16        167        9,747        14,580   

In more than one year but not more than two years

    3,107        1,034        (122     9        164        94        4,286   

In more than two years but not more than three years

    3,390        897        (32     1        164        3        4,423   

In more than three years but not more than four years

    1,066        807        128        6        151        3        2,161   

In more than four years but not more than five years

    4,169        784        70        11        152        3        5,189   

In more than five years

    16,857        7,949        485        3        1,708        10        27,012   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
    32,754        12,136        349        46        2,506        9,860        57,651   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Carrying amount

    33,205               273        46        1,384        9,860        44,768   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-80


Table of Contents

2013

  Bank loans,
debentures
and

other loans
    Expected
future
interest
payments
    Derivatives
related to
net debt
    Other
derivatives
    Obligations
under
finance
leases
    Other
financial
liabilities (a)
    Total  
    US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M  

Due for payment:

             

In one year or less or on demand

    5,015        813        13        37        36        10,613        16,527   

In more than one year but not more than two years

    2,751        978        (138     3        46        57        3,697   

In more than two years but not more than three years

    3,606        889        9        4        28        27        4,563   

In more than three years but not more than four years

    2,878        744        74        2        24        11        3,733   

In more than four years but not more than five years

    1,038        658        266        16        9        7        1,994   

In more than five years

    17,608        4,889        1,232        4        25        199        23,957   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
    32,896        8,971        1,456        66        168        10,914        54,471   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Carrying amount

    33,035               726        66        137        10,914        44,878   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(a) Includes trade and other payables of US$ nil (2013: US$41 million) included in liabilities held for sale. Refer to note 25 Assets and liabilities held for sale.

The amounts presented in the tables above comprise the contractual undiscounted cash flows, and therefore will not always agree with the amounts presented in the balance sheet. The Group holds derivatives related to net debt, commodities and currencies that are classified as other financial assets when they are expected to generate cash inflows. Refer to note 11 ‘Other financial assets’.

Credit risk

Credit risk arises from the non-performance by counterparties of their contractual financial obligations towards the Group. To manage credit risk the Group maintains Group-wide procedures covering the application for credit approvals, granting and renewal of counterparty limits and daily monitoring of exposures against these limits. As part of these processes, the financial viability of all counterparties is regularly monitored and assessed. The maximum exposure to credit risk is limited to the total carrying amount of relevant financial assets on the balance sheet as at the reporting date.

The Group’s credit risk exposures are categorised under the following headings:

Counterparties

The Group conducts transactions with the following major types of counterparties:

 

  Receivables counterparties

Approximately half of sales to the Group’s customers are made on open terms.

 

F-81


Table of Contents
  Payment guarantee counterparties

Approximately half of sales to the Group’s customers occur via secured payment mechanisms.

 

  Derivative counterparties

Counterparties to derivative contracts consist of a diverse number of financial institutions and industrial counterparties in the relevant markets.

 

  Cash investment counterparties

As part of managing cash flow and liquidity, the Group holds short-term cash investments with a range of approved financial institutions.

The Group has no significant concentration of credit risk with any single counterparty or group of counterparties.

Geographic

The Group trades in all major geographic regions. Countries in which the Group has a significant credit risk exposure include South Africa, Australia, the United States, Japan and Singapore. Where appropriate, secured payment mechanisms and other risk mitigation instruments are used to protect revenues from credit risk losses.

Industry

In line with our asset portfolio, the Group sells into a diverse range of industries and customer sectors. This diversity means that the Group is not materially exposed to any individual industry or customer.

The following table shows the Group’s receivables at the reporting date that are exposed to credit risk and the ageing and impairment profile thereon:

 

2014

   Gross
amount
     Receivables
past due and
impaired
     Receivables
neither past
due nor
impaired
     Receivables past due but not impaired  
            Less than
30 days
     31 to 60
days
     61 to 90
days
     Over
90 days
 
     US$M      US$M      US$M      US$M      US$M      US$M      US$M  

Trade receivables

     4,735         115         4,562         46                         12   

Other receivables

     4,005         17         3,761         9         26         33         159   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     8,740         132         8,323         55         26         33         171   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

2013

   Gross
amount
     Receivables
past due and
impaired
     Receivables
neither past
due nor
impaired
     Receivables past due but not impaired  
            Less than
30 days
     31 to 60
days
     61 to 90
days
     Over
90 days
 
     US$M      US$M      US$M      US$M      US$M      US$M      US$M  

Trade receivables

     4,531         116         4,367         24         1                 23   

Other receivables

     3,904         11         3,468         103         34         49         239   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     8,435         127         7,835         127         35         49         262   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Receivables are deemed to be past due or impaired with reference to the Group’s normal terms and conditions of business. These terms and conditions are determined on a case-by-case basis with reference to the customer’s

 

F-82


Table of Contents

credit quality and prevailing market conditions. Receivables that are classified as ‘past due’ in the above tables are those that have not been settled within the terms and conditions that have been agreed with that customer. For an analysis of movements in impaired trade receivables, refer to note 10 ‘Trade and other receivables’.

The credit quality of the Group’s customers is monitored on an ongoing basis and assessed for impairment where indicators of such impairment exist. The solvency of each debtor and their ability to repay the receivable is considered in assessing receivables for impairment. In certain circumstances the Group may seek collateral as security for the receivable. Where receivables have been impaired, the Group actively seeks to recover the amounts in question and enforce compliance with credit terms.

No other financial assets were past due or impaired at 30 June 2014 (30 June 2013: nil).

Fair values

All financial assets and liabilities, other than derivatives, are initially recognised at the fair value of consideration paid or received, net of transaction costs as appropriate, and subsequently carried at fair value or amortised cost, as indicated in the tables below. Derivatives are initially recognised at fair value on the date the contract is entered into and are subsequently remeasured at their fair value.

The financial assets and liabilities are presented by class in the tables below at their carrying amounts, which generally approximate to the fair values. In the case of US$3,319 million (2013: US$5,377 million) of centrally managed fixed rate debt and other fixed interest borrowings of US$2,018 million (2013: US$3,533 million) not swapped to floating rate, the fair values at 30 June 2014 were US$3,718 million (2013: US$5,309 million) and US$1,947 million (2013: US$3,454 million) respectively.

 

F-83


Table of Contents

Financial assets and liabilities

 

2014

  Notes     Loans and
receivables
    Available
for sale
securities
    Held at
fair value
through
profit
or loss
    Cash
flow
hedges
    Other
financial
assets
and
liabilities
at
amortised
cost
    Total  
          US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M  

Financial assets

             

Cash and cash equivalents

    23        8,803                                    8,803   

Trade and other receivables (a) (b)

    10        5,431               1,071                      6,502   

Cross currency and interest rate swaps

    11                      846        637               1,483   

Commodity contracts

    11                      25                      25   

Other derivative contracts

    11                      271                      271   

Loans to equity accounted investments

    10        1,205                                    1,205   

Interest bearing loans receivable

    10        337                                    337   

Shares

    11               512                             512   

Other investments

    11               145                             145   
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total financial assets

      15,776        657        2,213        637               19,283   
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Non-financial assets

                132,130   
             

 

 

 

Total assets

                151,413   
             

 

 

 

Financial liabilities

             

Trade and other payables (c) (d)

    15                      300               9,560        9,860   

Cross currency and interest rate swaps, and swaptions

    17                      221        52               273   

Commodity contracts

    17                      9                      9   

Other derivative contracts

    17                      37                      37   

Unsecured bank overdrafts and short-term borrowings

    16                                    51        51   

Unsecured bank loans

    16                                    1,462        1,462   

Notes and debentures (e)

    16                                    31,247        31,247   

Finance leases

    16                                    1,384        1,384   

Unsecured other

    16                                    445        445   
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total financial liabilities

                    567        52        44,149        44,768   
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Non-financial liabilities

                21,263   
             

 

 

 

Total liabilities

                66,031   
             

 

 

 

 

F-84


Table of Contents

2013

  Notes     Loans and
receivables
    Available
for sale
securities
    Held at
fair value
through
profit
or loss
    Cash
flow
hedges
    Other
financial
assets and
liabilities
at
amortised
cost
    Total  
          US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M  

Financial assets

             

Cash and cash equivalents

    23        5,677                                    5,677   

Trade and other receivables (a) (b)

    10        5,212               1,059                      6,271   

Cross currency and interest rate swaps

    11                      879        83               962   

Forward exchange contracts

    11                      1                      1   

Commodity contracts

    11                      49                      49   

Other derivative contracts

    11                      195                      195   

Loans to equity accounted investments

    10        1,209                                    1,209   

Interest bearing loans receivable

    10        308                                    308   

Shares

    11               534                             534   

Other investments

    11               139                             139   
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total financial assets

      12,406        673        2,183        83               15,345   
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Non-financial assets

                123,833   
             

 

 

 

Total assets

                139,178   
             

 

 

 

Financial liabilities

             

Trade and other payables (c) (d)

    15                      248               10,651        10,899   

Cross currency and interest rate swaps, and swaptions

    17                      555        171               726   

Forward exchange contracts

    17                      1                      1   

Commodity contracts

    17                      28                      28   

Other derivative contracts

    17                      37                      37   

Unsecured bank overdrafts and short-term borrowings

    16                                    10        10   

Unsecured bank loans

    16                                    1,086        1,086   

Commercial paper

    16                                    1,330        1,330   

Notes and debentures (e)

    16                                    30,259        30,259   

Secured bank and other loans

    16                                    20        20   

Redeemable preference shares

    16                                    15        15   

Finance leases

    16                                    137        137   

Unsecured other

    16                                    330        330   
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total financial liabilities

                    869        171        43,838        44,878   
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Non-financial liabilities

                19,009   
             

 

 

 

Total liabilities

                63,887   
             

 

 

 

 

(a)  Excludes input taxes of US$564 million (2013: US$537 million) included in other receivables. Refer to note 10 Trade and other receivables.

 

F-85


Table of Contents
(b)  Includes trade and other receivables of US$ nil (2013: US$17 million) included in assets held for sale. Refer to note 25 Assets and liabilities held for sale.

 

(c)  Excludes input taxes of US$398 million (2013: US$288 million) included in other payables. Refer to note 15 Trade and other payables.

 

(d)  Includes trade and other payables of US$ nil (2013: US$41 million) included in liabilities held for sale. Refer to note 25 Assets and liabilities held for sale.

 

(e)  Includes US$3,319 million (2013: US$5,377 million) of fixed rate debt not swapped to floating rate, US$1,998 million (2013: US$3,491 million) of fixed rate debt assumed as part of the acquisition of Petrohawk Energy Corporation and US$25,930 million (2013: US$21,391 million) of other debt swapped to floating rate under fair value hedges that is fair valued for interest rate risk.

Valuation hierarchy

The carrying amount of financial assets and liabilities measured at fair value is principally calculated with reference to quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities. Where no price information is available from a quoted market source, alternative market mechanisms or recent comparable transactions, fair value is estimated based on the Group’s views on relevant future prices, net of valuation allowances to accommodate liquidity, modelling and other risks implicit in such estimates. The inputs used in fair value calculations are determined by the relevant Group Function. Our Group Functions support the Businesses and operate under a defined set of accountabilities authorised by the Group Management Committee. Movements in the fair value of financial assets and liabilities may be recognised through the income statement or in other comprehensive income. The following table shows the Group’s financial assets and liabilities carried at fair value with reference to the nature of valuation inputs used:

 

2014

   Level 1 (a)      Level 2 (b)     Level 3 (c)      Total  
     US$M      US$M     US$M      US$M  

Financial assets and liabilities

          

Trade and other receivables

             1,071                1,071   

Trade and other payables

             (300             (300

Cross currency and interest rate swaps

             1,210                1,210   

Commodity contracts

             16                16   

Other derivative contracts

             (13     247         234   

Investments – available for sale

     5         145        507         657   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     5         2,129        754         2,888   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

2013

   Level 1 (a)      Level 2 (b)     Level 3 (c)      Total  
     US$M      US$M     US$M      US$M  

Financial assets and liabilities

          

Trade and other receivables

             1,059                1,059   

Trade and other payables

             (248             (248

Cross currency and interest rate swaps, and swaptions

             236                236   

Commodity contracts

             21                21   

Other derivative contracts

             (5     163         158   

Investments – available for sale

     5         141        527         673   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     5         1,204        690         1,899   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(a)  Valuation is based on unadjusted quoted prices in active markets for identical financial assets and liabilities.

 

F-86


Table of Contents
(b)  Valuation is based on inputs (other than quoted prices included in Level 1) that are observable for the financial asset or liability, either directly (i.e. as unquoted prices) or indirectly (i.e. derived from prices).

 

(c)  Valuation is based on inputs that are not based on observable market data.

Level 3 financial assets and liabilities

The following table shows the movements in the Group’s level 3 financial assets and liabilities:

 

     2014     2013  
     US$M     US$M  

At the beginning of the financial year

     690        820   

Additions

     66        36   

Disposals

     (47     (8

Realised gains/(losses) recognised in the income statement (a)

     6        (13

Unrealised gains/(losses) recognised in the income statement (a)

     77        (54

Unrealised losses recognised in other comprehensive income (b)

     (19     (91

Transfers (c)

     (19       
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

At the end of the financial year

     754        690   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(a)  Realised and unrealised gains and losses recognised in the income statement are recorded in expenses. Refer to note 5 Expenses.

 

(b)  Unrealised gains and losses recognised in other comprehensive income are recorded in the financial assets reserve. Refer to note 20 Other equity.

 

(c)  Transfers comprise US$19 million related to an available for sale investment now classified as an equity accounted investment due to the adoption of IFRS 11 ‘Joint Arrangements’.

Sensitivity of Level 3 financial assets and liabilities

The carrying amount of financial assets and liabilities that are valued using inputs other than observable market data are calculated using appropriate valuation models, including discounted cash flow modelling, with inputs such as commodity prices, foreign exchange rates and inflation. The potential effect of using reasonably possible alternative assumptions in these models, based on a change in the most significant input by 10 per cent while holding all other variables constant, is shown in the following table. Significant inputs are assessed individually for each financial asset and liability.

 

            Profit after taxation     Equity  

2014

   Carrying
amount
     10% increase
in input
     10% decrease
in input
    10% increase
in input
     10% decrease
in input
 
     US$M      US$M      US$M     US$M      US$M  

Financial assets and liabilities

             

Other derivative contracts

     247         67         (67     67         (67

Investments – available for sale

     507                        72         (39
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     754         67         (67     139         (106
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

F-87


Table of Contents
            Profit after taxation     Equity  

2013

   Carrying
amount
     10% increase
in input
     10% decrease
in input
    10% increase
in input
     10% decrease
in input
 
     US$M      US$M      US$M     US$M      US$M  

Financial assets and liabilities

             

Other derivative contracts

     163         42         (41     42         (41

Investments – available for sale

     527                        71         (67
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     690         42         (41     113         (108
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Offsetting financial assets and liabilities

Financial assets and liabilities are offset and the net amount reported in the balance sheet where BHP Billiton currently has a legally enforceable right to offset the recognised amounts, and there is an intention to settle on a net basis or realise the asset and settle the liability simultaneously. BHP Billiton also entered into master netting arrangements that do not meet the criteria for offsetting but allow for the related amounts to be set-off in certain circumstances, such as the event of default.

The following table presents the recognised financial instruments that are offset, or subject to enforceable master netting arrangements but not offset, as at 30 June 2014 and 30 June 2013. The column ‘Net amount’ shows the impact on the Group’s balance sheet if all set-off rights were exercised.

 

            Effects of offsetting on the balance sheet      Related amounts not offset  

2014

US$M

   Notes      Gross
amounts
     Gross amounts
set-off in
the balance
sheet
    Net amounts
presented in
the balance
sheet
     Amounts
subject to
master netting
arrangements
    Net amount  

Financial assets

               

Trade receivables

     10         4,639         (19     4,620                4,620   

Cross currency and interest rate swaps (a)

     11         1,483                1,483         (214     1,269   
     

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

        6,122         (19     6,103         (214     5,889   
     

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Financial liabilities

               

Trade creditors

     15         6,992         (19     6,973                6,973   

Cross currency and interest rate swaps (a)

     17         273                273         (214     59   
     

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

        7,265         (19     7,246         (214     7,032   
     

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-88


Table of Contents
            Effects of offsetting on the balance sheet      Related amounts not offset  

2013

US$M

   Notes      Gross
amounts
     Gross amounts
set-off in
the balance
sheet
    Net amounts
presented in
the balance
sheet
     Amounts
subject to
master netting
arrangements
    Net amount  

Financial assets

               

Trade receivables

     10         4,417         (2     4,415                4,415   

Cross currency and interest rate swaps (a)

     11         962                962         (352     610   
     

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

        5,379         (2     5,377         (352     5,025   
     

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Financial liabilities

               

Trade creditors

     15         7,603         (2     7,601                7,601   

Cross currency and interest rate swaps, and swaptions (a)

     17         726                726         (352     374   
     

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

        8,329         (2     8,327         (352     7,975   
     

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(a) BHP Billiton enters into derivative transactions under International Swaps and Derivatives Association (ISDA) master netting agreements. Under the terms of these arrangements, only where certain events occur such as default, the net position owing/receivable to a single counterparty will be taken as owing and all the relevant arrangements terminated. As BHP Billiton does not presently have a legally enforceable right of set-off, these amounts have not been offset in the balance sheet, but have been presented separately in the table above.

Capital management

The Group’s long-term strategy is to own and operate large, long-life, low-cost, expandable, upstream assets diversified by commodity, geography and market. The Group will invest capital in assets where they fit its strategy. The Group’s priorities for cash flow are:

 

  reinvestment in projects that carry attractive rates of return regardless of the economic climate;

 

  commitment to a solid ‘A’ credit rating; and

 

  returning excess capital to shareholders firstly with its progressive dividend policy and thereafter via capital management initiatives (for example share buy-backs).

Further information relevant to the actions and outcomes of the Group’s capital management strategy is contained in section 7.1.4 Consolidated Cash Flow Statement, note 9 ‘Dividends’, note 19 ‘Share capital’ and note 20 ‘Other equity’.

The Group monitors capital using a gearing ratio, being the ratio of net debt to net debt plus net assets. Our policy is for net gearing to be a maximum of 40 per cent.

 

 

F-89


Table of Contents
     2014     2013  
     US$M     US$M  

Cash and cash equivalents

     (8,803     (5,677

Current debt

     4,262        5,088   

Non-current debt

     30,327        28,099   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net debt

     25,786        27,510   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net assets

     85,382        75,291   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Gearing

     23.2     26.8
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

30    Pension and other post-retirement obligations

The Group operates the following pension and post-retirement medical schemes:

Defined contribution pension schemes and multi-employer pension schemes

The Group contributed US$467 million (2013: US$456 million; 2012: US$388 million) to defined contribution plans and multi-employer defined contribution plans. These contributions are expensed as incurred.

Defined benefit pension schemes

The Group has closed all defined benefit schemes to new entrants. Defined benefit pension schemes remain operating in Australia, the US, Canada, South America, Europe and South Africa for existing members. Full actuarial valuations are prepared and updated annually to 30 June by local actuaries for all schemes. The Projected Unit Credit valuation method is used. The Group operates final salary schemes that provide final salary benefits only, non-salary related schemes that provide flat dollar benefits and mixed benefit schemes that consist of a final salary defined benefit portion and a defined contribution portion.

Defined benefit post-retirement medical schemes

The Group operates a number of post-retirement medical schemes in the US, Canada, Europe and South Africa. Full actuarial valuations are prepared by local actuaries for all schemes. All of the post-retirement medical schemes in the Group are unfunded.

The Group’s defined benefit pension schemes and post-retirement medical schemes expose the Group to a number of risks:

 

Risk

  

Description

Volatility in asset values

   The Group is exposed to changes in the value of assets held in funded pension schemes to meet future benefit payments.

Uncertainty in benefit payments

   The cost to the Group of meeting future benefit obligations will depend on the value of the benefits paid in the future. To the extent these payments are dependent on future experience, there is some uncertainty. Some of the schemes’ benefit obligations are linked to inflation or to salaries, and some schemes provide benefits that are paid for the life of the member. If future experience varies from the assumptions used to value these obligations, the cost of meeting the obligations will vary.

Uncertainty in future funding requirements

   Movement in the value of benefit obligations and scheme assets will impact the contributions that the Group will be required to make to the schemes in the future. In many cases, pension schemes are managed under trust, and the Group does not have full control over the rate of funding or investment policy for scheme assets. In addition, the Group is exposed to changes in the regulations applicable to benefit schemes.

 

F-90


Table of Contents

Recognising this, the Group has adopted an approach of moving away from providing defined benefit pensions. The majority of Group sponsored defined benefit pension schemes have been closed to new entrants for many years. Existing benefit schemes, and the terms of employee participation in these schemes, are reviewed on a regular basis.

The Group follows a coordinated strategy for the funding and investment of its defined benefit pension schemes (subject to meeting all local requirements). The Group’s aim is for the value of defined benefit scheme assets to be maintained at close to the value of the corresponding benefit obligations, allowing for some short-term volatility.

The following tables set out details of the Group’s defined benefit pension and post-retirement medical schemes.

Balance sheet disclosures

The amounts recognised in the Consolidated Balance Sheet are as follows:

 

     Defined benefit
pension schemes
    Post-retirement
medical schemes
 
         2014             2013         2014      2013  
     US$M     US$M     US$M      US$M  

Present value of funded defined benefit obligation

     1,297        1,839                  

Present value of unfunded defined benefit obligation

     103        112        425         410   

Fair value of defined benefit scheme assets

     (1,319     (1,891               
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Scheme deficit

     81        60        425         410   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Unrecognised surplus

     33        70                  

Unrecognised past service credits

                           5   

Adjustment for employer contributions tax

     3        9                  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net liability recognised in the Consolidated Balance Sheet

     117        139        425         415   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

The Group has no legal obligation to settle these liabilities with any immediate contributions or additional one-off contributions. The Group intends to continue to contribute to each defined benefit pension and post-retirement medical scheme in accordance with the latest recommendations of each scheme actuary.

Income statement disclosures

The amounts recognised in the Consolidated Income Statement are as follows:

 

     Defined benefit
pension schemes
    Post-retirement
medical schemes
 
     2014     2013     2012     2014     2013     2012  
     US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M  

Current service cost

     44        62        57        11        12        8   

Net interest expense/(income) on net defined benefit liability/(asset)

     (1     (5     1        23        24        25   

Past service costs

            2                      (7     7   

Curtailment and settlement losses/(gains) and other adjustments (a)

     128        (15     (4     (1              
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total expense

     171        44        54        33        29        40   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

– Recognised in employee benefits expense

     172        49        53        10        5        15   

– Recognised in net finance costs

     (1     (5     1        23        24        25   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-91


Table of Contents

 

(a)  In the 2014 financial year, the Group settled defined benefit pension schemes held in the UK and the Netherlands. The settlement gave rise to a loss of US$150 million, being the difference between assets transferred to insurance companies of US$640 million in exchange for them taking on the obligations under the schemes of US$490 million. This was partially offset by gains of US$22 million relating to curtailments and plan amendments of schemes in the UK and US due to the removal of salary and future service accrual linkage from benefits.

Statement of Comprehensive Income (SOCI) disclosures

The amounts recognised in the Consolidated Statement of Comprehensive Income are as follows:

 

     Defined benefit
pension schemes
    Post-retirement
medical schemes
 
     2014     2013     2012     2014      2013     2012  
     US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M      US$M     US$M  

Actuarial (gains)/losses (a)

     (22     (65     221        5         (14     47   

Limit on net assets and other adjustments (b)

     (40     18        (18                      
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total amount recognised in the SOCI

     (62     (47     203        5         (14     47   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total cumulative amount recognised in the SOCI (c)

     407        469        516        158         153        167   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(a)  In the 2014 financial year, the US$5 million loss on post-retirement medical schemes includes a US$5 million gain due to the removal of prior period unrecognised past service credits.

 

(b)  Includes a gain of US$41 million recognised during the 2014 financial year which resulted from the settlement of a defined benefit pension scheme in the Netherlands and the subsequent release of the asset ceiling restriction. The corresponding entry is recognised as a loss in the income statement.

 

(c)  Cumulative amounts are calculated from the transition to IFRS on 1 July 2004.

The change in the net defined benefit liability is as follows:

 

     Defined benefit
pension schemes
    Post-retirement
medical schemes
 
     2014     2013     2014     2013  
     US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M  

Net defined benefit liability at the beginning of the financial year

     139        349        415        450   

Amount recognised in the income statement

     171        44        33        29   

Remeasurement (gain)/loss recognised in other comprehensive income

     (62     (47     5        (14

Disbursements and settlements paid directly by employer

     (23     (16     (20     (22

Employer contributions

     (108     (174              

Foreign exchange losses/(gains)

     6        (3     (9     (28

Other adjustments

     (6     (14     1          
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net defined benefit liability at the end of the financial year

     117        139        425        415   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-92


Table of Contents

The change in the present value of the defined benefit obligation is as follows:

 

     Defined benefit
pension schemes
    Post-retirement
medical schemes
 
     2014     2013     2014     2013  
     US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M  

Defined benefit obligation at the beginning of the financial year

     1,951        2,215        410        446   

Current service cost

     44        62        11        12   

Interest cost

     71        87        23        24   

Contributions by scheme participants

     2        2                 

Actuarial (gains)/losses due to experience

     (39     3        (12       

Actuarial losses/(gains) due to changes in financial assumptions

     19        (32     19        (9

Actuarial losses/(gains) due to changes in demographic assumptions

     2        2        3        (5

Benefits paid to participants

     (166     (239     (20     (22

Past service costs

            2               (7

Settlements (a)

     (490                     

Curtailments

     (22     (15     (1       

Foreign exchange losses/(gains)

     27        (67     (9     (28

Transferred to liabilities held for sale

            (69     1        (1

Other adjustments

     1                        
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Defined benefit obligation at the end of the financial year

     1,400        1,951        425        410   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The change in the fair value of scheme assets for defined benefit pension schemes is as follows:

 

     Defined benefit
pension schemes
 
     2014     2013  
     US$M     US$M  

Fair value of scheme assets at the beginning of the financial year

     1,891        1,935   

Interest income on scheme assets (b)

     74        92   

Return on scheme assets greater than the discount rate (b)

     4        38   

Employer contributions

     131        190   

Contributions by scheme participants

     2        2   

Benefits paid to participants

     (166     (239

Settlements (a)

     (640       

Foreign exchange gains/(losses)

     22        (72

Transferred to liabilities held for sale

            (55

Other adjustments

     1          
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Fair value of scheme assets at the end of the financial year

     1,319        1,891   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(a)  In the 2014 financial year, the Group settled defined benefit pension schemes held in the UK and the Netherlands. The settlement gave rise to a loss of US$150 million, being the difference between assets transferred to insurance companies of US$640 million in exchange for them taking on the obligations under the schemes of US$490 million.

 

(b)  In the 2013 financial year, the US$92 million of interest income and the actuarial gain of US$38 million were calculated in accordance with the previous version of IAS19/AASB19 ‘Employee Benefits’.

 

F-93


Table of Contents

The change in the unrecognised surplus (the effect of the asset ceiling) for defined benefit pension schemes is as follows:

 

     Defined benefit
pension schemes
 
     2014  
     US$M  

Unrecognised surplus at the beginning of the financial year

     70   

Interest cost on unrecognised surplus

     2   

Change in unrecognised surplus in excess of interest

     (40

Foreign exchange losses

     1   
  

 

 

 

Unrecognised surplus at the end of the financial year

     33   
  

 

 

 

The effect of the asset ceiling for the year ended 30 June 2014 relates to one scheme in Canada and was determined as the unrecognised surplus in the scheme arising from ongoing legal proceedings with respect to ownership of this surplus.

The fair value of defined benefit pension scheme assets by major asset class is as follows:

 

     Fair value  
     2014      2013  
     US$M      US$M  

Asset class

     

Bonds (a)

     1,084         1,154   

Equities

     132         231   

Cash and cash equivalents

     67         259   

Property (b)

     11         17   

Other (c)

     25         230   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     1,319         1,891   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(a)  The bonds asset class as at 30 June 2014 includes Fixed Interest Government Bonds of US$305 million, Index linked Government Bonds of US$304 million and Corporate bonds of US$475 million.

 

(b)  Property is the only asset class that does not have a quoted market price in an active market.

 

(c)  Scheme assets classified as ‘Other’ as at 30 June 2014 primarily comprise insured annuities in South Africa and Canada.

The fair value of scheme assets includes no amounts relating to any of the Group’s own financial instruments or any of the property occupied by or other assets used by the Group.

Scheme assets are invested in a diversified range of asset classes, predominantly comprising bonds and equities. In some locations, scheme trustees and other bodies have legal responsibility for the investment of scheme assets and decisions on investment strategy are taken in consultation with the Group.

The Group monitors its exposure to changes in equity markets, interest rates and inflation, and measures its balance sheet pension risk using a risk-based approach. Asset-liability studies are carried out periodically for the major pension schemes and the suitability of investment strategies for all defined benefit pension schemes are also reviewed periodically.

 

F-94


Table of Contents

The Group’s aim is to progressively shift defined benefit pension scheme assets towards investments that match the anticipated profile of the benefit obligations, as funding levels improve, and as benefit obligations mature. Over time, this is expected to result in a further reduction in the total exposure of pension scheme assets to equity markets. For pension schemes that pay lifetime benefits, the Group may consider and support the purchase of annuities to back these benefit obligations if it is commercially sensible to do so.

Weighted average maturity profile of defined benefit obligation

 

    Defined benefit pension
schemes
    Post-retirement medical
schemes
 
    2014     2013     2014     2013  

Weighted average duration of defined benefit obligation (years)

    8        10        13        12   

Actuarial assumptions

The principal actuarial assumptions at the reporting date (expressed as weighted averages) for defined benefit pension schemes are as follows:

 

     Australia      Americas      Europe      South Africa  
     2014      2013      2014      2013      2014      2013      2014      2013  
     %      %      %      %      %      %      %      %  

Discount rate

     3.3         3.0         4.3         4.3         4.1         4.4         9.4         8.6   

Future salary increases

     3.9         4.0         4.8         4.6         n/a         5.1         9.0         8.3   

The principal actuarial assumptions at the reporting date (expressed as weighted averages) for post-retirement medical schemes are as follows:

 

     Americas      South Africa  
     2014      2013      2014      2013  
     %      %      %      %  

Discount rate

     3.9         4.3         9.2         8.7   

Medical cost trend rate (ultimate)

     4.4         4.4         8.7         7.9   

Assumptions regarding future mortality can be material depending upon the size and nature of the scheme liabilities. Post-retirement mortality assumptions in the Americas, Europe and South Africa are based on post-retirement mortality tables that are standard in these regions.

For the main schemes, these tables imply the following expected future lifetimes (in years) for employees aged 65 as at the balance sheet date: US males 19.9 (2013: 19.8), US females 21.6 (2013: 21.6); Canadian males 21.0 (2013: 19.8), Canadian females 23.9 (2013: 22.2); UK males 24.6 (2013: 23.6), UK females 25.6 (2013: 26.2); South African males 19.2 (2013: 19.0), South African females 23.6 (2013: 23.4).

 

F-95


Table of Contents

Estimated contributions for the defined benefit pension and post-retirement medical schemes are as follows:

 

     Defined benefit
pension schemes
     Post-retirement
medical schemes
 
     US$M      US$M  

Estimated employer contributions for the year ending 30 June 2015

     33           

Estimated benefits paid to participants directly by employer for the year ending 30 June 2015

     2         22   

Estimated contributions by scheme participants for the year ending 30 June 2015

     1           

Sensitivity to assumptions

The Group’s defined benefit obligation at the reporting date has been determined using actuarial calculations that require assumptions about future events. The estimated sensitivity of the defined benefit obligation to each significant assumption shown below has been determined at an individual scheme level if each assumption were changed in isolation. In practice, the schemes are subject to multiple external experience items which may vary the defined benefit obligation over time. The methods and assumptions used in preparing these sensitivity results remain consistent with those used in previous reporting periods.

The estimated effects of variations in the principal actuarial assumptions on the Group’s defined benefit obligation at the reporting date are as follows:

 

     Increase/(decrease) in defined benefit
obligation
 
     Defined benefit
pension schemes
    Post-retirement
medical schemes
 
     US$M     US$M  

Discount rate

    

Increase of 1%

     (89     (48

Decrease of 1%

     105        59   

Future salary increases

    

Increase of 1%

     18        n/a   

Decrease of 1%

     (17     n/a   

Mortality

    

Increase in life expectancy at age 65 of 1 year

     20        17   

Decrease in life expectancy at age 65 of 1 year

     (20     (16

Medical cost trend rate (initial and ultimate)

    

Increase of 1%

     n/a        52   

Decrease of 1%

     n/a        (42

 

F-96


Table of Contents

31    Key management personnel

Key management personnel compensation comprises:

 

     2014      2013      2012  
     US$      US$      US$  

Short-term employee benefits

     29,302,029         24,959,049         19,889,528   

Post-employment benefits

     3,176,079         3,446,910         3,586,477   

Share-based payments

     21,300,632         26,297,032         26,645,312   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     53,778,740         54,702,991         50,121,317   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Transactions with key management personnel

During the financial year, there were no purchases from the Group (2013: US$ nil; 2012: US$ nil).

There are no amounts payable at 30 June 2014 (2013: US$ nil).

Loans with key management personnel

There are no loans (2013: US$ nil) with key management personnel.

Transactions with personally related entities

A number of Directors of the Group hold or have held positions in other companies, where it is considered they control or significantly influence the financial or operating policies of those entities. There have been no transactions with those entities and no amounts were owed by the Group to personally related entities (2013: US$ nil).

32    Related party transactions

Subsidiaries

The percentage of ordinary shares held in significant subsidiaries is disclosed in note 26 ‘Subsidiaries’.

Joint operations

The percentage interest held in significant joint operations is disclosed in note 28 ‘Interests in joint operations’.

Joint ventures

The percentage interest held in significant joint ventures is disclosed in note 27 ‘Investments accounted for using the equity method’.

Associates

The percentage interest held in significant associates is disclosed in note 27 ‘Investments accounted for using the equity method’.

Key management personnel

Disclosures relating to key management personnel are set out in note 31 ‘Key management personnel’.

 

F-97


Table of Contents

Transactions with related parties

 

    Joint operations (a)     Joint ventures     Associates     Other related parties (b)  
        2014             2013             2014         2013             2014             2013             2014             2013      
    US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M  

Sales of goods/services

    252.911        259.880                      3.781        0.060                 

Purchases of goods/services

    37.782        40.827                      978.186        729.400                 

Interest income

    1.753        0.175        5.405        13.935        65.039        38.195                 

Interest expense

    0.003        0.021                                             

Dividends received

                  581.086        347.031        668.880        363.277                 

Loans made to related parties

    (6.183     (42.561     (0.115     (546.278     121.173        246.760                 

 

(a) Disclosures in respect of transactions with joint operations represent the amount for which legal right of set-off does not exist.
(b) Excludes transactions with post-employment benefit plans for the benefit of Group employees. These are shown in note 30 Pension and other post-retirement obligations.

Transactions between each parent company and its subsidiaries, which are related parties of that company, are eliminated on consolidation and are not disclosed in this note.

Outstanding balances with related parties

 

    Joint operations (a)     Joint ventures     Associates     Other related parties  
        2014             2013             2014             2013             2014         2013             2014             2013      
    US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M  

Trade amounts owing to related parties

    13.329        24.510                      117.672        96.578                 

Loan amounts owing to
related parties

    44.298        37.315                      41.427        152.631                 

Trade amounts owing from related parties

    17.385        19.403                             0.061                 

Loan amounts owing from related parties

    75.413        74.613        150.101        150.216        1,087.890        1,077.921                 

 

(a) Disclosures in respect of amounts owing to/from joint operations represent the amount owing to the joint operation entity or from the joint operation third party participants for which legal right of set-off does not exist.

Terms and conditions

Sales to and purchases from related parties of goods and services are made in arm’s length transactions at normal market prices and on normal commercial terms.

Outstanding balances at year-end are unsecured and settlement occurs in cash.

Other amounts owing from related parties represent secured loans made to joint operations, associates and joint ventures under co-funding arrangements. Such loans are made on an arm’s length basis with interest charged at market rates and are due to be repaid between 31 July 2014 and 31 August 2031.

No guarantees are provided or received for any related party receivables or payables.

No provision for doubtful debts has been recognised in relation to any outstanding balances and no expense has been recognised in respect of bad or doubtful debts due from related parties.

 

F-98


Table of Contents

33    Employee share ownership plans

Awards were provided under the following employee share ownership plans for the year ended 30 June 2014: the Long Term Incentive Plan (LTIP), Group Incentive Scheme (GIS), Management Award Plan (MAP), Group Short Term Incentive Plan (GSTIP), Transitional GMC awards, the all-employee share plan, Shareplus and the Kgatelo Pele Employee Share Ownership Plan (ESOP). These awards take the form of rights to receive ordinary shares in either BHP Billiton Limited or BHP Billiton Plc. Awards made are subject to performance hurdles (LTIP and Transitional GMC) and service conditions (all plans). Subject to the performance conditions and service conditions being met and the extent to which they are met, the awards will vest and the participant will become entitled to the appropriate number of ordinary shares or, if relevant, entitled to exercise options over the relevant number of ordinary shares. Awards under the plans do not confer any rights to participate in a share issue; however, there is discretion under each of the plans to adjust the awards in response to a variation of BHP Billiton’s share capital.

All awards issued prior to 1 July 2011 are eligible to receive a payment equal to the dividend amount that would have been earned on the underlying shares awarded to those participants (the Dividend Equivalent Payment). The Dividend Equivalent Payment is made to the participants once the underlying shares are issued or transferred to them. No Dividend Equivalent Payment is made in respect of awards that lapse. Awards issued after 1 July 2011 under GSTIP and MAP are no longer eligible to receive the Dividend Equivalent Payment.

A description of these plans is as follows:

 

(i) GIS and GSTIP

The GIS is a plan for the GMC and the GSTIP is a plan for management employees other than the GMC (being first introduced during the year ended 30 June 2009). The GIS and GSTIP awards are split equally between a cash award (being a percentage of base salary) and a grant of rights to receive BHP Billiton shares. The rights are subject to a two-year vesting period before they vest or can be exercised. If, during the vesting period, an individual resigns without the Remuneration Committee’s consent, or is dismissed for cause, their rights are forfeited. Awards in respect of the year ended 30 June 2014 will be awarded during the year ending 30 June 2015.

 

(ii) LTIP and MAP

The LTIP is a plan for the GMC. The LTIP awards are awarded annually. The performance hurdle applicable to the awards requires the Group’s Total Shareholder Return (TSR) over a five-year performance period to be greater than a combination of the Peer Group TSR (being the weighted median TSR where the comparator group is a specified group of peer companies) and, for awards from December 2010 onwards, the Index TSR (being the index value where the comparator group is a market index such as the MSCI World). To the extent that the performance hurdle is not achieved, awards are forfeited. There is no retesting. For awards to vest in full, the Group’s TSR must exceed the Peer Group TSR and Index TSR (if applicable) by a specified percentage per year, determined for each grant by the Remuneration Committee. Since the establishment of the LTIP in 2004, this percentage has been set at 5.5 per cent per year. The vesting scale is determined for each grant by the Committee.

The MAP is a plan for management employees other than the GMC. Under the MAP, participants receive an award of rights to receive BHP Billiton shares. The number of rights is determined by role, performance and organisational level. There are no performance conditions attached to the awards and awards will vest at the end of three years providing participants remain in employment over that time.

 

(iii) Transitional GMC awards

As the MAP awards that are allocated to individuals in their non-GMC management positions have a three-year service condition and the LTIP awards provided to GMC members have a five-year service and

 

F-99


Table of Contents

performance condition, as a transitional step, the Committee may determine that new GMC members recruited from within BHP Billiton receive Transitional GMC awards to bridge the gap between the two programs.

Transitional GMC awards have two tranches. Tranche one has a three-year service and performance condition. Tranche two has a four-year service and performance condition. The Remuneration Committee has absolute discretion to determine if the performance condition has been met and whether any, all or part of the award will vest (or otherwise lapse), having regard to (but not limited to) BHP Billiton’s TSR over the three-year or four-year performance period (respectively), the participant’s contribution to Group outcomes and the participant’s personal performance (with guidance on this assessment from the CEO). No Dividend Equivalent Payment is payable on these awards.

 

(iv) Shareplus

Shareplus, an all-employee share purchase plan, commenced in April 2007. Employees may contribute up to US$5,000 to acquire shares (Acquired Shares) in any Plan year. On the third anniversary of the start of a Plan year, the Company will match the number of Acquired Shares held by the employee at that time with Matched Shares. The employees have no beneficial entitlement to the Matched Shares until they are awarded. Acquired Shares are purchased on a quarterly basis. Employees can sell their Acquired Shares at any time. If, prior to the third anniversary, an individual sells their Acquired Shares, resigns without the Remuneration Committee’s consent or is dismissed for cause, their entitlement to Matched Shares is forfeited.

 

(v) Kgatelo Pele ESOP

The Kgatelo Pele ESOP commenced in June 2013 with a three-year vesting period. All eligible employees are entitled to awards to the value of ZAR8,667 each year, with the last tranche to be granted in June 2015. Beneficiaries must be permanently employed by Hotazel Manganese Mines (Proprietary) Limited as at 1 May (effective date) of each year to qualify for the allocation for that particular year. Hotazel Manganese Mines (Proprietary) Limited will contribute the necessary amount to the Kgatelo Pele Trust by way of donation to enable the purchase of shares, which will be held until the end of the vesting period. During this period, beneficiaries will be entitled to dividends declared by BHP Billiton. At the end of each vesting period, eligible employees will be given the opportunity to create a portfolio by having the shares transferred into their own names or to sell their entitlements and receive the cash benefit.

 

F-100


Table of Contents

Employee share awards – current plans

 

2014

  Number
of awards
on issue

at the
beginning
of the
financial
year
    Number
of
awards
issued
during

the year
    Number
of
awards
vested
and
exercised
    Number
of
awards
lapsed
    Number
of awards
remaining
at the end
of the
financial
year
    Number of
awards
vested and
exercisable
at the end
of the
financial
year
 

BHP Billiton Limited

           

GIS awards – deferred shares

    244,868        114,629        215,953               143,544          

GIS awards – options

    90,389               90,389                        

– weighted average exercise price – A$

    29.15               29.15                        

– weighted average share price – A$

        36.80         

– weighted average contractual term for outstanding options – days

                

GSTIP awards – deferred shares

    2,388,298        1,256,041        1,414,934        51,071        2,178,334        46,839   

GSTIP awards – options

    284,636               116,876        57,441        110,319        110,319   

– weighted average exercise price – A$

    39.44               38.41        38.41        41.08        41.08   

– weighted average share price – A$

        36.82         

– weighted average contractual term for outstanding options – days

                

LTIP awards

    6,066,035        1,298,015        1,688,386        1,329,484        4,346,180        1,512,567   

Transitional GMC awards

    35,834        235,360                      271,194          

MAP awards

    7,981,682        2,921,588        2,481,689        714,586        7,706,995        486,850   

Shareplus

    3,092,062        2,010,066        1,339,097        302,226        3,460,805          
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

BHP Billiton Plc

           

GIS awards – deferred shares

    136,632               101,551               35,081          

GIS awards – options

    109,792               79,403               30,389        30,389   

– weighted average exercise price – £

    15.58               12.47               23.71        23.71   

– weighted average share price – £

        19.31         

– weighted average contractual term for outstanding options – days

                

GSTIP awards – deferred shares

    700,770        242,715        485,820        10,508        447,157        13,228   

GSTIP awards – options

    54,960               12,487               42,473        42,473   

– weighted average exercise price – £

    20.80               17.43               22.08        22.08   

– weighted average share price – £

        18.72         

– weighted average contractual term for outstanding options – days

                

LTIP awards

    2,638,166               726,863        476,180        1,435,123        541,220   

Transitional GMC awards

    39,860                             39,860          

MAP awards

    2,418,076        724,685        728,298        151,257        2,263,206        231,746   

Shareplus

    702,203        434,461        296,186        83,012        757,466          

Kgatelo Pele ESOP

           66,064                      66,064          
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-101


Table of Contents

Fair value and assumptions in the calculation of fair value for awards issued

 

2014

  Weighted
average

fair value
of awards
granted
during
the year (a)
US$
    Risk-free
interest
rate  (b)
    Estimated
life of
awards
    Share
price at
grant
date
    Estimated
volatility
of share
price 
(c)
    Dividend
yield
 

BHP Billiton Limited

           

GIS awards – deferred shares

    29.24        n/a        3 years        A$30.94        n/a        3.17

GIS awards – options

                                         

GSTIP awards – deferred shares

    26.62        n/a        3 years        A$30.94        n/a        3.17

GSTIP awards – options

                                         

LTIP awards

    13.25        1.42     5 years        A$30.94        31.0     3.17

Transitional GMC awards

    25.37        n/a        3-4 years        A$30.94        n/a        3.17

MAP awards

    25.78        n/a        3 years        A$30.94        n/a        3.17

Shareplus

    31.37        2.55     3 years        A$36.78        n/a        3.11
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

BHP Billiton Plc

           

GIS awards – deferred shares

                                         

GIS awards – options

                                         

GSTIP awards – deferred shares

    24.24        n/a        3 years        £17.15        n/a        3.65

GSTIP awards – options

                                         

LTIP awards

                                         

Transitional GMC awards

                                         

MAP awards

    23.35        n/a        3 years        £17.15        n/a        3.65

Shareplus

    28.61        2.05     3 years        £18.91        n/a        3.49

Kgatelo Pele ESOP

    30.14        n/a        3 years        £18.91        n/a        n/a   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-102


Table of Contents

Employee share awards – current plans

 

2013

  Number of
awards on
issue at the
beginning of
the financial
year
    Number of
awards
issued
during the
year
    Number of
awards
vested and
exercised
    Number
of
awards
lapsed
    Number of
awards
remaining
at the end
of the
financial
year
    Number of
awards
vested and
exercisable
at the end
of the
financial
year
 

BHP Billiton Limited

           

GIS awards – deferred shares

    614,335        53,854        407,847        15,474        244,868        23,167   

GIS awards – options

    764,318               359,098        314,831        90,389        90,389   

– weighted average exercise price – A$

    34.44               29.15        41.99        29.15        29.15   

– weighted average share price – A$

        34.15         

– weighted average contractual term for outstanding options – days

                

GSTIP awards – deferred shares

    2,234,410        1,248,794        1,024,623        70,283        2,388,298        194,382   

GSTIP awards – options

    335,160                      50,524        284,636        284,636   

– weighted average exercise price – A$

    39.29                      38.41        39.44        39.44   

– weighted average share price – A$

                

– weighted average contractual term for outstanding options – days

                

LTIP awards

    10,047,354        693,628        4,621,864        53,083        6,066,035        2,367,453   

Transitional GMC awards

           35,834                      35,834          

MAP awards

    7,841,674        3,142,398        2,196,959        805,431        7,981,682        687,175   

Shareplus

    2,436,201        1,966,016        1,015,575        294,580        3,092,062          
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

BHP Billiton Plc

           

GIS awards – deferred shares

    253,076        54,268        170,712               136,632        4,195   

GIS awards – options

    297,042               172,704        14,546        109,792        109,792   

– weighted average exercise price – £

    12.94               10.96        16.51        15.58        15.58   

– weighted average share price – £

        19.29         

– weighted average contractual term for outstanding options – days

                

GSTIP awards – deferred shares

    890,553        281,561        412,558        58,786        700,770        65,838   

GSTIP awards – options

    96,012               21,030        20,022        54,960        54,960   

– weighted average exercise price – £

    20.35               17.53        22.08        20.80        20.80   

– weighted average share price – £

        19.37         

– weighted average contractual term for outstanding options – days

                

LTIP awards

    3,941,270        401,831        1,684,852        20,083        2,638,166        912,476   

Transitional GMC awards

           39,860                      39,860          

MAP awards

    2,837,040        797,840        860,119        356,685        2,418,076        250,305   

Shareplus

    588,356        439,800        241,642        84,311        702,203          
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-103


Table of Contents

Fair value and assumptions in the calculation of fair value for awards issued

 

2013

   Weighted
average
fair value
of awards
granted
during
the year (a)
US$
     Risk-free
interest
rate (b)
    Estimated
life of
awards
     Share
price at
grant
date
     Estimated
volatility
of share
price (c)
    Dividend
yield
 

BHP Billiton Limited

               

GIS awards – deferred shares

     32.40         n/a        3 years         A$31.45         n/a        2.78

GIS awards – options

                                             

GSTIP awards – deferred shares

     29.84         n/a        3 years         A$31.45         n/a        2.78

GSTIP awards – options

                                             

LTIP awards

     16.41         0.73     5 years         A$31.45         35.0     2.78

Transitional GMC awards

     28.61         n/a        3-4 years         A$31.45         n/a        2.78

MAP awards

     29.01         n/a        3 years         A$31.45         n/a        2.78

Shareplus

     32.55         3.34     3 years         A$33.74         n/a        2.50
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

BHP Billiton Plc

               

GIS awards – deferred shares

     28.91         n/a        3 years         £18.06         n/a        3.31

GIS awards – options

                                             

GSTIP awards – deferred shares

     26.22         n/a        3 years         £18.06         n/a        3.31

GSTIP awards – options

                                             

LTIP awards

     14.59         0.73     5 years         £18.06         35.0     3.31

Transitional GMC awards

     24.94         n/a        3-4 years         £18.06         n/a        3.31

MAP awards

     25.37         n/a        3 years         £18.06         n/a        3.31

Shareplus

     28.80         2.24     3 years         £19.49         n/a        2.89
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-104


Table of Contents

Employee share awards – current plans

 

2012

  Number of
awards on
issue at the
beginning
of the
financial
year
    Number of
awards
issued
during the
year
    Number of
awards
vested and
exercised
    Number
of
awards
lapsed
    Number of
awards
remaining
at the end
of the
financial
year
    Number of
awards
vested and
exercisable
at the end
of the
financial
year
 

BHP Billiton Limited

           

GIS awards – deferred shares

    979,532        200,295        560,080        5,412        614,335        306,199   

GIS awards – options

    935,360               163,268        7,774        764,318        764,318   

– weighted average exercise price – A$

    33.47               29.10        30.12        34.44        34.44   

– weighted average share price – A$

        35.37         

– weighted average contractual term for outstanding options – days

                

GSTIP awards – deferred shares

    1,649,522        1,246,167        600,778        60,501        2,234,410        191,704   

GSTIP awards – options

    335,160                             335,160        247,906   

– weighted average exercise price – A$

    39.29                             39.29        38.41   

– weighted average share price – A$

                

– weighted average contractual term for outstanding options – days

            14     

LTIP awards

    13,531,419        550,954        3,747,840        287,179        10,047,354        2,250,843   

MAP awards

    6,207,609        3,287,253        1,334,130        319,058        7,841,674        554,150   

Shareplus

    2,154,184        1,620,551        1,113,270        225,264        2,436,201          
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

BHP Billiton Plc

           

GIS awards – deferred shares

    358,741        78,169        175,749        8,085        253,076        121,712   

GIS awards – options

    490,143               169,287        23,814        297,042        266,653   

– weighted average exercise price – £

    12.51               11.20        16.51        12.94        11.71   

– weighted average share price – £

        19.43         

– weighted average contractual term for outstanding options – days

            5     

GSTIP awards – deferred shares

    715,310        489,703        309,737        4,723        890,553        117,071   

GSTIP awards – options

    96,012                             96,012        29,457   

– weighted average exercise price – £

    20.35                             20.35        16.44   

– weighted average share price – £

                

– weighted average contractual term for outstanding options – days

            37     

LTIP awards

    5,461,373        293,020        1,637,984        175,139        3,941,270        859,016   

MAP awards

    2,358,080        1,084,015        540,306        64,749        2,837,040        257,500   

Shareplus

    516,791        400,855        259,884        69,406        588,356          
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-105


Table of Contents

Fair value and assumptions in the calculation of fair value for awards issued

 

2012

   Weighted
average
fair value
of awards
granted
during
the year 
(a)
US$
     Risk-free
interest
rate
(b)
    Estimated
life of
awards
     Share
price at
grant
date
     Estimated
volatility
of share
price
(c)
    Dividend
yield
 

BHP Billiton Limited

               

GIS awards – deferred shares

     47.77         n/a        3 years         A$43.77         n/a        2.19

GIS awards – options

                                             

GSTIP awards – deferred shares

     44.77         n/a        3 years         A$43.77         n/a        2.19

GSTIP awards – options

                                             

LTIP awards

     27.61         1.82     5 years         A$43.77         33.0     2.19

MAP awards

     43.79         n/a        3 years         A$43.77         n/a        2.19

Shareplus

     30.47         4.38     3 years         A$33.80         n/a        2.25
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

BHP Billiton Plc

               

GIS awards – deferred shares

     40.38         n/a        3 years         £24.60         n/a        2.47

GIS awards – options

                                             

GSTIP awards – deferred shares

     37.52         n/a        3 years         £24.60         n/a        2.47

GSTIP awards – options

                                             

LTIP awards

     23.27         1.82     5 years         £24.60         33.0     2.47

MAP awards

     36.59         n/a        3 years         £24.60         n/a        2.47

Shareplus

     25.57         2.76     3 years         £18.53         n/a        2.57
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Employee share awards – past plans (d)

 

2014

   Number
of awards
at the
beginning
of the
financial
year
     Number
of
awards
issued
     Number
of
awards
exercised
     Number
of
awards
lapsed
     Number of
awards
remaining
at the end
of the
financial
year
     Number of
awards
exercisable
at the end
of the
financial
year
 

BHP Billiton Limited

                 

Employee Share Plan shares

     3,950,536                 1,773,508                 2,177,028         2,177,028   

 

F-106


Table of Contents

2013

   Number
of awards
at the
beginning
of the
financial
year
     Number
of
awards
issued
     Number
of
awards
exercised
     Number
of
awards
lapsed
     Number of
awards
remaining
at the end
of the
financial
year
     Number of
awards
exercisable
at the end
of the
financial
year
 

BHP Billiton Limited

                 

Employee Share Plan shares

     5,447,321                 1,496,785                 3,950,536         3,950,536   

 

2012

   Number
of awards
at the
beginning
of the
financial
year
     Number
of
awards
issued
     Number
of
awards
exercised
     Number
of
awards
lapsed
     Number of
awards
remaining
at the end
of the
financial
year
     Number of
awards
exercisable
at the end
of the
financial
year
 

BHP Billiton Limited

                 

Employee Share Plan options

     284,850                 242,010         42,840                   

– weighted average exercise price – A$

     8.30                 8.30         8.30                   

Employee Share Plan shares

     6,960,419                 1,513,098                 5,447,321         5,447,321   

Performance Share Plan Performance Rights

     58,563                 58,563                           
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

BHP Billiton Plc

                 

Co-Investment Plan (CIP)

     2,245                 2,245                           
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Employee share awards – summary (f) (g)

 

    Awards outstanding at:            

Month of issue

  30 June 2014     11 September 2014     Exercise price (e)    

Exercise period/release date

BHP Billiton Limited

       

Employee Share Plan shares

       

October 1997

    826,659        806,008             Oct 1997 – Oct 2017

May 1995

    1,350,369        1,305,763             May 1995 – May 2015
 

 

 

   

 

 

     
    2,177,028        2,111,771       
 

 

 

   

 

 

     

GIS awards

       

Deferred shares

       

December 2013

    114,629        91,398             Aug 2015 – Aug 2018

December 2012

    28,915                    Aug 2014 – Aug 2017
 

 

 

   

 

 

     
    143,544        91,398       
 

 

 

   

 

 

     

GSTIP awards

       

Deferred shares

       

October 2013

    1,189,309        1,147,144             Aug 2015 – Aug 2018

October 2012

    942,186                    Aug 2014 – Aug 2017

 

F-107


Table of Contents
    Awards outstanding at:            

Month of issue

  30 June 2014     11 September 2014     Exercise price (e)    

Exercise period/release date

October 2010

    46,839        46,839             Aug 2012 – Aug 2015

Options

       

October 2010

    87,254        87,254        A$41.78      Aug 2012 – Aug 2015

October 2009

    23,065               A$38.41      Aug 2011 – Aug 2014
 

 

 

   

 

 

     
    2,288,653        1,281,237       
 

 

 

   

 

 

     

LTIP awards

       

December 2013

    1,298,015        1,219,116             Aug 2018 – Aug 2023

December 2012

    315,012        263,372             Aug 2017 – Aug 2022

December 2011

    287,368        255,721             Aug 2016 – Aug 2021

December 2010

    370,069        357,171             Aug 2015 – Aug 2020

December 2009

    563,149        62,214             Aug 2014 – Aug 2019

December 2008

    216,264                    Aug 2013 – Aug 2018

December 2007

    625,780        544,030             Aug 2012 – Aug 2017

December 2006

    455,899        392,716             Aug 2011 – Aug 2016

December 2005

    197,349        188,516             Aug 2010 – Aug 2015

December 2004

    17,275                    Aug 2009 – Aug 2014
 

 

 

   

 

 

     
    4,346,180        3,282,856       
 

 

 

   

 

 

     

Transitional GMC awards

       

December 2013

    117,680        117,680             Aug 2017

December 2013

    117,680        117,680             Aug 2016

December 2012

    17,917        17,917             Aug 2016

December 2012

    17,917        17,917             Aug 2015
 

 

 

   

 

 

     
    271,194        271,194       
 

 

 

   

 

 

     

MAP awards

       

October 2013 and April 2014

    2,705,673        2,689,976             Aug 2016 – Aug 2019

October 2012 and March 2013

    2,530,705        2,433,349             Aug 2015 – Aug 2018

October 2011 and March 2012

    1,983,767        9,467             Aug 2014 – Aug 2017

October 2010 and March 2011

    318,725        286,075             Aug 2013 – Aug 2016

October 2009 and March 2010

    168,125        160,125             Aug 2012 – Aug 2015
 

 

 

   

 

 

     
    7,706,995        5,578,992       
 

 

 

   

 

 

     

Shareplus

       

September 2013 to June 2014

    1,878,199        1,803,854             Apr 2016

September 2012 to June 2013

    1,582,606        1,525,478             Apr 2015
 

 

 

   

 

 

     
    3,460,805        3,329,332       
 

 

 

   

 

 

     

BHP Billiton Plc

       

GIS awards

       

Deferred shares

       

December 2012

    35,081                    Aug 2014 – Aug 2017

Options

       

December 2010

    30,389        30,389        £23.71      Aug 2012 – Aug 2015
 

 

 

   

 

 

     
    65,470        30,389       
 

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

F-108


Table of Contents
    Awards outstanding at:            

Month of issue

  30 June 2014     11 September 2014     Exercise price (e)    

Exercise period/release date

GSTIP awards

       

Deferred shares

       

October 2013

    213,706        208,032             Aug 2015 – Aug 2018

October 2012

    220,223        5,489             Aug 2014 – Aug 2017

October 2010

    13,228        13,228             Aug 2012 – Aug 2015

Options

       

October 2010

    42,473        42,473        £22.08      Aug 2012 – Aug 2015
 

 

 

   

 

 

     
    489,630        269,222       
 

 

 

   

 

 

     

LTIP awards

       

December 2012

    287,231        287,231             Aug 2017 – Aug 2022

December 2011

    202,672        202,672             Aug 2016 – Aug 2021

December 2010

    190,000        190,000             Aug 2015 – Aug 2020

December 2009

    214,000                    Aug 2014 – Aug 2019

December 2007

    240,644        232,744             Aug 2012 – Aug 2017

December 2006

    171,610        171,027             Aug 2011 – Aug 2016

December 2005

    121,466        114,883             Aug 2010 – Aug 2015

December 2004

    7,500                    Aug 2009 – Aug 2014
 

 

 

   

 

 

     
    1,435,123        1,198,557       
 

 

 

   

 

 

     

Transitional GMC awards

       

December 2012

    19,930        19,930             Aug 2016

December 2012

    19,930        19,930             Aug 2015
 

 

 

   

 

 

     
    39,860        39,860       
 

 

 

   

 

 

     

MAP awards

       

October 2013 and April 2014

    678,815        658,963             Aug 2016 – Aug 2019

October 2012 and March 2013

    681,930        661,029             Aug 2015 – Aug 2018

October 2011 and March 2012

    670,715        37,935             Aug 2014 – Aug 2017

October 2010 and March 2011

    153,426        131,550             Aug 2013 – Aug 2016

October 2009 and March 2010

    77,320        74,820             Aug 2012 – Aug 2015

November 2008 and March 2009

    1,000                    Aug 2011 – Aug 2014
 

 

 

   

 

 

     
    2,263,206        1,564,297       
 

 

 

   

 

 

     

Shareplus

       

September 2013 to June 2014

    404,974        387,077             Apr 2016

September 2012 to June 2013

    352,492        342,306             Apr 2015
 

 

 

   

 

 

     
    757,466        729,383       
 

 

 

   

 

 

     

Kgatelo Pele ESOP

       

June 2014

    30,208        30,208             Jun 2017

June 2013

    35,856        35,856             Jun 2016
 

 

 

   

 

 

     
    66,064        66,064       
 

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

(a) The fair value of awards as presented in the tables above represents the fair value at grant date. The fair values of awards granted were estimated using a Monte Carlo simulation methodology, Black-Scholes option pricing technique and net present value technique.

 

(b) The risk-free interest rate used is an applicable government bond rate.

 

F-109


Table of Contents
(c) Historical volatility has been used to estimate the volatility of the share price.

 

(d) Awards issued under these plans occurred before 7 November 2002 and as such are exempt from the provisions of IFRS 2/AASB 2 ‘Share-based Payment’. Details of these plans have been provided for information purposes only.

 

(e) Exercise price on awards issued is equal to the exercise price as per awards outstanding.

 

(f) Shares issued on exercise of BHP Billiton’s employee share ownership plans include shares purchased on-market.

 

(g) In respect of employee share awards, the Group utilises the following trusts:

 

  (i) The Billiton Employee Share Ownership Plan Trust is a discretionary trust for the benefit of all employees of BHP Billiton Plc and its subsidiaries. The trustee is an independent company, resident in Jersey. The Trust uses funds provided by BHP Billiton Plc and/or its subsidiaries as appropriate to acquire ordinary shares to enable awards to be made or satisfied under the LTIP, MAP, GIS, GSTIP, CIP, Shareplus and other employee share schemes operated by BHP Billiton Plc from time to time. The ordinary shares may be acquired by purchase in the market or by subscription at not less than nominal value. The Trust has waived its rights to dividends on shares held to meet future awards under Shareplus.

 

  (ii) The BHP Billiton Limited Executive Incentive Scheme Trust is a discretionary trust established for the purpose of holding shares in BHP Billiton Limited to satisfy exercises made under the LTIP, MAP, GIS, GSTIP, Shareplus and other employee share schemes operated by BHP Billiton Limited from time to time. During the 2014 financial year, this Trust was closed and any remaining shares were used to satisfy employee awards.

 

  (iii) The BHP Billiton Employee Equity Trust is a discretionary trust for the benefit of all employees of BHP Billiton Limited and its subsidiaries. The Trust uses funds provided by BHP Billiton Limited and/or its subsidiaries as appropriate to acquire ordinary shares to enable awards to be made or satisfied under the LTIP, MAP, GIS, GSTIP, Shareplus and other employee share schemes operated by BHP Billiton Limited from time to time. The ordinary shares may be acquired by purchase in the market or by subscription at not less than nominal value. The Trust has waived its rights to dividends on shares held.

 

  (iv) Kgatelo Pele Trust is a discretionary trust established for the benefit of the Hotazel Manganese Mines employees. The Trust uses funds provided by Hotazel Manganese mines to acquire shares in BHP Billiton Plc until such time that they vest in the employees.

34    Employees

 

     2014      2013      2012  

Average number of employees (a)

        

Petroleum and Potash

     4,207         4,449         4,067   

Copper

     10,070         10,435         9,445   

Iron Ore

     8,035         6,883         4,711   

Coal

     12,318         12,240         11,679   

Aluminium, Manganese and Nickel

     10,775         11,115         11,388   

Group and unallocated

     1,639         1,770         1,948   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total average number of employees

     47,044         46,892         43,238   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(a)  Average employee numbers include the Executive Director, 100 per cent of employees of subsidiary companies and our share of employees of joint operations. Employees of equity accounted investments are not included. Part-time employees are included on a full-time equivalent basis. Employees of businesses acquired or disposed of during the year are included for the period of ownership. Contractors are not included.

 

F-110


Table of Contents

35    Auditor’s remuneration

 

     2014      2013      2012  
     US$M      US$M      US$M  

Fees payable to the Group’s auditor for assurance services

        

Audit of the Group’s annual report (a)

     4.093         3.953         4.577   

Audit of subsidiaries, joint ventures and associates (b)

     13.201         15.197         17.927   

Audit-related assurance services (c)

     5.635         5.779         6.317   

Other assurance services (d)

     2.133         3.844         3.637   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total assurance services

     25.062         28.773         32.458   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Fees payable to the Group’s auditor for other services

        

Other services relating to corporate finance (e)

     1.820         0.393         2.378   

All other services (f)

     1.302         1.372         1.407   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total other services

     3.122         1.765         3.785   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total fees

     28.184         30.538         36.243   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

All amounts were paid to KPMG or KPMG affiliated firms. Fees are determined in local currencies and are billed in US dollars based on the exchange rate at the beginning of the relevant financial year.

 

(a) Comprises the fee payable to the Group’s auditors for the audit of the Group’s financial statements.

 

(b) Comprises the audits of the Group’s subsidiaries, joint ventures and associates, as well as audit fees of US$ nil (2013: US$0.204 million; 2012: US$0.051 million) for pension funds. For UK purposes, fees for the audit of pension funds would be classified as a separate component of ‘other services’.

 

(c) Mainly comprises review of half-year reports and audit work in relation to compliance with section 404 of the US Sarbanes-Oxley Act.

 

(d) Mainly comprises assurance in respect of the Group’s sustainability reporting.

 

(e) Mainly comprises services in connection with acquisitions, divestments and debt raising transactions.

 

(f) Mainly comprises non-statutory assurance based procedures, advice on accounting matters and tax compliance services. Tax compliance services amounted to US$ 0.008 million (2013: US$ nil; 2012: US$ nil).

36    Subsequent events

Proposed demerger of assets

The Group announced on 19 August 2014 that it plans to demerge a selection of its aluminium, coal, manganese, nickel and silver assets to create an independent metals and mining company. This includes BHP Billiton’s interests in its integrated Aluminium business, Manganese business and the Cerro Matoso nickel operation, Energy Coal South Africa, Illawarra metallurgical coal and the Cannington silver-lead-zinc mine.

It is intended that the new company would be listed on the Australian Securities Exchange with a secondary listing on the Johannesburg Stock Exchange. A final Board decision will only be made once the necessary government, taxation, regulatory and other third party approvals are secured on satisfactory terms. Once the necessary approvals are in place, shareholders will have the opportunity to vote on the proposed demerger.

As numerous steps are required to enable the demerger to proceed, the relevant businesses have not been classified as held for sale or distribution as at 30 June 2014. Subject to final Board approval to proceed, shareholder approval and the receipt of satisfactory third party approvals, the demerger is expected to be completed in the first half of the 2015 calendar year.

 

F-111


Table of Contents

Summarised financial information as at 30 June 2014 and for the year ended 30 June 2014 of the businesses included in the proposed demerger is provided below:

 

     2014  
     US$M  

Current assets

     2,860   

Non-current assets

     14,619   

Current liabilities

     1,897   

Non-current liabilities

     3,950   
  

 

 

 

Net assets

     11,632   
  

 

 

 

Attributable to non-controlling interests

     867   

Attributable to members of BHP Billiton Group

     10,765   
  

 

 

 

Revenue

     10,444   

Depreciation and amortisation

     1,303   

Profit before interest and taxation

     764   
  

 

 

 

Net operating cash inflows

     1,658   

Net investing cash outflows

     700   
  

 

 

 

Transaction costs incurred

     45   
  

 

 

 

The demerger will be recognised as a reduction in equity at the fair value of the shares in the demerged company distributed to shareholders. A gain or loss will arise on the difference between the fair value of those shares and the net assets of the demerged businesses determined at the date of the demerger, which will include the fair value step-up on the Manganese business described below, less any transaction costs. Transaction costs will mainly comprise stamp duty, professional fees and separation and establishment costs.

In contemplation of the proposed demerger, BHP Billiton and Anglo American have agreed to make certain changes to the agreement which governs their interests in the Manganese business. BHP Billiton manages and owns 60 per cent of the Manganese business with Anglo American owning the remaining 40 per cent.

Subject to obtaining the required approvals for the agreement, the changes will result in BHP Billiton and Anglo American agreeing to share joint control of the Manganese business. BHP Billiton will discontinue consolidation of the Manganese business and account for its 60 per cent interest as an equity accounted joint venture. BHP Billiton will therefore derecognise the existing carrying amounts of all assets, liabilities and the non-controlling interest in the Manganese business attributed to Anglo American and initially record its retained 60 per cent interest at fair value. The remeasurement at fair value will give rise to an estimated gain of approximately US$2 billion.

Repeal of Minerals Resource Rent Tax (MRRT)

On 2 September 2014, legislation to repeal the MRRT in Australia received the support of both Houses of Parliament. The MRRT will continue to apply until 30 September 2014. At 30 June 2014, the Group carried an MRRT deferred tax asset (net of income tax consequences) of US$698 million. An income tax charge approximating this amount is expected to be recognised in the 2015 financial year.

Chilean tax reform

Subsequent to the finalisation of the financial statements, the lower house of the newly elected Chilean Government passed a tax reform bill that will be retroactively applied to all entities operating in Chile starting from 1 January 2014. While the reform is yet to be signed by the President of Chile, the reform reflects the

 

F-112


Table of Contents

underlying principles that the government presented to Congress earlier this year and is therefore taken as substantively enacted with lower house approval. The reform allows entities to elect into one of two new taxation systems with both systems progressively increasing the first category tax rate over a 4 to 5 year period. BHP Billiton is currently assessing the impacts of this reform before making any election. The impacts of this reform will be reflected in the year ending 30 June 2015.

Other than the matters outlined above, no matters or circumstances have arisen since the end of the financial year that have significantly affected, or may significantly affect, the operations, results of operations or state of affairs of the Group in subsequent accounting periods.

37    Impact of new accounting standards and change in accounting policies

Comparative financial information for the years ended 30 June 2012 and 30 June 2013 has been restated for the effects of new accounting standards and interpretations which came into effect in the financial year commencing from 1 July 2013; and for the effects of other voluntary changes in accounting policy. The changes described below resulted in changes to assets and liabilities reported for each segment. The segments impacted are identified below for each asset affected. The nature of each change reflected in the restated comparative information is as follows:

 

  IFRS 10/AASB 10 ‘Consolidated Financial Statements’ is a replacement of IAS 27/AASB 127 ‘Consolidated and Separate Financial Statements’. The revised standard introduces a modified single concept of control that applies to all entities. It changes the requirements for determining whether an entity is consolidated by revising the definition of control and adding further guiding principles. Under IFRS 10, Minera Escondida Limitada (Escondida – Copper Segment) has been determined as being controlled by the Group. Under IAS 27, BHP Billiton did not control Escondida and it accounted for Escondida as a jointly controlled entity in accordance with the previous IAS 31 ‘Interest in Joint Ventures’. As a result, the Group recognised its 57.5 per cent share of Escondida’s revenue, expenses, assets, liabilities and cash flows in its financial statements.

The restated comparative information presents 100 per cent of Escondida’s revenue, expenses, assets, liabilities and cash flows and a 42.5 per cent non-controlling interest in Escondida’s profit and net assets. Upon transition to IFRS 10 effective on 1 July 2011, an increase to Total Equity of US$2,226 million was recorded, representing the recognition of the non-controlling interests as at that date.

No other entities which were previously not consolidated under IAS 27 have been determined to be controlled under IFRS 10.

 

  IFRS 11/AASB 11 ‘Joint Arrangements’ is a replacement of IAS 31/AASB131 ‘Interest in Joint Ventures’ and modifies the accounting for joint arrangements in two ways:

 

    it changes the definition of joint control with reference to the definition of unanimous consent being the contractually agreed sharing of control of an arrangement with reference to voting on relevant activities. Arrangements which do not fall within this definition are beyond the scope of IFRS 11 and are accounted for under other IFRS; and

 

    for those entities within the scope of IFRS 11, a distinction is made between joint ventures and joint operations based on the rights and obligations of the parties arising from the arrangement in the normal course of business. Entities in which the Group has rights only to the net assets of the arrangement are classified as ‘joint ventures’ and are equity accounted under the modified IAS 28 ‘Investments in Associates and Joint Ventures’. Entities in which the Group has rights to the underlying assets and obligations for the liabilities of the arrangement are classified as ‘joint operations’. Accordingly, the Group recognises its share of the jointly held assets and liabilities, its proportionate share of revenue or output from the joint operation and its share of any expenses incurred jointly.

 

F-113


Table of Contents

Entities previously accounted for as jointly controlled entities now accounted for as equity accounted investments

The following entities previously accounted for as jointly controlled entities under IAS 31 no longer meet the definition of joint control with reference to the definition of unanimous consent and are now considered associates that are equity accounted under the revised IAS 28:

 

    Compañía Minera Antamina SA (Copper Segment);

 

    Carbones del Cerrejón LLC (Coal Segment);

 

    Newcastle Coal Infrastructure Group Pty Limited (Coal Segment);

 

    Cleopatra Gas Gathering Company LLC (Petroleum and Potash Segment); and

 

    Caesar Oil Pipeline Company LLC (Petroleum and Potash Segment).

The following entities previously accounted for as jointly controlled entities under IAS 31 are now classified as joint ventures under IFRS 11 and are equity accounted under the requirements of the revised IAS 28:

 

    Samarco Mineração SA (Iron Ore Segment); and

 

    Richards Bay Minerals (Group and Unallocated) comprising two legal entities, Richards Bay Mining (Proprietary) Limited and Richards Bay Titanium (Proprietary) Limited.

As a result of these changes, the Group no longer recognises its proportionate share of the revenue, expenses, assets, liabilities and cash flows of each of the above entities. Instead the Group recognises:

 

    its interest in the joint venture on a single line, ‘Investments accounted for using the equity method’, in the Consolidated Balance Sheet;

 

    its share of net profit on a single line, ‘Share of operating profit of equity accounted investments’, in the Consolidated Income Statement;

 

    cash flows as ‘Dividends received from equity accounted investments’ in the Consolidated Cash Flow Statement; and

 

    equity accounted investments are now considered to be related parties to the Group.

Transition to IFRS 11 and the revised IAS 28 effective on 1 July 2011 has resulted in an increase in net assets of US$480 million as the Group’s share of losses of equity accounted investments exceeded the carrying amount of its interests in those equity accounted investments on transition date. Shares of subsequent profits earned by these loss-making equity accounted investments (for which the investment balance has been reduced to nil) have not been recognised in the restated comparative information (and will not be recognised in the future) until the previously unrecognised losses have been recouped. Where the Group’s investment in an equity accounted investment is nil (and there is no legal or constructive obligation or the Group has not made payment on behalf of the associate or joint venture), dividends received from the equity accounted investment have been recognised in the Group’s result as a ‘Share of operating profit of equity accounted investments’ for the period rather than being eliminated as a consolidation adjustment.

Entities previously accounted for as jointly controlled entities now classified as joint operations

The following entities previously accounted for as jointly controlled entities under IAS 31 have been classified as joint operations under IFRS 11 and, as a result, there is no impact on the comparative information as the Group will continue to recognise its share of assets, liabilities, revenues, expenses and cash flows:

 

    Phola Coal Processing Plant (Pty) Ltd (Coal Segment); and

 

    Mozal SARL (Aluminium, Manganese and Nickel Segment).

 

F-114


Table of Contents

Contractual Arrangements previously accounted for as jointly controlled assets now classified as joint operations

The following contractual arrangements, previously accounted for as jointly controlled assets under IAS 31 have been classified as joint operations and, as a result, there is no impact on the comparative information as the Group has continued to recognise its share of assets, liabilities, revenues, expenses and cash flows:

 

    Petroleum Joint arrangements including Atlantis, Bass Strait, Greater Angostura, Liverpool Bay, Macedon, Mad Dog, Minerva, Neptune, North West Shelf, Onshore US, Pyrenees, ROD Integrated Development, Shenzi, Stybarrow and Zamzama;

 

    Central Queensland Coal Associates;

 

    Gregory;

 

    Alumar; and

 

    Worsley.

Contractual Arrangements previously accounted for as jointly controlled assets now accounted for under other IFRS

The following contractual arrangements, previously accounted for as jointly controlled assets under IAS 31 do not fall within the scope of either IFRS 10 or IFRS 11 and as a result these arrangements have been accounted for under other IFRS. This has not resulted in a change to the comparative information as the Group has continued to recognise its share of revenues, expenses, assets, liabilities and cash flows:

 

    Mt Goldsworthy;

 

    Mt Newman;

 

    Yandi; and

 

    EKATI.

 

  IFRIC 20 ‘Stripping Costs in the Production Phase of a Surface Mine’ applies to waste removal (stripping) costs incurred during the production phase of a surface mine; it does not deal with stripping costs in the development phase of a surface mine nor stripping costs in an underground mine. IFRIC 20 modifies the accounting for production stripping as follows:

 

    requires an entity to recognise a production stripping asset only when the following criteria are met:

 

    it is probable that the future economic benefit (improved access to the ore body) associated with the stripping activity will flow to the entity;

 

    the entity can identify the component of the ore body for which access has been improved; and

 

    the costs relating to the stripping activity associated with that component can be measured reliably.

 

    mandates that stripping activity assets be depreciated on a systematic basis, over the expected useful life of the identified component of the ore body that becomes more accessible as a result of the stripping activity. The units of production method shall be applied unless another method is more appropriate; and

 

    provides principles to follow in the determination of the adjustment on transition.

The Group has determined a component to be that part of the ore body that is directly accessible as a result of the stripping activity. Depending on the ore body and associated mine plan, each pushback or phase identified in the mine plan will generally constitute a separate component.

 

F-115


Table of Contents

Before the introduction of IFRIC 20, the Group’s accounting for production stripping costs was based on common industry practice in compliance with IFRS principles as follows:

 

    when the ratio of waste material to ore extracted (for an area of interest) was expected to be constant throughout its estimated life, the production stripping costs for the period were charged directly to the income statement as operating costs; and

 

    when the ratio of waste to ore extracted (for an area of interest) was not expected to be constant throughout its estimated life, strip accounting was applied as follows:

 

    in periods when the current ratio of waste to ore (current strip ratio) was greater than the estimated life-of-mine ratio of waste to ore (life-of-mine strip ratio), the cost of removal of the excess portion of waste (inclusive of an allocation of relevant overhead expenditure) was capitalised to the balance sheet in ‘Other mineral assets’; and

 

    in subsequent periods when the current strip ratio was less than the estimated life-of-mine strip ratio, a portion of previously capitalised stripping costs (representing the difference between the amount of waste actually removed and the average amount of waste removed per period) was charged to the income statement as operating costs.

IFRIC 20 has impacted the accounting for production stripping at Escondida, Western Australia Iron Ore, Nickel West and EKATI. At the Group’s transition date of 1 July 2011, the net book value of deferred stripping balances for all surface mines was US$2,125 million, after adjusting for the impact of IFRS 10 and 11 as set out above. Application of IFRIC 20 to the Group has resulted in a transition adjustment to reduce the deferred stripping asset by US$1,797 million with a corresponding decrease in opening total equity of US$1,797 million (US$1,273 million after tax).

 

  The Group has changed its Exploration and Evaluation Expenditure policy from 1 July 2013 such that all acquisitions of exploration leases are classified as intangible exploration assets or tangible exploration assets based on the nature of the assets acquired. Only acquired exploration leases which can be reasonably associated with known resources (for mineral leases) or known reserves (for petroleum leases) are now classified as a tangible asset (component of ‘Property, plant and equipment’). All other exploration leases acquired are now classified as an intangible asset (‘Other intangible asset’). This has resulted in reclassification of exploration assets from ‘Property, plant and equipment’ to ‘Intangible assets’. Prior period comparative information has been restated for consistent presentation with the current period.

 

  In addition to the above newly applicable accounting standards, interpretations and changes in policy which have required restatement of comparative information, the following new or revised accounting standards have been applied commencing 1 July 2013, but have not had sufficient impact to warrant any restatements:

 

    IFRS 13/AASB 13 ‘Fair Value Measurement’ replaces fair value measurement guidance in individual IFRSs with a single source of fair value measurement guidance; and

 

    Amendments to IAS 19/AASB 119 ‘Employee Benefits’. These amendments require:

 

    all actuarial gains and losses to be recognised immediately in other comprehensive income (consistent with current Group policy);

 

    the expected return on plan assets (recognised in the income statement) must be calculated based on the rate used to discount the defined benefit obligation;

 

    the definition of short term benefits (e.g. annual leave) has changed from a focus on when such benefits are due to be settled to when they are expected to be settled requiring a best estimate of the timing of expected future cash flows; and

 

    ‘Expected return on pension scheme assets’ and ‘Discounting on post-retirement employee benefits’ previously reported as separate components of ‘Financial income’ and ‘Financial expenses’ respectively are now being replaced by a single item ‘Net interest expense/(income) on post-retirement employee benefits’.

 

F-116


Table of Contents

Consolidated Income Statement for the year ended 30 June 2013

 

    Year ended
30 June 2013

As published
    Restatements     Year ended
30 June 2013

Restated
 
      IFRS10     IFRS11     IFRIC20     Other    
    US$M                             US$M  

Revenue

           

Group production

    63,203        3,744        (3,880                   63,067   

Third party products

    2,765        (108     229                      2,886   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Revenue

    65,968        3,636        (3,651                   65,953   

Other income

    4,130        10        (193                   3,947   

Expenses excluding net finance costs

    (50,873     (1,889     1,909        813               (50,040

Share of operating profit of equity accounted investments

                  1,065        77               1,142   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Profit from operations

    19,225        1,757        (870     890               21,002   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Comprising:

           

Group production

    19,104        1,755        (874     890               20,875   

Third party products

    121        2        4                      127   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
    19,225        1,757        (870     890               21,002   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Financial expenses

    (1,522     (14     60               92        (1,384

Financial income

    169               31               (92     108   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net finance costs

    (1,353     (14     91                      (1,276
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Profit before taxation

    17,872        1,743        (779     890               19,726   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income tax expense

    (5,641     (384     518        (207            (5,714

Royalty-related taxation (net of income tax benefit)

    (1,156     (85     55        (6            (1,192
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total taxation expense

    (6,797     (469     573        (213            (6,906
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Profit after taxation

    11,075        1,274        (206     677               12,820   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Attributable to non-controlling interests

    199        1,274        (8     132               1,597   

Attributable to members of BHP Billiton Group

    10,876               (198     545               11,223   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Basic earnings per ordinary share (cents)

    204.4               (3.7     10.2               210.9   

Diluted earnings per ordinary share (cents)

    203.7               (3.7     10.2               210.2   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Dividends per ordinary share – paid during the period (cents)

    114.0                                    114.0   

Dividends per ordinary share – determined in respect of the period (cents)

    116.0                                    116.0   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-117


Table of Contents

Consolidated Balance Sheet as at 30 June 2013

 

     As at
30 June 2013
As published
    Restatements     As at
30 June 2013

Restated
 
       IFRS10     IFRS11     IFRIC20     Other    
     US$M                             US$M  

ASSETS

            

Current assets

            

Cash and cash equivalents

     6,060        95        (478                   5,677   

Trade and other receivables

     6,728        280        (698                   6,310   

Other financial assets

     159        1        1                      161   

Inventories

     5,822        522        (296     (227            5,821   

Assets classified as held for sale

     286                                    286   

Current tax assets

     327               (60                   267   

Other

     404        44        (17                   431   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total current assets

     19,786        942        (1,548     (227            18,953   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Non-current assets

            

Trade and other receivables

     1,579        (4     423                      1,998   

Other financial assets

     1,698        1        20                      1,719   

Inventories

     622               (3                   619   

Property, plant and equipment

     102,927        3,793        (5,452     (430     (273     100,565   

Intangible assets

     5,226        1        (4            273        5,496   

Investments accounted for using the equity method

                   3,545        130               3,675   

Deferred tax assets

     6,136               (147     80               6,069   

Other

     135               (51                   84   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total non-current assets

     118,323        3,791        (1,669     (220            120,225   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total assets

     138,109        4,733        (3,217     (447            139,178   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

LIABILITIES

            

Current liabilities

            

Trade and other payables

     10,881        280        (301                   10,860   

Interest bearing liabilities

     5,303        28        (243                   5,088   

Liabilities classified as held for sale

     220                                    220   

Other financial liabilities

     217        2        (9                   210   

Current tax payable

     1,148        25        (15                   1,158   

Provisions

     2,395        65        (88                   2,372   

Deferred income

     208        22        1                      231   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total current liabilities

     20,372        422        (655                   20,139   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Non-current liabilities

            

Trade and other payables

     293               (7                   286   

Interest bearing liabilities

     29,862        424        (2,187                   28,099   

Other financial liabilities

     582                                    582   

Deferred tax liabilities

     6,469        323        (346     (134            6,312   

Provisions

     8,237        123        (182                   8,178   

Deferred income

     259               32                      291   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total non-current liabilities

     45,702        870        (2,690     (134            43,748   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities

     66,074        1,292        (3,345     (134            63,887   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net assets

     72,035        3,441        128        (313            75,291   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

EQUITY

            

Share capital – BHP Billiton Limited

     1,186                                    1,186   

Share capital – BHP Billiton Plc

     1,069                                    1,069   

Treasury shares

     (540                                 (540

Reserves

     1,970                                    1,970   

Retained earnings

     66,979               128        (125            66,982   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total equity attributable to members of BHP Billiton Group

     70,664               128        (125            70,667   

Non-controlling interests

     1,371        3,441               (188            4,624   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total equity

     72,035        3,441        128        (313            75,291   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-118


Table of Contents

Consolidated Cash Flow Statement for the year ended 30 June 2013

 

    Year ended
30 June 2013
As published
    Restatements     Year ended
30 June 2013
Restated
 
      IFRS10     IFRS11     IFRIC20     Other    
    US$M                             US$M  

Operating activities

           

Profit before taxation

    17,872        1,743        (779     890            –        19,726   

Adjustments for:

           

Non-cash or non-operating exceptional items

    1,867               161        (135            1,893   

Depreciation and amortisation expense

    6,945        223        (202     65               7,031   

Net gain on sale of non-current assets

    (46                                 (46

Impairments of property, plant and equipment, financial assets and intangibles

    311        19                             330   

Employee share awards expense

    210                                    210   

Net finance costs

    1,353        14        (91                   1,276   

Share of operating profit of equity accounted investments

                  (1,065     (77            (1,142

Other

    (344     35        30        258               (21

Changes in assets and liabilities:

           

Trade and other receivables

    780        118        139                      1,037   

Inventories

    (47     (116     17        76               (70

Trade and other payables

    (557     (164     (46                   (767

Net other financial assets and liabilities

    122        (4     1                      119   

Provisions and other liabilities

    (817     8        26                      (783
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash generated from operations

    27,649        1,876        (1,809     1,077               28,793   

Dividends received

    13               (2                   11   

Dividends received from equity accounted investments

                  710                      710   

Interest received

    79               61                      140   

Interest paid

    (963     (11     48                      (926

Income tax refunded

                                         

Income tax paid

    (7,589     (360     331                      (7,618

Royalty-related taxation paid

    (937     (78     59                      (956
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net operating cash flows

    18,252        1,427        (602     1,077               20,154   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Investing activities

           

Purchases of property, plant and equipment

    (21,573     (940     1,347        (1,077            (22,243

Exploration expenditure

    (1,326     (32     7                      (1,351

Exploration expenditure expensed and included in operating cash flows

    1,022        32        (7                   1,047   

Purchase of intangibles

    (400                                 (400

Investment in financial assets

    (338            (137                   (475

Investment in subsidiaries, operations and joint operations, net of their cash

                                         

Investment in equity accounted investments

                  (84                   (84
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash outflows from investing activities

    (22,615     (940     1,126        (1,077            (23,506

Proceeds from sale of property, plant and equipment

    2,338                                    2,338   

Proceeds from financial assets

    204        (11     47                      240   

Proceeds from divestment of subsidiaries, operations and joint operations, net of their cash

    2,202               (1,700                   502   

Proceeds from sale or partial sale of equity accounted investments

                  1,700                      1,700   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net investing cash flows

    (17,871     (951     1,173        (1,077            (18,726
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Financing activities

           

Proceeds from interest bearing liabilities

    9,961        245        (1,049                   9,157   

Proceeds from debt related instruments

    14                                    14   

Repayment of interest bearing liabilities

    (2,580     (28     594                      (2,014

Proceeds from ordinary shares

    21                                    21   

Contributions from non-controlling interests

    73                                    73   

Purchase of shares by ESOP Trusts

    (445                                 (445

Dividends paid

    (6,167                                 (6,167

Dividends paid to non-controlling interests

    (55     (782                          (837
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net financing cash flows

    822        (565     (455                   (198
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net increase/(decrease) in cash and cash equivalents

    1,203        (89     116                      1,230   

Cash and cash equivalents, net of overdrafts, at the beginning of the financial year

    4,881        186        (613                   4,454   

Foreign currency exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents

    (34     (2     19                      (17
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash and cash equivalents, net of overdrafts, at the end of the financial year

    6,050        95        (478                   5,667   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-119


Table of Contents

Consolidated Income Statement for the year ended 30 June 2012

 

    Year ended
30 June 2012
As published
    Restatements     Year ended
30 June 2012
Restated
 
      IFRS10     IFRS11     IFRIC20     Other    
    US$M                US$M   

Revenue

           

Group production

    68,747        3,157        (4,935                   66,969   

Third party products

    3,479        (116     145                      3,508   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Revenue

    72,226        3,041        (4,790                   70,477   

Other income

    906        9        (17                   898   

Expenses excluding net finance costs

    (49,380     (1,733     2,143        326               (48,644

Share of operating profit of equity accounted investments

                  1,815        54               1,869   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Profit from operations

    23,752        1,317        (849     380               24,600   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Comprising:

           

Group production

    23,626        1,311        (851     380               24,466   

Third party products

    126        6        2                      134   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
    23,752        1,317        (849     380               24,600   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Financial expenses

    (955     (4     20               103        (836

Financial income

    225        2        44               (103     168   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net finance costs

    (730     (2     64                      (668
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Profit before taxation

    23,022        1,315        (785     380               23,932   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income tax expense

    (7,238     (251     529        (93            (7,053

Royalty-related taxation (net of income tax benefit)

    (252     (53     46        (3            (262
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total taxation expense

    (7,490     (304     575        (96            (7,315
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Profit after taxation

    15,532        1,011        (210     284               16,617   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Attributable to non-controlling interests

    115        1,011        (36     54               1,144   

Attributable to members of BHP Billiton Group

    15,417               (174     230               15,473   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Basic earnings per ordinary share (cents)

    289.6               (3.3     4.4               290.7   

Diluted earnings per ordinary share (cents)

    288.4               (3.3     4.3               289.4   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Dividends per ordinary share – paid during the period (cents)

    110.0                                    110.0   

Dividends per ordinary share – determined in respect of the period (cents)

    112.0                                    112.0   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-120


Table of Contents

Consolidated Balance Sheet as at 30 June 2012

 

     As at
30 June 2012

As published
    Restatements     As at
30 June 2012

Restated
 
       IFRS10      IFRS11     IFRIC20     Other    
     US$M                 US$M   

ASSETS

             

Current assets

             

Cash and cash equivalents

     4,781        186         (492                   4,475   

Trade and other receivables

     7,704        359         (634                   7,429   

Other financial assets

     282        13                              295   

Inventories

     6,233        389         (287     (166            6,169   

Assets classified as held for sale

     848                (848                     

Current tax assets

     137                (49                   88   

Other

     466        35         (30                   471   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total current assets

     20,451        982         (2,340     (166            18,927   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Non-current assets

             

Trade and other receivables

     1,475        1         893                      2,369   

Other financial assets

     1,881        4         30                      1,915   

Inventories

     424        16         (3                   437   

Property, plant and equipment

     95,247        3,108         (4,341     (1,304     (477     92,233   

Intangible assets

     5,112        1         (4            477        5,586   

Investments accounted for using the equity method

                    3,128        53               3,181   

Deferred tax assets

     4,525                (202     120               4,443   

Other

     158        1         (49                   110   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total non-current assets

     108,822        3,131         (548     (1,131            110,274   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total assets

     129,273        4,113         (2,888     (1,297            129,201   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

LIABILITIES

             

Current liabilities

             

Trade and other payables

     12,024        414         (247                   12,191   

Interest bearing liabilities

     3,531        37         (539                   3,029   

Liabilities classified as held for sale

     433                (433                     

Other financial liabilities

     200        18         (11                   207   

Current tax payable

     2,811        6         (71                   2,746   

Provisions

     2,784        66         (99                   2,751   

Deferred income

     251        11                              262   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total current liabilities

     22,034        552         (1,400                   21,186   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Non-current liabilities

             

Trade and other payables

     509                (12                   497   

Interest bearing liabilities

     24,799        198         (1,343                   23,654   

Other financial liabilities

     317        2                              319   

Deferred tax liabilities

     5,287        311         (237     (307            5,054   

Provisions

     8,914        101         (196                   8,819   

Deferred income

     328                29                      357   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total non-current liabilities

     40,154        612         (1,759     (307            38,700   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities

     62,188        1,164         (3,159     (307            59,886   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net assets

     67,085        2,949         271        (990            69,315   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

EQUITY

             

Share capital – BHP Billiton Limited

     1,186                                     1,186   

Share capital – BHP Billiton Plc

     1,069                                     1,069   

Treasury shares

     (533                                  (533

Reserves

     1,912                                     1,912   

Retained earnings

     62,236                326        (670            61,892   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total equity attributable to members of BHP Billiton Group

     65,870                326        (670            65,526   

Non-controlling interests

     1,215        2,949         (55     (320            3,789   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total equity

     67,085        2,949         271        (990            69,315   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-121


Table of Contents

Consolidated Cash Flow Statement for the year ended 30 June 2012

 

    Year ended
30 June 2012
As published
    Restatements     Year ended
30 June 2012
Restated
 
      IFRS10     IFRS11     IFRIC20     Other    
    US$M                US$M   

Operating activities

           

Profit before taxation

    23,022        1,315        (785     380            –        23,932   

Adjustments for:

           

Non-cash or non-operating exceptional items

    3,417                                    3,417   

Depreciation and amortisation expense

    6,408        204        (182     1               6,431   

Net gain on sale of non-current assets

    (116            (2                   (118

Impairments of property, plant and equipment, financial assets and intangibles

    100                                    100   

Employee share awards expense

    270                                    270   

Net finance costs

    730        2        (64                   668   

Share of operating profit of equity accounted investments

                  (1,815     (54            (1,869

Other

    (481            15        90               (376

Changes in assets and liabilities:

           

Trade and other receivables

    1,464        52        239                      1,755   

Inventories

    (208     5        53        166               16   

Trade and other payables

    (288     95        6                      (187

Net other financial assets and liabilities

    (18     4        (13                   (27

Provisions and other liabilities

    (1,026     (4     5                      (1,025
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash generated from operations

    33,274        1,673        (2,543     583               32,987   

Dividends received

    25               (15                   10   

Dividends received from equity accounted investments

                  712                      712   

Interest received

    127        2        92                      221   

Interest paid

    (715     (9     91                      (633

Income tax refunded

    530                                    530   

Income tax paid

    (7,842     (272     622                      (7,492

Royalty-related taxation paid

    (1,015     (61                          (1,076
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net operating cash flows

    24,384        1,333        (1,041     583               25,259   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Investing activities

           

Purchases of property, plant and equipment

    (18,385     (869     1,200        (583            (18,637

Exploration expenditure

    (2,452     (44     3                      (2,493

Exploration expenditure expensed and included in operating cash flows

    1,602        45        (3                   1,644   

Purchase of intangibles

    (220            1                      (219

Investment in financial assets

    (341            (130                   (471

Investment in subsidiaries, operations and joint operations, net of their cash

    (12,556                                 (12,556

Investment in equity accounted investments

                  (83                   (83
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash outflows from investing activities

    (32,352     (868     988        (583            (32,815

Proceeds from sale of property, plant and equipment

    159               (13                   146   

Proceeds from financial assets

    151        (14     41                      178   

Proceeds from divestment of subsidiaries, operations and joint operations, net of their cash

    6                                    6   

Proceeds from sale or partial sale of equity accounted investments

                                         
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net investing cash flows

    (32,036     (882     1,016        (583            (32,485
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Financing activities

           

Proceeds from interest bearing liabilities

    13,287               (470                   12,817   

Settlements from debt related instruments

    (180                                 (180

Repayment of interest bearing liabilities

    (4,280     (44     331                      (3,993

Proceeds from ordinary shares

    21                                    21   

Contributions from non-controlling interests

    101                                    101   

Purchase of shares by ESOP Trusts

    (424                                 (424

Share buy-back – BHP Billiton Plc

    (83                                 (83

Dividends paid

    (5,877                                 (5,877

Dividends paid to non-controlling interests

    (56     (287                          (343
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net financing cash flows

    2,509        (331     (139                   2,039   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net increase/(decrease) in cash and cash equivalents

    (5,143     120        (164                   (5,187

Cash and cash equivalents, net of overdrafts, at the beginning of the financial year

    10,080        65        (474                   9,671   

Foreign currency exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents

    (56     1        25                      (30
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash and cash equivalents, net of overdrafts, at the end of the financial year

    4,881        186        (613                   4,454   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-122


Table of Contents

7.2     Not required for US reporting

7.3     Directors’ declaration

In accordance with a resolution of the Directors of the BHP Billiton Group, the Directors declare that:

 

(a) in the Directors’ opinion and to the best of their knowledge the financial statements and notes, set out in sections 7.1 and 7.2, are in accordance with the UK Companies Act 2006 and the Australian Corporations Act 2001, including:

 

  (i) Complying with the applicable Accounting Standards; and

 

  (ii) Giving a true and fair view of the assets, liabilities, financial position and profit or loss of each of BHP Billiton Limited, BHP Billiton Plc, the BHP Billiton Group and the undertakings included in the consolidation taken as a whole as at 30 June 2014 and of their performance for the year ended 30 June 2014;

 

(b) the financial report also complies with International Financial Reporting Standards, as disclosed in note 1;

 

(c) to the best of the Directors’ knowledge, the management report (comprising the Strategic Report and Directors’ Report) includes a fair review of the development and performance of the business and the financial position of the BHP Billiton Group and the undertakings included in the consolidation taken as a whole, together with a description of the principal risks and uncertainties that the Group faces; and

 

(d) in the Directors’ opinion there are reasonable grounds to believe that each of the BHP Billiton Group, BHP Billiton Limited and BHP Billiton Plc will be able to pay its debts as and when they become due and payable.

The Directors have been given the declarations required by Section 295A of the Australian Corporations Act 2001 from the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer for the financial year ended 30 June 2014.

Signed in accordance with a resolution of the Board of Directors.

Jac Nasser AO

Chairman

Andrew Mackenzie

Chief Executive Officer

Dated this 11th day of September 2014

 

F-123


Table of Contents
7.4 Statement of Directors’ Responsibilities in respect of the Annual Report and the Financial Statements

The Directors are responsible for preparing the Annual Report and the Group and parent company financial statements in accordance with applicable law and regulations. References to the ‘Group and parent company financial statements’ are made in relation to the Group and individual parent company financial statements of BHP Billiton Plc.

UK company law requires the Directors to prepare Group and parent company financial statements for each financial year. The Directors are required to prepare the Group financial statements in accordance with IFRS as adopted by the EU and applicable law and have elected to prepare the parent company financial statements in accordance with UK Accounting Standards and applicable law (UK Generally Accepted Accounting Practice).

The Group financial statements must, in accordance with IFRS as adopted by the EU and applicable law, present fairly the financial position and performance of the Group; references in the UK Companies Act 2006 to such financial statements giving a true and fair view are references to their achieving a fair presentation.

The parent company financial statements must, in accordance with UK Generally Accepted Accounting Practice, give a true and fair view of the state of affairs of the parent company at the end of the financial year and of the profit or loss of the parent company for the financial year.

In preparing each of the Group and parent company financial statements, the Directors are required to:

 

  select suitable accounting policies and then apply them consistently;

 

  make judgements and estimates that are reasonable and prudent;

 

  for the Group financial statements, state whether they have been prepared in accordance with IFRS as adopted by the EU;

 

  for the parent company financial statements, state whether applicable UK Accounting Standards have been followed, subject to any material departures disclosed and explained in the parent company financial statements; and

 

  prepare the financial statements on the going concern basis unless it is inappropriate to presume that the Group and the parent company will continue in business.

The Directors are responsible for keeping proper accounting records that disclose with reasonable accuracy at any time the financial position of the parent company and enable them to ensure that its financial statements comply with the UK Companies Act 2006. They have general responsibility for taking such steps as are reasonably open to them to safeguard the assets of the Group and to prevent and detect fraud and other irregularities.

Under applicable law and regulations, the Directors are also responsible for preparing a Strategic Report, Directors’ Report, Directors’ Remuneration Report and Corporate Governance Statement that complies with that law and those regulations.

The Directors are responsible for the maintenance and integrity of the corporate and financial information included on the Company’s website. Legislation in the UK governing the preparation and dissemination of financial statements may differ from legislation in other jurisdictions.

 

F-124


Table of Contents
7.5 Not required for US reporting

 

F-125


Table of Contents

7.6    Reports of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firms

 

LOGO

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firms

To the members of BHP Billiton Plc and BHP Billiton Limited:

We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of the BHP Billiton Group (comprising BHP Billiton Plc, BHP Billiton Limited and their respective subsidiaries) as of 30 June 2014, and the related consolidated income statement, consolidated statement of comprehensive income, consolidated statement of changes in equity and consolidated cash flow statement for the year then ended. These consolidated financial statements are the responsibility of the BHP Billiton Group’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these consolidated financial statements based on our audits. The accompanying consolidated financial statements of the BHP Billiton Group as of 30 June 2013 and for each of the years in the two-year period ended 30 June 2013, were audited by other auditors whose report thereon dated 25 September 2013, expressed an unqualified opinion on those statements, before the restatement described in note 37 to the consolidated financial statements.

We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audits to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of the BHP Billiton Group as of 30 June 2014 and 2013, and the results of its operations and its cash flows for each of the years in the three-year period ended 30 June 2014, in conformity with International Financial Reporting Standards as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board.

We also have audited the adjustments described in notes 1 and 37 that were applied to restate the 2013 and 2012 consolidated financial statements. In our opinion, such adjustments are appropriate and have been properly applied. KPMG LLP was not engaged to audit, review, or apply any procedures to the 2013 consolidated financial statements of the BHP Billiton Group other than with respect to the adjustments and, accordingly, it does not express an opinion or any other form of assurance on the 2013 or 2012 consolidated financial statements taken as a whole.

We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the BHP Billiton Group’s internal control over financial reporting as of 30 June 2014, based on criteria established in Internal Control – Integrated Framework (1992) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission, and our report dated 25 September 2014 expressed an unqualified opinion on the effectiveness of the BHP Billiton Group’s internal control over financial reporting.

 

/s/ KPMG LLP

KPMG LLP

London, United Kingdom

25 September 2014

  

/s/ KPMG

KPMG

Melbourne, Australia

25 September 2014

 

F-126


Table of Contents

LOGO

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firms

To the members of BHP Billiton Plc and BHP Billiton Limited:

We have audited, before the effects of the adjustments to retrospectively apply the change in accounting described in note 37, the accompanying consolidated balance sheet of the BHP Billiton Group (comprising BHP Billiton Plc, BHP Billiton Limited and their respective subsidiaries) as of 30 June 2013, and the related consolidated income statement, consolidated statement of comprehensive income, consolidated statement of changes in equity and consolidated cash flow statement for each of the years in the two-year period ended 30 June 2013. The 2013 and 2012 financial statements before the effects of the adjustments discussed in note 37 are not presented herein. The 2013 and 2012 consolidated financial statements are the responsibility of the BHP Billiton Group’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these consolidated financial statements based on our audits.

We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audits to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

In our opinion, the 2013 and 2012 financial statements, before the effects of the adjustments to retrospectively apply the change in accounting described in notes 1 and 37, present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of the BHP Billiton Group as of 30 June 2013, and the results of its operations and its cash flows for each of the years in the two-year period ended 30 June 2013 in conformity with International Financial Reporting Standards as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board.

KPMG Audit Plc was not engaged to audit, review, or apply any procedures to the adjustments to retrospectively apply the change in accounting described in notes 1 and 37 and, accordingly, it does not express an opinion or any other form of assurance about whether such adjustments are appropriate and have been properly applied. Those adjustments were audited by a successor auditor.

 

/s/ KPMG Audit Plc

KPMG Audit Plc

London, United Kingdom

25 September 2013

  

/s/ KPMG

KPMG

Melbourne, Australia

25 September 2013

 

F-127


Table of Contents

LOGO

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firms

To the members of BHP Billiton Plc and BHP Billiton Limited:

We have audited the BHP Billiton Group’s (comprising BHP Billiton Plc, BHP Billiton Limited and their respective subsidiaries) internal control over financial reporting as of 30 June 2014, based on criteria established in Internal Control – Integrated Framework (1992) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO). The BHP Billiton Group’s management is responsible for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, included in the accompanying section 3.14.1 Risk and Audit Committee Report. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the BHP Billiton Group’s internal control over financial reporting based on our audit.

We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audit included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, and testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk. Our audit also included performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.

A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorisations of management and directors of the company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorised acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

In our opinion, the BHP Billiton Group maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of 30 June 2014, based on criteria established in Internal Control – Integrated Framework (1992) issued by the COSO.

 

F-128


Table of Contents

We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the consolidated balance sheet of the BHP Billiton Group as of 30 June 2014, and the related consolidated income statement, consolidated statement of comprehensive income, consolidated statement of changes in equity and consolidated cash flow statement for the year then ended, and our report dated 25 September 2014 expressed an unqualified opinion on those consolidated financial statements. We have also audited the adjustments described in notes 1 and 37 that were applied to restate the 2013 and 2012 consolidated financial statements.

 

/s/ KPMG LLP

KPMG LLP

London, United Kingdom

25 September 2014

  

/s/ KPMG

KPMG

Melbourne, Australia

25 September 2014

 

F-129


Table of Contents

7.7    Supplementary oil and gas information – unaudited

In accordance with the requirements of the Financial Accounting Standards Board (FASB) Accounting Standard Codification ‘Extractive Activities-Oil and Gas’ (Topic 932) and SEC requirements set out in Subpart 1200 of Regulation S-K, the Group is presenting certain disclosures about its oil and gas activities. These disclosures are presented below as supplementary oil and gas information, in addition to information disclosed in section 1.12.2 ‘Petroleum and Potash Business’, section 2.1.1 ‘Petroleum and Potash Business’, section 2.2.1 ‘Production – Petroleum’ and section 2.3.1 ‘Petroleum reserves’.

The information set out in this section is referred to as unaudited as it is not included in the scope of the audit opinion of the independent auditor on the Consolidated Financial Statements, refer section 7.6 Independent Auditors’ reports.

Reserves and production

Proved oil and gas reserves and net crude oil and condensate, natural gas, LNG and NGL production information is included in section 2.2.1 ‘Production – Petroleum’ and section 2.3.1 ‘Petroleum reserves’ of this Annual Report.

Capitalised costs relating to oil and gas production activities

The following table shows the aggregate capitalised costs relating to oil and gas exploration and production activities and related accumulated depreciation, depletion, amortisation and valuation allowances.

 

     Australia     United
States
    Other (b)     Total  
     US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M  

Capitalised cost

        

2014

        

Unproved properties

     344        7,355        200        7,899   

Proved properties

     14,801        34,963        2,388        52,152   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total costs

     15,145        42,318        2,588        60,051   

Less: Accumulated depreciation, depletion, amortisation and valuation allowances

     (7,135     (13,269     (2,021     (22,425
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net capitalised costs

     8,010        29,049        567        37,626   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

2013 (a)

        

Unproved properties

     279        7,875        154        8,308   

Proved properties

     13,870        29,781        3,871        47,522   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total costs

     14,149        37,656        4,025        55,830   

Less: Accumulated depreciation, depletion, amortisation and valuation allowances

     (6,512     (10,258     (3,314     (20,084
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net capitalised costs

     7,637        27,398        711        35,746   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

2012 (a)

        

Unproved properties

     363        11,800        155        12,318   

Proved properties

     12,572        19,850        3,846        36,268   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total costs

     12,935        31,650        4,001        48,586   

Less: Accumulated depreciation, depletion, amortisation and valuation allowances

     (5,973     (7,413     (3,211     (16,597
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net capitalised costs

     6,962        24,237        790        31,989   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-130


Table of Contents

 

(a) Comparative information for 2013 and 2012 has been restated on account of adoption of IFRS 10 and 11. The impact to net capitalised costs was a reduction of US$121 million in 2013 and US$124 million in 2012.

 

(b) Other is primarily comprised of Algeria, Brazil, Pakistan, Trinidad and Tobago and the United Kingdom.

Costs incurred relating to oil and gas property acquisition, exploration and development activities

The following table shows costs incurred relating to oil and gas property acquisition, exploration and development activities (whether charged to expense or capitalised). Amounts shown include interest capitalised.

 

     Australia      United States      Other (c)      Total  
     US$M      US$M      US$M      US$M  

2014

           

Acquisitions of proved property

                               

Acquisitions of unproved property

     35         217         42         294   

Exploration (a)

     185         242         97         524   

Development

     949         5,034         75         6,058   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total costs (b)

     1,169         5,493         214         6,876   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

2013

           

Acquisitions of proved property

                               

Acquisitions of unproved property

             123                 123   

Exploration (a)

     125         373         221         719   

Development

     1,410         5,698         66         7,174   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total costs (b)

     1,535         6,194         287         8,016   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

2012

           

Acquisitions of proved property

             4,746                 4,746   

Acquisitions of unproved property

     5         10,366                 10,371   

Exploration (a)

     251         690         331         1,272   

Development

     1,663         4,460         102         6,225   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total costs (b)

     1,919         20,262         433         22,614   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(a)  Represents gross exploration expenditure, including capitalised exploration expenditure, in addition to exploration and evaluation costs charged to income as incurred.

 

(b) Total costs include US$6,387 million (2013: US$7,393 million; 2012: US$6,905 million) capitalised during the year.

 

(c)  Other is primarily comprised of Algeria, Pakistan, Trinidad and Tobago and the United Kingdom.

 

F-131


Table of Contents

Results of operations from oil and gas producing activities

The following information is similar to the disclosures in note 2 ‘Segment reporting’ of the BHP Billiton Group financial statements, but differs in several respects as to the level of detail and geographic information. Amounts shown in the following table exclude financial income, financial expenses, and general corporate overheads.

Income taxes were determined by applying the applicable statutory rates to pre-tax income with adjustments for permanent differences and tax credits.

 

    Australia     United States     Other (g)     Total  
    US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M  

2014

       

Oil and gas revenue (a)

    5,722        7,517        1,045        14,284   

Production costs

    (740     (2,129     (246     (3,115

Exploration expenses

    (157     (233     (99     (489

Depreciation, depletion, amortisation and valuation provision (b)

    (617     (3,465     (172     (4,254

Production taxes (c)

    (340            (29     (369
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
    3,868        1,690        499        6,057   

Income taxes

    (1,025     (353     (413     (1,791

Royalty-related taxes (d)

    (662            8        (654
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Results of oil and gas producing activities (e)

    2,181        1,337        94        3,612   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

2013 (f)

       

Oil and gas revenue (a)

    5,794        5,807        1,332        12,933   

Production costs

    (753     (1,693     (256     (2,702

Exploration expenses

    (122     (278     (223     (623

Depreciation, depletion, amortisation and valuation provision (b)

    (561     (2,809     (141     (3,511

Production taxes (c)

    (362            1        (361
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
    3,996        1,027        713        5,736   

Income taxes

    (1,265     (162     (637     (2,064

Royalty-related taxes (d)

    (822            8        (814
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Results of oil and gas producing activities (e)

    1,909        865        84        2,858   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

2012 (f)

       

Oil and gas revenue (a)

    6,233        4,889        1,580        12,702   

Production costs

    (684     (1,225     (354     (2,263

Exploration expenses

    (156     (275     (304     (735

Depreciation, depletion, amortisation and valuation provision (b)

    (707     (4,961     (218     (5,886

Production taxes (c)

    (342            (30     (372
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
    4,344        (1,572     674        3,446   

Income taxes

    (1,332     745        (534     (1,121

Royalty-related taxes (d)

    (641            (3     (644
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Results of oil and gas producing activities (e)

    2,371        (827     137        1,681   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(a)  Includes sales to affiliated companies of US$262 million (2013: US$ nil; 2012: US$ nil).

 

(b)  Includes a valuation provision of US$309 million (2013: US$447 million; 2012: US$2,986 million).

 

(c)  Includes royalties and excise duty.

 

F-132


Table of Contents
(d)  Includes petroleum resource rent tax and petroleum revenue tax where applicable.

 

(e)  Amounts shown exclude financial income, financial expenses and general corporate overheads and, accordingly, do not represent all of the operations attributable to the Petroleum and Potash segment presented in note 2 Segment reporting to the financial statements.

 

(f)  Comparative information for 2013 and 2012 has been restated on account of adoption of IFRS 10 and 11. The impact to net results of operations was negative US$2 million in 2013 and US$ nil in 2012.

 

(g)  Other is primarily comprised of Algeria, Pakistan, Trinidad and Tobago and the United Kingdom.

Standardised measure of discounted future net cash flows relating to proved oil and gas reserves (Standardised measure)

The purpose of this disclosure is to provide data with respect to the estimated future net cash flows from future production of proved developed and undeveloped reserves of crude oil, condensate, natural gas liquids and natural gas.

The Standardised measure is based on the Group’s estimated proved reserves (as presented in section 2.3.1 ‘Petroleum reserves’) and this data should be read in conjunction with that disclosure, which is hereby incorporated by reference into this section. The Standardised measure is prepared on a basis which presumes that year-end economic and operating conditions will continue over the periods in which year-end proved reserves would be produced. The effects of future inflation, future changes in exchange rates, expected future changes in technology, taxes, operating practices and any regulatory changes have not been included.

The Standardised measure is prepared by projecting the estimated future annual production of proved reserves owned at period end and pricing that future production to derive future cash inflows. Estimates of future cash flows for 2014, 2013 and 2012 are computed using the average first-day-of-the-month price during the 12-month period. Future price increases for all periods presented are considered only to the extent that they are provided by fixed and determinable contractual arrangements in effect at year-end and are not dependent upon future inflation or exchange rate changes.

Future cash inflows for all periods presented are then reduced by future costs of producing and developing the year-end proved reserves based on costs in effect at year-end without regard to future inflation or changes in technology or operating practices. Future development costs include the costs of drilling and equipping development wells and construction of platforms and production facilities to gain access to proved reserves owned at year-end. They also include future costs, net of residual salvage value, associated with the abandonment of wells, dismantling of production platforms and rehabilitation of drilling sites. Future cash inflows are further reduced by future income taxes based on tax rates in effect at year-end and after considering the future deductions and credits applicable to proved properties owned at year-end. The resultant annual future net cash flows (after deductions of operating costs including resource rent taxes, development costs and income taxes) are discounted at 10 per cent per annum to derive the Standardised measure.

There are many important variables, assumptions and imprecisions inherent in developing the Standardised measure, the most important of which are the level of proved reserves and the rate of production thereof. The Standardised measure is not an estimate of the fair market value of the Group’s oil and gas reserves. An estimate of fair value would also take into account, among other things, the expected recovery of reserves in excess of proved reserves, anticipated future changes in prices, costs and exchange rates, anticipated future changes in secondary tax and income tax rates and alternative discount factors representing the time value of money and adjustments for risks inherent in producing oil and gas.

 

F-133


Table of Contents
     Australia     United States     Other (a)     Total  
     US$M     US$M     US$M     US$M  

Standardised measure

        

2014

        

Future cash inflows

     47,633        70,958        3,820        122,411   

Future production costs

     (11,355     (19,732     (717     (31,804

Future development costs

     (5,772     (12,953     (516     (19,241

Future income taxes

     (12,240     (10,527     (1,394     (24,161
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Future net cash flows

     18,266        27,746        1,193        47,205   

Discount at 10 per cent per annum

     (6,880     (10,866     (295     (18,041
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Standardised measure

     11,386        16,880        898        29,164   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

2013

        

Future cash inflows

     48,862        71,836        5,194        125,892   

Future production costs

     (12,818     (19,194     (1,147     (33,159

Future development costs

     (6,801     (11,946     (473     (19,220

Future income taxes

     (11,321     (12,185     (1,913     (25,419
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Future net cash flows

     17,922        28,511        1,661        48,094   

Discount at 10 per cent per annum

     (6,176     (12,785     (360     (19,321
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Standardised measure

     11,746        15,726        1,301        28,773   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

2012

        

Future cash inflows

     52,777        67,811        6,293        126,881   

Future production costs

     (12,646     (17,582     (1,339     (31,567

Future development costs

     (8,612     (13,212     (450     (22,274

Future income taxes

     (11,882     (10,414     (2,345     (24,641
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Future net cash flows

     19,637        26,603        2,159        48,399   

Discount at 10 per cent per annum

     (7,363     (13,090     (469     (20,922
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Standardised measure

     12,274        13,513        1,690        27,477   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(a)  Other is primarily comprised of Algeria, Pakistan, Trinidad and Tobago and the United Kingdom.

 

F-134


Table of Contents

Changes in the Standardised measure are presented in the following table. The beginning of the year and end of the year totals are shown after reduction for income taxes and these, together with the changes in income tax amounts, are shown as discounted amounts (at 10 per cent per annum). All other items of change represent discounted amounts before consideration of income tax effects.

 

     2014     2013     2012  
     US$M     US$M     US$M  

Changes in the Standardised measure

      

Standardised measure at the beginning of the year

     28,773        27,477        19,920   

Revisions:

      

Prices, net of production costs

     4,366        189        4,132   

Changes in future development costs

     (841     940        (987

Revisions of quantity estimates (a)

     (3,871     (4,396     5,265   

Accretion of discount

     4,564        4,323        3,134   

Changes in production timing and other

     (1,170     260        426   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     31,821        28,793        31,890   

Sales of oil and gas, net of production costs

     (10,800     (9,876     (10,093

Acquisitions of reserves-in-place

                   5,661   

Sales of reserves-in-place

     (107            (16

Previously estimated development costs incurred

     2,683        3,710        3,416   

Extensions, discoveries, and improved recoveries, net of future costs

     3,946        7,272        946   

Changes in future income taxes

     1,621        (1,126     (4,327
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Standardised measure at the end of the year

     29,164        28,773        27,477   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(a)  Changes in reserves quantities are shown in the Petroleum reserves tables in section 2.3.1.

Accounting for suspended exploratory well costs

Refer to note 1 ‘Accounting policies’ (Exploration and evaluation expenditure) of the BHP Billiton Group financial statements for a discussion of the accounting policy applied to the cost of exploratory wells. Suspended wells are also reviewed in this context.

The following tables provide the changes to capitalised exploratory well costs that were pending the determination of proved reserves for the three years ended 30 June 2014, 30 June 2013 and 30 June 2012.

 

     2014     2013     2012  
     US$M     US$M     US$M  

Movement in capitalised exploratory well costs

      

At the beginning of the year

     603        703        550   

Additions to capitalised exploratory well costs pending the determination of proved reserves

     28        97        455   

Capitalised exploratory well costs charged to expense

     (194     (99     (144

Capitalised exploratory well costs reclassified to wells, equipment, and facilities based on the determination of proved reserves

     (48     (56     (158

Other

     (1     (42       
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

At the end of the year

     388        603        703   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-135


Table of Contents

The following table provides an ageing of capitalised exploratory well costs, based on the date the drilling was completed, and the number of projects for which exploratory well costs have been capitalised for a period greater than one year since the completion of drilling.

 

    2014     2013     2012  
    US$M     US$M     US$M  

Ageing of capitalised exploratory well costs

     

Exploratory well costs capitalised for a period of one year or less

    31        96        340   

Exploratory well costs capitalised for a period greater than one year

    357        507        363   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

At the end of the year

    388        603        703   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     
    2014     2013     2012  

Number of projects that have been capitalised for a period greater than one year

    17        15        10   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Drilling and other exploratory and development activities

The number of crude oil and natural gas wells drilled and completed for each of the last three years was as follows:

 

     Net Exploratory Wells      Net Development Wells         
     Productive      Dry      Total      Productive      Dry      Total      Total  

Year ended 30 June 2014

                    

Australia

     1         2         3         3                 3         6   

United States (a)

             2         2         401         15         416         418   

Other (b)

                             1                 1         1   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     1         4         5         405         15         420         425   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Year ended 30 June 2013

                    

Australia

             1         1                                 1   

United States (a)

             1         1         352         16         368         369   

Other (b)

                             2                 2         2   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

             2         2         354         16         370         372   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Year ended 30 June 2012

                    

Australia

                             1                 1         1   

United States

     4         3         7         190         1         191         198   

Other (b)

             1         1         2         1         3         4   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     4         4         8         193         2         195         203   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(a)  Dry net development wells include four net wells (2013: 13 net wells) that encountered problems during drilling and/or completion and were not pursued further.

 

(b)  Other is primarily comprised of Algeria, Pakistan, Trinidad and Tobago and the United Kingdom.

The number of wells drilled refers to the number of wells completed at any time during the respective year, regardless of when drilling was initiated. Completion refers to the installation of permanent equipment for production of oil or gas, or, in the case of a dry well, to reporting to the appropriate authority that the well has been abandoned.

 

F-136


Table of Contents

An exploratory well is a well drilled to find oil or gas in a new field or to find a new reservoir in a field previously found to be productive of oil or gas in another reservoir. A development well is a well drilled within the limits of a known oil or gas reservoir to the depth of a stratigraphic horizon known to be productive.

A productive well is an exploratory, development or extension well that is not a dry well. A dry well (hole) is an exploratory, development, or extension well that proves to be incapable of producing either oil or gas in sufficient quantities to justify completion as an oil or gas well.

Oil and gas properties, wells, operations and acreage

The following tables show the number of gross and net productive crude oil and natural gas wells and total gross and net developed and undeveloped oil and natural gas acreage as at 30 June 2014. A gross well or acre is one in which a working interest is owned, while a net well or acre exists when the sum of fractional working interests owned in gross wells or acres equals one. Productive wells are producing wells and wells mechanically capable of production. Developed acreage is comprised of leased acres that are within an area by or assignable to a productive well. Undeveloped acreage is comprised of leased acres on which wells have not been drilled or completed to a point that would permit the production of economic quantities of oil and gas, regardless of whether such acres contain proved reserves.

The number of productive crude oil and natural gas wells in which we held an interest at 30 June 2014 was as follows:

 

     Crude Oil Wells      Natural Gas Wells      Total  
     Gross      Net      Gross      Net      Gross      Net  

Australia

     354         176         127         48         481         224   

United States

     391         214         7,362         2,431         7,753         2,645   

Other (a)

     60         24         46         10         106         34   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     805         414         7,535         2,489         8,340         2,903   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(a)  Other is primarily comprised of Algeria, Pakistan, Trinidad and Tobago and the United Kingdom.

Of the productive crude oil and natural gas wells, 25 (net: 10) operated wells had multiple completions.

Developed and undeveloped acreage (including both leases and concessions) held at 30 June 2014 was as follows:

 

     Developed Acreage      Undeveloped Acreage  

Thousands of acres

   Gross      Net      Gross      Net  

Australia

     2,072         811         7,125         4,463   

United States

     1,157         674         2,220         1,510   

Other (a)

     307         115         13,825         9,955   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total (b)

     3,536         1,600         23,170         15,928   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(a)  Undeveloped acreage primarily consists of acreage in Brazil, Trinidad and Tobago, South Africa, Philippines and Malaysia.

 

(b)  Approximately 1,470,807 gross acres (1,276,339 net acres), 1,937,729 gross acres (1,110,992 net acres) and 5,196,953 gross acres (4,914,905 net acres) of undeveloped acreage will expire in the years ending 30 June 2015, 2016 and 2017 respectively, if the Company does not establish production or take any other action to extend the terms of the licenses and concessions.

 

F-137